Merge branch 'master' into staging
[jackhill/guix/guix.git] / doc / guix.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @c -*-texinfo-*-
3
4 @c %**start of header
5 @setfilename guix.info
6 @documentencoding UTF-8
7 @settitle GNU Guix Reference Manual
8 @c %**end of header
9
10 @include version.texi
11
12 @c Identifier of the OpenPGP key used to sign tarballs and such.
13 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID 3CE464558A84FDC69DB40CFB090B11993D9AEBB5
14 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL https://sv.gnu.org/people/viewgpg.php?user_id=15145
15
16 @c Base URL for downloads.
17 @set BASE-URL https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/guix
18
19 @c The official substitute server used by default.
20 @set SUBSTITUTE-SERVER ci.guix.gnu.org
21 @set SUBSTITUTE-URL https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}
22
23 @copying
24 Copyright @copyright{} 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Ludovic Courtès@*
25 Copyright @copyright{} 2013, 2014, 2016 Andreas Enge@*
26 Copyright @copyright{} 2013 Nikita Karetnikov@*
27 Copyright @copyright{} 2014, 2015, 2016 Alex Kost@*
28 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Mathieu Lirzin@*
29 Copyright @copyright{} 2014 Pierre-Antoine Rault@*
30 Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Taylan Ulrich Bayırlı/Kammer@*
31 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2019, 2020 Leo Famulari@*
32 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Ricardo Wurmus@*
33 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Ben Woodcroft@*
34 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018 Chris Marusich@*
35 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Efraim Flashner@*
36 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 John Darrington@*
37 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017 ng0@*
38 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Jan Nieuwenhuizen@*
39 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Julien Lepiller@*
40 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Alex ter Weele@*
41 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Christopher Baines@*
42 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019 Clément Lassieur@*
43 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Mathieu Othacehe@*
44 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Federico Beffa@*
45 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Carlo Zancanaro@*
46 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Thomas Danckaert@*
47 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 humanitiesNerd@*
48 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Christopher Allan Webber@*
49 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Marius Bakke@*
50 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2019, 2020 Hartmut Goebel@*
51 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2019, 2020 Maxim Cournoyer@*
52 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Tobias Geerinckx-Rice@*
53 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 George Clemmer@*
54 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Andy Wingo@*
55 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019 Arun Isaac@*
56 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 nee@*
57 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Rutger Helling@*
58 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Oleg Pykhalov@*
59 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Mike Gerwitz@*
60 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Pierre-Antoine Rouby@*
61 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019 Gábor Boskovits@*
62 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019 Florian Pelz@*
63 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Laura Lazzati@*
64 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Alex Vong@*
65 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Josh Holland@*
66 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Diego Nicola Barbato@*
67 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Ivan Petkov@*
68 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Jakob L. Kreuze@*
69 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Kyle Andrews@*
70 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Alex Griffin@*
71 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Guillaume Le Vaillant@*
72 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Leo Prikler@*
73 Copyright @copyright{} 2019, 2020 Simon Tournier@*
74 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Wiktor Żelazny@*
75 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Damien Cassou@*
76 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Jakub Kądziołka@*
77 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Jack Hill@*
78
79 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
80 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
81 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
82 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
83 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
84 Documentation License''.
85 @end copying
86
87 @dircategory System administration
88 @direntry
89 * Guix: (guix). Manage installed software and system configuration.
90 * guix package: (guix)Invoking guix package. Installing, removing, and upgrading packages.
91 * guix gc: (guix)Invoking guix gc. Reclaiming unused disk space.
92 * guix pull: (guix)Invoking guix pull. Update the list of available packages.
93 * guix system: (guix)Invoking guix system. Manage the operating system configuration.
94 * guix deploy: (guix)Invoking guix deploy. Manage operating system configurations for remote hosts.
95 @end direntry
96
97 @dircategory Software development
98 @direntry
99 * guix environment: (guix)Invoking guix environment. Building development environments with Guix.
100 * guix build: (guix)Invoking guix build. Building packages.
101 * guix pack: (guix)Invoking guix pack. Creating binary bundles.
102 @end direntry
103
104 @titlepage
105 @title GNU Guix Reference Manual
106 @subtitle Using the GNU Guix Functional Package Manager
107 @author The GNU Guix Developers
108
109 @page
110 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
111 Edition @value{EDITION} @*
112 @value{UPDATED} @*
113
114 @insertcopying
115 @end titlepage
116
117 @contents
118
119 @c *********************************************************************
120 @node Top
121 @top GNU Guix
122
123 This document describes GNU Guix version @value{VERSION}, a functional
124 package management tool written for the GNU system.
125
126 @c TRANSLATORS: You can replace the following paragraph with information on
127 @c how to join your own translation team and how to report issues with the
128 @c translation.
129 This manual is also available in Simplified Chinese (@pxref{Top,,, guix.zh_CN,
130 GNU Guix参考手册}), French (@pxref{Top,,, guix.fr, Manuel de référence de GNU
131 Guix}), German (@pxref{Top,,, guix.de, Referenzhandbuch zu GNU Guix}),
132 Spanish (@pxref{Top,,, guix.es, Manual de referencia de GNU Guix}), and
133 Russian (@pxref{Top,,, guix.ru, Руководство GNU Guix}). If you
134 would like to translate it in your native language, consider joining the
135 @uref{https://translationproject.org/domain/guix-manual.html, Translation
136 Project}.
137
138 @menu
139 * Introduction:: What is Guix about?
140 * Installation:: Installing Guix.
141 * System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
142 * Package Management:: Package installation, upgrade, etc.
143 * Development:: Guix-aided software development.
144 * Programming Interface:: Using Guix in Scheme.
145 * Utilities:: Package management commands.
146 * System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
147 * Documentation:: Browsing software user manuals.
148 * Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
149 * Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
150 * Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
151 * Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
152 * Contributing:: Your help needed!
153
154 * Acknowledgments:: Thanks!
155 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license of this manual.
156 * Concept Index:: Concepts.
157 * Programming Index:: Data types, functions, and variables.
158
159 @detailmenu
160 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
161
162 Introduction
163
164 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
165 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
166
167 Installation
168
169 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
170 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
171 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
172 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
173 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
174 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
175
176 Setting Up the Daemon
177
178 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
179 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
180 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
181
182 System Installation
183
184 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
185 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
186 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
187 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
188 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
189 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
190 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
191 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
192 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
193
194 Manual Installation
195
196 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
197 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
198
199 Package Management
200
201 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
202 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
203 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
204 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
205 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
206 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
207 * Channels:: Customizing the package collection.
208 * Invoking guix time-machine:: Running an older revision of Guix.
209 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
210 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
211 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
212
213 Substitutes
214
215 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
216 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
217 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
218 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
219 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
220 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
221
222 Development
223
224 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
225 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
226
227 Programming Interface
228
229 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
230 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
231 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
232 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
233 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
234 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
235 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
236 * Invoking guix repl:: Fiddling with Guix interactively.
237
238 Defining Packages
239
240 * package Reference:: The package data type.
241 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
242
243 Utilities
244
245 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
246 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
247 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
248 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
249 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
250 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
251 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
252 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
253 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
254 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
255 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
256 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
257 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
258 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
259 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
260
261 Invoking @command{guix build}
262
263 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
264 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
265 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
266 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
267
268 System Configuration
269
270 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
271 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
272 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
273 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
274 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
275 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
276 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
277 * Services:: Specifying system services.
278 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
279 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
280 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
281 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
282 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
283 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
284 * Invoking guix deploy:: Deploying a system configuration to a remote host.
285 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
286 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
287
288 Services
289
290 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
291 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
292 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
293 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
294 * X Window:: Graphical display.
295 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
296 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
297 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
298 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
299 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
300 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
301 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
302 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
303 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
304 * Web Services:: Web servers.
305 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
306 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
307 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
308 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
309 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
310 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
311 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
312 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
313 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
314 * Game Services:: Game servers.
315 * PAM Mount Service:: Service to mount volumes when logging in.
316 * Linux Services:: Services tied to the Linux kernel.
317 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
318
319 Defining Services
320
321 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
322 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
323 * Service Reference:: API reference.
324 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
325
326 @end detailmenu
327 @end menu
328
329 @c *********************************************************************
330 @node Introduction
331 @chapter Introduction
332
333 @cindex purpose
334 GNU Guix@footnote{``Guix'' is pronounced like ``geeks'', or ``ɡiːks''
335 using the international phonetic alphabet (IPA).} is a package
336 management tool for and distribution of the GNU system.
337 Guix makes it easy for unprivileged
338 users to install, upgrade, or remove software packages, to roll back to a
339 previous package set, to build packages from source, and generally
340 assists with the creation and maintenance of software environments.
341
342 @cindex Guix System
343 @cindex GuixSD, now Guix System
344 @cindex Guix System Distribution, now Guix System
345 You can install GNU@tie{}Guix on top of an existing GNU/Linux system where it
346 complements the available tools without interference (@pxref{Installation}),
347 or you can use it as a standalone operating system distribution,
348 @dfn{Guix@tie{}System}@footnote{We used to refer to Guix System as ``Guix
349 System Distribution'' or ``GuixSD''. We now consider it makes more sense to
350 group everything under the ``Guix'' banner since, after all, Guix System is
351 readily available through the @command{guix system} command, even if you're
352 using a different distro underneath!}. @xref{GNU Distribution}.
353
354 @menu
355 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
356 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
357 @end menu
358
359 @node Managing Software the Guix Way
360 @section Managing Software the Guix Way
361
362 @cindex user interfaces
363 Guix provides a command-line package management interface
364 (@pxref{Package Management}), tools to help with software development
365 (@pxref{Development}), command-line utilities for more advanced usage,
366 (@pxref{Utilities}), as well as Scheme programming interfaces
367 (@pxref{Programming Interface}).
368 @cindex build daemon
369 Its @dfn{build daemon} is responsible for building packages on behalf of
370 users (@pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}) and for downloading pre-built
371 binaries from authorized sources (@pxref{Substitutes}).
372
373 @cindex extensibility of the distribution
374 @cindex customization, of packages
375 Guix includes package definitions for many GNU and non-GNU packages, all
376 of which @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, respect the
377 user's computing freedom}. It is @emph{extensible}: users can write
378 their own package definitions (@pxref{Defining Packages}) and make them
379 available as independent package modules (@pxref{Package Modules}). It
380 is also @emph{customizable}: users can @emph{derive} specialized package
381 definitions from existing ones, including from the command line
382 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
383
384 @cindex functional package management
385 @cindex isolation
386 Under the hood, Guix implements the @dfn{functional package management}
387 discipline pioneered by Nix (@pxref{Acknowledgments}).
388 In Guix, the package build and installation process is seen
389 as a @emph{function}, in the mathematical sense. That function takes inputs,
390 such as build scripts, a compiler, and libraries, and
391 returns an installed package. As a pure function, its result depends
392 solely on its inputs---for instance, it cannot refer to software or
393 scripts that were not explicitly passed as inputs. A build function
394 always produces the same result when passed a given set of inputs. It
395 cannot alter the environment of the running system in
396 any way; for instance, it cannot create, modify, or delete files outside
397 of its build and installation directories. This is achieved by running
398 build processes in isolated environments (or @dfn{containers}), where only their
399 explicit inputs are visible.
400
401 @cindex store
402 The result of package build functions is @dfn{cached} in the file
403 system, in a special directory called @dfn{the store} (@pxref{The
404 Store}). Each package is installed in a directory of its own in the
405 store---by default under @file{/gnu/store}. The directory name contains
406 a hash of all the inputs used to build that package; thus, changing an
407 input yields a different directory name.
408
409 This approach is the foundation for the salient features of Guix: support
410 for transactional package upgrade and rollback, per-user installation, and
411 garbage collection of packages (@pxref{Features}).
412
413
414 @node GNU Distribution
415 @section GNU Distribution
416
417 @cindex Guix System
418 Guix comes with a distribution of the GNU system consisting entirely of
419 free software@footnote{The term ``free'' here refers to the
420 @url{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,freedom provided to
421 users of that software}.}. The
422 distribution can be installed on its own (@pxref{System Installation}),
423 but it is also possible to install Guix as a package manager on top of
424 an installed GNU/Linux system (@pxref{Installation}). When we need to
425 distinguish between the two, we refer to the standalone distribution as
426 Guix@tie{}System.
427
428 The distribution provides core GNU packages such as GNU libc, GCC, and
429 Binutils, as well as many GNU and non-GNU applications. The complete
430 list of available packages can be browsed
431 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/packages,on-line} or by
432 running @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}):
433
434 @example
435 guix package --list-available
436 @end example
437
438 Our goal is to provide a practical 100% free software distribution of
439 Linux-based and other variants of GNU, with a focus on the promotion and
440 tight integration of GNU components, and an emphasis on programs and
441 tools that help users exert that freedom.
442
443 Packages are currently available on the following platforms:
444
445 @table @code
446
447 @item x86_64-linux
448 Intel/AMD @code{x86_64} architecture, Linux-Libre kernel;
449
450 @item i686-linux
451 Intel 32-bit architecture (IA32), Linux-Libre kernel;
452
453 @item armhf-linux
454 ARMv7-A architecture with hard float, Thumb-2 and NEON,
455 using the EABI hard-float application binary interface (ABI),
456 and Linux-Libre kernel.
457
458 @item aarch64-linux
459 little-endian 64-bit ARMv8-A processors, Linux-Libre kernel.
460
461 @item mips64el-linux
462 little-endian 64-bit MIPS processors, specifically the Loongson series,
463 n32 ABI, and Linux-Libre kernel. This configuration is no longer fully
464 supported; in particular, the project's build farms no longer provide
465 substitutes for this architecture.
466
467 @end table
468
469 With Guix@tie{}System, you @emph{declare} all aspects of the operating system
470 configuration and Guix takes care of instantiating the configuration in a
471 transactional, reproducible, and stateless fashion (@pxref{System
472 Configuration}). Guix System uses the Linux-libre kernel, the Shepherd
473 initialization system (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd
474 Manual}), the well-known GNU utilities and tool chain, as well as the
475 graphical environment or system services of your choice.
476
477 Guix System is available on all the above platforms except
478 @code{mips64el-linux}.
479
480 @noindent
481 For information on porting to other architectures or kernels,
482 @pxref{Porting}.
483
484 Building this distribution is a cooperative effort, and you are invited
485 to join! @xref{Contributing}, for information about how you can help.
486
487
488 @c *********************************************************************
489 @node Installation
490 @chapter Installation
491
492 @cindex installing Guix
493
494 @quotation Note
495 We recommend the use of this
496 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
497 shell installer script} to install Guix on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
498 thereafter called a @dfn{foreign distro}.@footnote{This section is concerned
499 with the installation of the package manager, which can be done on top of a
500 running GNU/Linux system. If, instead, you want to install the complete GNU
501 operating system, @pxref{System Installation}.} The script automates the
502 download, installation, and initial configuration of Guix. It should be run
503 as the root user.
504 @end quotation
505
506 @cindex foreign distro
507 @cindex directories related to foreign distro
508 When installed on a foreign distro, GNU@tie{}Guix complements the available
509 tools without interference. Its data lives exclusively in two directories,
510 usually @file{/gnu/store} and @file{/var/guix}; other files on your system,
511 such as @file{/etc}, are left untouched.
512
513 Once installed, Guix can be updated by running @command{guix pull}
514 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}).
515
516 If you prefer to perform the installation steps manually or want to tweak
517 them, you may find the following subsections useful. They describe the
518 software requirements of Guix, as well as how to install it manually and get
519 ready to use it.
520
521 @menu
522 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
523 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
524 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
525 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
526 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
527 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
528 * Upgrading Guix:: Upgrading Guix and its build daemon.
529 @end menu
530
531 @node Binary Installation
532 @section Binary Installation
533
534 @cindex installing Guix from binaries
535 @cindex installer script
536 This section describes how to install Guix on an arbitrary system from a
537 self-contained tarball providing binaries for Guix and for all its
538 dependencies. This is often quicker than installing from source, which
539 is described in the next sections. The only requirement is to have
540 GNU@tie{}tar and Xz.
541
542 @c Note duplicated from the ``Installation'' node.
543 @quotation Note
544 We recommend the use of this
545 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
546 shell installer script}. The script automates the download, installation, and
547 initial configuration steps described below. It should be run as the root
548 user.
549 @end quotation
550
551 Installing goes along these lines:
552
553 @enumerate
554 @item
555 @cindex downloading Guix binary
556 Download the binary tarball from
557 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz},
558 where @var{system} is @code{x86_64-linux} for an @code{x86_64} machine
559 already running the kernel Linux, and so on.
560
561 @c The following is somewhat duplicated in ``System Installation''.
562 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
563 authenticity of the tarball against it, along these lines:
564
565 @example
566 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
567 $ gpg --verify guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
568 @end example
569
570 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
571 then run this command to import it:
572
573 @example
574 $ wget @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL} \
575 -qO - | gpg --import -
576 @end example
577
578 @noindent
579 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
580
581 Take note that a warning like ``This key is not certified with a trusted
582 signature!'' is normal.
583
584 @c end authentication part
585
586 @item
587 Now, you need to become the @code{root} user. Depending on your distribution,
588 you may have to run @code{su -} or @code{sudo -i}. As @code{root}, run:
589
590 @example
591 # cd /tmp
592 # tar --warning=no-timestamp -xf \
593 /path/to/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz
594 # mv var/guix /var/ && mv gnu /
595 @end example
596
597 This creates @file{/gnu/store} (@pxref{The Store}) and @file{/var/guix}.
598 The latter contains a ready-to-use profile for @code{root} (see next
599 step.)
600
601 Do @emph{not} unpack the tarball on a working Guix system since that
602 would overwrite its own essential files.
603
604 The @code{--warning=no-timestamp} option makes sure GNU@tie{}tar does
605 not emit warnings about ``implausibly old time stamps'' (such
606 warnings were triggered by GNU@tie{}tar 1.26 and older; recent
607 versions are fine.)
608 They stem from the fact that all the
609 files in the archive have their modification time set to zero (which
610 means January 1st, 1970.) This is done on purpose to make sure the
611 archive content is independent of its creation time, thus making it
612 reproducible.
613
614 @item
615 Make the profile available under @file{~root/.config/guix/current}, which is
616 where @command{guix pull} will install updates (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}):
617
618 @example
619 # mkdir -p ~root/.config/guix
620 # ln -sf /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix \
621 ~root/.config/guix/current
622 @end example
623
624 Source @file{etc/profile} to augment @code{PATH} and other relevant
625 environment variables:
626
627 @example
628 # GUIX_PROFILE="`echo ~root`/.config/guix/current" ; \
629 source $GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile
630 @end example
631
632 @item
633 Create the group and user accounts for build users as explained below
634 (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
635
636 @item
637 Run the daemon, and set it to automatically start on boot.
638
639 If your host distro uses the systemd init system, this can be achieved
640 with these commands:
641
642 @c Versions of systemd that supported symlinked service files are not
643 @c yet widely deployed, so we should suggest that users copy the service
644 @c files into place.
645 @c
646 @c See this thread for more information:
647 @c https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2017-01/msg01199.html
648
649 @example
650 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service \
651 /etc/systemd/system/
652 # systemctl start guix-daemon && systemctl enable guix-daemon
653 @end example
654
655 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
656
657 @example
658 # initctl reload-configuration
659 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf \
660 /etc/init/
661 # start guix-daemon
662 @end example
663
664 Otherwise, you can still start the daemon manually with:
665
666 @example
667 # ~root/.config/guix/current/bin/guix-daemon \
668 --build-users-group=guixbuild
669 @end example
670
671 @item
672 Make the @command{guix} command available to other users on the machine,
673 for instance with:
674
675 @example
676 # mkdir -p /usr/local/bin
677 # cd /usr/local/bin
678 # ln -s /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/bin/guix
679 @end example
680
681 It is also a good idea to make the Info version of this manual available
682 there:
683
684 @example
685 # mkdir -p /usr/local/share/info
686 # cd /usr/local/share/info
687 # for i in /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/share/info/* ;
688 do ln -s $i ; done
689 @end example
690
691 That way, assuming @file{/usr/local/share/info} is in the search path,
692 running @command{info guix} will open this manual (@pxref{Other Info
693 Directories,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}, for more details on changing the
694 Info search path.)
695
696 @item
697 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
698 To use substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or one of its mirrors
699 (@pxref{Substitutes}), authorize them:
700
701 @example
702 # guix archive --authorize < \
703 ~root/.config/guix/current/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
704 @end example
705
706 @item
707 Each user may need to perform a few additional steps to make their Guix
708 environment ready for use, @pxref{Application Setup}.
709 @end enumerate
710
711 Voilà, the installation is complete!
712
713 You can confirm that Guix is working by installing a sample package into
714 the root profile:
715
716 @example
717 # guix install hello
718 @end example
719
720 The binary installation tarball can be (re)produced and verified simply
721 by running the following command in the Guix source tree:
722
723 @example
724 make guix-binary.@var{system}.tar.xz
725 @end example
726
727 @noindent
728 ...@: which, in turn, runs:
729
730 @example
731 guix pack -s @var{system} --localstatedir \
732 --profile-name=current-guix guix
733 @end example
734
735 @xref{Invoking guix pack}, for more info on this handy tool.
736
737 @node Requirements
738 @section Requirements
739
740 This section lists requirements when building Guix from source. The
741 build procedure for Guix is the same as for other GNU software, and is
742 not covered here. Please see the files @file{README} and @file{INSTALL}
743 in the Guix source tree for additional details.
744
745 @cindex official website
746 GNU Guix is available for download from its website at
747 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/}.
748
749 GNU Guix depends on the following packages:
750
751 @itemize
752 @item @url{https://gnu.org/software/guile/, GNU Guile}, version 3.0.x or
753 2.2.x;
754 @item @url{https://notabug.org/cwebber/guile-gcrypt, Guile-Gcrypt}, version
755 0.1.0 or later;
756 @item
757 @uref{https://gnutls.org/, GnuTLS}, specifically its Guile bindings
758 (@pxref{Guile Preparations, how to install the GnuTLS bindings for
759 Guile,, gnutls-guile, GnuTLS-Guile});
760 @item
761 @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-sqlite3/guile-sqlite3, Guile-SQLite3}, version 0.1.0
762 or later;
763 @item
764 @c FIXME: Specify a version number once a release has been made.
765 @uref{https://gitlab.com/guile-git/guile-git, Guile-Git}, from August
766 2017 or later;
767 @item @uref{https://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/guile-json/, Guile-JSON} 3.x;
768 @item @url{https://zlib.net, zlib};
769 @item @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/make/, GNU Make}.
770 @end itemize
771
772 The following dependencies are optional:
773
774 @itemize
775 @item
776 @c Note: We need at least 0.12.0 for 'userauth-gssapi!'.
777 Support for build offloading (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}) and
778 @command{guix copy} (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}) depends on
779 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH},
780 version 0.12.0 or later.
781
782 @item
783 When @url{https://www.nongnu.org/lzip/lzlib.html, lzlib} is available, lzlib
784 substitutes can be used and @command{guix publish} can compress substitutes
785 with lzlib.
786
787 @item
788 When @url{http://www.bzip.org, libbz2} is available,
789 @command{guix-daemon} can use it to compress build logs.
790 @end itemize
791
792 Unless @code{--disable-daemon} was passed to @command{configure}, the
793 following packages are also needed:
794
795 @itemize
796 @item @url{https://gnupg.org/, GNU libgcrypt};
797 @item @url{https://sqlite.org, SQLite 3};
798 @item @url{https://gcc.gnu.org, GCC's g++}, with support for the
799 C++11 standard.
800 @end itemize
801
802 @cindex state directory
803 When configuring Guix on a system that already has a Guix installation,
804 be sure to specify the same state directory as the existing installation
805 using the @code{--localstatedir} option of the @command{configure}
806 script (@pxref{Directory Variables, @code{localstatedir},, standards,
807 GNU Coding Standards}). Usually, this @var{localstatedir} option is
808 set to the value @file{/var}. The @command{configure} script protects
809 against unintended misconfiguration of @var{localstatedir} so you do not
810 inadvertently corrupt your store (@pxref{The Store}).
811
812 @node Running the Test Suite
813 @section Running the Test Suite
814
815 @cindex test suite
816 After a successful @command{configure} and @code{make} run, it is a good
817 idea to run the test suite. It can help catch issues with the setup or
818 environment, or bugs in Guix itself---and really, reporting test
819 failures is a good way to help improve the software. To run the test
820 suite, type:
821
822 @example
823 make check
824 @end example
825
826 Test cases can run in parallel: you can use the @code{-j} option of
827 GNU@tie{}make to speed things up. The first run may take a few minutes
828 on a recent machine; subsequent runs will be faster because the store
829 that is created for test purposes will already have various things in
830 cache.
831
832 It is also possible to run a subset of the tests by defining the
833 @code{TESTS} makefile variable as in this example:
834
835 @example
836 make check TESTS="tests/store.scm tests/cpio.scm"
837 @end example
838
839 By default, tests results are displayed at a file level. In order to
840 see the details of every individual test cases, it is possible to define
841 the @code{SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS} makefile variable as in this example:
842
843 @example
844 make check TESTS="tests/base64.scm" SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no"
845 @end example
846
847 Upon failure, please email @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org} and attach the
848 @file{test-suite.log} file. Please specify the Guix version being used
849 as well as version numbers of the dependencies (@pxref{Requirements}) in
850 your message.
851
852 Guix also comes with a whole-system test suite that tests complete
853 Guix System instances. It can only run on systems where
854 Guix is already installed, using:
855
856 @example
857 make check-system
858 @end example
859
860 @noindent
861 or, again, by defining @code{TESTS} to select a subset of tests to run:
862
863 @example
864 make check-system TESTS="basic mcron"
865 @end example
866
867 These system tests are defined in the @code{(gnu tests @dots{})}
868 modules. They work by running the operating systems under test with
869 lightweight instrumentation in a virtual machine (VM). They can be
870 computationally intensive or rather cheap, depending on whether
871 substitutes are available for their dependencies (@pxref{Substitutes}).
872 Some of them require a lot of storage space to hold VM images.
873
874 Again in case of test failures, please send @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org}
875 all the details.
876
877 @node Setting Up the Daemon
878 @section Setting Up the Daemon
879
880 @cindex daemon
881 Operations such as building a package or running the garbage collector
882 are all performed by a specialized process, the @dfn{build daemon}, on
883 behalf of clients. Only the daemon may access the store and its
884 associated database. Thus, any operation that manipulates the store
885 goes through the daemon. For instance, command-line tools such as
886 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build} communicate with the
887 daemon (@i{via} remote procedure calls) to instruct it what to do.
888
889 The following sections explain how to prepare the build daemon's
890 environment. See also @ref{Substitutes}, for information on how to allow
891 the daemon to download pre-built binaries.
892
893 @menu
894 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
895 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
896 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
897 @end menu
898
899 @node Build Environment Setup
900 @subsection Build Environment Setup
901
902 @cindex build environment
903 In a standard multi-user setup, Guix and its daemon---the
904 @command{guix-daemon} program---are installed by the system
905 administrator; @file{/gnu/store} is owned by @code{root} and
906 @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}. Unprivileged users may use
907 Guix tools to build packages or otherwise access the store, and the
908 daemon will do it on their behalf, ensuring that the store is kept in a
909 consistent state, and allowing built packages to be shared among users.
910
911 @cindex build users
912 When @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}, you may not want package
913 build processes themselves to run as @code{root} too, for obvious
914 security reasons. To avoid that, a special pool of @dfn{build users}
915 should be created for use by build processes started by the daemon.
916 These build users need not have a shell and a home directory: they will
917 just be used when the daemon drops @code{root} privileges in build
918 processes. Having several such users allows the daemon to launch
919 distinct build processes under separate UIDs, which guarantees that they
920 do not interfere with each other---an essential feature since builds are
921 regarded as pure functions (@pxref{Introduction}).
922
923 On a GNU/Linux system, a build user pool may be created like this (using
924 Bash syntax and the @code{shadow} commands):
925
926 @c See https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-guix/2013-01/msg00239.html
927 @c for why `-G' is needed.
928 @example
929 # groupadd --system guixbuild
930 # for i in `seq -w 1 10`;
931 do
932 useradd -g guixbuild -G guixbuild \
933 -d /var/empty -s `which nologin` \
934 -c "Guix build user $i" --system \
935 guixbuilder$i;
936 done
937 @end example
938
939 @noindent
940 The number of build users determines how many build jobs may run in
941 parallel, as specified by the @option{--max-jobs} option
942 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}). To use
943 @command{guix system vm} and related commands, you may need to add the
944 build users to the @code{kvm} group so they can access @file{/dev/kvm},
945 using @code{-G guixbuild,kvm} instead of @code{-G guixbuild}
946 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
947
948 The @code{guix-daemon} program may then be run as @code{root} with the
949 following command@footnote{If your machine uses the systemd init system,
950 dropping the @file{@var{prefix}/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}
951 file in @file{/etc/systemd/system} will ensure that
952 @command{guix-daemon} is automatically started. Similarly, if your
953 machine uses the Upstart init system, drop the
954 @file{@var{prefix}/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf}
955 file in @file{/etc/init}.}:
956
957 @example
958 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
959 @end example
960
961 @cindex chroot
962 @noindent
963 This way, the daemon starts build processes in a chroot, under one of
964 the @code{guixbuilder} users. On GNU/Linux, by default, the chroot
965 environment contains nothing but:
966
967 @c Keep this list in sync with libstore/build.cc! -----------------------
968 @itemize
969 @item
970 a minimal @code{/dev} directory, created mostly independently from the
971 host @code{/dev}@footnote{``Mostly'', because while the set of files
972 that appear in the chroot's @code{/dev} is fixed, most of these files
973 can only be created if the host has them.};
974
975 @item
976 the @code{/proc} directory; it only shows the processes of the container
977 since a separate PID name space is used;
978
979 @item
980 @file{/etc/passwd} with an entry for the current user and an entry for
981 user @file{nobody};
982
983 @item
984 @file{/etc/group} with an entry for the user's group;
985
986 @item
987 @file{/etc/hosts} with an entry that maps @code{localhost} to
988 @code{127.0.0.1};
989
990 @item
991 a writable @file{/tmp} directory.
992 @end itemize
993
994 You can influence the directory where the daemon stores build trees
995 @i{via} the @code{TMPDIR} environment variable. However, the build tree
996 within the chroot is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0},
997 where @var{name} is the derivation name---e.g., @code{coreutils-8.24}.
998 This way, the value of @code{TMPDIR} does not leak inside build
999 environments, which avoids discrepancies in cases where build processes
1000 capture the name of their build tree.
1001
1002 @vindex http_proxy
1003 The daemon also honors the @code{http_proxy} environment variable for
1004 HTTP downloads it performs, be it for fixed-output derivations
1005 (@pxref{Derivations}) or for substitutes (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1006
1007 If you are installing Guix as an unprivileged user, it is still possible
1008 to run @command{guix-daemon} provided you pass @code{--disable-chroot}.
1009 However, build processes will not be isolated from one another, and not
1010 from the rest of the system. Thus, build processes may interfere with
1011 each other, and may access programs, libraries, and other files
1012 available on the system---making it much harder to view them as
1013 @emph{pure} functions.
1014
1015
1016 @node Daemon Offload Setup
1017 @subsection Using the Offload Facility
1018
1019 @cindex offloading
1020 @cindex build hook
1021 When desired, the build daemon can @dfn{offload} derivation builds to
1022 other machines running Guix, using the @code{offload} @dfn{build
1023 hook}@footnote{This feature is available only when
1024 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH} is
1025 present.}. When that
1026 feature is enabled, a list of user-specified build machines is read from
1027 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}; every time a build is requested, for
1028 instance via @code{guix build}, the daemon attempts to offload it to one
1029 of the machines that satisfy the constraints of the derivation, in
1030 particular its system type---e.g., @file{x86_64-linux}. Missing
1031 prerequisites for the build are copied over SSH to the target machine,
1032 which then proceeds with the build; upon success the output(s) of the
1033 build are copied back to the initial machine.
1034
1035 The @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} file typically looks like this:
1036
1037 @lisp
1038 (list (build-machine
1039 (name "eightysix.example.org")
1040 (system "x86_64-linux")
1041 (host-key "ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nza@dots{}")
1042 (user "bob")
1043 (speed 2.)) ;incredibly fast!
1044
1045 (build-machine
1046 (name "meeps.example.org")
1047 (system "mips64el-linux")
1048 (host-key "ssh-rsa AAAAB3Nza@dots{}")
1049 (user "alice")
1050 (private-key
1051 (string-append (getenv "HOME")
1052 "/.ssh/identity-for-guix"))))
1053 @end lisp
1054
1055 @noindent
1056 In the example above we specify a list of two build machines, one for
1057 the @code{x86_64} architecture and one for the @code{mips64el}
1058 architecture.
1059
1060 In fact, this file is---not surprisingly!---a Scheme file that is
1061 evaluated when the @code{offload} hook is started. Its return value
1062 must be a list of @code{build-machine} objects. While this example
1063 shows a fixed list of build machines, one could imagine, say, using
1064 DNS-SD to return a list of potential build machines discovered in the
1065 local network (@pxref{Introduction, Guile-Avahi,, guile-avahi, Using
1066 Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}). The @code{build-machine} data type is
1067 detailed below.
1068
1069 @deftp {Data Type} build-machine
1070 This data type represents build machines to which the daemon may offload
1071 builds. The important fields are:
1072
1073 @table @code
1074
1075 @item name
1076 The host name of the remote machine.
1077
1078 @item system
1079 The system type of the remote machine---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
1080
1081 @item user
1082 The user account to use when connecting to the remote machine over SSH.
1083 Note that the SSH key pair must @emph{not} be passphrase-protected, to
1084 allow non-interactive logins.
1085
1086 @item host-key
1087 This must be the machine's SSH @dfn{public host key} in OpenSSH format.
1088 This is used to authenticate the machine when we connect to it. It is a
1089 long string that looks like this:
1090
1091 @example
1092 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3NzaC@dots{}mde+UhL hint@@example.org
1093 @end example
1094
1095 If the machine is running the OpenSSH daemon, @command{sshd}, the host
1096 key can be found in a file such as
1097 @file{/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key.pub}.
1098
1099 If the machine is running the SSH daemon of GNU@tie{}lsh,
1100 @command{lshd}, the host key is in @file{/etc/lsh/host-key.pub} or a
1101 similar file. It can be converted to the OpenSSH format using
1102 @command{lsh-export-key} (@pxref{Converting keys,,, lsh, LSH Manual}):
1103
1104 @example
1105 $ lsh-export-key --openssh < /etc/lsh/host-key.pub
1106 ssh-rsa AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAAEOp8FoQAAAQEAs1eB46LV@dots{}
1107 @end example
1108
1109 @end table
1110
1111 A number of optional fields may be specified:
1112
1113 @table @asis
1114
1115 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
1116 Port number of SSH server on the machine.
1117
1118 @item @code{private-key} (default: @file{~root/.ssh/id_rsa})
1119 The SSH private key file to use when connecting to the machine, in
1120 OpenSSH format. This key must not be protected with a passphrase.
1121
1122 Note that the default value is the private key @emph{of the root
1123 account}. Make sure it exists if you use the default.
1124
1125 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{"zlib@@openssh.com,zlib"})
1126 @itemx @code{compression-level} (default: @code{3})
1127 The SSH-level compression methods and compression level requested.
1128
1129 Note that offloading relies on SSH compression to reduce bandwidth usage
1130 when transferring files to and from build machines.
1131
1132 @item @code{daemon-socket} (default: @code{"/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket"})
1133 File name of the Unix-domain socket @command{guix-daemon} is listening
1134 to on that machine.
1135
1136 @item @code{parallel-builds} (default: @code{1})
1137 The number of builds that may run in parallel on the machine.
1138
1139 @item @code{speed} (default: @code{1.0})
1140 A ``relative speed factor''. The offload scheduler will tend to prefer
1141 machines with a higher speed factor.
1142
1143 @item @code{features} (default: @code{'()})
1144 A list of strings denoting specific features supported by the machine.
1145 An example is @code{"kvm"} for machines that have the KVM Linux modules
1146 and corresponding hardware support. Derivations can request features by
1147 name, and they will be scheduled on matching build machines.
1148
1149 @end table
1150 @end deftp
1151
1152 The @command{guix} command must be in the search path on the build
1153 machines. You can check whether this is the case by running:
1154
1155 @example
1156 ssh build-machine guix repl --version
1157 @end example
1158
1159 There is one last thing to do once @file{machines.scm} is in place. As
1160 explained above, when offloading, files are transferred back and forth
1161 between the machine stores. For this to work, you first need to
1162 generate a key pair on each machine to allow the daemon to export signed
1163 archives of files from the store (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
1164
1165 @example
1166 # guix archive --generate-key
1167 @end example
1168
1169 @noindent
1170 Each build machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that
1171 it accepts store items it receives from the master:
1172
1173 @example
1174 # guix archive --authorize < master-public-key.txt
1175 @end example
1176
1177 @noindent
1178 Likewise, the master machine must authorize the key of each build machine.
1179
1180 All the fuss with keys is here to express pairwise mutual trust
1181 relations between the master and the build machines. Concretely, when
1182 the master receives files from a build machine (and @i{vice versa}), its
1183 build daemon can make sure they are genuine, have not been tampered
1184 with, and that they are signed by an authorized key.
1185
1186 @cindex offload test
1187 To test whether your setup is operational, run this command on the
1188 master node:
1189
1190 @example
1191 # guix offload test
1192 @end example
1193
1194 This will attempt to connect to each of the build machines specified in
1195 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}, make sure Guile and the Guix modules are
1196 available on each machine, attempt to export to the machine and import
1197 from it, and report any error in the process.
1198
1199 If you want to test a different machine file, just specify it on the
1200 command line:
1201
1202 @example
1203 # guix offload test machines-qualif.scm
1204 @end example
1205
1206 Last, you can test the subset of the machines whose name matches a
1207 regular expression like this:
1208
1209 @example
1210 # guix offload test machines.scm '\.gnu\.org$'
1211 @end example
1212
1213 @cindex offload status
1214 To display the current load of all build hosts, run this command on the
1215 main node:
1216
1217 @example
1218 # guix offload status
1219 @end example
1220
1221
1222 @node SELinux Support
1223 @subsection SELinux Support
1224
1225 @cindex SELinux, daemon policy
1226 @cindex mandatory access control, SELinux
1227 @cindex security, guix-daemon
1228 Guix includes an SELinux policy file at @file{etc/guix-daemon.cil} that
1229 can be installed on a system where SELinux is enabled, in order to label
1230 Guix files and to specify the expected behavior of the daemon. Since
1231 Guix System does not provide an SELinux base policy, the daemon policy cannot
1232 be used on Guix System.
1233
1234 @subsubsection Installing the SELinux policy
1235 @cindex SELinux, policy installation
1236 To install the policy run this command as root:
1237
1238 @example
1239 semodule -i etc/guix-daemon.cil
1240 @end example
1241
1242 Then relabel the file system with @code{restorecon} or by a different
1243 mechanism provided by your system.
1244
1245 Once the policy is installed, the file system has been relabeled, and
1246 the daemon has been restarted, it should be running in the
1247 @code{guix_daemon_t} context. You can confirm this with the following
1248 command:
1249
1250 @example
1251 ps -Zax | grep guix-daemon
1252 @end example
1253
1254 Monitor the SELinux log files as you run a command like @code{guix build
1255 hello} to convince yourself that SELinux permits all necessary
1256 operations.
1257
1258 @subsubsection Limitations
1259 @cindex SELinux, limitations
1260
1261 This policy is not perfect. Here is a list of limitations or quirks
1262 that should be considered when deploying the provided SELinux policy for
1263 the Guix daemon.
1264
1265 @enumerate
1266 @item
1267 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t} isn’t actually used. None of the socket
1268 operations involve contexts that have anything to do with
1269 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t}. It doesn’t hurt to have this unused label,
1270 but it would be preferrable to define socket rules for only this label.
1271
1272 @item
1273 @code{guix gc} cannot access arbitrary links to profiles. By design,
1274 the file label of the destination of a symlink is independent of the
1275 file label of the link itself. Although all profiles under
1276 $localstatedir are labelled, the links to these profiles inherit the
1277 label of the directory they are in. For links in the user’s home
1278 directory this will be @code{user_home_t}. But for links from the root
1279 user’s home directory, or @file{/tmp}, or the HTTP server’s working
1280 directory, etc, this won’t work. @code{guix gc} would be prevented from
1281 reading and following these links.
1282
1283 @item
1284 The daemon’s feature to listen for TCP connections might no longer work.
1285 This might require extra rules, because SELinux treats network sockets
1286 differently from files.
1287
1288 @item
1289 Currently all files with a name matching the regular expression
1290 @code{/gnu/store/.+-(guix-.+|profile)/bin/guix-daemon} are assigned the
1291 label @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}; this means that @emph{any} file with
1292 that name in any profile would be permitted to run in the
1293 @code{guix_daemon_t} domain. This is not ideal. An attacker could
1294 build a package that provides this executable and convince a user to
1295 install and run it, which lifts it into the @code{guix_daemon_t} domain.
1296 At that point SELinux could not prevent it from accessing files that are
1297 allowed for processes in that domain.
1298
1299 We could generate a much more restrictive policy at installation time,
1300 so that only the @emph{exact} file name of the currently installed
1301 @code{guix-daemon} executable would be labelled with
1302 @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}, instead of using a broad regular expression.
1303 The downside is that root would have to install or upgrade the policy at
1304 installation time whenever the Guix package that provides the
1305 effectively running @code{guix-daemon} executable is upgraded.
1306 @end enumerate
1307
1308 @node Invoking guix-daemon
1309 @section Invoking @command{guix-daemon}
1310
1311 The @command{guix-daemon} program implements all the functionality to
1312 access the store. This includes launching build processes, running the
1313 garbage collector, querying the availability of a build result, etc. It
1314 is normally run as @code{root} like this:
1315
1316 @example
1317 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
1318 @end example
1319
1320 @noindent
1321 For details on how to set it up, @pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}.
1322
1323 @cindex chroot
1324 @cindex container, build environment
1325 @cindex build environment
1326 @cindex reproducible builds
1327 By default, @command{guix-daemon} launches build processes under
1328 different UIDs, taken from the build group specified with
1329 @code{--build-users-group}. In addition, each build process is run in a
1330 chroot environment that only contains the subset of the store that the
1331 build process depends on, as specified by its derivation
1332 (@pxref{Programming Interface, derivation}), plus a set of specific
1333 system directories. By default, the latter contains @file{/dev} and
1334 @file{/dev/pts}. Furthermore, on GNU/Linux, the build environment is a
1335 @dfn{container}: in addition to having its own file system tree, it has
1336 a separate mount name space, its own PID name space, network name space,
1337 etc. This helps achieve reproducible builds (@pxref{Features}).
1338
1339 When the daemon performs a build on behalf of the user, it creates a
1340 build directory under @file{/tmp} or under the directory specified by
1341 its @code{TMPDIR} environment variable. This directory is shared with
1342 the container for the duration of the build, though within the container,
1343 the build tree is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0}.
1344
1345 The build directory is automatically deleted upon completion, unless the
1346 build failed and the client specified @option{--keep-failed}
1347 (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @option{--keep-failed}}).
1348
1349 The daemon listens for connections and spawns one sub-process for each session
1350 started by a client (one of the @command{guix} sub-commands.) The
1351 @command{guix processes} command allows you to get an overview of the activity
1352 on your system by viewing each of the active sessions and clients.
1353 @xref{Invoking guix processes}, for more information.
1354
1355 The following command-line options are supported:
1356
1357 @table @code
1358 @item --build-users-group=@var{group}
1359 Take users from @var{group} to run build processes (@pxref{Setting Up
1360 the Daemon, build users}).
1361
1362 @item --no-substitutes
1363 @cindex substitutes
1364 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
1365 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
1366 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1367
1368 When the daemon runs with @code{--no-substitutes}, clients can still
1369 explicitly enable substitution @i{via} the @code{set-build-options}
1370 remote procedure call (@pxref{The Store}).
1371
1372 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
1373 @anchor{daemon-substitute-urls}
1374 Consider @var{urls} the default whitespace-separated list of substitute
1375 source URLs. When this option is omitted,
1376 @indicateurl{https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is used.
1377
1378 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, as long
1379 as they are signed by a trusted signature (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1380
1381 @cindex offloading
1382 @item --no-offload
1383 Do not use offload builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1384 Setup}). That is, always build things locally instead of offloading
1385 builds to remote machines.
1386
1387 @item --cache-failures
1388 Cache build failures. By default, only successful builds are cached.
1389
1390 When this option is used, @command{guix gc --list-failures} can be used
1391 to query the set of store items marked as failed; @command{guix gc
1392 --clear-failures} removes store items from the set of cached failures.
1393 @xref{Invoking guix gc}.
1394
1395 @item --cores=@var{n}
1396 @itemx -c @var{n}
1397 Use @var{n} CPU cores to build each derivation; @code{0} means as many
1398 as available.
1399
1400 The default value is @code{0}, but it may be overridden by clients, such
1401 as the @code{--cores} option of @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking
1402 guix build}).
1403
1404 The effect is to define the @code{NIX_BUILD_CORES} environment variable
1405 in the build process, which can then use it to exploit internal
1406 parallelism---for instance, by running @code{make -j$NIX_BUILD_CORES}.
1407
1408 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
1409 @itemx -M @var{n}
1410 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. The default value is
1411 @code{1}. Setting it to @code{0} means that no builds will be performed
1412 locally; instead, the daemon will offload builds (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1413 Setup}), or simply fail.
1414
1415 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
1416 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
1417 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1418
1419 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1420
1421 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1422 Build Options, @code{--max-silent-time}}).
1423
1424 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
1425 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
1426 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1427
1428 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1429
1430 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1431 Build Options, @code{--timeout}}).
1432
1433 @item --rounds=@var{N}
1434 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
1435 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical. Note that this
1436 setting can be overridden by clients such as @command{guix build}
1437 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1438
1439 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
1440 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
1441 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
1442
1443 @item --debug
1444 Produce debugging output.
1445
1446 This is useful to debug daemon start-up issues, but then it may be
1447 overridden by clients, for example the @code{--verbosity} option of
1448 @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1449
1450 @item --chroot-directory=@var{dir}
1451 Add @var{dir} to the build chroot.
1452
1453 Doing this may change the result of build processes---for instance if
1454 they use optional dependencies found in @var{dir} when it is available,
1455 and not otherwise. For that reason, it is not recommended to do so.
1456 Instead, make sure that each derivation declares all the inputs that it
1457 needs.
1458
1459 @item --disable-chroot
1460 Disable chroot builds.
1461
1462 Using this option is not recommended since, again, it would allow build
1463 processes to gain access to undeclared dependencies. It is necessary,
1464 though, when @command{guix-daemon} is running under an unprivileged user
1465 account.
1466
1467 @item --log-compression=@var{type}
1468 Compress build logs according to @var{type}, one of @code{gzip},
1469 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
1470
1471 Unless @code{--lose-logs} is used, all the build logs are kept in the
1472 @var{localstatedir}. To save space, the daemon automatically compresses
1473 them with bzip2 by default.
1474
1475 @item --disable-deduplication
1476 @cindex deduplication
1477 Disable automatic file ``deduplication'' in the store.
1478
1479 By default, files added to the store are automatically ``deduplicated'':
1480 if a newly added file is identical to another one found in the store,
1481 the daemon makes the new file a hard link to the other file. This can
1482 noticeably reduce disk usage, at the expense of slightly increased
1483 input/output load at the end of a build process. This option disables
1484 this optimization.
1485
1486 @item --gc-keep-outputs[=yes|no]
1487 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep outputs of live
1488 derivations.
1489
1490 @cindex GC roots
1491 @cindex garbage collector roots
1492 When set to ``yes'', the GC will keep the outputs of any live derivation
1493 available in the store---the @code{.drv} files. The default is ``no'',
1494 meaning that derivation outputs are kept only if they are reachable from a GC
1495 root. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for more on GC roots.
1496
1497 @item --gc-keep-derivations[=yes|no]
1498 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep derivations
1499 corresponding to live outputs.
1500
1501 When set to ``yes'', as is the case by default, the GC keeps
1502 derivations---i.e., @code{.drv} files---as long as at least one of their
1503 outputs is live. This allows users to keep track of the origins of
1504 items in their store. Setting it to ``no'' saves a bit of disk space.
1505
1506 In this way, setting @code{--gc-keep-derivations} to ``yes'' causes liveness
1507 to flow from outputs to derivations, and setting @code{--gc-keep-outputs} to
1508 ``yes'' causes liveness to flow from derivations to outputs. When both are
1509 set to ``yes'', the effect is to keep all the build prerequisites (the
1510 sources, compiler, libraries, and other build-time tools) of live objects in
1511 the store, regardless of whether these prerequisites are reachable from a GC
1512 root. This is convenient for developers since it saves rebuilds or downloads.
1513
1514 @item --impersonate-linux-2.6
1515 On Linux-based systems, impersonate Linux 2.6. This means that the
1516 kernel's @code{uname} system call will report 2.6 as the release number.
1517
1518 This might be helpful to build programs that (usually wrongfully) depend
1519 on the kernel version number.
1520
1521 @item --lose-logs
1522 Do not keep build logs. By default they are kept under
1523 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/log}.
1524
1525 @item --system=@var{system}
1526 Assume @var{system} as the current system type. By default it is the
1527 architecture/kernel pair found at configure time, such as
1528 @code{x86_64-linux}.
1529
1530 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
1531 Listen for connections on @var{endpoint}. @var{endpoint} is interpreted
1532 as the file name of a Unix-domain socket if it starts with
1533 @code{/} (slash sign). Otherwise, @var{endpoint} is interpreted as a
1534 host name or host name and port to listen to. Here are a few examples:
1535
1536 @table @code
1537 @item --listen=/gnu/var/daemon
1538 Listen for connections on the @file{/gnu/var/daemon} Unix-domain socket,
1539 creating it if needed.
1540
1541 @item --listen=localhost
1542 @cindex daemon, remote access
1543 @cindex remote access to the daemon
1544 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
1545 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
1546 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1547 @code{localhost}, on port 44146.
1548
1549 @item --listen=128.0.0.42:1234
1550 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1551 @code{128.0.0.42}, on port 1234.
1552 @end table
1553
1554 This option can be repeated multiple times, in which case
1555 @command{guix-daemon} accepts connections on all the specified
1556 endpoints. Users can tell client commands what endpoint to connect to
1557 by setting the @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable
1558 (@pxref{The Store, @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET}}).
1559
1560 @quotation Note
1561 The daemon protocol is @emph{unauthenticated and unencrypted}. Using
1562 @code{--listen=@var{host}} is suitable on local networks, such as
1563 clusters, where only trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon. In
1564 other cases where remote access to the daemon is needed, we recommend
1565 using Unix-domain sockets along with SSH.
1566 @end quotation
1567
1568 When @code{--listen} is omitted, @command{guix-daemon} listens for
1569 connections on the Unix-domain socket located at
1570 @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
1571 @end table
1572
1573
1574 @node Application Setup
1575 @section Application Setup
1576
1577 @cindex foreign distro
1578 When using Guix on top of GNU/Linux distribution other than Guix System---a
1579 so-called @dfn{foreign distro}---a few additional steps are needed to
1580 get everything in place. Here are some of them.
1581
1582 @subsection Locales
1583
1584 @anchor{locales-and-locpath}
1585 @cindex locales, when not on Guix System
1586 @vindex LOCPATH
1587 @vindex GUIX_LOCPATH
1588 Packages installed @i{via} Guix will not use the locale data of the
1589 host system. Instead, you must first install one of the locale packages
1590 available with Guix and then define the @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} environment
1591 variable:
1592
1593 @example
1594 $ guix install glibc-locales
1595 $ export GUIX_LOCPATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/lib/locale
1596 @end example
1597
1598 Note that the @code{glibc-locales} package contains data for all the
1599 locales supported by the GNU@tie{}libc and weighs in at around
1600 110@tie{}MiB. Alternatively, the @code{glibc-utf8-locales} is smaller but
1601 limited to a few UTF-8 locales.
1602
1603 The @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} variable plays a role similar to @code{LOCPATH}
1604 (@pxref{Locale Names, @code{LOCPATH},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
1605 Manual}). There are two important differences though:
1606
1607 @enumerate
1608 @item
1609 @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} is honored only by the libc in Guix, and not by the libc
1610 provided by foreign distros. Thus, using @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} allows you
1611 to make sure the programs of the foreign distro will not end up loading
1612 incompatible locale data.
1613
1614 @item
1615 libc suffixes each entry of @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} with @code{/X.Y}, where
1616 @code{X.Y} is the libc version---e.g., @code{2.22}. This means that,
1617 should your Guix profile contain a mixture of programs linked against
1618 different libc version, each libc version will only try to load locale
1619 data in the right format.
1620 @end enumerate
1621
1622 This is important because the locale data format used by different libc
1623 versions may be incompatible.
1624
1625 @subsection Name Service Switch
1626
1627 @cindex name service switch, glibc
1628 @cindex NSS (name service switch), glibc
1629 @cindex nscd (name service caching daemon)
1630 @cindex name service caching daemon (nscd)
1631 When using Guix on a foreign distro, we @emph{strongly recommend} that
1632 the system run the GNU C library's @dfn{name service cache daemon},
1633 @command{nscd}, which should be listening on the
1634 @file{/var/run/nscd/socket} socket. Failing to do that, applications
1635 installed with Guix may fail to look up host names or user accounts, or
1636 may even crash. The next paragraphs explain why.
1637
1638 @cindex @file{nsswitch.conf}
1639 The GNU C library implements a @dfn{name service switch} (NSS), which is
1640 an extensible mechanism for ``name lookups'' in general: host name
1641 resolution, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name Service Switch,,, libc,
1642 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
1643
1644 @cindex Network information service (NIS)
1645 @cindex NIS (Network information service)
1646 Being extensible, the NSS supports @dfn{plugins}, which provide new name
1647 lookup implementations: for example, the @code{nss-mdns} plugin allow
1648 resolution of @code{.local} host names, the @code{nis} plugin allows
1649 user account lookup using the Network information service (NIS), and so
1650 on. These extra ``lookup services'' are configured system-wide in
1651 @file{/etc/nsswitch.conf}, and all the programs running on the system
1652 honor those settings (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C
1653 Reference Manual}).
1654
1655 When they perform a name lookup---for instance by calling the
1656 @code{getaddrinfo} function in C---applications first try to connect to
1657 the nscd; on success, nscd performs name lookups on their behalf. If
1658 the nscd is not running, then they perform the name lookup by
1659 themselves, by loading the name lookup services into their own address
1660 space and running it. These name lookup services---the
1661 @file{libnss_*.so} files---are @code{dlopen}'d, but they may come from
1662 the host system's C library, rather than from the C library the
1663 application is linked against (the C library coming from Guix).
1664
1665 And this is where the problem is: if your application is linked against
1666 Guix's C library (say, glibc 2.24) and tries to load NSS plugins from
1667 another C library (say, @code{libnss_mdns.so} for glibc 2.22), it will
1668 likely crash or have its name lookups fail unexpectedly.
1669
1670 Running @command{nscd} on the system, among other advantages, eliminates
1671 this binary incompatibility problem because those @code{libnss_*.so}
1672 files are loaded in the @command{nscd} process, not in applications
1673 themselves.
1674
1675 @subsection X11 Fonts
1676
1677 @cindex fonts
1678 The majority of graphical applications use Fontconfig to locate and
1679 load fonts and perform X11-client-side rendering. The @code{fontconfig}
1680 package in Guix looks for fonts in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}
1681 by default. Thus, to allow graphical applications installed with Guix
1682 to display fonts, you have to install fonts with Guix as well.
1683 Essential font packages include @code{gs-fonts}, @code{font-dejavu}, and
1684 @code{font-gnu-freefont-ttf}.
1685
1686 To display text written in Chinese languages, Japanese, or Korean in
1687 graphical applications, consider installing
1688 @code{font-adobe-source-han-sans} or @code{font-wqy-zenhei}. The former
1689 has multiple outputs, one per language family (@pxref{Packages with
1690 Multiple Outputs}). For instance, the following command installs fonts
1691 for Chinese languages:
1692
1693 @example
1694 guix install font-adobe-source-han-sans:cn
1695 @end example
1696
1697 @cindex @code{xterm}
1698 Older programs such as @command{xterm} do not use Fontconfig and instead
1699 rely on server-side font rendering. Such programs require to specify a
1700 full name of a font using XLFD (X Logical Font Description), like this:
1701
1702 @example
1703 -*-dejavu sans-medium-r-normal-*-*-100-*-*-*-*-*-1
1704 @end example
1705
1706 To be able to use such full names for the TrueType fonts installed in
1707 your Guix profile, you need to extend the font path of the X server:
1708
1709 @c Note: 'xset' does not accept symlinks so the trick below arranges to
1710 @c get at the real directory. See <https://bugs.gnu.org/30655>.
1711 @example
1712 xset +fp $(dirname $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile/share/fonts/truetype/fonts.dir))
1713 @end example
1714
1715 @cindex @code{xlsfonts}
1716 After that, you can run @code{xlsfonts} (from @code{xlsfonts} package)
1717 to make sure your TrueType fonts are listed there.
1718
1719 @cindex @code{fc-cache}
1720 @cindex font cache
1721 After installing fonts you may have to refresh the font cache to use
1722 them in applications. The same applies when applications installed via
1723 Guix do not seem to find fonts. To force rebuilding of the font cache
1724 run @code{fc-cache -rv}. The @code{fc-cache} command is provided by
1725 the @code{fontconfig} package.
1726
1727 @subsection X.509 Certificates
1728
1729 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
1730 The @code{nss-certs} package provides X.509 certificates, which allow
1731 programs to authenticate Web servers accessed over HTTPS.
1732
1733 When using Guix on a foreign distro, you can install this package and
1734 define the relevant environment variables so that packages know where to
1735 look for certificates. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for detailed
1736 information.
1737
1738 @subsection Emacs Packages
1739
1740 @cindex @code{emacs}
1741 When you install Emacs packages with Guix, the elisp files may be placed
1742 either in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/} or in
1743 sub-directories of
1744 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d/}. The latter
1745 directory exists because potentially there may exist thousands of Emacs
1746 packages and storing all their files in a single directory may not be
1747 reliable (because of name conflicts). So we think using a separate
1748 directory for each package is a good idea. It is very similar to how
1749 the Emacs package system organizes the file structure (@pxref{Package
1750 Files,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1751
1752 By default, Emacs (installed with Guix) ``knows'' where these packages
1753 are placed, so you do not need to perform any configuration. If, for
1754 some reason, you want to avoid auto-loading Emacs packages installed
1755 with Guix, you can do so by running Emacs with @code{--no-site-file}
1756 option (@pxref{Init File,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1757
1758 @subsection The GCC toolchain
1759
1760 @cindex GCC
1761 @cindex ld-wrapper
1762
1763 Guix offers individual compiler packages such as @code{gcc} but if you
1764 are in need of a complete toolchain for compiling and linking source
1765 code what you really want is the @code{gcc-toolchain} package. This
1766 package provides a complete GCC toolchain for C/C++ development,
1767 including GCC itself, the GNU C Library (headers and binaries, plus
1768 debugging symbols in the @code{debug} output), Binutils, and a linker
1769 wrapper.
1770
1771 The wrapper's purpose is to inspect the @code{-L} and @code{-l} switches
1772 passed to the linker, add corresponding @code{-rpath} arguments, and
1773 invoke the actual linker with this new set of arguments. You can instruct the
1774 wrapper to refuse to link against libraries not in the store by setting the
1775 @code{GUIX_LD_WRAPPER_ALLOW_IMPURITIES} environment variable to @code{no}.
1776
1777 @node Upgrading Guix
1778 @section Upgrading Guix
1779
1780 @cindex Upgrading Guix, on a foreign distro
1781
1782 To upgrade Guix, run:
1783
1784 @example
1785 guix pull
1786 @end example
1787
1788 @xref{Invoking guix pull}, for more information.
1789
1790 @cindex upgrading Guix for the root user, on a foreign distro
1791 @cindex upgrading the Guix daemon, on a foreign distro
1792 @cindex @command{guix pull} for the root user, on a foreign distro
1793
1794 On a foreign distro, you can upgrade the build daemon by running:
1795
1796 @example
1797 sudo -i guix pull
1798 @end example
1799
1800 @noindent
1801 followed by (assuming your distro uses the systemd service management
1802 tool):
1803
1804 @example
1805 systemctl restart guix-daemon.service
1806 @end example
1807
1808 On Guix System, upgrading the daemon is achieved by reconfiguring the
1809 system (@pxref{Invoking guix system, @code{guix system reconfigure}}).
1810
1811 @c TODO What else?
1812
1813 @c *********************************************************************
1814 @node System Installation
1815 @chapter System Installation
1816
1817 @cindex installing Guix System
1818 @cindex Guix System, installation
1819 This section explains how to install Guix System
1820 on a machine. Guix, as a package manager, can
1821 also be installed on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
1822 @pxref{Installation}.
1823
1824 @ifinfo
1825 @quotation Note
1826 @c This paragraph is for people reading this from tty2 of the
1827 @c installation image.
1828 You are reading this documentation with an Info reader. For details on
1829 how to use it, hit the @key{RET} key (``return'' or ``enter'') on the
1830 link that follows: @pxref{Top, Info reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU
1831 Info}. Hit @kbd{l} afterwards to come back here.
1832
1833 Alternately, run @command{info info} in another tty to keep the manual
1834 available.
1835 @end quotation
1836 @end ifinfo
1837
1838 @menu
1839 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
1840 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
1841 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
1842 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
1843 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
1844 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
1845 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
1846 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
1847 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
1848 @end menu
1849
1850 @node Limitations
1851 @section Limitations
1852
1853 We consider Guix System to be ready for a wide range of ``desktop'' and server
1854 use cases. The reliability guarantees it provides---transactional upgrades
1855 and rollbacks, reproducibility---make it a solid foundation.
1856
1857 Nevertheless, before you proceed with the installation, be aware of the
1858 following noteworthy limitations applicable to version @value{VERSION}:
1859
1860 @itemize
1861 @item
1862 Support for the Logical Volume Manager (LVM) is missing.
1863
1864 @item
1865 More and more system services are provided (@pxref{Services}), but some
1866 may be missing.
1867
1868 @item
1869 GNOME, Xfce, LXDE, and Enlightenment are available (@pxref{Desktop Services}),
1870 as well as a number of X11 window managers. However, KDE is currently
1871 missing.
1872 @end itemize
1873
1874 More than a disclaimer, this is an invitation to report issues (and success
1875 stories!), and to join us in improving it. @xref{Contributing}, for more
1876 info.
1877
1878
1879 @node Hardware Considerations
1880 @section Hardware Considerations
1881
1882 @cindex hardware support on Guix System
1883 GNU@tie{}Guix focuses on respecting the user's computing freedom. It
1884 builds around the kernel Linux-libre, which means that only hardware for
1885 which free software drivers and firmware exist is supported. Nowadays,
1886 a wide range of off-the-shelf hardware is supported on
1887 GNU/Linux-libre---from keyboards to graphics cards to scanners and
1888 Ethernet controllers. Unfortunately, there are still areas where
1889 hardware vendors deny users control over their own computing, and such
1890 hardware is not supported on Guix System.
1891
1892 @cindex WiFi, hardware support
1893 One of the main areas where free drivers or firmware are lacking is WiFi
1894 devices. WiFi devices known to work include those using Atheros chips
1895 (AR9271 and AR7010), which corresponds to the @code{ath9k} Linux-libre
1896 driver, and those using Broadcom/AirForce chips (BCM43xx with
1897 Wireless-Core Revision 5), which corresponds to the @code{b43-open}
1898 Linux-libre driver. Free firmware exists for both and is available
1899 out-of-the-box on Guix System, as part of @code{%base-firmware}
1900 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{firmware}}).
1901
1902 @cindex RYF, Respects Your Freedom
1903 The @uref{https://www.fsf.org/, Free Software Foundation} runs
1904 @uref{https://www.fsf.org/ryf, @dfn{Respects Your Freedom}} (RYF), a
1905 certification program for hardware products that respect your freedom
1906 and your privacy and ensure that you have control over your device. We
1907 encourage you to check the list of RYF-certified devices.
1908
1909 Another useful resource is the @uref{https://www.h-node.org/, H-Node}
1910 web site. It contains a catalog of hardware devices with information
1911 about their support in GNU/Linux.
1912
1913
1914 @node USB Stick and DVD Installation
1915 @section USB Stick and DVD Installation
1916
1917 An ISO-9660 installation image that can be written to a USB stick or
1918 burnt to a DVD can be downloaded from
1919 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz},
1920 where @var{system} is one of:
1921
1922 @table @code
1923 @item x86_64-linux
1924 for a GNU/Linux system on Intel/AMD-compatible 64-bit CPUs;
1925
1926 @item i686-linux
1927 for a 32-bit GNU/Linux system on Intel-compatible CPUs.
1928 @end table
1929
1930 @c start duplication of authentication part from ``Binary Installation''
1931 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
1932 authenticity of the image against it, along these lines:
1933
1934 @example
1935 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz.sig
1936 $ gpg --verify guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz.sig
1937 @end example
1938
1939 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
1940 then run this command to import it:
1941
1942 @example
1943 $ wget @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL} \
1944 -qO - | gpg --import -
1945 @end example
1946
1947 @noindent
1948 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
1949
1950 Take note that a warning like ``This key is not certified with a trusted
1951 signature!'' is normal.
1952
1953 @c end duplication
1954
1955 This image contains the tools necessary for an installation.
1956 It is meant to be copied @emph{as is} to a large-enough USB stick or DVD.
1957
1958 @unnumberedsubsec Copying to a USB Stick
1959
1960 To copy the image to a USB stick, follow these steps:
1961
1962 @enumerate
1963 @item
1964 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
1965
1966 @example
1967 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz
1968 @end example
1969
1970 @item
1971 Insert a USB stick of 1@tie{}GiB or more into your machine, and determine
1972 its device name. Assuming that the USB stick is known as @file{/dev/sdX},
1973 copy the image with:
1974
1975 @example
1976 dd if=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso of=/dev/sdX
1977 sync
1978 @end example
1979
1980 Access to @file{/dev/sdX} usually requires root privileges.
1981 @end enumerate
1982
1983 @unnumberedsubsec Burning on a DVD
1984
1985 To copy the image to a DVD, follow these steps:
1986
1987 @enumerate
1988 @item
1989 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
1990
1991 @example
1992 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz
1993 @end example
1994
1995 @item
1996 Insert a blank DVD into your machine, and determine
1997 its device name. Assuming that the DVD drive is known as @file{/dev/srX},
1998 copy the image with:
1999
2000 @example
2001 growisofs -dvd-compat -Z /dev/srX=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso
2002 @end example
2003
2004 Access to @file{/dev/srX} usually requires root privileges.
2005 @end enumerate
2006
2007 @unnumberedsubsec Booting
2008
2009 Once this is done, you should be able to reboot the system and boot from
2010 the USB stick or DVD. The latter usually requires you to get in the
2011 BIOS or UEFI boot menu, where you can choose to boot from the USB stick.
2012 In order to boot from Libreboot, switch to the command mode by pressing
2013 the @kbd{c} key and type @command{search_grub usb}.
2014
2015 @xref{Installing Guix in a VM}, if, instead, you would like to install
2016 Guix System in a virtual machine (VM).
2017
2018
2019 @node Preparing for Installation
2020 @section Preparing for Installation
2021
2022 Once you have booted, you can use the guided graphical installer, which makes
2023 it easy to get started (@pxref{Guided Graphical Installation}). Alternately,
2024 if you are already familiar with GNU/Linux and if you want more control than
2025 what the graphical installer provides, you can choose the ``manual''
2026 installation process (@pxref{Manual Installation}).
2027
2028 The graphical installer is available on TTY1. You can obtain root shells on
2029 TTYs 3 to 6 by hitting @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, etc. TTY2 shows
2030 this documentation and you can reach it with @kbd{ctrl-alt-f2}. Documentation
2031 is browsable using the Info reader commands (@pxref{Top,,, info-stnd,
2032 Stand-alone GNU Info}). The installation system runs the GPM mouse daemon,
2033 which allows you to select text with the left mouse button and to paste it
2034 with the middle button.
2035
2036 @quotation Note
2037 Installation requires access to the Internet so that any missing
2038 dependencies of your system configuration can be downloaded. See the
2039 ``Networking'' section below.
2040 @end quotation
2041
2042 @node Guided Graphical Installation
2043 @section Guided Graphical Installation
2044
2045 The graphical installer is a text-based user interface. It will guide you,
2046 with dialog boxes, through the steps needed to install GNU@tie{}Guix System.
2047
2048 The first dialog boxes allow you to set up the system as you use it during the
2049 installation: you can choose the language, keyboard layout, and set up
2050 networking, which will be used during the installation. The image below shows
2051 the networking dialog.
2052
2053 @image{images/installer-network,5in,, networking setup with the graphical installer}
2054
2055 Later steps allow you to partition your hard disk, as shown in the image
2056 below, to choose whether or not to use encrypted file systems, to enter the
2057 host name and root password, and to create an additional account, among other
2058 things.
2059
2060 @image{images/installer-partitions,5in,, partitioning with the graphical installer}
2061
2062 Note that, at any time, the installer allows you to exit the current
2063 installation step and resume at a previous step, as show in the image below.
2064
2065 @image{images/installer-resume,5in,, resuming the installation process}
2066
2067 Once you're done, the installer produces an operating system configuration and
2068 displays it (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). At that point you can
2069 hit ``OK'' and installation will proceed. On success, you can reboot into the
2070 new system and enjoy. @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2071
2072
2073 @node Manual Installation
2074 @section Manual Installation
2075
2076 This section describes how you would ``manually'' install GNU@tie{}Guix System
2077 on your machine. This option requires familiarity with GNU/Linux, with the
2078 shell, and with common administration tools. If you think this is not for
2079 you, consider using the guided graphical installer (@pxref{Guided Graphical
2080 Installation}).
2081
2082 The installation system provides root shells on TTYs 3 to 6; press
2083 @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, and so on to reach them. It includes
2084 many common tools needed to install the system. But it is also a full-blown
2085 Guix System, which means that you can install additional packages, should you
2086 need it, using @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
2087
2088 @menu
2089 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
2090 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
2091 @end menu
2092
2093 @node Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning
2094 @subsection Keyboard Layout, Networking, and Partitioning
2095
2096 Before you can install the system, you may want to adjust the keyboard layout,
2097 set up networking, and partition your target hard disk. This section will
2098 guide you through this.
2099
2100 @subsubsection Keyboard Layout
2101
2102 @cindex keyboard layout
2103 The installation image uses the US qwerty keyboard layout. If you want
2104 to change it, you can use the @command{loadkeys} command. For example,
2105 the following command selects the Dvorak keyboard layout:
2106
2107 @example
2108 loadkeys dvorak
2109 @end example
2110
2111 See the files under @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/keymaps} for
2112 a list of available keyboard layouts. Run @command{man loadkeys} for
2113 more information.
2114
2115 @subsubsection Networking
2116
2117 Run the following command to see what your network interfaces are called:
2118
2119 @example
2120 ifconfig -a
2121 @end example
2122
2123 @noindent
2124 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
2125
2126 @example
2127 ip address
2128 @end example
2129
2130 @c https://cgit.freedesktop.org/systemd/systemd/tree/src/udev/udev-builtin-net_id.c#n20
2131 Wired interfaces have a name starting with @samp{e}; for example, the
2132 interface corresponding to the first on-board Ethernet controller is
2133 called @samp{eno1}. Wireless interfaces have a name starting with
2134 @samp{w}, like @samp{w1p2s0}.
2135
2136 @table @asis
2137 @item Wired connection
2138 To configure a wired network run the following command, substituting
2139 @var{interface} with the name of the wired interface you want to use.
2140
2141 @example
2142 ifconfig @var{interface} up
2143 @end example
2144
2145 @noindent
2146 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
2147
2148 @example
2149 ip link set @var{interface} up
2150 @end example
2151
2152 @item Wireless connection
2153 @cindex wireless
2154 @cindex WiFi
2155 To configure wireless networking, you can create a configuration file
2156 for the @command{wpa_supplicant} configuration tool (its location is not
2157 important) using one of the available text editors such as
2158 @command{nano}:
2159
2160 @example
2161 nano wpa_supplicant.conf
2162 @end example
2163
2164 As an example, the following stanza can go to this file and will work
2165 for many wireless networks, provided you give the actual SSID and
2166 passphrase for the network you are connecting to:
2167
2168 @example
2169 network=@{
2170 ssid="@var{my-ssid}"
2171 key_mgmt=WPA-PSK
2172 psk="the network's secret passphrase"
2173 @}
2174 @end example
2175
2176 Start the wireless service and run it in the background with the
2177 following command (substitute @var{interface} with the name of the
2178 network interface you want to use):
2179
2180 @example
2181 wpa_supplicant -c wpa_supplicant.conf -i @var{interface} -B
2182 @end example
2183
2184 Run @command{man wpa_supplicant} for more information.
2185 @end table
2186
2187 @cindex DHCP
2188 At this point, you need to acquire an IP address. On a network where IP
2189 addresses are automatically assigned @i{via} DHCP, you can run:
2190
2191 @example
2192 dhclient -v @var{interface}
2193 @end example
2194
2195 Try to ping a server to see if networking is up and running:
2196
2197 @example
2198 ping -c 3 gnu.org
2199 @end example
2200
2201 Setting up network access is almost always a requirement because the
2202 image does not contain all the software and tools that may be needed.
2203
2204 @cindex installing over SSH
2205 If you want to, you can continue the installation remotely by starting
2206 an SSH server:
2207
2208 @example
2209 herd start ssh-daemon
2210 @end example
2211
2212 Make sure to either set a password with @command{passwd}, or configure
2213 OpenSSH public key authentication before logging in.
2214
2215 @subsubsection Disk Partitioning
2216
2217 Unless this has already been done, the next step is to partition, and
2218 then format the target partition(s).
2219
2220 The installation image includes several partitioning tools, including
2221 Parted (@pxref{Overview,,, parted, GNU Parted User Manual}),
2222 @command{fdisk}, and @command{cfdisk}. Run it and set up your disk with
2223 the partition layout you want:
2224
2225 @example
2226 cfdisk
2227 @end example
2228
2229 If your disk uses the GUID Partition Table (GPT) format and you plan to
2230 install BIOS-based GRUB (which is the default), make sure a BIOS Boot
2231 Partition is available (@pxref{BIOS installation,,, grub, GNU GRUB
2232 manual}).
2233
2234 @cindex EFI, installation
2235 @cindex UEFI, installation
2236 @cindex ESP, EFI system partition
2237 If you instead wish to use EFI-based GRUB, a FAT32 @dfn{EFI System Partition}
2238 (ESP) is required. This partition can be mounted at @file{/boot/efi} for
2239 instance and must have the @code{esp} flag set. E.g., for @command{parted}:
2240
2241 @example
2242 parted /dev/sda set 1 esp on
2243 @end example
2244
2245 @quotation Note
2246 @vindex grub-bootloader
2247 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
2248 Unsure whether to use EFI- or BIOS-based GRUB? If the directory
2249 @file{/sys/firmware/efi} exists in the installation image, then you should
2250 probably perform an EFI installation, using @code{grub-efi-bootloader}.
2251 Otherwise you should use the BIOS-based GRUB, known as
2252 @code{grub-bootloader}. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more info on
2253 bootloaders.
2254 @end quotation
2255
2256 Once you are done partitioning the target hard disk drive, you have to
2257 create a file system on the relevant partition(s)@footnote{Currently
2258 Guix System only supports ext4, btrfs, and JFS file systems. In particular,
2259 code that reads file system UUIDs and labels only works for these file system
2260 types.}. For the ESP, if you have one and assuming it is
2261 @file{/dev/sda1}, run:
2262
2263 @example
2264 mkfs.fat -F32 /dev/sda1
2265 @end example
2266
2267 Preferably, assign file systems a label so that you can easily and
2268 reliably refer to them in @code{file-system} declarations (@pxref{File
2269 Systems}). This is typically done using the @code{-L} option of
2270 @command{mkfs.ext4} and related commands. So, assuming the target root
2271 partition lives at @file{/dev/sda2}, a file system with the label
2272 @code{my-root} can be created with:
2273
2274 @example
2275 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/sda2
2276 @end example
2277
2278 @cindex encrypted disk
2279 If you are instead planning to encrypt the root partition, you can use
2280 the Cryptsetup/LUKS utilities to do that (see @inlinefmtifelse{html,
2281 @uref{https://linux.die.net/man/8/cryptsetup, @code{man cryptsetup}},
2282 @code{man cryptsetup}} for more information.) Assuming you want to
2283 store the root partition on @file{/dev/sda2}, the command sequence would
2284 be along these lines:
2285
2286 @example
2287 cryptsetup luksFormat /dev/sda2
2288 cryptsetup open --type luks /dev/sda2 my-partition
2289 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/mapper/my-partition
2290 @end example
2291
2292 Once that is done, mount the target file system under @file{/mnt}
2293 with a command like (again, assuming @code{my-root} is the label of the
2294 root file system):
2295
2296 @example
2297 mount LABEL=my-root /mnt
2298 @end example
2299
2300 Also mount any other file systems you would like to use on the target
2301 system relative to this path. If you have opted for @file{/boot/efi} as an
2302 EFI mount point for example, mount it at @file{/mnt/boot/efi} now so it is
2303 found by @code{guix system init} afterwards.
2304
2305 Finally, if you plan to use one or more swap partitions (@pxref{Memory
2306 Concepts, swap space,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}), make
2307 sure to initialize them with @command{mkswap}. Assuming you have one
2308 swap partition on @file{/dev/sda3}, you would run:
2309
2310 @example
2311 mkswap /dev/sda3
2312 swapon /dev/sda3
2313 @end example
2314
2315 Alternatively, you may use a swap file. For example, assuming that in
2316 the new system you want to use the file @file{/swapfile} as a swap file,
2317 you would run@footnote{This example will work for many types of file
2318 systems (e.g., ext4). However, for copy-on-write file systems (e.g.,
2319 btrfs), the required steps may be different. For details, see the
2320 manual pages for @command{mkswap} and @command{swapon}.}:
2321
2322 @example
2323 # This is 10 GiB of swap space. Adjust "count" to change the size.
2324 dd if=/dev/zero of=/mnt/swapfile bs=1MiB count=10240
2325 # For security, make the file readable and writable only by root.
2326 chmod 600 /mnt/swapfile
2327 mkswap /mnt/swapfile
2328 swapon /mnt/swapfile
2329 @end example
2330
2331 Note that if you have encrypted the root partition and created a swap
2332 file in its file system as described above, then the encryption also
2333 protects the swap file, just like any other file in that file system.
2334
2335 @node Proceeding with the Installation
2336 @subsection Proceeding with the Installation
2337
2338 With the target partitions ready and the target root mounted on
2339 @file{/mnt}, we're ready to go. First, run:
2340
2341 @example
2342 herd start cow-store /mnt
2343 @end example
2344
2345 This makes @file{/gnu/store} copy-on-write, such that packages added to it
2346 during the installation phase are written to the target disk on @file{/mnt}
2347 rather than kept in memory. This is necessary because the first phase of
2348 the @command{guix system init} command (see below) entails downloads or
2349 builds to @file{/gnu/store} which, initially, is an in-memory file system.
2350
2351 Next, you have to edit a file and
2352 provide the declaration of the operating system to be installed. To
2353 that end, the installation system comes with three text editors. We
2354 recommend GNU nano (@pxref{Top,,, nano, GNU nano Manual}), which
2355 supports syntax highlighting and parentheses matching; other editors
2356 include GNU Zile (an Emacs clone), and
2357 nvi (a clone of the original BSD @command{vi} editor).
2358 We strongly recommend storing that file on the target root file system, say,
2359 as @file{/mnt/etc/config.scm}. Failing to do that, you will have lost your
2360 configuration file once you have rebooted into the newly-installed system.
2361
2362 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for an overview of the
2363 configuration file. The example configurations discussed in that
2364 section are available under @file{/etc/configuration} in the
2365 installation image. Thus, to get started with a system configuration
2366 providing a graphical display server (a ``desktop'' system), you can run
2367 something along these lines:
2368
2369 @example
2370 # mkdir /mnt/etc
2371 # cp /etc/configuration/desktop.scm /mnt/etc/config.scm
2372 # nano /mnt/etc/config.scm
2373 @end example
2374
2375 You should pay attention to what your configuration file contains, and
2376 in particular:
2377
2378 @itemize
2379 @item
2380 Make sure the @code{bootloader-configuration} form refers to the target
2381 you want to install GRUB on. It should mention @code{grub-bootloader} if
2382 you are installing GRUB in the legacy way, or @code{grub-efi-bootloader}
2383 for newer UEFI systems. For legacy systems, the @code{target} field
2384 names a device, like @code{/dev/sda}; for UEFI systems it names a path
2385 to a mounted EFI partition, like @code{/boot/efi}; do make sure the path is
2386 currently mounted and a @code{file-system} entry is specified in your
2387 configuration.
2388
2389 @item
2390 Be sure that your file system labels match the value of their respective
2391 @code{device} fields in your @code{file-system} configuration, assuming
2392 your @code{file-system} configuration uses the @code{file-system-label}
2393 procedure in its @code{device} field.
2394
2395 @item
2396 If there are encrypted or RAID partitions, make sure to add a
2397 @code{mapped-devices} field to describe them (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
2398 @end itemize
2399
2400 Once you are done preparing the configuration file, the new system must
2401 be initialized (remember that the target root file system is mounted
2402 under @file{/mnt}):
2403
2404 @example
2405 guix system init /mnt/etc/config.scm /mnt
2406 @end example
2407
2408 @noindent
2409 This copies all the necessary files and installs GRUB on
2410 @file{/dev/sdX}, unless you pass the @option{--no-bootloader} option. For
2411 more information, @pxref{Invoking guix system}. This command may trigger
2412 downloads or builds of missing packages, which can take some time.
2413
2414 Once that command has completed---and hopefully succeeded!---you can run
2415 @command{reboot} and boot into the new system. The @code{root} password
2416 in the new system is initially empty; other users' passwords need to be
2417 initialized by running the @command{passwd} command as @code{root},
2418 unless your configuration specifies otherwise
2419 (@pxref{user-account-password, user account passwords}).
2420 @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2421
2422
2423 @node After System Installation
2424 @section After System Installation
2425
2426 Success, you've now booted into Guix System! From then on, you can update the
2427 system whenever you want by running, say:
2428
2429 @example
2430 guix pull
2431 sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
2432 @end example
2433
2434 @noindent
2435 This builds a new system generation with the latest packages and services
2436 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). We recommend doing that regularly so that
2437 your system includes the latest security updates (@pxref{Security Updates}).
2438
2439 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2019-01/msg00268.html>.
2440 @quotation Note
2441 @cindex sudo vs. @command{guix pull}
2442 Note that @command{sudo guix} runs your user's @command{guix} command and
2443 @emph{not} root's, because @command{sudo} leaves @code{PATH} unchanged. To
2444 explicitly run root's @command{guix}, type @command{sudo -i guix @dots{}}.
2445
2446 The difference matters here, because @command{guix pull} updates
2447 the @command{guix} command and package definitions only for the user it is ran
2448 as. This means that if you choose to use @command{guix system reconfigure} in
2449 root's login shell, you'll need to @command{guix pull} separately.
2450 @end quotation
2451
2452 Join us on @code{#guix} on the Freenode IRC network or on
2453 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to share your experience!
2454
2455
2456 @node Installing Guix in a VM
2457 @section Installing Guix in a Virtual Machine
2458
2459 @cindex virtual machine, Guix System installation
2460 @cindex virtual private server (VPS)
2461 @cindex VPS (virtual private server)
2462 If you'd like to install Guix System in a virtual machine (VM) or on a
2463 virtual private server (VPS) rather than on your beloved machine, this
2464 section is for you.
2465
2466 To boot a @uref{https://qemu.org/,QEMU} VM for installing Guix System in a
2467 disk image, follow these steps:
2468
2469 @enumerate
2470 @item
2471 First, retrieve and decompress the Guix system installation image as
2472 described previously (@pxref{USB Stick and DVD Installation}).
2473
2474 @item
2475 Create a disk image that will hold the installed system. To make a
2476 qcow2-formatted disk image, use the @command{qemu-img} command:
2477
2478 @example
2479 qemu-img create -f qcow2 guix-system.img 50G
2480 @end example
2481
2482 The resulting file will be much smaller than 50 GB (typically less than
2483 1 MB), but it will grow as the virtualized storage device is filled up.
2484
2485 @item
2486 Boot the USB installation image in an VM:
2487
2488 @example
2489 qemu-system-x86_64 -m 1024 -smp 1 -enable-kvm \
2490 -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci -boot menu=on,order=d \
2491 -drive file=guix-system.img \
2492 -drive media=cdrom,file=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso
2493 @end example
2494
2495 @code{-enable-kvm} is optional, but significantly improves performance,
2496 @pxref{Running Guix in a VM}.
2497
2498 @item
2499 You're now root in the VM, proceed with the installation process.
2500 @xref{Preparing for Installation}, and follow the instructions.
2501 @end enumerate
2502
2503 Once installation is complete, you can boot the system that's on your
2504 @file{guix-system.img} image. @xref{Running Guix in a VM}, for how to do
2505 that.
2506
2507 @node Building the Installation Image
2508 @section Building the Installation Image
2509
2510 @cindex installation image
2511 The installation image described above was built using the @command{guix
2512 system} command, specifically:
2513
2514 @example
2515 guix system disk-image --file-system-type=iso9660 \
2516 gnu/system/install.scm
2517 @end example
2518
2519 Have a look at @file{gnu/system/install.scm} in the source tree,
2520 and see also @ref{Invoking guix system} for more information
2521 about the installation image.
2522
2523 @section Building the Installation Image for ARM Boards
2524
2525 Many ARM boards require a specific variant of the
2526 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot} bootloader.
2527
2528 If you build a disk image and the bootloader is not available otherwise
2529 (on another boot drive etc), it's advisable to build an image that
2530 includes the bootloader, specifically:
2531
2532 @example
2533 guix system disk-image --system=armhf-linux -e '((@@ (gnu system install) os-with-u-boot) (@@ (gnu system install) installation-os) "A20-OLinuXino-Lime2")'
2534 @end example
2535
2536 @code{A20-OLinuXino-Lime2} is the name of the board. If you specify an invalid
2537 board, a list of possible boards will be printed.
2538
2539 @c *********************************************************************
2540 @node Package Management
2541 @chapter Package Management
2542
2543 @cindex packages
2544 The purpose of GNU Guix is to allow users to easily install, upgrade, and
2545 remove software packages, without having to know about their build
2546 procedures or dependencies. Guix also goes beyond this obvious set of
2547 features.
2548
2549 This chapter describes the main features of Guix, as well as the
2550 package management tools it provides. Along with the command-line
2551 interface described below (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{guix
2552 package}}), you may also use the Emacs-Guix interface (@pxref{Top,,,
2553 emacs-guix, The Emacs-Guix Reference Manual}), after installing
2554 @code{emacs-guix} package (run @kbd{M-x guix-help} command to start
2555 with it):
2556
2557 @example
2558 guix install emacs-guix
2559 @end example
2560
2561 @menu
2562 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
2563 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
2564 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
2565 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
2566 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
2567 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
2568 * Channels:: Customizing the package collection.
2569 * Invoking guix time-machine:: Running an older revision of Guix.
2570 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
2571 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
2572 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
2573 @end menu
2574
2575 @node Features
2576 @section Features
2577
2578 When using Guix, each package ends up in the @dfn{package store}, in its
2579 own directory---something that resembles
2580 @file{/gnu/store/xxx-package-1.2}, where @code{xxx} is a base32 string.
2581
2582 Instead of referring to these directories, users have their own
2583 @dfn{profile}, which points to the packages that they actually want to
2584 use. These profiles are stored within each user's home directory, at
2585 @code{$HOME/.guix-profile}.
2586
2587 For example, @code{alice} installs GCC 4.7.2. As a result,
2588 @file{/home/alice/.guix-profile/bin/gcc} points to
2589 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2/bin/gcc}. Now, on the same machine,
2590 @code{bob} had already installed GCC 4.8.0. The profile of @code{bob}
2591 simply continues to point to
2592 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.0/bin/gcc}---i.e., both versions of GCC
2593 coexist on the same system without any interference.
2594
2595 The @command{guix package} command is the central tool to manage
2596 packages (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). It operates on the per-user
2597 profiles, and can be used @emph{with normal user privileges}.
2598
2599 @cindex transactions
2600 The command provides the obvious install, remove, and upgrade
2601 operations. Each invocation is actually a @emph{transaction}: either
2602 the specified operation succeeds, or nothing happens. Thus, if the
2603 @command{guix package} process is terminated during the transaction,
2604 or if a power outage occurs during the transaction, then the user's
2605 profile remains in its previous state, and remains usable.
2606
2607 In addition, any package transaction may be @emph{rolled back}. So, if,
2608 for example, an upgrade installs a new version of a package that turns
2609 out to have a serious bug, users may roll back to the previous instance
2610 of their profile, which was known to work well. Similarly, the global
2611 system configuration on Guix is subject to
2612 transactional upgrades and roll-back
2613 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
2614
2615 All packages in the package store may be @emph{garbage-collected}.
2616 Guix can determine which packages are still referenced by user
2617 profiles, and remove those that are provably no longer referenced
2618 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Users may also explicitly remove old
2619 generations of their profile so that the packages they refer to can be
2620 collected.
2621
2622 @cindex reproducibility
2623 @cindex reproducible builds
2624 Guix takes a @dfn{purely functional} approach to package
2625 management, as described in the introduction (@pxref{Introduction}).
2626 Each @file{/gnu/store} package directory name contains a hash of all the
2627 inputs that were used to build that package---compiler, libraries, build
2628 scripts, etc. This direct correspondence allows users to make sure a
2629 given package installation matches the current state of their
2630 distribution. It also helps maximize @dfn{build reproducibility}:
2631 thanks to the isolated build environments that are used, a given build
2632 is likely to yield bit-identical files when performed on different
2633 machines (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, container}).
2634
2635 @cindex substitutes
2636 This foundation allows Guix to support @dfn{transparent binary/source
2637 deployment}. When a pre-built binary for a @file{/gnu/store} item is
2638 available from an external source---a @dfn{substitute}, Guix just
2639 downloads it and unpacks it;
2640 otherwise, it builds the package from source, locally
2641 (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because build results are usually bit-for-bit
2642 reproducible, users do not have to trust servers that provide
2643 substitutes: they can force a local build and @emph{challenge} providers
2644 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
2645
2646 Control over the build environment is a feature that is also useful for
2647 developers. The @command{guix environment} command allows developers of
2648 a package to quickly set up the right development environment for their
2649 package, without having to manually install the dependencies of the
2650 package into their profile (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
2651
2652 @cindex replication, of software environments
2653 @cindex provenance tracking, of software artifacts
2654 All of Guix and its package definitions is version-controlled, and
2655 @command{guix pull} allows you to ``travel in time'' on the history of Guix
2656 itself (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). This makes it possible to replicate a
2657 Guix instance on a different machine or at a later point in time, which in
2658 turn allows you to @emph{replicate complete software environments}, while
2659 retaining precise @dfn{provenance tracking} of the software.
2660
2661 @node Invoking guix package
2662 @section Invoking @command{guix package}
2663
2664 @cindex installing packages
2665 @cindex removing packages
2666 @cindex package installation
2667 @cindex package removal
2668 The @command{guix package} command is the tool that allows users to
2669 install, upgrade, and remove packages, as well as rolling back to
2670 previous configurations. It operates only on the user's own profile,
2671 and works with normal user privileges (@pxref{Features}). Its syntax
2672 is:
2673
2674 @example
2675 guix package @var{options}
2676 @end example
2677
2678 @cindex transactions
2679 Primarily, @var{options} specifies the operations to be performed during
2680 the transaction. Upon completion, a new profile is created, but
2681 previous @dfn{generations} of the profile remain available, should the user
2682 want to roll back.
2683
2684 For example, to remove @code{lua} and install @code{guile} and
2685 @code{guile-cairo} in a single transaction:
2686
2687 @example
2688 guix package -r lua -i guile guile-cairo
2689 @end example
2690
2691 @cindex aliases, for @command{guix package}
2692 For your convenience, we also provide the following aliases:
2693
2694 @itemize
2695 @item
2696 @command{guix search} is an alias for @command{guix package -s},
2697 @item
2698 @command{guix install} is an alias for @command{guix package -i},
2699 @item
2700 @command{guix remove} is an alias for @command{guix package -r},
2701 @item
2702 @command{guix upgrade} is an alias for @command{guix package -u},
2703 @item
2704 and @command{guix show} is an alias for @command{guix package --show=}.
2705 @end itemize
2706
2707 These aliases are less expressive than @command{guix package} and provide
2708 fewer options, so in some cases you'll probably want to use @command{guix
2709 package} directly.
2710
2711 @command{guix package} also supports a @dfn{declarative approach}
2712 whereby the user specifies the exact set of packages to be available and
2713 passes it @i{via} the @option{--manifest} option
2714 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
2715
2716 @cindex profile
2717 For each user, a symlink to the user's default profile is automatically
2718 created in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}. This symlink always points to the
2719 current generation of the user's default profile. Thus, users can add
2720 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin} to their @code{PATH} environment
2721 variable, and so on.
2722 @cindex search paths
2723 If you are not using Guix System, consider adding the
2724 following lines to your @file{~/.bash_profile} (@pxref{Bash Startup
2725 Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}) so that newly-spawned
2726 shells get all the right environment variable definitions:
2727
2728 @example
2729 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile" ; \
2730 source "$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/profile"
2731 @end example
2732
2733 In a multi-user setup, user profiles are stored in a place registered as
2734 a @dfn{garbage-collector root}, which @file{$HOME/.guix-profile} points
2735 to (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). That directory is normally
2736 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/profiles/per-user/@var{user}}, where
2737 @var{localstatedir} is the value passed to @code{configure} as
2738 @code{--localstatedir}, and @var{user} is the user name. The
2739 @file{per-user} directory is created when @command{guix-daemon} is
2740 started, and the @var{user} sub-directory is created by @command{guix
2741 package}.
2742
2743 The @var{options} can be among the following:
2744
2745 @table @code
2746
2747 @item --install=@var{package} @dots{}
2748 @itemx -i @var{package} @dots{}
2749 Install the specified @var{package}s.
2750
2751 Each @var{package} may specify either a simple package name, such as
2752 @code{guile}, or a package name followed by an at-sign and version number,
2753 such as @code{guile@@1.8.8} or simply @code{guile@@1.8} (in the latter
2754 case, the newest version prefixed by @code{1.8} is selected.)
2755
2756 If no version number is specified, the
2757 newest available version will be selected. In addition, @var{package}
2758 may contain a colon, followed by the name of one of the outputs of the
2759 package, as in @code{gcc:doc} or @code{binutils@@2.22:lib}
2760 (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). Packages with a corresponding
2761 name (and optionally version) are searched for among the GNU
2762 distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
2763
2764 @cindex propagated inputs
2765 Sometimes packages have @dfn{propagated inputs}: these are dependencies
2766 that automatically get installed along with the required package
2767 (@pxref{package-propagated-inputs, @code{propagated-inputs} in
2768 @code{package} objects}, for information about propagated inputs in
2769 package definitions).
2770
2771 @anchor{package-cmd-propagated-inputs}
2772 An example is the GNU MPC library: its C header files refer to those of
2773 the GNU MPFR library, which in turn refer to those of the GMP library.
2774 Thus, when installing MPC, the MPFR and GMP libraries also get installed
2775 in the profile; removing MPC also removes MPFR and GMP---unless they had
2776 also been explicitly installed by the user.
2777
2778 Besides, packages sometimes rely on the definition of environment
2779 variables for their search paths (see explanation of
2780 @code{--search-paths} below). Any missing or possibly incorrect
2781 environment variable definitions are reported here.
2782
2783 @item --install-from-expression=@var{exp}
2784 @itemx -e @var{exp}
2785 Install the package @var{exp} evaluates to.
2786
2787 @var{exp} must be a Scheme expression that evaluates to a
2788 @code{<package>} object. This option is notably useful to disambiguate
2789 between same-named variants of a package, with expressions such as
2790 @code{(@@ (gnu packages base) guile-final)}.
2791
2792 Note that this option installs the first output of the specified
2793 package, which may be insufficient when needing a specific output of a
2794 multiple-output package.
2795
2796 @item --install-from-file=@var{file}
2797 @itemx -f @var{file}
2798 Install the package that the code within @var{file} evaluates to.
2799
2800 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
2801 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
2802
2803 @lisp
2804 @include package-hello.scm
2805 @end lisp
2806
2807 Developers may find it useful to include such a @file{guix.scm} file
2808 in the root of their project source tree that can be used to test
2809 development snapshots and create reproducible development environments
2810 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
2811
2812 @item --remove=@var{package} @dots{}
2813 @itemx -r @var{package} @dots{}
2814 Remove the specified @var{package}s.
2815
2816 As for @code{--install}, each @var{package} may specify a version number
2817 and/or output name in addition to the package name. For instance,
2818 @code{-r glibc:debug} would remove the @code{debug} output of
2819 @code{glibc}.
2820
2821 @item --upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
2822 @itemx -u [@var{regexp} @dots{}]
2823 @cindex upgrading packages
2824 Upgrade all the installed packages. If one or more @var{regexp}s are
2825 specified, upgrade only installed packages whose name matches a
2826 @var{regexp}. Also see the @code{--do-not-upgrade} option below.
2827
2828 Note that this upgrades package to the latest version of packages found
2829 in the distribution currently installed. To update your distribution,
2830 you should regularly run @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix
2831 pull}).
2832
2833 @item --do-not-upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
2834 When used together with the @code{--upgrade} option, do @emph{not}
2835 upgrade any packages whose name matches a @var{regexp}. For example, to
2836 upgrade all packages in the current profile except those containing the
2837 substring ``emacs'':
2838
2839 @example
2840 $ guix package --upgrade . --do-not-upgrade emacs
2841 @end example
2842
2843 @item @anchor{profile-manifest}--manifest=@var{file}
2844 @itemx -m @var{file}
2845 @cindex profile declaration
2846 @cindex profile manifest
2847 Create a new generation of the profile from the manifest object
2848 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated
2849 several times, in which case the manifests are concatenated.
2850
2851 This allows you to @emph{declare} the profile's contents rather than
2852 constructing it through a sequence of @code{--install} and similar
2853 commands. The advantage is that @var{file} can be put under version
2854 control, copied to different machines to reproduce the same profile, and
2855 so on.
2856
2857 @c FIXME: Add reference to (guix profile) documentation when available.
2858 @var{file} must return a @dfn{manifest} object, which is roughly a list
2859 of packages:
2860
2861 @findex packages->manifest
2862 @lisp
2863 (use-package-modules guile emacs)
2864
2865 (packages->manifest
2866 (list emacs
2867 guile-2.0
2868 ;; Use a specific package output.
2869 (list guile-2.0 "debug")))
2870 @end lisp
2871
2872 @findex specifications->manifest
2873 In this example we have to know which modules define the @code{emacs}
2874 and @code{guile-2.0} variables to provide the right
2875 @code{use-package-modules} line, which can be cumbersome. We can
2876 instead provide regular package specifications and let
2877 @code{specifications->manifest} look up the corresponding package
2878 objects, like this:
2879
2880 @lisp
2881 (specifications->manifest
2882 '("emacs" "guile@@2.2" "guile@@2.2:debug"))
2883 @end lisp
2884
2885 @item --roll-back
2886 @cindex rolling back
2887 @cindex undoing transactions
2888 @cindex transactions, undoing
2889 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of the profile---i.e., undo
2890 the last transaction.
2891
2892 When combined with options such as @code{--install}, roll back occurs
2893 before any other actions.
2894
2895 When rolling back from the first generation that actually contains
2896 installed packages, the profile is made to point to the @dfn{zeroth
2897 generation}, which contains no files apart from its own metadata.
2898
2899 After having rolled back, installing, removing, or upgrading packages
2900 overwrites previous future generations. Thus, the history of the
2901 generations in a profile is always linear.
2902
2903 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
2904 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
2905 @cindex generations
2906 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
2907
2908 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
2909 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
2910 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
2911 the latest generation after @code{--roll-back}, use
2912 @code{--switch-generation=+1}.
2913
2914 The difference between @code{--roll-back} and
2915 @code{--switch-generation=-1} is that @code{--switch-generation} will
2916 not make a zeroth generation, so if a specified generation does not
2917 exist, the current generation will not be changed.
2918
2919 @item --search-paths[=@var{kind}]
2920 @cindex search paths
2921 Report environment variable definitions, in Bash syntax, that may be
2922 needed in order to use the set of installed packages. These environment
2923 variables are used to specify @dfn{search paths} for files used by some
2924 of the installed packages.
2925
2926 For example, GCC needs the @code{CPATH} and @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
2927 environment variables to be defined so it can look for headers and
2928 libraries in the user's profile (@pxref{Environment Variables,,, gcc,
2929 Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). If GCC and, say, the C
2930 library are installed in the profile, then @code{--search-paths} will
2931 suggest setting these variables to @code{@var{profile}/include} and
2932 @code{@var{profile}/lib}, respectively.
2933
2934 The typical use case is to define these environment variables in the
2935 shell:
2936
2937 @example
2938 $ eval `guix package --search-paths`
2939 @end example
2940
2941 @var{kind} may be one of @code{exact}, @code{prefix}, or @code{suffix},
2942 meaning that the returned environment variable definitions will either
2943 be exact settings, or prefixes or suffixes of the current value of these
2944 variables. When omitted, @var{kind} defaults to @code{exact}.
2945
2946 This option can also be used to compute the @emph{combined} search paths
2947 of several profiles. Consider this example:
2948
2949 @example
2950 $ guix package -p foo -i guile
2951 $ guix package -p bar -i guile-json
2952 $ guix package -p foo -p bar --search-paths
2953 @end example
2954
2955 The last command above reports about the @code{GUILE_LOAD_PATH}
2956 variable, even though, taken individually, neither @file{foo} nor
2957 @file{bar} would lead to that recommendation.
2958
2959
2960 @item --profile=@var{profile}
2961 @itemx -p @var{profile}
2962 Use @var{profile} instead of the user's default profile.
2963
2964 @var{profile} must be the name of a file that will be created upon
2965 completion. Concretely, @var{profile} will be a mere symbolic link
2966 (``symlink'') pointing to the actual profile where packages are
2967 installed:
2968
2969 @example
2970 $ guix install hello -p ~/code/my-profile
2971 @dots{}
2972 $ ~/code/my-profile/bin/hello
2973 Hello, world!
2974 @end example
2975
2976 All it takes to get rid of the profile is to remove this symlink and its
2977 siblings that point to specific generations:
2978
2979 @example
2980 $ rm ~/code/my-profile ~/code/my-profile-*-link
2981 @end example
2982
2983 @item --list-profiles
2984 List all the user's profiles:
2985
2986 @example
2987 $ guix package --list-profiles
2988 /home/charlie/.guix-profile
2989 /home/charlie/code/my-profile
2990 /home/charlie/code/devel-profile
2991 /home/charlie/tmp/test
2992 @end example
2993
2994 When running as root, list all the profiles of all the users.
2995
2996 @cindex collisions, in a profile
2997 @cindex colliding packages in profiles
2998 @cindex profile collisions
2999 @item --allow-collisions
3000 Allow colliding packages in the new profile. Use at your own risk!
3001
3002 By default, @command{guix package} reports as an error @dfn{collisions}
3003 in the profile. Collisions happen when two or more different versions
3004 or variants of a given package end up in the profile.
3005
3006 @item --bootstrap
3007 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the profile. This option is only
3008 useful to distribution developers.
3009
3010 @end table
3011
3012 In addition to these actions, @command{guix package} supports the
3013 following options to query the current state of a profile, or the
3014 availability of packages:
3015
3016 @table @option
3017
3018 @item --search=@var{regexp}
3019 @itemx -s @var{regexp}
3020 @cindex searching for packages
3021 List the available packages whose name, synopsis, or description matches
3022 @var{regexp} (in a case-insensitive fashion), sorted by relevance.
3023 Print all the metadata of matching packages in
3024 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils,
3025 GNU recutils manual}).
3026
3027 This allows specific fields to be extracted using the @command{recsel}
3028 command, for instance:
3029
3030 @example
3031 $ guix package -s malloc | recsel -p name,version,relevance
3032 name: jemalloc
3033 version: 4.5.0
3034 relevance: 6
3035
3036 name: glibc
3037 version: 2.25
3038 relevance: 1
3039
3040 name: libgc
3041 version: 7.6.0
3042 relevance: 1
3043 @end example
3044
3045 Similarly, to show the name of all the packages available under the
3046 terms of the GNU@tie{}LGPL version 3:
3047
3048 @example
3049 $ guix package -s "" | recsel -p name -e 'license ~ "LGPL 3"'
3050 name: elfutils
3051
3052 name: gmp
3053 @dots{}
3054 @end example
3055
3056 It is also possible to refine search results using several @code{-s} flags to
3057 @command{guix package}, or several arguments to @command{guix search}. For
3058 example, the following command returns a list of board games (this time using
3059 the @command{guix search} alias):
3060
3061 @example
3062 $ guix search '\<board\>' game | recsel -p name
3063 name: gnubg
3064 @dots{}
3065 @end example
3066
3067 If we were to omit @code{-s game}, we would also get software packages
3068 that deal with printed circuit boards; removing the angle brackets
3069 around @code{board} would further add packages that have to do with
3070 keyboards.
3071
3072 And now for a more elaborate example. The following command searches
3073 for cryptographic libraries, filters out Haskell, Perl, Python, and Ruby
3074 libraries, and prints the name and synopsis of the matching packages:
3075
3076 @example
3077 $ guix search crypto library | \
3078 recsel -e '! (name ~ "^(ghc|perl|python|ruby)")' -p name,synopsis
3079 @end example
3080
3081 @noindent
3082 @xref{Selection Expressions,,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}, for more
3083 information on @dfn{selection expressions} for @code{recsel -e}.
3084
3085 @item --show=@var{package}
3086 Show details about @var{package}, taken from the list of available packages, in
3087 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU
3088 recutils manual}).
3089
3090 @example
3091 $ guix package --show=python | recsel -p name,version
3092 name: python
3093 version: 2.7.6
3094
3095 name: python
3096 version: 3.3.5
3097 @end example
3098
3099 You may also specify the full name of a package to only get details about a
3100 specific version of it (this time using the @command{guix show} alias):
3101 @example
3102 $ guix show python@@3.4 | recsel -p name,version
3103 name: python
3104 version: 3.4.3
3105 @end example
3106
3107
3108
3109 @item --list-installed[=@var{regexp}]
3110 @itemx -I [@var{regexp}]
3111 List the currently installed packages in the specified profile, with the
3112 most recently installed packages shown last. When @var{regexp} is
3113 specified, list only installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3114
3115 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3116 tabs: the package name, its version string, the part of the package that
3117 is installed (for instance, @code{out} for the default output,
3118 @code{include} for its headers, etc.), and the path of this package in
3119 the store.
3120
3121 @item --list-available[=@var{regexp}]
3122 @itemx -A [@var{regexp}]
3123 List packages currently available in the distribution for this system
3124 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). When @var{regexp} is specified, list only
3125 available packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3126
3127 For each package, print the following items separated by tabs: its name,
3128 its version string, the parts of the package (@pxref{Packages with
3129 Multiple Outputs}), and the source location of its definition.
3130
3131 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3132 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
3133 @cindex generations
3134 Return a list of generations along with their creation dates; for each
3135 generation, show the installed packages, with the most recently
3136 installed packages shown last. Note that the zeroth generation is never
3137 shown.
3138
3139 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3140 tabs: the name of a package, its version string, the part of the package
3141 that is installed (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}), and the
3142 location of this package in the store.
3143
3144 When @var{pattern} is used, the command returns only matching
3145 generations. Valid patterns include:
3146
3147 @itemize
3148 @item @emph{Integers and comma-separated integers}. Both patterns denote
3149 generation numbers. For instance, @code{--list-generations=1} returns
3150 the first one.
3151
3152 And @code{--list-generations=1,8,2} outputs three generations in the
3153 specified order. Neither spaces nor trailing commas are allowed.
3154
3155 @item @emph{Ranges}. @code{--list-generations=2..9} prints the
3156 specified generations and everything in between. Note that the start of
3157 a range must be smaller than its end.
3158
3159 It is also possible to omit the endpoint. For example,
3160 @code{--list-generations=2..}, returns all generations starting from the
3161 second one.
3162
3163 @item @emph{Durations}. You can also get the last @emph{N}@tie{}days, weeks,
3164 or months by passing an integer along with the first letter of the
3165 duration. For example, @code{--list-generations=20d} lists generations
3166 that are up to 20 days old.
3167 @end itemize
3168
3169 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3170 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
3171 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
3172 one.
3173
3174 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
3175 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
3176 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
3177 specified duration match. For instance, @code{--delete-generations=1m}
3178 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
3179
3180 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted. Also, the
3181 zeroth generation is never deleted.
3182
3183 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
3184 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
3185
3186 @end table
3187
3188 Finally, since @command{guix package} may actually start build
3189 processes, it supports all the common build options (@pxref{Common Build
3190 Options}). It also supports package transformation options, such as
3191 @option{--with-source} (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
3192 However, note that package transformations are lost when upgrading; to
3193 preserve transformations across upgrades, you should define your own
3194 package variant in a Guile module and add it to @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
3195 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
3196
3197 @node Substitutes
3198 @section Substitutes
3199
3200 @cindex substitutes
3201 @cindex pre-built binaries
3202 Guix supports transparent source/binary deployment, which means that it
3203 can either build things locally, or download pre-built items from a
3204 server, or both. We call these pre-built items @dfn{substitutes}---they
3205 are substitutes for local build results. In many cases, downloading a
3206 substitute is much faster than building things locally.
3207
3208 Substitutes can be anything resulting from a derivation build
3209 (@pxref{Derivations}). Of course, in the common case, they are
3210 pre-built package binaries, but source tarballs, for instance, which
3211 also result from derivation builds, can be available as substitutes.
3212
3213 @menu
3214 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
3215 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
3216 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
3217 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
3218 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
3219 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
3220 @end menu
3221
3222 @node Official Substitute Server
3223 @subsection Official Substitute Server
3224
3225 @cindex build farm
3226 The @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} server is a front-end to an official build farm
3227 that builds packages from Guix continuously for some
3228 architectures, and makes them available as substitutes. This is the
3229 default source of substitutes; it can be overridden by passing the
3230 @option{--substitute-urls} option either to @command{guix-daemon}
3231 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}})
3232 or to client tools such as @command{guix package}
3233 (@pxref{client-substitute-urls,, client @option{--substitute-urls}
3234 option}).
3235
3236 Substitute URLs can be either HTTP or HTTPS.
3237 HTTPS is recommended because communications are encrypted; conversely,
3238 using HTTP makes all communications visible to an eavesdropper, who
3239 could use the information gathered to determine, for instance, whether
3240 your system has unpatched security vulnerabilities.
3241
3242 Substitutes from the official build farm are enabled by default when
3243 using Guix System (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). However,
3244 they are disabled by default when using Guix on a foreign distribution,
3245 unless you have explicitly enabled them via one of the recommended
3246 installation steps (@pxref{Installation}). The following paragraphs
3247 describe how to enable or disable substitutes for the official build
3248 farm; the same procedure can also be used to enable substitutes for any
3249 other substitute server.
3250
3251 @node Substitute Server Authorization
3252 @subsection Substitute Server Authorization
3253
3254 @cindex security
3255 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
3256 @cindex access control list (ACL), for substitutes
3257 @cindex ACL (access control list), for substitutes
3258 To allow Guix to download substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or a
3259 mirror thereof, you
3260 must add its public key to the access control list (ACL) of archive
3261 imports, using the @command{guix archive} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3262 archive}). Doing so implies that you trust @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to not
3263 be compromised and to serve genuine substitutes.
3264
3265 The public key for @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is installed along with Guix, in
3266 @code{@var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub}, where @var{prefix} is
3267 the installation prefix of Guix. If you installed Guix from source,
3268 make sure you checked the GPG signature of
3269 @file{guix-@value{VERSION}.tar.gz}, which contains this public key file.
3270 Then, you can run something like this:
3271
3272 @example
3273 # guix archive --authorize < @var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
3274 @end example
3275
3276 Once this is in place, the output of a command like @code{guix build}
3277 should change from something like:
3278
3279 @example
3280 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3281 The following derivations would be built:
3282 /gnu/store/yr7bnx8xwcayd6j95r2clmkdl1qh688w-emacs-24.3.drv
3283 /gnu/store/x8qsh1hlhgjx6cwsjyvybnfv2i37z23w-dbus-1.6.4.tar.gz.drv
3284 /gnu/store/1ixwp12fl950d15h2cj11c73733jay0z-alsa-lib-1.0.27.1.tar.bz2.drv
3285 /gnu/store/nlma1pw0p603fpfiqy7kn4zm105r5dmw-util-linux-2.21.drv
3286 @dots{}
3287 @end example
3288
3289 @noindent
3290 to something like:
3291
3292 @example
3293 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3294 112.3 MB would be downloaded:
3295 /gnu/store/pk3n22lbq6ydamyymqkkz7i69wiwjiwi-emacs-24.3
3296 /gnu/store/2ygn4ncnhrpr61rssa6z0d9x22si0va3-libjpeg-8d
3297 /gnu/store/71yz6lgx4dazma9dwn2mcjxaah9w77jq-cairo-1.12.16
3298 /gnu/store/7zdhgp0n1518lvfn8mb96sxqfmvqrl7v-libxrender-0.9.7
3299 @dots{}
3300 @end example
3301
3302 @noindent
3303 The text changed from ``The following derivations would be built'' to
3304 ``112.3 MB would be downloaded''. This indicates that substitutes from
3305 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} are usable and will be downloaded, when
3306 possible, for future builds.
3307
3308 @cindex substitutes, how to disable
3309 The substitute mechanism can be disabled globally by running
3310 @code{guix-daemon} with @code{--no-substitutes} (@pxref{Invoking
3311 guix-daemon}). It can also be disabled temporarily by passing the
3312 @code{--no-substitutes} option to @command{guix package}, @command{guix
3313 build}, and other command-line tools.
3314
3315 @node Substitute Authentication
3316 @subsection Substitute Authentication
3317
3318 @cindex digital signatures
3319 Guix detects and raises an error when attempting to use a substitute
3320 that has been tampered with. Likewise, it ignores substitutes that are
3321 not signed, or that are not signed by one of the keys listed in the ACL.
3322
3323 There is one exception though: if an unauthorized server provides
3324 substitutes that are @emph{bit-for-bit identical} to those provided by
3325 an authorized server, then the unauthorized server becomes eligible for
3326 downloads. For example, assume we have chosen two substitute servers
3327 with this option:
3328
3329 @example
3330 --substitute-urls="https://a.example.org https://b.example.org"
3331 @end example
3332
3333 @noindent
3334 @cindex reproducible builds
3335 If the ACL contains only the key for @code{b.example.org}, and if
3336 @code{a.example.org} happens to serve the @emph{exact same} substitutes,
3337 then Guix will download substitutes from @code{a.example.org} because it
3338 comes first in the list and can be considered a mirror of
3339 @code{b.example.org}. In practice, independent build machines usually
3340 produce the same binaries, thanks to bit-reproducible builds (see
3341 below).
3342
3343 When using HTTPS, the server's X.509 certificate is @emph{not} validated
3344 (in other words, the server is not authenticated), contrary to what
3345 HTTPS clients such as Web browsers usually do. This is because Guix
3346 authenticates substitute information itself, as explained above, which
3347 is what we care about (whereas X.509 certificates are about
3348 authenticating bindings between domain names and public keys.)
3349
3350 @node Proxy Settings
3351 @subsection Proxy Settings
3352
3353 @vindex http_proxy
3354 Substitutes are downloaded over HTTP or HTTPS.
3355 The @code{http_proxy} environment
3356 variable can be set in the environment of @command{guix-daemon} and is
3357 honored for downloads of substitutes. Note that the value of
3358 @code{http_proxy} in the environment where @command{guix build},
3359 @command{guix package}, and other client commands are run has
3360 @emph{absolutely no effect}.
3361
3362 @node Substitution Failure
3363 @subsection Substitution Failure
3364
3365 Even when a substitute for a derivation is available, sometimes the
3366 substitution attempt will fail. This can happen for a variety of
3367 reasons: the substitute server might be offline, the substitute may
3368 recently have been deleted, the connection might have been interrupted,
3369 etc.
3370
3371 When substitutes are enabled and a substitute for a derivation is
3372 available, but the substitution attempt fails, Guix will attempt to
3373 build the derivation locally depending on whether or not
3374 @code{--fallback} was given (@pxref{fallback-option,, common build
3375 option @code{--fallback}}). Specifically, if @code{--fallback} was
3376 omitted, then no local build will be performed, and the derivation is
3377 considered to have failed. However, if @code{--fallback} was given,
3378 then Guix will attempt to build the derivation locally, and the success
3379 or failure of the derivation depends on the success or failure of the
3380 local build. Note that when substitutes are disabled or no substitute
3381 is available for the derivation in question, a local build will
3382 @emph{always} be performed, regardless of whether or not
3383 @code{--fallback} was given.
3384
3385 To get an idea of how many substitutes are available right now, you can
3386 try running the @command{guix weather} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3387 weather}). This command provides statistics on the substitutes provided
3388 by a server.
3389
3390 @node On Trusting Binaries
3391 @subsection On Trusting Binaries
3392
3393 @cindex trust, of pre-built binaries
3394 Today, each individual's control over their own computing is at the
3395 mercy of institutions, corporations, and groups with enough power and
3396 determination to subvert the computing infrastructure and exploit its
3397 weaknesses. While using @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} substitutes can be
3398 convenient, we encourage users to also build on their own, or even run
3399 their own build farm, such that @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is less of an
3400 interesting target. One way to help is by publishing the software you
3401 build using @command{guix publish} so that others have one more choice
3402 of server to download substitutes from (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
3403
3404 Guix has the foundations to maximize build reproducibility
3405 (@pxref{Features}). In most cases, independent builds of a given
3406 package or derivation should yield bit-identical results. Thus, through
3407 a diverse set of independent package builds, we can strengthen the
3408 integrity of our systems. The @command{guix challenge} command aims to
3409 help users assess substitute servers, and to assist developers in
3410 finding out about non-deterministic package builds (@pxref{Invoking guix
3411 challenge}). Similarly, the @option{--check} option of @command{guix
3412 build} allows users to check whether previously-installed substitutes
3413 are genuine by rebuilding them locally (@pxref{build-check,
3414 @command{guix build --check}}).
3415
3416 In the future, we want Guix to have support to publish and retrieve
3417 binaries to/from other users, in a peer-to-peer fashion. If you would
3418 like to discuss this project, join us on @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
3419
3420 @node Packages with Multiple Outputs
3421 @section Packages with Multiple Outputs
3422
3423 @cindex multiple-output packages
3424 @cindex package outputs
3425 @cindex outputs
3426
3427 Often, packages defined in Guix have a single @dfn{output}---i.e., the
3428 source package leads to exactly one directory in the store. When running
3429 @command{guix install glibc}, one installs the default output of the
3430 GNU libc package; the default output is called @code{out}, but its name
3431 can be omitted as shown in this command. In this particular case, the
3432 default output of @code{glibc} contains all the C header files, shared
3433 libraries, static libraries, Info documentation, and other supporting
3434 files.
3435
3436 Sometimes it is more appropriate to separate the various types of files
3437 produced from a single source package into separate outputs. For
3438 instance, the GLib C library (used by GTK+ and related packages)
3439 installs more than 20 MiB of reference documentation as HTML pages.
3440 To save space for users who do not need it, the documentation goes to a
3441 separate output, called @code{doc}. To install the main GLib output,
3442 which contains everything but the documentation, one would run:
3443
3444 @example
3445 guix install glib
3446 @end example
3447
3448 @cindex documentation
3449 The command to install its documentation is:
3450
3451 @example
3452 guix install glib:doc
3453 @end example
3454
3455 Some packages install programs with different ``dependency footprints''.
3456 For instance, the WordNet package installs both command-line tools and
3457 graphical user interfaces (GUIs). The former depend solely on the C
3458 library, whereas the latter depend on Tcl/Tk and the underlying X
3459 libraries. In this case, we leave the command-line tools in the default
3460 output, whereas the GUIs are in a separate output. This allows users
3461 who do not need the GUIs to save space. The @command{guix size} command
3462 can help find out about such situations (@pxref{Invoking guix size}).
3463 @command{guix graph} can also be helpful (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
3464
3465 There are several such multiple-output packages in the GNU distribution.
3466 Other conventional output names include @code{lib} for libraries and
3467 possibly header files, @code{bin} for stand-alone programs, and
3468 @code{debug} for debugging information (@pxref{Installing Debugging
3469 Files}). The outputs of a packages are listed in the third column of
3470 the output of @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking
3471 guix package}).
3472
3473
3474 @node Invoking guix gc
3475 @section Invoking @command{guix gc}
3476
3477 @cindex garbage collector
3478 @cindex disk space
3479 Packages that are installed, but not used, may be @dfn{garbage-collected}.
3480 The @command{guix gc} command allows users to explicitly run the garbage
3481 collector to reclaim space from the @file{/gnu/store} directory. It is
3482 the @emph{only} way to remove files from @file{/gnu/store}---removing
3483 files or directories manually may break it beyond repair!
3484
3485 @cindex GC roots
3486 @cindex garbage collector roots
3487 The garbage collector has a set of known @dfn{roots}: any file under
3488 @file{/gnu/store} reachable from a root is considered @dfn{live} and
3489 cannot be deleted; any other file is considered @dfn{dead} and may be
3490 deleted. The set of garbage collector roots (``GC roots'' for short)
3491 includes default user profiles; by default, the symlinks under
3492 @file{/var/guix/gcroots} represent these GC roots. New GC roots can be
3493 added with @command{guix build --root}, for example (@pxref{Invoking
3494 guix build}). The @command{guix gc --list-roots} command lists them.
3495
3496 Prior to running @code{guix gc --collect-garbage} to make space, it is
3497 often useful to remove old generations from user profiles; that way, old
3498 package builds referenced by those generations can be reclaimed. This
3499 is achieved by running @code{guix package --delete-generations}
3500 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
3501
3502 Our recommendation is to run a garbage collection periodically, or when
3503 you are short on disk space. For instance, to guarantee that at least
3504 5@tie{}GB are available on your disk, simply run:
3505
3506 @example
3507 guix gc -F 5G
3508 @end example
3509
3510 It is perfectly safe to run as a non-interactive periodic job
3511 (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}, for how to set up such a job).
3512 Running @command{guix gc} with no arguments will collect as
3513 much garbage as it can, but that is often inconvenient: you may find
3514 yourself having to rebuild or re-download software that is ``dead'' from
3515 the GC viewpoint but that is necessary to build other pieces of
3516 software---e.g., the compiler tool chain.
3517
3518 The @command{guix gc} command has three modes of operation: it can be
3519 used to garbage-collect any dead files (the default), to delete specific
3520 files (the @code{--delete} option), to print garbage-collector
3521 information, or for more advanced queries. The garbage collection
3522 options are as follows:
3523
3524 @table @code
3525 @item --collect-garbage[=@var{min}]
3526 @itemx -C [@var{min}]
3527 Collect garbage---i.e., unreachable @file{/gnu/store} files and
3528 sub-directories. This is the default operation when no option is
3529 specified.
3530
3531 When @var{min} is given, stop once @var{min} bytes have been collected.
3532 @var{min} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
3533 suffix, such as @code{MiB} for mebibytes and @code{GB} for gigabytes
3534 (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
3535
3536 When @var{min} is omitted, collect all the garbage.
3537
3538 @item --free-space=@var{free}
3539 @itemx -F @var{free}
3540 Collect garbage until @var{free} space is available under
3541 @file{/gnu/store}, if possible; @var{free} denotes storage space, such
3542 as @code{500MiB}, as described above.
3543
3544 When @var{free} or more is already available in @file{/gnu/store}, do
3545 nothing and exit immediately.
3546
3547 @item --delete-generations[=@var{duration}]
3548 @itemx -d [@var{duration}]
3549 Before starting the garbage collection process, delete all the generations
3550 older than @var{duration}, for all the user profiles; when run as root, this
3551 applies to all the profiles @emph{of all the users}.
3552
3553 For example, this command deletes all the generations of all your profiles
3554 that are older than 2 months (except generations that are current), and then
3555 proceeds to free space until at least 10 GiB are available:
3556
3557 @example
3558 guix gc -d 2m -F 10G
3559 @end example
3560
3561 @item --delete
3562 @itemx -D
3563 Attempt to delete all the store files and directories specified as
3564 arguments. This fails if some of the files are not in the store, or if
3565 they are still live.
3566
3567 @item --list-failures
3568 List store items corresponding to cached build failures.
3569
3570 This prints nothing unless the daemon was started with
3571 @option{--cache-failures} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
3572 @option{--cache-failures}}).
3573
3574 @item --list-roots
3575 List the GC roots owned by the user; when run as root, list @emph{all} the GC
3576 roots.
3577
3578 @item --list-busy
3579 List store items in use by currently running processes. These store
3580 items are effectively considered GC roots: they cannot be deleted.
3581
3582 @item --clear-failures
3583 Remove the specified store items from the failed-build cache.
3584
3585 Again, this option only makes sense when the daemon is started with
3586 @option{--cache-failures}. Otherwise, it does nothing.
3587
3588 @item --list-dead
3589 Show the list of dead files and directories still present in the
3590 store---i.e., files and directories no longer reachable from any root.
3591
3592 @item --list-live
3593 Show the list of live store files and directories.
3594
3595 @end table
3596
3597 In addition, the references among existing store files can be queried:
3598
3599 @table @code
3600
3601 @item --references
3602 @itemx --referrers
3603 @cindex package dependencies
3604 List the references (respectively, the referrers) of store files given
3605 as arguments.
3606
3607 @item --requisites
3608 @itemx -R
3609 @cindex closure
3610 List the requisites of the store files passed as arguments. Requisites
3611 include the store files themselves, their references, and the references
3612 of these, recursively. In other words, the returned list is the
3613 @dfn{transitive closure} of the store files.
3614
3615 @xref{Invoking guix size}, for a tool to profile the size of the closure
3616 of an element. @xref{Invoking guix graph}, for a tool to visualize
3617 the graph of references.
3618
3619 @item --derivers
3620 @cindex derivation
3621 Return the derivation(s) leading to the given store items
3622 (@pxref{Derivations}).
3623
3624 For example, this command:
3625
3626 @example
3627 guix gc --derivers `guix package -I ^emacs$ | cut -f4`
3628 @end example
3629
3630 @noindent
3631 returns the @file{.drv} file(s) leading to the @code{emacs} package
3632 installed in your profile.
3633
3634 Note that there may be zero matching @file{.drv} files, for instance
3635 because these files have been garbage-collected. There can also be more
3636 than one matching @file{.drv} due to fixed-output derivations.
3637 @end table
3638
3639 Lastly, the following options allow you to check the integrity of the
3640 store and to control disk usage.
3641
3642 @table @option
3643
3644 @item --verify[=@var{options}]
3645 @cindex integrity, of the store
3646 @cindex integrity checking
3647 Verify the integrity of the store.
3648
3649 By default, make sure that all the store items marked as valid in the
3650 database of the daemon actually exist in @file{/gnu/store}.
3651
3652 When provided, @var{options} must be a comma-separated list containing one
3653 or more of @code{contents} and @code{repair}.
3654
3655 When passing @option{--verify=contents}, the daemon computes the
3656 content hash of each store item and compares it against its hash in the
3657 database. Hash mismatches are reported as data corruptions. Because it
3658 traverses @emph{all the files in the store}, this command can take a
3659 long time, especially on systems with a slow disk drive.
3660
3661 @cindex repairing the store
3662 @cindex corruption, recovering from
3663 Using @option{--verify=repair} or @option{--verify=contents,repair}
3664 causes the daemon to try to repair corrupt store items by fetching
3665 substitutes for them (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because repairing is not
3666 atomic, and thus potentially dangerous, it is available only to the
3667 system administrator. A lightweight alternative, when you know exactly
3668 which items in the store are corrupt, is @command{guix build --repair}
3669 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
3670
3671 @item --optimize
3672 @cindex deduplication
3673 Optimize the store by hard-linking identical files---this is
3674 @dfn{deduplication}.
3675
3676 The daemon performs deduplication after each successful build or archive
3677 import, unless it was started with @code{--disable-deduplication}
3678 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @code{--disable-deduplication}}). Thus,
3679 this option is primarily useful when the daemon was running with
3680 @code{--disable-deduplication}.
3681
3682 @end table
3683
3684 @node Invoking guix pull
3685 @section Invoking @command{guix pull}
3686
3687 @cindex upgrading Guix
3688 @cindex updating Guix
3689 @cindex @command{guix pull}
3690 @cindex pull
3691 Packages are installed or upgraded to the latest version available in
3692 the distribution currently available on your local machine. To update
3693 that distribution, along with the Guix tools, you must run @command{guix
3694 pull}: the command downloads the latest Guix source code and package
3695 descriptions, and deploys it. Source code is downloaded from a
3696 @uref{https://git-scm.com, Git} repository, by default the official
3697 GNU@tie{}Guix repository, though this can be customized.
3698
3699 Specifically, @command{guix pull} downloads code from the @dfn{channels}
3700 (@pxref{Channels}) specified by one of the followings, in this order:
3701
3702 @enumerate
3703 @item
3704 the @option{--channels} option;
3705 @item
3706 the user's @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file;
3707 @item
3708 the system-wide @file{/etc/guix/channels.scm} file;
3709 @item
3710 the built-in default channels specified in the @code{%default-channels}
3711 variable.
3712 @end enumerate
3713
3714 On completion, @command{guix package} will use packages and package
3715 versions from this just-retrieved copy of Guix. Not only that, but all
3716 the Guix commands and Scheme modules will also be taken from that latest
3717 version. New @command{guix} sub-commands added by the update also
3718 become available.
3719
3720 Any user can update their Guix copy using @command{guix pull}, and the
3721 effect is limited to the user who ran @command{guix pull}. For
3722 instance, when user @code{root} runs @command{guix pull}, this has no
3723 effect on the version of Guix that user @code{alice} sees, and vice
3724 versa.
3725
3726 The result of running @command{guix pull} is a @dfn{profile} available
3727 under @file{~/.config/guix/current} containing the latest Guix. Thus,
3728 make sure to add it to the beginning of your search path so that you use
3729 the latest version, and similarly for the Info manual
3730 (@pxref{Documentation}):
3731
3732 @example
3733 export PATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/bin:$PATH"
3734 export INFOPATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/share/info:$INFOPATH"
3735 @end example
3736
3737 The @code{--list-generations} or @code{-l} option lists past generations
3738 produced by @command{guix pull}, along with details about their provenance:
3739
3740 @example
3741 $ guix pull -l
3742 Generation 1 Jun 10 2018 00:18:18
3743 guix 65956ad
3744 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3745 branch: origin/master
3746 commit: 65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe
3747
3748 Generation 2 Jun 11 2018 11:02:49
3749 guix e0cc7f6
3750 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3751 branch: origin/master
3752 commit: e0cc7f669bec22c37481dd03a7941c7d11a64f1d
3753 2 new packages: keepalived, libnfnetlink
3754 6 packages upgraded: emacs-nix-mode@@2.0.4,
3755 guile2.0-guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac, guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac,
3756 heimdal@@7.5.0, milkytracker@@1.02.00, nix@@2.0.4
3757
3758 Generation 3 Jun 13 2018 23:31:07 (current)
3759 guix 844cc1c
3760 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3761 branch: origin/master
3762 commit: 844cc1c8f394f03b404c5bb3aee086922373490c
3763 28 new packages: emacs-helm-ls-git, emacs-helm-mu, @dots{}
3764 69 packages upgraded: borg@@1.1.6, cheese@@3.28.0, @dots{}
3765 @end example
3766
3767 @xref{Invoking guix describe, @command{guix describe}}, for other ways to
3768 describe the current status of Guix.
3769
3770 This @code{~/.config/guix/current} profile works exactly like the profiles
3771 created by @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). That
3772 is, you can list generations, roll back to the previous
3773 generation---i.e., the previous Guix---and so on:
3774
3775 @example
3776 $ guix pull --roll-back
3777 switched from generation 3 to 2
3778 $ guix pull --delete-generations=1
3779 deleting /var/guix/profiles/per-user/charlie/current-guix-1-link
3780 @end example
3781
3782 You can also use @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package})
3783 to manage the profile by naming it explicitly:
3784 @example
3785 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --roll-back
3786 switched from generation 3 to 2
3787 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --delete-generations=1
3788 deleting /var/guix/profiles/per-user/charlie/current-guix-1-link
3789 @end example
3790
3791 The @command{guix pull} command is usually invoked with no arguments,
3792 but it supports the following options:
3793
3794 @table @code
3795 @item --url=@var{url}
3796 @itemx --commit=@var{commit}
3797 @itemx --branch=@var{branch}
3798 Download code for the @code{guix} channel from the specified @var{url}, at the
3799 given @var{commit} (a valid Git commit ID represented as a hexadecimal
3800 string), or @var{branch}.
3801
3802 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
3803 @cindex configuration file for channels
3804 These options are provided for convenience, but you can also specify your
3805 configuration in the @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file or using the
3806 @option{--channels} option (see below).
3807
3808 @item --channels=@var{file}
3809 @itemx -C @var{file}
3810 Read the list of channels from @var{file} instead of
3811 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} or @file{/etc/guix/channels.scm}.
3812 @var{file} must contain Scheme code that
3813 evaluates to a list of channel objects. @xref{Channels}, for more
3814 information.
3815
3816 @cindex channel news
3817 @item --news
3818 @itemx -N
3819 Display the list of packages added or upgraded since the previous
3820 generation, as well as, occasionally, news written by channel authors
3821 for their users (@pxref{Channels, Writing Channel News}).
3822
3823 The package information is the same as displayed upon @command{guix
3824 pull} completion, but without ellipses; it is also similar to the output
3825 of @command{guix pull -l} for the last generation (see below).
3826
3827 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3828 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
3829 List all the generations of @file{~/.config/guix/current} or, if @var{pattern}
3830 is provided, the subset of generations that match @var{pattern}.
3831 The syntax of @var{pattern} is the same as with @code{guix package
3832 --list-generations} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
3833
3834 @item --roll-back
3835 @cindex rolling back
3836 @cindex undoing transactions
3837 @cindex transactions, undoing
3838 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of @file{~/.config/guix/current}---i.e.,
3839 undo the last transaction.
3840
3841 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
3842 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
3843 @cindex generations
3844 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
3845
3846 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
3847 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
3848 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
3849 the latest generation after @code{--roll-back}, use
3850 @code{--switch-generation=+1}.
3851
3852 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3853 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
3854 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
3855 one.
3856
3857 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
3858 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
3859 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
3860 specified duration match. For instance, @code{--delete-generations=1m}
3861 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
3862
3863 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted.
3864
3865 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
3866 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
3867
3868 @xref{Invoking guix describe}, for a way to display information about the
3869 current generation only.
3870
3871 @item --profile=@var{profile}
3872 @itemx -p @var{profile}
3873 Use @var{profile} instead of @file{~/.config/guix/current}.
3874
3875 @item --dry-run
3876 @itemx -n
3877 Show which channel commit(s) would be used and what would be built or
3878 substituted but do not actually do it.
3879
3880 @item --system=@var{system}
3881 @itemx -s @var{system}
3882 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
3883 the system type of the build host.
3884
3885 @item --verbose
3886 Produce verbose output, writing build logs to the standard error output.
3887
3888 @item --bootstrap
3889 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the latest Guix. This option is only
3890 useful to Guix developers.
3891 @end table
3892
3893 The @dfn{channel} mechanism allows you to instruct @command{guix pull} which
3894 repository and branch to pull from, as well as @emph{additional} repositories
3895 containing package modules that should be deployed. @xref{Channels}, for more
3896 information.
3897
3898 In addition, @command{guix pull} supports all the common build options
3899 (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
3900
3901 @node Channels
3902 @section Channels
3903
3904 @cindex channels
3905 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
3906 @cindex configuration file for channels
3907 @cindex @command{guix pull}, configuration file
3908 @cindex configuration of @command{guix pull}
3909 Guix and its package collection are updated by running @command{guix pull}
3910 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). By default @command{guix pull} downloads and
3911 deploys Guix itself from the official GNU@tie{}Guix repository. This can be
3912 customized by defining @dfn{channels} in the
3913 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file. A channel specifies a URL and branch
3914 of a Git repository to be deployed, and @command{guix pull} can be instructed
3915 to pull from one or more channels. In other words, channels can be used to
3916 @emph{customize} and to @emph{extend} Guix, as we will see below.
3917
3918 @subsection Using a Custom Guix Channel
3919
3920 The channel called @code{guix} specifies where Guix itself---its command-line
3921 tools as well as its package collection---should be downloaded. For instance,
3922 suppose you want to update from your own copy of the Guix repository at
3923 @code{example.org}, and specifically the @code{super-hacks} branch, you can
3924 write in @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} this specification:
3925
3926 @lisp
3927 ;; Tell 'guix pull' to use my own repo.
3928 (list (channel
3929 (name 'guix)
3930 (url "https://example.org/my-guix.git")
3931 (branch "super-hacks")))
3932 @end lisp
3933
3934 @noindent
3935 From there on, @command{guix pull} will fetch code from the @code{super-hacks}
3936 branch of the repository at @code{example.org}.
3937
3938 @subsection Specifying Additional Channels
3939
3940 @cindex extending the package collection (channels)
3941 @cindex personal packages (channels)
3942 @cindex channels, for personal packages
3943 You can also specify @emph{additional channels} to pull from. Let's say you
3944 have a bunch of custom package variants or personal packages that you think
3945 would make little sense to contribute to the Guix project, but would like to
3946 have these packages transparently available to you at the command line. You
3947 would first write modules containing those package definitions (@pxref{Package
3948 Modules}), maintain them in a Git repository, and then you and anyone else can
3949 use it as an additional channel to get packages from. Neat, no?
3950
3951 @c What follows stems from discussions at
3952 @c <https://debbugs.gnu.org/cgi/bugreport.cgi?bug=22629#134> as well as
3953 @c earlier discussions on guix-devel@gnu.org.
3954 @quotation Warning
3955 Before you, dear user, shout---``woow this is @emph{soooo coool}!''---and
3956 publish your personal channel to the world, we would like to share a few words
3957 of caution:
3958
3959 @itemize
3960 @item
3961 Before publishing a channel, please consider contributing your package
3962 definitions to Guix proper (@pxref{Contributing}). Guix as a project is open
3963 to free software of all sorts, and packages in Guix proper are readily
3964 available to all Guix users and benefit from the project's quality assurance
3965 process.
3966
3967 @item
3968 When you maintain package definitions outside Guix, we, Guix developers,
3969 consider that @emph{the compatibility burden is on you}. Remember that
3970 package modules and package definitions are just Scheme code that uses various
3971 programming interfaces (APIs). We want to remain free to change these APIs to
3972 keep improving Guix, possibly in ways that break your channel. We never
3973 change APIs gratuitously, but we will @emph{not} commit to freezing APIs
3974 either.
3975
3976 @item
3977 Corollary: if you're using an external channel and that channel breaks, please
3978 @emph{report the issue to the channel authors}, not to the Guix project.
3979 @end itemize
3980
3981 You've been warned! Having said this, we believe external channels are a
3982 practical way to exert your freedom to augment Guix' package collection and to
3983 share your improvements, which are basic tenets of
3984 @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, free software}. Please
3985 email us at @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} if you'd like to discuss this.
3986 @end quotation
3987
3988 To use a channel, write @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} to instruct
3989 @command{guix pull} to pull from it @emph{in addition} to the default Guix
3990 channel(s):
3991
3992 @vindex %default-channels
3993 @lisp
3994 ;; Add my personal packages to those Guix provides.
3995 (cons (channel
3996 (name 'my-personal-packages)
3997 (url "https://example.org/personal-packages.git"))
3998 %default-channels)
3999 @end lisp
4000
4001 @noindent
4002 Note that the snippet above is (as always!)@: Scheme code; we use @code{cons} to
4003 add a channel the list of channels that the variable @code{%default-channels}
4004 is bound to (@pxref{Pairs, @code{cons} and lists,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
4005 Manual}). With this file in place, @command{guix pull} builds not only Guix
4006 but also the package modules from your own repository. The result in
4007 @file{~/.config/guix/current} is the union of Guix with your own package
4008 modules:
4009
4010 @example
4011 $ guix pull --list-generations
4012 @dots{}
4013 Generation 19 Aug 27 2018 16:20:48
4014 guix d894ab8
4015 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4016 branch: master
4017 commit: d894ab8e9bfabcefa6c49d9ba2e834dd5a73a300
4018 my-personal-packages dd3df5e
4019 repository URL: https://example.org/personal-packages.git
4020 branch: master
4021 commit: dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb
4022 11 new packages: my-gimp, my-emacs-with-cool-features, @dots{}
4023 4 packages upgraded: emacs-racket-mode@@0.0.2-2.1b78827, @dots{}
4024 @end example
4025
4026 @noindent
4027 The output of @command{guix pull} above shows that Generation@tie{}19 includes
4028 both Guix and packages from the @code{my-personal-packages} channel. Among
4029 the new and upgraded packages that are listed, some like @code{my-gimp} and
4030 @code{my-emacs-with-cool-features} might come from
4031 @code{my-personal-packages}, while others come from the Guix default channel.
4032
4033 To create a channel, create a Git repository containing your own package
4034 modules and make it available. The repository can contain anything, but a
4035 useful channel will contain Guile modules that export packages. Once you
4036 start using a channel, Guix will behave as if the root directory of that
4037 channel's Git repository has been added to the Guile load path (@pxref{Load
4038 Paths,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For example, if your channel
4039 contains a file at @file{my-packages/my-tools.scm} that defines a Guile
4040 module, then the module will be available under the name @code{(my-packages
4041 my-tools)}, and you will be able to use it like any other module
4042 (@pxref{Modules,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
4043
4044 @cindex dependencies, channels
4045 @cindex meta-data, channels
4046 @subsection Declaring Channel Dependencies
4047
4048 Channel authors may decide to augment a package collection provided by other
4049 channels. They can declare their channel to be dependent on other channels in
4050 a meta-data file @file{.guix-channel}, which is to be placed in the root of
4051 the channel repository.
4052
4053 The meta-data file should contain a simple S-expression like this:
4054
4055 @lisp
4056 (channel
4057 (version 0)
4058 (dependencies
4059 (channel
4060 (name some-collection)
4061 (url "https://example.org/first-collection.git"))
4062 (channel
4063 (name some-other-collection)
4064 (url "https://example.org/second-collection.git")
4065 (branch "testing"))))
4066 @end lisp
4067
4068 In the above example this channel is declared to depend on two other channels,
4069 which will both be fetched automatically. The modules provided by the channel
4070 will be compiled in an environment where the modules of all these declared
4071 channels are available.
4072
4073 For the sake of reliability and maintainability, you should avoid dependencies
4074 on channels that you don't control, and you should aim to keep the number of
4075 dependencies to a minimum.
4076
4077 @cindex subdirectory, channels
4078 @subsection Package Modules in a Sub-directory
4079
4080 As a channel author, you may want to keep your channel modules in a
4081 sub-directory. If your modules are in the sub-directory @file{guix}, you must
4082 add a meta-data file @file{.guix-channel} that contains:
4083
4084 @lisp
4085 (channel
4086 (version 0)
4087 (directory "guix"))
4088 @end lisp
4089
4090 @cindex news, for channels
4091 @subsection Writing Channel News
4092
4093 Channel authors may occasionally want to communicate to their users
4094 information about important changes in the channel. You'd send them all
4095 an email, but that's not convenient.
4096
4097 Instead, channels can provide a @dfn{news file}; when the channel users
4098 run @command{guix pull}, that news file is automatically read and
4099 @command{guix pull --news} can display the announcements that correspond
4100 to the new commits that have been pulled, if any.
4101
4102 To do that, channel authors must first declare the name of the news file
4103 in their @file{.guix-channel} file:
4104
4105 @lisp
4106 (channel
4107 (version 0)
4108 (news-file "etc/news.txt"))
4109 @end lisp
4110
4111 The news file itself, @file{etc/news.txt} in this example, must look
4112 something like this:
4113
4114 @lisp
4115 (channel-news
4116 (version 0)
4117 (entry (tag "the-bug-fix")
4118 (title (en "Fixed terrible bug")
4119 (fr "Oh la la"))
4120 (body (en "@@emph@{Good news@}! It's fixed!")
4121 (eo "Certe ĝi pli bone funkcias nun!")))
4122 (entry (commit "bdcabe815cd28144a2d2b4bc3c5057b051fa9906")
4123 (title (en "Added a great package")
4124 (ca "Què vol dir guix?"))
4125 (body (en "Don't miss the @@code@{hello@} package!"))))
4126 @end lisp
4127
4128 The file consists of a list of @dfn{news entries}. Each entry is
4129 associated with a commit or tag: it describes changes made in this
4130 commit, possibly in preceding commits as well. Users see entries only
4131 the first time they obtain the commit the entry refers to.
4132
4133 The @code{title} field should be a one-line summary while @code{body}
4134 can be arbitrarily long, and both can contain Texinfo markup
4135 (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). Both the title and body are
4136 a list of language tag/message tuples, which allows @command{guix pull}
4137 to display news in the language that corresponds to the user's locale.
4138
4139 If you want to translate news using a gettext-based workflow, you can
4140 extract translatable strings with @command{xgettext} (@pxref{xgettext
4141 Invocation,,, gettext, GNU Gettext Utilities}). For example, assuming
4142 you write news entries in English first, the command below creates a PO
4143 file containing the strings to translate:
4144
4145 @example
4146 xgettext -o news.po -l scheme -ken etc/news.scm
4147 @end example
4148
4149 To sum up, yes, you could use your channel as a blog. But beware, this
4150 is @emph{not quite} what your users might expect.
4151
4152 @subsection Replicating Guix
4153
4154 @cindex pinning, channels
4155 @cindex replicating Guix
4156 @cindex reproducibility, of Guix
4157 The @command{guix pull --list-generations} output above shows precisely which
4158 commits were used to build this instance of Guix. We can thus replicate it,
4159 say, on another machine, by providing a channel specification in
4160 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} that is ``pinned'' to these commits:
4161
4162 @lisp
4163 ;; Deploy specific commits of my channels of interest.
4164 (list (channel
4165 (name 'guix)
4166 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4167 (commit "d894ab8e9bfabcefa6c49d9ba2e834dd5a73a300"))
4168 (channel
4169 (name 'my-personal-packages)
4170 (url "https://example.org/personal-packages.git")
4171 (commit "dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb")))
4172 @end lisp
4173
4174 The @command{guix describe --format=channels} command can even generate this
4175 list of channels directly (@pxref{Invoking guix describe}). The resulting
4176 file can be used with the -C options of @command{guix pull}
4177 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}) or @command{guix time-machine}
4178 (@pxref{Invoking guix time-machine}).
4179
4180 At this point the two machines run the @emph{exact same Guix}, with access to
4181 the @emph{exact same packages}. The output of @command{guix build gimp} on
4182 one machine will be exactly the same, bit for bit, as the output of the same
4183 command on the other machine. It also means both machines have access to all
4184 the source code of Guix and, transitively, to all the source code of every
4185 package it defines.
4186
4187 This gives you super powers, allowing you to track the provenance of binary
4188 artifacts with very fine grain, and to reproduce software environments at
4189 will---some sort of ``meta reproducibility'' capabilities, if you will.
4190 @xref{Inferiors}, for another way to take advantage of these super powers.
4191
4192 @node Invoking guix time-machine
4193 @section Invoking @command{guix time-machine}
4194
4195 @cindex @command{guix time-machine}
4196 @cindex pinning, channels
4197 @cindex replicating Guix
4198 @cindex reproducibility, of Guix
4199
4200 The @command{guix time-machine} command provides access to other
4201 revisions of Guix, for example to install older versions of packages,
4202 or to reproduce a computation in an identical environment. The revision
4203 of Guix to be used is defined by a commit or by a channel
4204 description file created by @command{guix describe}
4205 (@pxref{Invoking guix describe}).
4206
4207 The general syntax is:
4208
4209 @example
4210 guix time-machine @var{options}@dots{} -- @var{command} @var {arg}@dots{}
4211 @end example
4212
4213 where @var{command} and @var{arg}@dots{} are passed unmodified to the
4214 @command{guix} command if the specified revision. The @var{options} that define
4215 this revision are the same as for @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}):
4216
4217 @table @code
4218 @item --url=@var{url}
4219 @itemx --commit=@var{commit}
4220 @itemx --branch=@var{branch}
4221 Use the @code{guix} channel from the specified @var{url}, at the
4222 given @var{commit} (a valid Git commit ID represented as a hexadecimal
4223 string), or @var{branch}.
4224
4225 @item --channels=@var{file}
4226 @itemx -C @var{file}
4227 Read the list of channels from @var{file}. @var{file} must contain
4228 Scheme code that evaluates to a list of channel objects.
4229 @xref{Channels} for more information.
4230 @end table
4231
4232 As for @command{guix pull}, the absence of any options means that the
4233 the latest commit on the master branch will be used. The command
4234
4235 @example
4236 guix time-machine -- build hello
4237 @end example
4238
4239 will thus build the package @code{hello} as defined in the master branch,
4240 which is in general a newer revision of Guix than you have installed.
4241 Time travel works in both directions!
4242
4243 Note that @command{guix time-machine} can trigger builds of channels and
4244 their dependencies, and these are controlled by the standard build
4245 options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4246
4247 @node Inferiors
4248 @section Inferiors
4249
4250 @c TODO: Remove this once we're more confident about API stability.
4251 @quotation Note
4252 The functionality described here is a ``technology preview'' as of version
4253 @value{VERSION}. As such, the interface is subject to change.
4254 @end quotation
4255
4256 @cindex inferiors
4257 @cindex composition of Guix revisions
4258 Sometimes you might need to mix packages from the revision of Guix you're
4259 currently running with packages available in a different revision of Guix.
4260 Guix @dfn{inferiors} allow you to achieve that by composing different Guix
4261 revisions in arbitrary ways.
4262
4263 @cindex inferior packages
4264 Technically, an ``inferior'' is essentially a separate Guix process connected
4265 to your main Guix process through a REPL (@pxref{Invoking guix repl}). The
4266 @code{(guix inferior)} module allows you to create inferiors and to
4267 communicate with them. It also provides a high-level interface to browse and
4268 manipulate the packages that an inferior provides---@dfn{inferior packages}.
4269
4270 When combined with channels (@pxref{Channels}), inferiors provide a simple way
4271 to interact with a separate revision of Guix. For example, let's assume you
4272 want to install in your profile the current @code{guile} package, along with
4273 the @code{guile-json} as it existed in an older revision of Guix---perhaps
4274 because the newer @code{guile-json} has an incompatible API and you want to
4275 run your code against the old API@. To do that, you could write a manifest for
4276 use by @code{guix package --manifest} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}); in that
4277 manifest, you would create an inferior for that old Guix revision you care
4278 about, and you would look up the @code{guile-json} package in the inferior:
4279
4280 @lisp
4281 (use-modules (guix inferior) (guix channels)
4282 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'first'
4283
4284 (define channels
4285 ;; This is the old revision from which we want to
4286 ;; extract guile-json.
4287 (list (channel
4288 (name 'guix)
4289 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4290 (commit
4291 "65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe"))))
4292
4293 (define inferior
4294 ;; An inferior representing the above revision.
4295 (inferior-for-channels channels))
4296
4297 ;; Now create a manifest with the current "guile" package
4298 ;; and the old "guile-json" package.
4299 (packages->manifest
4300 (list (first (lookup-inferior-packages inferior "guile-json"))
4301 (specification->package "guile")))
4302 @end lisp
4303
4304 On its first run, @command{guix package --manifest} might have to build the
4305 channel you specified before it can create the inferior; subsequent runs will
4306 be much faster because the Guix revision will be cached.
4307
4308 The @code{(guix inferior)} module provides the following procedures to open an
4309 inferior:
4310
4311 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-for-channels @var{channels} @
4312 [#:cache-directory] [#:ttl]
4313 Return an inferior for @var{channels}, a list of channels. Use the cache at
4314 @var{cache-directory}, where entries can be reclaimed after @var{ttl} seconds.
4315 This procedure opens a new connection to the build daemon.
4316
4317 As a side effect, this procedure may build or substitute binaries for
4318 @var{channels}, which can take time.
4319 @end deffn
4320
4321 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-inferior @var{directory} @
4322 [#:command "bin/guix"]
4323 Open the inferior Guix in @var{directory}, running
4324 @code{@var{directory}/@var{command} repl} or equivalent. Return @code{#f} if
4325 the inferior could not be launched.
4326 @end deffn
4327
4328 @cindex inferior packages
4329 The procedures listed below allow you to obtain and manipulate inferior
4330 packages.
4331
4332 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-packages @var{inferior}
4333 Return the list of packages known to @var{inferior}.
4334 @end deffn
4335
4336 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-inferior-packages @var{inferior} @var{name} @
4337 [@var{version}]
4338 Return the sorted list of inferior packages matching @var{name} in
4339 @var{inferior}, with highest version numbers first. If @var{version} is true,
4340 return only packages with a version number prefixed by @var{version}.
4341 @end deffn
4342
4343 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package? @var{obj}
4344 Return true if @var{obj} is an inferior package.
4345 @end deffn
4346
4347 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-name @var{package}
4348 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-version @var{package}
4349 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-synopsis @var{package}
4350 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-description @var{package}
4351 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-home-page @var{package}
4352 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-location @var{package}
4353 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-inputs @var{package}
4354 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-inputs @var{package}
4355 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4356 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4357 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-search-paths @var{package}
4358 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-native-search-paths @var{package}
4359 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-search-paths @var{package}
4360 These procedures are the counterpart of package record accessors
4361 (@pxref{package Reference}). Most of them work by querying the inferior
4362 @var{package} comes from, so the inferior must still be live when you call
4363 these procedures.
4364 @end deffn
4365
4366 Inferior packages can be used transparently like any other package or
4367 file-like object in G-expressions (@pxref{G-Expressions}). They are also
4368 transparently handled by the @code{packages->manifest} procedure, which is
4369 commonly use in manifests (@pxref{Invoking guix package, the
4370 @option{--manifest} option of @command{guix package}}). Thus you can insert
4371 an inferior package pretty much anywhere you would insert a regular package:
4372 in manifests, in the @code{packages} field of your @code{operating-system}
4373 declaration, and so on.
4374
4375 @node Invoking guix describe
4376 @section Invoking @command{guix describe}
4377
4378 @cindex reproducibility
4379 @cindex replicating Guix
4380 Often you may want to answer questions like: ``Which revision of Guix am I
4381 using?'' or ``Which channels am I using?'' This is useful information in many
4382 situations: if you want to @emph{replicate} an environment on a different
4383 machine or user account, if you want to report a bug or to determine what
4384 change in the channels you are using caused it, or if you want to record your
4385 system state for reproducibility purposes. The @command{guix describe}
4386 command answers these questions.
4387
4388 When run from a @command{guix pull}ed @command{guix}, @command{guix describe}
4389 displays the channel(s) that it was built from, including their repository URL
4390 and commit IDs (@pxref{Channels}):
4391
4392 @example
4393 $ guix describe
4394 Generation 10 Sep 03 2018 17:32:44 (current)
4395 guix e0fa68c
4396 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4397 branch: master
4398 commit: e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727
4399 @end example
4400
4401 If you're familiar with the Git version control system, this is similar in
4402 spirit to @command{git describe}; the output is also similar to that of
4403 @command{guix pull --list-generations}, but limited to the current generation
4404 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{--list-generations} option}). Because
4405 the Git commit ID shown above unambiguously refers to a snapshot of Guix, this
4406 information is all it takes to describe the revision of Guix you're using, and
4407 also to replicate it.
4408
4409 To make it easier to replicate Guix, @command{guix describe} can also be asked
4410 to return a list of channels instead of the human-readable description above:
4411
4412 @example
4413 $ guix describe -f channels
4414 (list (channel
4415 (name 'guix)
4416 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4417 (commit
4418 "e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727")))
4419 @end example
4420
4421 @noindent
4422 You can save this to a file and feed it to @command{guix pull -C} on some
4423 other machine or at a later point in time, which will instantiate @emph{this
4424 exact Guix revision} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{-C} option}).
4425 From there on, since you're able to deploy the same revision of Guix, you can
4426 just as well @emph{replicate a complete software environment}. We humbly
4427 think that this is @emph{awesome}, and we hope you'll like it too!
4428
4429 The details of the options supported by @command{guix describe} are as
4430 follows:
4431
4432 @table @code
4433 @item --format=@var{format}
4434 @itemx -f @var{format}
4435 Produce output in the specified @var{format}, one of:
4436
4437 @table @code
4438 @item human
4439 produce human-readable output;
4440 @item channels
4441 produce a list of channel specifications that can be passed to @command{guix
4442 pull -C} or installed as @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} (@pxref{Invoking
4443 guix pull});
4444 @item json
4445 @cindex JSON
4446 produce a list of channel specifications in JSON format;
4447 @item recutils
4448 produce a list of channel specifications in Recutils format.
4449 @end table
4450
4451 @item --profile=@var{profile}
4452 @itemx -p @var{profile}
4453 Display information about @var{profile}.
4454 @end table
4455
4456 @node Invoking guix archive
4457 @section Invoking @command{guix archive}
4458
4459 @cindex @command{guix archive}
4460 @cindex archive
4461 The @command{guix archive} command allows users to @dfn{export} files
4462 from the store into a single archive, and to later @dfn{import} them on
4463 a machine that runs Guix.
4464 In particular, it allows store files to be transferred from one machine
4465 to the store on another machine.
4466
4467 @quotation Note
4468 If you're looking for a way to produce archives in a format suitable for
4469 tools other than Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix pack}.
4470 @end quotation
4471
4472 @cindex exporting store items
4473 To export store files as an archive to standard output, run:
4474
4475 @example
4476 guix archive --export @var{options} @var{specifications}...
4477 @end example
4478
4479 @var{specifications} may be either store file names or package
4480 specifications, as for @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix
4481 package}). For instance, the following command creates an archive
4482 containing the @code{gui} output of the @code{git} package and the main
4483 output of @code{emacs}:
4484
4485 @example
4486 guix archive --export git:gui /gnu/store/...-emacs-24.3 > great.nar
4487 @end example
4488
4489 If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix archive}
4490 automatically builds them. The build process may be controlled with the
4491 common build options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4492
4493 To transfer the @code{emacs} package to a machine connected over SSH,
4494 one would run:
4495
4496 @example
4497 guix archive --export -r emacs | ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4498 @end example
4499
4500 @noindent
4501 Similarly, a complete user profile may be transferred from one machine
4502 to another like this:
4503
4504 @example
4505 guix archive --export -r $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile) | \
4506 ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4507 @end example
4508
4509 @noindent
4510 However, note that, in both examples, all of @code{emacs} and the
4511 profile as well as all of their dependencies are transferred (due to
4512 @code{-r}), regardless of what is already available in the store on the
4513 target machine. The @code{--missing} option can help figure out which
4514 items are missing from the target store. The @command{guix copy}
4515 command simplifies and optimizes this whole process, so this is probably
4516 what you should use in this case (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
4517
4518 @cindex nar, archive format
4519 @cindex normalized archive (nar)
4520 Archives are stored in the ``normalized archive'' or ``nar'' format, which is
4521 comparable in spirit to `tar', but with differences
4522 that make it more appropriate for our purposes. First, rather than
4523 recording all Unix metadata for each file, the nar format only mentions
4524 the file type (regular, directory, or symbolic link); Unix permissions
4525 and owner/group are dismissed. Second, the order in which directory
4526 entries are stored always follows the order of file names according to
4527 the C locale collation order. This makes archive production fully
4528 deterministic.
4529
4530 When exporting, the daemon digitally signs the contents of the archive,
4531 and that digital signature is appended. When importing, the daemon
4532 verifies the signature and rejects the import in case of an invalid
4533 signature or if the signing key is not authorized.
4534 @c FIXME: Add xref to daemon doc about signatures.
4535
4536 The main options are:
4537
4538 @table @code
4539 @item --export
4540 Export the specified store files or packages (see below.) Write the
4541 resulting archive to the standard output.
4542
4543 Dependencies are @emph{not} included in the output, unless
4544 @code{--recursive} is passed.
4545
4546 @item -r
4547 @itemx --recursive
4548 When combined with @code{--export}, this instructs @command{guix
4549 archive} to include dependencies of the given items in the archive.
4550 Thus, the resulting archive is self-contained: it contains the closure
4551 of the exported store items.
4552
4553 @item --import
4554 Read an archive from the standard input, and import the files listed
4555 therein into the store. Abort if the archive has an invalid digital
4556 signature, or if it is signed by a public key not among the authorized
4557 keys (see @code{--authorize} below.)
4558
4559 @item --missing
4560 Read a list of store file names from the standard input, one per line,
4561 and write on the standard output the subset of these files missing from
4562 the store.
4563
4564 @item --generate-key[=@var{parameters}]
4565 @cindex signing, archives
4566 Generate a new key pair for the daemon. This is a prerequisite before
4567 archives can be exported with @code{--export}. Note that this operation
4568 usually takes time, because it needs to gather enough entropy to
4569 generate the key pair.
4570
4571 The generated key pair is typically stored under @file{/etc/guix}, in
4572 @file{signing-key.pub} (public key) and @file{signing-key.sec} (private
4573 key, which must be kept secret.) When @var{parameters} is omitted,
4574 an ECDSA key using the Ed25519 curve is generated, or, for Libgcrypt
4575 versions before 1.6.0, it is a 4096-bit RSA key.
4576 Alternatively, @var{parameters} can specify
4577 @code{genkey} parameters suitable for Libgcrypt (@pxref{General
4578 public-key related Functions, @code{gcry_pk_genkey},, gcrypt, The
4579 Libgcrypt Reference Manual}).
4580
4581 @item --authorize
4582 @cindex authorizing, archives
4583 Authorize imports signed by the public key passed on standard input.
4584 The public key must be in ``s-expression advanced format''---i.e., the
4585 same format as the @file{signing-key.pub} file.
4586
4587 The list of authorized keys is kept in the human-editable file
4588 @file{/etc/guix/acl}. The file contains
4589 @url{https://people.csail.mit.edu/rivest/Sexp.txt, ``advanced-format
4590 s-expressions''} and is structured as an access-control list in the
4591 @url{https://theworld.com/~cme/spki.txt, Simple Public-Key Infrastructure
4592 (SPKI)}.
4593
4594 @item --extract=@var{directory}
4595 @itemx -x @var{directory}
4596 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
4597 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and extract it to @var{directory}. This is a
4598 low-level operation needed in only very narrow use cases; see below.
4599
4600 For example, the following command extracts the substitute for Emacs
4601 served by @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to @file{/tmp/emacs}:
4602
4603 @example
4604 $ wget -O - \
4605 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-emacs-24.5 \
4606 | bunzip2 | guix archive -x /tmp/emacs
4607 @end example
4608
4609 Single-item archives are different from multiple-item archives produced
4610 by @command{guix archive --export}; they contain a single store item,
4611 and they do @emph{not} embed a signature. Thus this operation does
4612 @emph{no} signature verification and its output should be considered
4613 unsafe.
4614
4615 The primary purpose of this operation is to facilitate inspection of
4616 archive contents coming from possibly untrusted substitute servers.
4617
4618 @item --list
4619 @itemx -t
4620 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
4621 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and print the list of files it contains, as in
4622 this example:
4623
4624 @example
4625 $ wget -O - \
4626 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/lzip/@dots{}-emacs-26.3 \
4627 | lzip -d | guix archive -t
4628 @end example
4629
4630 @end table
4631
4632
4633 @c *********************************************************************
4634 @node Development
4635 @chapter Development
4636
4637 @cindex software development
4638 If you are a software developer, Guix provides tools that you should find
4639 helpful---independently of the language you're developing in. This is what
4640 this chapter is about.
4641
4642 The @command{guix environment} command provides a convenient way to set up
4643 @dfn{development environments} containing all the dependencies and tools
4644 necessary to work on the software package of your choice. The @command{guix
4645 pack} command allows you to create @dfn{application bundles} that can be
4646 easily distributed to users who do not run Guix.
4647
4648 @menu
4649 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
4650 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
4651 @end menu
4652
4653 @node Invoking guix environment
4654 @section Invoking @command{guix environment}
4655
4656 @cindex reproducible build environments
4657 @cindex development environments
4658 @cindex @command{guix environment}
4659 @cindex environment, package build environment
4660 The purpose of @command{guix environment} is to assist hackers in
4661 creating reproducible development environments without polluting their
4662 package profile. The @command{guix environment} tool takes one or more
4663 packages, builds all of their inputs, and creates a shell
4664 environment to use them.
4665
4666 The general syntax is:
4667
4668 @example
4669 guix environment @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
4670 @end example
4671
4672 The following example spawns a new shell set up for the development of
4673 GNU@tie{}Guile:
4674
4675 @example
4676 guix environment guile
4677 @end example
4678
4679 If the needed dependencies are not built yet, @command{guix environment}
4680 automatically builds them. The environment of the new shell is an augmented
4681 version of the environment that @command{guix environment} was run in.
4682 It contains the necessary search paths for building the given package
4683 added to the existing environment variables. To create a ``pure''
4684 environment, in which the original environment variables have been unset,
4685 use the @code{--pure} option@footnote{Users sometimes wrongfully augment
4686 environment variables such as @code{PATH} in their @file{~/.bashrc}
4687 file. As a consequence, when @code{guix environment} launches it, Bash
4688 may read @file{~/.bashrc}, thereby introducing ``impurities'' in these
4689 environment variables. It is an error to define such environment
4690 variables in @file{.bashrc}; instead, they should be defined in
4691 @file{.bash_profile}, which is sourced only by log-in shells.
4692 @xref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}, for
4693 details on Bash start-up files.}.
4694
4695 @vindex GUIX_ENVIRONMENT
4696 @command{guix environment} defines the @code{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT}
4697 variable in the shell it spawns; its value is the file name of the
4698 profile of this environment. This allows users to, say, define a
4699 specific prompt for development environments in their @file{.bashrc}
4700 (@pxref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}):
4701
4702 @example
4703 if [ -n "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT" ]
4704 then
4705 export PS1="\u@@\h \w [dev]\$ "
4706 fi
4707 @end example
4708
4709 @noindent
4710 ...@: or to browse the profile:
4711
4712 @example
4713 $ ls "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin"
4714 @end example
4715
4716 Additionally, more than one package may be specified, in which case the
4717 union of the inputs for the given packages are used. For example, the
4718 command below spawns a shell where all of the dependencies of both Guile
4719 and Emacs are available:
4720
4721 @example
4722 guix environment guile emacs
4723 @end example
4724
4725 Sometimes an interactive shell session is not desired. An arbitrary
4726 command may be invoked by placing the @code{--} token to separate the
4727 command from the rest of the arguments:
4728
4729 @example
4730 guix environment guile -- make -j4
4731 @end example
4732
4733 In other situations, it is more convenient to specify the list of
4734 packages needed in the environment. For example, the following command
4735 runs @command{python} from an environment containing Python@tie{}2.7 and
4736 NumPy:
4737
4738 @example
4739 guix environment --ad-hoc python2-numpy python-2.7 -- python
4740 @end example
4741
4742 Furthermore, one might want the dependencies of a package and also some
4743 additional packages that are not build-time or runtime dependencies, but
4744 are useful when developing nonetheless. Because of this, the
4745 @code{--ad-hoc} flag is positional. Packages appearing before
4746 @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be
4747 added to the environment. Packages appearing after are interpreted as
4748 packages that will be added to the environment directly. For example,
4749 the following command creates a Guix development environment that
4750 additionally includes Git and strace:
4751
4752 @example
4753 guix environment guix --ad-hoc git strace
4754 @end example
4755
4756 Sometimes it is desirable to isolate the environment as much as
4757 possible, for maximal purity and reproducibility. In particular, when
4758 using Guix on a host distro that is not Guix System, it is desirable to
4759 prevent access to @file{/usr/bin} and other system-wide resources from
4760 the development environment. For example, the following command spawns
4761 a Guile REPL in a ``container'' where only the store and the current
4762 working directory are mounted:
4763
4764 @example
4765 guix environment --ad-hoc --container guile -- guile
4766 @end example
4767
4768 @quotation Note
4769 The @code{--container} option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
4770 @end quotation
4771
4772 The available options are summarized below.
4773
4774 @table @code
4775 @item --root=@var{file}
4776 @itemx -r @var{file}
4777 @cindex persistent environment
4778 @cindex garbage collector root, for environments
4779 Make @var{file} a symlink to the profile for this environment, and
4780 register it as a garbage collector root.
4781
4782 This is useful if you want to protect your environment from garbage
4783 collection, to make it ``persistent''.
4784
4785 When this option is omitted, the environment is protected from garbage
4786 collection only for the duration of the @command{guix environment}
4787 session. This means that next time you recreate the same environment,
4788 you could have to rebuild or re-download packages. @xref{Invoking guix
4789 gc}, for more on GC roots.
4790
4791 @item --expression=@var{expr}
4792 @itemx -e @var{expr}
4793 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that
4794 @var{expr} evaluates to.
4795
4796 For example, running:
4797
4798 @example
4799 guix environment -e '(@@ (gnu packages maths) petsc-openmpi)'
4800 @end example
4801
4802 starts a shell with the environment for this specific variant of the
4803 PETSc package.
4804
4805 Running:
4806
4807 @example
4808 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(@@ (gnu) %base-packages)'
4809 @end example
4810
4811 starts a shell with all the base system packages available.
4812
4813 The above commands only use the default output of the given packages.
4814 To select other outputs, two element tuples can be specified:
4815
4816 @example
4817 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(list (@@ (gnu packages bash) bash) "include")'
4818 @end example
4819
4820 @item --load=@var{file}
4821 @itemx -l @var{file}
4822 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that the code
4823 within @var{file} evaluates to.
4824
4825 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
4826 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
4827
4828 @lisp
4829 @verbatiminclude environment-gdb.scm
4830 @end lisp
4831
4832 @item --manifest=@var{file}
4833 @itemx -m @var{file}
4834 Create an environment for the packages contained in the manifest object
4835 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated
4836 several times, in which case the manifests are concatenated.
4837
4838 This is similar to the same-named option in @command{guix package}
4839 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the same
4840 manifest files.
4841
4842 @item --ad-hoc
4843 Include all specified packages in the resulting environment, as if an
4844 @i{ad hoc} package were defined with them as inputs. This option is
4845 useful for quickly creating an environment without having to write a
4846 package expression to contain the desired inputs.
4847
4848 For instance, the command:
4849
4850 @example
4851 guix environment --ad-hoc guile guile-sdl -- guile
4852 @end example
4853
4854 runs @command{guile} in an environment where Guile and Guile-SDL are
4855 available.
4856
4857 Note that this example implicitly asks for the default output of
4858 @code{guile} and @code{guile-sdl}, but it is possible to ask for a
4859 specific output---e.g., @code{glib:bin} asks for the @code{bin} output
4860 of @code{glib} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
4861
4862 This option may be composed with the default behavior of @command{guix
4863 environment}. Packages appearing before @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted
4864 as packages whose dependencies will be added to the environment, the
4865 default behavior. Packages appearing after are interpreted as packages
4866 that will be added to the environment directly.
4867
4868 @item --pure
4869 Unset existing environment variables when building the new environment, except
4870 those specified with @option{--preserve} (see below.) This has the effect of
4871 creating an environment in which search paths only contain package inputs.
4872
4873 @item --preserve=@var{regexp}
4874 @itemx -E @var{regexp}
4875 When used alongside @option{--pure}, preserve the environment variables
4876 matching @var{regexp}---in other words, put them on a ``white list'' of
4877 environment variables that must be preserved. This option can be repeated
4878 several times.
4879
4880 @example
4881 guix environment --pure --preserve=^SLURM --ad-hoc openmpi @dots{} \
4882 -- mpirun @dots{}
4883 @end example
4884
4885 This example runs @command{mpirun} in a context where the only environment
4886 variables defined are @code{PATH}, environment variables whose name starts
4887 with @code{SLURM}, as well as the usual ``precious'' variables (@code{HOME},
4888 @code{USER}, etc.)
4889
4890 @item --search-paths
4891 Display the environment variable definitions that make up the
4892 environment.
4893
4894 @item --system=@var{system}
4895 @itemx -s @var{system}
4896 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
4897
4898 @item --container
4899 @itemx -C
4900 @cindex container
4901 Run @var{command} within an isolated container. The current working
4902 directory outside the container is mapped inside the container.
4903 Additionally, unless overridden with @code{--user}, a dummy home
4904 directory is created that matches the current user's home directory, and
4905 @file{/etc/passwd} is configured accordingly.
4906
4907 The spawned process runs as the current user outside the container. Inside
4908 the container, it has the same UID and GID as the current user, unless
4909 @option{--user} is passed (see below.)
4910
4911 @item --network
4912 @itemx -N
4913 For containers, share the network namespace with the host system.
4914 Containers created without this flag only have access to the loopback
4915 device.
4916
4917 @item --link-profile
4918 @itemx -P
4919 For containers, link the environment profile to
4920 @file{~/.guix-profile} within the container. This is equivalent to
4921 running the command @command{ln -s $GUIX_ENVIRONMENT ~/.guix-profile}
4922 within the container. Linking will fail and abort the environment if
4923 the directory already exists, which will certainly be the case if
4924 @command{guix environment} was invoked in the user's home directory.
4925
4926 Certain packages are configured to look in
4927 @code{~/.guix-profile} for configuration files and data;@footnote{For
4928 example, the @code{fontconfig} package inspects
4929 @file{~/.guix-profile/share/fonts} for additional fonts.}
4930 @code{--link-profile} allows these programs to behave as expected within
4931 the environment.
4932
4933 @item --user=@var{user}
4934 @itemx -u @var{user}
4935 For containers, use the username @var{user} in place of the current
4936 user. The generated @file{/etc/passwd} entry within the container will
4937 contain the name @var{user}, the home directory will be
4938 @file{/home/@var{user}}, and no user GECOS data will be copied. Furthermore,
4939 the UID and GID inside the container are 1000. @var{user}
4940 need not exist on the system.
4941
4942 Additionally, any shared or exposed path (see @code{--share} and
4943 @code{--expose} respectively) whose target is within the current user's
4944 home directory will be remapped relative to @file{/home/USER}; this
4945 includes the automatic mapping of the current working directory.
4946
4947 @example
4948 # will expose paths as /home/foo/wd, /home/foo/test, and /home/foo/target
4949 cd $HOME/wd
4950 guix environment --container --user=foo \
4951 --expose=$HOME/test \
4952 --expose=/tmp/target=$HOME/target
4953 @end example
4954
4955 While this will limit the leaking of user identity through home paths
4956 and each of the user fields, this is only one useful component of a
4957 broader privacy/anonymity solution---not one in and of itself.
4958
4959 @item --no-cwd
4960 For containers, the default behavior is to share the current working
4961 directory with the isolated container and immediately change to that
4962 directory within the container. If this is undesirable, @code{--no-cwd}
4963 will cause the current working directory to @emph{not} be automatically
4964 shared and will change to the user's home directory within the container
4965 instead. See also @code{--user}.
4966
4967 @item --expose=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
4968 @itemx --share=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
4969 For containers, @code{--expose} (resp. @code{--share}) exposes the file
4970 system @var{source} from the host system as the read-only
4971 (resp. writable) file system @var{target} within the container. If
4972 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
4973 point in the container.
4974
4975 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
4976 home directory is accessible read-only via the @file{/exchange}
4977 directory:
4978
4979 @example
4980 guix environment --container --expose=$HOME=/exchange --ad-hoc guile -- guile
4981 @end example
4982
4983 @end table
4984
4985 @command{guix environment}
4986 also supports all of the common build options that @command{guix
4987 build} supports (@pxref{Common Build Options}) as well as package
4988 transformation options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
4989
4990 @node Invoking guix pack
4991 @section Invoking @command{guix pack}
4992
4993 Occasionally you want to pass software to people who are not (yet!)
4994 lucky enough to be using Guix. You'd tell them to run @command{guix
4995 package -i @var{something}}, but that's not possible in this case. This
4996 is where @command{guix pack} comes in.
4997
4998 @quotation Note
4999 If you are looking for ways to exchange binaries among machines that
5000 already run Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix copy}, @ref{Invoking guix
5001 publish}, and @ref{Invoking guix archive}.
5002 @end quotation
5003
5004 @cindex pack
5005 @cindex bundle
5006 @cindex application bundle
5007 @cindex software bundle
5008 The @command{guix pack} command creates a shrink-wrapped @dfn{pack} or
5009 @dfn{software bundle}: it creates a tarball or some other archive
5010 containing the binaries of the software you're interested in, and all
5011 its dependencies. The resulting archive can be used on any machine that
5012 does not have Guix, and people can run the exact same binaries as those
5013 you have with Guix. The pack itself is created in a bit-reproducible
5014 fashion, so anyone can verify that it really contains the build results
5015 that you pretend to be shipping.
5016
5017 For example, to create a bundle containing Guile, Emacs, Geiser, and all
5018 their dependencies, you can run:
5019
5020 @example
5021 $ guix pack guile emacs geiser
5022 @dots{}
5023 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pack.tar.gz
5024 @end example
5025
5026 The result here is a tarball containing a @file{/gnu/store} directory
5027 with all the relevant packages. The resulting tarball contains a
5028 @dfn{profile} with the three packages of interest; the profile is the
5029 same as would be created by @command{guix package -i}. It is this
5030 mechanism that is used to create Guix's own standalone binary tarball
5031 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
5032
5033 Users of this pack would have to run
5034 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/bin/guile} to run Guile, which you may
5035 find inconvenient. To work around it, you can create, say, a
5036 @file{/opt/gnu/bin} symlink to the profile:
5037
5038 @example
5039 guix pack -S /opt/gnu/bin=bin guile emacs geiser
5040 @end example
5041
5042 @noindent
5043 That way, users can happily type @file{/opt/gnu/bin/guile} and enjoy.
5044
5045 @cindex relocatable binaries, with @command{guix pack}
5046 What if the recipient of your pack does not have root privileges on
5047 their machine, and thus cannot unpack it in the root file system? In
5048 that case, you will want to use the @code{--relocatable} option (see
5049 below). This option produces @dfn{relocatable binaries}, meaning they
5050 they can be placed anywhere in the file system hierarchy: in the example
5051 above, users can unpack your tarball in their home directory and
5052 directly run @file{./opt/gnu/bin/guile}.
5053
5054 @cindex Docker, build an image with guix pack
5055 Alternatively, you can produce a pack in the Docker image format using
5056 the following command:
5057
5058 @example
5059 guix pack -f docker -S /bin=bin guile guile-readline
5060 @end example
5061
5062 @noindent
5063 The result is a tarball that can be passed to the @command{docker load}
5064 command, followed by @code{docker run}:
5065
5066 @example
5067 docker load < @var{file}
5068 docker run -ti guile-guile-readline /bin/guile
5069 @end example
5070
5071 @noindent
5072 where @var{file} is the image returned by @var{guix pack}, and
5073 @code{guile-guile-readline} is its ``image tag''. See the
5074 @uref{https://docs.docker.com/engine/reference/commandline/load/, Docker
5075 documentation} for more information.
5076
5077 @cindex Singularity, build an image with guix pack
5078 @cindex SquashFS, build an image with guix pack
5079 Yet another option is to produce a SquashFS image with the following
5080 command:
5081
5082 @example
5083 guix pack -f squashfs bash guile emacs geiser
5084 @end example
5085
5086 @noindent
5087 The result is a SquashFS file system image that can either be mounted or
5088 directly be used as a file system container image with the
5089 @uref{https://singularity.lbl.gov, Singularity container execution
5090 environment}, using commands like @command{singularity shell} or
5091 @command{singularity exec}.
5092
5093 Several command-line options allow you to customize your pack:
5094
5095 @table @code
5096 @item --format=@var{format}
5097 @itemx -f @var{format}
5098 Produce a pack in the given @var{format}.
5099
5100 The available formats are:
5101
5102 @table @code
5103 @item tarball
5104 This is the default format. It produces a tarball containing all the
5105 specified binaries and symlinks.
5106
5107 @item docker
5108 This produces a tarball that follows the
5109 @uref{https://github.com/docker/docker/blob/master/image/spec/v1.2.md,
5110 Docker Image Specification}. The ``repository name'' as it appears in
5111 the output of the @command{docker images} command is computed from
5112 package names passed on the command line or in the manifest file.
5113
5114 @item squashfs
5115 This produces a SquashFS image containing all the specified binaries and
5116 symlinks, as well as empty mount points for virtual file systems like
5117 procfs.
5118
5119 @quotation Note
5120 Singularity @emph{requires} you to provide @file{/bin/sh} in the image.
5121 For that reason, @command{guix pack -f squashfs} always implies @code{-S
5122 /bin=bin}. Thus, your @command{guix pack} invocation must always start
5123 with something like:
5124
5125 @example
5126 guix pack -f squashfs bash @dots{}
5127 @end example
5128
5129 If you forget the @code{bash} (or similar) package, @command{singularity
5130 run} and @command{singularity exec} will fail with an unhelpful ``no
5131 such file or directory'' message.
5132 @end quotation
5133 @end table
5134
5135 @cindex relocatable binaries
5136 @item --relocatable
5137 @itemx -R
5138 Produce @dfn{relocatable binaries}---i.e., binaries that can be placed
5139 anywhere in the file system hierarchy and run from there.
5140
5141 When this option is passed once, the resulting binaries require support for
5142 @dfn{user namespaces} in the kernel Linux; when passed
5143 @emph{twice}@footnote{Here's a trick to memorize it: @code{-RR}, which adds
5144 PRoot support, can be thought of as the abbreviation of ``Really
5145 Relocatable''. Neat, isn't it?}, relocatable binaries fall to back to PRoot
5146 if user namespaces are unavailable, and essentially work anywhere---see below
5147 for the implications.
5148
5149 For example, if you create a pack containing Bash with:
5150
5151 @example
5152 guix pack -RR -S /mybin=bin bash
5153 @end example
5154
5155 @noindent
5156 ...@: you can copy that pack to a machine that lacks Guix, and from your
5157 home directory as a normal user, run:
5158
5159 @example
5160 tar xf pack.tar.gz
5161 ./mybin/sh
5162 @end example
5163
5164 @noindent
5165 In that shell, if you type @code{ls /gnu/store}, you'll notice that
5166 @file{/gnu/store} shows up and contains all the dependencies of
5167 @code{bash}, even though the machine actually lacks @file{/gnu/store}
5168 altogether! That is probably the simplest way to deploy Guix-built
5169 software on a non-Guix machine.
5170
5171 @quotation Note
5172 By default, relocatable binaries rely on the @dfn{user namespace} feature of
5173 the kernel Linux, which allows unprivileged users to mount or change root.
5174 Old versions of Linux did not support it, and some GNU/Linux distributions
5175 turn it off.
5176
5177 To produce relocatable binaries that work even in the absence of user
5178 namespaces, pass @option{--relocatable} or @option{-R} @emph{twice}. In that
5179 case, binaries will try user namespace support and fall back to PRoot if user
5180 namespaces are not supported.
5181
5182 The @uref{https://proot-me.github.io/, PRoot} program provides the necessary
5183 support for file system virtualization. It achieves that by using the
5184 @code{ptrace} system call on the running program. This approach has the
5185 advantage to work without requiring special kernel support, but it incurs
5186 run-time overhead every time a system call is made.
5187 @end quotation
5188
5189 @cindex entry point, for Docker images
5190 @item --entry-point=@var{command}
5191 Use @var{command} as the @dfn{entry point} of the resulting pack, if the pack
5192 format supports it---currently @code{docker} and @code{squashfs} (Singularity)
5193 support it. @var{command} must be relative to the profile contained in the
5194 pack.
5195
5196 The entry point specifies the command that tools like @code{docker run} or
5197 @code{singularity run} automatically start by default. For example, you can
5198 do:
5199
5200 @example
5201 guix pack -f docker --entry-point=bin/guile guile
5202 @end example
5203
5204 The resulting pack can easily be loaded and @code{docker run} with no extra
5205 arguments will spawn @code{bin/guile}:
5206
5207 @example
5208 docker load -i pack.tar.gz
5209 docker run @var{image-id}
5210 @end example
5211
5212 @item --expression=@var{expr}
5213 @itemx -e @var{expr}
5214 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
5215
5216 This has the same purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
5217 build} (@pxref{Additional Build Options, @code{--expression} in
5218 @command{guix build}}).
5219
5220 @item --manifest=@var{file}
5221 @itemx -m @var{file}
5222 Use the packages contained in the manifest object returned by the Scheme
5223 code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated several times, in which
5224 case the manifests are concatenated.
5225
5226 This has a similar purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
5227 package} (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the
5228 same manifest files. It allows you to define a collection of packages
5229 once and use it both for creating profiles and for creating archives
5230 for use on machines that do not have Guix installed. Note that you can
5231 specify @emph{either} a manifest file @emph{or} a list of packages,
5232 but not both.
5233
5234 @item --system=@var{system}
5235 @itemx -s @var{system}
5236 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
5237 the system type of the build host.
5238
5239 @item --target=@var{triplet}
5240 @cindex cross-compilation
5241 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
5242 as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying target triplets, GNU
5243 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
5244
5245 @item --compression=@var{tool}
5246 @itemx -C @var{tool}
5247 Compress the resulting tarball using @var{tool}---one of @code{gzip},
5248 @code{bzip2}, @code{xz}, @code{lzip}, or @code{none} for no compression.
5249
5250 @item --symlink=@var{spec}
5251 @itemx -S @var{spec}
5252 Add the symlinks specified by @var{spec} to the pack. This option can
5253 appear several times.
5254
5255 @var{spec} has the form @code{@var{source}=@var{target}}, where
5256 @var{source} is the symlink that will be created and @var{target} is the
5257 symlink target.
5258
5259 For instance, @code{-S /opt/gnu/bin=bin} creates a @file{/opt/gnu/bin}
5260 symlink pointing to the @file{bin} sub-directory of the profile.
5261
5262 @item --save-provenance
5263 Save provenance information for the packages passed on the command line.
5264 Provenance information includes the URL and commit of the channels in use
5265 (@pxref{Channels}).
5266
5267 Provenance information is saved in the
5268 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/manifest} file in the pack, along with the
5269 usual package metadata---the name and version of each package, their
5270 propagated inputs, and so on. It is useful information to the recipient of
5271 the pack, who then knows how the pack was (supposedly) obtained.
5272
5273 This option is not enabled by default because, like timestamps, provenance
5274 information contributes nothing to the build process. In other words, there
5275 is an infinity of channel URLs and commit IDs that can lead to the same pack.
5276 Recording such ``silent'' metadata in the output thus potentially breaks the
5277 source-to-binary bitwise reproducibility property.
5278
5279 @item --root=@var{file}
5280 @itemx -r @var{file}
5281 @cindex garbage collector root, for packs
5282 Make @var{file} a symlink to the resulting pack, and register it as a garbage
5283 collector root.
5284
5285 @item --localstatedir
5286 @itemx --profile-name=@var{name}
5287 Include the ``local state directory'', @file{/var/guix}, in the resulting
5288 pack, and notably the @file{/var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/@var{name}}
5289 profile---by default @var{name} is @code{guix-profile}, which corresponds to
5290 @file{~root/.guix-profile}.
5291
5292 @file{/var/guix} contains the store database (@pxref{The Store}) as well
5293 as garbage-collector roots (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Providing it in
5294 the pack means that the store is ``complete'' and manageable by Guix;
5295 not providing it pack means that the store is ``dead'': items cannot be
5296 added to it or removed from it after extraction of the pack.
5297
5298 One use case for this is the Guix self-contained binary tarball
5299 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
5300
5301 @item --derivation
5302 @itemx -d
5303 Print the name of the derivation that builds the pack.
5304
5305 @item --bootstrap
5306 Use the bootstrap binaries to build the pack. This option is only
5307 useful to Guix developers.
5308 @end table
5309
5310 In addition, @command{guix pack} supports all the common build options
5311 (@pxref{Common Build Options}) and all the package transformation
5312 options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
5313
5314
5315 @c *********************************************************************
5316 @node Programming Interface
5317 @chapter Programming Interface
5318
5319 GNU Guix provides several Scheme programming interfaces (APIs) to
5320 define, build, and query packages. The first interface allows users to
5321 write high-level package definitions. These definitions refer to
5322 familiar packaging concepts, such as the name and version of a package,
5323 its build system, and its dependencies. These definitions can then be
5324 turned into concrete build actions.
5325
5326 Build actions are performed by the Guix daemon, on behalf of users. In a
5327 standard setup, the daemon has write access to the store---the
5328 @file{/gnu/store} directory---whereas users do not. The recommended
5329 setup also has the daemon perform builds in chroots, under a specific
5330 build users, to minimize interference with the rest of the system.
5331
5332 @cindex derivation
5333 Lower-level APIs are available to interact with the daemon and the
5334 store. To instruct the daemon to perform a build action, users actually
5335 provide it with a @dfn{derivation}. A derivation is a low-level
5336 representation of the build actions to be taken, and the environment in
5337 which they should occur---derivations are to package definitions what
5338 assembly is to C programs. The term ``derivation'' comes from the fact
5339 that build results @emph{derive} from them.
5340
5341 This chapter describes all these APIs in turn, starting from high-level
5342 package definitions.
5343
5344 @menu
5345 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
5346 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
5347 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
5348 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
5349 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
5350 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
5351 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
5352 * Invoking guix repl:: Fiddling with Guix interactively.
5353 @end menu
5354
5355 @node Package Modules
5356 @section Package Modules
5357
5358 From a programming viewpoint, the package definitions of the
5359 GNU distribution are provided by Guile modules in the @code{(gnu packages
5360 @dots{})} name space@footnote{Note that packages under the @code{(gnu
5361 packages @dots{})} module name space are not necessarily ``GNU
5362 packages''. This module naming scheme follows the usual Guile module
5363 naming convention: @code{gnu} means that these modules are distributed
5364 as part of the GNU system, and @code{packages} identifies modules that
5365 define packages.} (@pxref{Modules, Guile modules,, guile, GNU Guile
5366 Reference Manual}). For instance, the @code{(gnu packages emacs)}
5367 module exports a variable named @code{emacs}, which is bound to a
5368 @code{<package>} object (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
5369
5370 The @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} module name space is
5371 automatically scanned for packages by the command-line tools. For
5372 instance, when running @code{guix install emacs}, all the @code{(gnu
5373 packages @dots{})} modules are scanned until one that exports a package
5374 object whose name is @code{emacs} is found. This package search
5375 facility is implemented in the @code{(gnu packages)} module.
5376
5377 @cindex customization, of packages
5378 @cindex package module search path
5379 Users can store package definitions in modules with different
5380 names---e.g., @code{(my-packages emacs)}@footnote{Note that the file
5381 name and module name must match. For instance, the @code{(my-packages
5382 emacs)} module must be stored in a @file{my-packages/emacs.scm} file
5383 relative to the load path specified with @option{--load-path} or
5384 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}. @xref{Modules and the File System,,,
5385 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for details.}. There are two ways to make
5386 these package definitions visible to the user interfaces:
5387
5388 @enumerate
5389 @item
5390 By adding the directory containing your package modules to the search path
5391 with the @code{-L} flag of @command{guix package} and other commands
5392 (@pxref{Common Build Options}), or by setting the @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
5393 environment variable described below.
5394
5395 @item
5396 By defining a @dfn{channel} and configuring @command{guix pull} so that it
5397 pulls from it. A channel is essentially a Git repository containing package
5398 modules. @xref{Channels}, for more information on how to define and use
5399 channels.
5400 @end enumerate
5401
5402 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH} works similarly to other search path variables:
5403
5404 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
5405 This is a colon-separated list of directories to search for additional
5406 package modules. Directories listed in this variable take precedence
5407 over the own modules of the distribution.
5408 @end defvr
5409
5410 The distribution is fully @dfn{bootstrapped} and @dfn{self-contained}:
5411 each package is built based solely on other packages in the
5412 distribution. The root of this dependency graph is a small set of
5413 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}, provided by the @code{(gnu packages
5414 bootstrap)} module. For more information on bootstrapping,
5415 @pxref{Bootstrapping}.
5416
5417 @node Defining Packages
5418 @section Defining Packages
5419
5420 The high-level interface to package definitions is implemented in the
5421 @code{(guix packages)} and @code{(guix build-system)} modules. As an
5422 example, the package definition, or @dfn{recipe}, for the GNU Hello
5423 package looks like this:
5424
5425 @lisp
5426 (define-module (gnu packages hello)
5427 #:use-module (guix packages)
5428 #:use-module (guix download)
5429 #:use-module (guix build-system gnu)
5430 #:use-module (guix licenses)
5431 #:use-module (gnu packages gawk))
5432
5433 (define-public hello
5434 (package
5435 (name "hello")
5436 (version "2.10")
5437 (source (origin
5438 (method url-fetch)
5439 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
5440 ".tar.gz"))
5441 (sha256
5442 (base32
5443 "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"))))
5444 (build-system gnu-build-system)
5445 (arguments '(#:configure-flags '("--enable-silent-rules")))
5446 (inputs `(("gawk" ,gawk)))
5447 (synopsis "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package")
5448 (description "Guess what GNU Hello prints!")
5449 (home-page "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/")
5450 (license gpl3+)))
5451 @end lisp
5452
5453 @noindent
5454 Without being a Scheme expert, the reader may have guessed the meaning
5455 of the various fields here. This expression binds the variable
5456 @code{hello} to a @code{<package>} object, which is essentially a record
5457 (@pxref{SRFI-9, Scheme records,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
5458 This package object can be inspected using procedures found in the
5459 @code{(guix packages)} module; for instance, @code{(package-name hello)}
5460 returns---surprise!---@code{"hello"}.
5461
5462 With luck, you may be able to import part or all of the definition of
5463 the package you are interested in from another repository, using the
5464 @code{guix import} command (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
5465
5466 In the example above, @var{hello} is defined in a module of its own,
5467 @code{(gnu packages hello)}. Technically, this is not strictly
5468 necessary, but it is convenient to do so: all the packages defined in
5469 modules under @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} are automatically known to
5470 the command-line tools (@pxref{Package Modules}).
5471
5472 There are a few points worth noting in the above package definition:
5473
5474 @itemize
5475 @item
5476 The @code{source} field of the package is an @code{<origin>} object
5477 (@pxref{origin Reference}, for the complete reference).
5478 Here, the @code{url-fetch} method from @code{(guix download)} is used,
5479 meaning that the source is a file to be downloaded over FTP or HTTP.
5480
5481 The @code{mirror://gnu} prefix instructs @code{url-fetch} to use one of
5482 the GNU mirrors defined in @code{(guix download)}.
5483
5484 The @code{sha256} field specifies the expected SHA256 hash of the file
5485 being downloaded. It is mandatory, and allows Guix to check the
5486 integrity of the file. The @code{(base32 @dots{})} form introduces the
5487 base32 representation of the hash. You can obtain this information with
5488 @code{guix download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) and @code{guix
5489 hash} (@pxref{Invoking guix hash}).
5490
5491 @cindex patches
5492 When needed, the @code{origin} form can also have a @code{patches} field
5493 listing patches to be applied, and a @code{snippet} field giving a
5494 Scheme expression to modify the source code.
5495
5496 @item
5497 @cindex GNU Build System
5498 The @code{build-system} field specifies the procedure to build the
5499 package (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here, @var{gnu-build-system}
5500 represents the familiar GNU Build System, where packages may be
5501 configured, built, and installed with the usual @code{./configure &&
5502 make && make check && make install} command sequence.
5503
5504 @item
5505 The @code{arguments} field specifies options for the build system
5506 (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here it is interpreted by
5507 @var{gnu-build-system} as a request run @file{configure} with the
5508 @code{--enable-silent-rules} flag.
5509
5510 @cindex quote
5511 @cindex quoting
5512 @findex '
5513 @findex quote
5514 What about these quote (@code{'}) characters? They are Scheme syntax to
5515 introduce a literal list; @code{'} is synonymous with @code{quote}.
5516 @xref{Expression Syntax, quoting,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual},
5517 for details. Here the value of the @code{arguments} field is a list of
5518 arguments passed to the build system down the road, as with @code{apply}
5519 (@pxref{Fly Evaluation, @code{apply},, guile, GNU Guile Reference
5520 Manual}).
5521
5522 The hash-colon (@code{#:}) sequence defines a Scheme @dfn{keyword}
5523 (@pxref{Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}), and
5524 @code{#:configure-flags} is a keyword used to pass a keyword argument
5525 to the build system (@pxref{Coding With Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile
5526 Reference Manual}).
5527
5528 @item
5529 The @code{inputs} field specifies inputs to the build process---i.e.,
5530 build-time or run-time dependencies of the package. Here, we define an
5531 input called @code{"gawk"} whose value is that of the @var{gawk}
5532 variable; @var{gawk} is itself bound to a @code{<package>} object.
5533
5534 @cindex backquote (quasiquote)
5535 @findex `
5536 @findex quasiquote
5537 @cindex comma (unquote)
5538 @findex ,
5539 @findex unquote
5540 @findex ,@@
5541 @findex unquote-splicing
5542 Again, @code{`} (a backquote, synonymous with @code{quasiquote}) allows
5543 us to introduce a literal list in the @code{inputs} field, while
5544 @code{,} (a comma, synonymous with @code{unquote}) allows us to insert a
5545 value in that list (@pxref{Expression Syntax, unquote,, guile, GNU Guile
5546 Reference Manual}).
5547
5548 Note that GCC, Coreutils, Bash, and other essential tools do not need to
5549 be specified as inputs here. Instead, @var{gnu-build-system} takes care
5550 of ensuring that they are present (@pxref{Build Systems}).
5551
5552 However, any other dependencies need to be specified in the
5553 @code{inputs} field. Any dependency not specified here will simply be
5554 unavailable to the build process, possibly leading to a build failure.
5555 @end itemize
5556
5557 @xref{package Reference}, for a full description of possible fields.
5558
5559 Once a package definition is in place, the
5560 package may actually be built using the @code{guix build} command-line
5561 tool (@pxref{Invoking guix build}), troubleshooting any build failures
5562 you encounter (@pxref{Debugging Build Failures}). You can easily jump back to the
5563 package definition using the @command{guix edit} command
5564 (@pxref{Invoking guix edit}).
5565 @xref{Packaging Guidelines}, for
5566 more information on how to test package definitions, and
5567 @ref{Invoking guix lint}, for information on how to check a definition
5568 for style conformance.
5569 @vindex GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
5570 Lastly, @pxref{Channels}, for information
5571 on how to extend the distribution by adding your own package definitions
5572 in a ``channel''.
5573
5574 Finally, updating the package definition to a new upstream version
5575 can be partly automated by the @command{guix refresh} command
5576 (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
5577
5578 Behind the scenes, a derivation corresponding to the @code{<package>}
5579 object is first computed by the @code{package-derivation} procedure.
5580 That derivation is stored in a @code{.drv} file under @file{/gnu/store}.
5581 The build actions it prescribes may then be realized by using the
5582 @code{build-derivations} procedure (@pxref{The Store}).
5583
5584 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-derivation @var{store} @var{package} [@var{system}]
5585 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} for @var{system}
5586 (@pxref{Derivations}).
5587
5588 @var{package} must be a valid @code{<package>} object, and @var{system}
5589 must be a string denoting the target system type---e.g.,
5590 @code{"x86_64-linux"} for an x86_64 Linux-based GNU system. @var{store}
5591 must be a connection to the daemon, which operates on the store
5592 (@pxref{The Store}).
5593 @end deffn
5594
5595 @noindent
5596 @cindex cross-compilation
5597 Similarly, it is possible to compute a derivation that cross-builds a
5598 package for some other system:
5599
5600 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-cross-derivation @var{store} @
5601 @var{package} @var{target} [@var{system}]
5602 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} cross-built from
5603 @var{system} to @var{target}.
5604
5605 @var{target} must be a valid GNU triplet denoting the target hardware
5606 and operating system, such as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"}
5607 (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets,,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
5608 @end deffn
5609
5610 @cindex package transformations
5611 @cindex input rewriting
5612 @cindex dependency tree rewriting
5613 Packages can be manipulated in arbitrary ways. An example of a useful
5614 transformation is @dfn{input rewriting}, whereby the dependency tree of
5615 a package is rewritten by replacing specific inputs by others:
5616
5617 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting @var{replacements} @
5618 [@var{rewrite-name}]
5619 Return a procedure that, when passed a package, replaces its direct and
5620 indirect dependencies (but not its implicit inputs) according to
5621 @var{replacements}. @var{replacements} is a list of package pairs; the
5622 first element of each pair is the package to replace, and the second one
5623 is the replacement.
5624
5625 Optionally, @var{rewrite-name} is a one-argument procedure that takes
5626 the name of a package and returns its new name after rewrite.
5627 @end deffn
5628
5629 @noindent
5630 Consider this example:
5631
5632 @lisp
5633 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
5634 ;; This is a procedure to replace OPENSSL by LIBRESSL,
5635 ;; recursively.
5636 (package-input-rewriting `((,openssl . ,libressl))))
5637
5638 (define git-with-libressl
5639 (libressl-instead-of-openssl git))
5640 @end lisp
5641
5642 @noindent
5643 Here we first define a rewriting procedure that replaces @var{openssl}
5644 with @var{libressl}. Then we use it to define a @dfn{variant} of the
5645 @var{git} package that uses @var{libressl} instead of @var{openssl}.
5646 This is exactly what the @option{--with-input} command-line option does
5647 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options, @option{--with-input}}).
5648
5649 The following variant of @code{package-input-rewriting} can match packages to
5650 be replaced by name rather than by identity.
5651
5652 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting/spec @var{replacements}
5653 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies the given @var{replacements} to
5654 all the package graph (excluding implicit inputs). @var{replacements} is a list of
5655 spec/procedures pair; each spec is a package specification such as @code{"gcc"} or
5656 @code{"guile@@2"}, and each procedure takes a matching package and returns a
5657 replacement for that package.
5658 @end deffn
5659
5660 The example above could be rewritten this way:
5661
5662 @lisp
5663 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
5664 ;; Replace all the packages called "openssl" with LibreSSL.
5665 (package-input-rewriting/spec `(("openssl" . ,(const libressl)))))
5666 @end lisp
5667
5668 The key difference here is that, this time, packages are matched by spec and
5669 not by identity. In other words, any package in the graph that is called
5670 @code{openssl} will be replaced.
5671
5672 A more generic procedure to rewrite a package dependency graph is
5673 @code{package-mapping}: it supports arbitrary changes to nodes in the
5674 graph.
5675
5676 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-mapping @var{proc} [@var{cut?}]
5677 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies @var{proc} to all the packages
5678 depended on and returns the resulting package. The procedure stops recursion
5679 when @var{cut?} returns true for a given package.
5680 @end deffn
5681
5682 @menu
5683 * package Reference:: The package data type.
5684 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
5685 @end menu
5686
5687
5688 @node package Reference
5689 @subsection @code{package} Reference
5690
5691 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{package}
5692 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
5693
5694 @deftp {Data Type} package
5695 This is the data type representing a package recipe.
5696
5697 @table @asis
5698 @item @code{name}
5699 The name of the package, as a string.
5700
5701 @item @code{version}
5702 The version of the package, as a string.
5703
5704 @item @code{source}
5705 An object telling how the source code for the package should be
5706 acquired. Most of the time, this is an @code{origin} object, which
5707 denotes a file fetched from the Internet (@pxref{origin Reference}). It
5708 can also be any other ``file-like'' object such as a @code{local-file},
5709 which denotes a file from the local file system (@pxref{G-Expressions,
5710 @code{local-file}}).
5711
5712 @item @code{build-system}
5713 The build system that should be used to build the package (@pxref{Build
5714 Systems}).
5715
5716 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
5717 The arguments that should be passed to the build system. This is a
5718 list, typically containing sequential keyword-value pairs.
5719
5720 @item @code{inputs} (default: @code{'()})
5721 @itemx @code{native-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
5722 @itemx @code{propagated-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
5723 @cindex inputs, of packages
5724 These fields list dependencies of the package. Each one is a list of
5725 tuples, where each tuple has a label for the input (a string) as its
5726 first element, a package, origin, or derivation as its second element,
5727 and optionally the name of the output thereof that should be used, which
5728 defaults to @code{"out"} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}, for
5729 more on package outputs). For example, the list below specifies three
5730 inputs:
5731
5732 @lisp
5733 `(("libffi" ,libffi)
5734 ("libunistring" ,libunistring)
5735 ("glib:bin" ,glib "bin")) ;the "bin" output of Glib
5736 @end lisp
5737
5738 @cindex cross compilation, package dependencies
5739 The distinction between @code{native-inputs} and @code{inputs} is
5740 necessary when considering cross-compilation. When cross-compiling,
5741 dependencies listed in @code{inputs} are built for the @emph{target}
5742 architecture; conversely, dependencies listed in @code{native-inputs}
5743 are built for the architecture of the @emph{build} machine.
5744
5745 @code{native-inputs} is typically used to list tools needed at
5746 build time, but not at run time, such as Autoconf, Automake, pkg-config,
5747 Gettext, or Bison. @command{guix lint} can report likely mistakes in
5748 this area (@pxref{Invoking guix lint}).
5749
5750 @anchor{package-propagated-inputs}
5751 Lastly, @code{propagated-inputs} is similar to @code{inputs}, but the
5752 specified packages will be automatically installed alongside the package
5753 they belong to (@pxref{package-cmd-propagated-inputs, @command{guix
5754 package}}, for information on how @command{guix package} deals with
5755 propagated inputs.)
5756
5757 For example this is necessary when a C/C++ library needs headers of
5758 another library to compile, or when a pkg-config file refers to another
5759 one @i{via} its @code{Requires} field.
5760
5761 Another example where @code{propagated-inputs} is useful is for languages
5762 that lack a facility to record the run-time search path akin to the
5763 @code{RUNPATH} of ELF files; this includes Guile, Python, Perl, and
5764 more. To ensure that libraries written in those languages can find
5765 library code they depend on at run time, run-time dependencies must be
5766 listed in @code{propagated-inputs} rather than @code{inputs}.
5767
5768 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{'("out")})
5769 The list of output names of the package. @xref{Packages with Multiple
5770 Outputs}, for typical uses of additional outputs.
5771
5772 @item @code{native-search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
5773 @itemx @code{search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
5774 A list of @code{search-path-specification} objects describing
5775 search-path environment variables honored by the package.
5776
5777 @item @code{replacement} (default: @code{#f})
5778 This must be either @code{#f} or a package object that will be used as a
5779 @dfn{replacement} for this package. @xref{Security Updates, grafts},
5780 for details.
5781
5782 @item @code{synopsis}
5783 A one-line description of the package.
5784
5785 @item @code{description}
5786 A more elaborate description of the package.
5787
5788 @item @code{license}
5789 @cindex license, of packages
5790 The license of the package; a value from @code{(guix licenses)},
5791 or a list of such values.
5792
5793 @item @code{home-page}
5794 The URL to the home-page of the package, as a string.
5795
5796 @item @code{supported-systems} (default: @var{%supported-systems})
5797 The list of systems supported by the package, as strings of the form
5798 @code{architecture-kernel}, for example @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
5799
5800 @item @code{location} (default: source location of the @code{package} form)
5801 The source location of the package. It is useful to override this when
5802 inheriting from another package, in which case this field is not
5803 automatically corrected.
5804 @end table
5805 @end deftp
5806
5807 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-package
5808 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of a package field definition, this
5809 identifier resolves to the package being defined.
5810
5811 The example below shows how to add a package as a native input of itself when
5812 cross-compiling:
5813
5814 @lisp
5815 (package
5816 (name "guile")
5817 ;; ...
5818
5819 ;; When cross-compiled, Guile, for example, depends on
5820 ;; a native version of itself. Add it here.
5821 (native-inputs (if (%current-target-system)
5822 `(("self" ,this-package))
5823 '())))
5824 @end lisp
5825
5826 It is an error to refer to @code{this-package} outside a package definition.
5827 @end deffn
5828
5829 @node origin Reference
5830 @subsection @code{origin} Reference
5831
5832 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{origin}
5833 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
5834
5835 @deftp {Data Type} origin
5836 This is the data type representing a source code origin.
5837
5838 @table @asis
5839 @item @code{uri}
5840 An object containing the URI of the source. The object type depends on
5841 the @code{method} (see below). For example, when using the
5842 @var{url-fetch} method of @code{(guix download)}, the valid @code{uri}
5843 values are: a URL represented as a string, or a list thereof.
5844
5845 @item @code{method}
5846 A procedure that handles the URI.
5847
5848 Examples include:
5849
5850 @table @asis
5851 @item @var{url-fetch} from @code{(guix download)}
5852 download a file from the HTTP, HTTPS, or FTP URL specified in the
5853 @code{uri} field;
5854
5855 @vindex git-fetch
5856 @item @var{git-fetch} from @code{(guix git-download)}
5857 clone the Git version control repository, and check out the revision
5858 specified in the @code{uri} field as a @code{git-reference} object; a
5859 @code{git-reference} looks like this:
5860
5861 @lisp
5862 (git-reference
5863 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/hello.git")
5864 (commit "v2.10"))
5865 @end lisp
5866 @end table
5867
5868 @item @code{sha256}
5869 A bytevector containing the SHA-256 hash of the source. Typically the
5870 @code{base32} form is used here to generate the bytevector from a
5871 base-32 string.
5872
5873 You can obtain this information using @code{guix download}
5874 (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) or @code{guix hash} (@pxref{Invoking
5875 guix hash}).
5876
5877 @item @code{file-name} (default: @code{#f})
5878 The file name under which the source code should be saved. When this is
5879 @code{#f}, a sensible default value will be used in most cases. In case
5880 the source is fetched from a URL, the file name from the URL will be
5881 used. For version control checkouts, it is recommended to provide the
5882 file name explicitly because the default is not very descriptive.
5883
5884 @item @code{patches} (default: @code{'()})
5885 A list of file names, origins, or file-like objects (@pxref{G-Expressions,
5886 file-like objects}) pointing to patches to be applied to the source.
5887
5888 This list of patches must be unconditional. In particular, it cannot
5889 depend on the value of @code{%current-system} or
5890 @code{%current-target-system}.
5891
5892 @item @code{snippet} (default: @code{#f})
5893 A G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}) or S-expression that will be run
5894 in the source directory. This is a convenient way to modify the source,
5895 sometimes more convenient than a patch.
5896
5897 @item @code{patch-flags} (default: @code{'("-p1")})
5898 A list of command-line flags that should be passed to the @code{patch}
5899 command.
5900
5901 @item @code{patch-inputs} (default: @code{#f})
5902 Input packages or derivations to the patching process. When this is
5903 @code{#f}, the usual set of inputs necessary for patching are provided,
5904 such as GNU@tie{}Patch.
5905
5906 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
5907 A list of Guile modules that should be loaded during the patching
5908 process and while running the code in the @code{snippet} field.
5909
5910 @item @code{patch-guile} (default: @code{#f})
5911 The Guile package that should be used in the patching process. When
5912 this is @code{#f}, a sensible default is used.
5913 @end table
5914 @end deftp
5915
5916
5917 @node Build Systems
5918 @section Build Systems
5919
5920 @cindex build system
5921 Each package definition specifies a @dfn{build system} and arguments for
5922 that build system (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This @code{build-system}
5923 field represents the build procedure of the package, as well as implicit
5924 dependencies of that build procedure.
5925
5926 Build systems are @code{<build-system>} objects. The interface to
5927 create and manipulate them is provided by the @code{(guix build-system)}
5928 module, and actual build systems are exported by specific modules.
5929
5930 @cindex bag (low-level package representation)
5931 Under the hood, build systems first compile package objects to
5932 @dfn{bags}. A @dfn{bag} is like a package, but with less
5933 ornamentation---in other words, a bag is a lower-level representation of
5934 a package, which includes all the inputs of that package, including some
5935 that were implicitly added by the build system. This intermediate
5936 representation is then compiled to a derivation (@pxref{Derivations}).
5937
5938 Build systems accept an optional list of @dfn{arguments}. In package
5939 definitions, these are passed @i{via} the @code{arguments} field
5940 (@pxref{Defining Packages}). They are typically keyword arguments
5941 (@pxref{Optional Arguments, keyword arguments in Guile,, guile, GNU
5942 Guile Reference Manual}). The value of these arguments is usually
5943 evaluated in the @dfn{build stratum}---i.e., by a Guile process launched
5944 by the daemon (@pxref{Derivations}).
5945
5946 The main build system is @code{gnu-build-system}, which implements the
5947 standard build procedure for GNU and many other packages. It
5948 is provided by the @code{(guix build-system gnu)} module.
5949
5950 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnu-build-system
5951 @code{gnu-build-system} represents the GNU Build System, and variants
5952 thereof (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile conventions,,
5953 standards, GNU Coding Standards}).
5954
5955 @cindex build phases
5956 In a nutshell, packages using it are configured, built, and installed with
5957 the usual @code{./configure && make && make check && make install}
5958 command sequence. In practice, a few additional steps are often needed.
5959 All these steps are split up in separate @dfn{phases},
5960 notably@footnote{Please see the @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)}
5961 modules for more details about the build phases.}:
5962
5963 @table @code
5964 @item unpack
5965 Unpack the source tarball, and change the current directory to the
5966 extracted source tree. If the source is actually a directory, copy it
5967 to the build tree, and enter that directory.
5968
5969 @item patch-source-shebangs
5970 Patch shebangs encountered in source files so they refer to the right
5971 store file names. For instance, this changes @code{#!/bin/sh} to
5972 @code{#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3/bin/sh}.
5973
5974 @item configure
5975 Run the @file{configure} script with a number of default options, such
5976 as @code{--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, as well as the options specified
5977 by the @code{#:configure-flags} argument.
5978
5979 @item build
5980 Run @code{make} with the list of flags specified with
5981 @code{#:make-flags}. If the @code{#:parallel-build?} argument is true
5982 (the default), build with @code{make -j}.
5983
5984 @item check
5985 Run @code{make check}, or some other target specified with
5986 @code{#:test-target}, unless @code{#:tests? #f} is passed. If the
5987 @code{#:parallel-tests?} argument is true (the default), run @code{make
5988 check -j}.
5989
5990 @item install
5991 Run @code{make install} with the flags listed in @code{#:make-flags}.
5992
5993 @item patch-shebangs
5994 Patch shebangs on the installed executable files.
5995
5996 @item strip
5997 Strip debugging symbols from ELF files (unless @code{#:strip-binaries?}
5998 is false), copying them to the @code{debug} output when available
5999 (@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
6000 @end table
6001
6002 @vindex %standard-phases
6003 The build-side module @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
6004 @code{%standard-phases} as the default list of build phases.
6005 @code{%standard-phases} is a list of symbol/procedure pairs, where the
6006 procedure implements the actual phase.
6007
6008 The list of phases used for a particular package can be changed with the
6009 @code{#:phases} parameter. For instance, passing:
6010
6011 @example
6012 #:phases (modify-phases %standard-phases (delete 'configure))
6013 @end example
6014
6015 means that all the phases described above will be used, except the
6016 @code{configure} phase.
6017
6018 In addition, this build system ensures that the ``standard'' environment
6019 for GNU packages is available. This includes tools such as GCC, libc,
6020 Coreutils, Bash, Make, Diffutils, grep, and sed (see the @code{(guix
6021 build-system gnu)} module for a complete list). We call these the
6022 @dfn{implicit inputs} of a package, because package definitions do not
6023 have to mention them.
6024 @end defvr
6025
6026 Other @code{<build-system>} objects are defined to support other
6027 conventions and tools used by free software packages. They inherit most
6028 of @code{gnu-build-system}, and differ mainly in the set of inputs
6029 implicitly added to the build process, and in the list of phases
6030 executed. Some of these build systems are listed below.
6031
6032 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ant-build-system
6033 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ant)}. It
6034 implements the build procedure for Java packages that can be built with
6035 @url{https://ant.apache.org/, Ant build tool}.
6036
6037 It adds both @code{ant} and the @dfn{Java Development Kit} (JDK) as
6038 provided by the @code{icedtea} package to the set of inputs. Different
6039 packages can be specified with the @code{#:ant} and @code{#:jdk}
6040 parameters, respectively.
6041
6042 When the original package does not provide a suitable Ant build file,
6043 the parameter @code{#:jar-name} can be used to generate a minimal Ant
6044 build file @file{build.xml} with tasks to build the specified jar
6045 archive. In this case the parameter @code{#:source-dir} can be used to
6046 specify the source sub-directory, defaulting to ``src''.
6047
6048 The @code{#:main-class} parameter can be used with the minimal ant
6049 buildfile to specify the main class of the resulting jar. This makes the
6050 jar file executable. The @code{#:test-include} parameter can be used to
6051 specify the list of junit tests to run. It defaults to
6052 @code{(list "**/*Test.java")}. The @code{#:test-exclude} can be used to
6053 disable some tests. It defaults to @code{(list "**/Abstract*.java")},
6054 because abstract classes cannot be run as tests.
6055
6056 The parameter @code{#:build-target} can be used to specify the Ant task
6057 that should be run during the @code{build} phase. By default the
6058 ``jar'' task will be run.
6059
6060 @end defvr
6061
6062 @defvr {Scheme Variable} android-ndk-build-system
6063 @cindex Android distribution
6064 @cindex Android NDK build system
6065 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system android-ndk)}. It
6066 implements a build procedure for Android NDK (native development kit)
6067 packages using a Guix-specific build process.
6068
6069 The build system assumes that packages install their public interface
6070 (header) files to the subdirectory "include" of the "out" output and
6071 their libraries to the subdirectory "lib" of the "out" output.
6072
6073 It's also assumed that the union of all the dependencies of a package
6074 has no conflicting files.
6075
6076 For the time being, cross-compilation is not supported - so right now
6077 the libraries and header files are assumed to be host tools.
6078
6079 @end defvr
6080
6081 @defvr {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/source
6082 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/sbcl
6083 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/ecl
6084
6085 These variables, exported by @code{(guix build-system asdf)}, implement
6086 build procedures for Common Lisp packages using
6087 @url{https://common-lisp.net/project/asdf/, ``ASDF''}. ASDF is a system
6088 definition facility for Common Lisp programs and libraries.
6089
6090 The @code{asdf-build-system/source} system installs the packages in
6091 source form, and can be loaded using any common lisp implementation, via
6092 ASDF. The others, such as @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}, install binary
6093 systems in the format which a particular implementation understands.
6094 These build systems can also be used to produce executable programs, or
6095 lisp images which contain a set of packages pre-loaded.
6096
6097 The build system uses naming conventions. For binary packages, the
6098 package name should be prefixed with the lisp implementation, such as
6099 @code{sbcl-} for @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}.
6100
6101 Additionally, the corresponding source package should be labeled using
6102 the same convention as python packages (see @ref{Python Modules}), using
6103 the @code{cl-} prefix.
6104
6105 For binary packages, each system should be defined as a Guix package.
6106 If one package @code{origin} contains several systems, package variants
6107 can be created in order to build all the systems. Source packages,
6108 which use @code{asdf-build-system/source}, may contain several systems.
6109
6110 In order to create executable programs and images, the build-side
6111 procedures @code{build-program} and @code{build-image} can be used.
6112 They should be called in a build phase after the @code{create-symlinks}
6113 phase, so that the system which was just built can be used within the
6114 resulting image. @code{build-program} requires a list of Common Lisp
6115 expressions to be passed as the @code{#:entry-program} argument.
6116
6117 If the system is not defined within its own @code{.asd} file of the same
6118 name, then the @code{#:asd-file} parameter should be used to specify
6119 which file the system is defined in. Furthermore, if the package
6120 defines a system for its tests in a separate file, it will be loaded
6121 before the tests are run if it is specified by the
6122 @code{#:test-asd-file} parameter. If it is not set, the files
6123 @code{<system>-tests.asd}, @code{<system>-test.asd}, @code{tests.asd},
6124 and @code{test.asd} will be tried if they exist.
6125
6126 If for some reason the package must be named in a different way than the
6127 naming conventions suggest, the @code{#:asd-system-name} parameter can
6128 be used to specify the name of the system.
6129
6130 @end defvr
6131
6132 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cargo-build-system
6133 @cindex Rust programming language
6134 @cindex Cargo (Rust build system)
6135 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cargo)}. It
6136 supports builds of packages using Cargo, the build tool of the
6137 @uref{https://www.rust-lang.org, Rust programming language}.
6138
6139 It adds @code{rustc} and @code{cargo} to the set of inputs.
6140 A different Rust package can be specified with the @code{#:rust} parameter.
6141
6142 Regular cargo dependencies should be added to the package definition via the
6143 @code{#:cargo-inputs} parameter as a list of name and spec pairs, where the
6144 spec can be a package or a source definition. Note that the spec must
6145 evaluate to a path to a gzipped tarball which includes a @code{Cargo.toml}
6146 file at its root, or it will be ignored. Similarly, cargo dev-dependencies
6147 should be added to the package definition via the
6148 @code{#:cargo-development-inputs} parameter.
6149
6150 In its @code{configure} phase, this build system will make any source inputs
6151 specified in the @code{#:cargo-inputs} and @code{#:cargo-development-inputs}
6152 parameters available to cargo. It will also remove an included
6153 @code{Cargo.lock} file to be recreated by @code{cargo} during the
6154 @code{build} phase. The @code{install} phase installs any crate the binaries
6155 if they are defined by the crate.
6156 @end defvr
6157
6158
6159 @defvr {Scheme Variable} copy-build-system
6160 @cindex (copy build system)
6161 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system copy)}. It
6162 supports builds of simple packages that don't require much compiling,
6163 mostly just moving files around.
6164
6165 It adds much of the @code{gnu-build-system} packages to the set of
6166 inputs. Because of this, the @code{copy-build-system} does not require
6167 all the boilerplate code often needed for the
6168 @code{trivial-build-system}.
6169
6170 To further simplify the file installation process, an
6171 @code{#:install-plan} argument is exposed to let the packager specify
6172 which files go where. The install plan is a list of @code{(@var{source}
6173 @var{target} [@var{filters}])}. @var{filters} are optional.
6174
6175 @itemize
6176 @item When @var{source} matches a file or directory without trailing slash, install it to @var{target}.
6177 @itemize
6178 @item If @var{target} has a trailing slash, install @var{source} basename beneath @var{target}.
6179 @item Otherwise install @var{source} as @var{target}.
6180 @end itemize
6181
6182 @item When @var{source} is a directory with a trailing slash, or when @var{filters} are used,
6183 the trailing slash of @var{target} is implied with the same meaning
6184 as above.
6185 @itemize
6186 @item Without @var{filters}, install the full @var{source} @emph{content} to @var{target}.
6187 @item With @var{filters} among @code{#:include}, @code{#:include-regexp}, @code{#:exclude},
6188 @code{#:exclude-regexp}, only select files are installed depending on
6189 the filters. Each filters is specified by a list of strings.
6190 @itemize
6191 @item With @code{#:include}, install all the files which the path suffix matches
6192 at least one of the elements in the given list.
6193 @item With @code{#:include-regexp}, install all the files which the
6194 subpaths match at least one of the regular expressions in the given
6195 list.
6196 @item The @code{#:exclude} and @code{#:exclude-regexp} filters
6197 are the complement of their inclusion counterpart. Without @code{#:include} flags,
6198 install all files but those matching the exclusion filters.
6199 If both inclusions and exclusions are specified, the exclusions are done
6200 on top of the inclusions.
6201 @end itemize
6202 @end itemize
6203 In all cases, the paths relative to @var{source} are preserved within
6204 @var{target}.
6205 @end itemize
6206
6207 Examples:
6208
6209 @itemize
6210 @item @code{("foo/bar" "share/my-app/")}: Install @file{bar} to @file{share/my-app/bar}.
6211 @item @code{("foo/bar" "share/my-app/baz")}: Install @file{bar} to @file{share/my-app/baz}.
6212 @item @code{("foo/" "share/my-app")}: Install the content of @file{foo} inside @file{share/my-app},
6213 e.g., install @file{foo/sub/file} to @file{share/my-app/sub/file}.
6214 @item @code{("foo/" "share/my-app" #:include ("sub/file"))}: Install only @file{foo/sub/file} to
6215 @file{share/my-app/sub/file}.
6216 @item @code{("foo/sub" "share/my-app" #:include ("file"))}: Install @file{foo/sub/file} to
6217 @file{share/my-app/file}.
6218 @end itemize
6219 @end defvr
6220
6221
6222 @cindex Clojure (programming language)
6223 @cindex simple Clojure build system
6224 @defvr {Scheme Variable} clojure-build-system
6225 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system clojure)}. It implements
6226 a simple build procedure for @uref{https://clojure.org/, Clojure} packages
6227 using plain old @code{compile} in Clojure. Cross-compilation is not supported
6228 yet.
6229
6230 It adds @code{clojure}, @code{icedtea} and @code{zip} to the set of inputs.
6231 Different packages can be specified with the @code{#:clojure}, @code{#:jdk} and
6232 @code{#:zip} parameters, respectively.
6233
6234 A list of source directories, test directories and jar names can be specified
6235 with the @code{#:source-dirs}, @code{#:test-dirs} and @code{#:jar-names}
6236 parameters, respectively. Compile directory and main class can be specified
6237 with the @code{#:compile-dir} and @code{#:main-class} parameters, respectively.
6238 Other parameters are documented below.
6239
6240 This build system is an extension of @code{ant-build-system}, but with the
6241 following phases changed:
6242
6243 @table @code
6244
6245 @item build
6246 This phase calls @code{compile} in Clojure to compile source files and runs
6247 @command{jar} to create jars from both source files and compiled files
6248 according to the include list and exclude list specified in
6249 @code{#:aot-include} and @code{#:aot-exclude}, respectively. The exclude list
6250 has priority over the include list. These lists consist of symbols
6251 representing Clojure libraries or the special keyword @code{#:all} representing
6252 all Clojure libraries found under the source directories. The parameter
6253 @code{#:omit-source?} decides if source should be included into the jars.
6254
6255 @item check
6256 This phase runs tests according to the include list and exclude list specified
6257 in @code{#:test-include} and @code{#:test-exclude}, respectively. Their
6258 meanings are analogous to that of @code{#:aot-include} and
6259 @code{#:aot-exclude}, except that the special keyword @code{#:all} now
6260 stands for all Clojure libraries found under the test directories. The
6261 parameter @code{#:tests?} decides if tests should be run.
6262
6263 @item install
6264 This phase installs all jars built previously.
6265 @end table
6266
6267 Apart from the above, this build system also contains an additional phase:
6268
6269 @table @code
6270
6271 @item install-doc
6272 This phase installs all top-level files with base name matching
6273 @code{%doc-regex}. A different regex can be specified with the
6274 @code{#:doc-regex} parameter. All files (recursively) inside the documentation
6275 directories specified in @code{#:doc-dirs} are installed as well.
6276 @end table
6277 @end defvr
6278
6279 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cmake-build-system
6280 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cmake)}. It
6281 implements the build procedure for packages using the
6282 @url{https://www.cmake.org, CMake build tool}.
6283
6284 It automatically adds the @code{cmake} package to the set of inputs.
6285 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:cmake}
6286 parameter.
6287
6288 The @code{#:configure-flags} parameter is taken as a list of flags
6289 passed to the @command{cmake} command. The @code{#:build-type}
6290 parameter specifies in abstract terms the flags passed to the compiler;
6291 it defaults to @code{"RelWithDebInfo"} (short for ``release mode with
6292 debugging information''), which roughly means that code is compiled with
6293 @code{-O2 -g}, as is the case for Autoconf-based packages by default.
6294 @end defvr
6295
6296 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dune-build-system
6297 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dune)}. It
6298 supports builds of packages using @uref{https://dune.build/, Dune}, a build
6299 tool for the OCaml programming language. It is implemented as an extension
6300 of the @code{ocaml-build-system} which is described below. As such, the
6301 @code{#:ocaml} and @code{#:findlib} parameters can be passed to this build
6302 system.
6303
6304 It automatically adds the @code{dune} package to the set of inputs.
6305 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:dune}
6306 parameter.
6307
6308 There is no @code{configure} phase because dune packages typically don't
6309 need to be configured. The @code{#:build-flags} parameter is taken as a
6310 list of flags passed to the @code{dune} command during the build.
6311
6312 The @code{#:jbuild?} parameter can be passed to use the @code{jbuild}
6313 command instead of the more recent @code{dune} command while building
6314 a package. Its default value is @code{#f}.
6315
6316 The @code{#:package} parameter can be passed to specify a package name, which
6317 is useful when a package contains multiple packages and you want to build
6318 only one of them. This is equivalent to passing the @code{-p} argument to
6319 @code{dune}.
6320 @end defvr
6321
6322 @defvr {Scheme Variable} go-build-system
6323 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system go)}. It
6324 implements a build procedure for Go packages using the standard
6325 @url{https://golang.org/cmd/go/#hdr-Compile_packages_and_dependencies,
6326 Go build mechanisms}.
6327
6328 The user is expected to provide a value for the key @code{#:import-path}
6329 and, in some cases, @code{#:unpack-path}. The
6330 @url{https://golang.org/doc/code.html#ImportPaths, import path}
6331 corresponds to the file system path expected by the package's build
6332 scripts and any referring packages, and provides a unique way to
6333 refer to a Go package. It is typically based on a combination of the
6334 package source code's remote URI and file system hierarchy structure. In
6335 some cases, you will need to unpack the package's source code to a
6336 different directory structure than the one indicated by the import path,
6337 and @code{#:unpack-path} should be used in such cases.
6338
6339 Packages that provide Go libraries should install their source code into
6340 the built output. The key @code{#:install-source?}, which defaults to
6341 @code{#t}, controls whether or not the source code is installed. It can
6342 be set to @code{#f} for packages that only provide executable files.
6343 @end defvr
6344
6345 @defvr {Scheme Variable} glib-or-gtk-build-system
6346 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system glib-or-gtk)}. It
6347 is intended for use with packages making use of GLib or GTK+.
6348
6349 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
6350 @code{gnu-build-system}:
6351
6352 @table @code
6353 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
6354 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-wrap} ensures that programs in
6355 @file{bin/} are able to find GLib ``schemas'' and
6356 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gtk3/stable/gtk-running.html, GTK+
6357 modules}. This is achieved by wrapping the programs in launch scripts
6358 that appropriately set the @code{XDG_DATA_DIRS} and @code{GTK_PATH}
6359 environment variables.
6360
6361 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping
6362 process by listing their names in the
6363 @code{#:glib-or-gtk-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter. This is useful
6364 when an output is known not to contain any GLib or GTK+ binaries, and
6365 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on
6366 GLib and GTK+.
6367
6368 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
6369 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas} makes sure that all
6370 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gio/stable/glib-compile-schemas.html,
6371 GSettings schemas} of GLib are compiled. Compilation is performed by the
6372 @command{glib-compile-schemas} program. It is provided by the package
6373 @code{glib:bin} which is automatically imported by the build system.
6374 The @code{glib} package providing @command{glib-compile-schemas} can be
6375 specified with the @code{#:glib} parameter.
6376 @end table
6377
6378 Both phases are executed after the @code{install} phase.
6379 @end defvr
6380
6381 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guile-build-system
6382 This build system is for Guile packages that consist exclusively of Scheme
6383 code and that are so lean that they don't even have a makefile, let alone a
6384 @file{configure} script. It compiles Scheme code using @command{guild
6385 compile} (@pxref{Compilation,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) and
6386 installs the @file{.scm} and @file{.go} files in the right place. It also
6387 installs documentation.
6388
6389 This build system supports cross-compilation by using the @code{--target}
6390 option of @command{guild compile}.
6391
6392 Packages built with @code{guile-build-system} must provide a Guile package in
6393 their @code{native-inputs} field.
6394 @end defvr
6395
6396 @defvr {Scheme Variable} julia-build-system
6397 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system julia)}. It implements
6398 the build procedure used by @uref{https://julialang.org/, julia} packages,
6399 which essentially is similar to running @command{julia -e 'using Pkg;
6400 Pkg.add(package)'} in an environment where @code{JULIA_LOAD_PATH} contains the
6401 paths to all Julia package inputs. Tests are run not run.
6402
6403 Julia packages require the source @code{file-name} to be the real name of the
6404 package, correctly capitalized.
6405
6406 For packages requiring shared library dependencies, you may need to write the
6407 @file{/deps/deps.jl} file manually. It's usually a line of @code{const
6408 variable = /gnu/store/library.so} for each dependency, plus a void function
6409 @code{check_deps() = nothing}.
6410
6411 Some older packages that aren't using @file{Package.toml} yet, will require
6412 this file to be created, too. The function @code{julia-create-package-toml}
6413 helps creating the file. You need to pass the outputs and the source of the
6414 package, it's name (the same as the @code{file-name} parameter), the package
6415 uuid, the package version, and a list of dependencies specified by their name
6416 and their uuid.
6417 @end defvr
6418
6419 @defvr {Scheme Variable} minify-build-system
6420 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system minify)}. It
6421 implements a minification procedure for simple JavaScript packages.
6422
6423 It adds @code{uglify-js} to the set of inputs and uses it to compress
6424 all JavaScript files in the @file{src} directory. A different minifier
6425 package can be specified with the @code{#:uglify-js} parameter, but it
6426 is expected that the package writes the minified code to the standard
6427 output.
6428
6429 When the input JavaScript files are not all located in the @file{src}
6430 directory, the parameter @code{#:javascript-files} can be used to
6431 specify a list of file names to feed to the minifier.
6432 @end defvr
6433
6434 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ocaml-build-system
6435 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ocaml)}. It implements
6436 a build procedure for @uref{https://ocaml.org, OCaml} packages, which consists
6437 of choosing the correct set of commands to run for each package. OCaml
6438 packages can expect many different commands to be run. This build system will
6439 try some of them.
6440
6441 When the package has a @file{setup.ml} file present at the top-level, it will
6442 run @code{ocaml setup.ml -configure}, @code{ocaml setup.ml -build} and
6443 @code{ocaml setup.ml -install}. The build system will assume that this file
6444 was generated by @uref{http://oasis.forge.ocamlcore.org/, OASIS} and will take
6445 care of setting the prefix and enabling tests if they are not disabled. You
6446 can pass configure and build flags with the @code{#:configure-flags} and
6447 @code{#:build-flags}. The @code{#:test-flags} key can be passed to change the
6448 set of flags used to enable tests. The @code{#:use-make?} key can be used to
6449 bypass this system in the build and install phases.
6450
6451 When the package has a @file{configure} file, it is assumed that it is a
6452 hand-made configure script that requires a different argument format than
6453 in the @code{gnu-build-system}. You can add more flags with the
6454 @code{#:configure-flags} key.
6455
6456 When the package has a @file{Makefile} file (or @code{#:use-make?} is
6457 @code{#t}), it will be used and more flags can be passed to the build and
6458 install phases with the @code{#:make-flags} key.
6459
6460 Finally, some packages do not have these files and use a somewhat standard
6461 location for its build system. In that case, the build system will run
6462 @code{ocaml pkg/pkg.ml} or @code{ocaml pkg/build.ml} and take care of
6463 providing the path to the required findlib module. Additional flags can
6464 be passed via the @code{#:build-flags} key. Install is taken care of by
6465 @command{opam-installer}. In this case, the @code{opam} package must
6466 be added to the @code{native-inputs} field of the package definition.
6467
6468 Note that most OCaml packages assume they will be installed in the same
6469 directory as OCaml, which is not what we want in guix. In particular, they
6470 will install @file{.so} files in their module's directory, which is usually
6471 fine because it is in the OCaml compiler directory. In guix though, these
6472 libraries cannot be found and we use @code{CAML_LD_LIBRARY_PATH}. This
6473 variable points to @file{lib/ocaml/site-lib/stubslibs} and this is where
6474 @file{.so} libraries should be installed.
6475 @end defvr
6476
6477 @defvr {Scheme Variable} python-build-system
6478 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system python)}. It
6479 implements the more or less standard build procedure used by Python
6480 packages, which consists in running @code{python setup.py build} and
6481 then @code{python setup.py install --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}.
6482
6483 For packages that install stand-alone Python programs under @code{bin/},
6484 it takes care of wrapping these programs so that their @code{PYTHONPATH}
6485 environment variable points to all the Python libraries they depend on.
6486
6487 Which Python package is used to perform the build can be specified with
6488 the @code{#:python} parameter. This is a useful way to force a package
6489 to be built for a specific version of the Python interpreter, which
6490 might be necessary if the package is only compatible with a single
6491 interpreter version.
6492
6493 By default guix calls @code{setup.py} under control of
6494 @code{setuptools}, much like @command{pip} does. Some packages are not
6495 compatible with setuptools (and pip), thus you can disable this by
6496 setting the @code{#:use-setuptools?} parameter to @code{#f}.
6497 @end defvr
6498
6499 @defvr {Scheme Variable} perl-build-system
6500 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system perl)}. It
6501 implements the standard build procedure for Perl packages, which either
6502 consists in running @code{perl Build.PL --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}},
6503 followed by @code{Build} and @code{Build install}; or in running
6504 @code{perl Makefile.PL PREFIX=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, followed by
6505 @code{make} and @code{make install}, depending on which of
6506 @code{Build.PL} or @code{Makefile.PL} is present in the package
6507 distribution. Preference is given to the former if both @code{Build.PL}
6508 and @code{Makefile.PL} exist in the package distribution. This
6509 preference can be reversed by specifying @code{#t} for the
6510 @code{#:make-maker?} parameter.
6511
6512 The initial @code{perl Makefile.PL} or @code{perl Build.PL} invocation
6513 passes flags specified by the @code{#:make-maker-flags} or
6514 @code{#:module-build-flags} parameter, respectively.
6515
6516 Which Perl package is used can be specified with @code{#:perl}.
6517 @end defvr
6518
6519 @defvr {Scheme Variable} qt-build-system
6520 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system qt)}. It
6521 is intended for use with applications using Qt or KDE.
6522
6523 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
6524 @code{cmake-build-system}:
6525
6526 @table @code
6527 @item check-setup
6528 The phase @code{check-setup} prepares the environment for running
6529 the checks as commonly used by Qt test programs.
6530 For now this only sets some environment variables:
6531 @code{QT_QPA_PLATFORM=offscreen},
6532 @code{DBUS_FATAL_WARNINGS=0} and
6533 @code{CTEST_OUTPUT_ON_FAILURE=1}.
6534
6535 This phase is added before the @code{check} phase.
6536 It's a separate phase to ease adjusting if necessary.
6537
6538 @item qt-wrap
6539 The phase @code{qt-wrap}
6540 searches for Qt5 plugin paths, QML paths and some XDG in the inputs
6541 and output. In case some path is found, all programs in the output's
6542 @file{bin/}, @file{sbin/}, @file{libexec/} and @file{lib/libexec/} directories
6543 are wrapped in scripts defining the necessary environment variables.
6544
6545 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping process
6546 by listing their names in the @code{#:qt-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter.
6547 This is useful when an output is known not to contain any Qt binaries, and
6548 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on Qt, KDE,
6549 or such.
6550
6551 This phase is added after the @code{install} phase.
6552 @end table
6553 @end defvr
6554
6555 @defvr {Scheme Variable} r-build-system
6556 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system r)}. It
6557 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://r-project.org, R}
6558 packages, which essentially is little more than running @code{R CMD
6559 INSTALL --library=/gnu/store/@dots{}} in an environment where
6560 @code{R_LIBS_SITE} contains the paths to all R package inputs. Tests
6561 are run after installation using the R function
6562 @code{tools::testInstalledPackage}.
6563 @end defvr
6564
6565 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rakudo-build-system
6566 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system rakudo)}. It
6567 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://rakudo.org/,
6568 Rakudo} for @uref{https://perl6.org/, Perl6} packages. It installs the
6569 package to @code{/gnu/store/@dots{}/NAME-VERSION/share/perl6} and
6570 installs the binaries, library files and the resources, as well as wrap
6571 the files under the @code{bin/} directory. Tests can be skipped by
6572 passing @code{#f} to the @code{tests?} parameter.
6573
6574 Which rakudo package is used can be specified with @code{rakudo}.
6575 Which perl6-tap-harness package used for the tests can be specified with
6576 @code{#:prove6} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
6577 @code{with-prove6?} parameter.
6578 Which perl6-zef package used for tests and installing can be specified
6579 with @code{#:zef} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
6580 @code{with-zef?} parameter.
6581 @end defvr
6582
6583 @defvr {Scheme Variable} texlive-build-system
6584 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system texlive)}. It is
6585 used to build TeX packages in batch mode with a specified engine. The
6586 build system sets the @code{TEXINPUTS} variable to find all TeX source
6587 files in the inputs.
6588
6589 By default it runs @code{luatex} on all files ending on @code{ins}. A
6590 different engine and format can be specified with the
6591 @code{#:tex-format} argument. Different build targets can be specified
6592 with the @code{#:build-targets} argument, which expects a list of file
6593 names. The build system adds only @code{texlive-bin} and
6594 @code{texlive-latex-base} (both from @code{(gnu packages tex}) to the
6595 inputs. Both can be overridden with the arguments @code{#:texlive-bin}
6596 and @code{#:texlive-latex-base}, respectively.
6597
6598 The @code{#:tex-directory} parameter tells the build system where to
6599 install the built files under the texmf tree.
6600 @end defvr
6601
6602 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ruby-build-system
6603 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ruby)}. It
6604 implements the RubyGems build procedure used by Ruby packages, which
6605 involves running @code{gem build} followed by @code{gem install}.
6606
6607 The @code{source} field of a package that uses this build system
6608 typically references a gem archive, since this is the format that Ruby
6609 developers use when releasing their software. The build system unpacks
6610 the gem archive, potentially patches the source, runs the test suite,
6611 repackages the gem, and installs it. Additionally, directories and
6612 tarballs may be referenced to allow building unreleased gems from Git or
6613 a traditional source release tarball.
6614
6615 Which Ruby package is used can be specified with the @code{#:ruby}
6616 parameter. A list of additional flags to be passed to the @command{gem}
6617 command can be specified with the @code{#:gem-flags} parameter.
6618 @end defvr
6619
6620 @defvr {Scheme Variable} waf-build-system
6621 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system waf)}. It
6622 implements a build procedure around the @code{waf} script. The common
6623 phases---@code{configure}, @code{build}, and @code{install}---are
6624 implemented by passing their names as arguments to the @code{waf}
6625 script.
6626
6627 The @code{waf} script is executed by the Python interpreter. Which
6628 Python package is used to run the script can be specified with the
6629 @code{#:python} parameter.
6630 @end defvr
6631
6632 @defvr {Scheme Variable} scons-build-system
6633 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system scons)}. It
6634 implements the build procedure used by the SCons software construction
6635 tool. This build system runs @code{scons} to build the package,
6636 @code{scons test} to run tests, and then @code{scons install} to install
6637 the package.
6638
6639 Additional flags to be passed to @code{scons} can be specified with the
6640 @code{#:scons-flags} parameter. The default build and install targets
6641 can be overridden with @code{#:build-targets} and
6642 @code{#:install-targets} respectively. The version of Python used to
6643 run SCons can be specified by selecting the appropriate SCons package
6644 with the @code{#:scons} parameter.
6645 @end defvr
6646
6647 @defvr {Scheme Variable} haskell-build-system
6648 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system haskell)}. It
6649 implements the Cabal build procedure used by Haskell packages, which
6650 involves running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs configure
6651 --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}} and @code{runhaskell Setup.hs build}.
6652 Instead of installing the package by running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs
6653 install}, to avoid trying to register libraries in the read-only
6654 compiler store directory, the build system uses @code{runhaskell
6655 Setup.hs copy}, followed by @code{runhaskell Setup.hs register}. In
6656 addition, the build system generates the package documentation by
6657 running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs haddock}, unless @code{#:haddock? #f}
6658 is passed. Optional Haddock parameters can be passed with the help of
6659 the @code{#:haddock-flags} parameter. If the file @code{Setup.hs} is
6660 not found, the build system looks for @code{Setup.lhs} instead.
6661
6662 Which Haskell compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:haskell}
6663 parameter which defaults to @code{ghc}.
6664 @end defvr
6665
6666 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dub-build-system
6667 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dub)}. It
6668 implements the Dub build procedure used by D packages, which
6669 involves running @code{dub build} and @code{dub run}.
6670 Installation is done by copying the files manually.
6671
6672 Which D compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:ldc}
6673 parameter which defaults to @code{ldc}.
6674 @end defvr
6675
6676 @defvr {Scheme Variable} emacs-build-system
6677 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system emacs)}. It
6678 implements an installation procedure similar to the packaging system
6679 of Emacs itself (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
6680
6681 It first creates the @code{@code{package}-autoloads.el} file, then it
6682 byte compiles all Emacs Lisp files. Differently from the Emacs
6683 packaging system, the Info documentation files are moved to the standard
6684 documentation directory and the @file{dir} file is deleted. Each
6685 package is installed in its own directory under
6686 @file{share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d}.
6687 @end defvr
6688
6689 @defvr {Scheme Variable} font-build-system
6690 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system font)}. It
6691 implements an installation procedure for font packages where upstream
6692 provides pre-compiled TrueType, OpenType, etc.@: font files that merely
6693 need to be copied into place. It copies font files to standard
6694 locations in the output directory.
6695 @end defvr
6696
6697 @defvr {Scheme Variable} meson-build-system
6698 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system meson)}. It
6699 implements the build procedure for packages that use
6700 @url{https://mesonbuild.com, Meson} as their build system.
6701
6702 It adds both Meson and @uref{https://ninja-build.org/, Ninja} to the set
6703 of inputs, and they can be changed with the parameters @code{#:meson}
6704 and @code{#:ninja} if needed. The default Meson is
6705 @code{meson-for-build}, which is special because it doesn't clear the
6706 @code{RUNPATH} of binaries and libraries when they are installed.
6707
6708 This build system is an extension of @code{gnu-build-system}, but with the
6709 following phases changed to some specific for Meson:
6710
6711 @table @code
6712
6713 @item configure
6714 The phase runs @code{meson} with the flags specified in
6715 @code{#:configure-flags}. The flag @code{--build-type} is always set to
6716 @code{plain} unless something else is specified in @code{#:build-type}.
6717
6718 @item build
6719 The phase runs @code{ninja} to build the package in parallel by default, but
6720 this can be changed with @code{#:parallel-build?}.
6721
6722 @item check
6723 The phase runs @code{ninja} with the target specified in @code{#:test-target},
6724 which is @code{"test"} by default.
6725
6726 @item install
6727 The phase runs @code{ninja install} and can not be changed.
6728 @end table
6729
6730 Apart from that, the build system also adds the following phases:
6731
6732 @table @code
6733
6734 @item fix-runpath
6735 This phase ensures that all binaries can find the libraries they need.
6736 It searches for required libraries in subdirectories of the package being
6737 built, and adds those to @code{RUNPATH} where needed. It also removes
6738 references to libraries left over from the build phase by
6739 @code{meson-for-build}, such as test dependencies, that aren't actually
6740 required for the program to run.
6741
6742 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
6743 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
6744 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
6745
6746 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
6747 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
6748 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
6749 @end table
6750 @end defvr
6751
6752 @defvr {Scheme Variable} linux-module-build-system
6753 @code{linux-module-build-system} allows building Linux kernel modules.
6754
6755 @cindex build phases
6756 This build system is an extension of @code{gnu-build-system}, but with the
6757 following phases changed:
6758
6759 @table @code
6760
6761 @item configure
6762 This phase configures the environment so that the Linux kernel's Makefile
6763 can be used to build the external kernel module.
6764
6765 @item build
6766 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to build the external
6767 kernel module.
6768
6769 @item install
6770 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to install the external
6771 kernel module.
6772 @end table
6773
6774 It is possible and useful to specify the Linux kernel to use for building
6775 the module (in the "arguments" form of a package using the
6776 linux-module-build-system, use the key #:linux to specify it).
6777 @end defvr
6778
6779 @defvr {Scheme Variable} node-build-system
6780 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system node)}. It
6781 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://nodejs.org,
6782 Node.js}, which implements an approximation of the @code{npm install}
6783 command, followed by an @code{npm test} command.
6784
6785 Which Node.js package is used to interpret the @code{npm} commands can
6786 be specified with the @code{#:node} parameter which defaults to
6787 @code{node}.
6788 @end defvr
6789
6790 Lastly, for packages that do not need anything as sophisticated, a
6791 ``trivial'' build system is provided. It is trivial in the sense that
6792 it provides basically no support: it does not pull any implicit inputs,
6793 and does not have a notion of build phases.
6794
6795 @defvr {Scheme Variable} trivial-build-system
6796 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system trivial)}.
6797
6798 This build system requires a @code{#:builder} argument. This argument
6799 must be a Scheme expression that builds the package output(s)---as
6800 with @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations,
6801 @code{build-expression->derivation}}).
6802 @end defvr
6803
6804 @node The Store
6805 @section The Store
6806
6807 @cindex store
6808 @cindex store items
6809 @cindex store paths
6810
6811 Conceptually, the @dfn{store} is the place where derivations that have
6812 been built successfully are stored---by default, @file{/gnu/store}.
6813 Sub-directories in the store are referred to as @dfn{store items} or
6814 sometimes @dfn{store paths}. The store has an associated database that
6815 contains information such as the store paths referred to by each store
6816 path, and the list of @emph{valid} store items---results of successful
6817 builds. This database resides in @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/db},
6818 where @var{localstatedir} is the state directory specified @i{via}
6819 @option{--localstatedir} at configure time, usually @file{/var}.
6820
6821 The store is @emph{always} accessed by the daemon on behalf of its clients
6822 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). To manipulate the store, clients
6823 connect to the daemon over a Unix-domain socket, send requests to it,
6824 and read the result---these are remote procedure calls, or RPCs.
6825
6826 @quotation Note
6827 Users must @emph{never} modify files under @file{/gnu/store} directly.
6828 This would lead to inconsistencies and break the immutability
6829 assumptions of Guix's functional model (@pxref{Introduction}).
6830
6831 @xref{Invoking guix gc, @command{guix gc --verify}}, for information on
6832 how to check the integrity of the store and attempt recovery from
6833 accidental modifications.
6834 @end quotation
6835
6836 The @code{(guix store)} module provides procedures to connect to the
6837 daemon, and to perform RPCs. These are described below. By default,
6838 @code{open-connection}, and thus all the @command{guix} commands,
6839 connect to the local daemon or to the URI specified by the
6840 @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable.
6841
6842 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET
6843 When set, the value of this variable should be a file name or a URI
6844 designating the daemon endpoint. When it is a file name, it denotes a
6845 Unix-domain socket to connect to. In addition to file names, the
6846 supported URI schemes are:
6847
6848 @table @code
6849 @item file
6850 @itemx unix
6851 These are for Unix-domain sockets.
6852 @code{file:///var/guix/daemon-socket/socket} is equivalent to
6853 @file{/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
6854
6855 @item guix
6856 @cindex daemon, remote access
6857 @cindex remote access to the daemon
6858 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
6859 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
6860 These URIs denote connections over TCP/IP, without encryption nor
6861 authentication of the remote host. The URI must specify the host name
6862 and optionally a port number (by default port 44146 is used):
6863
6864 @example
6865 guix://master.guix.example.org:1234
6866 @end example
6867
6868 This setup is suitable on local networks, such as clusters, where only
6869 trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon at
6870 @code{master.guix.example.org}.
6871
6872 The @code{--listen} option of @command{guix-daemon} can be used to
6873 instruct it to listen for TCP connections (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
6874 @code{--listen}}).
6875
6876 @item ssh
6877 @cindex SSH access to build daemons
6878 These URIs allow you to connect to a remote daemon over SSH. This
6879 feature requires Guile-SSH (@pxref{Requirements}) and a working
6880 @code{guile} binary in @code{PATH} on the destination machine. It
6881 supports public key and GSSAPI authentication. A typical URL might look
6882 like this:
6883
6884 @example
6885 ssh://charlie@@guix.example.org:22
6886 @end example
6887
6888 As for @command{guix copy}, the usual OpenSSH client configuration files
6889 are honored (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
6890 @end table
6891
6892 Additional URI schemes may be supported in the future.
6893
6894 @c XXX: Remove this note when the protocol incurs fewer round trips
6895 @c and when (guix derivations) no longer relies on file system access.
6896 @quotation Note
6897 The ability to connect to remote build daemons is considered
6898 experimental as of @value{VERSION}. Please get in touch with us to
6899 share any problems or suggestions you may have (@pxref{Contributing}).
6900 @end quotation
6901 @end defvr
6902
6903 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-connection [@var{uri}] [#:reserve-space? #t]
6904 Connect to the daemon over the Unix-domain socket at @var{uri} (a string). When
6905 @var{reserve-space?} is true, instruct it to reserve a little bit of
6906 extra space on the file system so that the garbage collector can still
6907 operate should the disk become full. Return a server object.
6908
6909 @var{file} defaults to @code{%default-socket-path}, which is the normal
6910 location given the options that were passed to @command{configure}.
6911 @end deffn
6912
6913 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} close-connection @var{server}
6914 Close the connection to @var{server}.
6915 @end deffn
6916
6917 @defvr {Scheme Variable} current-build-output-port
6918 This variable is bound to a SRFI-39 parameter, which refers to the port
6919 where build and error logs sent by the daemon should be written.
6920 @end defvr
6921
6922 Procedures that make RPCs all take a server object as their first
6923 argument.
6924
6925 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} valid-path? @var{server} @var{path}
6926 @cindex invalid store items
6927 Return @code{#t} when @var{path} designates a valid store item and
6928 @code{#f} otherwise (an invalid item may exist on disk but still be
6929 invalid, for instance because it is the result of an aborted or failed
6930 build.)
6931
6932 A @code{&store-protocol-error} condition is raised if @var{path} is not
6933 prefixed by the store directory (@file{/gnu/store}).
6934 @end deffn
6935
6936 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} add-text-to-store @var{server} @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
6937 Add @var{text} under file @var{name} in the store, and return its store
6938 path. @var{references} is the list of store paths referred to by the
6939 resulting store path.
6940 @end deffn
6941
6942 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-derivations @var{store} @var{derivations} @
6943 [@var{mode}]
6944 Build @var{derivations}, a list of @code{<derivation>} objects, @file{.drv}
6945 file names, or derivation/output pairs, using the specified
6946 @var{mode}---@code{(build-mode normal)} by default.
6947 @end deffn
6948
6949 Note that the @code{(guix monads)} module provides a monad as well as
6950 monadic versions of the above procedures, with the goal of making it
6951 more convenient to work with code that accesses the store (@pxref{The
6952 Store Monad}).
6953
6954 @c FIXME
6955 @i{This section is currently incomplete.}
6956
6957 @node Derivations
6958 @section Derivations
6959
6960 @cindex derivations
6961 Low-level build actions and the environment in which they are performed
6962 are represented by @dfn{derivations}. A derivation contains the
6963 following pieces of information:
6964
6965 @itemize
6966 @item
6967 The outputs of the derivation---derivations produce at least one file or
6968 directory in the store, but may produce more.
6969
6970 @item
6971 @cindex build-time dependencies
6972 @cindex dependencies, build-time
6973 The inputs of the derivations---i.e., its build-time dependencies---which may
6974 be other derivations or plain files in the store (patches, build scripts,
6975 etc.)
6976
6977 @item
6978 The system type targeted by the derivation---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
6979
6980 @item
6981 The file name of a build script in the store, along with the arguments
6982 to be passed.
6983
6984 @item
6985 A list of environment variables to be defined.
6986
6987 @end itemize
6988
6989 @cindex derivation path
6990 Derivations allow clients of the daemon to communicate build actions to
6991 the store. They exist in two forms: as an in-memory representation,
6992 both on the client- and daemon-side, and as files in the store whose
6993 name end in @code{.drv}---these files are referred to as @dfn{derivation
6994 paths}. Derivations paths can be passed to the @code{build-derivations}
6995 procedure to perform the build actions they prescribe (@pxref{The
6996 Store}).
6997
6998 @cindex fixed-output derivations
6999 Operations such as file downloads and version-control checkouts for
7000 which the expected content hash is known in advance are modeled as
7001 @dfn{fixed-output derivations}. Unlike regular derivations, the outputs
7002 of a fixed-output derivation are independent of its inputs---e.g., a
7003 source code download produces the same result regardless of the download
7004 method and tools being used.
7005
7006 @cindex references
7007 @cindex run-time dependencies
7008 @cindex dependencies, run-time
7009 The outputs of derivations---i.e., the build results---have a set of
7010 @dfn{references}, as reported by the @code{references} RPC or the
7011 @command{guix gc --references} command (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). References
7012 are the set of run-time dependencies of the build results. References are a
7013 subset of the inputs of the derivation; this subset is automatically computed
7014 by the build daemon by scanning all the files in the outputs.
7015
7016 The @code{(guix derivations)} module provides a representation of
7017 derivations as Scheme objects, along with procedures to create and
7018 otherwise manipulate derivations. The lowest-level primitive to create
7019 a derivation is the @code{derivation} procedure:
7020
7021 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} derivation @var{store} @var{name} @var{builder} @
7022 @var{args} [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
7023 [#:recursive? #f] [#:inputs '()] [#:env-vars '()] @
7024 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:references-graphs #f] @
7025 [#:allowed-references #f] [#:disallowed-references #f] @
7026 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] [#:local-build? #f] @
7027 [#:substitutable? #t] [#:properties '()]
7028 Build a derivation with the given arguments, and return the resulting
7029 @code{<derivation>} object.
7030
7031 When @var{hash} and @var{hash-algo} are given, a
7032 @dfn{fixed-output derivation} is created---i.e., one whose result is
7033 known in advance, such as a file download. If, in addition,
7034 @var{recursive?} is true, then that fixed output may be an executable
7035 file or a directory and @var{hash} must be the hash of an archive
7036 containing this output.
7037
7038 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of file
7039 name/store path pairs. In that case, the reference graph of each store
7040 path is exported in the build environment in the corresponding file, in
7041 a simple text format.
7042
7043 When @var{allowed-references} is true, it must be a list of store items
7044 or outputs that the derivation's output may refer to. Likewise,
7045 @var{disallowed-references}, if true, must be a list of things the
7046 outputs may @emph{not} refer to.
7047
7048 When @var{leaked-env-vars} is true, it must be a list of strings
7049 denoting environment variables that are allowed to ``leak'' from the
7050 daemon's environment to the build environment. This is only applicable
7051 to fixed-output derivations---i.e., when @var{hash} is true. The main
7052 use is to allow variables such as @code{http_proxy} to be passed to
7053 derivations that download files.
7054
7055 When @var{local-build?} is true, declare that the derivation is not a
7056 good candidate for offloading and should rather be built locally
7057 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). This is the case for small derivations
7058 where the costs of data transfers would outweigh the benefits.
7059
7060 When @var{substitutable?} is false, declare that substitutes of the
7061 derivation's output should not be used (@pxref{Substitutes}). This is
7062 useful, for instance, when building packages that capture details of the
7063 host CPU instruction set.
7064
7065 @var{properties} must be an association list describing ``properties'' of the
7066 derivation. It is kept as-is, uninterpreted, in the derivation.
7067 @end deffn
7068
7069 @noindent
7070 Here's an example with a shell script as its builder, assuming
7071 @var{store} is an open connection to the daemon, and @var{bash} points
7072 to a Bash executable in the store:
7073
7074 @lisp
7075 (use-modules (guix utils)
7076 (guix store)
7077 (guix derivations))
7078
7079 (let ((builder ; add the Bash script to the store
7080 (add-text-to-store store "my-builder.sh"
7081 "echo hello world > $out\n" '())))
7082 (derivation store "foo"
7083 bash `("-e" ,builder)
7084 #:inputs `((,bash) (,builder))
7085 #:env-vars '(("HOME" . "/homeless"))))
7086 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo.drv => /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo>
7087 @end lisp
7088
7089 As can be guessed, this primitive is cumbersome to use directly. A
7090 better approach is to write build scripts in Scheme, of course! The
7091 best course of action for that is to write the build code as a
7092 ``G-expression'', and to pass it to @code{gexp->derivation}. For more
7093 information, @pxref{G-Expressions}.
7094
7095 Once upon a time, @code{gexp->derivation} did not exist and constructing
7096 derivations with build code written in Scheme was achieved with
7097 @code{build-expression->derivation}, documented below. This procedure
7098 is now deprecated in favor of the much nicer @code{gexp->derivation}.
7099
7100 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-expression->derivation @var{store} @
7101 @var{name} @var{exp} @
7102 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:inputs '()] @
7103 [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
7104 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
7105 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
7106 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
7107 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
7108 Return a derivation that executes Scheme expression @var{exp} as a
7109 builder for derivation @var{name}. @var{inputs} must be a list of
7110 @code{(name drv-path sub-drv)} tuples; when @var{sub-drv} is omitted,
7111 @code{"out"} is assumed. @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile
7112 modules from the current search path to be copied in the store,
7113 compiled, and made available in the load path during the execution of
7114 @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix build utils) (guix build
7115 gnu-build-system))}.
7116
7117 @var{exp} is evaluated in an environment where @code{%outputs} is bound
7118 to a list of output/path pairs, and where @code{%build-inputs} is bound
7119 to a list of string/output-path pairs made from @var{inputs}.
7120 Optionally, @var{env-vars} is a list of string pairs specifying the name
7121 and value of environment variables visible to the builder. The builder
7122 terminates by passing the result of @var{exp} to @code{exit}; thus, when
7123 @var{exp} returns @code{#f}, the build is considered to have failed.
7124
7125 @var{exp} is built using @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation). When
7126 @var{guile-for-build} is omitted or is @code{#f}, the value of the
7127 @code{%guile-for-build} fluid is used instead.
7128
7129 See the @code{derivation} procedure for the meaning of
7130 @var{references-graphs}, @var{allowed-references},
7131 @var{disallowed-references}, @var{local-build?}, and
7132 @var{substitutable?}.
7133 @end deffn
7134
7135 @noindent
7136 Here's an example of a single-output derivation that creates a directory
7137 containing one file:
7138
7139 @lisp
7140 (let ((builder '(let ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out")))
7141 (mkdir out) ; create /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo
7142 (call-with-output-file (string-append out "/test")
7143 (lambda (p)
7144 (display '(hello guix) p))))))
7145 (build-expression->derivation store "goo" builder))
7146
7147 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo.drv => @dots{}>
7148 @end lisp
7149
7150
7151 @node The Store Monad
7152 @section The Store Monad
7153
7154 @cindex monad
7155
7156 The procedures that operate on the store described in the previous
7157 sections all take an open connection to the build daemon as their first
7158 argument. Although the underlying model is functional, they either have
7159 side effects or depend on the current state of the store.
7160
7161 The former is inconvenient: the connection to the build daemon has to be
7162 carried around in all those functions, making it impossible to compose
7163 functions that do not take that parameter with functions that do. The
7164 latter can be problematic: since store operations have side effects
7165 and/or depend on external state, they have to be properly sequenced.
7166
7167 @cindex monadic values
7168 @cindex monadic functions
7169 This is where the @code{(guix monads)} module comes in. This module
7170 provides a framework for working with @dfn{monads}, and a particularly
7171 useful monad for our uses, the @dfn{store monad}. Monads are a
7172 construct that allows two things: associating ``context'' with values
7173 (in our case, the context is the store), and building sequences of
7174 computations (here computations include accesses to the store). Values
7175 in a monad---values that carry this additional context---are called
7176 @dfn{monadic values}; procedures that return such values are called
7177 @dfn{monadic procedures}.
7178
7179 Consider this ``normal'' procedure:
7180
7181 @lisp
7182 (define (sh-symlink store)
7183 ;; Return a derivation that symlinks the 'bash' executable.
7184 (let* ((drv (package-derivation store bash))
7185 (out (derivation->output-path drv))
7186 (sh (string-append out "/bin/bash")))
7187 (build-expression->derivation store "sh"
7188 `(symlink ,sh %output))))
7189 @end lisp
7190
7191 Using @code{(guix monads)} and @code{(guix gexp)}, it may be rewritten
7192 as a monadic function:
7193
7194 @lisp
7195 (define (sh-symlink)
7196 ;; Same, but return a monadic value.
7197 (mlet %store-monad ((drv (package->derivation bash)))
7198 (gexp->derivation "sh"
7199 #~(symlink (string-append #$drv "/bin/bash")
7200 #$output))))
7201 @end lisp
7202
7203 There are several things to note in the second version: the @code{store}
7204 parameter is now implicit and is ``threaded'' in the calls to the
7205 @code{package->derivation} and @code{gexp->derivation} monadic
7206 procedures, and the monadic value returned by @code{package->derivation}
7207 is @dfn{bound} using @code{mlet} instead of plain @code{let}.
7208
7209 As it turns out, the call to @code{package->derivation} can even be
7210 omitted since it will take place implicitly, as we will see later
7211 (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
7212
7213 @lisp
7214 (define (sh-symlink)
7215 (gexp->derivation "sh"
7216 #~(symlink (string-append #$bash "/bin/bash")
7217 #$output)))
7218 @end lisp
7219
7220 @c See
7221 @c <https://syntaxexclamation.wordpress.com/2014/06/26/escaping-continuations/>
7222 @c for the funny quote.
7223 Calling the monadic @code{sh-symlink} has no effect. As someone once
7224 said, ``you exit a monad like you exit a building on fire: by running''.
7225 So, to exit the monad and get the desired effect, one must use
7226 @code{run-with-store}:
7227
7228 @lisp
7229 (run-with-store (open-connection) (sh-symlink))
7230 @result{} /gnu/store/...-sh-symlink
7231 @end lisp
7232
7233 Note that the @code{(guix monad-repl)} module extends the Guile REPL with
7234 new ``meta-commands'' to make it easier to deal with monadic procedures:
7235 @code{run-in-store}, and @code{enter-store-monad}. The former is used
7236 to ``run'' a single monadic value through the store:
7237
7238 @example
7239 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,run-in-store (package->derivation hello)
7240 $1 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
7241 @end example
7242
7243 The latter enters a recursive REPL, where all the return values are
7244 automatically run through the store:
7245
7246 @example
7247 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,enter-store-monad
7248 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (package->derivation hello)
7249 $2 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
7250 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (text-file "foo" "Hello!")
7251 $3 = "/gnu/store/@dots{}-foo"
7252 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> ,q
7253 scheme@@(guile-user)>
7254 @end example
7255
7256 @noindent
7257 Note that non-monadic values cannot be returned in the
7258 @code{store-monad} REPL.
7259
7260 The main syntactic forms to deal with monads in general are provided by
7261 the @code{(guix monads)} module and are described below.
7262
7263 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-monad @var{monad} @var{body} ...
7264 Evaluate any @code{>>=} or @code{return} forms in @var{body} as being
7265 in @var{monad}.
7266 @end deffn
7267
7268 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} return @var{val}
7269 Return a monadic value that encapsulates @var{val}.
7270 @end deffn
7271
7272 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} >>= @var{mval} @var{mproc} ...
7273 @dfn{Bind} monadic value @var{mval}, passing its ``contents'' to monadic
7274 procedures @var{mproc}@dots{}@footnote{This operation is commonly
7275 referred to as ``bind'', but that name denotes an unrelated procedure in
7276 Guile. Thus we use this somewhat cryptic symbol inherited from the
7277 Haskell language.}. There can be one @var{mproc} or several of them, as
7278 in this example:
7279
7280 @lisp
7281 (run-with-state
7282 (with-monad %state-monad
7283 (>>= (return 1)
7284 (lambda (x) (return (+ 1 x)))
7285 (lambda (x) (return (* 2 x)))))
7286 'some-state)
7287
7288 @result{} 4
7289 @result{} some-state
7290 @end lisp
7291 @end deffn
7292
7293 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} mlet @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
7294 @var{body} ...
7295 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} mlet* @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
7296 @var{body} ...
7297 Bind the variables @var{var} to the monadic values @var{mval} in
7298 @var{body}, which is a sequence of expressions. As with the bind
7299 operator, this can be thought of as ``unpacking'' the raw, non-monadic
7300 value ``contained'' in @var{mval} and making @var{var} refer to that
7301 raw, non-monadic value within the scope of the @var{body}. The form
7302 (@var{var} -> @var{val}) binds @var{var} to the ``normal'' value
7303 @var{val}, as per @code{let}. The binding operations occur in sequence
7304 from left to right. The last expression of @var{body} must be a monadic
7305 expression, and its result will become the result of the @code{mlet} or
7306 @code{mlet*} when run in the @var{monad}.
7307
7308 @code{mlet*} is to @code{mlet} what @code{let*} is to @code{let}
7309 (@pxref{Local Bindings,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
7310 @end deffn
7311
7312 @deffn {Scheme System} mbegin @var{monad} @var{mexp} ...
7313 Bind @var{mexp} and the following monadic expressions in sequence,
7314 returning the result of the last expression. Every expression in the
7315 sequence must be a monadic expression.
7316
7317 This is akin to @code{mlet}, except that the return values of the
7318 monadic expressions are ignored. In that sense, it is analogous to
7319 @code{begin}, but applied to monadic expressions.
7320 @end deffn
7321
7322 @deffn {Scheme System} mwhen @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
7323 When @var{condition} is true, evaluate the sequence of monadic
7324 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
7325 @var{condition} is false, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
7326 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
7327 @end deffn
7328
7329 @deffn {Scheme System} munless @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
7330 When @var{condition} is false, evaluate the sequence of monadic
7331 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
7332 @var{condition} is true, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
7333 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
7334 @end deffn
7335
7336 @cindex state monad
7337 The @code{(guix monads)} module provides the @dfn{state monad}, which
7338 allows an additional value---the state---to be @emph{threaded} through
7339 monadic procedure calls.
7340
7341 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %state-monad
7342 The state monad. Procedures in the state monad can access and change
7343 the state that is threaded.
7344
7345 Consider the example below. The @code{square} procedure returns a value
7346 in the state monad. It returns the square of its argument, but also
7347 increments the current state value:
7348
7349 @lisp
7350 (define (square x)
7351 (mlet %state-monad ((count (current-state)))
7352 (mbegin %state-monad
7353 (set-current-state (+ 1 count))
7354 (return (* x x)))))
7355
7356 (run-with-state (sequence %state-monad (map square (iota 3))) 0)
7357 @result{} (0 1 4)
7358 @result{} 3
7359 @end lisp
7360
7361 When ``run'' through @var{%state-monad}, we obtain that additional state
7362 value, which is the number of @code{square} calls.
7363 @end defvr
7364
7365 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} current-state
7366 Return the current state as a monadic value.
7367 @end deffn
7368
7369 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} set-current-state @var{value}
7370 Set the current state to @var{value} and return the previous state as a
7371 monadic value.
7372 @end deffn
7373
7374 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-push @var{value}
7375 Push @var{value} to the current state, which is assumed to be a list,
7376 and return the previous state as a monadic value.
7377 @end deffn
7378
7379 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-pop
7380 Pop a value from the current state and return it as a monadic value.
7381 The state is assumed to be a list.
7382 @end deffn
7383
7384 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-state @var{mval} [@var{state}]
7385 Run monadic value @var{mval} starting with @var{state} as the initial
7386 state. Return two values: the resulting value, and the resulting state.
7387 @end deffn
7388
7389 The main interface to the store monad, provided by the @code{(guix
7390 store)} module, is as follows.
7391
7392 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %store-monad
7393 The store monad---an alias for @var{%state-monad}.
7394
7395 Values in the store monad encapsulate accesses to the store. When its
7396 effect is needed, a value of the store monad must be ``evaluated'' by
7397 passing it to the @code{run-with-store} procedure (see below.)
7398 @end defvr
7399
7400 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-store @var{store} @var{mval} [#:guile-for-build] [#:system (%current-system)]
7401 Run @var{mval}, a monadic value in the store monad, in @var{store}, an
7402 open store connection.
7403 @end deffn
7404
7405 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
7406 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
7407 containing @var{text}, a string. @var{references} is a list of store items that the
7408 resulting text file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
7409 @end deffn
7410
7411 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} binary-file @var{name} @var{data} [@var{references}]
7412 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
7413 containing @var{data}, a bytevector. @var{references} is a list of store
7414 items that the resulting binary file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
7415 @end deffn
7416
7417 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} interned-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
7418 [#:recursive? #t] [#:select? (const #t)]
7419 Return the name of @var{file} once interned in the store. Use
7420 @var{name} as its store name, or the basename of @var{file} if
7421 @var{name} is omitted.
7422
7423 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added
7424 recursively; if @var{file} designates a flat file and @var{recursive?}
7425 is true, its contents are added, and its permission bits are kept.
7426
7427 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
7428 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
7429 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
7430 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
7431
7432 The example below adds a file to the store, under two different names:
7433
7434 @lisp
7435 (run-with-store (open-connection)
7436 (mlet %store-monad ((a (interned-file "README"))
7437 (b (interned-file "README" "LEGU-MIN")))
7438 (return (list a b))))
7439
7440 @result{} ("/gnu/store/rwm@dots{}-README" "/gnu/store/44i@dots{}-LEGU-MIN")
7441 @end lisp
7442
7443 @end deffn
7444
7445 The @code{(guix packages)} module exports the following package-related
7446 monadic procedures:
7447
7448 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package-file @var{package} [@var{file}] @
7449 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] @
7450 [#:output "out"]
7451 Return as a monadic
7452 value in the absolute file name of @var{file} within the @var{output}
7453 directory of @var{package}. When @var{file} is omitted, return the name
7454 of the @var{output} directory of @var{package}. When @var{target} is
7455 true, use it as a cross-compilation target triplet.
7456 @end deffn
7457
7458 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package->derivation @var{package} [@var{system}]
7459 @deffnx {Monadic Procedure} package->cross-derivation @var{package} @
7460 @var{target} [@var{system}]
7461 Monadic version of @code{package-derivation} and
7462 @code{package-cross-derivation} (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
7463 @end deffn
7464
7465
7466 @node G-Expressions
7467 @section G-Expressions
7468
7469 @cindex G-expression
7470 @cindex build code quoting
7471 So we have ``derivations'', which represent a sequence of build actions
7472 to be performed to produce an item in the store (@pxref{Derivations}).
7473 These build actions are performed when asking the daemon to actually
7474 build the derivations; they are run by the daemon in a container
7475 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
7476
7477 @cindex strata of code
7478 It should come as no surprise that we like to write these build actions
7479 in Scheme. When we do that, we end up with two @dfn{strata} of Scheme
7480 code@footnote{The term @dfn{stratum} in this context was coined by
7481 Manuel Serrano et al.@: in the context of their work on Hop. Oleg
7482 Kiselyov, who has written insightful
7483 @url{http://okmij.org/ftp/meta-programming/#meta-scheme, essays and code
7484 on this topic}, refers to this kind of code generation as
7485 @dfn{staging}.}: the ``host code''---code that defines packages, talks
7486 to the daemon, etc.---and the ``build code''---code that actually
7487 performs build actions, such as making directories, invoking
7488 @command{make}, etc.
7489
7490 To describe a derivation and its build actions, one typically needs to
7491 embed build code inside host code. It boils down to manipulating build
7492 code as data, and the homoiconicity of Scheme---code has a direct
7493 representation as data---comes in handy for that. But we need more than
7494 the normal @code{quasiquote} mechanism in Scheme to construct build
7495 expressions.
7496
7497 The @code{(guix gexp)} module implements @dfn{G-expressions}, a form of
7498 S-expressions adapted to build expressions. G-expressions, or
7499 @dfn{gexps}, consist essentially of three syntactic forms: @code{gexp},
7500 @code{ungexp}, and @code{ungexp-splicing} (or simply: @code{#~},
7501 @code{#$}, and @code{#$@@}), which are comparable to
7502 @code{quasiquote}, @code{unquote}, and @code{unquote-splicing},
7503 respectively (@pxref{Expression Syntax, @code{quasiquote},, guile,
7504 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). However, there are major differences:
7505
7506 @itemize
7507 @item
7508 Gexps are meant to be written to a file and run or manipulated by other
7509 processes.
7510
7511 @item
7512 When a high-level object such as a package or derivation is unquoted
7513 inside a gexp, the result is as if its output file name had been
7514 introduced.
7515
7516 @item
7517 Gexps carry information about the packages or derivations they refer to,
7518 and these dependencies are automatically added as inputs to the build
7519 processes that use them.
7520 @end itemize
7521
7522 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
7523 This mechanism is not limited to package and derivation
7524 objects: @dfn{compilers} able to ``lower'' other high-level objects to
7525 derivations or files in the store can be defined,
7526 such that these objects can also be inserted
7527 into gexps. For example, a useful type of high-level objects that can be
7528 inserted in a gexp is ``file-like objects'', which make it easy to
7529 add files to the store and to refer to them in
7530 derivations and such (see @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}
7531 below.)
7532
7533 To illustrate the idea, here is an example of a gexp:
7534
7535 @lisp
7536 (define build-exp
7537 #~(begin
7538 (mkdir #$output)
7539 (chdir #$output)
7540 (symlink (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
7541 "list-files")))
7542 @end lisp
7543
7544 This gexp can be passed to @code{gexp->derivation}; we obtain a
7545 derivation that builds a directory containing exactly one symlink to
7546 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22/bin/ls}:
7547
7548 @lisp
7549 (gexp->derivation "the-thing" build-exp)
7550 @end lisp
7551
7552 As one would expect, the @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"} string is
7553 substituted to the reference to the @var{coreutils} package in the
7554 actual build code, and @var{coreutils} is automatically made an input to
7555 the derivation. Likewise, @code{#$output} (equivalent to @code{(ungexp
7556 output)}) is replaced by a string containing the directory name of the
7557 output of the derivation.
7558
7559 @cindex cross compilation
7560 In a cross-compilation context, it is useful to distinguish between
7561 references to the @emph{native} build of a package---that can run on the
7562 host---versus references to cross builds of a package. To that end, the
7563 @code{#+} plays the same role as @code{#$}, but is a reference to a
7564 native package build:
7565
7566 @lisp
7567 (gexp->derivation "vi"
7568 #~(begin
7569 (mkdir #$output)
7570 (mkdir (string-append #$output "/bin"))
7571 (system* (string-append #+coreutils "/bin/ln")
7572 "-s"
7573 (string-append #$emacs "/bin/emacs")
7574 (string-append #$output "/bin/vi")))
7575 #:target "mips64el-linux-gnu")
7576 @end lisp
7577
7578 @noindent
7579 In the example above, the native build of @var{coreutils} is used, so
7580 that @command{ln} can actually run on the host; but then the
7581 cross-compiled build of @var{emacs} is referenced.
7582
7583 @cindex imported modules, for gexps
7584 @findex with-imported-modules
7585 Another gexp feature is @dfn{imported modules}: sometimes you want to be
7586 able to use certain Guile modules from the ``host environment'' in the
7587 gexp, so those modules should be imported in the ``build environment''.
7588 The @code{with-imported-modules} form allows you to express that:
7589
7590 @lisp
7591 (let ((build (with-imported-modules '((guix build utils))
7592 #~(begin
7593 (use-modules (guix build utils))
7594 (mkdir-p (string-append #$output "/bin"))))))
7595 (gexp->derivation "empty-dir"
7596 #~(begin
7597 #$build
7598 (display "success!\n")
7599 #t)))
7600 @end lisp
7601
7602 @noindent
7603 In this example, the @code{(guix build utils)} module is automatically
7604 pulled into the isolated build environment of our gexp, such that
7605 @code{(use-modules (guix build utils))} works as expected.
7606
7607 @cindex module closure
7608 @findex source-module-closure
7609 Usually you want the @emph{closure} of the module to be imported---i.e.,
7610 the module itself and all the modules it depends on---rather than just
7611 the module; failing to do that, attempts to use the module will fail
7612 because of missing dependent modules. The @code{source-module-closure}
7613 procedure computes the closure of a module by looking at its source file
7614 headers, which comes in handy in this case:
7615
7616 @lisp
7617 (use-modules (guix modules)) ;for 'source-module-closure'
7618
7619 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
7620 '((guix build utils)
7621 (gnu build vm)))
7622 (gexp->derivation "something-with-vms"
7623 #~(begin
7624 (use-modules (guix build utils)
7625 (gnu build vm))
7626 @dots{})))
7627 @end lisp
7628
7629 @cindex extensions, for gexps
7630 @findex with-extensions
7631 In the same vein, sometimes you want to import not just pure-Scheme
7632 modules, but also ``extensions'' such as Guile bindings to C libraries
7633 or other ``full-blown'' packages. Say you need the @code{guile-json}
7634 package available on the build side, here's how you would do it:
7635
7636 @lisp
7637 (use-modules (gnu packages guile)) ;for 'guile-json'
7638
7639 (with-extensions (list guile-json)
7640 (gexp->derivation "something-with-json"
7641 #~(begin
7642 (use-modules (json))
7643 @dots{})))
7644 @end lisp
7645
7646 The syntactic form to construct gexps is summarized below.
7647
7648 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} #~@var{exp}
7649 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} (gexp @var{exp})
7650 Return a G-expression containing @var{exp}. @var{exp} may contain one
7651 or more of the following forms:
7652
7653 @table @code
7654 @item #$@var{obj}
7655 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj})
7656 Introduce a reference to @var{obj}. @var{obj} may have one of the
7657 supported types, for example a package or a
7658 derivation, in which case the @code{ungexp} form is replaced by its
7659 output file name---e.g., @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22}.
7660
7661 If @var{obj} is a list, it is traversed and references to supported
7662 objects are substituted similarly.
7663
7664 If @var{obj} is another gexp, its contents are inserted and its
7665 dependencies are added to those of the containing gexp.
7666
7667 If @var{obj} is another kind of object, it is inserted as is.
7668
7669 @item #$@var{obj}:@var{output}
7670 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj} @var{output})
7671 This is like the form above, but referring explicitly to the
7672 @var{output} of @var{obj}---this is useful when @var{obj} produces
7673 multiple outputs (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
7674
7675 @item #+@var{obj}
7676 @itemx #+@var{obj}:output
7677 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj})
7678 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj} @var{output})
7679 Same as @code{ungexp}, but produces a reference to the @emph{native}
7680 build of @var{obj} when used in a cross compilation context.
7681
7682 @item #$output[:@var{output}]
7683 @itemx (ungexp output [@var{output}])
7684 Insert a reference to derivation output @var{output}, or to the main
7685 output when @var{output} is omitted.
7686
7687 This only makes sense for gexps passed to @code{gexp->derivation}.
7688
7689 @item #$@@@var{lst}
7690 @itemx (ungexp-splicing @var{lst})
7691 Like the above, but splices the contents of @var{lst} inside the
7692 containing list.
7693
7694 @item #+@@@var{lst}
7695 @itemx (ungexp-native-splicing @var{lst})
7696 Like the above, but refers to native builds of the objects listed in
7697 @var{lst}.
7698
7699 @end table
7700
7701 G-expressions created by @code{gexp} or @code{#~} are run-time objects
7702 of the @code{gexp?} type (see below.)
7703 @end deffn
7704
7705 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-imported-modules @var{modules} @var{body}@dots{}
7706 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring @var{modules}
7707 in their execution environment.
7708
7709 Each item in @var{modules} can be the name of a module, such as
7710 @code{(guix build utils)}, or it can be a module name, followed by an
7711 arrow, followed by a file-like object:
7712
7713 @lisp
7714 `((guix build utils)
7715 (guix gcrypt)
7716 ((guix config) => ,(scheme-file "config.scm"
7717 #~(define-module @dots{}))))
7718 @end lisp
7719
7720 @noindent
7721 In the example above, the first two modules are taken from the search
7722 path, and the last one is created from the given file-like object.
7723
7724 This form has @emph{lexical} scope: it has an effect on the gexps
7725 directly defined in @var{body}@dots{}, but not on those defined, say, in
7726 procedures called from @var{body}@dots{}.
7727 @end deffn
7728
7729 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-extensions @var{extensions} @var{body}@dots{}
7730 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring
7731 @var{extensions} in their build and execution environment.
7732 @var{extensions} is typically a list of package objects such as those
7733 defined in the @code{(gnu packages guile)} module.
7734
7735 Concretely, the packages listed in @var{extensions} are added to the
7736 load path while compiling imported modules in @var{body}@dots{}; they
7737 are also added to the load path of the gexp returned by
7738 @var{body}@dots{}.
7739 @end deffn
7740
7741 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gexp? @var{obj}
7742 Return @code{#t} if @var{obj} is a G-expression.
7743 @end deffn
7744
7745 G-expressions are meant to be written to disk, either as code building
7746 some derivation, or as plain files in the store. The monadic procedures
7747 below allow you to do that (@pxref{The Store Monad}, for more
7748 information about monads.)
7749
7750 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->derivation @var{name} @var{exp} @
7751 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] [#:graft? #t] @
7752 [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
7753 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
7754 [#:module-path @var{%load-path}] @
7755 [#:effective-version "2.2"] @
7756 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
7757 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
7758 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] @
7759 [#:script-name (string-append @var{name} "-builder")] @
7760 [#:deprecation-warnings #f] @
7761 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] @
7762 [#:properties '()] [#:guile-for-build #f]
7763 Return a derivation @var{name} that runs @var{exp} (a gexp) with
7764 @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation) on @var{system}; @var{exp} is
7765 stored in a file called @var{script-name}. When @var{target} is true,
7766 it is used as the cross-compilation target triplet for packages referred
7767 to by @var{exp}.
7768
7769 @var{modules} is deprecated in favor of @code{with-imported-modules}.
7770 Its meaning is to
7771 make @var{modules} available in the evaluation context of @var{exp};
7772 @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile modules searched in
7773 @var{module-path} to be copied in the store, compiled, and made available in
7774 the load path during the execution of @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix
7775 build utils) (guix build gnu-build-system))}.
7776
7777 @var{effective-version} determines the string to use when adding extensions of
7778 @var{exp} (see @code{with-extensions}) to the search path---e.g., @code{"2.2"}.
7779
7780 @var{graft?} determines whether packages referred to by @var{exp} should be grafted when
7781 applicable.
7782
7783 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of tuples of one of the
7784 following forms:
7785
7786 @example
7787 (@var{file-name} @var{package})
7788 (@var{file-name} @var{package} @var{output})
7789 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation})
7790 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation} @var{output})
7791 (@var{file-name} @var{store-item})
7792 @end example
7793
7794 The right-hand-side of each element of @var{references-graphs} is automatically made
7795 an input of the build process of @var{exp}. In the build environment, each
7796 @var{file-name} contains the reference graph of the corresponding item, in a simple
7797 text format.
7798
7799 @var{allowed-references} must be either @code{#f} or a list of output names and packages.
7800 In the latter case, the list denotes store items that the result is allowed to
7801 refer to. Any reference to another store item will lead to a build error.
7802 Similarly for @var{disallowed-references}, which can list items that must not be
7803 referenced by the outputs.
7804
7805 @var{deprecation-warnings} determines whether to show deprecation warnings while
7806 compiling modules. It can be @code{#f}, @code{#t}, or @code{'detailed}.
7807
7808 The other arguments are as for @code{derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
7809 @end deffn
7810
7811 @cindex file-like objects
7812 The @code{local-file}, @code{plain-file}, @code{computed-file},
7813 @code{program-file}, and @code{scheme-file} procedures below return
7814 @dfn{file-like objects}. That is, when unquoted in a G-expression,
7815 these objects lead to a file in the store. Consider this G-expression:
7816
7817 @lisp
7818 #~(system* #$(file-append glibc "/sbin/nscd") "-f"
7819 #$(local-file "/tmp/my-nscd.conf"))
7820 @end lisp
7821
7822 The effect here is to ``intern'' @file{/tmp/my-nscd.conf} by copying it
7823 to the store. Once expanded, for instance @i{via}
7824 @code{gexp->derivation}, the G-expression refers to that copy under
7825 @file{/gnu/store}; thus, modifying or removing the file in @file{/tmp}
7826 does not have any effect on what the G-expression does.
7827 @code{plain-file} can be used similarly; it differs in that the file
7828 content is directly passed as a string.
7829
7830 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} local-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
7831 [#:recursive? #f] [#:select? (const #t)]
7832 Return an object representing local file @var{file} to add to the store;
7833 this object can be used in a gexp. If @var{file} is a literal string
7834 denoting a relative file name, it is looked up relative to the source
7835 file where it appears; if @var{file} is not a literal string, it is
7836 looked up relative to the current working directory at run time.
7837 @var{file} will be added to the store under @var{name}--by default the
7838 base name of @var{file}.
7839
7840 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added recursively; if @var{file}
7841 designates a flat file and @var{recursive?} is true, its contents are added, and its
7842 permission bits are kept.
7843
7844 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
7845 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
7846 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
7847 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
7848
7849 This is the declarative counterpart of the @code{interned-file} monadic
7850 procedure (@pxref{The Store Monad, @code{interned-file}}).
7851 @end deffn
7852
7853 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} plain-file @var{name} @var{content}
7854 Return an object representing a text file called @var{name} with the given
7855 @var{content} (a string or a bytevector) to be added to the store.
7856
7857 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file}.
7858 @end deffn
7859
7860 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} computed-file @var{name} @var{gexp} @
7861 [#:options '(#:local-build? #t)]
7862 Return an object representing the store item @var{name}, a file or
7863 directory computed by @var{gexp}. @var{options}
7864 is a list of additional arguments to pass to @code{gexp->derivation}.
7865
7866 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->derivation}.
7867 @end deffn
7868
7869 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->script @var{name} @var{exp} @
7870 [#:guile (default-guile)] [#:module-path %load-path] @
7871 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f]
7872 Return an executable script @var{name} that runs @var{exp} using
7873 @var{guile}, with @var{exp}'s imported modules in its search path.
7874 Look up @var{exp}'s modules in @var{module-path}.
7875
7876 The example below builds a script that simply invokes the @command{ls}
7877 command:
7878
7879 @lisp
7880 (use-modules (guix gexp) (gnu packages base))
7881
7882 (gexp->script "list-files"
7883 #~(execl #$(file-append coreutils "/bin/ls")
7884 "ls"))
7885 @end lisp
7886
7887 When ``running'' it through the store (@pxref{The Store Monad,
7888 @code{run-with-store}}), we obtain a derivation that produces an
7889 executable file @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-list-files} along these lines:
7890
7891 @example
7892 #!/gnu/store/@dots{}-guile-2.0.11/bin/guile -ds
7893 !#
7894 (execl "/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"/bin/ls" "ls")
7895 @end example
7896 @end deffn
7897
7898 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} program-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
7899 [#:guile #f] [#:module-path %load-path]
7900 Return an object representing the executable store item @var{name} that
7901 runs @var{gexp}. @var{guile} is the Guile package used to execute that
7902 script. Imported modules of @var{gexp} are looked up in @var{module-path}.
7903
7904 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->script}.
7905 @end deffn
7906
7907 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->file @var{name} @var{exp} @
7908 [#:set-load-path? #t] [#:module-path %load-path] @
7909 [#:splice? #f] @
7910 [#:guile (default-guile)]
7911 Return a derivation that builds a file @var{name} containing @var{exp}.
7912 When @var{splice?} is true, @var{exp} is considered to be a list of
7913 expressions that will be spliced in the resulting file.
7914
7915 When @var{set-load-path?} is true, emit code in the resulting file to
7916 set @code{%load-path} and @code{%load-compiled-path} to honor
7917 @var{exp}'s imported modules. Look up @var{exp}'s modules in
7918 @var{module-path}.
7919
7920 The resulting file holds references to all the dependencies of @var{exp}
7921 or a subset thereof.
7922 @end deffn
7923
7924 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} scheme-file @var{name} @var{exp} [#:splice? #f]
7925 Return an object representing the Scheme file @var{name} that contains
7926 @var{exp}.
7927
7928 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->file}.
7929 @end deffn
7930
7931 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file* @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
7932 Return as a monadic value a derivation that builds a text file
7933 containing all of @var{text}. @var{text} may list, in addition to
7934 strings, objects of any type that can be used in a gexp: packages,
7935 derivations, local file objects, etc. The resulting store file holds
7936 references to all these.
7937
7938 This variant should be preferred over @code{text-file} anytime the file
7939 to create will reference items from the store. This is typically the
7940 case when building a configuration file that embeds store file names,
7941 like this:
7942
7943 @lisp
7944 (define (profile.sh)
7945 ;; Return the name of a shell script in the store that
7946 ;; initializes the 'PATH' environment variable.
7947 (text-file* "profile.sh"
7948 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:"
7949 grep "/bin:" sed "/bin\n"))
7950 @end lisp
7951
7952 In this example, the resulting @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile.sh} file
7953 will reference @var{coreutils}, @var{grep}, and @var{sed}, thereby
7954 preventing them from being garbage-collected during its lifetime.
7955 @end deffn
7956
7957 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mixed-text-file @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
7958 Return an object representing store file @var{name} containing
7959 @var{text}. @var{text} is a sequence of strings and file-like objects,
7960 as in:
7961
7962 @lisp
7963 (mixed-text-file "profile"
7964 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:" grep "/bin")
7965 @end lisp
7966
7967 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file*}.
7968 @end deffn
7969
7970 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-union @var{name} @var{files}
7971 Return a @code{<computed-file>} that builds a directory containing all of @var{files}.
7972 Each item in @var{files} must be a two-element list where the first element is the
7973 file name to use in the new directory, and the second element is a gexp
7974 denoting the target file. Here's an example:
7975
7976 @lisp
7977 (file-union "etc"
7978 `(("hosts" ,(plain-file "hosts"
7979 "127.0.0.1 localhost"))
7980 ("bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc"
7981 "alias ls='ls --color=auto'"))))
7982 @end lisp
7983
7984 This yields an @code{etc} directory containing these two files.
7985 @end deffn
7986
7987 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} directory-union @var{name} @var{things}
7988 Return a directory that is the union of @var{things}, where @var{things} is a list of
7989 file-like objects denoting directories. For example:
7990
7991 @lisp
7992 (directory-union "guile+emacs" (list guile emacs))
7993 @end lisp
7994
7995 yields a directory that is the union of the @code{guile} and @code{emacs} packages.
7996 @end deffn
7997
7998 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-append @var{obj} @var{suffix} @dots{}
7999 Return a file-like object that expands to the concatenation of @var{obj}
8000 and @var{suffix}, where @var{obj} is a lowerable object and each
8001 @var{suffix} is a string.
8002
8003 As an example, consider this gexp:
8004
8005 @lisp
8006 (gexp->script "run-uname"
8007 #~(system* #$(file-append coreutils
8008 "/bin/uname")))
8009 @end lisp
8010
8011 The same effect could be achieved with:
8012
8013 @lisp
8014 (gexp->script "run-uname"
8015 #~(system* (string-append #$coreutils
8016 "/bin/uname")))
8017 @end lisp
8018
8019 There is one difference though: in the @code{file-append} case, the
8020 resulting script contains the absolute file name as a string, whereas in
8021 the second case, the resulting script contains a @code{(string-append
8022 @dots{})} expression to construct the file name @emph{at run time}.
8023 @end deffn
8024
8025 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-parameters ((@var{parameter} @var{value}) @dots{}) @var{exp}
8026 This macro is similar to the @code{parameterize} form for
8027 dynamically-bound @dfn{parameters} (@pxref{Parameters,,, guile, GNU
8028 Guile Reference Manual}). The key difference is that it takes effect
8029 when the file-like object returned by @var{exp} is lowered to a
8030 derivation or store item.
8031
8032 A typical use of @code{with-parameters} is to force the system in effect
8033 for a given object:
8034
8035 @lisp
8036 (with-parameters ((%current-system "i686-linux"))
8037 coreutils)
8038 @end lisp
8039
8040 The example above returns an object that corresponds to the i686 build
8041 of Coreutils, regardless of the current value of @code{%current-system}.
8042 @end deffn
8043
8044
8045 Of course, in addition to gexps embedded in ``host'' code, there are
8046 also modules containing build tools. To make it clear that they are
8047 meant to be used in the build stratum, these modules are kept in the
8048 @code{(guix build @dots{})} name space.
8049
8050 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
8051 Internally, high-level objects are @dfn{lowered}, using their compiler,
8052 to either derivations or store items. For instance, lowering a package
8053 yields a derivation, and lowering a @code{plain-file} yields a store
8054 item. This is achieved using the @code{lower-object} monadic procedure.
8055
8056 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} lower-object @var{obj} [@var{system}] @
8057 [#:target #f]
8058 Return as a value in @var{%store-monad} the derivation or store item
8059 corresponding to @var{obj} for @var{system}, cross-compiling for
8060 @var{target} if @var{target} is true. @var{obj} must be an object that
8061 has an associated gexp compiler, such as a @code{<package>}.
8062 @end deffn
8063
8064 @node Invoking guix repl
8065 @section Invoking @command{guix repl}
8066
8067 @cindex REPL, read-eval-print loop
8068 The @command{guix repl} command spawns a Guile @dfn{read-eval-print loop}
8069 (REPL) for interactive programming (@pxref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile,
8070 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). Compared to just launching the @command{guile}
8071 command, @command{guix repl} guarantees that all the Guix modules and all its
8072 dependencies are available in the search path. You can use it this way:
8073
8074 @example
8075 $ guix repl
8076 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,use (gnu packages base)
8077 scheme@@(guile-user)> coreutils
8078 $1 = #<package coreutils@@8.29 gnu/packages/base.scm:327 3e28300>
8079 @end example
8080
8081 @cindex inferiors
8082 In addition, @command{guix repl} implements a simple machine-readable REPL
8083 protocol for use by @code{(guix inferior)}, a facility to interact with
8084 @dfn{inferiors}, separate processes running a potentially different revision
8085 of Guix.
8086
8087 The available options are as follows:
8088
8089 @table @code
8090 @item --type=@var{type}
8091 @itemx -t @var{type}
8092 Start a REPL of the given @var{TYPE}, which can be one of the following:
8093
8094 @table @code
8095 @item guile
8096 This is default, and it spawns a standard full-featured Guile REPL.
8097 @item machine
8098 Spawn a REPL that uses the machine-readable protocol. This is the protocol
8099 that the @code{(guix inferior)} module speaks.
8100 @end table
8101
8102 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
8103 By default, @command{guix repl} reads from standard input and writes to
8104 standard output. When this option is passed, it will instead listen for
8105 connections on @var{endpoint}. Here are examples of valid options:
8106
8107 @table @code
8108 @item --listen=tcp:37146
8109 Accept connections on localhost on port 37146.
8110
8111 @item --listen=unix:/tmp/socket
8112 Accept connections on the Unix-domain socket @file{/tmp/socket}.
8113 @end table
8114
8115 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
8116 @itemx -L @var{directory}
8117 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
8118 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
8119
8120 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
8121 the command-line tool.
8122
8123 @item -q
8124 Inhibit loading of the @file{~/.guile} file. By default, that
8125 configuration file is loaded when spawning a @code{guile} REPL.
8126 @end table
8127
8128 @c *********************************************************************
8129 @node Utilities
8130 @chapter Utilities
8131
8132 This section describes Guix command-line utilities. Some of them are
8133 primarily targeted at developers and users who write new package
8134 definitions, while others are more generally useful. They complement
8135 the Scheme programming interface of Guix in a convenient way.
8136
8137 @menu
8138 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
8139 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
8140 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
8141 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
8142 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
8143 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
8144 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
8145 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
8146 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
8147 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
8148 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
8149 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
8150 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
8151 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
8152 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
8153 @end menu
8154
8155 @node Invoking guix build
8156 @section Invoking @command{guix build}
8157
8158 @cindex package building
8159 @cindex @command{guix build}
8160 The @command{guix build} command builds packages or derivations and
8161 their dependencies, and prints the resulting store paths. Note that it
8162 does not modify the user's profile---this is the job of the
8163 @command{guix package} command (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). Thus,
8164 it is mainly useful for distribution developers.
8165
8166 The general syntax is:
8167
8168 @example
8169 guix build @var{options} @var{package-or-derivation}@dots{}
8170 @end example
8171
8172 As an example, the following command builds the latest versions of Emacs
8173 and of Guile, displays their build logs, and finally displays the
8174 resulting directories:
8175
8176 @example
8177 guix build emacs guile
8178 @end example
8179
8180 Similarly, the following command builds all the available packages:
8181
8182 @example
8183 guix build --quiet --keep-going \
8184 `guix package -A | cut -f1,2 --output-delimiter=@@`
8185 @end example
8186
8187 @var{package-or-derivation} may be either the name of a package found in
8188 the software distribution such as @code{coreutils} or
8189 @code{coreutils@@8.20}, or a derivation such as
8190 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.19.drv}. In the former case, a
8191 package with the corresponding name (and optionally version) is searched
8192 for among the GNU distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
8193
8194 Alternatively, the @code{--expression} option may be used to specify a
8195 Scheme expression that evaluates to a package; this is useful when
8196 disambiguating among several same-named packages or package variants is
8197 needed.
8198
8199 There may be zero or more @var{options}. The available options are
8200 described in the subsections below.
8201
8202 @menu
8203 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
8204 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
8205 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
8206 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
8207 @end menu
8208
8209 @node Common Build Options
8210 @subsection Common Build Options
8211
8212 A number of options that control the build process are common to
8213 @command{guix build} and other commands that can spawn builds, such as
8214 @command{guix package} or @command{guix archive}. These are the
8215 following:
8216
8217 @table @code
8218
8219 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
8220 @itemx -L @var{directory}
8221 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
8222 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
8223
8224 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
8225 the command-line tools.
8226
8227 @item --keep-failed
8228 @itemx -K
8229 Keep the build tree of failed builds. Thus, if a build fails, its build
8230 tree is kept under @file{/tmp}, in a directory whose name is shown at
8231 the end of the build log. This is useful when debugging build issues.
8232 @xref{Debugging Build Failures}, for tips and tricks on how to debug
8233 build issues.
8234
8235 This option implies @option{--no-offload}, and it has no effect when
8236 connecting to a remote daemon with a @code{guix://} URI (@pxref{The
8237 Store, the @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} variable}).
8238
8239 @item --keep-going
8240 @itemx -k
8241 Keep going when some of the derivations fail to build; return only once
8242 all the builds have either completed or failed.
8243
8244 The default behavior is to stop as soon as one of the specified
8245 derivations has failed.
8246
8247 @item --dry-run
8248 @itemx -n
8249 Do not build the derivations.
8250
8251 @anchor{fallback-option}
8252 @item --fallback
8253 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
8254 packages locally (@pxref{Substitution Failure}).
8255
8256 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
8257 @anchor{client-substitute-urls}
8258 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
8259 URLs, overriding the default list of URLs of @command{guix-daemon}
8260 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @command{guix-daemon} URLs}).
8261
8262 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, provided
8263 they are signed by a key authorized by the system administrator
8264 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
8265
8266 When @var{urls} is the empty string, substitutes are effectively
8267 disabled.
8268
8269 @item --no-substitutes
8270 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
8271 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
8272 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
8273
8274 @item --no-grafts
8275 Do not ``graft'' packages. In practice, this means that package updates
8276 available as grafts are not applied. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
8277 information on grafts.
8278
8279 @item --rounds=@var{n}
8280 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
8281 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical.
8282
8283 This is a useful way to detect non-deterministic builds processes.
8284 Non-deterministic build processes are a problem because they make it
8285 practically impossible for users to @emph{verify} whether third-party
8286 binaries are genuine. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more.
8287
8288 Note that, currently, the differing build results are not kept around,
8289 so you will have to manually investigate in case of an error---e.g., by
8290 stashing one of the build results with @code{guix archive --export}
8291 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}), then rebuilding, and finally comparing
8292 the two results.
8293
8294 @item --no-offload
8295 Do not use offload builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload
8296 Setup}). That is, always build things locally instead of offloading
8297 builds to remote machines.
8298
8299 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
8300 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
8301 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
8302
8303 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
8304 guix-daemon, @code{--max-silent-time}}).
8305
8306 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
8307 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
8308 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
8309
8310 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
8311 guix-daemon, @code{--timeout}}).
8312
8313 @c Note: This option is actually not part of %standard-build-options but
8314 @c most programs honor it.
8315 @cindex verbosity, of the command-line tools
8316 @cindex build logs, verbosity
8317 @item -v @var{level}
8318 @itemx --verbosity=@var{level}
8319 Use the given verbosity @var{level}, an integer. Choosing 0 means that no
8320 output is produced, 1 is for quiet output, and 2 shows all the build log
8321 output on standard error.
8322
8323 @item --cores=@var{n}
8324 @itemx -c @var{n}
8325 Allow the use of up to @var{n} CPU cores for the build. The special
8326 value @code{0} means to use as many CPU cores as available.
8327
8328 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
8329 @itemx -M @var{n}
8330 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. @xref{Invoking
8331 guix-daemon, @code{--max-jobs}}, for details about this option and the
8332 equivalent @command{guix-daemon} option.
8333
8334 @item --debug=@var{level}
8335 Produce debugging output coming from the build daemon. @var{level} must be an
8336 integer between 0 and 5; higher means more verbose output. Setting a level of
8337 4 or more may be helpful when debugging setup issues with the build daemon.
8338
8339 @end table
8340
8341 Behind the scenes, @command{guix build} is essentially an interface to
8342 the @code{package-derivation} procedure of the @code{(guix packages)}
8343 module, and to the @code{build-derivations} procedure of the @code{(guix
8344 derivations)} module.
8345
8346 In addition to options explicitly passed on the command line,
8347 @command{guix build} and other @command{guix} commands that support
8348 building honor the @code{GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS} environment variable.
8349
8350 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS
8351 Users can define this variable to a list of command line options that
8352 will automatically be used by @command{guix build} and other
8353 @command{guix} commands that can perform builds, as in the example
8354 below:
8355
8356 @example
8357 $ export GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS="--no-substitutes -c 2 -L /foo/bar"
8358 @end example
8359
8360 These options are parsed independently, and the result is appended to
8361 the parsed command-line options.
8362 @end defvr
8363
8364
8365 @node Package Transformation Options
8366 @subsection Package Transformation Options
8367
8368 @cindex package variants
8369 Another set of command-line options supported by @command{guix build}
8370 and also @command{guix package} are @dfn{package transformation
8371 options}. These are options that make it possible to define @dfn{package
8372 variants}---for instance, packages built from different source code.
8373 This is a convenient way to create customized packages on the fly
8374 without having to type in the definitions of package variants
8375 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
8376
8377 @table @code
8378
8379 @item --with-source=@var{source}
8380 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}=@var{source}
8381 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}@@@var{version}=@var{source}
8382 Use @var{source} as the source of @var{package}, and @var{version} as
8383 its version number.
8384 @var{source} must be a file name or a URL, as for @command{guix
8385 download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}).
8386
8387 When @var{package} is omitted,
8388 it is taken to be the package name specified on the
8389 command line that matches the base of @var{source}---e.g.,
8390 if @var{source} is @code{/src/guile-2.0.10.tar.gz}, the corresponding
8391 package is @code{guile}.
8392
8393 Likewise, when @var{version} is omitted, the version string is inferred from
8394 @var{source}; in the previous example, it is @code{2.0.10}.
8395
8396 This option allows users to try out versions of packages other than the
8397 one provided by the distribution. The example below downloads
8398 @file{ed-1.7.tar.gz} from a GNU mirror and uses that as the source for
8399 the @code{ed} package:
8400
8401 @example
8402 guix build ed --with-source=mirror://gnu/ed/ed-1.7.tar.gz
8403 @end example
8404
8405 As a developer, @code{--with-source} makes it easy to test release
8406 candidates:
8407
8408 @example
8409 guix build guile --with-source=../guile-2.0.9.219-e1bb7.tar.xz
8410 @end example
8411
8412 @dots{} or to build from a checkout in a pristine environment:
8413
8414 @example
8415 $ git clone git://git.sv.gnu.org/guix.git
8416 $ guix build guix --with-source=guix@@1.0=./guix
8417 @end example
8418
8419 @item --with-input=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
8420 Replace dependency on @var{package} by a dependency on
8421 @var{replacement}. @var{package} must be a package name, and
8422 @var{replacement} must be a package specification such as @code{guile}
8423 or @code{guile@@1.8}.
8424
8425 For instance, the following command builds Guix, but replaces its
8426 dependency on the current stable version of Guile with a dependency on
8427 the legacy version of Guile, @code{guile@@2.0}:
8428
8429 @example
8430 guix build --with-input=guile=guile@@2.0 guix
8431 @end example
8432
8433 This is a recursive, deep replacement. So in this example, both
8434 @code{guix} and its dependency @code{guile-json} (which also depends on
8435 @code{guile}) get rebuilt against @code{guile@@2.0}.
8436
8437 This is implemented using the @code{package-input-rewriting} Scheme
8438 procedure (@pxref{Defining Packages, @code{package-input-rewriting}}).
8439
8440 @item --with-graft=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
8441 This is similar to @code{--with-input} but with an important difference:
8442 instead of rebuilding the whole dependency chain, @var{replacement} is
8443 built and then @dfn{grafted} onto the binaries that were initially
8444 referring to @var{package}. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
8445 information on grafts.
8446
8447 For example, the command below grafts version 3.5.4 of GnuTLS onto Wget
8448 and all its dependencies, replacing references to the version of GnuTLS
8449 they currently refer to:
8450
8451 @example
8452 guix build --with-graft=gnutls=gnutls@@3.5.4 wget
8453 @end example
8454
8455 This has the advantage of being much faster than rebuilding everything.
8456 But there is a caveat: it works if and only if @var{package} and
8457 @var{replacement} are strictly compatible---for example, if they provide
8458 a library, the application binary interface (ABI) of those libraries
8459 must be compatible. If @var{replacement} is somehow incompatible with
8460 @var{package}, then the resulting package may be unusable. Use with
8461 care!
8462
8463 @item --with-git-url=@var{package}=@var{url}
8464 @cindex Git, using the latest commit
8465 @cindex latest commit, building
8466 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of the @code{master} branch of the
8467 Git repository at @var{url}. Git sub-modules of the repository are fetched,
8468 recursively.
8469
8470 For example, the following command builds the NumPy Python library against the
8471 latest commit of the master branch of Python itself:
8472
8473 @example
8474 guix build python-numpy \
8475 --with-git-url=python=https://github.com/python/cpython
8476 @end example
8477
8478 This option can also be combined with @code{--with-branch} or
8479 @code{--with-commit} (see below).
8480
8481 @cindex continuous integration
8482 Obviously, since it uses the latest commit of the given branch, the result of
8483 such a command varies over time. Nevertheless it is a convenient way to
8484 rebuild entire software stacks against the latest commit of one or more
8485 packages. This is particularly useful in the context of continuous
8486 integration (CI).
8487
8488 Checkouts are kept in a cache under @file{~/.cache/guix/checkouts} to speed up
8489 consecutive accesses to the same repository. You may want to clean it up once
8490 in a while to save disk space.
8491
8492 @item --with-branch=@var{package}=@var{branch}
8493 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of @var{branch}. If the
8494 @code{source} field of @var{package} is an origin with the @code{git-fetch}
8495 method (@pxref{origin Reference}) or a @code{git-checkout} object, the
8496 repository URL is taken from that @code{source}. Otherwise you have to use
8497 @code{--with-git-url} to specify the URL of the Git repository.
8498
8499 For instance, the following command builds @code{guile-sqlite3} from the
8500 latest commit of its @code{master} branch, and then builds @code{guix} (which
8501 depends on it) and @code{cuirass} (which depends on @code{guix}) against this
8502 specific @code{guile-sqlite3} build:
8503
8504 @example
8505 guix build --with-branch=guile-sqlite3=master cuirass
8506 @end example
8507
8508 @item --with-commit=@var{package}=@var{commit}
8509 This is similar to @code{--with-branch}, except that it builds from
8510 @var{commit} rather than the tip of a branch. @var{commit} must be a valid
8511 Git commit SHA1 identifier or a tag.
8512 @end table
8513
8514 @node Additional Build Options
8515 @subsection Additional Build Options
8516
8517 The command-line options presented below are specific to @command{guix
8518 build}.
8519
8520 @table @code
8521
8522 @item --quiet
8523 @itemx -q
8524 Build quietly, without displaying the build log; this is equivalent to
8525 @code{--verbosity=0}. Upon completion, the build log is kept in @file{/var}
8526 (or similar) and can always be retrieved using the @option{--log-file} option.
8527
8528 @item --file=@var{file}
8529 @itemx -f @var{file}
8530 Build the package, derivation, or other file-like object that the code within
8531 @var{file} evaluates to (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
8532
8533 As an example, @var{file} might contain a package definition like this
8534 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
8535
8536 @lisp
8537 @include package-hello.scm
8538 @end lisp
8539
8540 @item --manifest=@var{manifest}
8541 @itemx -m @var{manifest}
8542 Build all packages listed in the given @var{manifest}
8543 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
8544
8545 @item --expression=@var{expr}
8546 @itemx -e @var{expr}
8547 Build the package or derivation @var{expr} evaluates to.
8548
8549 For example, @var{expr} may be @code{(@@ (gnu packages guile)
8550 guile-1.8)}, which unambiguously designates this specific variant of
8551 version 1.8 of Guile.
8552
8553 Alternatively, @var{expr} may be a G-expression, in which case it is used
8554 as a build program passed to @code{gexp->derivation}
8555 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
8556
8557 Lastly, @var{expr} may refer to a zero-argument monadic procedure
8558 (@pxref{The Store Monad}). The procedure must return a derivation as a
8559 monadic value, which is then passed through @code{run-with-store}.
8560
8561 @item --source
8562 @itemx -S
8563 Build the source derivations of the packages, rather than the packages
8564 themselves.
8565
8566 For instance, @code{guix build -S gcc} returns something like
8567 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2.tar.bz2}, which is the GCC
8568 source tarball.
8569
8570 The returned source tarball is the result of applying any patches and
8571 code snippets specified in the package @code{origin} (@pxref{Defining
8572 Packages}).
8573
8574 Note that @command{guix build -S} compiles the sources only of the
8575 specified packages. They do not include the sources of statically
8576 linked dependencies and by themselves are insufficient for reproducing
8577 the packages.
8578
8579 @item --sources
8580 Fetch and return the source of @var{package-or-derivation} and all their
8581 dependencies, recursively. This is a handy way to obtain a local copy
8582 of all the source code needed to build @var{packages}, allowing you to
8583 eventually build them even without network access. It is an extension
8584 of the @code{--source} option and can accept one of the following
8585 optional argument values:
8586
8587 @table @code
8588 @item package
8589 This value causes the @code{--sources} option to behave in the same way
8590 as the @code{--source} option.
8591
8592 @item all
8593 Build the source derivations of all packages, including any source that
8594 might be listed as @code{inputs}. This is the default value.
8595
8596 @example
8597 $ guix build --sources tzdata
8598 The following derivations will be built:
8599 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzdata2015b.tar.gz.drv
8600 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
8601 @end example
8602
8603 @item transitive
8604 Build the source derivations of all packages, as well of all transitive
8605 inputs to the packages. This can be used e.g.@: to
8606 prefetch package source for later offline building.
8607
8608 @example
8609 $ guix build --sources=transitive tzdata
8610 The following derivations will be built:
8611 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
8612 /gnu/store/@dots{}-findutils-4.4.2.tar.xz.drv
8613 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.21.tar.xz.drv
8614 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23.tar.xz.drv
8615 /gnu/store/@dots{}-make-4.1.tar.xz.drv
8616 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.tar.xz.drv
8617 @dots{}
8618 @end example
8619
8620 @end table
8621
8622 @item --system=@var{system}
8623 @itemx -s @var{system}
8624 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
8625 the system type of the build host. The @command{guix build} command allows
8626 you to repeat this option several times, in which case it builds for all the
8627 specified systems; other commands ignore extraneous @option{-s} options.
8628
8629 @quotation Note
8630 The @code{--system} flag is for @emph{native} compilation and must not
8631 be confused with cross-compilation. See @code{--target} below for
8632 information on cross-compilation.
8633 @end quotation
8634
8635 An example use of this is on Linux-based systems, which can emulate
8636 different personalities. For instance, passing
8637 @code{--system=i686-linux} on an @code{x86_64-linux} system or
8638 @code{--system=armhf-linux} on an @code{aarch64-linux} system allows you
8639 to build packages in a complete 32-bit environment.
8640
8641 @quotation Note
8642 Building for an @code{armhf-linux} system is unconditionally enabled on
8643 @code{aarch64-linux} machines, although certain aarch64 chipsets do not
8644 allow for this functionality, notably the ThunderX.
8645 @end quotation
8646
8647 Similarly, when transparent emulation with QEMU and @code{binfmt_misc}
8648 is enabled (@pxref{Virtualization Services,
8649 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type}}), you can build for any system for
8650 which a QEMU @code{binfmt_misc} handler is installed.
8651
8652 Builds for a system other than that of the machine you are using can
8653 also be offloaded to a remote machine of the right architecture.
8654 @xref{Daemon Offload Setup}, for more information on offloading.
8655
8656 @item --target=@var{triplet}
8657 @cindex cross-compilation
8658 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
8659 as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets, GNU
8660 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
8661
8662 @anchor{build-check}
8663 @item --check
8664 @cindex determinism, checking
8665 @cindex reproducibility, checking
8666 Rebuild @var{package-or-derivation}, which are already available in the
8667 store, and raise an error if the build results are not bit-for-bit
8668 identical.
8669
8670 This mechanism allows you to check whether previously installed
8671 substitutes are genuine (@pxref{Substitutes}), or whether the build result
8672 of a package is deterministic. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more
8673 background information and tools.
8674
8675 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
8676 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
8677 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
8678
8679 @item --repair
8680 @cindex repairing store items
8681 @cindex corruption, recovering from
8682 Attempt to repair the specified store items, if they are corrupt, by
8683 re-downloading or rebuilding them.
8684
8685 This operation is not atomic and thus restricted to @code{root}.
8686
8687 @item --derivations
8688 @itemx -d
8689 Return the derivation paths, not the output paths, of the given
8690 packages.
8691
8692 @item --root=@var{file}
8693 @itemx -r @var{file}
8694 @cindex GC roots, adding
8695 @cindex garbage collector roots, adding
8696 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
8697 collector root.
8698
8699 Consequently, the results of this @command{guix build} invocation are
8700 protected from garbage collection until @var{file} is removed. When
8701 that option is omitted, build results are eligible for garbage
8702 collection as soon as the build completes. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for
8703 more on GC roots.
8704
8705 @item --log-file
8706 @cindex build logs, access
8707 Return the build log file names or URLs for the given
8708 @var{package-or-derivation}, or raise an error if build logs are
8709 missing.
8710
8711 This works regardless of how packages or derivations are specified. For
8712 instance, the following invocations are equivalent:
8713
8714 @example
8715 guix build --log-file `guix build -d guile`
8716 guix build --log-file `guix build guile`
8717 guix build --log-file guile
8718 guix build --log-file -e '(@@ (gnu packages guile) guile-2.0)'
8719 @end example
8720
8721 If a log is unavailable locally, and unless @code{--no-substitutes} is
8722 passed, the command looks for a corresponding log on one of the
8723 substitute servers (as specified with @code{--substitute-urls}.)
8724
8725 So for instance, imagine you want to see the build log of GDB on MIPS,
8726 but you are actually on an @code{x86_64} machine:
8727
8728 @example
8729 $ guix build --log-file gdb -s mips64el-linux
8730 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/log/@dots{}-gdb-7.10
8731 @end example
8732
8733 You can freely access a huge library of build logs!
8734 @end table
8735
8736 @node Debugging Build Failures
8737 @subsection Debugging Build Failures
8738
8739 @cindex build failures, debugging
8740 When defining a new package (@pxref{Defining Packages}), you will
8741 probably find yourself spending some time debugging and tweaking the
8742 build until it succeeds. To do that, you need to operate the build
8743 commands yourself in an environment as close as possible to the one the
8744 build daemon uses.
8745
8746 To that end, the first thing to do is to use the @option{--keep-failed}
8747 or @option{-K} option of @command{guix build}, which will keep the
8748 failed build tree in @file{/tmp} or whatever directory you specified as
8749 @code{TMPDIR} (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @code{--keep-failed}}).
8750
8751 From there on, you can @command{cd} to the failed build tree and source
8752 the @file{environment-variables} file, which contains all the
8753 environment variable definitions that were in place when the build
8754 failed. So let's say you're debugging a build failure in package
8755 @code{foo}; a typical session would look like this:
8756
8757 @example
8758 $ guix build foo -K
8759 @dots{} @i{build fails}
8760 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
8761 $ source ./environment-variables
8762 $ cd foo-1.2
8763 @end example
8764
8765 Now, you can invoke commands as if you were the daemon (almost) and
8766 troubleshoot your build process.
8767
8768 Sometimes it happens that, for example, a package's tests pass when you
8769 run them manually but they fail when the daemon runs them. This can
8770 happen because the daemon runs builds in containers where, unlike in our
8771 environment above, network access is missing, @file{/bin/sh} does not
8772 exist, etc. (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
8773
8774 In such cases, you may need to run inspect the build process from within
8775 a container similar to the one the build daemon creates:
8776
8777 @example
8778 $ guix build -K foo
8779 @dots{}
8780 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
8781 $ guix environment --no-grafts -C foo --ad-hoc strace gdb
8782 [env]# source ./environment-variables
8783 [env]# cd foo-1.2
8784 @end example
8785
8786 Here, @command{guix environment -C} creates a container and spawns a new
8787 shell in it (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}). The @command{--ad-hoc
8788 strace gdb} part adds the @command{strace} and @command{gdb} commands to
8789 the container, which would may find handy while debugging. The
8790 @option{--no-grafts} option makes sure we get the exact same
8791 environment, with ungrafted packages (@pxref{Security Updates}, for more
8792 info on grafts).
8793
8794 To get closer to a container like that used by the build daemon, we can
8795 remove @file{/bin/sh}:
8796
8797 @example
8798 [env]# rm /bin/sh
8799 @end example
8800
8801 (Don't worry, this is harmless: this is all happening in the throw-away
8802 container created by @command{guix environment}.)
8803
8804 The @command{strace} command is probably not in the search path, but we
8805 can run:
8806
8807 @example
8808 [env]# $GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin/strace -f -o log make check
8809 @end example
8810
8811 In this way, not only you will have reproduced the environment variables
8812 the daemon uses, you will also be running the build process in a container
8813 similar to the one the daemon uses.
8814
8815
8816 @node Invoking guix edit
8817 @section Invoking @command{guix edit}
8818
8819 @cindex @command{guix edit}
8820 @cindex package definition, editing
8821 So many packages, so many source files! The @command{guix edit} command
8822 facilitates the life of users and packagers by pointing their editor at
8823 the source file containing the definition of the specified packages.
8824 For instance:
8825
8826 @example
8827 guix edit gcc@@4.9 vim
8828 @end example
8829
8830 @noindent
8831 launches the program specified in the @code{VISUAL} or in the
8832 @code{EDITOR} environment variable to view the recipe of GCC@tie{}4.9.3
8833 and that of Vim.
8834
8835 If you are using a Guix Git checkout (@pxref{Building from Git}), or
8836 have created your own packages on @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
8837 (@pxref{Package Modules}), you will be able to edit the package
8838 recipes. In other cases, you will be able to examine the read-only recipes
8839 for packages currently in the store.
8840
8841 Instead of @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}, the command-line option
8842 @code{--load-path=@var{directory}} (or in short @code{-L
8843 @var{directory}}) allows you to add @var{directory} to the front of the
8844 package module search path and so make your own packages visible.
8845
8846 @node Invoking guix download
8847 @section Invoking @command{guix download}
8848
8849 @cindex @command{guix download}
8850 @cindex downloading package sources
8851 When writing a package definition, developers typically need to download
8852 a source tarball, compute its SHA256 hash, and write that
8853 hash in the package definition (@pxref{Defining Packages}). The
8854 @command{guix download} tool helps with this task: it downloads a file
8855 from the given URI, adds it to the store, and prints both its file name
8856 in the store and its SHA256 hash.
8857
8858 The fact that the downloaded file is added to the store saves bandwidth:
8859 when the developer eventually tries to build the newly defined package
8860 with @command{guix build}, the source tarball will not have to be
8861 downloaded again because it is already in the store. It is also a
8862 convenient way to temporarily stash files, which may be deleted
8863 eventually (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
8864
8865 The @command{guix download} command supports the same URIs as used in
8866 package definitions. In particular, it supports @code{mirror://} URIs.
8867 @code{https} URIs (HTTP over TLS) are supported @emph{provided} the
8868 Guile bindings for GnuTLS are available in the user's environment; when
8869 they are not available, an error is raised. @xref{Guile Preparations,
8870 how to install the GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile,
8871 GnuTLS-Guile}, for more information.
8872
8873 @command{guix download} verifies HTTPS server certificates by loading
8874 the certificates of X.509 authorities from the directory pointed to by
8875 the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} environment variable (@pxref{X.509
8876 Certificates}), unless @option{--no-check-certificate} is used.
8877
8878 The following options are available:
8879
8880 @table @code
8881 @item --format=@var{fmt}
8882 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
8883 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}. For more
8884 information on the valid values for @var{fmt}, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}.
8885
8886 @item --no-check-certificate
8887 Do not validate the X.509 certificates of HTTPS servers.
8888
8889 When using this option, you have @emph{absolutely no guarantee} that you
8890 are communicating with the authentic server responsible for the given
8891 URL, which makes you vulnerable to ``man-in-the-middle'' attacks.
8892
8893 @item --output=@var{file}
8894 @itemx -o @var{file}
8895 Save the downloaded file to @var{file} instead of adding it to the
8896 store.
8897 @end table
8898
8899 @node Invoking guix hash
8900 @section Invoking @command{guix hash}
8901
8902 @cindex @command{guix hash}
8903 The @command{guix hash} command computes the SHA256 hash of a file.
8904 It is primarily a convenience tool for anyone contributing to the
8905 distribution: it computes the cryptographic hash of a file, which can be
8906 used in the definition of a package (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
8907
8908 The general syntax is:
8909
8910 @example
8911 guix hash @var{option} @var{file}
8912 @end example
8913
8914 When @var{file} is @code{-} (a hyphen), @command{guix hash} computes the
8915 hash of data read from standard input. @command{guix hash} has the
8916 following options:
8917
8918 @table @code
8919
8920 @item --format=@var{fmt}
8921 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
8922 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}.
8923
8924 Supported formats: @code{nix-base32}, @code{base32}, @code{base16}
8925 (@code{hex} and @code{hexadecimal} can be used as well).
8926
8927 If the @option{--format} option is not specified, @command{guix hash}
8928 will output the hash in @code{nix-base32}. This representation is used
8929 in the definitions of packages.
8930
8931 @item --recursive
8932 @itemx -r
8933 Compute the hash on @var{file} recursively.
8934
8935 In this case, the hash is computed on an archive containing @var{file},
8936 including its children if it is a directory. Some of the metadata of
8937 @var{file} is part of the archive; for instance, when @var{file} is a
8938 regular file, the hash is different depending on whether @var{file} is
8939 executable or not. Metadata such as time stamps has no impact on the
8940 hash (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
8941 @c FIXME: Replace xref above with xref to an ``Archive'' section when
8942 @c it exists.
8943
8944 @item --exclude-vcs
8945 @itemx -x
8946 When combined with @option{--recursive}, exclude version control system
8947 directories (@file{.bzr}, @file{.git}, @file{.hg}, etc.)
8948
8949 @vindex git-fetch
8950 As an example, here is how you would compute the hash of a Git checkout,
8951 which is useful when using the @code{git-fetch} method (@pxref{origin
8952 Reference}):
8953
8954 @example
8955 $ git clone http://example.org/foo.git
8956 $ cd foo
8957 $ guix hash -rx .
8958 @end example
8959 @end table
8960
8961 @node Invoking guix import
8962 @section Invoking @command{guix import}
8963
8964 @cindex importing packages
8965 @cindex package import
8966 @cindex package conversion
8967 @cindex Invoking @command{guix import}
8968 The @command{guix import} command is useful for people who would like to
8969 add a package to the distribution with as little work as
8970 possible---a legitimate demand. The command knows of a few
8971 repositories from which it can ``import'' package metadata. The result
8972 is a package definition, or a template thereof, in the format we know
8973 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
8974
8975 The general syntax is:
8976
8977 @example
8978 guix import @var{importer} @var{options}@dots{}
8979 @end example
8980
8981 @var{importer} specifies the source from which to import package
8982 metadata, and @var{options} specifies a package identifier and other
8983 options specific to @var{importer}.
8984
8985 Some of the importers rely on the ability to run the @command{gpgv} command.
8986 For these, GnuPG must be installed and in @code{$PATH}; run @code{guix install
8987 gnupg} if needed.
8988
8989 Currently, the available ``importers'' are:
8990
8991 @table @code
8992 @item gnu
8993 Import metadata for the given GNU package. This provides a template
8994 for the latest version of that GNU package, including the hash of its
8995 source tarball, and its canonical synopsis and description.
8996
8997 Additional information such as the package dependencies and its
8998 license needs to be figured out manually.
8999
9000 For example, the following command returns a package definition for
9001 GNU@tie{}Hello:
9002
9003 @example
9004 guix import gnu hello
9005 @end example
9006
9007 Specific command-line options are:
9008
9009 @table @code
9010 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
9011 As for @code{guix refresh}, specify the policy to handle missing OpenPGP
9012 keys when verifying the package signature. @xref{Invoking guix
9013 refresh, @code{--key-download}}.
9014 @end table
9015
9016 @item pypi
9017 @cindex pypi
9018 Import metadata from the @uref{https://pypi.python.org/, Python Package
9019 Index}. Information is taken from the JSON-formatted description
9020 available at @code{pypi.python.org} and usually includes all the relevant
9021 information, including package dependencies. For maximum efficiency, it
9022 is recommended to install the @command{unzip} utility, so that the
9023 importer can unzip Python wheels and gather data from them.
9024
9025 The command below imports metadata for the @code{itsdangerous} Python
9026 package:
9027
9028 @example
9029 guix import pypi itsdangerous
9030 @end example
9031
9032 @table @code
9033 @item --recursive
9034 @itemx -r
9035 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
9036 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
9037 in Guix.
9038 @end table
9039
9040 @item gem
9041 @cindex gem
9042 Import metadata from @uref{https://rubygems.org/, RubyGems}. Information
9043 is taken from the JSON-formatted description available at
9044 @code{rubygems.org} and includes most relevant information, including
9045 runtime dependencies. There are some caveats, however. The metadata
9046 doesn't distinguish between synopses and descriptions, so the same string
9047 is used for both fields. Additionally, the details of non-Ruby
9048 dependencies required to build native extensions is unavailable and left
9049 as an exercise to the packager.
9050
9051 The command below imports metadata for the @code{rails} Ruby package:
9052
9053 @example
9054 guix import gem rails
9055 @end example
9056
9057 @table @code
9058 @item --recursive
9059 @itemx -r
9060 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
9061 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
9062 in Guix.
9063 @end table
9064
9065 @item cpan
9066 @cindex CPAN
9067 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN}.
9068 Information is taken from the JSON-formatted metadata provided through
9069 @uref{https://fastapi.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN's API} and includes most
9070 relevant information, such as module dependencies. License information
9071 should be checked closely. If Perl is available in the store, then the
9072 @code{corelist} utility will be used to filter core modules out of the
9073 list of dependencies.
9074
9075 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Acme::Boolean}
9076 Perl module:
9077
9078 @example
9079 guix import cpan Acme::Boolean
9080 @end example
9081
9082 @item cran
9083 @cindex CRAN
9084 @cindex Bioconductor
9085 Import metadata from @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN}, the
9086 central repository for the @uref{https://r-project.org, GNU@tie{}R
9087 statistical and graphical environment}.
9088
9089 Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file of the package.
9090
9091 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Cairo}
9092 R package:
9093
9094 @example
9095 guix import cran Cairo
9096 @end example
9097
9098 When @code{--recursive} is added, the importer will traverse the
9099 dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively and generate
9100 package expressions for all those packages that are not yet in Guix.
9101
9102 When @code{--archive=bioconductor} is added, metadata is imported from
9103 @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor}, a repository of R
9104 packages for for the analysis and comprehension of high-throughput
9105 genomic data in bioinformatics.
9106
9107 Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file contained in the
9108 package archive.
9109
9110 The command below imports metadata for the @code{GenomicRanges}
9111 R package:
9112
9113 @example
9114 guix import cran --archive=bioconductor GenomicRanges
9115 @end example
9116
9117 Finally, you can also import R packages that have not yet been published on
9118 CRAN or Bioconductor as long as they are in a git repository. Use
9119 @code{--archive=git} followed by the URL of the git repository:
9120
9121 @example
9122 guix import cran --archive=git https://github.com/immunogenomics/harmony
9123 @end example
9124
9125 @item texlive
9126 @cindex TeX Live
9127 @cindex CTAN
9128 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.ctan.org/, CTAN}, the
9129 comprehensive TeX archive network for TeX packages that are part of the
9130 @uref{https://www.tug.org/texlive/, TeX Live distribution}.
9131
9132 Information about the package is obtained through the XML API provided
9133 by CTAN, while the source code is downloaded from the SVN repository of
9134 the Tex Live project. This is done because the CTAN does not keep
9135 versioned archives.
9136
9137 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{fontspec}
9138 TeX package:
9139
9140 @example
9141 guix import texlive fontspec
9142 @end example
9143
9144 When @code{--archive=DIRECTORY} is added, the source code is downloaded
9145 not from the @file{latex} sub-directory of the @file{texmf-dist/source}
9146 tree in the TeX Live SVN repository, but from the specified sibling
9147 directory under the same root.
9148
9149 The command below imports metadata for the @code{ifxetex} package from
9150 CTAN while fetching the sources from the directory
9151 @file{texmf/source/generic}:
9152
9153 @example
9154 guix import texlive --archive=generic ifxetex
9155 @end example
9156
9157 @item json
9158 @cindex JSON, import
9159 Import package metadata from a local JSON file. Consider the following
9160 example package definition in JSON format:
9161
9162 @example
9163 @{
9164 "name": "hello",
9165 "version": "2.10",
9166 "source": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
9167 "build-system": "gnu",
9168 "home-page": "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/",
9169 "synopsis": "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package",
9170 "description": "GNU Hello prints a greeting.",
9171 "license": "GPL-3.0+",
9172 "native-inputs": ["gettext"]
9173 @}
9174 @end example
9175
9176 The field names are the same as for the @code{<package>} record
9177 (@xref{Defining Packages}). References to other packages are provided
9178 as JSON lists of quoted package specification strings such as
9179 @code{guile} or @code{guile@@2.0}.
9180
9181 The importer also supports a more explicit source definition using the
9182 common fields for @code{<origin>} records:
9183
9184 @example
9185 @{
9186 @dots{}
9187 "source": @{
9188 "method": "url-fetch",
9189 "uri": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
9190 "sha256": @{
9191 "base32": "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"
9192 @}
9193 @}
9194 @dots{}
9195 @}
9196 @end example
9197
9198 The command below reads metadata from the JSON file @code{hello.json}
9199 and outputs a package expression:
9200
9201 @example
9202 guix import json hello.json
9203 @end example
9204
9205 @item nix
9206 Import metadata from a local copy of the source of the
9207 @uref{https://nixos.org/nixpkgs/, Nixpkgs distribution}@footnote{This
9208 relies on the @command{nix-instantiate} command of
9209 @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix}.}. Package definitions in Nixpkgs are
9210 typically written in a mixture of Nix-language and Bash code. This
9211 command only imports the high-level package structure that is written in
9212 the Nix language. It normally includes all the basic fields of a
9213 package definition.
9214
9215 When importing a GNU package, the synopsis and descriptions are replaced
9216 by their canonical upstream variant.
9217
9218 Usually, you will first need to do:
9219
9220 @example
9221 export NIX_REMOTE=daemon
9222 @end example
9223
9224 @noindent
9225 so that @command{nix-instantiate} does not try to open the Nix database.
9226
9227 As an example, the command below imports the package definition of
9228 LibreOffice (more precisely, it imports the definition of the package
9229 bound to the @code{libreoffice} top-level attribute):
9230
9231 @example
9232 guix import nix ~/path/to/nixpkgs libreoffice
9233 @end example
9234
9235 @item hackage
9236 @cindex hackage
9237 Import metadata from the Haskell community's central package archive
9238 @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org/, Hackage}. Information is taken from
9239 Cabal files and includes all the relevant information, including package
9240 dependencies.
9241
9242 Specific command-line options are:
9243
9244 @table @code
9245 @item --stdin
9246 @itemx -s
9247 Read a Cabal file from standard input.
9248 @item --no-test-dependencies
9249 @itemx -t
9250 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
9251 @item --cabal-environment=@var{alist}
9252 @itemx -e @var{alist}
9253 @var{alist} is a Scheme alist defining the environment in which the
9254 Cabal conditionals are evaluated. The accepted keys are: @code{os},
9255 @code{arch}, @code{impl} and a string representing the name of a flag.
9256 The value associated with a flag has to be either the symbol
9257 @code{true} or @code{false}. The value associated with other keys
9258 has to conform to the Cabal file format definition. The default value
9259 associated with the keys @code{os}, @code{arch} and @code{impl} is
9260 @samp{linux}, @samp{x86_64} and @samp{ghc}, respectively.
9261 @item --recursive
9262 @itemx -r
9263 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
9264 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
9265 in Guix.
9266 @end table
9267
9268 The command below imports metadata for the latest version of the
9269 @code{HTTP} Haskell package without including test dependencies and
9270 specifying the value of the flag @samp{network-uri} as @code{false}:
9271
9272 @example
9273 guix import hackage -t -e "'((\"network-uri\" . false))" HTTP
9274 @end example
9275
9276 A specific package version may optionally be specified by following the
9277 package name by an at-sign and a version number as in the following example:
9278
9279 @example
9280 guix import hackage mtl@@2.1.3.1
9281 @end example
9282
9283 @item stackage
9284 @cindex stackage
9285 The @code{stackage} importer is a wrapper around the @code{hackage} one.
9286 It takes a package name, looks up the package version included in a
9287 long-term support (LTS) @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage}
9288 release and uses the @code{hackage} importer to retrieve its metadata.
9289 Note that it is up to you to select an LTS release compatible with the
9290 GHC compiler used by Guix.
9291
9292 Specific command-line options are:
9293
9294 @table @code
9295 @item --no-test-dependencies
9296 @itemx -t
9297 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
9298 @item --lts-version=@var{version}
9299 @itemx -l @var{version}
9300 @var{version} is the desired LTS release version. If omitted the latest
9301 release is used.
9302 @item --recursive
9303 @itemx -r
9304 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
9305 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
9306 in Guix.
9307 @end table
9308
9309 The command below imports metadata for the @code{HTTP} Haskell package
9310 included in the LTS Stackage release version 7.18:
9311
9312 @example
9313 guix import stackage --lts-version=7.18 HTTP
9314 @end example
9315
9316 @item elpa
9317 @cindex elpa
9318 Import metadata from an Emacs Lisp Package Archive (ELPA) package
9319 repository (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
9320
9321 Specific command-line options are:
9322
9323 @table @code
9324 @item --archive=@var{repo}
9325 @itemx -a @var{repo}
9326 @var{repo} identifies the archive repository from which to retrieve the
9327 information. Currently the supported repositories and their identifiers
9328 are:
9329 @itemize -
9330 @item
9331 @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/packages, GNU}, selected by the @code{gnu}
9332 identifier. This is the default.
9333
9334 Packages from @code{elpa.gnu.org} are signed with one of the keys
9335 contained in the GnuPG keyring at
9336 @file{share/emacs/25.1/etc/package-keyring.gpg} (or similar) in the
9337 @code{emacs} package (@pxref{Package Installation, ELPA package
9338 signatures,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
9339
9340 @item
9341 @uref{https://stable.melpa.org/packages, MELPA-Stable}, selected by the
9342 @code{melpa-stable} identifier.
9343
9344 @item
9345 @uref{https://melpa.org/packages, MELPA}, selected by the @code{melpa}
9346 identifier.
9347 @end itemize
9348
9349 @item --recursive
9350 @itemx -r
9351 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
9352 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
9353 in Guix.
9354 @end table
9355
9356 @item crate
9357 @cindex crate
9358 Import metadata from the crates.io Rust package repository
9359 @uref{https://crates.io, crates.io}, as in this example:
9360
9361 @example
9362 guix import crate blake2-rfc
9363 @end example
9364
9365 The crate importer also allows you to specify a version string:
9366
9367 @example
9368 guix import crate constant-time-eq@@0.1.0
9369 @end example
9370
9371 Additional options include:
9372
9373 @table @code
9374 @item --recursive
9375 @itemx -r
9376 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
9377 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
9378 in Guix.
9379 @end table
9380
9381 @item opam
9382 @cindex OPAM
9383 @cindex OCaml
9384 Import metadata from the @uref{https://opam.ocaml.org/, OPAM} package
9385 repository used by the OCaml community.
9386 @end table
9387
9388 The structure of the @command{guix import} code is modular. It would be
9389 useful to have more importers for other package formats, and your help
9390 is welcome here (@pxref{Contributing}).
9391
9392 @node Invoking guix refresh
9393 @section Invoking @command{guix refresh}
9394
9395 @cindex @command {guix refresh}
9396 The primary audience of the @command{guix refresh} command is developers
9397 of the GNU software distribution. By default, it reports any packages
9398 provided by the distribution that are outdated compared to the latest
9399 upstream version, like this:
9400
9401 @example
9402 $ guix refresh
9403 gnu/packages/gettext.scm:29:13: gettext would be upgraded from 0.18.1.1 to 0.18.2.1
9404 gnu/packages/glib.scm:77:12: glib would be upgraded from 2.34.3 to 2.37.0
9405 @end example
9406
9407 Alternately, one can specify packages to consider, in which case a
9408 warning is emitted for packages that lack an updater:
9409
9410 @example
9411 $ guix refresh coreutils guile guile-ssh
9412 gnu/packages/ssh.scm:205:2: warning: no updater for guile-ssh
9413 gnu/packages/guile.scm:136:12: guile would be upgraded from 2.0.12 to 2.0.13
9414 @end example
9415
9416 @command{guix refresh} browses the upstream repository of each package and determines
9417 the highest version number of the releases therein. The command
9418 knows how to update specific types of packages: GNU packages, ELPA
9419 packages, etc.---see the documentation for @option{--type} below. There
9420 are many packages, though, for which it lacks a method to determine
9421 whether a new upstream release is available. However, the mechanism is
9422 extensible, so feel free to get in touch with us to add a new method!
9423
9424 @table @code
9425
9426 @item --recursive
9427 Consider the packages specified, and all the packages upon which they depend.
9428
9429 @example
9430 $ guix refresh --recursive coreutils
9431 gnu/packages/acl.scm:35:2: warning: no updater for acl
9432 gnu/packages/m4.scm:30:12: info: 1.4.18 is already the latest version of m4
9433 gnu/packages/xml.scm:68:2: warning: no updater for expat
9434 gnu/packages/multiprecision.scm:40:12: info: 6.1.2 is already the latest version of gmp
9435 @dots{}
9436 @end example
9437
9438 @end table
9439
9440 Sometimes the upstream name differs from the package name used in Guix,
9441 and @command{guix refresh} needs a little help. Most updaters honor the
9442 @code{upstream-name} property in package definitions, which can be used
9443 to that effect:
9444
9445 @lisp
9446 (define-public network-manager
9447 (package
9448 (name "network-manager")
9449 ;; @dots{}
9450 (properties '((upstream-name . "NetworkManager")))))
9451 @end lisp
9452
9453 When passed @code{--update}, it modifies distribution source files to
9454 update the version numbers and source tarball hashes of those package
9455 recipes (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This is achieved by downloading
9456 each package's latest source tarball and its associated OpenPGP
9457 signature, authenticating the downloaded tarball against its signature
9458 using @command{gpgv}, and finally computing its hash---note that GnuPG must be
9459 installed and in @code{$PATH}; run @code{guix install gnupg} if needed.
9460
9461 When the public
9462 key used to sign the tarball is missing from the user's keyring, an
9463 attempt is made to automatically retrieve it from a public key server;
9464 when this is successful, the key is added to the user's keyring; otherwise,
9465 @command{guix refresh} reports an error.
9466
9467 The following options are supported:
9468
9469 @table @code
9470
9471 @item --expression=@var{expr}
9472 @itemx -e @var{expr}
9473 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
9474
9475 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
9476
9477 @example
9478 guix refresh -l -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) glibc-final)'
9479 @end example
9480
9481 This command lists the dependents of the ``final'' libc (essentially all
9482 the packages.)
9483
9484 @item --update
9485 @itemx -u
9486 Update distribution source files (package recipes) in place. This is
9487 usually run from a checkout of the Guix source tree (@pxref{Running
9488 Guix Before It Is Installed}):
9489
9490 @example
9491 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -s non-core -u
9492 @end example
9493
9494 @xref{Defining Packages}, for more information on package definitions.
9495
9496 @item --select=[@var{subset}]
9497 @itemx -s @var{subset}
9498 Select all the packages in @var{subset}, one of @code{core} or
9499 @code{non-core}.
9500
9501 The @code{core} subset refers to all the packages at the core of the
9502 distribution---i.e., packages that are used to build ``everything
9503 else''. This includes GCC, libc, Binutils, Bash, etc. Usually,
9504 changing one of these packages in the distribution entails a rebuild of
9505 all the others. Thus, such updates are an inconvenience to users in
9506 terms of build time or bandwidth used to achieve the upgrade.
9507
9508 The @code{non-core} subset refers to the remaining packages. It is
9509 typically useful in cases where an update of the core packages would be
9510 inconvenient.
9511
9512 @item --manifest=@var{file}
9513 @itemx -m @var{file}
9514 Select all the packages from the manifest in @var{file}. This is useful to
9515 check if any packages of the user manifest can be updated.
9516
9517 @item --type=@var{updater}
9518 @itemx -t @var{updater}
9519 Select only packages handled by @var{updater} (may be a comma-separated
9520 list of updaters). Currently, @var{updater} may be one of:
9521
9522 @table @code
9523 @item gnu
9524 the updater for GNU packages;
9525 @item gnome
9526 the updater for GNOME packages;
9527 @item kde
9528 the updater for KDE packages;
9529 @item xorg
9530 the updater for X.org packages;
9531 @item kernel.org
9532 the updater for packages hosted on kernel.org;
9533 @item elpa
9534 the updater for @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/, ELPA} packages;
9535 @item cran
9536 the updater for @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN} packages;
9537 @item bioconductor
9538 the updater for @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor} R packages;
9539 @item cpan
9540 the updater for @uref{https://www.cpan.org/, CPAN} packages;
9541 @item pypi
9542 the updater for @uref{https://pypi.python.org, PyPI} packages.
9543 @item gem
9544 the updater for @uref{https://rubygems.org, RubyGems} packages.
9545 @item github
9546 the updater for @uref{https://github.com, GitHub} packages.
9547 @item hackage
9548 the updater for @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org, Hackage} packages.
9549 @item stackage
9550 the updater for @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage} packages.
9551 @item crate
9552 the updater for @uref{https://crates.io, Crates} packages.
9553 @item launchpad
9554 the updater for @uref{https://launchpad.net, Launchpad} packages.
9555 @end table
9556
9557 For instance, the following command only checks for updates of Emacs
9558 packages hosted at @code{elpa.gnu.org} and for updates of CRAN packages:
9559
9560 @example
9561 $ guix refresh --type=elpa,cran
9562 gnu/packages/statistics.scm:819:13: r-testthat would be upgraded from 0.10.0 to 0.11.0
9563 gnu/packages/emacs.scm:856:13: emacs-auctex would be upgraded from 11.88.6 to 11.88.9
9564 @end example
9565
9566 @end table
9567
9568 In addition, @command{guix refresh} can be passed one or more package
9569 names, as in this example:
9570
9571 @example
9572 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -u emacs idutils gcc@@4.8
9573 @end example
9574
9575 @noindent
9576 The command above specifically updates the @code{emacs} and
9577 @code{idutils} packages. The @code{--select} option would have no
9578 effect in this case.
9579
9580 When considering whether to upgrade a package, it is sometimes
9581 convenient to know which packages would be affected by the upgrade and
9582 should be checked for compatibility. For this the following option may
9583 be used when passing @command{guix refresh} one or more package names:
9584
9585 @table @code
9586
9587 @item --list-updaters
9588 @itemx -L
9589 List available updaters and exit (see @option{--type} above.)
9590
9591 For each updater, display the fraction of packages it covers; at the
9592 end, display the fraction of packages covered by all these updaters.
9593
9594 @item --list-dependent
9595 @itemx -l
9596 List top-level dependent packages that would need to be rebuilt as a
9597 result of upgrading one or more packages.
9598
9599 @xref{Invoking guix graph, the @code{reverse-package} type of
9600 @command{guix graph}}, for information on how to visualize the list of
9601 dependents of a package.
9602
9603 @end table
9604
9605 Be aware that the @code{--list-dependent} option only
9606 @emph{approximates} the rebuilds that would be required as a result of
9607 an upgrade. More rebuilds might be required under some circumstances.
9608
9609 @example
9610 $ guix refresh --list-dependent flex
9611 Building the following 120 packages would ensure 213 dependent packages are rebuilt:
9612 hop@@2.4.0 geiser@@0.4 notmuch@@0.18 mu@@0.9.9.5 cflow@@1.4 idutils@@4.6 @dots{}
9613 @end example
9614
9615 The command above lists a set of packages that could be built to check
9616 for compatibility with an upgraded @code{flex} package.
9617
9618 @table @code
9619
9620 @item --list-transitive
9621 List all the packages which one or more packages depend upon.
9622
9623 @example
9624 $ guix refresh --list-transitive flex
9625 flex@@2.6.4 depends on the following 25 packages: perl@@5.28.0 help2man@@1.47.6
9626 bison@@3.0.5 indent@@2.2.10 tar@@1.30 gzip@@1.9 bzip2@@1.0.6 xz@@5.2.4 file@@5.33 @dots{}
9627 @end example
9628
9629 @end table
9630
9631 The command above lists a set of packages which, when changed, would cause
9632 @code{flex} to be rebuilt.
9633
9634 The following options can be used to customize GnuPG operation:
9635
9636 @table @code
9637
9638 @item --gpg=@var{command}
9639 Use @var{command} as the GnuPG 2.x command. @var{command} is searched
9640 for in @code{$PATH}.
9641
9642 @item --keyring=@var{file}
9643 Use @var{file} as the keyring for upstream keys. @var{file} must be in the
9644 @dfn{keybox format}. Keybox files usually have a name ending in @file{.kbx}
9645 and the GNU@tie{}Privacy Guard (GPG) can manipulate these files
9646 (@pxref{kbxutil, @command{kbxutil},, gnupg, Using the GNU Privacy Guard}, for
9647 information on a tool to manipulate keybox files).
9648
9649 When this option is omitted, @command{guix refresh} uses
9650 @file{~/.config/guix/upstream/trustedkeys.kbx} as the keyring for upstream
9651 signing keys. OpenPGP signatures are checked against keys from this keyring;
9652 missing keys are downloaded to this keyring as well (see
9653 @option{--key-download} below.)
9654
9655 You can export keys from your default GPG keyring into a keybox file using
9656 commands like this one:
9657
9658 @example
9659 gpg --export rms@@gnu.org | kbxutil --import-openpgp >> mykeyring.kbx
9660 @end example
9661
9662 Likewise, you can fetch keys to a specific keybox file like this:
9663
9664 @example
9665 gpg --no-default-keyring --keyring mykeyring.kbx \
9666 --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
9667 @end example
9668
9669 @ref{GPG Configuration Options, @option{--keyring},, gnupg, Using the GNU
9670 Privacy Guard}, for more information on GPG's @option{--keyring} option.
9671
9672 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
9673 Handle missing OpenPGP keys according to @var{policy}, which may be one
9674 of:
9675
9676 @table @code
9677 @item always
9678 Always download missing OpenPGP keys from the key server, and add them
9679 to the user's GnuPG keyring.
9680
9681 @item never
9682 Never try to download missing OpenPGP keys. Instead just bail out.
9683
9684 @item interactive
9685 When a package signed with an unknown OpenPGP key is encountered, ask
9686 the user whether to download it or not. This is the default behavior.
9687 @end table
9688
9689 @item --key-server=@var{host}
9690 Use @var{host} as the OpenPGP key server when importing a public key.
9691
9692 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
9693 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
9694 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
9695
9696 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
9697 the command-line tools.
9698
9699 @end table
9700
9701 The @code{github} updater uses the
9702 @uref{https://developer.github.com/v3/, GitHub API} to query for new
9703 releases. When used repeatedly e.g.@: when refreshing all packages,
9704 GitHub will eventually refuse to answer any further API requests. By
9705 default 60 API requests per hour are allowed, and a full refresh on all
9706 GitHub packages in Guix requires more than this. Authentication with
9707 GitHub through the use of an API token alleviates these limits. To use
9708 an API token, set the environment variable @code{GUIX_GITHUB_TOKEN} to a
9709 token procured from @uref{https://github.com/settings/tokens} or
9710 otherwise.
9711
9712
9713 @node Invoking guix lint
9714 @section Invoking @command{guix lint}
9715
9716 @cindex @command{guix lint}
9717 @cindex package, checking for errors
9718 The @command{guix lint} command is meant to help package developers avoid
9719 common errors and use a consistent style. It runs a number of checks on
9720 a given set of packages in order to find common mistakes in their
9721 definitions. Available @dfn{checkers} include (see
9722 @code{--list-checkers} for a complete list):
9723
9724 @table @code
9725 @item synopsis
9726 @itemx description
9727 Validate certain typographical and stylistic rules about package
9728 descriptions and synopses.
9729
9730 @item inputs-should-be-native
9731 Identify inputs that should most likely be native inputs.
9732
9733 @item source
9734 @itemx home-page
9735 @itemx mirror-url
9736 @itemx github-url
9737 @itemx source-file-name
9738 Probe @code{home-page} and @code{source} URLs and report those that are
9739 invalid. Suggest a @code{mirror://} URL when applicable. If the
9740 @code{source} URL redirects to a GitHub URL, recommend usage of the GitHub
9741 URL. Check that the source file name is meaningful, e.g.@: is not just a
9742 version number or ``git-checkout'', without a declared @code{file-name}
9743 (@pxref{origin Reference}).
9744
9745 @item source-unstable-tarball
9746 Parse the @code{source} URL to determine if a tarball from GitHub is
9747 autogenerated or if it is a release tarball. Unfortunately GitHub's
9748 autogenerated tarballs are sometimes regenerated.
9749
9750 @item archival
9751 @cindex Software Heritage, source code archive
9752 @cindex archival of source code, Software Heritage
9753 Checks whether the package's source code is archived at
9754 @uref{https://www.softwareheritage.org, Software Heritage}.
9755
9756 When the source code that is not archived comes from a version-control system
9757 (VCS)---e.g., it's obtained with @code{git-fetch}, send Software Heritage a
9758 ``save'' request so that it eventually archives it. This ensures that the
9759 source will remain available in the long term, and that Guix can fall back to
9760 Software Heritage should the source code disappear from its original host.
9761 The status of recent ``save'' requests can be
9762 @uref{https://archive.softwareheritage.org/save/#requests, viewed on-line}.
9763
9764 When source code is a tarball obtained with @code{url-fetch}, simply print a
9765 message when it is not archived. As of this writing, Software Heritage does
9766 not allow requests to save arbitrary tarballs; we are working on ways to
9767 ensure that non-VCS source code is also archived.
9768
9769 Software Heritage
9770 @uref{https://archive.softwareheritage.org/api/#rate-limiting, limits the
9771 request rate per IP address}. When the limit is reached, @command{guix lint}
9772 prints a message and the @code{archival} checker stops doing anything until
9773 that limit has been reset.
9774
9775 @item cve
9776 @cindex security vulnerabilities
9777 @cindex CVE, Common Vulnerabilities and Exposures
9778 Report known vulnerabilities found in the Common Vulnerabilities and
9779 Exposures (CVE) databases of the current and past year
9780 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/vuln/data-feeds, published by the US
9781 NIST}.
9782
9783 To view information about a particular vulnerability, visit pages such as:
9784
9785 @itemize
9786 @item
9787 @indicateurl{https://web.nvd.nist.gov/view/vuln/detail?vulnId=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
9788 @item
9789 @indicateurl{https://cve.mitre.org/cgi-bin/cvename.cgi?name=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
9790 @end itemize
9791
9792 @noindent
9793 where @code{CVE-YYYY-ABCD} is the CVE identifier---e.g.,
9794 @code{CVE-2015-7554}.
9795
9796 Package developers can specify in package recipes the
9797 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/products/cpe,Common Platform Enumeration (CPE)}
9798 name and version of the package when they differ from the name or version
9799 that Guix uses, as in this example:
9800
9801 @lisp
9802 (package
9803 (name "grub")
9804 ;; @dots{}
9805 ;; CPE calls this package "grub2".
9806 (properties '((cpe-name . "grub2")
9807 (cpe-version . "2.3"))))
9808 @end lisp
9809
9810 @c See <https://www.openwall.com/lists/oss-security/2017/03/15/3>.
9811 Some entries in the CVE database do not specify which version of a
9812 package they apply to, and would thus ``stick around'' forever. Package
9813 developers who found CVE alerts and verified they can be ignored can
9814 declare them as in this example:
9815
9816 @lisp
9817 (package
9818 (name "t1lib")
9819 ;; @dots{}
9820 ;; These CVEs no longer apply and can be safely ignored.
9821 (properties `((lint-hidden-cve . ("CVE-2011-0433"
9822 "CVE-2011-1553"
9823 "CVE-2011-1554"
9824 "CVE-2011-5244")))))
9825 @end lisp
9826
9827 @item formatting
9828 Warn about obvious source code formatting issues: trailing white space,
9829 use of tabulations, etc.
9830 @end table
9831
9832 The general syntax is:
9833
9834 @example
9835 guix lint @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
9836 @end example
9837
9838 If no package is given on the command line, then all packages are checked.
9839 The @var{options} may be zero or more of the following:
9840
9841 @table @code
9842 @item --list-checkers
9843 @itemx -l
9844 List and describe all the available checkers that will be run on packages
9845 and exit.
9846
9847 @item --checkers
9848 @itemx -c
9849 Only enable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
9850 names returned by @code{--list-checkers}.
9851
9852 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
9853 @itemx -L @var{directory}
9854 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
9855 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
9856
9857 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
9858 the command-line tools.
9859
9860 @end table
9861
9862 @node Invoking guix size
9863 @section Invoking @command{guix size}
9864
9865 @cindex size
9866 @cindex package size
9867 @cindex closure
9868 @cindex @command{guix size}
9869 The @command{guix size} command helps package developers profile the
9870 disk usage of packages. It is easy to overlook the impact of an
9871 additional dependency added to a package, or the impact of using a
9872 single output for a package that could easily be split (@pxref{Packages
9873 with Multiple Outputs}). Such are the typical issues that
9874 @command{guix size} can highlight.
9875
9876 The command can be passed one or more package specifications
9877 such as @code{gcc@@4.8}
9878 or @code{guile:debug}, or a file name in the store. Consider this
9879 example:
9880
9881 @example
9882 $ guix size coreutils
9883 store item total self
9884 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-5.5.0-lib 60.4 30.1 38.1%
9885 /gnu/store/@dots{}-glibc-2.27 30.3 28.8 36.6%
9886 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.28 78.9 15.0 19.0%
9887 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gmp-6.1.2 63.1 2.7 3.4%
9888 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-static-4.4.12 1.5 1.5 1.9%
9889 /gnu/store/@dots{}-acl-2.2.52 61.1 0.4 0.5%
9890 /gnu/store/@dots{}-attr-2.4.47 60.6 0.2 0.3%
9891 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libcap-2.25 60.5 0.2 0.2%
9892 total: 78.9 MiB
9893 @end example
9894
9895 @cindex closure
9896 The store items listed here constitute the @dfn{transitive closure} of
9897 Coreutils---i.e., Coreutils and all its dependencies, recursively---as
9898 would be returned by:
9899
9900 @example
9901 $ guix gc -R /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23
9902 @end example
9903
9904 Here the output shows three columns next to store items. The first column,
9905 labeled ``total'', shows the size in mebibytes (MiB) of the closure of
9906 the store item---that is, its own size plus the size of all its
9907 dependencies. The next column, labeled ``self'', shows the size of the
9908 item itself. The last column shows the ratio of the size of the item
9909 itself to the space occupied by all the items listed here.
9910
9911 In this example, we see that the closure of Coreutils weighs in at
9912 79@tie{}MiB, most of which is taken by libc and GCC's run-time support
9913 libraries. (That libc and GCC's libraries represent a large fraction of
9914 the closure is not a problem @i{per se} because they are always available
9915 on the system anyway.)
9916
9917 When the package(s) passed to @command{guix size} are available in the
9918 store@footnote{More precisely, @command{guix size} looks for the
9919 @emph{ungrafted} variant of the given package(s), as returned by
9920 @code{guix build @var{package} --no-grafts}. @xref{Security Updates},
9921 for information on grafts.}, @command{guix size} queries the daemon to determine its
9922 dependencies, and measures its size in the store, similar to @command{du
9923 -ms --apparent-size} (@pxref{du invocation,,, coreutils, GNU
9924 Coreutils}).
9925
9926 When the given packages are @emph{not} in the store, @command{guix size}
9927 reports information based on the available substitutes
9928 (@pxref{Substitutes}). This makes it possible it to profile disk usage of
9929 store items that are not even on disk, only available remotely.
9930
9931 You can also specify several package names:
9932
9933 @example
9934 $ guix size coreutils grep sed bash
9935 store item total self
9936 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.24 77.8 13.8 13.4%
9937 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.22 73.1 0.8 0.8%
9938 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.42 72.3 4.7 4.6%
9939 /gnu/store/@dots{}-readline-6.3 67.6 1.2 1.2%
9940 @dots{}
9941 total: 102.3 MiB
9942 @end example
9943
9944 @noindent
9945 In this example we see that the combination of the four packages takes
9946 102.3@tie{}MiB in total, which is much less than the sum of each closure
9947 since they have a lot of dependencies in common.
9948
9949 The available options are:
9950
9951 @table @option
9952
9953 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
9954 Use substitute information from @var{urls}.
9955 @xref{client-substitute-urls, the same option for @code{guix build}}.
9956
9957 @item --sort=@var{key}
9958 Sort lines according to @var{key}, one of the following options:
9959
9960 @table @code
9961 @item self
9962 the size of each item (the default);
9963 @item closure
9964 the total size of the item's closure.
9965 @end table
9966
9967 @item --map-file=@var{file}
9968 Write a graphical map of disk usage in PNG format to @var{file}.
9969
9970 For the example above, the map looks like this:
9971
9972 @image{images/coreutils-size-map,5in,, map of Coreutils disk usage
9973 produced by @command{guix size}}
9974
9975 This option requires that
9976 @uref{https://wingolog.org/software/guile-charting/, Guile-Charting} be
9977 installed and visible in Guile's module search path. When that is not
9978 the case, @command{guix size} fails as it tries to load it.
9979
9980 @item --system=@var{system}
9981 @itemx -s @var{system}
9982 Consider packages for @var{system}---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
9983
9984 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
9985 @itemx -L @var{directory}
9986 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
9987 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
9988
9989 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
9990 the command-line tools.
9991 @end table
9992
9993 @node Invoking guix graph
9994 @section Invoking @command{guix graph}
9995
9996 @cindex DAG
9997 @cindex @command{guix graph}
9998 @cindex package dependencies
9999 Packages and their dependencies form a @dfn{graph}, specifically a
10000 directed acyclic graph (DAG). It can quickly become difficult to have a
10001 mental model of the package DAG, so the @command{guix graph} command
10002 provides a visual representation of the DAG. By default,
10003 @command{guix graph} emits a DAG representation in the input format of
10004 @uref{https://www.graphviz.org/, Graphviz}, so its output can be passed
10005 directly to the @command{dot} command of Graphviz. It can also emit an
10006 HTML page with embedded JavaScript code to display a ``chord diagram''
10007 in a Web browser, using the @uref{https://d3js.org/, d3.js} library, or
10008 emit Cypher queries to construct a graph in a graph database supporting
10009 the @uref{https://www.opencypher.org/, openCypher} query language.
10010 The general syntax is:
10011
10012 @example
10013 guix graph @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
10014 @end example
10015
10016 For example, the following command generates a PDF file representing the
10017 package DAG for the GNU@tie{}Core Utilities, showing its build-time
10018 dependencies:
10019
10020 @example
10021 guix graph coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
10022 @end example
10023
10024 The output looks like this:
10025
10026 @image{images/coreutils-graph,2in,,Dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
10027
10028 Nice little graph, no?
10029
10030 But there is more than one graph! The one above is concise: it is the
10031 graph of package objects, omitting implicit inputs such as GCC, libc,
10032 grep, etc. It is often useful to have such a concise graph, but
10033 sometimes one may want to see more details. @command{guix graph} supports
10034 several types of graphs, allowing you to choose the level of detail:
10035
10036 @table @code
10037 @item package
10038 This is the default type used in the example above. It shows the DAG of
10039 package objects, excluding implicit dependencies. It is concise, but
10040 filters out many details.
10041
10042 @item reverse-package
10043 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. For example:
10044
10045 @example
10046 guix graph --type=reverse-package ocaml
10047 @end example
10048
10049 ...@: yields the graph of packages that @emph{explicitly} depend on OCaml (if
10050 you are also interested in cases where OCaml is an implicit dependency, see
10051 @code{reverse-bag} below.)
10052
10053 Note that for core packages this can yield huge graphs. If all you want
10054 is to know the number of packages that depend on a given package, use
10055 @command{guix refresh --list-dependent} (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh,
10056 @option{--list-dependent}}).
10057
10058 @item bag-emerged
10059 This is the package DAG, @emph{including} implicit inputs.
10060
10061 For instance, the following command:
10062
10063 @example
10064 guix graph --type=bag-emerged coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
10065 @end example
10066
10067 ...@: yields this bigger graph:
10068
10069 @image{images/coreutils-bag-graph,,5in,Detailed dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
10070
10071 At the bottom of the graph, we see all the implicit inputs of
10072 @var{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
10073
10074 Now, note that the dependencies of these implicit inputs---that is, the
10075 @dfn{bootstrap dependencies} (@pxref{Bootstrapping})---are not shown
10076 here, for conciseness.
10077
10078 @item bag
10079 Similar to @code{bag-emerged}, but this time including all the bootstrap
10080 dependencies.
10081
10082 @item bag-with-origins
10083 Similar to @code{bag}, but also showing origins and their dependencies.
10084
10085 @item reverse-bag
10086 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. Unlike @code{reverse-package},
10087 it also takes implicit dependencies into account. For example:
10088
10089 @example
10090 guix graph -t reverse-bag dune
10091 @end example
10092
10093 @noindent
10094 ...@: yields the graph of all packages that depend on Dune, directly or
10095 indirectly. Since Dune is an @emph{implicit} dependency of many packages
10096 @i{via} @code{dune-build-system}, this shows a large number of packages,
10097 whereas @code{reverse-package} would show very few if any.
10098
10099 @item derivation
10100 This is the most detailed representation: It shows the DAG of
10101 derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) and plain store items. Compared to
10102 the above representation, many additional nodes are visible, including
10103 build scripts, patches, Guile modules, etc.
10104
10105 For this type of graph, it is also possible to pass a @file{.drv} file
10106 name instead of a package name, as in:
10107
10108 @example
10109 guix graph -t derivation `guix system build -d my-config.scm`
10110 @end example
10111
10112 @item module
10113 This is the graph of @dfn{package modules} (@pxref{Package Modules}).
10114 For example, the following command shows the graph for the package
10115 module that defines the @code{guile} package:
10116
10117 @example
10118 guix graph -t module guile | dot -Tpdf > module-graph.pdf
10119 @end example
10120 @end table
10121
10122 All the types above correspond to @emph{build-time dependencies}. The
10123 following graph type represents the @emph{run-time dependencies}:
10124
10125 @table @code
10126 @item references
10127 This is the graph of @dfn{references} of a package output, as returned
10128 by @command{guix gc --references} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
10129
10130 If the given package output is not available in the store, @command{guix
10131 graph} attempts to obtain dependency information from substitutes.
10132
10133 Here you can also pass a store file name instead of a package name. For
10134 example, the command below produces the reference graph of your profile
10135 (which can be big!):
10136
10137 @example
10138 guix graph -t references `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
10139 @end example
10140
10141 @item referrers
10142 This is the graph of the @dfn{referrers} of a store item, as returned by
10143 @command{guix gc --referrers} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
10144
10145 This relies exclusively on local information from your store. For
10146 instance, let us suppose that the current Inkscape is available in 10
10147 profiles on your machine; @command{guix graph -t referrers inkscape}
10148 will show a graph rooted at Inkscape and with those 10 profiles linked
10149 to it.
10150
10151 It can help determine what is preventing a store item from being garbage
10152 collected.
10153
10154 @end table
10155
10156 The available options are the following:
10157
10158 @table @option
10159 @item --type=@var{type}
10160 @itemx -t @var{type}
10161 Produce a graph output of @var{type}, where @var{type} must be one of
10162 the values listed above.
10163
10164 @item --list-types
10165 List the supported graph types.
10166
10167 @item --backend=@var{backend}
10168 @itemx -b @var{backend}
10169 Produce a graph using the selected @var{backend}.
10170
10171 @item --list-backends
10172 List the supported graph backends.
10173
10174 Currently, the available backends are Graphviz and d3.js.
10175
10176 @item --expression=@var{expr}
10177 @itemx -e @var{expr}
10178 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
10179
10180 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
10181
10182 @example
10183 guix graph -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) gnu-make-final)'
10184 @end example
10185
10186 @item --system=@var{system}
10187 @itemx -s @var{system}
10188 Display the graph for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
10189
10190 The package dependency graph is largely architecture-independent, but there
10191 are some architecture-dependent bits that this option allows you to visualize.
10192
10193 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
10194 @itemx -L @var{directory}
10195 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
10196 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
10197
10198 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
10199 the command-line tools.
10200 @end table
10201
10202 On top of that, @command{guix graph} supports all the usual package
10203 transformation options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}). This
10204 makes it easy to view the effect of a graph-rewriting transformation
10205 such as @option{--with-input}. For example, the command below outputs
10206 the graph of @code{git} once @code{openssl} has been replaced by
10207 @code{libressl} everywhere in the graph:
10208
10209 @example
10210 guix graph git --with-input=openssl=libressl
10211 @end example
10212
10213 So many possibilities, so much fun!
10214
10215 @node Invoking guix publish
10216 @section Invoking @command{guix publish}
10217
10218 @cindex @command{guix publish}
10219 The purpose of @command{guix publish} is to enable users to easily share
10220 their store with others, who can then use it as a substitute server
10221 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
10222
10223 When @command{guix publish} runs, it spawns an HTTP server which allows
10224 anyone with network access to obtain substitutes from it. This means
10225 that any machine running Guix can also act as if it were a build farm,
10226 since the HTTP interface is compatible with Cuirass, the software behind
10227 the @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} build farm.
10228
10229 For security, each substitute is signed, allowing recipients to check
10230 their authenticity and integrity (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because
10231 @command{guix publish} uses the signing key of the system, which is only
10232 readable by the system administrator, it must be started as root; the
10233 @code{--user} option makes it drop root privileges early on.
10234
10235 The signing key pair must be generated before @command{guix publish} is
10236 launched, using @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
10237 guix archive}).
10238
10239 The general syntax is:
10240
10241 @example
10242 guix publish @var{options}@dots{}
10243 @end example
10244
10245 Running @command{guix publish} without any additional arguments will
10246 spawn an HTTP server on port 8080:
10247
10248 @example
10249 guix publish
10250 @end example
10251
10252 Once a publishing server has been authorized (@pxref{Invoking guix
10253 archive}), the daemon may download substitutes from it:
10254
10255 @example
10256 guix-daemon --substitute-urls=http://example.org:8080
10257 @end example
10258
10259 By default, @command{guix publish} compresses archives on the fly as it
10260 serves them. This ``on-the-fly'' mode is convenient in that it requires
10261 no setup and is immediately available. However, when serving lots of
10262 clients, we recommend using the @option{--cache} option, which enables
10263 caching of the archives before they are sent to clients---see below for
10264 details. The @command{guix weather} command provides a handy way to
10265 check what a server provides (@pxref{Invoking guix weather}).
10266
10267 As a bonus, @command{guix publish} also serves as a content-addressed
10268 mirror for source files referenced in @code{origin} records
10269 (@pxref{origin Reference}). For instance, assuming @command{guix
10270 publish} is running on @code{example.org}, the following URL returns the
10271 raw @file{hello-2.10.tar.gz} file with the given SHA256 hash
10272 (represented in @code{nix-base32} format, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}):
10273
10274 @example
10275 http://example.org/file/hello-2.10.tar.gz/sha256/0ssi1@dots{}ndq1i
10276 @end example
10277
10278 Obviously, these URLs only work for files that are in the store; in
10279 other cases, they return 404 (``Not Found'').
10280
10281 @cindex build logs, publication
10282 Build logs are available from @code{/log} URLs like:
10283
10284 @example
10285 http://example.org/log/gwspk@dots{}-guile-2.2.3
10286 @end example
10287
10288 @noindent
10289 When @command{guix-daemon} is configured to save compressed build logs,
10290 as is the case by default (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}), @code{/log}
10291 URLs return the compressed log as-is, with an appropriate
10292 @code{Content-Type} and/or @code{Content-Encoding} header. We recommend
10293 running @command{guix-daemon} with @code{--log-compression=gzip} since
10294 Web browsers can automatically decompress it, which is not the case with
10295 bzip2 compression.
10296
10297 The following options are available:
10298
10299 @table @code
10300 @item --port=@var{port}
10301 @itemx -p @var{port}
10302 Listen for HTTP requests on @var{port}.
10303
10304 @item --listen=@var{host}
10305 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
10306 accept connections from any interface.
10307
10308 @item --user=@var{user}
10309 @itemx -u @var{user}
10310 Change privileges to @var{user} as soon as possible---i.e., once the
10311 server socket is open and the signing key has been read.
10312
10313 @item --compression[=@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
10314 @itemx -C [@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
10315 Compress data using the given @var{method} and @var{level}. @var{method} is
10316 one of @code{lzip} and @code{gzip}; when @var{method} is omitted, @code{gzip}
10317 is used.
10318
10319 When @var{level} is zero, disable compression. The range 1 to 9 corresponds
10320 to different compression levels: 1 is the fastest, and 9 is the best
10321 (CPU-intensive). The default is 3.
10322
10323 Usually, @code{lzip} compresses noticeably better than @code{gzip} for a small
10324 increase in CPU usage; see
10325 @uref{https://nongnu.org/lzip/lzip_benchmark.html,benchmarks on the lzip Web
10326 page}.
10327
10328 Unless @option{--cache} is used, compression occurs on the fly and
10329 the compressed streams are not
10330 cached. Thus, to reduce load on the machine that runs @command{guix
10331 publish}, it may be a good idea to choose a low compression level, to
10332 run @command{guix publish} behind a caching proxy, or to use
10333 @option{--cache}. Using @option{--cache} has the advantage that it
10334 allows @command{guix publish} to add @code{Content-Length} HTTP header
10335 to its responses.
10336
10337 This option can be repeated, in which case every substitute gets compressed
10338 using all the selected methods, and all of them are advertised. This is
10339 useful when users may not support all the compression methods: they can select
10340 the one they support.
10341
10342 @item --cache=@var{directory}
10343 @itemx -c @var{directory}
10344 Cache archives and meta-data (@code{.narinfo} URLs) to @var{directory}
10345 and only serve archives that are in cache.
10346
10347 When this option is omitted, archives and meta-data are created
10348 on-the-fly. This can reduce the available bandwidth, especially when
10349 compression is enabled, since this may become CPU-bound. Another
10350 drawback of the default mode is that the length of archives is not known
10351 in advance, so @command{guix publish} does not add a
10352 @code{Content-Length} HTTP header to its responses, which in turn
10353 prevents clients from knowing the amount of data being downloaded.
10354
10355 Conversely, when @option{--cache} is used, the first request for a store
10356 item (@i{via} a @code{.narinfo} URL) returns 404 and triggers a
10357 background process to @dfn{bake} the archive---computing its
10358 @code{.narinfo} and compressing the archive, if needed. Once the
10359 archive is cached in @var{directory}, subsequent requests succeed and
10360 are served directly from the cache, which guarantees that clients get
10361 the best possible bandwidth.
10362
10363 The ``baking'' process is performed by worker threads. By default, one
10364 thread per CPU core is created, but this can be customized. See
10365 @option{--workers} below.
10366
10367 When @option{--ttl} is used, cached entries are automatically deleted
10368 when they have expired.
10369
10370 @item --workers=@var{N}
10371 When @option{--cache} is used, request the allocation of @var{N} worker
10372 threads to ``bake'' archives.
10373
10374 @item --ttl=@var{ttl}
10375 Produce @code{Cache-Control} HTTP headers that advertise a time-to-live
10376 (TTL) of @var{ttl}. @var{ttl} must denote a duration: @code{5d} means 5
10377 days, @code{1m} means 1 month, and so on.
10378
10379 This allows the user's Guix to keep substitute information in cache for
10380 @var{ttl}. However, note that @code{guix publish} does not itself
10381 guarantee that the store items it provides will indeed remain available
10382 for as long as @var{ttl}.
10383
10384 Additionally, when @option{--cache} is used, cached entries that have
10385 not been accessed for @var{ttl} and that no longer have a corresponding
10386 item in the store, may be deleted.
10387
10388 @item --nar-path=@var{path}
10389 Use @var{path} as the prefix for the URLs of ``nar'' files
10390 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive, normalized archives}).
10391
10392 By default, nars are served at a URL such as
10393 @code{/nar/gzip/@dots{}-coreutils-8.25}. This option allows you to
10394 change the @code{/nar} part to @var{path}.
10395
10396 @item --public-key=@var{file}
10397 @itemx --private-key=@var{file}
10398 Use the specific @var{file}s as the public/private key pair used to sign
10399 the store items being published.
10400
10401 The files must correspond to the same key pair (the private key is used
10402 for signing and the public key is merely advertised in the signature
10403 metadata). They must contain keys in the canonical s-expression format
10404 as produced by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
10405 guix archive}). By default, @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.pub} and
10406 @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.sec} are used.
10407
10408 @item --repl[=@var{port}]
10409 @itemx -r [@var{port}]
10410 Spawn a Guile REPL server (@pxref{REPL Servers,,, guile, GNU Guile
10411 Reference Manual}) on @var{port} (37146 by default). This is used
10412 primarily for debugging a running @command{guix publish} server.
10413 @end table
10414
10415 Enabling @command{guix publish} on Guix System is a one-liner: just
10416 instantiate a @code{guix-publish-service-type} service in the @code{services} field
10417 of the @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{guix-publish-service-type,
10418 @code{guix-publish-service-type}}).
10419
10420 If you are instead running Guix on a ``foreign distro'', follow these
10421 instructions:
10422
10423 @itemize
10424 @item
10425 If your host distro uses the systemd init system:
10426
10427 @example
10428 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-publish.service \
10429 /etc/systemd/system/
10430 # systemctl start guix-publish && systemctl enable guix-publish
10431 @end example
10432
10433 @item
10434 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
10435
10436 @example
10437 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-publish.conf /etc/init/
10438 # start guix-publish
10439 @end example
10440
10441 @item
10442 Otherwise, proceed similarly with your distro's init system.
10443 @end itemize
10444
10445 @node Invoking guix challenge
10446 @section Invoking @command{guix challenge}
10447
10448 @cindex reproducible builds
10449 @cindex verifiable builds
10450 @cindex @command{guix challenge}
10451 @cindex challenge
10452 Do the binaries provided by this server really correspond to the source
10453 code it claims to build? Is a package build process deterministic?
10454 These are the questions the @command{guix challenge} command attempts to
10455 answer.
10456
10457 The former is obviously an important question: Before using a substitute
10458 server (@pxref{Substitutes}), one had better @emph{verify} that it
10459 provides the right binaries, and thus @emph{challenge} it. The latter
10460 is what enables the former: If package builds are deterministic, then
10461 independent builds of the package should yield the exact same result,
10462 bit for bit; if a server provides a binary different from the one
10463 obtained locally, it may be either corrupt or malicious.
10464
10465 We know that the hash that shows up in @file{/gnu/store} file names is
10466 the hash of all the inputs of the process that built the file or
10467 directory---compilers, libraries, build scripts,
10468 etc. (@pxref{Introduction}). Assuming deterministic build processes,
10469 one store file name should map to exactly one build output.
10470 @command{guix challenge} checks whether there is, indeed, a single
10471 mapping by comparing the build outputs of several independent builds of
10472 any given store item.
10473
10474 The command output looks like this:
10475
10476 @smallexample
10477 $ guix challenge --substitute-urls="https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER} https://guix.example.org"
10478 updating list of substitutes from 'https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}'... 100.0%
10479 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
10480 /gnu/store/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d contents differ:
10481 local hash: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
10482 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
10483 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 1zy4fmaaqcnjrzzajkdn3f5gmjk754b43qkq47llbyak9z0qjyim
10484 differing files:
10485 /lib/libcrypto.so.1.1
10486 /lib/libssl.so.1.1
10487
10488 /gnu/store/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 contents differ:
10489 local hash: 00p3bmryhjxrhpn2gxs2fy0a15lnip05l97205pgbk5ra395hyha
10490 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 069nb85bv4d4a6slrwjdy8v1cn4cwspm3kdbmyb81d6zckj3nq9f
10491 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 0mdqa9w1p6cmli6976v4wi0sw9r4p5prkj7lzfd1877wk11c9c73
10492 differing file:
10493 /libexec/git-core/git-fsck
10494
10495 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1 contents differ:
10496 local hash: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
10497 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
10498 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 1cy25x1a4fzq5rk0pmvc8xhwyffnqz95h2bpvqsz2mpvlbccy0gs
10499 differing file:
10500 /share/man/man1/pius.1.gz
10501
10502 @dots{}
10503
10504 6,406 store items were analyzed:
10505 - 4,749 (74.1%) were identical
10506 - 525 (8.2%) differed
10507 - 1,132 (17.7%) were inconclusive
10508 @end smallexample
10509
10510 @noindent
10511 In this example, @command{guix challenge} first scans the store to
10512 determine the set of locally-built derivations---as opposed to store
10513 items that were downloaded from a substitute server---and then queries
10514 all the substitute servers. It then reports those store items for which
10515 the servers obtained a result different from the local build.
10516
10517 @cindex non-determinism, in package builds
10518 As an example, @code{guix.example.org} always gets a different answer.
10519 Conversely, @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} agrees with local builds, except in the
10520 case of Git. This might indicate that the build process of Git is
10521 non-deterministic, meaning that its output varies as a function of
10522 various things that Guix does not fully control, in spite of building
10523 packages in isolated environments (@pxref{Features}). Most common
10524 sources of non-determinism include the addition of timestamps in build
10525 results, the inclusion of random numbers, and directory listings sorted
10526 by inode number. See @uref{https://reproducible-builds.org/docs/}, for
10527 more information.
10528
10529 To find out what is wrong with this Git binary, the easiest approach is
10530 to run:
10531
10532 @example
10533 guix challenge git \
10534 --diff=diffoscope \
10535 --substitute-urls="https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER} https://guix.example.org"
10536 @end example
10537
10538 This automatically invokes @command{diffoscope}, which displays detailed
10539 information about files that differ.
10540
10541 Alternately, we can do something along these lines (@pxref{Invoking guix
10542 archive}):
10543
10544 @example
10545 $ wget -q -O - https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 \
10546 | guix archive -x /tmp/git
10547 $ diff -ur --no-dereference /gnu/store/@dots{}-git.2.5.0 /tmp/git
10548 @end example
10549
10550 This command shows the difference between the files resulting from the
10551 local build, and the files resulting from the build on
10552 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Overview, Comparing and Merging Files,,
10553 diffutils, Comparing and Merging Files}). The @command{diff} command
10554 works great for text files. When binary files differ, a better option
10555 is @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, a tool that helps
10556 visualize differences for all kinds of files.
10557
10558 Once you have done that work, you can tell whether the differences are due
10559 to a non-deterministic build process or to a malicious server. We try
10560 hard to remove sources of non-determinism in packages to make it easier
10561 to verify substitutes, but of course, this is a process that
10562 involves not just Guix, but a large part of the free software community.
10563 In the meantime, @command{guix challenge} is one tool to help address
10564 the problem.
10565
10566 If you are writing packages for Guix, you are encouraged to check
10567 whether @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} and other substitute servers obtain the
10568 same build result as you did with:
10569
10570 @example
10571 $ guix challenge @var{package}
10572 @end example
10573
10574 @noindent
10575 where @var{package} is a package specification such as
10576 @code{guile@@2.0} or @code{glibc:debug}.
10577
10578 The general syntax is:
10579
10580 @example
10581 guix challenge @var{options} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
10582 @end example
10583
10584 When a difference is found between the hash of a locally-built item and
10585 that of a server-provided substitute, or among substitutes provided by
10586 different servers, the command displays it as in the example above and
10587 its exit code is 2 (other non-zero exit codes denote other kinds of
10588 errors.)
10589
10590 The one option that matters is:
10591
10592 @table @code
10593
10594 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
10595 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
10596 URLs to compare to.
10597
10598 @item --diff=@var{mode}
10599 Upon mismatches, show differences according to @var{mode}, one of:
10600
10601 @table @asis
10602 @item @code{simple} (the default)
10603 Show the list of files that differ.
10604
10605 @item @code{diffoscope}
10606 @itemx @var{command}
10607 Invoke @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, passing it
10608 two directories whose contents do not match.
10609
10610 When @var{command} is an absolute file name, run @var{command} instead
10611 of Diffoscope.
10612
10613 @item @code{none}
10614 Do not show further details about the differences.
10615 @end table
10616
10617 Thus, unless @code{--diff=none} is passed, @command{guix challenge}
10618 downloads the store items from the given substitute servers so that it
10619 can compare them.
10620
10621 @item --verbose
10622 @itemx -v
10623 Show details about matches (identical contents) in addition to
10624 information about mismatches.
10625
10626 @end table
10627
10628 @node Invoking guix copy
10629 @section Invoking @command{guix copy}
10630
10631 @cindex copy, of store items, over SSH
10632 @cindex SSH, copy of store items
10633 @cindex sharing store items across machines
10634 @cindex transferring store items across machines
10635 The @command{guix copy} command copies items from the store of one
10636 machine to that of another machine over a secure shell (SSH)
10637 connection@footnote{This command is available only when Guile-SSH was
10638 found. @xref{Requirements}, for details.}. For example, the following
10639 command copies the @code{coreutils} package, the user's profile, and all
10640 their dependencies over to @var{host}, logged in as @var{user}:
10641
10642 @example
10643 guix copy --to=@var{user}@@@var{host} \
10644 coreutils `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
10645 @end example
10646
10647 If some of the items to be copied are already present on @var{host},
10648 they are not actually sent.
10649
10650 The command below retrieves @code{libreoffice} and @code{gimp} from
10651 @var{host}, assuming they are available there:
10652
10653 @example
10654 guix copy --from=@var{host} libreoffice gimp
10655 @end example
10656
10657 The SSH connection is established using the Guile-SSH client, which is
10658 compatible with OpenSSH: it honors @file{~/.ssh/known_hosts} and
10659 @file{~/.ssh/config}, and uses the SSH agent for authentication.
10660
10661 The key used to sign items that are sent must be accepted by the remote
10662 machine. Likewise, the key used by the remote machine to sign items you
10663 are retrieving must be in @file{/etc/guix/acl} so it is accepted by your
10664 own daemon. @xref{Invoking guix archive}, for more information about
10665 store item authentication.
10666
10667 The general syntax is:
10668
10669 @example
10670 guix copy [--to=@var{spec}|--from=@var{spec}] @var{items}@dots{}
10671 @end example
10672
10673 You must always specify one of the following options:
10674
10675 @table @code
10676 @item --to=@var{spec}
10677 @itemx --from=@var{spec}
10678 Specify the host to send to or receive from. @var{spec} must be an SSH
10679 spec such as @code{example.org}, @code{charlie@@example.org}, or
10680 @code{charlie@@example.org:2222}.
10681 @end table
10682
10683 The @var{items} can be either package names, such as @code{gimp}, or
10684 store items, such as @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-idutils-4.6}.
10685
10686 When specifying the name of a package to send, it is first built if
10687 needed, unless @option{--dry-run} was specified. Common build options
10688 are supported (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
10689
10690
10691 @node Invoking guix container
10692 @section Invoking @command{guix container}
10693 @cindex container
10694 @cindex @command{guix container}
10695 @quotation Note
10696 As of version @value{VERSION}, this tool is experimental. The interface
10697 is subject to radical change in the future.
10698 @end quotation
10699
10700 The purpose of @command{guix container} is to manipulate processes
10701 running within an isolated environment, commonly known as a
10702 ``container'', typically created by the @command{guix environment}
10703 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}) and @command{guix system container}
10704 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}) commands.
10705
10706 The general syntax is:
10707
10708 @example
10709 guix container @var{action} @var{options}@dots{}
10710 @end example
10711
10712 @var{action} specifies the operation to perform with a container, and
10713 @var{options} specifies the context-specific arguments for the action.
10714
10715 The following actions are available:
10716
10717 @table @code
10718 @item exec
10719 Execute a command within the context of a running container.
10720
10721 The syntax is:
10722
10723 @example
10724 guix container exec @var{pid} @var{program} @var{arguments}@dots{}
10725 @end example
10726
10727 @var{pid} specifies the process ID of the running container.
10728 @var{program} specifies an executable file name within the root file
10729 system of the container. @var{arguments} are the additional options that
10730 will be passed to @var{program}.
10731
10732 The following command launches an interactive login shell inside a
10733 Guix system container, started by @command{guix system container}, and whose
10734 process ID is 9001:
10735
10736 @example
10737 guix container exec 9001 /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
10738 @end example
10739
10740 Note that the @var{pid} cannot be the parent process of a container. It
10741 must be PID 1 of the container or one of its child processes.
10742
10743 @end table
10744
10745 @node Invoking guix weather
10746 @section Invoking @command{guix weather}
10747
10748 Occasionally you're grumpy because substitutes are lacking and you end
10749 up building packages by yourself (@pxref{Substitutes}). The
10750 @command{guix weather} command reports on substitute availability on the
10751 specified servers so you can have an idea of whether you'll be grumpy
10752 today. It can sometimes be useful info as a user, but it is primarily
10753 useful to people running @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking guix
10754 publish}).
10755
10756 @cindex statistics, for substitutes
10757 @cindex availability of substitutes
10758 @cindex substitute availability
10759 @cindex weather, substitute availability
10760 Here's a sample run:
10761
10762 @example
10763 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=https://guix.example.org
10764 computing 5,872 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
10765 looking for 6,128 store items on https://guix.example.org..
10766 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
10767 https://guix.example.org
10768 43.4% substitutes available (2,658 out of 6,128)
10769 7,032.5 MiB of nars (compressed)
10770 19,824.2 MiB on disk (uncompressed)
10771 0.030 seconds per request (182.9 seconds in total)
10772 33.5 requests per second
10773
10774 9.8% (342 out of 3,470) of the missing items are queued
10775 867 queued builds
10776 x86_64-linux: 518 (59.7%)
10777 i686-linux: 221 (25.5%)
10778 aarch64-linux: 128 (14.8%)
10779 build rate: 23.41 builds per hour
10780 x86_64-linux: 11.16 builds per hour
10781 i686-linux: 6.03 builds per hour
10782 aarch64-linux: 6.41 builds per hour
10783 @end example
10784
10785 @cindex continuous integration, statistics
10786 As you can see, it reports the fraction of all the packages for which
10787 substitutes are available on the server---regardless of whether
10788 substitutes are enabled, and regardless of whether this server's signing
10789 key is authorized. It also reports the size of the compressed archives
10790 (``nars'') provided by the server, the size the corresponding store
10791 items occupy in the store (assuming deduplication is turned off), and
10792 the server's throughput. The second part gives continuous integration
10793 (CI) statistics, if the server supports it. In addition, using the
10794 @option{--coverage} option, @command{guix weather} can list ``important''
10795 package substitutes missing on the server (see below).
10796
10797 To achieve that, @command{guix weather} queries over HTTP(S) meta-data
10798 (@dfn{narinfos}) for all the relevant store items. Like @command{guix
10799 challenge}, it ignores signatures on those substitutes, which is
10800 innocuous since the command only gathers statistics and cannot install
10801 those substitutes.
10802
10803 The general syntax is:
10804
10805 @example
10806 guix weather @var{options}@dots{} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
10807 @end example
10808
10809 When @var{packages} is omitted, @command{guix weather} checks the availability
10810 of substitutes for @emph{all} the packages, or for those specified with
10811 @option{--manifest}; otherwise it only considers the specified packages. It
10812 is also possible to query specific system types with @option{--system}.
10813 @command{guix weather} exits with a non-zero code when the fraction of
10814 available substitutes is below 100%.
10815
10816 The available options are listed below.
10817
10818 @table @code
10819 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
10820 @var{urls} is the space-separated list of substitute server URLs to
10821 query. When this option is omitted, the default set of substitute
10822 servers is queried.
10823
10824 @item --system=@var{system}
10825 @itemx -s @var{system}
10826 Query substitutes for @var{system}---e.g., @code{aarch64-linux}. This
10827 option can be repeated, in which case @command{guix weather} will query
10828 substitutes for several system types.
10829
10830 @item --manifest=@var{file}
10831 Instead of querying substitutes for all the packages, only ask for those
10832 specified in @var{file}. @var{file} must contain a @dfn{manifest}, as
10833 with the @code{-m} option of @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking
10834 guix package}).
10835
10836 This option can be repeated several times, in which case the manifests
10837 are concatenated.
10838
10839 @item --coverage[=@var{count}]
10840 @itemx -c [@var{count}]
10841 Report on substitute coverage for packages: list packages with at least
10842 @var{count} dependents (zero by default) for which substitutes are
10843 unavailable. Dependent packages themselves are not listed: if @var{b} depends
10844 on @var{a} and @var{a} has no substitutes, only @var{a} is listed, even though
10845 @var{b} usually lacks substitutes as well. The result looks like this:
10846
10847 @example
10848 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL} -c 10
10849 computing 8,983 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
10850 looking for 9,343 store items on @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}...
10851 updating substitutes from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}'... 100.0%
10852 @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}
10853 64.7% substitutes available (6,047 out of 9,343)
10854 @dots{}
10855 2502 packages are missing from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}' for 'x86_64-linux', among which:
10856 58 kcoreaddons@@5.49.0 /gnu/store/@dots{}-kcoreaddons-5.49.0
10857 46 qgpgme@@1.11.1 /gnu/store/@dots{}-qgpgme-1.11.1
10858 37 perl-http-cookiejar@@0.008 /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-http-cookiejar-0.008
10859 @dots{}
10860 @end example
10861
10862 What this example shows is that @code{kcoreaddons} and presumably the 58
10863 packages that depend on it have no substitutes at @code{ci.guix.info};
10864 likewise for @code{qgpgme} and the 46 packages that depend on it.
10865
10866 If you are a Guix developer, or if you are taking care of this build farm,
10867 you'll probably want to have a closer look at these packages: they may simply
10868 fail to build.
10869
10870 @item --display-missing
10871 Display the list of store items for which substitutes are missing.
10872 @end table
10873
10874 @node Invoking guix processes
10875 @section Invoking @command{guix processes}
10876
10877 The @command{guix processes} command can be useful to developers and system
10878 administrators, especially on multi-user machines and on build farms: it lists
10879 the current sessions (connections to the daemon), as well as information about
10880 the processes involved@footnote{Remote sessions, when @command{guix-daemon} is
10881 started with @option{--listen} specifying a TCP endpoint, are @emph{not}
10882 listed.}. Here's an example of the information it returns:
10883
10884 @example
10885 $ sudo guix processes
10886 SessionPID: 19002
10887 ClientPID: 19090
10888 ClientCommand: guix environment --ad-hoc python
10889
10890 SessionPID: 19402
10891 ClientPID: 19367
10892 ClientCommand: guix publish -u guix-publish -p 3000 -C 9 @dots{}
10893
10894 SessionPID: 19444
10895 ClientPID: 19419
10896 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
10897 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-ipc-cmd-0.96.lock
10898 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-python-six-bootstrap-1.11.0.lock
10899 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-libjpeg-turbo-2.0.0.lock
10900 ChildProcess: 20495: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
10901 ChildProcess: 27733: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
10902 ChildProcess: 27793: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
10903 @end example
10904
10905 In this example we see that @command{guix-daemon} has three clients:
10906 @command{guix environment}, @command{guix publish}, and the Cuirass continuous
10907 integration tool; their process identifier (PID) is given by the
10908 @code{ClientPID} field. The @code{SessionPID} field gives the PID of the
10909 @command{guix-daemon} sub-process of this particular session.
10910
10911 The @code{LockHeld} fields show which store items are currently locked by this
10912 session, which corresponds to store items being built or substituted (the
10913 @code{LockHeld} field is not displayed when @command{guix processes} is not
10914 running as root.) Last, by looking at the @code{ChildProcess} field, we
10915 understand that these three builds are being offloaded (@pxref{Daemon Offload
10916 Setup}).
10917
10918 The output is in Recutils format so we can use the handy @command{recsel}
10919 command to select sessions of interest (@pxref{Selection Expressions,,,
10920 recutils, GNU recutils manual}). As an example, the command shows the command
10921 line and PID of the client that triggered the build of a Perl package:
10922
10923 @example
10924 $ sudo guix processes | \
10925 recsel -p ClientPID,ClientCommand -e 'LockHeld ~ "perl"'
10926 ClientPID: 19419
10927 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
10928 @end example
10929
10930 @node System Configuration
10931 @chapter System Configuration
10932
10933 @cindex system configuration
10934 Guix System supports a consistent whole-system configuration
10935 mechanism. By that we mean that all aspects of the global system
10936 configuration---such as the available system services, timezone and
10937 locale settings, user accounts---are declared in a single place. Such
10938 a @dfn{system configuration} can be @dfn{instantiated}---i.e., effected.
10939
10940 One of the advantages of putting all the system configuration under the
10941 control of Guix is that it supports transactional system upgrades, and
10942 makes it possible to roll back to a previous system instantiation,
10943 should something go wrong with the new one (@pxref{Features}). Another
10944 advantage is that it makes it easy to replicate the exact same configuration
10945 across different machines, or at different points in time, without
10946 having to resort to additional administration tools layered on top of
10947 the own tools of the system.
10948 @c Yes, we're talking of Puppet, Chef, & co. here. ↑
10949
10950 This section describes this mechanism. First we focus on the system
10951 administrator's viewpoint---explaining how the system is configured and
10952 instantiated. Then we show how this mechanism can be extended, for
10953 instance to support new system services.
10954
10955 @menu
10956 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
10957 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
10958 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
10959 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
10960 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
10961 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
10962 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
10963 * Services:: Specifying system services.
10964 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
10965 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
10966 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
10967 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
10968 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
10969 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
10970 * Invoking guix deploy:: Deploying a system configuration to a remote host.
10971 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
10972 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
10973 @end menu
10974
10975 @node Using the Configuration System
10976 @section Using the Configuration System
10977
10978 The operating system is configured by providing an
10979 @code{operating-system} declaration in a file that can then be passed to
10980 the @command{guix system} command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). A
10981 simple setup, with the default system services, the default Linux-Libre
10982 kernel, initial RAM disk, and boot loader looks like this:
10983
10984 @findex operating-system
10985 @lisp
10986 @include os-config-bare-bones.texi
10987 @end lisp
10988
10989 This example should be self-describing. Some of the fields defined
10990 above, such as @code{host-name} and @code{bootloader}, are mandatory.
10991 Others, such as @code{packages} and @code{services}, can be omitted, in
10992 which case they get a default value.
10993
10994 Below we discuss the effect of some of the most important fields
10995 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}, for details about all the available
10996 fields), and how to @dfn{instantiate} the operating system using
10997 @command{guix system}.
10998
10999 @unnumberedsubsec Bootloader
11000
11001 @cindex legacy boot, on Intel machines
11002 @cindex BIOS boot, on Intel machines
11003 @cindex UEFI boot
11004 @cindex EFI boot
11005 The @code{bootloader} field describes the method that will be used to boot
11006 your system. Machines based on Intel processors can boot in ``legacy'' BIOS
11007 mode, as in the example above. However, more recent machines rely instead on
11008 the @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI) to boot. In that case,
11009 the @code{bootloader} field should contain something along these lines:
11010
11011 @lisp
11012 (bootloader-configuration
11013 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
11014 (target "/boot/efi"))
11015 @end lisp
11016
11017 @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more information on the available
11018 configuration options.
11019
11020 @unnumberedsubsec Globally-Visible Packages
11021
11022 @vindex %base-packages
11023 The @code{packages} field lists packages that will be globally visible
11024 on the system, for all user accounts---i.e., in every user's @code{PATH}
11025 environment variable---in addition to the per-user profiles
11026 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). The @code{%base-packages} variable
11027 provides all the tools one would expect for basic user and administrator
11028 tasks---including the GNU Core Utilities, the GNU Networking Utilities,
11029 the GNU Zile lightweight text editor, @command{find}, @command{grep},
11030 etc. The example above adds GNU@tie{}Screen to those,
11031 taken from the @code{(gnu packages screen)}
11032 module (@pxref{Package Modules}). The
11033 @code{(list package output)} syntax can be used to add a specific output
11034 of a package:
11035
11036 @lisp
11037 (use-modules (gnu packages))
11038 (use-modules (gnu packages dns))
11039
11040 (operating-system
11041 ;; ...
11042 (packages (cons (list bind "utils")
11043 %base-packages)))
11044 @end lisp
11045
11046 @findex specification->package
11047 Referring to packages by variable name, like @code{bind} above, has
11048 the advantage of being unambiguous; it also allows typos and such to be
11049 diagnosed right away as ``unbound variables''. The downside is that one
11050 needs to know which module defines which package, and to augment the
11051 @code{use-package-modules} line accordingly. To avoid that, one can use
11052 the @code{specification->package} procedure of the @code{(gnu packages)}
11053 module, which returns the best package for a given name or name and
11054 version:
11055
11056 @lisp
11057 (use-modules (gnu packages))
11058
11059 (operating-system
11060 ;; ...
11061 (packages (append (map specification->package
11062 '("tcpdump" "htop" "gnupg@@2.0"))
11063 %base-packages)))
11064 @end lisp
11065
11066 @unnumberedsubsec System Services
11067
11068 @cindex services
11069 @vindex %base-services
11070 The @code{services} field lists @dfn{system services} to be made
11071 available when the system starts (@pxref{Services}).
11072 The @code{operating-system} declaration above specifies that, in
11073 addition to the basic services, we want the OpenSSH secure shell
11074 daemon listening on port 2222 (@pxref{Networking Services,
11075 @code{openssh-service-type}}). Under the hood,
11076 @code{openssh-service-type} arranges so that @command{sshd} is started with the
11077 right command-line options, possibly with supporting configuration files
11078 generated as needed (@pxref{Defining Services}).
11079
11080 @cindex customization, of services
11081 @findex modify-services
11082 Occasionally, instead of using the base services as is, you will want to
11083 customize them. To do this, use @code{modify-services} (@pxref{Service
11084 Reference, @code{modify-services}}) to modify the list.
11085
11086 For example, suppose you want to modify @code{guix-daemon} and Mingetty
11087 (the console log-in) in the @code{%base-services} list (@pxref{Base
11088 Services, @code{%base-services}}). To do that, you can write the
11089 following in your operating system declaration:
11090
11091 @lisp
11092 (define %my-services
11093 ;; My very own list of services.
11094 (modify-services %base-services
11095 (guix-service-type config =>
11096 (guix-configuration
11097 (inherit config)
11098 (use-substitutes? #f)
11099 (extra-options '("--gc-keep-derivations"))))
11100 (mingetty-service-type config =>
11101 (mingetty-configuration
11102 (inherit config)))))
11103
11104 (operating-system
11105 ;; @dots{}
11106 (services %my-services))
11107 @end lisp
11108
11109 This changes the configuration---i.e., the service parameters---of the
11110 @code{guix-service-type} instance, and that of all the
11111 @code{mingetty-service-type} instances in the @code{%base-services} list.
11112 Observe how this is accomplished: first, we arrange for the original
11113 configuration to be bound to the identifier @code{config} in the
11114 @var{body}, and then we write the @var{body} so that it evaluates to the
11115 desired configuration. In particular, notice how we use @code{inherit}
11116 to create a new configuration which has the same values as the old
11117 configuration, but with a few modifications.
11118
11119 @cindex encrypted disk
11120 The configuration for a typical ``desktop'' usage, with an encrypted
11121 root partition, the X11 display
11122 server, GNOME and Xfce (users can choose which of these desktop
11123 environments to use at the log-in screen by pressing @kbd{F1}), network
11124 management, power management, and more, would look like this:
11125
11126 @lisp
11127 @include os-config-desktop.texi
11128 @end lisp
11129
11130 A graphical system with a choice of lightweight window managers
11131 instead of full-blown desktop environments would look like this:
11132
11133 @lisp
11134 @include os-config-lightweight-desktop.texi
11135 @end lisp
11136
11137 This example refers to the @file{/boot/efi} file system by its UUID,
11138 @code{1234-ABCD}. Replace this UUID with the right UUID on your system,
11139 as returned by the @command{blkid} command.
11140
11141 @xref{Desktop Services}, for the exact list of services provided by
11142 @code{%desktop-services}. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for background
11143 information about the @code{nss-certs} package that is used here.
11144
11145 Again, @code{%desktop-services} is just a list of service objects. If
11146 you want to remove services from there, you can do so using the
11147 procedures for list filtering (@pxref{SRFI-1 Filtering and
11148 Partitioning,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For instance, the
11149 following expression returns a list that contains all the services in
11150 @code{%desktop-services} minus the Avahi service:
11151
11152 @lisp
11153 (remove (lambda (service)
11154 (eq? (service-kind service) avahi-service-type))
11155 %desktop-services)
11156 @end lisp
11157
11158 @unnumberedsubsec Instantiating the System
11159
11160 Assuming the @code{operating-system} declaration
11161 is stored in the @file{my-system-config.scm}
11162 file, the @command{guix system reconfigure my-system-config.scm} command
11163 instantiates that configuration, and makes it the default GRUB boot
11164 entry (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
11165
11166 The normal way to change the system configuration is by updating this
11167 file and re-running @command{guix system reconfigure}. One should never
11168 have to touch files in @file{/etc} or to run commands that modify the
11169 system state such as @command{useradd} or @command{grub-install}. In
11170 fact, you must avoid that since that would not only void your warranty
11171 but also prevent you from rolling back to previous versions of your
11172 system, should you ever need to.
11173
11174 @cindex roll-back, of the operating system
11175 Speaking of roll-back, each time you run @command{guix system
11176 reconfigure}, a new @dfn{generation} of the system is created---without
11177 modifying or deleting previous generations. Old system generations get
11178 an entry in the bootloader boot menu, allowing you to boot them in case
11179 something went wrong with the latest generation. Reassuring, no? The
11180 @command{guix system list-generations} command lists the system
11181 generations available on disk. It is also possible to roll back the
11182 system via the commands @command{guix system roll-back} and
11183 @command{guix system switch-generation}.
11184
11185 Although the @command{guix system reconfigure} command will not modify
11186 previous generations, you must take care when the current generation is not
11187 the latest (e.g., after invoking @command{guix system roll-back}), since
11188 the operation might overwrite a later generation (@pxref{Invoking guix
11189 system}).
11190
11191 @unnumberedsubsec The Programming Interface
11192
11193 At the Scheme level, the bulk of an @code{operating-system} declaration
11194 is instantiated with the following monadic procedure (@pxref{The Store
11195 Monad}):
11196
11197 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} operating-system-derivation os
11198 Return a derivation that builds @var{os}, an @code{operating-system}
11199 object (@pxref{Derivations}).
11200
11201 The output of the derivation is a single directory that refers to all
11202 the packages, configuration files, and other supporting files needed to
11203 instantiate @var{os}.
11204 @end deffn
11205
11206 This procedure is provided by the @code{(gnu system)} module. Along
11207 with @code{(gnu services)} (@pxref{Services}), this module contains the
11208 guts of Guix System. Make sure to visit it!
11209
11210
11211 @node operating-system Reference
11212 @section @code{operating-system} Reference
11213
11214 This section summarizes all the options available in
11215 @code{operating-system} declarations (@pxref{Using the Configuration
11216 System}).
11217
11218 @deftp {Data Type} operating-system
11219 This is the data type representing an operating system configuration.
11220 By that, we mean all the global system configuration, not per-user
11221 configuration (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
11222
11223 @table @asis
11224 @item @code{kernel} (default: @var{linux-libre})
11225 The package object of the operating system kernel to use@footnote{Currently
11226 only the Linux-libre kernel is supported. In the future, it will be
11227 possible to use the GNU@tie{}Hurd.}.
11228
11229 @item @code{kernel-arguments} (default: @code{'("quiet")})
11230 List of strings or gexps representing additional arguments to pass on
11231 the command-line of the kernel---e.g., @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
11232
11233 @item @code{bootloader}
11234 The system bootloader configuration object. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}.
11235
11236 @item @code{label}
11237 This is the label (a string) as it appears in the bootloader's menu entry.
11238 The default label includes the kernel name and version.
11239
11240 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
11241 This field specifies the keyboard layout to use in the console. It can be
11242 either @code{#f}, in which case the default keyboard layout is used (usually
11243 US English), or a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record.
11244
11245 This keyboard layout is in effect as soon as the kernel has booted. For
11246 instance, it is the keyboard layout in effect when you type a passphrase if
11247 your root file system is on a @code{luks-device-mapping} mapped device
11248 (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
11249
11250 @quotation Note
11251 This does @emph{not} specify the keyboard layout used by the bootloader, nor
11252 that used by the graphical display server. @xref{Bootloader Configuration},
11253 for information on how to specify the bootloader's keyboard layout. @xref{X
11254 Window}, for information on how to specify the keyboard layout used by the X
11255 Window System.
11256 @end quotation
11257
11258 @item @code{initrd-modules} (default: @code{%base-initrd-modules})
11259 @cindex initrd
11260 @cindex initial RAM disk
11261 The list of Linux kernel modules that need to be available in the
11262 initial RAM disk. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
11263
11264 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{base-initrd})
11265 A procedure that returns an initial RAM disk for the Linux
11266 kernel. This field is provided to support low-level customization and
11267 should rarely be needed for casual use. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
11268
11269 @item @code{firmware} (default: @code{%base-firmware})
11270 @cindex firmware
11271 List of firmware packages loadable by the operating system kernel.
11272
11273 The default includes firmware needed for Atheros- and Broadcom-based
11274 WiFi devices (Linux-libre modules @code{ath9k} and @code{b43-open},
11275 respectively). @xref{Hardware Considerations}, for more info on
11276 supported hardware.
11277
11278 @item @code{host-name}
11279 The host name.
11280
11281 @item @code{hosts-file}
11282 @cindex hosts file
11283 A file-like object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) for use as
11284 @file{/etc/hosts} (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
11285 Reference Manual}). The default is a file with entries for
11286 @code{localhost} and @var{host-name}.
11287
11288 @item @code{mapped-devices} (default: @code{'()})
11289 A list of mapped devices. @xref{Mapped Devices}.
11290
11291 @item @code{file-systems}
11292 A list of file systems. @xref{File Systems}.
11293
11294 @item @code{swap-devices} (default: @code{'()})
11295 @cindex swap devices
11296 A list of strings identifying devices or files to be used for ``swap
11297 space'' (@pxref{Memory Concepts,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
11298 Manual}). For example, @code{'("/dev/sda3")} or @code{'("/swapfile")}.
11299 It is possible to specify a swap file in a file system on a mapped
11300 device, provided that the necessary device mapping and file system are
11301 also specified. @xref{Mapped Devices} and @ref{File Systems}.
11302
11303 @item @code{users} (default: @code{%base-user-accounts})
11304 @itemx @code{groups} (default: @code{%base-groups})
11305 List of user accounts and groups. @xref{User Accounts}.
11306
11307 If the @code{users} list lacks a user account with UID@tie{}0, a
11308 ``root'' account with UID@tie{}0 is automatically added.
11309
11310 @item @code{skeletons} (default: @code{(default-skeletons)})
11311 A list target file name/file-like object tuples (@pxref{G-Expressions,
11312 file-like objects}). These are the skeleton files that will be added to
11313 the home directory of newly-created user accounts.
11314
11315 For instance, a valid value may look like this:
11316
11317 @lisp
11318 `((".bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc" "echo Hello\n"))
11319 (".guile" ,(plain-file "guile"
11320 "(use-modules (ice-9 readline))
11321 (activate-readline)")))
11322 @end lisp
11323
11324 @item @code{issue} (default: @code{%default-issue})
11325 A string denoting the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file, which is
11326 displayed when users log in on a text console.
11327
11328 @item @code{packages} (default: @code{%base-packages})
11329 The set of packages installed in the global profile, which is accessible
11330 at @file{/run/current-system/profile}.
11331
11332 The default set includes core utilities and it is good practice to
11333 install non-core utilities in user profiles (@pxref{Invoking guix
11334 package}).
11335
11336 @item @code{timezone}
11337 A timezone identifying string---e.g., @code{"Europe/Paris"}.
11338
11339 You can run the @command{tzselect} command to find out which timezone
11340 string corresponds to your region. Choosing an invalid timezone name
11341 causes @command{guix system} to fail.
11342
11343 @item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
11344 The name of the default locale (@pxref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C
11345 Library Reference Manual}). @xref{Locales}, for more information.
11346
11347 @item @code{locale-definitions} (default: @code{%default-locale-definitions})
11348 The list of locale definitions to be compiled and that may be used at
11349 run time. @xref{Locales}.
11350
11351 @item @code{locale-libcs} (default: @code{(list @var{glibc})})
11352 The list of GNU@tie{}libc packages whose locale data and tools are used
11353 to build the locale definitions. @xref{Locales}, for compatibility
11354 considerations that justify this option.
11355
11356 @item @code{name-service-switch} (default: @code{%default-nss})
11357 Configuration of the libc name service switch (NSS)---a
11358 @code{<name-service-switch>} object. @xref{Name Service Switch}, for
11359 details.
11360
11361 @item @code{services} (default: @code{%base-services})
11362 A list of service objects denoting system services. @xref{Services}.
11363
11364 @cindex essential services
11365 @item @code{essential-services} (default: ...)
11366 The list of ``essential services''---i.e., things like instances of
11367 @code{system-service-type} and @code{host-name-service-type} (@pxref{Service
11368 Reference}), which are derived from the operating system definition itself.
11369 As a user you should @emph{never} need to touch this field.
11370
11371 @item @code{pam-services} (default: @code{(base-pam-services)})
11372 @cindex PAM
11373 @cindex pluggable authentication modules
11374 Linux @dfn{pluggable authentication module} (PAM) services.
11375 @c FIXME: Add xref to PAM services section.
11376
11377 @item @code{setuid-programs} (default: @var{%setuid-programs})
11378 List of string-valued G-expressions denoting setuid programs.
11379 @xref{Setuid Programs}.
11380
11381 @item @code{sudoers-file} (default: @var{%sudoers-specification})
11382 @cindex sudoers file
11383 The contents of the @file{/etc/sudoers} file as a file-like object
11384 (@pxref{G-Expressions, @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}}).
11385
11386 This file specifies which users can use the @command{sudo} command, what
11387 they are allowed to do, and what privileges they may gain. The default
11388 is that only @code{root} and members of the @code{wheel} group may use
11389 @code{sudo}.
11390
11391 @end table
11392
11393 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-operating-system
11394 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of an operating system field definition,
11395 this identifier resolves to the operating system being defined.
11396
11397 The example below shows how to refer to the operating system being defined in
11398 the definition of the @code{label} field:
11399
11400 @lisp
11401 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
11402
11403 (operating-system
11404 ;; ...
11405 (label (package-full-name
11406 (operating-system-kernel this-operating-system))))
11407 @end lisp
11408
11409 It is an error to refer to @code{this-operating-system} outside an operating
11410 system definition.
11411 @end deffn
11412
11413 @end deftp
11414
11415 @node File Systems
11416 @section File Systems
11417
11418 The list of file systems to be mounted is specified in the
11419 @code{file-systems} field of the operating system declaration
11420 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). Each file system is declared
11421 using the @code{file-system} form, like this:
11422
11423 @lisp
11424 (file-system
11425 (mount-point "/home")
11426 (device "/dev/sda3")
11427 (type "ext4"))
11428 @end lisp
11429
11430 As usual, some of the fields are mandatory---those shown in the example
11431 above---while others can be omitted. These are described below.
11432
11433 @deftp {Data Type} file-system
11434 Objects of this type represent file systems to be mounted. They
11435 contain the following members:
11436
11437 @table @asis
11438 @item @code{type}
11439 This is a string specifying the type of the file system---e.g.,
11440 @code{"ext4"}.
11441
11442 @item @code{mount-point}
11443 This designates the place where the file system is to be mounted.
11444
11445 @item @code{device}
11446 This names the ``source'' of the file system. It can be one of three
11447 things: a file system label, a file system UUID, or the name of a
11448 @file{/dev} node. Labels and UUIDs offer a way to refer to file
11449 systems without having to hard-code their actual device
11450 name@footnote{Note that, while it is tempting to use
11451 @file{/dev/disk/by-uuid} and similar device names to achieve the same
11452 result, this is not recommended: These special device nodes are created
11453 by the udev daemon and may be unavailable at the time the device is
11454 mounted.}.
11455
11456 @findex file-system-label
11457 File system labels are created using the @code{file-system-label}
11458 procedure, UUIDs are created using @code{uuid}, and @file{/dev} node are
11459 plain strings. Here's an example of a file system referred to by its
11460 label, as shown by the @command{e2label} command:
11461
11462 @lisp
11463 (file-system
11464 (mount-point "/home")
11465 (type "ext4")
11466 (device (file-system-label "my-home")))
11467 @end lisp
11468
11469 @findex uuid
11470 UUIDs are converted from their string representation (as shown by the
11471 @command{tune2fs -l} command) using the @code{uuid} form@footnote{The
11472 @code{uuid} form expects 16-byte UUIDs as defined in
11473 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4122, RFC@tie{}4122}. This is the
11474 form of UUID used by the ext2 family of file systems and others, but it
11475 is different from ``UUIDs'' found in FAT file systems, for instance.},
11476 like this:
11477
11478 @lisp
11479 (file-system
11480 (mount-point "/home")
11481 (type "ext4")
11482 (device (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")))
11483 @end lisp
11484
11485 When the source of a file system is a mapped device (@pxref{Mapped
11486 Devices}), its @code{device} field @emph{must} refer to the mapped
11487 device name---e.g., @file{"/dev/mapper/root-partition"}.
11488 This is required so that
11489 the system knows that mounting the file system depends on having the
11490 corresponding device mapping established.
11491
11492 @item @code{flags} (default: @code{'()})
11493 This is a list of symbols denoting mount flags. Recognized flags
11494 include @code{read-only}, @code{bind-mount}, @code{no-dev} (disallow
11495 access to special files), @code{no-suid} (ignore setuid and setgid
11496 bits), @code{no-atime} (do not update file access times),
11497 @code{strict-atime} (update file access time), @code{lazy-time} (only
11498 update time on the in-memory version of the file inode), and
11499 @code{no-exec} (disallow program execution).
11500 @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
11501 Manual}, for more information on these flags.
11502
11503 @item @code{options} (default: @code{#f})
11504 This is either @code{#f}, or a string denoting mount options passed to the
11505 file system driver. @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C Library
11506 Reference Manual}, for details and run @command{man 8 mount} for options for
11507 various file systems.
11508
11509 @item @code{mount?} (default: @code{#t})
11510 This value indicates whether to automatically mount the file system when
11511 the system is brought up. When set to @code{#f}, the file system gets
11512 an entry in @file{/etc/fstab} (read by the @command{mount} command) but
11513 is not automatically mounted.
11514
11515 @item @code{needed-for-boot?} (default: @code{#f})
11516 This Boolean value indicates whether the file system is needed when
11517 booting. If that is true, then the file system is mounted when the
11518 initial RAM disk (initrd) is loaded. This is always the case, for
11519 instance, for the root file system.
11520
11521 @item @code{check?} (default: @code{#t})
11522 This Boolean indicates whether the file system needs to be checked for
11523 errors before being mounted.
11524
11525 @item @code{create-mount-point?} (default: @code{#f})
11526 When true, the mount point is created if it does not exist yet.
11527
11528 @item @code{dependencies} (default: @code{'()})
11529 This is a list of @code{<file-system>} or @code{<mapped-device>} objects
11530 representing file systems that must be mounted or mapped devices that
11531 must be opened before (and unmounted or closed after) this one.
11532
11533 As an example, consider a hierarchy of mounts: @file{/sys/fs/cgroup} is
11534 a dependency of @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/cpu} and
11535 @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/memory}.
11536
11537 Another example is a file system that depends on a mapped device, for
11538 example for an encrypted partition (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
11539 @end table
11540 @end deftp
11541
11542 The @code{(gnu system file-systems)} exports the following useful
11543 variables.
11544
11545 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-file-systems
11546 These are essential file systems that are required on normal systems,
11547 such as @var{%pseudo-terminal-file-system} and @var{%immutable-store} (see
11548 below.) Operating system declarations should always contain at least
11549 these.
11550 @end defvr
11551
11552 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %pseudo-terminal-file-system
11553 This is the file system to be mounted as @file{/dev/pts}. It supports
11554 @dfn{pseudo-terminals} created @i{via} @code{openpty} and similar
11555 functions (@pxref{Pseudo-Terminals,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
11556 Manual}). Pseudo-terminals are used by terminal emulators such as
11557 @command{xterm}.
11558 @end defvr
11559
11560 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shared-memory-file-system
11561 This file system is mounted as @file{/dev/shm} and is used to support
11562 memory sharing across processes (@pxref{Memory-mapped I/O,
11563 @code{shm_open},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
11564 @end defvr
11565
11566 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %immutable-store
11567 This file system performs a read-only ``bind mount'' of
11568 @file{/gnu/store}, making it read-only for all the users including
11569 @code{root}. This prevents against accidental modification by software
11570 running as @code{root} or by system administrators.
11571
11572 The daemon itself is still able to write to the store: it remounts it
11573 read-write in its own ``name space.''
11574 @end defvr
11575
11576 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %binary-format-file-system
11577 The @code{binfmt_misc} file system, which allows handling of arbitrary
11578 executable file types to be delegated to user space. This requires the
11579 @code{binfmt.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
11580 @end defvr
11581
11582 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %fuse-control-file-system
11583 The @code{fusectl} file system, which allows unprivileged users to mount
11584 and unmount user-space FUSE file systems. This requires the
11585 @code{fuse.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
11586 @end defvr
11587
11588 @node Mapped Devices
11589 @section Mapped Devices
11590
11591 @cindex device mapping
11592 @cindex mapped devices
11593 The Linux kernel has a notion of @dfn{device mapping}: a block device,
11594 such as a hard disk partition, can be @dfn{mapped} into another device,
11595 usually in @code{/dev/mapper/},
11596 with additional processing over the data that flows through
11597 it@footnote{Note that the GNU@tie{}Hurd makes no difference between the
11598 concept of a ``mapped device'' and that of a file system: both boil down
11599 to @emph{translating} input/output operations made on a file to
11600 operations on its backing store. Thus, the Hurd implements mapped
11601 devices, like file systems, using the generic @dfn{translator} mechanism
11602 (@pxref{Translators,,, hurd, The GNU Hurd Reference Manual}).}. A
11603 typical example is encryption device mapping: all writes to the mapped
11604 device are encrypted, and all reads are deciphered, transparently.
11605 Guix extends this notion by considering any device or set of devices that
11606 are @dfn{transformed} in some way to create a new device; for instance,
11607 RAID devices are obtained by @dfn{assembling} several other devices, such
11608 as hard disks or partitions, into a new one that behaves as one partition.
11609 Other examples, not yet implemented, are LVM logical volumes.
11610
11611 Mapped devices are declared using the @code{mapped-device} form,
11612 defined as follows; for examples, see below.
11613
11614 @deftp {Data Type} mapped-device
11615 Objects of this type represent device mappings that will be made when
11616 the system boots up.
11617
11618 @table @code
11619 @item source
11620 This is either a string specifying the name of the block device to be mapped,
11621 such as @code{"/dev/sda3"}, or a list of such strings when several devices
11622 need to be assembled for creating a new one.
11623
11624 @item target
11625 This string specifies the name of the resulting mapped device. For
11626 kernel mappers such as encrypted devices of type @code{luks-device-mapping},
11627 specifying @code{"my-partition"} leads to the creation of
11628 the @code{"/dev/mapper/my-partition"} device.
11629 For RAID devices of type @code{raid-device-mapping}, the full device name
11630 such as @code{"/dev/md0"} needs to be given.
11631
11632 @item type
11633 This must be a @code{mapped-device-kind} object, which specifies how
11634 @var{source} is mapped to @var{target}.
11635 @end table
11636 @end deftp
11637
11638 @defvr {Scheme Variable} luks-device-mapping
11639 This defines LUKS block device encryption using the @command{cryptsetup}
11640 command from the package with the same name. It relies on the
11641 @code{dm-crypt} Linux kernel module.
11642 @end defvr
11643
11644 @defvr {Scheme Variable} raid-device-mapping
11645 This defines a RAID device, which is assembled using the @code{mdadm}
11646 command from the package with the same name. It requires a Linux kernel
11647 module for the appropriate RAID level to be loaded, such as @code{raid456}
11648 for RAID-4, RAID-5 or RAID-6, or @code{raid10} for RAID-10.
11649 @end defvr
11650
11651 @cindex disk encryption
11652 @cindex LUKS
11653 The following example specifies a mapping from @file{/dev/sda3} to
11654 @file{/dev/mapper/home} using LUKS---the
11655 @url{https://gitlab.com/cryptsetup/cryptsetup,Linux Unified Key Setup}, a
11656 standard mechanism for disk encryption.
11657 The @file{/dev/mapper/home}
11658 device can then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system}
11659 declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
11660
11661 @lisp
11662 (mapped-device
11663 (source "/dev/sda3")
11664 (target "home")
11665 (type luks-device-mapping))
11666 @end lisp
11667
11668 Alternatively, to become independent of device numbering, one may obtain
11669 the LUKS UUID (@dfn{unique identifier}) of the source device by a
11670 command like:
11671
11672 @example
11673 cryptsetup luksUUID /dev/sda3
11674 @end example
11675
11676 and use it as follows:
11677
11678 @lisp
11679 (mapped-device
11680 (source (uuid "cb67fc72-0d54-4c88-9d4b-b225f30b0f44"))
11681 (target "home")
11682 (type luks-device-mapping))
11683 @end lisp
11684
11685 @cindex swap encryption
11686 It is also desirable to encrypt swap space, since swap space may contain
11687 sensitive data. One way to accomplish that is to use a swap file in a
11688 file system on a device mapped via LUKS encryption. In this way, the
11689 swap file is encrypted because the entire device is encrypted.
11690 @xref{Preparing for Installation,,Disk Partitioning}, for an example.
11691
11692 A RAID device formed of the partitions @file{/dev/sda1} and @file{/dev/sdb1}
11693 may be declared as follows:
11694
11695 @lisp
11696 (mapped-device
11697 (source (list "/dev/sda1" "/dev/sdb1"))
11698 (target "/dev/md0")
11699 (type raid-device-mapping))
11700 @end lisp
11701
11702 The @file{/dev/md0} device can then be used as the @code{device} of a
11703 @code{file-system} declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
11704 Note that the RAID level need not be given; it is chosen during the
11705 initial creation and formatting of the RAID device and is determined
11706 automatically later.
11707
11708
11709 @node User Accounts
11710 @section User Accounts
11711
11712 @cindex users
11713 @cindex accounts
11714 @cindex user accounts
11715 User accounts and groups are entirely managed through the
11716 @code{operating-system} declaration. They are specified with the
11717 @code{user-account} and @code{user-group} forms:
11718
11719 @lisp
11720 (user-account
11721 (name "alice")
11722 (group "users")
11723 (supplementary-groups '("wheel" ;allow use of sudo, etc.
11724 "audio" ;sound card
11725 "video" ;video devices such as webcams
11726 "cdrom")) ;the good ol' CD-ROM
11727 (comment "Bob's sister")
11728 (home-directory "/home/alice"))
11729 @end lisp
11730
11731 When booting or upon completion of @command{guix system reconfigure},
11732 the system ensures that only the user accounts and groups specified in
11733 the @code{operating-system} declaration exist, and with the specified
11734 properties. Thus, account or group creations or modifications made by
11735 directly invoking commands such as @command{useradd} are lost upon
11736 reconfiguration or reboot. This ensures that the system remains exactly
11737 as declared.
11738
11739 @deftp {Data Type} user-account
11740 Objects of this type represent user accounts. The following members may
11741 be specified:
11742
11743 @table @asis
11744 @item @code{name}
11745 The name of the user account.
11746
11747 @item @code{group}
11748 @cindex groups
11749 This is the name (a string) or identifier (a number) of the user group
11750 this account belongs to.
11751
11752 @item @code{supplementary-groups} (default: @code{'()})
11753 Optionally, this can be defined as a list of group names that this
11754 account belongs to.
11755
11756 @item @code{uid} (default: @code{#f})
11757 This is the user ID for this account (a number), or @code{#f}. In the
11758 latter case, a number is automatically chosen by the system when the
11759 account is created.
11760
11761 @item @code{comment} (default: @code{""})
11762 A comment about the account, such as the account owner's full name.
11763
11764 @item @code{home-directory}
11765 This is the name of the home directory for the account.
11766
11767 @item @code{create-home-directory?} (default: @code{#t})
11768 Indicates whether the home directory of this account should be created
11769 if it does not exist yet.
11770
11771 @item @code{shell} (default: Bash)
11772 This is a G-expression denoting the file name of a program to be used as
11773 the shell (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
11774
11775 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
11776 This Boolean value indicates whether the account is a ``system''
11777 account. System accounts are sometimes treated specially; for instance,
11778 graphical login managers do not list them.
11779
11780 @anchor{user-account-password}
11781 @cindex password, for user accounts
11782 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
11783 You would normally leave this field to @code{#f}, initialize user
11784 passwords as @code{root} with the @command{passwd} command, and then let
11785 users change it with @command{passwd}. Passwords set with
11786 @command{passwd} are of course preserved across reboot and
11787 reconfiguration.
11788
11789 If you @emph{do} want to set an initial password for an account, then
11790 this field must contain the encrypted password, as a string. You can use the
11791 @code{crypt} procedure for this purpose:
11792
11793 @lisp
11794 (user-account
11795 (name "charlie")
11796 (group "users")
11797
11798 ;; Specify a SHA-512-hashed initial password.
11799 (password (crypt "InitialPassword!" "$6$abc")))
11800 @end lisp
11801
11802 @quotation Note
11803 The hash of this initial password will be available in a file in
11804 @file{/gnu/store}, readable by all the users, so this method must be used with
11805 care.
11806 @end quotation
11807
11808 @xref{Passphrase Storage,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for
11809 more information on password encryption, and @ref{Encryption,,, guile, GNU
11810 Guile Reference Manual}, for information on Guile's @code{crypt} procedure.
11811
11812 @end table
11813 @end deftp
11814
11815 @cindex groups
11816 User group declarations are even simpler:
11817
11818 @lisp
11819 (user-group (name "students"))
11820 @end lisp
11821
11822 @deftp {Data Type} user-group
11823 This type is for, well, user groups. There are just a few fields:
11824
11825 @table @asis
11826 @item @code{name}
11827 The name of the group.
11828
11829 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
11830 The group identifier (a number). If @code{#f}, a new number is
11831 automatically allocated when the group is created.
11832
11833 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
11834 This Boolean value indicates whether the group is a ``system'' group.
11835 System groups have low numerical IDs.
11836
11837 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
11838 What, user groups can have a password? Well, apparently yes. Unless
11839 @code{#f}, this field specifies the password of the group.
11840
11841 @end table
11842 @end deftp
11843
11844 For convenience, a variable lists all the basic user groups one may
11845 expect:
11846
11847 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-groups
11848 This is the list of basic user groups that users and/or packages expect
11849 to be present on the system. This includes groups such as ``root'',
11850 ``wheel'', and ``users'', as well as groups used to control access to
11851 specific devices such as ``audio'', ``disk'', and ``cdrom''.
11852 @end defvr
11853
11854 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-user-accounts
11855 This is the list of basic system accounts that programs may expect to
11856 find on a GNU/Linux system, such as the ``nobody'' account.
11857
11858 Note that the ``root'' account is not included here. It is a
11859 special-case and is automatically added whether or not it is specified.
11860 @end defvr
11861
11862 @node Keyboard Layout
11863 @section Keyboard Layout
11864
11865 @cindex keyboard layout
11866 @cindex keymap
11867 To specify what each key of your keyboard does, you need to tell the operating
11868 system what @dfn{keyboard layout} you want to use. The default, when nothing
11869 is specified, is the US English QWERTY layout for 105-key PC keyboards.
11870 However, German speakers will usually prefer the German QWERTZ layout, French
11871 speakers will want the AZERTY layout, and so on; hackers might prefer Dvorak
11872 or bépo, and they might even want to further customize the effect of some of
11873 the keys. This section explains how to get that done.
11874
11875 @cindex keyboard layout, definition
11876 There are three components that will want to know about your keyboard layout:
11877
11878 @itemize
11879 @item
11880 The @emph{bootloader} may want to know what keyboard layout you want to use
11881 (@pxref{Bootloader Configuration, @code{keyboard-layout}}). This is useful if
11882 you want, for instance, to make sure that you can type the passphrase of your
11883 encrypted root partition using the right layout.
11884
11885 @item
11886 The @emph{operating system kernel}, Linux, will need that so that the console
11887 is properly configured (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
11888 @code{keyboard-layout}}).
11889
11890 @item
11891 The @emph{graphical display server}, usually Xorg, also has its own idea of
11892 the keyboard layout (@pxref{X Window, @code{keyboard-layout}}).
11893 @end itemize
11894
11895 Guix allows you to configure all three separately but, fortunately, it allows
11896 you to share the same keyboard layout for all three components.
11897
11898 @cindex XKB, keyboard layouts
11899 Keyboard layouts are represented by records created by the
11900 @code{keyboard-layout} procedure of @code{(gnu system keyboard)}. Following
11901 the X Keyboard extension (XKB), each layout has four attributes: a name (often
11902 a language code such as ``fi'' for Finnish or ``jp'' for Japanese), an
11903 optional variant name, an optional keyboard model name, and a possibly empty
11904 list of additional options. In most cases the layout name is all you care
11905 about. Here are a few example:
11906
11907 @lisp
11908 ;; The German QWERTZ layout. Here we assume a standard
11909 ;; "pc105" keyboard model.
11910 (keyboard-layout "de")
11911
11912 ;; The bépo variant of the French layout.
11913 (keyboard-layout "fr" "bepo")
11914
11915 ;; The Catalan layout.
11916 (keyboard-layout "es" "cat")
11917
11918 ;; The Latin American Spanish layout. In addition, the
11919 ;; "Caps Lock" key is used as an additional "Ctrl" key,
11920 ;; and the "Menu" key is used as a "Compose" key to enter
11921 ;; accented letters.
11922 (keyboard-layout "latam"
11923 #:options '("ctrl:nocaps" "compose:menu"))
11924
11925 ;; The Russian layout for a ThinkPad keyboard.
11926 (keyboard-layout "ru" #:model "thinkpad")
11927
11928 ;; The "US international" layout, which is the US layout plus
11929 ;; dead keys to enter accented characters. This is for an
11930 ;; Apple MacBook keyboard.
11931 (keyboard-layout "us" "intl" #:model "macbook78")
11932 @end lisp
11933
11934 See the @file{share/X11/xkb} directory of the @code{xkeyboard-config} package
11935 for a complete list of supported layouts, variants, and models.
11936
11937 @cindex keyboard layout, configuration
11938 Let's say you want your system to use the Turkish keyboard layout throughout
11939 your system---bootloader, console, and Xorg. Here's what your system
11940 configuration would look like:
11941
11942 @findex set-xorg-configuration
11943 @lisp
11944 ;; Using the Turkish layout for the bootloader, the console,
11945 ;; and for Xorg.
11946
11947 (operating-system
11948 ;; ...
11949 (keyboard-layout (keyboard-layout "tr")) ;for the console
11950 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
11951 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
11952 (target "/boot/efi")
11953 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout))) ;for GRUB
11954 (services (cons (set-xorg-configuration
11955 (xorg-configuration ;for Xorg
11956 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout)))
11957 %desktop-services)))
11958 @end lisp
11959
11960 In the example above, for GRUB and for Xorg, we just refer to the
11961 @code{keyboard-layout} field defined above, but we could just as well refer to
11962 a different layout. The @code{set-xorg-configuration} procedure communicates
11963 the desired Xorg configuration to the graphical log-in manager, by default
11964 GDM.
11965
11966 We've discussed how to specify the @emph{default} keyboard layout of your
11967 system when it starts, but you can also adjust it at run time:
11968
11969 @itemize
11970 @item
11971 If you're using GNOME, its settings panel has a ``Region & Language'' entry
11972 where you can select one or more keyboard layouts.
11973
11974 @item
11975 Under Xorg, the @command{setxkbmap} command (from the same-named package)
11976 allows you to change the current layout. For example, this is how you would
11977 change the layout to US Dvorak:
11978
11979 @example
11980 setxkbmap us dvorak
11981 @end example
11982
11983 @item
11984 The @code{loadkeys} command changes the keyboard layout in effect in the Linux
11985 console. However, note that @code{loadkeys} does @emph{not} use the XKB
11986 keyboard layout categorization described above. The command below loads the
11987 French bépo layout:
11988
11989 @example
11990 loadkeys fr-bepo
11991 @end example
11992 @end itemize
11993
11994 @node Locales
11995 @section Locales
11996
11997 @cindex locale
11998 A @dfn{locale} defines cultural conventions for a particular language
11999 and region of the world (@pxref{Locales,,, libc, The GNU C Library
12000 Reference Manual}). Each locale has a name that typically has the form
12001 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}.@var{codeset}}---e.g.,
12002 @code{fr_LU.utf8} designates the locale for the French language, with
12003 cultural conventions from Luxembourg, and using the UTF-8 encoding.
12004
12005 @cindex locale definition
12006 Usually, you will want to specify the default locale for the machine
12007 using the @code{locale} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
12008 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{locale}}).
12009
12010 The selected locale is automatically added to the @dfn{locale
12011 definitions} known to the system if needed, with its codeset inferred
12012 from its name---e.g., @code{bo_CN.utf8} will be assumed to use the
12013 @code{UTF-8} codeset. Additional locale definitions can be specified in
12014 the @code{locale-definitions} slot of @code{operating-system}---this is
12015 useful, for instance, if the codeset could not be inferred from the
12016 locale name. The default set of locale definitions includes some widely
12017 used locales, but not all the available locales, in order to save space.
12018
12019 For instance, to add the North Frisian locale for Germany, the value of
12020 that field may be:
12021
12022 @lisp
12023 (cons (locale-definition
12024 (name "fy_DE.utf8") (source "fy_DE"))
12025 %default-locale-definitions)
12026 @end lisp
12027
12028 Likewise, to save space, one might want @code{locale-definitions} to
12029 list only the locales that are actually used, as in:
12030
12031 @lisp
12032 (list (locale-definition
12033 (name "ja_JP.eucjp") (source "ja_JP")
12034 (charset "EUC-JP")))
12035 @end lisp
12036
12037 @vindex LOCPATH
12038 The compiled locale definitions are available at
12039 @file{/run/current-system/locale/X.Y}, where @code{X.Y} is the libc
12040 version, which is the default location where the GNU@tie{}libc provided
12041 by Guix looks for locale data. This can be overridden using the
12042 @code{LOCPATH} environment variable (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
12043 @code{LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
12044
12045 The @code{locale-definition} form is provided by the @code{(gnu system
12046 locale)} module. Details are given below.
12047
12048 @deftp {Data Type} locale-definition
12049 This is the data type of a locale definition.
12050
12051 @table @asis
12052
12053 @item @code{name}
12054 The name of the locale. @xref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
12055 Reference Manual}, for more information on locale names.
12056
12057 @item @code{source}
12058 The name of the source for that locale. This is typically the
12059 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}} part of the locale name.
12060
12061 @item @code{charset} (default: @code{"UTF-8"})
12062 The ``character set'' or ``code set'' for that locale,
12063 @uref{https://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets, as defined by
12064 IANA}.
12065
12066 @end table
12067 @end deftp
12068
12069 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-locale-definitions
12070 A list of commonly used UTF-8 locales, used as the default
12071 value of the @code{locale-definitions} field of @code{operating-system}
12072 declarations.
12073
12074 @cindex locale name
12075 @cindex normalized codeset in locale names
12076 These locale definitions use the @dfn{normalized codeset} for the part
12077 that follows the dot in the name (@pxref{Using gettextized software,
12078 normalized codeset,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). So for
12079 instance it has @code{uk_UA.utf8} but @emph{not}, say,
12080 @code{uk_UA.UTF-8}.
12081 @end defvr
12082
12083 @subsection Locale Data Compatibility Considerations
12084
12085 @cindex incompatibility, of locale data
12086 @code{operating-system} declarations provide a @code{locale-libcs} field
12087 to specify the GNU@tie{}libc packages that are used to compile locale
12088 declarations (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). ``Why would I
12089 care?'', you may ask. Well, it turns out that the binary format of
12090 locale data is occasionally incompatible from one libc version to
12091 another.
12092
12093 @c See <https://sourceware.org/ml/libc-alpha/2015-09/msg00575.html>
12094 @c and <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2015-08/msg00737.html>.
12095 For instance, a program linked against libc version 2.21 is unable to
12096 read locale data produced with libc 2.22; worse, that program
12097 @emph{aborts} instead of simply ignoring the incompatible locale
12098 data@footnote{Versions 2.23 and later of GNU@tie{}libc will simply skip
12099 the incompatible locale data, which is already an improvement.}.
12100 Similarly, a program linked against libc 2.22 can read most, but not
12101 all, of the locale data from libc 2.21 (specifically, @code{LC_COLLATE}
12102 data is incompatible); thus calls to @code{setlocale} may fail, but
12103 programs will not abort.
12104
12105 The ``problem'' with Guix is that users have a lot of freedom: They can
12106 choose whether and when to upgrade software in their profiles, and might
12107 be using a libc version different from the one the system administrator
12108 used to build the system-wide locale data.
12109
12110 Fortunately, unprivileged users can also install their own locale data
12111 and define @var{GUIX_LOCPATH} accordingly (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
12112 @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
12113
12114 Still, it is best if the system-wide locale data at
12115 @file{/run/current-system/locale} is built for all the libc versions
12116 actually in use on the system, so that all the programs can access
12117 it---this is especially crucial on a multi-user system. To do that, the
12118 administrator can specify several libc packages in the
12119 @code{locale-libcs} field of @code{operating-system}:
12120
12121 @lisp
12122 (use-package-modules base)
12123
12124 (operating-system
12125 ;; @dots{}
12126 (locale-libcs (list glibc-2.21 (canonical-package glibc))))
12127 @end lisp
12128
12129 This example would lead to a system containing locale definitions for
12130 both libc 2.21 and the current version of libc in
12131 @file{/run/current-system/locale}.
12132
12133
12134 @node Services
12135 @section Services
12136
12137 @cindex system services
12138 An important part of preparing an @code{operating-system} declaration is
12139 listing @dfn{system services} and their configuration (@pxref{Using the
12140 Configuration System}). System services are typically daemons launched
12141 when the system boots, or other actions needed at that time---e.g.,
12142 configuring network access.
12143
12144 Guix has a broad definition of ``service'' (@pxref{Service
12145 Composition}), but many services are managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd
12146 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}). On a running system, the @command{herd}
12147 command allows you to list the available services, show their status,
12148 start and stop them, or do other specific operations (@pxref{Jump
12149 Start,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). For example:
12150
12151 @example
12152 # herd status
12153 @end example
12154
12155 The above command, run as @code{root}, lists the currently defined
12156 services. The @command{herd doc} command shows a synopsis of the given
12157 service and its associated actions:
12158
12159 @example
12160 # herd doc nscd
12161 Run libc's name service cache daemon (nscd).
12162
12163 # herd doc nscd action invalidate
12164 invalidate: Invalidate the given cache--e.g., 'hosts' for host name lookups.
12165 @end example
12166
12167 The @command{start}, @command{stop}, and @command{restart} sub-commands
12168 have the effect you would expect. For instance, the commands below stop
12169 the nscd service and restart the Xorg display server:
12170
12171 @example
12172 # herd stop nscd
12173 Service nscd has been stopped.
12174 # herd restart xorg-server
12175 Service xorg-server has been stopped.
12176 Service xorg-server has been started.
12177 @end example
12178
12179 The following sections document the available services, starting with
12180 the core services, that may be used in an @code{operating-system}
12181 declaration.
12182
12183 @menu
12184 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
12185 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
12186 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
12187 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
12188 * X Window:: Graphical display.
12189 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
12190 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
12191 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
12192 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
12193 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
12194 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
12195 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
12196 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
12197 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
12198 * LDAP Services:: LDAP services.
12199 * Web Services:: Web servers.
12200 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
12201 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
12202 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
12203 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
12204 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
12205 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
12206 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
12207 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
12208 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
12209 * Game Services:: Game servers.
12210 * PAM Mount Service:: Service to mount volumes when logging in.
12211 * Guix Services:: Services relating specifically to Guix.
12212 * Linux Services:: Services tied to the Linux kernel.
12213 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
12214 @end menu
12215
12216 @node Base Services
12217 @subsection Base Services
12218
12219 The @code{(gnu services base)} module provides definitions for the basic
12220 services that one expects from the system. The services exported by
12221 this module are listed below.
12222
12223 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-services
12224 This variable contains a list of basic services (@pxref{Service Types
12225 and Services}, for more information on service objects) one would
12226 expect from the system: a login service (mingetty) on each tty, syslogd,
12227 the libc name service cache daemon (nscd), the udev device manager, and
12228 more.
12229
12230 This is the default value of the @code{services} field of
12231 @code{operating-system} declarations. Usually, when customizing a
12232 system, you will want to append services to @code{%base-services}, like
12233 this:
12234
12235 @lisp
12236 (append (list (service avahi-service-type)
12237 (service openssh-service-type))
12238 %base-services)
12239 @end lisp
12240 @end defvr
12241
12242 @defvr {Scheme Variable} special-files-service-type
12243 This is the service that sets up ``special files'' such as
12244 @file{/bin/sh}; an instance of it is part of @code{%base-services}.
12245
12246 The value associated with @code{special-files-service-type} services
12247 must be a list of tuples where the first element is the ``special file''
12248 and the second element is its target. By default it is:
12249
12250 @cindex @file{/bin/sh}
12251 @cindex @file{sh}, in @file{/bin}
12252 @lisp
12253 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append bash "/bin/sh")))
12254 @end lisp
12255
12256 @cindex @file{/usr/bin/env}
12257 @cindex @file{env}, in @file{/usr/bin}
12258 If you want to add, say, @code{/usr/bin/env} to your system, you can
12259 change it to:
12260
12261 @lisp
12262 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append bash "/bin/sh"))
12263 ("/usr/bin/env" ,(file-append coreutils "/bin/env")))
12264 @end lisp
12265
12266 Since this is part of @code{%base-services}, you can use
12267 @code{modify-services} to customize the set of special files
12268 (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{modify-services}}). But the simple way
12269 to add a special file is @i{via} the @code{extra-special-file} procedure
12270 (see below.)
12271 @end defvr
12272
12273 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} extra-special-file @var{file} @var{target}
12274 Use @var{target} as the ``special file'' @var{file}.
12275
12276 For example, adding the following lines to the @code{services} field of
12277 your operating system declaration leads to a @file{/usr/bin/env}
12278 symlink:
12279
12280 @lisp
12281 (extra-special-file "/usr/bin/env"
12282 (file-append coreutils "/bin/env"))
12283 @end lisp
12284 @end deffn
12285
12286 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} host-name-service @var{name}
12287 Return a service that sets the host name to @var{name}.
12288 @end deffn
12289
12290 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} login-service @var{config}
12291 Return a service to run login according to @var{config}, a
12292 @code{<login-configuration>} object, which specifies the message of the day,
12293 among other things.
12294 @end deffn
12295
12296 @deftp {Data Type} login-configuration
12297 This is the data type representing the configuration of login.
12298
12299 @table @asis
12300
12301 @item @code{motd}
12302 @cindex message of the day
12303 A file-like object containing the ``message of the day''.
12304
12305 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
12306 Allow empty passwords by default so that first-time users can log in when
12307 the 'root' account has just been created.
12308
12309 @end table
12310 @end deftp
12311
12312 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mingetty-service @var{config}
12313 Return a service to run mingetty according to @var{config}, a
12314 @code{<mingetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run, among
12315 other things.
12316 @end deffn
12317
12318 @deftp {Data Type} mingetty-configuration
12319 This is the data type representing the configuration of Mingetty, which
12320 provides the default implementation of virtual console log-in.
12321
12322 @table @asis
12323
12324 @item @code{tty}
12325 The name of the console this Mingetty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
12326
12327 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
12328 When true, this field must be a string denoting the user name under
12329 which the system automatically logs in. When it is @code{#f}, a
12330 user name and password must be entered to log in.
12331
12332 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#f})
12333 This must be either @code{#f}, in which case the default log-in program
12334 is used (@command{login} from the Shadow tool suite), or a gexp denoting
12335 the name of the log-in program.
12336
12337 @item @code{login-pause?} (default: @code{#f})
12338 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{auto-login}, the user
12339 will have to press a key before the log-in shell is launched.
12340
12341 @item @code{mingetty} (default: @var{mingetty})
12342 The Mingetty package to use.
12343
12344 @end table
12345 @end deftp
12346
12347 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} agetty-service @var{config}
12348 Return a service to run agetty according to @var{config}, an
12349 @code{<agetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run,
12350 among other things.
12351 @end deffn
12352
12353 @deftp {Data Type} agetty-configuration
12354 This is the data type representing the configuration of agetty, which
12355 implements virtual and serial console log-in. See the @code{agetty(8)}
12356 man page for more information.
12357
12358 @table @asis
12359
12360 @item @code{tty}
12361 The name of the console this agetty runs on, as a string---e.g.,
12362 @code{"ttyS0"}. This argument is optional, it will default to
12363 a reasonable default serial port used by the kernel Linux.
12364
12365 For this, if there is a value for an option @code{agetty.tty} in the kernel
12366 command line, agetty will extract the device name of the serial port
12367 from it and use that.
12368
12369 If not and if there is a value for an option @code{console} with a tty in
12370 the Linux command line, agetty will extract the device name of the
12371 serial port from it and use that.
12372
12373 In both cases, agetty will leave the other serial device settings
12374 (baud rate etc.)@: alone---in the hope that Linux pinned them to the
12375 correct values.
12376
12377 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{#f})
12378 A string containing a comma-separated list of one or more baud rates, in
12379 descending order.
12380
12381 @item @code{term} (default: @code{#f})
12382 A string containing the value used for the @code{TERM} environment
12383 variable.
12384
12385 @item @code{eight-bits?} (default: @code{#f})
12386 When @code{#t}, the tty is assumed to be 8-bit clean, and parity detection is
12387 disabled.
12388
12389 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
12390 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
12391 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
12392
12393 @item @code{no-reset?} (default: @code{#f})
12394 When @code{#t}, don't reset terminal cflags (control modes).
12395
12396 @item @code{host} (default: @code{#f})
12397 This accepts a string containing the "login_host", which will be written
12398 into the @file{/var/run/utmpx} file.
12399
12400 @item @code{remote?} (default: @code{#f})
12401 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{host}, this will add an
12402 @code{-r} fakehost option to the command line of the login program
12403 specified in @var{login-program}.
12404
12405 @item @code{flow-control?} (default: @code{#f})
12406 When set to @code{#t}, enable hardware (RTS/CTS) flow control.
12407
12408 @item @code{no-issue?} (default: @code{#f})
12409 When set to @code{#t}, the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file will
12410 not be displayed before presenting the login prompt.
12411
12412 @item @code{init-string} (default: @code{#f})
12413 This accepts a string that will be sent to the tty or modem before
12414 sending anything else. It can be used to initialize a modem.
12415
12416 @item @code{no-clear?} (default: @code{#f})
12417 When set to @code{#t}, agetty will not clear the screen before showing
12418 the login prompt.
12419
12420 @item @code{login-program} (default: (file-append shadow "/bin/login"))
12421 This must be either a gexp denoting the name of a log-in program, or
12422 unset, in which case the default value is the @command{login} from the
12423 Shadow tool suite.
12424
12425 @item @code{local-line} (default: @code{#f})
12426 Control the CLOCAL line flag. This accepts one of three symbols as
12427 arguments, @code{'auto}, @code{'always}, or @code{'never}. If @code{#f},
12428 the default value chosen by agetty is @code{'auto}.
12429
12430 @item @code{extract-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
12431 When set to @code{#t}, instruct agetty to try to extract the baud rate
12432 from the status messages produced by certain types of modems.
12433
12434 @item @code{skip-login?} (default: @code{#f})
12435 When set to @code{#t}, do not prompt the user for a login name. This
12436 can be used with @var{login-program} field to use non-standard login
12437 systems.
12438
12439 @item @code{no-newline?} (default: @code{#f})
12440 When set to @code{#t}, do not print a newline before printing the
12441 @file{/etc/issue} file.
12442
12443 @c Is this dangerous only when used with login-program, or always?
12444 @item @code{login-options} (default: @code{#f})
12445 This option accepts a string containing options that are passed to the
12446 login program. When used with the @var{login-program}, be aware that a
12447 malicious user could try to enter a login name containing embedded
12448 options that could be parsed by the login program.
12449
12450 @item @code{login-pause} (default: @code{#f})
12451 When set to @code{#t}, wait for any key before showing the login prompt.
12452 This can be used in conjunction with @var{auto-login} to save memory by
12453 lazily spawning shells.
12454
12455 @item @code{chroot} (default: @code{#f})
12456 Change root to the specified directory. This option accepts a directory
12457 path as a string.
12458
12459 @item @code{hangup?} (default: @code{#f})
12460 Use the Linux system call @code{vhangup} to do a virtual hangup of the
12461 specified terminal.
12462
12463 @item @code{keep-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
12464 When set to @code{#t}, try to keep the existing baud rate. The baud
12465 rates from @var{baud-rate} are used when agetty receives a @key{BREAK}
12466 character.
12467
12468 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{#f})
12469 When set to an integer value, terminate if no user name could be read
12470 within @var{timeout} seconds.
12471
12472 @item @code{detect-case?} (default: @code{#f})
12473 When set to @code{#t}, turn on support for detecting an uppercase-only
12474 terminal. This setting will detect a login name containing only
12475 uppercase letters as indicating an uppercase-only terminal and turn on
12476 some upper-to-lower case conversions. Note that this will not support
12477 Unicode characters.
12478
12479 @item @code{wait-cr?} (default: @code{#f})
12480 When set to @code{#t}, wait for the user or modem to send a
12481 carriage-return or linefeed character before displaying
12482 @file{/etc/issue} or login prompt. This is typically used with the
12483 @var{init-string} option.
12484
12485 @item @code{no-hints?} (default: @code{#f})
12486 When set to @code{#t}, do not print hints about Num, Caps, and Scroll
12487 locks.
12488
12489 @item @code{no-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
12490 By default, the hostname is printed. When this option is set to
12491 @code{#t}, no hostname will be shown at all.
12492
12493 @item @code{long-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
12494 By default, the hostname is only printed until the first dot. When this
12495 option is set to @code{#t}, the fully qualified hostname by
12496 @code{gethostname} or @code{getaddrinfo} is shown.
12497
12498 @item @code{erase-characters} (default: @code{#f})
12499 This option accepts a string of additional characters that should be
12500 interpreted as backspace when the user types their login name.
12501
12502 @item @code{kill-characters} (default: @code{#f})
12503 This option accepts a string that should be interpreted to mean "ignore
12504 all previous characters" (also called a "kill" character) when the user
12505 types their login name.
12506
12507 @item @code{chdir} (default: @code{#f})
12508 This option accepts, as a string, a directory path that will be changed
12509 to before login.
12510
12511 @item @code{delay} (default: @code{#f})
12512 This options accepts, as an integer, the number of seconds to sleep
12513 before opening the tty and displaying the login prompt.
12514
12515 @item @code{nice} (default: @code{#f})
12516 This option accepts, as an integer, the nice value with which to run the
12517 @command{login} program.
12518
12519 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
12520 This option provides an "escape hatch" for the user to provide arbitrary
12521 command-line arguments to @command{agetty} as a list of strings.
12522
12523 @end table
12524 @end deftp
12525
12526 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} kmscon-service-type @var{config}
12527 Return a service to run @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/kmscon,kmscon}
12528 according to @var{config}, a @code{<kmscon-configuration>} object, which
12529 specifies the tty to run, among other things.
12530 @end deffn
12531
12532 @deftp {Data Type} kmscon-configuration
12533 This is the data type representing the configuration of Kmscon, which
12534 implements virtual console log-in.
12535
12536 @table @asis
12537
12538 @item @code{virtual-terminal}
12539 The name of the console this Kmscon runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
12540
12541 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/login")})
12542 A gexp denoting the name of the log-in program. The default log-in program is
12543 @command{login} from the Shadow tool suite.
12544
12545 @item @code{login-arguments} (default: @code{'("-p")})
12546 A list of arguments to pass to @command{login}.
12547
12548 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
12549 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
12550 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
12551
12552 @item @code{hardware-acceleration?} (default: #f)
12553 Whether to use hardware acceleration.
12554
12555 @item @code{kmscon} (default: @var{kmscon})
12556 The Kmscon package to use.
12557
12558 @end table
12559 @end deftp
12560
12561 @cindex name service cache daemon
12562 @cindex nscd
12563 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nscd-service [@var{config}] [#:glibc glibc] @
12564 [#:name-services '()]
12565 Return a service that runs the libc name service cache daemon (nscd) with the
12566 given @var{config}---an @code{<nscd-configuration>} object. @xref{Name
12567 Service Switch}, for an example.
12568
12569 For convenience, the Shepherd service for nscd provides the following actions:
12570
12571 @table @code
12572 @item invalidate
12573 @cindex cache invalidation, nscd
12574 @cindex nscd, cache invalidation
12575 This invalidate the given cache. For instance, running:
12576
12577 @example
12578 herd invalidate nscd hosts
12579 @end example
12580
12581 @noindent
12582 invalidates the host name lookup cache of nscd.
12583
12584 @item statistics
12585 Running @command{herd statistics nscd} displays information about nscd usage
12586 and caches.
12587 @end table
12588
12589 @end deffn
12590
12591 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-configuration
12592 This is the default @code{<nscd-configuration>} value (see below) used
12593 by @code{nscd-service}. It uses the caches defined by
12594 @var{%nscd-default-caches}; see below.
12595 @end defvr
12596
12597 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-configuration
12598 This is the data type representing the name service cache daemon (nscd)
12599 configuration.
12600
12601 @table @asis
12602
12603 @item @code{name-services} (default: @code{'()})
12604 List of packages denoting @dfn{name services} that must be visible to
12605 the nscd---e.g., @code{(list @var{nss-mdns})}.
12606
12607 @item @code{glibc} (default: @var{glibc})
12608 Package object denoting the GNU C Library providing the @command{nscd}
12609 command.
12610
12611 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/nscd.log"})
12612 Name of the nscd log file. This is where debugging output goes when
12613 @code{debug-level} is strictly positive.
12614
12615 @item @code{debug-level} (default: @code{0})
12616 Integer denoting the debugging levels. Higher numbers mean that more
12617 debugging output is logged.
12618
12619 @item @code{caches} (default: @var{%nscd-default-caches})
12620 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects denoting things to be cached; see
12621 below.
12622
12623 @end table
12624 @end deftp
12625
12626 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-cache
12627 Data type representing a cache database of nscd and its parameters.
12628
12629 @table @asis
12630
12631 @item @code{database}
12632 This is a symbol representing the name of the database to be cached.
12633 Valid values are @code{passwd}, @code{group}, @code{hosts}, and
12634 @code{services}, which designate the corresponding NSS database
12635 (@pxref{NSS Basics,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
12636
12637 @item @code{positive-time-to-live}
12638 @itemx @code{negative-time-to-live} (default: @code{20})
12639 A number representing the number of seconds during which a positive or
12640 negative lookup result remains in cache.
12641
12642 @item @code{check-files?} (default: @code{#t})
12643 Whether to check for updates of the files corresponding to
12644 @var{database}.
12645
12646 For instance, when @var{database} is @code{hosts}, setting this flag
12647 instructs nscd to check for updates in @file{/etc/hosts} and to take
12648 them into account.
12649
12650 @item @code{persistent?} (default: @code{#t})
12651 Whether the cache should be stored persistently on disk.
12652
12653 @item @code{shared?} (default: @code{#t})
12654 Whether the cache should be shared among users.
12655
12656 @item @code{max-database-size} (default: 32@tie{}MiB)
12657 Maximum size in bytes of the database cache.
12658
12659 @c XXX: 'suggested-size' and 'auto-propagate?' seem to be expert
12660 @c settings, so leave them out.
12661
12662 @end table
12663 @end deftp
12664
12665 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-caches
12666 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects used by default by
12667 @code{nscd-configuration} (see above).
12668
12669 It enables persistent and aggressive caching of service and host name
12670 lookups. The latter provides better host name lookup performance,
12671 resilience in the face of unreliable name servers, and also better
12672 privacy---often the result of host name lookups is in local cache, so
12673 external name servers do not even need to be queried.
12674 @end defvr
12675
12676 @anchor{syslog-configuration-type}
12677 @cindex syslog
12678 @cindex logging
12679 @deftp {Data Type} syslog-configuration
12680 This data type represents the configuration of the syslog daemon.
12681
12682 @table @asis
12683 @item @code{syslogd} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$inetutils "/libexec/syslogd")})
12684 The syslog daemon to use.
12685
12686 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-syslog.conf})
12687 The syslog configuration file to use.
12688
12689 @end table
12690 @end deftp
12691
12692 @anchor{syslog-service}
12693 @cindex syslog
12694 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} syslog-service @var{config}
12695 Return a service that runs a syslog daemon according to @var{config}.
12696
12697 @xref{syslogd invocation,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils}, for more
12698 information on the configuration file syntax.
12699 @end deffn
12700
12701 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guix-service-type
12702 This is the type of the service that runs the build daemon,
12703 @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). Its value must be a
12704 @code{guix-configuration} record as described below.
12705 @end defvr
12706
12707 @anchor{guix-configuration-type}
12708 @deftp {Data Type} guix-configuration
12709 This data type represents the configuration of the Guix build daemon.
12710 @xref{Invoking guix-daemon}, for more information.
12711
12712 @table @asis
12713 @item @code{guix} (default: @var{guix})
12714 The Guix package to use.
12715
12716 @item @code{build-group} (default: @code{"guixbuild"})
12717 Name of the group for build user accounts.
12718
12719 @item @code{build-accounts} (default: @code{10})
12720 Number of build user accounts to create.
12721
12722 @item @code{authorize-key?} (default: @code{#t})
12723 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
12724 Whether to authorize the substitute keys listed in
12725 @code{authorized-keys}---by default that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}
12726 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
12727
12728 @vindex %default-authorized-guix-keys
12729 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{%default-authorized-guix-keys})
12730 The list of authorized key files for archive imports, as a list of
12731 string-valued gexps (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}). By default, it
12732 contains that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Substitutes}).
12733
12734 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#t})
12735 Whether to use substitutes.
12736
12737 @item @code{substitute-urls} (default: @code{%default-substitute-urls})
12738 The list of URLs where to look for substitutes by default.
12739
12740 @item @code{max-silent-time} (default: @code{0})
12741 @itemx @code{timeout} (default: @code{0})
12742 The number of seconds of silence and the number of seconds of activity,
12743 respectively, after which a build process times out. A value of zero
12744 disables the timeout.
12745
12746 @item @code{log-compression} (default: @code{'bzip2})
12747 The type of compression used for build logs---one of @code{gzip},
12748 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
12749
12750 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
12751 List of extra command-line options for @command{guix-daemon}.
12752
12753 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/guix-daemon.log"})
12754 File where @command{guix-daemon}'s standard output and standard error
12755 are written.
12756
12757 @item @code{http-proxy} (default: @code{#f})
12758 The HTTP proxy used for downloading fixed-output derivations and
12759 substitutes.
12760
12761 @item @code{tmpdir} (default: @code{#f})
12762 A directory path where the @command{guix-daemon} will perform builds.
12763
12764 @end table
12765 @end deftp
12766
12767 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-service [#:udev @var{eudev} #:rules @code{'()}]
12768 Run @var{udev}, which populates the @file{/dev} directory dynamically.
12769 udev rules can be provided as a list of files through the @var{rules}
12770 variable. The procedures @code{udev-rule} and @code{file->udev-rule} from
12771 @code{(gnu services base)} simplify the creation of such rule files.
12772 @end deffn
12773
12774 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{contents}]
12775 Return a udev-rule file named @var{file-name} containing the rules
12776 defined by the @var{contents} literal.
12777
12778 In the following example, a rule for a USB device is defined to be
12779 stored in the file @file{90-usb-thing.rules}. The rule runs a script
12780 upon detecting a USB device with a given product identifier.
12781
12782 @lisp
12783 (define %example-udev-rule
12784 (udev-rule
12785 "90-usb-thing.rules"
12786 (string-append "ACTION==\"add\", SUBSYSTEM==\"usb\", "
12787 "ATTR@{product@}==\"Example\", "
12788 "RUN+=\"/path/to/script\"")))
12789 @end lisp
12790
12791 The @command{herd rules udev} command, as root, returns the name of the
12792 directory containing all the active udev rules.
12793 @end deffn
12794
12795 Here we show how the default @var{udev-service} can be extended with it.
12796
12797 @lisp
12798 (operating-system
12799 ;; @dots{}
12800 (services
12801 (modify-services %desktop-services
12802 (udev-service-type config =>
12803 (udev-configuration (inherit config)
12804 (rules (append (udev-configuration-rules config)
12805 (list %example-udev-rule))))))))
12806 @end lisp
12807
12808 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file->udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{file}]
12809 Return a udev file named @var{file-name} containing the rules defined
12810 within @var{file}, a file-like object.
12811
12812 The following example showcases how we can use an existing rule file.
12813
12814 @lisp
12815 (use-modules (guix download) ;for url-fetch
12816 (guix packages) ;for origin
12817 @dots{})
12818
12819 (define %android-udev-rules
12820 (file->udev-rule
12821 "51-android-udev.rules"
12822 (let ((version "20170910"))
12823 (origin
12824 (method url-fetch)
12825 (uri (string-append "https://raw.githubusercontent.com/M0Rf30/"
12826 "android-udev-rules/" version "/51-android.rules"))
12827 (sha256
12828 (base32 "0lmmagpyb6xsq6zcr2w1cyx9qmjqmajkvrdbhjx32gqf1d9is003"))))))
12829 @end lisp
12830 @end deffn
12831
12832 Additionally, Guix package definitions can be included in @var{rules} in
12833 order to extend the udev rules with the definitions found under their
12834 @file{lib/udev/rules.d} sub-directory. In lieu of the previous
12835 @var{file->udev-rule} example, we could have used the
12836 @var{android-udev-rules} package which exists in Guix in the @code{(gnu
12837 packages android)} module.
12838
12839 The following example shows how to use the @var{android-udev-rules}
12840 package so that the Android tool @command{adb} can detect devices
12841 without root privileges. It also details how to create the
12842 @code{adbusers} group, which is required for the proper functioning of
12843 the rules defined within the @var{android-udev-rules} package. To
12844 create such a group, we must define it both as part of the
12845 @var{supplementary-groups} of our @var{user-account} declaration, as
12846 well as in the @var{groups} field of the @var{operating-system} record.
12847
12848 @lisp
12849 (use-modules (gnu packages android) ;for android-udev-rules
12850 (gnu system shadow) ;for user-group
12851 @dots{})
12852
12853 (operating-system
12854 ;; @dots{}
12855 (users (cons (user-acount
12856 ;; @dots{}
12857 (supplementary-groups
12858 '("adbusers" ;for adb
12859 "wheel" "netdev" "audio" "video")))))
12860
12861 (groups (cons (user-group (system? #t) (name "adbusers"))
12862 %base-groups))
12863
12864 ;; @dots{}
12865
12866 (services
12867 (modify-services %desktop-services
12868 (udev-service-type
12869 config =>
12870 (udev-configuration (inherit config)
12871 (rules (cons android-udev-rules
12872 (udev-configuration-rules config))))))))
12873 @end lisp
12874
12875 @defvr {Scheme Variable} urandom-seed-service-type
12876 Save some entropy in @var{%random-seed-file} to seed @file{/dev/urandom}
12877 when rebooting. It also tries to seed @file{/dev/urandom} from
12878 @file{/dev/hwrng} while booting, if @file{/dev/hwrng} exists and is
12879 readable.
12880 @end defvr
12881
12882 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %random-seed-file
12883 This is the name of the file where some random bytes are saved by
12884 @var{urandom-seed-service} to seed @file{/dev/urandom} when rebooting.
12885 It defaults to @file{/var/lib/random-seed}.
12886 @end defvr
12887
12888 @cindex mouse
12889 @cindex gpm
12890 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gpm-service-type
12891 This is the type of the service that runs GPM, the @dfn{general-purpose
12892 mouse daemon}, which provides mouse support to the Linux console. GPM
12893 allows users to use the mouse in the console, notably to select, copy,
12894 and paste text.
12895
12896 The value for services of this type must be a @code{gpm-configuration}
12897 (see below). This service is not part of @code{%base-services}.
12898 @end defvr
12899
12900 @deftp {Data Type} gpm-configuration
12901 Data type representing the configuration of GPM.
12902
12903 @table @asis
12904 @item @code{options} (default: @code{%default-gpm-options})
12905 Command-line options passed to @command{gpm}. The default set of
12906 options instruct @command{gpm} to listen to mouse events on
12907 @file{/dev/input/mice}. @xref{Command Line,,, gpm, gpm manual}, for
12908 more information.
12909
12910 @item @code{gpm} (default: @code{gpm})
12911 The GPM package to use.
12912
12913 @end table
12914 @end deftp
12915
12916 @anchor{guix-publish-service-type}
12917 @deffn {Scheme Variable} guix-publish-service-type
12918 This is the service type for @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking
12919 guix publish}). Its value must be a @code{guix-publish-configuration}
12920 object, as described below.
12921
12922 This assumes that @file{/etc/guix} already contains a signing key pair as
12923 created by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking guix
12924 archive}). If that is not the case, the service will fail to start.
12925 @end deffn
12926
12927 @deftp {Data Type} guix-publish-configuration
12928 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{guix publish}
12929 service.
12930
12931 @table @asis
12932 @item @code{guix} (default: @code{guix})
12933 The Guix package to use.
12934
12935 @item @code{port} (default: @code{80})
12936 The TCP port to listen for connections.
12937
12938 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
12939 The host (and thus, network interface) to listen to. Use
12940 @code{"0.0.0.0"} to listen on all the network interfaces.
12941
12942 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{'(("gzip" 3))})
12943 This is a list of compression method/level tuple used when compressing
12944 substitutes. For example, to compress all substitutes with @emph{both} lzip
12945 at level 7 and gzip at level 9, write:
12946
12947 @lisp
12948 '(("lzip" 7) ("gzip" 9))
12949 @end lisp
12950
12951 Level 9 achieves the best compression ratio at the expense of increased CPU
12952 usage, whereas level 1 achieves fast compression.
12953
12954 An empty list disables compression altogether.
12955
12956 @item @code{nar-path} (default: @code{"nar"})
12957 The URL path at which ``nars'' can be fetched. @xref{Invoking guix
12958 publish, @code{--nar-path}}, for details.
12959
12960 @item @code{cache} (default: @code{#f})
12961 When it is @code{#f}, disable caching and instead generate archives on
12962 demand. Otherwise, this should be the name of a directory---e.g.,
12963 @code{"/var/cache/guix/publish"}---where @command{guix publish} caches
12964 archives and meta-data ready to be sent. @xref{Invoking guix publish,
12965 @option{--cache}}, for more information on the tradeoffs involved.
12966
12967 @item @code{workers} (default: @code{#f})
12968 When it is an integer, this is the number of worker threads used for
12969 caching; when @code{#f}, the number of processors is used.
12970 @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--workers}}, for more information.
12971
12972 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{#f})
12973 When it is an integer, this denotes the @dfn{time-to-live} in seconds
12974 of the published archives. @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--ttl}},
12975 for more information.
12976 @end table
12977 @end deftp
12978
12979 @anchor{rngd-service}
12980 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} rngd-service [#:rng-tools @var{rng-tools}] @
12981 [#:device "/dev/hwrng"]
12982 Return a service that runs the @command{rngd} program from @var{rng-tools}
12983 to add @var{device} to the kernel's entropy pool. The service will fail if
12984 @var{device} does not exist.
12985 @end deffn
12986
12987 @anchor{pam-limits-service}
12988 @cindex session limits
12989 @cindex ulimit
12990 @cindex priority
12991 @cindex realtime
12992 @cindex jackd
12993 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} pam-limits-service [#:limits @code{'()}]
12994
12995 Return a service that installs a configuration file for the
12996 @uref{http://linux-pam.org/Linux-PAM-html/sag-pam_limits.html,
12997 @code{pam_limits} module}. The procedure optionally takes a list of
12998 @code{pam-limits-entry} values, which can be used to specify
12999 @code{ulimit} limits and nice priority limits to user sessions.
13000
13001 The following limits definition sets two hard and soft limits for all
13002 login sessions of users in the @code{realtime} group:
13003
13004 @lisp
13005 (pam-limits-service
13006 (list
13007 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'rtprio 99)
13008 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'memlock 'unlimited)))
13009 @end lisp
13010
13011 The first entry increases the maximum realtime priority for
13012 non-privileged processes; the second entry lifts any restriction of the
13013 maximum address space that can be locked in memory. These settings are
13014 commonly used for real-time audio systems.
13015 @end deffn
13016
13017 @node Scheduled Job Execution
13018 @subsection Scheduled Job Execution
13019
13020 @cindex cron
13021 @cindex mcron
13022 @cindex scheduling jobs
13023 The @code{(gnu services mcron)} module provides an interface to
13024 GNU@tie{}mcron, a daemon to run jobs at scheduled times (@pxref{Top,,,
13025 mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}). GNU@tie{}mcron is similar to the traditional
13026 Unix @command{cron} daemon; the main difference is that it is
13027 implemented in Guile Scheme, which provides a lot of flexibility when
13028 specifying the scheduling of jobs and their actions.
13029
13030 The example below defines an operating system that runs the
13031 @command{updatedb} (@pxref{Invoking updatedb,,, find, Finding Files})
13032 and the @command{guix gc} commands (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}) daily, as
13033 well as the @command{mkid} command on behalf of an unprivileged user
13034 (@pxref{mkid invocation,,, idutils, ID Database Utilities}). It uses
13035 gexps to introduce job definitions that are passed to mcron
13036 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
13037
13038 @lisp
13039 (use-modules (guix) (gnu) (gnu services mcron))
13040 (use-package-modules base idutils)
13041
13042 (define updatedb-job
13043 ;; Run 'updatedb' at 3AM every day. Here we write the
13044 ;; job's action as a Scheme procedure.
13045 #~(job '(next-hour '(3))
13046 (lambda ()
13047 (execl (string-append #$findutils "/bin/updatedb")
13048 "updatedb"
13049 "--prunepaths=/tmp /var/tmp /gnu/store"))))
13050
13051 (define garbage-collector-job
13052 ;; Collect garbage 5 minutes after midnight every day.
13053 ;; The job's action is a shell command.
13054 #~(job "5 0 * * *" ;Vixie cron syntax
13055 "guix gc -F 1G"))
13056
13057 (define idutils-job
13058 ;; Update the index database as user "charlie" at 12:15PM
13059 ;; and 19:15PM. This runs from the user's home directory.
13060 #~(job '(next-minute-from (next-hour '(12 19)) '(15))
13061 (string-append #$idutils "/bin/mkid src")
13062 #:user "charlie"))
13063
13064 (operating-system
13065 ;; @dots{}
13066 (services (cons (service mcron-service-type
13067 (mcron-configuration
13068 (jobs (list garbage-collector-job
13069 updatedb-job
13070 idutils-job))))
13071 %base-services)))
13072 @end lisp
13073
13074 For more complex jobs defined in Scheme where you need control over the top
13075 level, for instance to introduce a @code{use-modules} form, you can move your
13076 code to a separate program using the @code{program-file} procedure of the
13077 @code{(guix gexp)} module (@pxref{G-Expressions}). The example below
13078 illustrates that.
13079
13080 @lisp
13081 (define %battery-alert-job
13082 ;; Beep when the battery percentage falls below %MIN-LEVEL.
13083 #~(job
13084 '(next-minute (range 0 60 1))
13085 #$(program-file
13086 "battery-alert.scm"
13087 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
13088 '((guix build utils)))
13089 #~(begin
13090 (define %min-level 20)
13091 (use-modules (guix build utils)
13092 (ice-9 popen)
13093 (ice-9 regex)
13094 (ice-9 textual-ports)
13095 (srfi srfi-2))
13096 (setenv "LC_ALL" "C") ;ensure English output
13097 (and-let* ((input-pipe (open-pipe*
13098 OPEN_READ
13099 #$(file-append acpi "/bin/acpi")))
13100 (output (get-string-all input-pipe))
13101 (m (string-match "Discharging, ([0-9]+)%" output))
13102 (level (string->number (match:substring m 1)))
13103 ((< level %min-level)))
13104 (format #t "warning: Battery level is low (~a%)~%" level)
13105 (invoke #$(file-append beep "/bin/beep") "-r5")))))))
13106 @end lisp
13107
13108 @xref{Guile Syntax, mcron job specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron},
13109 for more information on mcron job specifications. Below is the
13110 reference of the mcron service.
13111
13112 On a running system, you can use the @code{schedule} action of the service to
13113 visualize the mcron jobs that will be executed next:
13114
13115 @example
13116 # herd schedule mcron
13117 @end example
13118
13119 @noindent
13120 The example above lists the next five tasks that will be executed, but you can
13121 also specify the number of tasks to display:
13122
13123 @example
13124 # herd schedule mcron 10
13125 @end example
13126
13127 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mcron-service-type
13128 This is the type of the @code{mcron} service, whose value is an
13129 @code{mcron-configuration} object.
13130
13131 This service type can be the target of a service extension that provides
13132 it additional job specifications (@pxref{Service Composition}). In
13133 other words, it is possible to define services that provide additional
13134 mcron jobs to run.
13135 @end defvr
13136
13137 @deftp {Data Type} mcron-configuration
13138 Data type representing the configuration of mcron.
13139
13140 @table @asis
13141 @item @code{mcron} (default: @var{mcron})
13142 The mcron package to use.
13143
13144 @item @code{jobs}
13145 This is a list of gexps (@pxref{G-Expressions}), where each gexp
13146 corresponds to an mcron job specification (@pxref{Syntax, mcron job
13147 specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}).
13148 @end table
13149 @end deftp
13150
13151
13152 @node Log Rotation
13153 @subsection Log Rotation
13154
13155 @cindex rottlog
13156 @cindex log rotation
13157 @cindex logging
13158 Log files such as those found in @file{/var/log} tend to grow endlessly,
13159 so it's a good idea to @dfn{rotate} them once in a while---i.e., archive
13160 their contents in separate files, possibly compressed. The @code{(gnu
13161 services admin)} module provides an interface to GNU@tie{}Rot[t]log, a
13162 log rotation tool (@pxref{Top,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
13163
13164 The example below defines an operating system that provides log rotation
13165 with the default settings, for commonly encountered log files.
13166
13167 @lisp
13168 (use-modules (guix) (gnu))
13169 (use-service-modules admin mcron)
13170 (use-package-modules base idutils)
13171
13172 (operating-system
13173 ;; @dots{}
13174 (services (cons (service rottlog-service-type)
13175 %base-services)))
13176 @end lisp
13177
13178 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rottlog-service-type
13179 This is the type of the Rottlog service, whose value is a
13180 @code{rottlog-configuration} object.
13181
13182 Other services can extend this one with new @code{log-rotation} objects
13183 (see below), thereby augmenting the set of files to be rotated.
13184
13185 This service type can define mcron jobs (@pxref{Scheduled Job
13186 Execution}) to run the rottlog service.
13187 @end defvr
13188
13189 @deftp {Data Type} rottlog-configuration
13190 Data type representing the configuration of rottlog.
13191
13192 @table @asis
13193 @item @code{rottlog} (default: @code{rottlog})
13194 The Rottlog package to use.
13195
13196 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @code{(file-append rottlog "/etc/rc")})
13197 The Rottlog configuration file to use (@pxref{Mandatory RC Variables,,,
13198 rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
13199
13200 @item @code{rotations} (default: @code{%default-rotations})
13201 A list of @code{log-rotation} objects as defined below.
13202
13203 @item @code{jobs}
13204 This is a list of gexps where each gexp corresponds to an mcron job
13205 specification (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}).
13206 @end table
13207 @end deftp
13208
13209 @deftp {Data Type} log-rotation
13210 Data type representing the rotation of a group of log files.
13211
13212 Taking an example from the Rottlog manual (@pxref{Period Related File
13213 Examples,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}), a log rotation might be
13214 defined like this:
13215
13216 @lisp
13217 (log-rotation
13218 (frequency 'daily)
13219 (files '("/var/log/apache/*"))
13220 (options '("storedir apache-archives"
13221 "rotate 6"
13222 "notifempty"
13223 "nocompress")))
13224 @end lisp
13225
13226 The list of fields is as follows:
13227
13228 @table @asis
13229 @item @code{frequency} (default: @code{'weekly})
13230 The log rotation frequency, a symbol.
13231
13232 @item @code{files}
13233 The list of files or file glob patterns to rotate.
13234
13235 @item @code{options} (default: @code{'()})
13236 The list of rottlog options for this rotation (@pxref{Configuration
13237 parameters,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]lg Manual}).
13238
13239 @item @code{post-rotate} (default: @code{#f})
13240 Either @code{#f} or a gexp to execute once the rotation has completed.
13241 @end table
13242 @end deftp
13243
13244 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-rotations
13245 Specifies weekly rotation of @var{%rotated-files} and of
13246 @file{/var/log/guix-daemon.log}.
13247 @end defvr
13248
13249 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %rotated-files
13250 The list of syslog-controlled files to be rotated. By default it is:
13251 @code{'("/var/log/messages" "/var/log/secure" "/var/log/debug" \
13252 "/var/log/maillog")}.
13253 @end defvr
13254
13255 @node Networking Services
13256 @subsection Networking Services
13257
13258 The @code{(gnu services networking)} module provides services to configure
13259 the network interface.
13260
13261 @cindex DHCP, networking service
13262 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dhcp-client-service-type
13263 This is the type of services that run @var{dhcp}, a Dynamic Host Configuration
13264 Protocol (DHCP) client, on all the non-loopback network interfaces. Its value
13265 is the DHCP client package to use, @code{isc-dhcp} by default.
13266 @end defvr
13267
13268 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dhcpd-service-type
13269 This type defines a service that runs a DHCP daemon. To create a
13270 service of this type, you must supply a @code{<dhcpd-configuration>}.
13271 For example:
13272
13273 @lisp
13274 (service dhcpd-service-type
13275 (dhcpd-configuration
13276 (config-file (local-file "my-dhcpd.conf"))
13277 (interfaces '("enp0s25"))))
13278 @end lisp
13279 @end deffn
13280
13281 @deftp {Data Type} dhcpd-configuration
13282 @table @asis
13283 @item @code{package} (default: @code{isc-dhcp})
13284 The package that provides the DHCP daemon. This package is expected to
13285 provide the daemon at @file{sbin/dhcpd} relative to its output
13286 directory. The default package is the
13287 @uref{https://www.isc.org/products/DHCP, ISC's DHCP server}.
13288 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
13289 The configuration file to use. This is required. It will be passed to
13290 @code{dhcpd} via its @code{-cf} option. This may be any ``file-like''
13291 object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}). See @code{man
13292 dhcpd.conf} for details on the configuration file syntax.
13293 @item @code{version} (default: @code{"4"})
13294 The DHCP version to use. The ISC DHCP server supports the values ``4'',
13295 ``6'', and ``4o6''. These correspond to the @code{dhcpd} program
13296 options @code{-4}, @code{-6}, and @code{-4o6}. See @code{man dhcpd} for
13297 details.
13298 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd"})
13299 The run directory to use. At service activation time, this directory
13300 will be created if it does not exist.
13301 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd/dhcpd.pid"})
13302 The PID file to use. This corresponds to the @code{-pf} option of
13303 @code{dhcpd}. See @code{man dhcpd} for details.
13304 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'()})
13305 The names of the network interfaces on which dhcpd should listen for
13306 broadcasts. If this list is not empty, then its elements (which must be
13307 strings) will be appended to the @code{dhcpd} invocation when starting
13308 the daemon. It may not be necessary to explicitly specify any
13309 interfaces here; see @code{man dhcpd} for details.
13310 @end table
13311 @end deftp
13312
13313 @defvr {Scheme Variable} static-networking-service-type
13314 This is the type for statically-configured network interfaces.
13315 @c TODO Document <static-networking> data structures.
13316 @end defvr
13317
13318 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} static-networking-service @var{interface} @var{ip} @
13319 [#:netmask #f] [#:gateway #f] [#:name-servers @code{'()}] @
13320 [#:requirement @code{'(udev)}]
13321 Return a service that starts @var{interface} with address @var{ip}. If
13322 @var{netmask} is true, use it as the network mask. If @var{gateway} is true,
13323 it must be a string specifying the default network gateway. @var{requirement}
13324 can be used to declare a dependency on another service before configuring the
13325 interface.
13326
13327 This procedure can be called several times, one for each network
13328 interface of interest. Behind the scenes what it does is extend
13329 @code{static-networking-service-type} with additional network interfaces
13330 to handle.
13331
13332 For example:
13333
13334 @lisp
13335 (static-networking-service "eno1" "192.168.1.82"
13336 #:gateway "192.168.1.2"
13337 #:name-servers '("192.168.1.2"))
13338 @end lisp
13339 @end deffn
13340
13341 @cindex wicd
13342 @cindex wireless
13343 @cindex WiFi
13344 @cindex network management
13345 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} wicd-service [#:wicd @var{wicd}]
13346 Return a service that runs @url{https://launchpad.net/wicd,Wicd}, a network
13347 management daemon that aims to simplify wired and wireless networking.
13348
13349 This service adds the @var{wicd} package to the global profile, providing
13350 several commands to interact with the daemon and configure networking:
13351 @command{wicd-client}, a graphical user interface, and the @command{wicd-cli}
13352 and @command{wicd-curses} user interfaces.
13353 @end deffn
13354
13355 @cindex ModemManager
13356
13357 @defvr {Scheme Variable} modem-manager-service-type
13358 This is the service type for the
13359 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/ModemManager, ModemManager}
13360 service. The value for this service type is a
13361 @code{modem-manager-configuration} record.
13362
13363 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
13364 Services}).
13365 @end defvr
13366
13367 @deftp {Data Type} modem-manager-configuration
13368 Data type representing the configuration of ModemManager.
13369
13370 @table @asis
13371 @item @code{modem-manager} (default: @code{modem-manager})
13372 The ModemManager package to use.
13373
13374 @end table
13375 @end deftp
13376
13377 @cindex USB_ModeSwitch
13378 @cindex Modeswitching
13379
13380 @defvr {Scheme Variable} usb-modeswitch-service-type
13381 This is the service type for the
13382 @uref{https://www.draisberghof.de/usb_modeswitch/, USB_ModeSwitch} service. The
13383 value for this service type is a @code{usb-modeswitch-configuration} record.
13384
13385 When plugged in, some USB modems (and other USB devices) initially present
13386 themselves as a read-only storage medium and not as a modem. They need to be
13387 @dfn{modeswitched} before they are usable. The USB_ModeSwitch service type
13388 installs udev rules to automatically modeswitch these devices when they are
13389 plugged in.
13390
13391 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
13392 Services}).
13393 @end defvr
13394
13395 @deftp {Data Type} usb-modeswitch-configuration
13396 Data type representing the configuration of USB_ModeSwitch.
13397
13398 @table @asis
13399 @item @code{usb-modeswitch} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch})
13400 The USB_ModeSwitch package providing the binaries for modeswitching.
13401
13402 @item @code{usb-modeswitch-data} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch-data})
13403 The package providing the device data and udev rules file used by
13404 USB_ModeSwitch.
13405
13406 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$usb-modeswitch:dispatcher "/etc/usb_modeswitch.conf")})
13407 Which config file to use for the USB_ModeSwitch dispatcher. By default the
13408 config file shipped with USB_ModeSwitch is used which disables logging to
13409 @file{/var/log} among other default settings. If set to @code{#f}, no config
13410 file is used.
13411
13412 @end table
13413 @end deftp
13414
13415 @cindex NetworkManager
13416
13417 @defvr {Scheme Variable} network-manager-service-type
13418 This is the service type for the
13419 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/NetworkManager, NetworkManager}
13420 service. The value for this service type is a
13421 @code{network-manager-configuration} record.
13422
13423 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
13424 Services}).
13425 @end defvr
13426
13427 @deftp {Data Type} network-manager-configuration
13428 Data type representing the configuration of NetworkManager.
13429
13430 @table @asis
13431 @item @code{network-manager} (default: @code{network-manager})
13432 The NetworkManager package to use.
13433
13434 @item @code{dns} (default: @code{"default"})
13435 Processing mode for DNS, which affects how NetworkManager uses the
13436 @code{resolv.conf} configuration file.
13437
13438 @table @samp
13439 @item default
13440 NetworkManager will update @code{resolv.conf} to reflect the nameservers
13441 provided by currently active connections.
13442
13443 @item dnsmasq
13444 NetworkManager will run @code{dnsmasq} as a local caching nameserver, using a
13445 @dfn{conditional forwarding} configuration if you are connected to a VPN, and
13446 then update @code{resolv.conf} to point to the local nameserver.
13447
13448 With this setting, you can share your network connection. For example when
13449 you want to share your network connection to another laptop @i{via} an
13450 Ethernet cable, you can open @command{nm-connection-editor} and configure the
13451 Wired connection's method for IPv4 and IPv6 to be ``Shared to other computers''
13452 and reestablish the connection (or reboot).
13453
13454 You can also set up a @dfn{host-to-guest connection} to QEMU VMs
13455 (@pxref{Installing Guix in a VM}). With a host-to-guest connection, you can
13456 e.g.@: access a Web server running on the VM (@pxref{Web Services}) from a Web
13457 browser on your host system, or connect to the VM @i{via} SSH
13458 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}). To set up a
13459 host-to-guest connection, run this command once:
13460
13461 @example
13462 nmcli connection add type tun \
13463 connection.interface-name tap0 \
13464 tun.mode tap tun.owner $(id -u) \
13465 ipv4.method shared \
13466 ipv4.addresses 172.28.112.1/24
13467 @end example
13468
13469 Then each time you launch your QEMU VM (@pxref{Running Guix in a VM}), pass
13470 @option{-nic tap,ifname=tap0,script=no,downscript=no} to
13471 @command{qemu-system-...}.
13472
13473 @item none
13474 NetworkManager will not modify @code{resolv.conf}.
13475 @end table
13476
13477 @item @code{vpn-plugins} (default: @code{'()})
13478 This is the list of available plugins for virtual private networks
13479 (VPNs). An example of this is the @code{network-manager-openvpn}
13480 package, which allows NetworkManager to manage VPNs @i{via} OpenVPN.
13481
13482 @end table
13483 @end deftp
13484
13485 @cindex Connman
13486 @deffn {Scheme Variable} connman-service-type
13487 This is the service type to run @url{https://01.org/connman,Connman},
13488 a network connection manager.
13489
13490 Its value must be an
13491 @code{connman-configuration} record as in this example:
13492
13493 @lisp
13494 (service connman-service-type
13495 (connman-configuration
13496 (disable-vpn? #t)))
13497 @end lisp
13498
13499 See below for details about @code{connman-configuration}.
13500 @end deffn
13501
13502 @deftp {Data Type} connman-configuration
13503 Data Type representing the configuration of connman.
13504
13505 @table @asis
13506 @item @code{connman} (default: @var{connman})
13507 The connman package to use.
13508
13509 @item @code{disable-vpn?} (default: @code{#f})
13510 When true, disable connman's vpn plugin.
13511 @end table
13512 @end deftp
13513
13514 @cindex WPA Supplicant
13515 @defvr {Scheme Variable} wpa-supplicant-service-type
13516 This is the service type to run @url{https://w1.fi/wpa_supplicant/,WPA
13517 supplicant}, an authentication daemon required to authenticate against
13518 encrypted WiFi or ethernet networks.
13519 @end defvr
13520
13521 @deftp {Data Type} wpa-supplicant-configuration
13522 Data type representing the configuration of WPA Supplicant.
13523
13524 It takes the following parameters:
13525
13526 @table @asis
13527 @item @code{wpa-supplicant} (default: @code{wpa-supplicant})
13528 The WPA Supplicant package to use.
13529
13530 @item @code{dbus?} (default: @code{#t})
13531 Whether to listen for requests on D-Bus.
13532
13533 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/wpa_supplicant.pid"})
13534 Where to store the PID file.
13535
13536 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
13537 If this is set, it must specify the name of a network interface that
13538 WPA supplicant will control.
13539
13540 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
13541 Optional configuration file to use.
13542
13543 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
13544 List of additional command-line arguments to pass to the daemon.
13545 @end table
13546 @end deftp
13547
13548 @cindex iptables
13549 @defvr {Scheme Variable} iptables-service-type
13550 This is the service type to set up an iptables configuration. iptables is a
13551 packet filtering framework supported by the Linux kernel. This service
13552 supports configuring iptables for both IPv4 and IPv6. A simple example
13553 configuration rejecting all incoming connections except those to the ssh port
13554 22 is shown below.
13555
13556 @lisp
13557 (service iptables-service-type
13558 (iptables-configuration
13559 (ipv4-rules (plain-file "iptables.rules" "*filter
13560 :INPUT ACCEPT
13561 :FORWARD ACCEPT
13562 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
13563 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
13564 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp-port-unreachable
13565 COMMIT
13566 "))
13567 (ipv6-rules (plain-file "ip6tables.rules" "*filter
13568 :INPUT ACCEPT
13569 :FORWARD ACCEPT
13570 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
13571 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
13572 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp6-port-unreachable
13573 COMMIT
13574 "))))
13575 @end lisp
13576 @end defvr
13577
13578 @deftp {Data Type} iptables-configuration
13579 The data type representing the configuration of iptables.
13580
13581 @table @asis
13582 @item @code{iptables} (default: @code{iptables})
13583 The iptables package that provides @code{iptables-restore} and
13584 @code{ip6tables-restore}.
13585 @item @code{ipv4-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
13586 The iptables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{iptables-restore}.
13587 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
13588 objects}).
13589 @item @code{ipv6-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
13590 The ip6tables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{ip6tables-restore}.
13591 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
13592 objects}).
13593 @end table
13594 @end deftp
13595
13596 @cindex nftables
13597 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nftables-service-type
13598 This is the service type to set up a nftables configuration. nftables is a
13599 netfilter project that aims to replace the existing iptables, ip6tables,
13600 arptables and ebtables framework. It provides a new packet filtering
13601 framework, a new user-space utility @command{nft}, and a compatibility layer
13602 for iptables. This service comes with a default ruleset
13603 @code{%default-nftables-ruleset} that rejecting all incomming connections
13604 except those to the ssh port 22. To use it, simply write:
13605
13606 @lisp
13607 (service nftables-service-type)
13608 @end lisp
13609 @end defvr
13610
13611 @deftp {Data Type} nftables-configuration
13612 The data type representing the configuration of nftables.
13613
13614 @table @asis
13615 @item @code{package} (default: @code{nftables})
13616 The nftables package that provides @command{nft}.
13617 @item @code{ruleset} (default: @code{%default-nftables-ruleset})
13618 The nftables ruleset to use. This may be any ``file-like'' object
13619 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
13620 @end table
13621 @end deftp
13622
13623 @cindex NTP (Network Time Protocol), service
13624 @cindex ntpd, service for the Network Time Protocol daemon
13625 @cindex real time clock
13626 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ntp-service-type
13627 This is the type of the service running the @uref{https://www.ntp.org,
13628 Network Time Protocol (NTP)} daemon, @command{ntpd}. The daemon will keep the
13629 system clock synchronized with that of the specified NTP servers.
13630
13631 The value of this service is an @code{ntpd-configuration} object, as described
13632 below.
13633 @end defvr
13634
13635 @deftp {Data Type} ntp-configuration
13636 This is the data type for the NTP service configuration.
13637
13638 @table @asis
13639 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{%ntp-servers})
13640 This is the list of servers (@code{<ntp-server>} records) with which
13641 @command{ntpd} will be synchronized. See the @code{ntp-server} data type
13642 definition below.
13643
13644 @item @code{allow-large-adjustment?} (default: @code{#t})
13645 This determines whether @command{ntpd} is allowed to make an initial
13646 adjustment of more than 1,000 seconds.
13647
13648 @item @code{ntp} (default: @code{ntp})
13649 The NTP package to use.
13650 @end table
13651 @end deftp
13652
13653 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %ntp-servers
13654 List of host names used as the default NTP servers. These are servers of the
13655 @uref{https://www.ntppool.org/en/, NTP Pool Project}.
13656 @end defvr
13657
13658 @deftp {Data Type} ntp-server
13659 The data type representing the configuration of a NTP server.
13660
13661 @table @asis
13662 @item @code{type} (default: @code{'server})
13663 The type of the NTP server, given as a symbol. One of @code{'pool},
13664 @code{'server}, @code{'peer}, @code{'broadcast} or @code{'manycastclient}.
13665
13666 @item @code{address}
13667 The address of the server, as a string.
13668
13669 @item @code{options}
13670 NTPD options to use with that specific server, given as a list of option names
13671 and/or of option names and values tuples. The following example define a server
13672 to use with the options @option{iburst} and @option{prefer}, as well as
13673 @option{version} 3 and a @option{maxpoll} time of 16 seconds.
13674
13675 @example
13676 (ntp-server
13677 (type 'server)
13678 (address "some.ntp.server.org")
13679 (options `(iburst (version 3) (maxpoll 16) prefer))))
13680 @end example
13681 @end table
13682 @end deftp
13683
13684 @cindex OpenNTPD
13685 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openntpd-service-type
13686 Run the @command{ntpd}, the Network Time Protocol (NTP) daemon, as implemented
13687 by @uref{http://www.openntpd.org, OpenNTPD}. The daemon will keep the system
13688 clock synchronized with that of the given servers.
13689
13690 @lisp
13691 (service
13692 openntpd-service-type
13693 (openntpd-configuration
13694 (listen-on '("127.0.0.1" "::1"))
13695 (sensor '("udcf0 correction 70000"))
13696 (constraint-from '("www.gnu.org"))
13697 (constraints-from '("https://www.google.com/"))
13698 (allow-large-adjustment? #t)))
13699
13700 @end lisp
13701 @end deffn
13702
13703 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %openntpd-servers
13704 This variable is a list of the server addresses defined in
13705 @var{%ntp-servers}.
13706 @end defvr
13707
13708 @deftp {Data Type} openntpd-configuration
13709 @table @asis
13710 @item @code{openntpd} (default: @code{(file-append openntpd "/sbin/ntpd")})
13711 The openntpd executable to use.
13712 @item @code{listen-on} (default: @code{'("127.0.0.1" "::1")})
13713 A list of local IP addresses or hostnames the ntpd daemon should listen on.
13714 @item @code{query-from} (default: @code{'()})
13715 A list of local IP address the ntpd daemon should use for outgoing queries.
13716 @item @code{sensor} (default: @code{'()})
13717 Specify a list of timedelta sensor devices ntpd should use. @code{ntpd}
13718 will listen to each sensor that actually exists and ignore non-existent ones.
13719 See @uref{https://man.openbsd.org/ntpd.conf, upstream documentation} for more
13720 information.
13721 @item @code{server} (default: @code{'()})
13722 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP servers to synchronize to.
13723 @item @code{servers} (default: @var{%openntp-servers})
13724 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP pools to synchronize to.
13725 @item @code{constraint-from} (default: @code{'()})
13726 @code{ntpd} can be configured to query the ‘Date’ from trusted HTTPS servers via TLS.
13727 This time information is not used for precision but acts as an authenticated
13728 constraint, thereby reducing the impact of unauthenticated NTP
13729 man-in-the-middle attacks.
13730 Specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of HTTPS servers to provide
13731 a constraint.
13732 @item @code{constraints-from} (default: @code{'()})
13733 As with constraint from, specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of
13734 HTTPS servers to provide a constraint. Should the hostname resolve to multiple
13735 IP addresses, @code{ntpd} will calculate a median constraint from all of them.
13736 @item @code{allow-large-adjustment?} (default: @code{#f})
13737 Determines if @code{ntpd} is allowed to make an initial adjustment of more
13738 than 180 seconds.
13739 @end table
13740 @end deftp
13741
13742 @cindex inetd
13743 @deffn {Scheme variable} inetd-service-type
13744 This service runs the @command{inetd} (@pxref{inetd invocation,,,
13745 inetutils, GNU Inetutils}) daemon. @command{inetd} listens for
13746 connections on internet sockets, and lazily starts the specified server
13747 program when a connection is made on one of these sockets.
13748
13749 The value of this service is an @code{inetd-configuration} object. The
13750 following example configures the @command{inetd} daemon to provide the
13751 built-in @command{echo} service, as well as an smtp service which
13752 forwards smtp traffic over ssh to a server @code{smtp-server} behind a
13753 gateway @code{hostname}:
13754
13755 @lisp
13756 (service
13757 inetd-service-type
13758 (inetd-configuration
13759 (entries (list
13760 (inetd-entry
13761 (name "echo")
13762 (socket-type 'stream)
13763 (protocol "tcp")
13764 (wait? #f)
13765 (user "root"))
13766 (inetd-entry
13767 (node "127.0.0.1")
13768 (name "smtp")
13769 (socket-type 'stream)
13770 (protocol "tcp")
13771 (wait? #f)
13772 (user "root")
13773 (program (file-append openssh "/bin/ssh"))
13774 (arguments
13775 '("ssh" "-qT" "-i" "/path/to/ssh_key"
13776 "-W" "smtp-server:25" "user@@hostname")))))))
13777 @end lisp
13778
13779 See below for more details about @code{inetd-configuration}.
13780 @end deffn
13781
13782 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-configuration
13783 Data type representing the configuration of @command{inetd}.
13784
13785 @table @asis
13786 @item @code{program} (default: @code{(file-append inetutils "/libexec/inetd")})
13787 The @command{inetd} executable to use.
13788
13789 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
13790 A list of @command{inetd} service entries. Each entry should be created
13791 by the @code{inetd-entry} constructor.
13792 @end table
13793 @end deftp
13794
13795 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-entry
13796 Data type representing an entry in the @command{inetd} configuration.
13797 Each entry corresponds to a socket where @command{inetd} will listen for
13798 requests.
13799
13800 @table @asis
13801 @item @code{node} (default: @code{#f})
13802 Optional string, a comma-separated list of local addresses
13803 @command{inetd} should use when listening for this service.
13804 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a complete
13805 description of all options.
13806 @item @code{name}
13807 A string, the name must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/services}.
13808 @item @code{socket-type}
13809 One of @code{'stream}, @code{'dgram}, @code{'raw}, @code{'rdm} or
13810 @code{'seqpacket}.
13811 @item @code{protocol}
13812 A string, must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/protocols}.
13813 @item @code{wait?} (default: @code{#t})
13814 Whether @command{inetd} should wait for the server to exit before
13815 listening to new service requests.
13816 @item @code{user}
13817 A string containing the user (and, optionally, group) name of the user
13818 as whom the server should run. The group name can be specified in a
13819 suffix, separated by a colon or period, i.e.@: @code{"user"},
13820 @code{"user:group"} or @code{"user.group"}.
13821 @item @code{program} (default: @code{"internal"})
13822 The server program which will serve the requests, or @code{"internal"}
13823 if @command{inetd} should use a built-in service.
13824 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
13825 A list strings or file-like objects, which are the server program's
13826 arguments, starting with the zeroth argument, i.e.@: the name of the
13827 program itself. For @command{inetd}'s internal services, this entry
13828 must be @code{'()} or @code{'("internal")}.
13829 @end table
13830
13831 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a more
13832 detailed discussion of each configuration field.
13833 @end deftp
13834
13835 @cindex Tor
13836 @defvr {Scheme Variable} tor-service-type
13837 This is the type for a service that runs the @uref{https://torproject.org,
13838 Tor} anonymous networking daemon. The service is configured using a
13839 @code{<tor-configuration>} record. By default, the Tor daemon runs as the
13840 @code{tor} unprivileged user, which is a member of the @code{tor} group.
13841
13842 @end defvr
13843
13844 @deftp {Data Type} tor-configuration
13845 @table @asis
13846 @item @code{tor} (default: @code{tor})
13847 The package that provides the Tor daemon. This package is expected to provide
13848 the daemon at @file{bin/tor} relative to its output directory. The default
13849 package is the @uref{https://www.torproject.org, Tor Project's}
13850 implementation.
13851
13852 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(plain-file "empty" "")})
13853 The configuration file to use. It will be appended to a default configuration
13854 file, and the final configuration file will be passed to @code{tor} via its
13855 @code{-f} option. This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions,
13856 file-like objects}). See @code{man tor} for details on the configuration file
13857 syntax.
13858
13859 @item @code{hidden-services} (default: @code{'()})
13860 The list of @code{<hidden-service>} records to use. For any hidden service
13861 you include in this list, appropriate configuration to enable the hidden
13862 service will be automatically added to the default configuration file. You
13863 may conveniently create @code{<hidden-service>} records using the
13864 @code{tor-hidden-service} procedure described below.
13865
13866 @item @code{socks-socket-type} (default: @code{'tcp})
13867 The default socket type that Tor should use for its SOCKS socket. This must
13868 be either @code{'tcp} or @code{'unix}. If it is @code{'tcp}, then by default
13869 Tor will listen on TCP port 9050 on the loopback interface (i.e., localhost).
13870 If it is @code{'unix}, then Tor will listen on the UNIX domain socket
13871 @file{/var/run/tor/socks-sock}, which will be made writable by members of the
13872 @code{tor} group.
13873
13874 If you want to customize the SOCKS socket in more detail, leave
13875 @code{socks-socket-type} at its default value of @code{'tcp} and use
13876 @code{config-file} to override the default by providing your own
13877 @code{SocksPort} option.
13878 @end table
13879 @end deftp
13880
13881 @cindex hidden service
13882 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-hidden-service @var{name} @var{mapping}
13883 Define a new Tor @dfn{hidden service} called @var{name} and implementing
13884 @var{mapping}. @var{mapping} is a list of port/host tuples, such as:
13885
13886 @example
13887 '((22 "127.0.0.1:22")
13888 (80 "127.0.0.1:8080"))
13889 @end example
13890
13891 In this example, port 22 of the hidden service is mapped to local port 22, and
13892 port 80 is mapped to local port 8080.
13893
13894 This creates a @file{/var/lib/tor/hidden-services/@var{name}} directory, where
13895 the @file{hostname} file contains the @code{.onion} host name for the hidden
13896 service.
13897
13898 See @uref{https://www.torproject.org/docs/tor-hidden-service.html.en, the Tor
13899 project's documentation} for more information.
13900 @end deffn
13901
13902 The @code{(gnu services rsync)} module provides the following services:
13903
13904 You might want an rsync daemon if you have files that you want available
13905 so anyone (or just yourself) can download existing files or upload new
13906 files.
13907
13908 @deffn {Scheme Variable} rsync-service-type
13909 This is the service type for the @uref{https://rsync.samba.org, rsync} daemon,
13910 The value for this service type is a
13911 @command{rsync-configuration} record as in this example:
13912
13913 @lisp
13914 (service rsync-service-type)
13915 @end lisp
13916
13917 See below for details about @code{rsync-configuration}.
13918 @end deffn
13919
13920 @deftp {Data Type} rsync-configuration
13921 Data type representing the configuration for @code{rsync-service}.
13922
13923 @table @asis
13924 @item @code{package} (default: @var{rsync})
13925 @code{rsync} package to use.
13926
13927 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{873})
13928 TCP port on which @command{rsync} listens for incoming connections. If port
13929 is less than @code{1024} @command{rsync} needs to be started as the
13930 @code{root} user and group.
13931
13932 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.pid"})
13933 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its PID.
13934
13935 @item @code{lock-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.lock"})
13936 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its lock file.
13937
13938 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/rsyncd.log"})
13939 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its log file.
13940
13941 @item @code{use-chroot?} (default: @var{#t})
13942 Whether to use chroot for @command{rsync} shared directory.
13943
13944 @item @code{share-path} (default: @file{/srv/rsync})
13945 Location of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
13946
13947 @item @code{share-comment} (default: @code{"Rsync share"})
13948 Comment of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
13949
13950 @item @code{read-only?} (default: @var{#f})
13951 Read-write permissions to shared directory.
13952
13953 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{300})
13954 I/O timeout in seconds.
13955
13956 @item @code{user} (default: @var{"root"})
13957 Owner of the @code{rsync} process.
13958
13959 @item @code{group} (default: @var{"root"})
13960 Group of the @code{rsync} process.
13961
13962 @item @code{uid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
13963 User name or user ID that file transfers to and from that module should take
13964 place as when the daemon was run as @code{root}.
13965
13966 @item @code{gid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
13967 Group name or group ID that will be used when accessing the module.
13968
13969 @end table
13970 @end deftp
13971
13972 Furthermore, @code{(gnu services ssh)} provides the following services.
13973 @cindex SSH
13974 @cindex SSH server
13975
13976 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lsh-service [#:host-key "/etc/lsh/host-key"] @
13977 [#:daemonic? #t] [#:interfaces '()] [#:port-number 22] @
13978 [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] [#:root-login? #f] @
13979 [#:syslog-output? #t] [#:x11-forwarding? #t] @
13980 [#:tcp/ip-forwarding? #t] [#:password-authentication? #t] @
13981 [#:public-key-authentication? #t] [#:initialize? #t]
13982 Run the @command{lshd} program from @var{lsh} to listen on port @var{port-number}.
13983 @var{host-key} must designate a file containing the host key, and readable
13984 only by root.
13985
13986 When @var{daemonic?} is true, @command{lshd} will detach from the
13987 controlling terminal and log its output to syslogd, unless one sets
13988 @var{syslog-output?} to false. Obviously, it also makes lsh-service
13989 depend on existence of syslogd service. When @var{pid-file?} is true,
13990 @command{lshd} writes its PID to the file called @var{pid-file}.
13991
13992 When @var{initialize?} is true, automatically create the seed and host key
13993 upon service activation if they do not exist yet. This may take long and
13994 require interaction.
13995
13996 When @var{initialize?} is false, it is up to the user to initialize the
13997 randomness generator (@pxref{lsh-make-seed,,, lsh, LSH Manual}), and to create
13998 a key pair with the private key stored in file @var{host-key} (@pxref{lshd
13999 basics,,, lsh, LSH Manual}).
14000
14001 When @var{interfaces} is empty, lshd listens for connections on all the
14002 network interfaces; otherwise, @var{interfaces} must be a list of host names
14003 or addresses.
14004
14005 @var{allow-empty-passwords?} specifies whether to accept log-ins with empty
14006 passwords, and @var{root-login?} specifies whether to accept log-ins as
14007 root.
14008
14009 The other options should be self-descriptive.
14010 @end deffn
14011
14012 @cindex SSH
14013 @cindex SSH server
14014 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openssh-service-type
14015 This is the type for the @uref{http://www.openssh.org, OpenSSH} secure
14016 shell daemon, @command{sshd}. Its value must be an
14017 @code{openssh-configuration} record as in this example:
14018
14019 @lisp
14020 (service openssh-service-type
14021 (openssh-configuration
14022 (x11-forwarding? #t)
14023 (permit-root-login 'without-password)
14024 (authorized-keys
14025 `(("alice" ,(local-file "alice.pub"))
14026 ("bob" ,(local-file "bob.pub"))))))
14027 @end lisp
14028
14029 See below for details about @code{openssh-configuration}.
14030
14031 This service can be extended with extra authorized keys, as in this
14032 example:
14033
14034 @lisp
14035 (service-extension openssh-service-type
14036 (const `(("charlie"
14037 ,(local-file "charlie.pub")))))
14038 @end lisp
14039 @end deffn
14040
14041 @deftp {Data Type} openssh-configuration
14042 This is the configuration record for OpenSSH's @command{sshd}.
14043
14044 @table @asis
14045 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/sshd.pid"})
14046 Name of the file where @command{sshd} writes its PID.
14047
14048 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{22})
14049 TCP port on which @command{sshd} listens for incoming connections.
14050
14051 @item @code{permit-root-login} (default: @code{#f})
14052 This field determines whether and when to allow logins as root. If
14053 @code{#f}, root logins are disallowed; if @code{#t}, they are allowed.
14054 If it's the symbol @code{'without-password}, then root logins are
14055 permitted but not with password-based authentication.
14056
14057 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
14058 When true, users with empty passwords may log in. When false, they may
14059 not.
14060
14061 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
14062 When true, users may log in with their password. When false, they have
14063 other authentication methods.
14064
14065 @item @code{public-key-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
14066 When true, users may log in using public key authentication. When
14067 false, users have to use other authentication method.
14068
14069 Authorized public keys are stored in @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
14070 This is used only by protocol version 2.
14071
14072 @item @code{x11-forwarding?} (default: @code{#f})
14073 When true, forwarding of X11 graphical client connections is
14074 enabled---in other words, @command{ssh} options @option{-X} and
14075 @option{-Y} will work.
14076
14077 @item @code{allow-agent-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
14078 Whether to allow agent forwarding.
14079
14080 @item @code{allow-tcp-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
14081 Whether to allow TCP forwarding.
14082
14083 @item @code{gateway-ports?} (default: @code{#f})
14084 Whether to allow gateway ports.
14085
14086 @item @code{challenge-response-authentication?} (default: @code{#f})
14087 Specifies whether challenge response authentication is allowed (e.g.@: via
14088 PAM).
14089
14090 @item @code{use-pam?} (default: @code{#t})
14091 Enables the Pluggable Authentication Module interface. If set to
14092 @code{#t}, this will enable PAM authentication using
14093 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} and
14094 @code{password-authentication?}, in addition to PAM account and session
14095 module processing for all authentication types.
14096
14097 Because PAM challenge response authentication usually serves an
14098 equivalent role to password authentication, you should disable either
14099 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} or
14100 @code{password-authentication?}.
14101
14102 @item @code{print-last-log?} (default: @code{#t})
14103 Specifies whether @command{sshd} should print the date and time of the
14104 last user login when a user logs in interactively.
14105
14106 @item @code{subsystems} (default: @code{'(("sftp" "internal-sftp"))})
14107 Configures external subsystems (e.g.@: file transfer daemon).
14108
14109 This is a list of two-element lists, each of which containing the
14110 subsystem name and a command (with optional arguments) to execute upon
14111 subsystem request.
14112
14113 The command @command{internal-sftp} implements an in-process SFTP
14114 server. Alternately, one can specify the @command{sftp-server} command:
14115 @lisp
14116 (service openssh-service-type
14117 (openssh-configuration
14118 (subsystems
14119 `(("sftp" ,(file-append openssh "/libexec/sftp-server"))))))
14120 @end lisp
14121
14122 @item @code{accepted-environment} (default: @code{'()})
14123 List of strings describing which environment variables may be exported.
14124
14125 Each string gets on its own line. See the @code{AcceptEnv} option in
14126 @code{man sshd_config}.
14127
14128 This example allows ssh-clients to export the @code{COLORTERM} variable.
14129 It is set by terminal emulators, which support colors. You can use it in
14130 your shell's resource file to enable colors for the prompt and commands
14131 if this variable is set.
14132
14133 @lisp
14134 (service openssh-service-type
14135 (openssh-configuration
14136 (accepted-environment '("COLORTERM"))))
14137 @end lisp
14138
14139 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{'()})
14140 @cindex authorized keys, SSH
14141 @cindex SSH authorized keys
14142 This is the list of authorized keys. Each element of the list is a user
14143 name followed by one or more file-like objects that represent SSH public
14144 keys. For example:
14145
14146 @lisp
14147 (openssh-configuration
14148 (authorized-keys
14149 `(("rekado" ,(local-file "rekado.pub"))
14150 ("chris" ,(local-file "chris.pub"))
14151 ("root" ,(local-file "rekado.pub") ,(local-file "chris.pub")))))
14152 @end lisp
14153
14154 @noindent
14155 registers the specified public keys for user accounts @code{rekado},
14156 @code{chris}, and @code{root}.
14157
14158 Additional authorized keys can be specified @i{via}
14159 @code{service-extension}.
14160
14161 Note that this does @emph{not} interfere with the use of
14162 @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
14163
14164 @item @code{log-level} (default: @code{'info})
14165 This is a symbol specifying the logging level: @code{quiet}, @code{fatal},
14166 @code{error}, @code{info}, @code{verbose}, @code{debug}, etc. See the man
14167 page for @file{sshd_config} for the full list of level names.
14168
14169 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
14170 This field can be used to append arbitrary text to the configuration file. It
14171 is especially useful for elaborate configurations that cannot be expressed
14172 otherwise. This configuration, for example, would generally disable root
14173 logins, but permit them from one specific IP address:
14174
14175 @lisp
14176 (openssh-configuration
14177 (extra-content "\
14178 Match Address 192.168.0.1
14179 PermitRootLogin yes"))
14180 @end lisp
14181
14182 @end table
14183 @end deftp
14184
14185 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dropbear-service [@var{config}]
14186 Run the @uref{https://matt.ucc.asn.au/dropbear/dropbear.html,Dropbear SSH
14187 daemon} with the given @var{config}, a @code{<dropbear-configuration>}
14188 object.
14189
14190 For example, to specify a Dropbear service listening on port 1234, add
14191 this call to the operating system's @code{services} field:
14192
14193 @lisp
14194 (dropbear-service (dropbear-configuration
14195 (port-number 1234)))
14196 @end lisp
14197 @end deffn
14198
14199 @deftp {Data Type} dropbear-configuration
14200 This data type represents the configuration of a Dropbear SSH daemon.
14201
14202 @table @asis
14203 @item @code{dropbear} (default: @var{dropbear})
14204 The Dropbear package to use.
14205
14206 @item @code{port-number} (default: 22)
14207 The TCP port where the daemon waits for incoming connections.
14208
14209 @item @code{syslog-output?} (default: @code{#t})
14210 Whether to enable syslog output.
14211
14212 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/dropbear.pid"})
14213 File name of the daemon's PID file.
14214
14215 @item @code{root-login?} (default: @code{#f})
14216 Whether to allow @code{root} logins.
14217
14218 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
14219 Whether to allow empty passwords.
14220
14221 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
14222 Whether to enable password-based authentication.
14223 @end table
14224 @end deftp
14225
14226 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %facebook-host-aliases
14227 This variable contains a string for use in @file{/etc/hosts}
14228 (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). Each
14229 line contains a entry that maps a known server name of the Facebook
14230 on-line service---e.g., @code{www.facebook.com}---to the local
14231 host---@code{127.0.0.1} or its IPv6 equivalent, @code{::1}.
14232
14233 This variable is typically used in the @code{hosts-file} field of an
14234 @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
14235 @file{/etc/hosts}}):
14236
14237 @lisp
14238 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
14239
14240 (operating-system
14241 (host-name "mymachine")
14242 ;; ...
14243 (hosts-file
14244 ;; Create a /etc/hosts file with aliases for "localhost"
14245 ;; and "mymachine", as well as for Facebook servers.
14246 (plain-file "hosts"
14247 (string-append (local-host-aliases host-name)
14248 %facebook-host-aliases))))
14249 @end lisp
14250
14251 This mechanism can prevent programs running locally, such as Web
14252 browsers, from accessing Facebook.
14253 @end defvr
14254
14255 The @code{(gnu services avahi)} provides the following definition.
14256
14257 @defvr {Scheme Variable} avahi-service-type
14258 This is the service that runs @command{avahi-daemon}, a system-wide
14259 mDNS/DNS-SD responder that allows for service discovery and
14260 ``zero-configuration'' host name lookups (see @uref{https://avahi.org/}).
14261 Its value must be a @code{zero-configuration} record---see below.
14262
14263 This service extends the name service cache daemon (nscd) so that it can
14264 resolve @code{.local} host names using
14265 @uref{https://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, nss-mdns}. @xref{Name
14266 Service Switch}, for information on host name resolution.
14267
14268 Additionally, add the @var{avahi} package to the system profile so that
14269 commands such as @command{avahi-browse} are directly usable.
14270 @end defvr
14271
14272 @deftp {Data Type} avahi-configuration
14273 Data type representation the configuration for Avahi.
14274
14275 @table @asis
14276
14277 @item @code{host-name} (default: @code{#f})
14278 If different from @code{#f}, use that as the host name to
14279 publish for this machine; otherwise, use the machine's actual host name.
14280
14281 @item @code{publish?} (default: @code{#t})
14282 When true, allow host names and services to be published (broadcast) over the
14283 network.
14284
14285 @item @code{publish-workstation?} (default: @code{#t})
14286 When true, @command{avahi-daemon} publishes the machine's host name and IP
14287 address via mDNS on the local network. To view the host names published on
14288 your local network, you can run:
14289
14290 @example
14291 avahi-browse _workstation._tcp
14292 @end example
14293
14294 @item @code{wide-area?} (default: @code{#f})
14295 When true, DNS-SD over unicast DNS is enabled.
14296
14297 @item @code{ipv4?} (default: @code{#t})
14298 @itemx @code{ipv6?} (default: @code{#t})
14299 These fields determine whether to use IPv4/IPv6 sockets.
14300
14301 @item @code{domains-to-browse} (default: @code{'()})
14302 This is a list of domains to browse.
14303 @end table
14304 @end deftp
14305
14306 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openvswitch-service-type
14307 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.openvswitch.org, Open vSwitch}
14308 service, whose value should be an @code{openvswitch-configuration}
14309 object.
14310 @end deffn
14311
14312 @deftp {Data Type} openvswitch-configuration
14313 Data type representing the configuration of Open vSwitch, a multilayer
14314 virtual switch which is designed to enable massive network automation
14315 through programmatic extension.
14316
14317 @table @asis
14318 @item @code{package} (default: @var{openvswitch})
14319 Package object of the Open vSwitch.
14320
14321 @end table
14322 @end deftp
14323
14324 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pagekite-service-type
14325 This is the service type for the @uref{https://pagekite.net, PageKite} service,
14326 a tunneling solution for making localhost servers publicly visible, even from
14327 behind restrictive firewalls or NAT without forwarded ports. The value for
14328 this service type is a @code{pagekite-configuration} record.
14329
14330 Here's an example exposing the local HTTP and SSH daemons:
14331
14332 @lisp
14333 (service pagekite-service-type
14334 (pagekite-configuration
14335 (kites '("http:@@kitename:localhost:80:@@kitesecret"
14336 "raw/22:@@kitename:localhost:22:@@kitesecret"))
14337 (extra-file "/etc/pagekite.rc")))
14338 @end lisp
14339 @end defvr
14340
14341 @deftp {Data Type} pagekite-configuration
14342 Data type representing the configuration of PageKite.
14343
14344 @table @asis
14345 @item @code{package} (default: @var{pagekite})
14346 Package object of PageKite.
14347
14348 @item @code{kitename} (default: @code{#f})
14349 PageKite name for authenticating to the frontend server.
14350
14351 @item @code{kitesecret} (default: @code{#f})
14352 Shared secret for authenticating to the frontend server. You should probably
14353 put this inside @code{extra-file} instead.
14354
14355 @item @code{frontend} (default: @code{#f})
14356 Connect to the named PageKite frontend server instead of the
14357 @uref{https://pagekite.net,,pagekite.net} service.
14358
14359 @item @code{kites} (default: @code{'("http:@@kitename:localhost:80:@@kitesecret")})
14360 List of service kites to use. Exposes HTTP on port 80 by default. The format
14361 is @code{proto:kitename:host:port:secret}.
14362
14363 @item @code{extra-file} (default: @code{#f})
14364 Extra configuration file to read, which you are expected to create manually.
14365 Use this to add additional options and manage shared secrets out-of-band.
14366
14367 @end table
14368 @end deftp
14369
14370 @node X Window
14371 @subsection X Window
14372
14373 @cindex X11
14374 @cindex X Window System
14375 @cindex login manager
14376 Support for the X Window graphical display system---specifically
14377 Xorg---is provided by the @code{(gnu services xorg)} module. Note that
14378 there is no @code{xorg-service} procedure. Instead, the X server is
14379 started by the @dfn{login manager}, by default the GNOME Display Manager (GDM).
14380
14381 @cindex GDM
14382 @cindex GNOME, login manager
14383 GDM of course allows users to log in into window managers and desktop
14384 environments other than GNOME; for those using GNOME, GDM is required for
14385 features such as automatic screen locking.
14386
14387 @cindex window manager
14388 To use X11, you must install at least one @dfn{window manager}---for
14389 example the @code{windowmaker} or @code{openbox} packages---preferably
14390 by adding it to the @code{packages} field of your operating system
14391 definition (@pxref{operating-system Reference, system-wide packages}).
14392
14393 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gdm-service-type
14394 This is the type for the @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/GDM/, GNOME
14395 Desktop Manager} (GDM), a program that manages graphical display servers and
14396 handles graphical user logins. Its value must be a @code{gdm-configuration}
14397 (see below.)
14398
14399 @cindex session types (X11)
14400 @cindex X11 session types
14401 GDM looks for @dfn{session types} described by the @file{.desktop} files in
14402 @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions} and allows users to choose
14403 a session from the log-in screen. Packages such as @code{gnome}, @code{xfce},
14404 and @code{i3} provide @file{.desktop} files; adding them to the system-wide
14405 set of packages automatically makes them available at the log-in screen.
14406
14407 In addition, @file{~/.xsession} files are honored. When available,
14408 @file{~/.xsession} must be an executable that starts a window manager
14409 and/or other X clients.
14410 @end defvr
14411
14412 @deftp {Data Type} gdm-configuration
14413 @table @asis
14414 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
14415 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{#f})
14416 When @code{auto-login?} is false, GDM presents a log-in screen.
14417
14418 When @code{auto-login?} is true, GDM logs in directly as
14419 @code{default-user}.
14420
14421 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
14422 When true, GDM writes debug messages to its log.
14423
14424 @item @code{gnome-shell-assets} (default: ...)
14425 List of GNOME Shell assets needed by GDM: icon theme, fonts, etc.
14426
14427 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default: @code{(xorg-configuration)})
14428 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
14429
14430 @item @code{xsession} (default: @code{(xinitrc)})
14431 Script to run before starting a X session.
14432
14433 @item @code{dbus-daemon} (default: @code{dbus-daemon-wrapper})
14434 File name of the @code{dbus-daemon} executable.
14435
14436 @item @code{gdm} (default: @code{gdm})
14437 The GDM package to use.
14438 @end table
14439 @end deftp
14440
14441 @defvr {Scheme Variable} slim-service-type
14442 This is the type for the SLiM graphical login manager for X11.
14443
14444 Like GDM, SLiM looks for session types described by @file{.desktop} files and
14445 allows users to choose a session from the log-in screen using @kbd{F1}. It
14446 also honors @file{~/.xsession} files.
14447
14448 Unlike GDM, SLiM does not spawn the user session on a different VT after
14449 logging in, which means that you can only start one graphical session. If you
14450 want to be able to run multiple graphical sessions at the same time you have
14451 to add multiple SLiM services to your system services. The following example
14452 shows how to replace the default GDM service with two SLiM services on tty7
14453 and tty8.
14454
14455 @lisp
14456 (use-modules (gnu services)
14457 (gnu services desktop)
14458 (gnu services xorg)
14459 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'remove'
14460
14461 (operating-system
14462 ;; ...
14463 (services (cons* (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
14464 (display ":0")
14465 (vt "vt7")))
14466 (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
14467 (display ":1")
14468 (vt "vt8")))
14469 (remove (lambda (service)
14470 (eq? (service-kind service) gdm-service-type))
14471 %desktop-services))))
14472 @end lisp
14473
14474 @end defvr
14475
14476 @deftp {Data Type} slim-configuration
14477 Data type representing the configuration of @code{slim-service-type}.
14478
14479 @table @asis
14480 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
14481 Whether to allow logins with empty passwords.
14482
14483 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
14484 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{""})
14485 When @code{auto-login?} is false, SLiM presents a log-in screen.
14486
14487 When @code{auto-login?} is true, SLiM logs in directly as
14488 @code{default-user}.
14489
14490 @item @code{theme} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme})
14491 @itemx @code{theme-name} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme-name})
14492 The graphical theme to use and its name.
14493
14494 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default: @code{#f})
14495 If true, this must be the name of the executable to start as the default
14496 session---e.g., @code{(file-append windowmaker "/bin/windowmaker")}.
14497
14498 If false, a session described by one of the available @file{.desktop}
14499 files in @code{/run/current-system/profile} and @code{~/.guix-profile}
14500 will be used.
14501
14502 @quotation Note
14503 You must install at least one window manager in the system profile or in
14504 your user profile. Failing to do that, if @code{auto-login-session} is
14505 false, you will be unable to log in.
14506 @end quotation
14507
14508 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
14509 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
14510
14511 @item @code{display} (default @code{":0"})
14512 The display on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
14513
14514 @item @code{vt} (default @code{"vt7"})
14515 The VT on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
14516
14517 @item @code{xauth} (default: @code{xauth})
14518 The XAuth package to use.
14519
14520 @item @code{shepherd} (default: @code{shepherd})
14521 The Shepherd package used when invoking @command{halt} and
14522 @command{reboot}.
14523
14524 @item @code{sessreg} (default: @code{sessreg})
14525 The sessreg package used in order to register the session.
14526
14527 @item @code{slim} (default: @code{slim})
14528 The SLiM package to use.
14529 @end table
14530 @end deftp
14531
14532 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
14533 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} %default-theme-name
14534 The default SLiM theme and its name.
14535 @end defvr
14536
14537
14538 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
14539 This is the data type representing the sddm service configuration.
14540
14541 @table @asis
14542 @item @code{display-server} (default: "x11")
14543 Select display server to use for the greeter. Valid values are "x11"
14544 or "wayland".
14545
14546 @item @code{numlock} (default: "on")
14547 Valid values are "on", "off" or "none".
14548
14549 @item @code{halt-command} (default @code{#~(string-apppend #$shepherd "/sbin/halt")})
14550 Command to run when halting.
14551
14552 @item @code{reboot-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shepherd "/sbin/reboot")})
14553 Command to run when rebooting.
14554
14555 @item @code{theme} (default "maldives")
14556 Theme to use. Default themes provided by SDDM are "elarun", "maldives" or "maya".
14557
14558 @item @code{themes-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/themes")
14559 Directory to look for themes.
14560
14561 @item @code{faces-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/faces")
14562 Directory to look for faces.
14563
14564 @item @code{default-path} (default "/run/current-system/profile/bin")
14565 Default PATH to use.
14566
14567 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: 1000)
14568 Minimum UID displayed in SDDM and allowed for log-in.
14569
14570 @item @code{maximum-uid} (default: 2000)
14571 Maximum UID to display in SDDM.
14572
14573 @item @code{remember-last-user?} (default #t)
14574 Remember last user.
14575
14576 @item @code{remember-last-session?} (default #t)
14577 Remember last session.
14578
14579 @item @code{hide-users} (default "")
14580 Usernames to hide from SDDM greeter.
14581
14582 @item @code{hide-shells} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/sbin/nologin")})
14583 Users with shells listed will be hidden from the SDDM greeter.
14584
14585 @item @code{session-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/wayland-session")})
14586 Script to run before starting a wayland session.
14587
14588 @item @code{sessions-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/wayland-sessions")
14589 Directory to look for desktop files starting wayland sessions.
14590
14591 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
14592 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
14593
14594 @item @code{xauth-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xauth "/bin/xauth")})
14595 Path to xauth.
14596
14597 @item @code{xephyr-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xorg-server "/bin/Xephyr")})
14598 Path to Xephyr.
14599
14600 @item @code{xdisplay-start} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xsetup")})
14601 Script to run after starting xorg-server.
14602
14603 @item @code{xdisplay-stop} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xstop")})
14604 Script to run before stopping xorg-server.
14605
14606 @item @code{xsession-command} (default: @code{xinitrc})
14607 Script to run before starting a X session.
14608
14609 @item @code{xsessions-directory} (default: "/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions")
14610 Directory to look for desktop files starting X sessions.
14611
14612 @item @code{minimum-vt} (default: 7)
14613 Minimum VT to use.
14614
14615 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default "")
14616 User to use for auto-login.
14617
14618 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default "")
14619 Desktop file to use for auto-login.
14620
14621 @item @code{relogin?} (default #f)
14622 Relogin after logout.
14623
14624 @end table
14625 @end deftp
14626
14627 @cindex login manager
14628 @cindex X11 login
14629 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sddm-service-type
14630 This is the type of the service to run the
14631 @uref{https://github.com/sddm/sddm,SDDM display manager}. Its value
14632 must be a @code{sddm-configuration} record (see below).
14633
14634 Here's an example use:
14635
14636 @lisp
14637 (service sddm-service-type
14638 (sddm-configuration
14639 (auto-login-user "alice")
14640 (auto-login-session "xfce.desktop")))
14641 @end lisp
14642 @end defvr
14643
14644 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
14645 This data type represents the configuration of the SDDM login manager.
14646 The available fields are:
14647
14648 @table @asis
14649 @item @code{sddm} (default: @code{sddm})
14650 The SDDM package to use.
14651
14652 @item @code{display-server} (default: @code{"x11"})
14653 This must be either @code{"x11"} or @code{"wayland"}.
14654
14655 @c FIXME: Add more fields.
14656
14657 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default: @code{""})
14658 If non-empty, this is the user account under which to log in
14659 automatically.
14660
14661 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default: @code{""})
14662 If non-empty, this is the @file{.desktop} file name to use as the
14663 auto-login session.
14664 @end table
14665 @end deftp
14666
14667 @cindex Xorg, configuration
14668 @deftp {Data Type} xorg-configuration
14669 This data type represents the configuration of the Xorg graphical display
14670 server. Note that there is not Xorg service; instead, the X server is started
14671 by a ``display manager'' such as GDM, SDDM, and SLiM. Thus, the configuration
14672 of these display managers aggregates an @code{xorg-configuration} record.
14673
14674 @table @asis
14675 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-xorg-modules})
14676 This is a list of @dfn{module packages} loaded by the Xorg
14677 server---e.g., @code{xf86-video-vesa}, @code{xf86-input-keyboard}, and so on.
14678
14679 @item @code{fonts} (default: @code{%default-xorg-fonts})
14680 This is a list of font directories to add to the server's @dfn{font path}.
14681
14682 @item @code{drivers} (default: @code{'()})
14683 This must be either the empty list, in which case Xorg chooses a graphics
14684 driver automatically, or a list of driver names that will be tried in this
14685 order---e.g., @code{("modesetting" "vesa")}.
14686
14687 @item @code{resolutions} (default: @code{'()})
14688 When @code{resolutions} is the empty list, Xorg chooses an appropriate screen
14689 resolution. Otherwise, it must be a list of resolutions---e.g., @code{((1024
14690 768) (640 480))}.
14691
14692 @cindex keyboard layout, for Xorg
14693 @cindex keymap, for Xorg
14694 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
14695 If this is @code{#f}, Xorg uses the default keyboard layout---usually US
14696 English (``qwerty'') for a 105-key PC keyboard.
14697
14698 Otherwise this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object specifying the keyboard
14699 layout in use when Xorg is running. @xref{Keyboard Layout}, for more
14700 information on how to specify the keyboard layout.
14701
14702 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
14703 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the configuration file. It
14704 is used to pass extra text to be added verbatim to the configuration file.
14705
14706 @item @code{server} (default: @code{xorg-server})
14707 This is the package providing the Xorg server.
14708
14709 @item @code{server-arguments} (default: @code{%default-xorg-server-arguments})
14710 This is the list of command-line arguments to pass to the X server. The
14711 default is @code{-nolisten tcp}.
14712 @end table
14713 @end deftp
14714
14715 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} set-xorg-configuration @var{config} @
14716 [@var{login-manager-service-type}]
14717 Tell the log-in manager (of type @var{login-manager-service-type}) to use
14718 @var{config}, an @code{<xorg-configuration>} record.
14719
14720 Since the Xorg configuration is embedded in the log-in manager's
14721 configuration---e.g., @code{gdm-configuration}---this procedure provides a
14722 shorthand to set the Xorg configuration.
14723 @end deffn
14724
14725 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-start-command [@var{config}]
14726 Return a @code{startx} script in which the modules, fonts, etc. specified
14727 in @var{config}, are available. The result should be used in place of
14728 @code{startx}.
14729
14730 Usually the X server is started by a login manager.
14731 @end deffn
14732
14733
14734 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} screen-locker-service @var{package} [@var{program}]
14735 Add @var{package}, a package for a screen locker or screen saver whose
14736 command is @var{program}, to the set of setuid programs and add a PAM entry
14737 for it. For example:
14738
14739 @lisp
14740 (screen-locker-service xlockmore "xlock")
14741 @end lisp
14742
14743 makes the good ol' XlockMore usable.
14744 @end deffn
14745
14746
14747 @node Printing Services
14748 @subsection Printing Services
14749
14750 @cindex printer support with CUPS
14751 The @code{(gnu services cups)} module provides a Guix service definition
14752 for the CUPS printing service. To add printer support to a Guix
14753 system, add a @code{cups-service} to the operating system definition:
14754
14755 @deffn {Scheme Variable} cups-service-type
14756 The service type for the CUPS print server. Its value should be a valid
14757 CUPS configuration (see below). To use the default settings, simply
14758 write:
14759 @lisp
14760 (service cups-service-type)
14761 @end lisp
14762 @end deffn
14763
14764 The CUPS configuration controls the basic things about your CUPS
14765 installation: what interfaces it listens on, what to do if a print job
14766 fails, how much logging to do, and so on. To actually add a printer,
14767 you have to visit the @url{http://localhost:631} URL, or use a tool such
14768 as GNOME's printer configuration services. By default, configuring a
14769 CUPS service will generate a self-signed certificate if needed, for
14770 secure connections to the print server.
14771
14772 Suppose you want to enable the Web interface of CUPS and also add
14773 support for Epson printers @i{via} the @code{escpr} package and for HP
14774 printers @i{via} the @code{hplip-minimal} package. You can do that directly,
14775 like this (you need to use the @code{(gnu packages cups)} module):
14776
14777 @lisp
14778 (service cups-service-type
14779 (cups-configuration
14780 (web-interface? #t)
14781 (extensions
14782 (list cups-filters escpr hplip-minimal))))
14783 @end lisp
14784
14785 Note: If you wish to use the Qt5 based GUI which comes with the hplip
14786 package then it is suggested that you install the @code{hplip} package,
14787 either in your OS configuration file or as your user.
14788
14789 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
14790 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
14791 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
14792 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
14793 if you have an old @code{cupsd.conf} file that you want to port over
14794 from some other system; see the end for more details.
14795
14796 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
14797 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services cups). Manually maintained
14798 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
14799 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
14800 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
14801 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
14802 @c the churn as CUPS updates.
14803
14804
14805 Available @code{cups-configuration} fields are:
14806
14807 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
14808 The CUPS package.
14809 @end deftypevr
14810
14811 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package-list extensions
14812 Drivers and other extensions to the CUPS package.
14813 @end deftypevr
14814
14815 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} files-configuration files-configuration
14816 Configuration of where to write logs, what directories to use for print
14817 spools, and related privileged configuration parameters.
14818
14819 Available @code{files-configuration} fields are:
14820
14821 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location access-log
14822 Defines the access log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
14823 access log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
14824 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
14825 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
14826 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
14827 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
14828 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-access_log}.
14829
14830 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/access_log"}.
14831 @end deftypevr
14832
14833 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name cache-dir
14834 Where CUPS should cache data.
14835
14836 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cups"}.
14837 @end deftypevr
14838
14839 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string config-file-perm
14840 Specifies the permissions for all configuration files that the scheduler
14841 writes.
14842
14843 Note that the permissions for the printers.conf file are currently
14844 masked to only allow access from the scheduler user (typically root).
14845 This is done because printer device URIs sometimes contain sensitive
14846 authentication information that should not be generally known on the
14847 system. There is no way to disable this security feature.
14848
14849 Defaults to @samp{"0640"}.
14850 @end deftypevr
14851
14852 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location error-log
14853 Defines the error log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
14854 error log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
14855 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
14856 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
14857 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
14858 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
14859 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-error_log}.
14860
14861 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/error_log"}.
14862 @end deftypevr
14863
14864 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string fatal-errors
14865 Specifies which errors are fatal, causing the scheduler to exit. The
14866 kind strings are:
14867
14868 @table @code
14869 @item none
14870 No errors are fatal.
14871
14872 @item all
14873 All of the errors below are fatal.
14874
14875 @item browse
14876 Browsing initialization errors are fatal, for example failed connections
14877 to the DNS-SD daemon.
14878
14879 @item config
14880 Configuration file syntax errors are fatal.
14881
14882 @item listen
14883 Listen or Port errors are fatal, except for IPv6 failures on the
14884 loopback or @code{any} addresses.
14885
14886 @item log
14887 Log file creation or write errors are fatal.
14888
14889 @item permissions
14890 Bad startup file permissions are fatal, for example shared TLS
14891 certificate and key files with world-read permissions.
14892 @end table
14893
14894 Defaults to @samp{"all -browse"}.
14895 @end deftypevr
14896
14897 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean file-device?
14898 Specifies whether the file pseudo-device can be used for new printer
14899 queues. The URI @uref{file:///dev/null} is always allowed.
14900
14901 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14902 @end deftypevr
14903
14904 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string group
14905 Specifies the group name or ID that will be used when executing external
14906 programs.
14907
14908 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
14909 @end deftypevr
14910
14911 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string log-file-perm
14912 Specifies the permissions for all log files that the scheduler writes.
14913
14914 Defaults to @samp{"0644"}.
14915 @end deftypevr
14916
14917 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location page-log
14918 Defines the page log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
14919 page log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
14920 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
14921 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
14922 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
14923 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
14924 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-page_log}.
14925
14926 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/page_log"}.
14927 @end deftypevr
14928
14929 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string remote-root
14930 Specifies the username that is associated with unauthenticated accesses
14931 by clients claiming to be the root user. The default is @code{remroot}.
14932
14933 Defaults to @samp{"remroot"}.
14934 @end deftypevr
14935
14936 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name request-root
14937 Specifies the directory that contains print jobs and other HTTP request
14938 data.
14939
14940 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups"}.
14941 @end deftypevr
14942
14943 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} sandboxing sandboxing
14944 Specifies the level of security sandboxing that is applied to print
14945 filters, backends, and other child processes of the scheduler; either
14946 @code{relaxed} or @code{strict}. This directive is currently only
14947 used/supported on macOS.
14948
14949 Defaults to @samp{strict}.
14950 @end deftypevr
14951
14952 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-keychain
14953 Specifies the location of TLS certificates and private keys. CUPS will
14954 look for public and private keys in this directory: a @code{.crt} files
14955 for PEM-encoded certificates and corresponding @code{.key} files for
14956 PEM-encoded private keys.
14957
14958 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups/ssl"}.
14959 @end deftypevr
14960
14961 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-root
14962 Specifies the directory containing the server configuration files.
14963
14964 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups"}.
14965 @end deftypevr
14966
14967 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean sync-on-close?
14968 Specifies whether the scheduler calls fsync(2) after writing
14969 configuration or state files.
14970
14971 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14972 @end deftypevr
14973
14974 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list system-group
14975 Specifies the group(s) to use for @code{@@SYSTEM} group authentication.
14976 @end deftypevr
14977
14978 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name temp-dir
14979 Specifies the directory where temporary files are stored.
14980
14981 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups/tmp"}.
14982 @end deftypevr
14983
14984 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string user
14985 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running external
14986 programs.
14987
14988 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
14989 @end deftypevr
14990
14991 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string set-env
14992 Set the specified environment variable to be passed to child processes.
14993
14994 Defaults to @samp{"variable value"}.
14995 @end deftypevr
14996 @end deftypevr
14997
14998 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} access-log-level access-log-level
14999 Specifies the logging level for the AccessLog file. The @code{config}
15000 level logs when printers and classes are added, deleted, or modified and
15001 when configuration files are accessed or updated. The @code{actions}
15002 level logs when print jobs are submitted, held, released, modified, or
15003 canceled, and any of the conditions for @code{config}. The @code{all}
15004 level logs all requests.
15005
15006 Defaults to @samp{actions}.
15007 @end deftypevr
15008
15009 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean auto-purge-jobs?
15010 Specifies whether to purge job history data automatically when it is no
15011 longer required for quotas.
15012
15013 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15014 @end deftypevr
15015
15016 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list browse-dns-sd-sub-types
15017 Specifies a list of DNS-SD sub-types to advertise for each shared printer.
15018 For example, @samp{"_cups" "_print"} will tell network clients that both
15019 CUPS sharing and IPP Everywhere are supported.
15020
15021 Defaults to @samp{"_cups"}.
15022 @end deftypevr
15023
15024 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} browse-local-protocols browse-local-protocols
15025 Specifies which protocols to use for local printer sharing.
15026
15027 Defaults to @samp{dnssd}.
15028 @end deftypevr
15029
15030 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browse-web-if?
15031 Specifies whether the CUPS web interface is advertised.
15032
15033 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15034 @end deftypevr
15035
15036 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browsing?
15037 Specifies whether shared printers are advertised.
15038
15039 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15040 @end deftypevr
15041
15042 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string classification
15043 Specifies the security classification of the server. Any valid banner
15044 name can be used, including "classified", "confidential", "secret",
15045 "topsecret", and "unclassified", or the banner can be omitted to disable
15046 secure printing functions.
15047
15048 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15049 @end deftypevr
15050
15051 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean classify-override?
15052 Specifies whether users may override the classification (cover page) of
15053 individual print jobs using the @code{job-sheets} option.
15054
15055 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15056 @end deftypevr
15057
15058 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-auth-type default-auth-type
15059 Specifies the default type of authentication to use.
15060
15061 Defaults to @samp{Basic}.
15062 @end deftypevr
15063
15064 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-encryption default-encryption
15065 Specifies whether encryption will be used for authenticated requests.
15066
15067 Defaults to @samp{Required}.
15068 @end deftypevr
15069
15070 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-language
15071 Specifies the default language to use for text and web content.
15072
15073 Defaults to @samp{"en"}.
15074 @end deftypevr
15075
15076 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-paper-size
15077 Specifies the default paper size for new print queues. @samp{"Auto"}
15078 uses a locale-specific default, while @samp{"None"} specifies there is
15079 no default paper size. Specific size names are typically
15080 @samp{"Letter"} or @samp{"A4"}.
15081
15082 Defaults to @samp{"Auto"}.
15083 @end deftypevr
15084
15085 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-policy
15086 Specifies the default access policy to use.
15087
15088 Defaults to @samp{"default"}.
15089 @end deftypevr
15090
15091 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean default-shared?
15092 Specifies whether local printers are shared by default.
15093
15094 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15095 @end deftypevr
15096
15097 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer dirty-clean-interval
15098 Specifies the delay for updating of configuration and state files, in
15099 seconds. A value of 0 causes the update to happen as soon as possible,
15100 typically within a few milliseconds.
15101
15102 Defaults to @samp{30}.
15103 @end deftypevr
15104
15105 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} error-policy error-policy
15106 Specifies what to do when an error occurs. Possible values are
15107 @code{abort-job}, which will discard the failed print job;
15108 @code{retry-job}, which will retry the job at a later time;
15109 @code{retry-current-job}, which retries the failed job immediately; and
15110 @code{stop-printer}, which stops the printer.
15111
15112 Defaults to @samp{stop-printer}.
15113 @end deftypevr
15114
15115 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-limit
15116 Specifies the maximum cost of filters that are run concurrently, which
15117 can be used to minimize disk, memory, and CPU resource problems. A
15118 limit of 0 disables filter limiting. An average print to a
15119 non-PostScript printer needs a filter limit of about 200. A PostScript
15120 printer needs about half that (100). Setting the limit below these
15121 thresholds will effectively limit the scheduler to printing a single job
15122 at any time.
15123
15124 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15125 @end deftypevr
15126
15127 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-nice
15128 Specifies the scheduling priority of filters that are run to print a
15129 job. The nice value ranges from 0, the highest priority, to 19, the
15130 lowest priority.
15131
15132 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15133 @end deftypevr
15134
15135 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-lookups host-name-lookups
15136 Specifies whether to do reverse lookups on connecting clients. The
15137 @code{double} setting causes @code{cupsd} to verify that the hostname
15138 resolved from the address matches one of the addresses returned for that
15139 hostname. Double lookups also prevent clients with unregistered
15140 addresses from connecting to your server. Only set this option to
15141 @code{#t} or @code{double} if absolutely required.
15142
15143 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15144 @end deftypevr
15145
15146 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-kill-delay
15147 Specifies the number of seconds to wait before killing the filters and
15148 backend associated with a canceled or held job.
15149
15150 Defaults to @samp{30}.
15151 @end deftypevr
15152
15153 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-interval
15154 Specifies the interval between retries of jobs in seconds. This is
15155 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
15156 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
15157 @code{retry-current-job}.
15158
15159 Defaults to @samp{30}.
15160 @end deftypevr
15161
15162 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-limit
15163 Specifies the number of retries that are done for jobs. This is
15164 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
15165 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
15166 @code{retry-current-job}.
15167
15168 Defaults to @samp{5}.
15169 @end deftypevr
15170
15171 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean keep-alive?
15172 Specifies whether to support HTTP keep-alive connections.
15173
15174 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15175 @end deftypevr
15176
15177 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer keep-alive-timeout
15178 Specifies how long an idle client connection remains open, in seconds.
15179
15180 Defaults to @samp{30}.
15181 @end deftypevr
15182
15183 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer limit-request-body
15184 Specifies the maximum size of print files, IPP requests, and HTML form
15185 data. A limit of 0 disables the limit check.
15186
15187 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15188 @end deftypevr
15189
15190 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list listen
15191 Listens on the specified interfaces for connections. Valid values are
15192 of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is either an
15193 IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or @code{*} to
15194 indicate all addresses. Values can also be file names of local UNIX
15195 domain sockets. The Listen directive is similar to the Port directive
15196 but allows you to restrict access to specific interfaces or networks.
15197 @end deftypevr
15198
15199 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer listen-back-log
15200 Specifies the number of pending connections that will be allowed. This
15201 normally only affects very busy servers that have reached the MaxClients
15202 limit, but can also be triggered by large numbers of simultaneous
15203 connections. When the limit is reached, the operating system will
15204 refuse additional connections until the scheduler can accept the pending
15205 ones.
15206
15207 Defaults to @samp{128}.
15208 @end deftypevr
15209
15210 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} location-access-control-list location-access-controls
15211 Specifies a set of additional access controls.
15212
15213 Available @code{location-access-controls} fields are:
15214
15215 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} file-name path
15216 Specifies the URI path to which the access control applies.
15217 @end deftypevr
15218
15219 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
15220 Access controls for all access to this path, in the same format as the
15221 @code{access-controls} of @code{operation-access-control}.
15222
15223 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15224 @end deftypevr
15225
15226 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} method-access-control-list method-access-controls
15227 Access controls for method-specific access to this path.
15228
15229 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15230
15231 Available @code{method-access-controls} fields are:
15232
15233 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} boolean reverse?
15234 If @code{#t}, apply access controls to all methods except the listed
15235 methods. Otherwise apply to only the listed methods.
15236
15237 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15238 @end deftypevr
15239
15240 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} method-list methods
15241 Methods to which this access control applies.
15242
15243 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15244 @end deftypevr
15245
15246 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
15247 Access control directives, as a list of strings. Each string should be
15248 one directive, such as "Order allow,deny".
15249
15250 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15251 @end deftypevr
15252 @end deftypevr
15253 @end deftypevr
15254
15255 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer log-debug-history
15256 Specifies the number of debugging messages that are retained for logging
15257 if an error occurs in a print job. Debug messages are logged regardless
15258 of the LogLevel setting.
15259
15260 Defaults to @samp{100}.
15261 @end deftypevr
15262
15263 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-level log-level
15264 Specifies the level of logging for the ErrorLog file. The value
15265 @code{none} stops all logging while @code{debug2} logs everything.
15266
15267 Defaults to @samp{info}.
15268 @end deftypevr
15269
15270 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-time-format log-time-format
15271 Specifies the format of the date and time in the log files. The value
15272 @code{standard} logs whole seconds while @code{usecs} logs microseconds.
15273
15274 Defaults to @samp{standard}.
15275 @end deftypevr
15276
15277 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients
15278 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed by
15279 the scheduler.
15280
15281 Defaults to @samp{100}.
15282 @end deftypevr
15283
15284 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients-per-host
15285 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed
15286 from a single address.
15287
15288 Defaults to @samp{100}.
15289 @end deftypevr
15290
15291 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-copies
15292 Specifies the maximum number of copies that a user can print of each
15293 job.
15294
15295 Defaults to @samp{9999}.
15296 @end deftypevr
15297
15298 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-hold-time
15299 Specifies the maximum time a job may remain in the @code{indefinite}
15300 hold state before it is canceled. A value of 0 disables cancellation of
15301 held jobs.
15302
15303 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15304 @end deftypevr
15305
15306 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs
15307 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed. Set
15308 to 0 to allow an unlimited number of jobs.
15309
15310 Defaults to @samp{500}.
15311 @end deftypevr
15312
15313 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-printer
15314 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
15315 printer. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per printer.
15316
15317 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15318 @end deftypevr
15319
15320 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-user
15321 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
15322 user. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per user.
15323
15324 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15325 @end deftypevr
15326
15327 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-job-time
15328 Specifies the maximum time a job may take to print before it is
15329 canceled, in seconds. Set to 0 to disable cancellation of "stuck" jobs.
15330
15331 Defaults to @samp{10800}.
15332 @end deftypevr
15333
15334 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-log-size
15335 Specifies the maximum size of the log files before they are rotated, in
15336 bytes. The value 0 disables log rotation.
15337
15338 Defaults to @samp{1048576}.
15339 @end deftypevr
15340
15341 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer multiple-operation-timeout
15342 Specifies the maximum amount of time to allow between files in a
15343 multiple file print job, in seconds.
15344
15345 Defaults to @samp{300}.
15346 @end deftypevr
15347
15348 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string page-log-format
15349 Specifies the format of PageLog lines. Sequences beginning with percent
15350 (@samp{%}) characters are replaced with the corresponding information,
15351 while all other characters are copied literally. The following percent
15352 sequences are recognized:
15353
15354 @table @samp
15355 @item %%
15356 insert a single percent character
15357
15358 @item %@{name@}
15359 insert the value of the specified IPP attribute
15360
15361 @item %C
15362 insert the number of copies for the current page
15363
15364 @item %P
15365 insert the current page number
15366
15367 @item %T
15368 insert the current date and time in common log format
15369
15370 @item %j
15371 insert the job ID
15372
15373 @item %p
15374 insert the printer name
15375
15376 @item %u
15377 insert the username
15378 @end table
15379
15380 A value of the empty string disables page logging. The string @code{%p
15381 %u %j %T %P %C %@{job-billing@} %@{job-originating-host-name@}
15382 %@{job-name@} %@{media@} %@{sides@}} creates a page log with the
15383 standard items.
15384
15385 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15386 @end deftypevr
15387
15388 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} environment-variables environment-variables
15389 Passes the specified environment variable(s) to child processes; a list
15390 of strings.
15391
15392 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15393 @end deftypevr
15394
15395 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} policy-configuration-list policies
15396 Specifies named access control policies.
15397
15398 Available @code{policy-configuration} fields are:
15399
15400 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string name
15401 Name of the policy.
15402 @end deftypevr
15403
15404 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-access
15405 Specifies an access list for a job's private values. @code{@@ACL} maps
15406 to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
15407 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
15408 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
15409 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
15410 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
15411 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
15412 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
15413 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
15414
15415 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
15416 @end deftypevr
15417
15418 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-values
15419 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
15420 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
15421
15422 Defaults to @samp{"job-name job-originating-host-name
15423 job-originating-user-name phone"}.
15424 @end deftypevr
15425
15426 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-access
15427 Specifies an access list for a subscription's private values.
15428 @code{@@ACL} maps to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
15429 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
15430 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
15431 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
15432 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
15433 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
15434 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
15435 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
15436
15437 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
15438 @end deftypevr
15439
15440 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-values
15441 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
15442 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
15443
15444 Defaults to @samp{"notify-events notify-pull-method notify-recipient-uri
15445 notify-subscriber-user-name notify-user-data"}.
15446 @end deftypevr
15447
15448 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} operation-access-control-list access-controls
15449 Access control by IPP operation.
15450
15451 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15452 @end deftypevr
15453 @end deftypevr
15454
15455 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-files
15456 Specifies whether job files (documents) are preserved after a job is
15457 printed. If a numeric value is specified, job files are preserved for
15458 the indicated number of seconds after printing. Otherwise a boolean
15459 value applies indefinitely.
15460
15461 Defaults to @samp{86400}.
15462 @end deftypevr
15463
15464 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-history
15465 Specifies whether the job history is preserved after a job is printed.
15466 If a numeric value is specified, the job history is preserved for the
15467 indicated number of seconds after printing. If @code{#t}, the job
15468 history is preserved until the MaxJobs limit is reached.
15469
15470 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15471 @end deftypevr
15472
15473 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer reload-timeout
15474 Specifies the amount of time to wait for job completion before
15475 restarting the scheduler.
15476
15477 Defaults to @samp{30}.
15478 @end deftypevr
15479
15480 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string rip-cache
15481 Specifies the maximum amount of memory to use when converting documents
15482 into bitmaps for a printer.
15483
15484 Defaults to @samp{"128m"}.
15485 @end deftypevr
15486
15487 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-admin
15488 Specifies the email address of the server administrator.
15489
15490 Defaults to @samp{"root@@localhost.localdomain"}.
15491 @end deftypevr
15492
15493 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-list-or-* server-alias
15494 The ServerAlias directive is used for HTTP Host header validation when
15495 clients connect to the scheduler from external interfaces. Using the
15496 special name @code{*} can expose your system to known browser-based DNS
15497 rebinding attacks, even when accessing sites through a firewall. If the
15498 auto-discovery of alternate names does not work, we recommend listing
15499 each alternate name with a ServerAlias directive instead of using
15500 @code{*}.
15501
15502 Defaults to @samp{*}.
15503 @end deftypevr
15504
15505 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-name
15506 Specifies the fully-qualified host name of the server.
15507
15508 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
15509 @end deftypevr
15510
15511 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} server-tokens server-tokens
15512 Specifies what information is included in the Server header of HTTP
15513 responses. @code{None} disables the Server header. @code{ProductOnly}
15514 reports @code{CUPS}. @code{Major} reports @code{CUPS 2}. @code{Minor}
15515 reports @code{CUPS 2.0}. @code{Minimal} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0}.
15516 @code{OS} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0 (@var{uname})} where @var{uname} is
15517 the output of the @code{uname} command. @code{Full} reports @code{CUPS
15518 2.0.0 (@var{uname}) IPP/2.0}.
15519
15520 Defaults to @samp{Minimal}.
15521 @end deftypevr
15522
15523 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list ssl-listen
15524 Listens on the specified interfaces for encrypted connections. Valid
15525 values are of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is
15526 either an IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or
15527 @code{*} to indicate all addresses.
15528
15529 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15530 @end deftypevr
15531
15532 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} ssl-options ssl-options
15533 Sets encryption options. By default, CUPS only supports encryption
15534 using TLS v1.0 or higher using known secure cipher suites. Security is
15535 reduced when @code{Allow} options are used, and enhanced when @code{Deny}
15536 options are used. The @code{AllowRC4} option enables the 128-bit RC4 cipher
15537 suites, which are required for some older clients. The @code{AllowSSL3} option
15538 enables SSL v3.0, which is required for some older clients that do not support
15539 TLS v1.0. The @code{DenyCBC} option disables all CBC cipher suites. The
15540 @code{DenyTLS1.0} option disables TLS v1.0 support - this sets the minimum
15541 protocol version to TLS v1.1.
15542
15543 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15544 @end deftypevr
15545
15546 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean strict-conformance?
15547 Specifies whether the scheduler requires clients to strictly adhere to
15548 the IPP specifications.
15549
15550 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15551 @end deftypevr
15552
15553 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer timeout
15554 Specifies the HTTP request timeout, in seconds.
15555
15556 Defaults to @samp{300}.
15557
15558 @end deftypevr
15559
15560 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean web-interface?
15561 Specifies whether the web interface is enabled.
15562
15563 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15564 @end deftypevr
15565
15566 At this point you're probably thinking ``oh dear, Guix manual, I like
15567 you but you can stop already with the configuration options''. Indeed.
15568 However, one more point: it could be that you have an existing
15569 @code{cupsd.conf} that you want to use. In that case, you can pass an
15570 @code{opaque-cups-configuration} as the configuration of a
15571 @code{cups-service-type}.
15572
15573 Available @code{opaque-cups-configuration} fields are:
15574
15575 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
15576 The CUPS package.
15577 @end deftypevr
15578
15579 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cupsd.conf
15580 The contents of the @code{cupsd.conf}, as a string.
15581 @end deftypevr
15582
15583 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cups-files.conf
15584 The contents of the @code{cups-files.conf} file, as a string.
15585 @end deftypevr
15586
15587 For example, if your @code{cupsd.conf} and @code{cups-files.conf} are in
15588 strings of the same name, you could instantiate a CUPS service like
15589 this:
15590
15591 @lisp
15592 (service cups-service-type
15593 (opaque-cups-configuration
15594 (cupsd.conf cupsd.conf)
15595 (cups-files.conf cups-files.conf)))
15596 @end lisp
15597
15598
15599 @node Desktop Services
15600 @subsection Desktop Services
15601
15602 The @code{(gnu services desktop)} module provides services that are
15603 usually useful in the context of a ``desktop'' setup---that is, on a
15604 machine running a graphical display server, possibly with graphical user
15605 interfaces, etc. It also defines services that provide specific desktop
15606 environments like GNOME, Xfce or MATE.
15607
15608 To simplify things, the module defines a variable containing the set of
15609 services that users typically expect on a machine with a graphical
15610 environment and networking:
15611
15612 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %desktop-services
15613 This is a list of services that builds upon @code{%base-services} and
15614 adds or adjusts services for a typical ``desktop'' setup.
15615
15616 In particular, it adds a graphical login manager (@pxref{X Window,
15617 @code{gdm-service-type}}), screen lockers, a network management tool
15618 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{network-manager-service-type}}) with modem
15619 support (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{modem-manager-service-type}}),
15620 energy and color management services, the @code{elogind} login and seat
15621 manager, the Polkit privilege service, the GeoClue location service, the
15622 AccountsService daemon that allows authorized users change system passwords,
15623 an NTP client (@pxref{Networking Services}), the Avahi daemon, and has the
15624 name service switch service configured to be able to use @code{nss-mdns}
15625 (@pxref{Name Service Switch, mDNS}).
15626 @end defvr
15627
15628 The @code{%desktop-services} variable can be used as the @code{services}
15629 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system
15630 Reference, @code{services}}).
15631
15632 Additionally, the @code{gnome-desktop-service-type},
15633 @code{xfce-desktop-service}, @code{mate-desktop-service-type} and
15634 @code{enlightenment-desktop-service-type} procedures can add GNOME, Xfce, MATE
15635 and/or Enlightenment to a system. To ``add GNOME'' means that system-level
15636 services like the backlight adjustment helpers and the power management
15637 utilities are added to the system, extending @code{polkit} and @code{dbus}
15638 appropriately, allowing GNOME to operate with elevated privileges on a
15639 limited number of special-purpose system interfaces. Additionally,
15640 adding a service made by @code{gnome-desktop-service-type} adds the GNOME
15641 metapackage to the system profile. Likewise, adding the Xfce service
15642 not only adds the @code{xfce} metapackage to the system profile, but it
15643 also gives the Thunar file manager the ability to open a ``root-mode''
15644 file management window, if the user authenticates using the
15645 administrator's password via the standard polkit graphical interface.
15646 To ``add MATE'' means that @code{polkit} and @code{dbus} are extended
15647 appropriately, allowing MATE to operate with elevated privileges on a
15648 limited number of special-purpose system interfaces. Additionally,
15649 adding a service of type @code{mate-desktop-service-type} adds the MATE
15650 metapackage to the system profile. ``Adding Enlightenment'' means that
15651 @code{dbus} is extended appropriately, and several of Enlightenment's binaries
15652 are set as setuid, allowing Enlightenment's screen locker and other
15653 functionality to work as expected.
15654
15655 The desktop environments in Guix use the Xorg display server by
15656 default. If you'd like to use the newer display server protocol
15657 called Wayland, you need to use the @code{sddm-service} instead of
15658 GDM as the graphical login manager. You should then
15659 select the ``GNOME (Wayland)'' session in SDDM. Alternatively you can
15660 also try starting GNOME on Wayland manually from a TTY with the
15661 command ``XDG_SESSION_TYPE=wayland exec dbus-run-session
15662 gnome-session``. Currently only GNOME has support for Wayland.
15663
15664 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnome-desktop-service-type
15665 This is the type of the service that adds the @uref{https://www.gnome.org,
15666 GNOME} desktop environment. Its value is a @code{gnome-desktop-configuration}
15667 object (see below.)
15668
15669 This service adds the @code{gnome} package to the system profile, and extends
15670 polkit with the actions from @code{gnome-settings-daemon}.
15671 @end defvr
15672
15673 @deftp {Data Type} gnome-desktop-configuration
15674 Configuration record for the GNOME desktop environment.
15675
15676 @table @asis
15677 @item @code{gnome} (default: @code{gnome})
15678 The GNOME package to use.
15679 @end table
15680 @end deftp
15681
15682 @defvr {Scheme Variable} xfce-desktop-service-type
15683 This is the type of a service to run the @uref{Xfce, https://xfce.org/}
15684 desktop environment. Its value is an @code{xfce-desktop-configuration} object
15685 (see below.)
15686
15687 This service adds the @code{xfce} package to the system profile, and
15688 extends polkit with the ability for @code{thunar} to manipulate the file
15689 system as root from within a user session, after the user has authenticated
15690 with the administrator's password.
15691 @end defvr
15692
15693 @deftp {Data Type} xfce-desktop-configuration
15694 Configuration record for the Xfce desktop environment.
15695
15696 @table @asis
15697 @item @code{xfce} (default: @code{xfce})
15698 The Xfce package to use.
15699 @end table
15700 @end deftp
15701
15702 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mate-desktop-service-type
15703 This is the type of the service that runs the @uref{https://mate-desktop.org/,
15704 MATE desktop environment}. Its value is a @code{mate-desktop-configuration}
15705 object (see below.)
15706
15707 This service adds the @code{mate} package to the system
15708 profile, and extends polkit with the actions from
15709 @code{mate-settings-daemon}.
15710 @end deffn
15711
15712 @deftp {Data Type} mate-desktop-configuration
15713 Configuration record for the MATE desktop environment.
15714
15715 @table @asis
15716 @item @code{mate} (default: @code{mate})
15717 The MATE package to use.
15718 @end table
15719 @end deftp
15720
15721 @deffn {Scheme Variable} enlightenment-desktop-service-type
15722 Return a service that adds the @code{enlightenment} package to the system
15723 profile, and extends dbus with actions from @code{efl}.
15724 @end deffn
15725
15726 @deftp {Data Type} enlightenment-desktop-service-configuration
15727 @table @asis
15728 @item @code{enlightenment} (default: @code{enlightenment})
15729 The enlightenment package to use.
15730 @end table
15731 @end deftp
15732
15733 Because the GNOME, Xfce and MATE desktop services pull in so many packages,
15734 the default @code{%desktop-services} variable doesn't include any of
15735 them by default. To add GNOME, Xfce or MATE, just @code{cons} them onto
15736 @code{%desktop-services} in the @code{services} field of your
15737 @code{operating-system}:
15738
15739 @lisp
15740 (use-modules (gnu))
15741 (use-service-modules desktop)
15742 (operating-system
15743 ...
15744 ;; cons* adds items to the list given as its last argument.
15745 (services (cons* (service gnome-desktop-service-type)
15746 (service xfce-desktop-service)
15747 %desktop-services))
15748 ...)
15749 @end lisp
15750
15751 These desktop environments will then be available as options in the
15752 graphical login window.
15753
15754 The actual service definitions included in @code{%desktop-services} and
15755 provided by @code{(gnu services dbus)} and @code{(gnu services desktop)}
15756 are described below.
15757
15758 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dbus-service [#:dbus @var{dbus}] [#:services '()]
15759 Return a service that runs the ``system bus'', using @var{dbus}, with
15760 support for @var{services}.
15761
15762 @uref{https://dbus.freedesktop.org/, D-Bus} is an inter-process communication
15763 facility. Its system bus is used to allow system services to communicate
15764 and to be notified of system-wide events.
15765
15766 @var{services} must be a list of packages that provide an
15767 @file{etc/dbus-1/system.d} directory containing additional D-Bus configuration
15768 and policy files. For example, to allow avahi-daemon to use the system bus,
15769 @var{services} must be equal to @code{(list avahi)}.
15770 @end deffn
15771
15772 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} elogind-service [#:config @var{config}]
15773 Return a service that runs the @code{elogind} login and
15774 seat management daemon. @uref{https://github.com/elogind/elogind,
15775 Elogind} exposes a D-Bus interface that can be used to know which users
15776 are logged in, know what kind of sessions they have open, suspend the
15777 system, inhibit system suspend, reboot the system, and other tasks.
15778
15779 Elogind handles most system-level power events for a computer, for
15780 example suspending the system when a lid is closed, or shutting it down
15781 when the power button is pressed.
15782
15783 The @var{config} keyword argument specifies the configuration for
15784 elogind, and should be the result of an @code{(elogind-configuration
15785 (@var{parameter} @var{value})...)} invocation. Available parameters and
15786 their default values are:
15787
15788 @table @code
15789 @item kill-user-processes?
15790 @code{#f}
15791 @item kill-only-users
15792 @code{()}
15793 @item kill-exclude-users
15794 @code{("root")}
15795 @item inhibit-delay-max-seconds
15796 @code{5}
15797 @item handle-power-key
15798 @code{poweroff}
15799 @item handle-suspend-key
15800 @code{suspend}
15801 @item handle-hibernate-key
15802 @code{hibernate}
15803 @item handle-lid-switch
15804 @code{suspend}
15805 @item handle-lid-switch-docked
15806 @code{ignore}
15807 @item power-key-ignore-inhibited?
15808 @code{#f}
15809 @item suspend-key-ignore-inhibited?
15810 @code{#f}
15811 @item hibernate-key-ignore-inhibited?
15812 @code{#f}
15813 @item lid-switch-ignore-inhibited?
15814 @code{#t}
15815 @item holdoff-timeout-seconds
15816 @code{30}
15817 @item idle-action
15818 @code{ignore}
15819 @item idle-action-seconds
15820 @code{(* 30 60)}
15821 @item runtime-directory-size-percent
15822 @code{10}
15823 @item runtime-directory-size
15824 @code{#f}
15825 @item remove-ipc?
15826 @code{#t}
15827 @item suspend-state
15828 @code{("mem" "standby" "freeze")}
15829 @item suspend-mode
15830 @code{()}
15831 @item hibernate-state
15832 @code{("disk")}
15833 @item hibernate-mode
15834 @code{("platform" "shutdown")}
15835 @item hybrid-sleep-state
15836 @code{("disk")}
15837 @item hybrid-sleep-mode
15838 @code{("suspend" "platform" "shutdown")}
15839 @end table
15840 @end deffn
15841
15842 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} accountsservice-service @
15843 [#:accountsservice @var{accountsservice}]
15844 Return a service that runs AccountsService, a system service that can
15845 list available accounts, change their passwords, and so on.
15846 AccountsService integrates with PolicyKit to enable unprivileged users
15847 to acquire the capability to modify their system configuration.
15848 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/AccountsService/, the
15849 accountsservice web site} for more information.
15850
15851 The @var{accountsservice} keyword argument is the @code{accountsservice}
15852 package to expose as a service.
15853 @end deffn
15854
15855 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} polkit-service @
15856 [#:polkit @var{polkit}]
15857 Return a service that runs the
15858 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/polkit/, Polkit privilege
15859 management service}, which allows system administrators to grant access to
15860 privileged operations in a structured way. By querying the Polkit service, a
15861 privileged system component can know when it should grant additional
15862 capabilities to ordinary users. For example, an ordinary user can be granted
15863 the capability to suspend the system if the user is logged in locally.
15864 @end deffn
15865
15866 @defvr {Scheme Variable} polkit-wheel-service
15867 Service that adds the @code{wheel} group as admins to the Polkit
15868 service. This makes it so that users in the @code{wheel} group are queried
15869 for their own passwords when performing administrative actions instead of
15870 @code{root}'s, similar to the behaviour used by @code{sudo}.
15871 @end defvr
15872
15873 @defvr {Scheme Variable} upower-service-type
15874 Service that runs @uref{https://upower.freedesktop.org/, @command{upowerd}}, a
15875 system-wide monitor for power consumption and battery levels, with the given
15876 configuration settings.
15877
15878 It implements the @code{org.freedesktop.UPower} D-Bus interface, and is
15879 notably used by GNOME.
15880 @end defvr
15881
15882 @deftp {Data Type} upower-configuration
15883 Data type representation the configuration for UPower.
15884
15885 @table @asis
15886
15887 @item @code{upower} (default: @var{upower})
15888 Package to use for @code{upower}.
15889
15890 @item @code{watts-up-pro?} (default: @code{#f})
15891 Enable the Watts Up Pro device.
15892
15893 @item @code{poll-batteries?} (default: @code{#t})
15894 Enable polling the kernel for battery level changes.
15895
15896 @item @code{ignore-lid?} (default: @code{#f})
15897 Ignore the lid state, this can be useful if it's incorrect on a device.
15898
15899 @item @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} (default: @code{#f})
15900 Whether battery percentage based policy should be used. The default is to use
15901 the time left, change to @code{#t} to use the percentage.
15902
15903 @item @code{percentage-low} (default: @code{10})
15904 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
15905 at which the battery is considered low.
15906
15907 @item @code{percentage-critical} (default: @code{3})
15908 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
15909 at which the battery is considered critical.
15910
15911 @item @code{percentage-action} (default: @code{2})
15912 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
15913 at which action will be taken.
15914
15915 @item @code{time-low} (default: @code{1200})
15916 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
15917 seconds at which the battery is considered low.
15918
15919 @item @code{time-critical} (default: @code{300})
15920 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
15921 seconds at which the battery is considered critical.
15922
15923 @item @code{time-action} (default: @code{120})
15924 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
15925 seconds at which action will be taken.
15926
15927 @item @code{critical-power-action} (default: @code{'hybrid-sleep})
15928 The action taken when @code{percentage-action} or @code{time-action} is
15929 reached (depending on the configuration of @code{use-percentage-for-policy?}).
15930
15931 Possible values are:
15932
15933 @itemize @bullet
15934 @item
15935 @code{'power-off}
15936
15937 @item
15938 @code{'hibernate}
15939
15940 @item
15941 @code{'hybrid-sleep}.
15942 @end itemize
15943
15944 @end table
15945 @end deftp
15946
15947 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udisks-service [#:udisks @var{udisks}]
15948 Return a service for @uref{https://udisks.freedesktop.org/docs/latest/,
15949 UDisks}, a @dfn{disk management} daemon that provides user interfaces with
15950 notifications and ways to mount/unmount disks. Programs that talk to UDisks
15951 include the @command{udisksctl} command, part of UDisks, and GNOME Disks.
15952 @end deffn
15953
15954 @deffn {Scheme Variable} colord-service-type
15955 This is the type of the service that runs @command{colord}, a system
15956 service with a D-Bus
15957 interface to manage the color profiles of input and output devices such as
15958 screens and scanners. It is notably used by the GNOME Color Manager graphical
15959 tool. See @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/software/colord/, the colord web
15960 site} for more information.
15961 @end deffn
15962
15963 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-application name [#:allowed? #t] [#:system? #f] [#:users '()]
15964 Return a configuration allowing an application to access GeoClue
15965 location data. @var{name} is the Desktop ID of the application, without
15966 the @code{.desktop} part. If @var{allowed?} is true, the application
15967 will have access to location information by default. The boolean
15968 @var{system?} value indicates whether an application is a system component
15969 or not. Finally @var{users} is a list of UIDs of all users for which
15970 this application is allowed location info access. An empty users list
15971 means that all users are allowed.
15972 @end deffn
15973
15974 @cindex scanner access
15975 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} sane-service-type
15976 This service provides access to scanners @i{via}
15977 @uref{http://www.sane-project.org, SANE} by installing the necessary udev
15978 rules.
15979 @end deffn
15980
15981 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %standard-geoclue-applications
15982 The standard list of well-known GeoClue application configurations,
15983 granting authority to the GNOME date-and-time utility to ask for the
15984 current location in order to set the time zone, and allowing the
15985 IceCat and Epiphany web browsers to request location information.
15986 IceCat and Epiphany both query the user before allowing a web page to
15987 know the user's location.
15988 @end defvr
15989
15990 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-service [#:colord @var{colord}] @
15991 [#:whitelist '()] @
15992 [#:wifi-geolocation-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/geolocate?key=geoclue"] @
15993 [#:submit-data? #f]
15994 [#:wifi-submission-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/submit?key=geoclue"] @
15995 [#:submission-nick "geoclue"] @
15996 [#:applications %standard-geoclue-applications]
15997 Return a service that runs the GeoClue location service. This service
15998 provides a D-Bus interface to allow applications to request access to a
15999 user's physical location, and optionally to add information to online
16000 location databases. See
16001 @uref{https://wiki.freedesktop.org/www/Software/GeoClue/, the GeoClue
16002 web site} for more information.
16003 @end deffn
16004
16005 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} bluetooth-service [#:bluez @var{bluez}] @
16006 [@w{#:auto-enable? #f}]
16007 Return a service that runs the @command{bluetoothd} daemon, which
16008 manages all the Bluetooth devices and provides a number of D-Bus
16009 interfaces. When AUTO-ENABLE? is true, the bluetooth controller is
16010 powered automatically at boot, which can be useful when using a
16011 bluetooth keyboard or mouse.
16012
16013 Users need to be in the @code{lp} group to access the D-Bus service.
16014 @end deffn
16015
16016 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnome-keyring-service-type
16017 This is the type of the service that adds the
16018 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/GnomeKeyring, GNOME Keyring}. Its
16019 value is a @code{gnome-keyring-configuration} object (see below.)
16020
16021 This service adds the @code{gnome-keyring} package to the system profile
16022 and extends PAM with entries using @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so}, unlocking
16023 a user's login keyring when they log in or setting its password with passwd.
16024 @end defvr
16025
16026 @deftp {Data Type} gnome-keyring-configuration
16027 Configuration record for the GNOME Keyring service.
16028
16029 @table @asis
16030 @item @code{keyring} (default: @code{gnome-keyring})
16031 The GNOME keyring package to use.
16032
16033 @item @code{pam-services}
16034 A list of @code{(@var{service} . @var{kind})} pairs denoting PAM
16035 services to extend, where @var{service} is the name of an existing
16036 service to extend and @var{kind} is one of @code{login} or
16037 @code{passwd}.
16038
16039 If @code{login} is given, it adds an optional
16040 @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so} to the auth block without arguments and to
16041 the session block with @code{auto_start}. If @code{passwd} is given, it
16042 adds an optional @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so} to the password block
16043 without arguments.
16044
16045 By default, this field contains ``gdm-password'' with the value @code{login}
16046 and ``passwd'' is with the value @code{passwd}.
16047 @end table
16048 @end deftp
16049
16050
16051 @node Sound Services
16052 @subsection Sound Services
16053
16054 @cindex sound support
16055 @cindex ALSA
16056 @cindex PulseAudio, sound support
16057
16058 The @code{(gnu services sound)} module provides a service to configure the
16059 Advanced Linux Sound Architecture (ALSA) system, which makes PulseAudio the
16060 preferred ALSA output driver.
16061
16062 @deffn {Scheme Variable} alsa-service-type
16063 This is the type for the @uref{https://alsa-project.org/, Advanced Linux Sound
16064 Architecture} (ALSA) system, which generates the @file{/etc/asound.conf}
16065 configuration file. The value for this type is a @command{alsa-configuration}
16066 record as in this example:
16067
16068 @lisp
16069 (service alsa-service-type)
16070 @end lisp
16071
16072 See below for details about @code{alsa-configuration}.
16073 @end deffn
16074
16075 @deftp {Data Type} alsa-configuration
16076 Data type representing the configuration for @code{alsa-service}.
16077
16078 @table @asis
16079 @item @code{alsa-plugins} (default: @var{alsa-plugins})
16080 @code{alsa-plugins} package to use.
16081
16082 @item @code{pulseaudio?} (default: @var{#t})
16083 Whether ALSA applications should transparently be made to use the
16084 @uref{https://www.pulseaudio.org/, PulseAudio} sound server.
16085
16086 Using PulseAudio allows you to run several sound-producing applications
16087 at the same time and to individual control them @i{via}
16088 @command{pavucontrol}, among other things.
16089
16090 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{""})
16091 String to append to the @file{/etc/asound.conf} file.
16092
16093 @end table
16094 @end deftp
16095
16096 Individual users who want to override the system configuration of ALSA can do
16097 it with the @file{~/.asoundrc} file:
16098
16099 @example
16100 # In guix, we have to specify the absolute path for plugins.
16101 pcm_type.jack @{
16102 lib "/home/alice/.guix-profile/lib/alsa-lib/libasound_module_pcm_jack.so"
16103 @}
16104
16105 # Routing ALSA to jack:
16106 # <http://jackaudio.org/faq/routing_alsa.html>.
16107 pcm.rawjack @{
16108 type jack
16109 playback_ports @{
16110 0 system:playback_1
16111 1 system:playback_2
16112 @}
16113
16114 capture_ports @{
16115 0 system:capture_1
16116 1 system:capture_2
16117 @}
16118 @}
16119
16120 pcm.!default @{
16121 type plug
16122 slave @{
16123 pcm "rawjack"
16124 @}
16125 @}
16126 @end example
16127
16128 See @uref{https://www.alsa-project.org/main/index.php/Asoundrc} for the
16129 details.
16130
16131 @deffn {Scheme Variable} pulseaudio-service-type
16132 This is the type for the @uref{https://www.pulseaudio.org/, PulseAudio}
16133 sound server. It exists to allow system overrides of the default settings
16134 via @code{pulseaudio-configuration}, see below.
16135
16136 @quotation Warning
16137 This service on its own does not ensure, that the @code{pulseaudio} package
16138 exists on your machine. It merely adds configuration files for it, as
16139 detailed below. In the (admittedly unlikely) case, that you find yourself
16140 without a @code{pulseaudio} package, consider enabling it through the
16141 @code{alsa-service-type} above.
16142 @end quotation
16143 @end deffn
16144
16145 @deftp {Data Type} pulseaudio-configuration
16146 Data type representing the configuration for @code{pulseaudio-service}.
16147
16148 @table @asis
16149 @item @var{client-conf} (default: @code{'()})
16150 List of settings to set in @file{client.conf}.
16151 Accepts a list of strings or a symbol-value pairs. A string will be
16152 inserted as-is with a newline added. A pair will be formatted as
16153 ``key = value'', again with a newline added.
16154
16155 @item @var{daemon-conf} (default: @code{'((flat-volumes . no))})
16156 List of settings to set in @file{daemon.conf}, formatted just like
16157 @var{client-conf}.
16158
16159 @item @var{script-file} (default: @code{(file-append pulseaudio "/etc/pulse/default.pa")})
16160 Script file to use as as @file{default.pa}.
16161
16162 @item @var{system-script-file} (default: @code{(file-append pulseaudio "/etc/pulse/system.pa")})
16163 Script file to use as as @file{system.pa}.
16164 @end table
16165 @end deftp
16166
16167 @deffn {Scheme Variable} ladspa-service-type
16168 This service sets the @var{LADSPA_PATH} variable, so that programs, which
16169 respect it, e.g. PulseAudio, can load LADSPA plugins.
16170
16171 The following example will setup the service to enable modules from the
16172 @code{swh-plugins} package:
16173
16174 @lisp
16175 (service ladspa-service-type
16176 (ladspa-configuration (plugins (list swh-plugins))))
16177 @end lisp
16178
16179 See @uref{http://plugin.org.uk/ladspa-swh/docs/ladspa-swh.html} for the
16180 details.
16181
16182 @end deffn
16183
16184 @node Database Services
16185 @subsection Database Services
16186
16187 @cindex database
16188 @cindex SQL
16189 The @code{(gnu services databases)} module provides the following services.
16190
16191 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} postgresql-service [#:postgresql postgresql] @
16192 [#:config-file] [#:data-directory ``/var/lib/postgresql/data''] @
16193 [#:port 5432] [#:locale ``en_US.utf8''] [#:extension-packages '()]
16194 Return a service that runs @var{postgresql}, the PostgreSQL database
16195 server.
16196
16197 The PostgreSQL daemon loads its runtime configuration from @var{config-file},
16198 creates a database cluster with @var{locale} as the default
16199 locale, stored in @var{data-directory}. It then listens on @var{port}.
16200
16201 @cindex postgresql extension-packages
16202 Additional extensions are loaded from packages listed in
16203 @var{extension-packages}. Extensions are available at runtime. For instance,
16204 to create a geographic database using the @code{postgis} extension, a user can
16205 configure the postgresql-service as in this example:
16206
16207 @cindex postgis
16208 @lisp
16209 (use-package-modules databases geo)
16210
16211 (operating-system
16212 ...
16213 ;; postgresql is required to run `psql' but postgis is not required for
16214 ;; proper operation.
16215 (packages (cons* postgresql %base-packages))
16216 (services
16217 (cons*
16218 (postgresql-service #:extension-packages (list postgis))
16219 %base-services)))
16220 @end lisp
16221
16222 Then the extension becomes visible and you can initialise an empty geographic
16223 database in this way:
16224
16225 @example
16226 psql -U postgres
16227 > create database postgistest;
16228 > \connect postgistest;
16229 > create extension postgis;
16230 > create extension postgis_topology;
16231 @end example
16232
16233 There is no need to add this field for contrib extensions such as hstore or
16234 dblink as they are already loadable by postgresql. This field is only
16235 required to add extensions provided by other packages.
16236 @end deffn
16237
16238 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mysql-service [#:config (mysql-configuration)]
16239 Return a service that runs @command{mysqld}, the MySQL or MariaDB
16240 database server.
16241
16242 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
16243 @command{mysqld}, which should be a @code{<mysql-configuration>} object.
16244 @end deffn
16245
16246 @deftp {Data Type} mysql-configuration
16247 Data type representing the configuration of @var{mysql-service}.
16248
16249 @table @asis
16250 @item @code{mysql} (default: @var{mariadb})
16251 Package object of the MySQL database server, can be either @var{mariadb}
16252 or @var{mysql}.
16253
16254 For MySQL, a temporary root password will be displayed at activation time.
16255 For MariaDB, the root password is empty.
16256
16257 @item @code{port} (default: @code{3306})
16258 TCP port on which the database server listens for incoming connections.
16259 @end table
16260 @end deftp
16261
16262 @defvr {Scheme Variable} memcached-service-type
16263 This is the service type for the @uref{https://memcached.org/,
16264 Memcached} service, which provides a distributed in memory cache. The
16265 value for the service type is a @code{memcached-configuration} object.
16266 @end defvr
16267
16268 @lisp
16269 (service memcached-service-type)
16270 @end lisp
16271
16272 @deftp {Data Type} memcached-configuration
16273 Data type representing the configuration of memcached.
16274
16275 @table @asis
16276 @item @code{memcached} (default: @code{memcached})
16277 The Memcached package to use.
16278
16279 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'("0.0.0.0")})
16280 Network interfaces on which to listen.
16281
16282 @item @code{tcp-port} (default: @code{11211})
16283 Port on which to accept connections on,
16284
16285 @item @code{udp-port} (default: @code{11211})
16286 Port on which to accept UDP connections on, a value of 0 will disable
16287 listening on a UDP socket.
16288
16289 @item @code{additional-options} (default: @code{'()})
16290 Additional command line options to pass to @code{memcached}.
16291 @end table
16292 @end deftp
16293
16294 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mongodb-service-type
16295 This is the service type for @uref{https://www.mongodb.com/, MongoDB}.
16296 The value for the service type is a @code{mongodb-configuration} object.
16297 @end defvr
16298
16299 @lisp
16300 (service mongodb-service-type)
16301 @end lisp
16302
16303 @deftp {Data Type} mongodb-configuration
16304 Data type representing the configuration of mongodb.
16305
16306 @table @asis
16307 @item @code{mongodb} (default: @code{mongodb})
16308 The MongoDB package to use.
16309
16310 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-mongodb-configuration-file})
16311 The configuration file for MongoDB.
16312
16313 @item @code{data-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/mongodb"})
16314 This value is used to create the directory, so that it exists and is
16315 owned by the mongodb user. It should match the data-directory which
16316 MongoDB is configured to use through the configuration file.
16317 @end table
16318 @end deftp
16319
16320 @defvr {Scheme Variable} redis-service-type
16321 This is the service type for the @uref{https://redis.io/, Redis}
16322 key/value store, whose value is a @code{redis-configuration} object.
16323 @end defvr
16324
16325 @deftp {Data Type} redis-configuration
16326 Data type representing the configuration of redis.
16327
16328 @table @asis
16329 @item @code{redis} (default: @code{redis})
16330 The Redis package to use.
16331
16332 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
16333 Network interface on which to listen.
16334
16335 @item @code{port} (default: @code{6379})
16336 Port on which to accept connections on, a value of 0 will disable
16337 listening on a TCP socket.
16338
16339 @item @code{working-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/redis"})
16340 Directory in which to store the database and related files.
16341 @end table
16342 @end deftp
16343
16344 @node Mail Services
16345 @subsection Mail Services
16346
16347 @cindex mail
16348 @cindex email
16349 The @code{(gnu services mail)} module provides Guix service definitions
16350 for email services: IMAP, POP3, and LMTP servers, as well as mail
16351 transport agents (MTAs). Lots of acronyms! These services are detailed
16352 in the subsections below.
16353
16354 @subsubheading Dovecot Service
16355
16356 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dovecot-service [#:config (dovecot-configuration)]
16357 Return a service that runs the Dovecot IMAP/POP3/LMTP mail server.
16358 @end deffn
16359
16360 By default, Dovecot does not need much configuration; the default
16361 configuration object created by @code{(dovecot-configuration)} will
16362 suffice if your mail is delivered to @code{~/Maildir}. A self-signed
16363 certificate will be generated for TLS-protected connections, though
16364 Dovecot will also listen on cleartext ports by default. There are a
16365 number of options, though, which mail administrators might need to change,
16366 and as is the case with other services, Guix allows the system
16367 administrator to specify these parameters via a uniform Scheme interface.
16368
16369 For example, to specify that mail is located at @code{maildir~/.mail},
16370 one would instantiate the Dovecot service like this:
16371
16372 @lisp
16373 (dovecot-service #:config
16374 (dovecot-configuration
16375 (mail-location "maildir:~/.mail")))
16376 @end lisp
16377
16378 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
16379 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
16380 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
16381 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
16382 if you have an old @code{dovecot.conf} file that you want to port over
16383 from some other system; see the end for more details.
16384
16385 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
16386 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services mail). Manually maintained
16387 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
16388 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
16389 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
16390 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
16391 @c the churn as dovecot updates.
16392
16393 Available @code{dovecot-configuration} fields are:
16394
16395 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
16396 The dovecot package.
16397 @end deftypevr
16398
16399 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list listen
16400 A list of IPs or hosts where to listen for connections. @samp{*}
16401 listens on all IPv4 interfaces, @samp{::} listens on all IPv6
16402 interfaces. If you want to specify non-default ports or anything more
16403 complex, customize the address and port fields of the
16404 @samp{inet-listener} of the specific services you are interested in.
16405 @end deftypevr
16406
16407 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} protocol-configuration-list protocols
16408 List of protocols we want to serve. Available protocols include
16409 @samp{imap}, @samp{pop3}, and @samp{lmtp}.
16410
16411 Available @code{protocol-configuration} fields are:
16412
16413 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string name
16414 The name of the protocol.
16415 @end deftypevr
16416
16417 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string auth-socket-path
16418 UNIX socket path to the master authentication server to find users.
16419 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
16420 It defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
16421 @end deftypevr
16422
16423 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
16424 Space separated list of plugins to load.
16425 @end deftypevr
16426
16427 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-userip-connections
16428 Maximum number of IMAP connections allowed for a user from each IP
16429 address. NOTE: The username is compared case-sensitively.
16430 Defaults to @samp{10}.
16431 @end deftypevr
16432
16433 @end deftypevr
16434
16435 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} service-configuration-list services
16436 List of services to enable. Available services include @samp{imap},
16437 @samp{imap-login}, @samp{pop3}, @samp{pop3-login}, @samp{auth}, and
16438 @samp{lmtp}.
16439
16440 Available @code{service-configuration} fields are:
16441
16442 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} string kind
16443 The service kind. Valid values include @code{director},
16444 @code{imap-login}, @code{pop3-login}, @code{lmtp}, @code{imap},
16445 @code{pop3}, @code{auth}, @code{auth-worker}, @code{dict},
16446 @code{tcpwrap}, @code{quota-warning}, or anything else.
16447 @end deftypevr
16448
16449 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} listener-configuration-list listeners
16450 Listeners for the service. A listener is either a
16451 @code{unix-listener-configuration}, a @code{fifo-listener-configuration}, or
16452 an @code{inet-listener-configuration}.
16453 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16454
16455 Available @code{unix-listener-configuration} fields are:
16456
16457 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
16458 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
16459 the section name.
16460 @end deftypevr
16461
16462 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
16463 The access mode for the socket.
16464 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
16465 @end deftypevr
16466
16467 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
16468 The user to own the socket.
16469 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16470 @end deftypevr
16471
16472 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
16473 The group to own the socket.
16474 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16475 @end deftypevr
16476
16477
16478 Available @code{fifo-listener-configuration} fields are:
16479
16480 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
16481 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
16482 the section name.
16483 @end deftypevr
16484
16485 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
16486 The access mode for the socket.
16487 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
16488 @end deftypevr
16489
16490 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
16491 The user to own the socket.
16492 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16493 @end deftypevr
16494
16495 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
16496 The group to own the socket.
16497 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16498 @end deftypevr
16499
16500
16501 Available @code{inet-listener-configuration} fields are:
16502
16503 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string protocol
16504 The protocol to listen for.
16505 @end deftypevr
16506
16507 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string address
16508 The address on which to listen, or empty for all addresses.
16509 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16510 @end deftypevr
16511
16512 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
16513 The port on which to listen.
16514 @end deftypevr
16515
16516 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl?
16517 Whether to use SSL for this service; @samp{yes}, @samp{no}, or
16518 @samp{required}.
16519 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16520 @end deftypevr
16521
16522 @end deftypevr
16523
16524 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer client-limit
16525 Maximum number of simultaneous client connections per process. Once
16526 this number of connections is received, the next incoming connection
16527 will prompt Dovecot to spawn another process. If set to 0,
16528 @code{default-client-limit} is used instead.
16529
16530 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16531
16532 @end deftypevr
16533
16534 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer service-count
16535 Number of connections to handle before starting a new process.
16536 Typically the only useful values are 0 (unlimited) or 1. 1 is more
16537 secure, but 0 is faster. <doc/wiki/LoginProcess.txt>.
16538 Defaults to @samp{1}.
16539
16540 @end deftypevr
16541
16542 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-limit
16543 Maximum number of processes that can exist for this service. If set to
16544 0, @code{default-process-limit} is used instead.
16545
16546 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16547
16548 @end deftypevr
16549
16550 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-min-avail
16551 Number of processes to always keep waiting for more connections.
16552 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16553 @end deftypevr
16554
16555 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer vsz-limit
16556 If you set @samp{service-count 0}, you probably need to grow
16557 this.
16558 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
16559 @end deftypevr
16560
16561 @end deftypevr
16562
16563 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} dict-configuration dict
16564 Dict configuration, as created by the @code{dict-configuration}
16565 constructor.
16566
16567 Available @code{dict-configuration} fields are:
16568
16569 @deftypevr {@code{dict-configuration} parameter} free-form-fields entries
16570 A list of key-value pairs that this dict should hold.
16571 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16572 @end deftypevr
16573
16574 @end deftypevr
16575
16576 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} passdb-configuration-list passdbs
16577 A list of passdb configurations, each one created by the
16578 @code{passdb-configuration} constructor.
16579
16580 Available @code{passdb-configuration} fields are:
16581
16582 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
16583 The driver that the passdb should use. Valid values include
16584 @samp{pam}, @samp{passwd}, @samp{shadow}, @samp{bsdauth}, and
16585 @samp{static}.
16586 Defaults to @samp{"pam"}.
16587 @end deftypevr
16588
16589 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
16590 Space separated list of arguments to the passdb driver.
16591 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16592 @end deftypevr
16593
16594 @end deftypevr
16595
16596 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} userdb-configuration-list userdbs
16597 List of userdb configurations, each one created by the
16598 @code{userdb-configuration} constructor.
16599
16600 Available @code{userdb-configuration} fields are:
16601
16602 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
16603 The driver that the userdb should use. Valid values include
16604 @samp{passwd} and @samp{static}.
16605 Defaults to @samp{"passwd"}.
16606 @end deftypevr
16607
16608 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
16609 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
16610 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16611 @end deftypevr
16612
16613 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args override-fields
16614 Override fields from passwd.
16615 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16616 @end deftypevr
16617
16618 @end deftypevr
16619
16620 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} plugin-configuration plugin-configuration
16621 Plug-in configuration, created by the @code{plugin-configuration}
16622 constructor.
16623 @end deftypevr
16624
16625 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} list-of-namespace-configuration namespaces
16626 List of namespaces. Each item in the list is created by the
16627 @code{namespace-configuration} constructor.
16628
16629 Available @code{namespace-configuration} fields are:
16630
16631 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string name
16632 Name for this namespace.
16633 @end deftypevr
16634
16635 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string type
16636 Namespace type: @samp{private}, @samp{shared} or @samp{public}.
16637 Defaults to @samp{"private"}.
16638 @end deftypevr
16639
16640 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string separator
16641 Hierarchy separator to use. You should use the same separator for
16642 all namespaces or some clients get confused. @samp{/} is usually a good
16643 one. The default however depends on the underlying mail storage
16644 format.
16645 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16646 @end deftypevr
16647
16648 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string prefix
16649 Prefix required to access this namespace. This needs to be
16650 different for all namespaces. For example @samp{Public/}.
16651 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16652 @end deftypevr
16653
16654 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string location
16655 Physical location of the mailbox. This is in the same format as
16656 mail_location, which is also the default for it.
16657 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16658 @end deftypevr
16659
16660 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean inbox?
16661 There can be only one INBOX, and this setting defines which
16662 namespace has it.
16663 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16664 @end deftypevr
16665
16666 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean hidden?
16667 If namespace is hidden, it's not advertised to clients via NAMESPACE
16668 extension. You'll most likely also want to set @samp{list? #f}. This is mostly
16669 useful when converting from another server with different namespaces
16670 which you want to deprecate but still keep working. For example you can
16671 create hidden namespaces with prefixes @samp{~/mail/}, @samp{~%u/mail/}
16672 and @samp{mail/}.
16673 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16674 @end deftypevr
16675
16676 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean list?
16677 Show the mailboxes under this namespace with the LIST command. This
16678 makes the namespace visible for clients that do not support the NAMESPACE
16679 extension. The special @code{children} value lists child mailboxes, but
16680 hides the namespace prefix.
16681 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16682 @end deftypevr
16683
16684 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean subscriptions?
16685 Namespace handles its own subscriptions. If set to @code{#f}, the
16686 parent namespace handles them. The empty prefix should always have this
16687 as @code{#t}).
16688 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16689 @end deftypevr
16690
16691 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} mailbox-configuration-list mailboxes
16692 List of predefined mailboxes in this namespace.
16693 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16694
16695 Available @code{mailbox-configuration} fields are:
16696
16697 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string name
16698 Name for this mailbox.
16699 @end deftypevr
16700
16701 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string auto
16702 @samp{create} will automatically create this mailbox.
16703 @samp{subscribe} will both create and subscribe to the mailbox.
16704 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
16705 @end deftypevr
16706
16707 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list special-use
16708 List of IMAP @code{SPECIAL-USE} attributes as specified by RFC 6154.
16709 Valid values are @code{\All}, @code{\Archive}, @code{\Drafts},
16710 @code{\Flagged}, @code{\Junk}, @code{\Sent}, and @code{\Trash}.
16711 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16712 @end deftypevr
16713
16714 @end deftypevr
16715
16716 @end deftypevr
16717
16718 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name base-dir
16719 Base directory where to store runtime data.
16720 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/"}.
16721 @end deftypevr
16722
16723 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-greeting
16724 Greeting message for clients.
16725 Defaults to @samp{"Dovecot ready."}.
16726 @end deftypevr
16727
16728 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-trusted-networks
16729 List of trusted network ranges. Connections from these IPs are
16730 allowed to override their IP addresses and ports (for logging and for
16731 authentication checks). @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} is also ignored
16732 for these networks. Typically you would specify your IMAP proxy servers
16733 here.
16734 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16735 @end deftypevr
16736
16737 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-access-sockets
16738 List of login access check sockets (e.g.@: tcpwrap).
16739 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16740 @end deftypevr
16741
16742 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-proctitle?
16743 Show more verbose process titles (in ps). Currently shows user name
16744 and IP address. Useful for seeing who is actually using the IMAP
16745 processes (e.g.@: shared mailboxes or if the same uid is used for multiple
16746 accounts).
16747 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16748 @end deftypevr
16749
16750 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean shutdown-clients?
16751 Should all processes be killed when Dovecot master process shuts down.
16752 Setting this to @code{#f} means that Dovecot can be upgraded without
16753 forcing existing client connections to close (although that could also
16754 be a problem if the upgrade is e.g.@: due to a security fix).
16755 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16756 @end deftypevr
16757
16758 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer doveadm-worker-count
16759 If non-zero, run mail commands via this many connections to doveadm
16760 server, instead of running them directly in the same process.
16761 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16762 @end deftypevr
16763
16764 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string doveadm-socket-path
16765 UNIX socket or host:port used for connecting to doveadm server.
16766 Defaults to @samp{"doveadm-server"}.
16767 @end deftypevr
16768
16769 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list import-environment
16770 List of environment variables that are preserved on Dovecot startup
16771 and passed down to all of its child processes. You can also give
16772 key=value pairs to always set specific settings.
16773 @end deftypevr
16774
16775 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean disable-plaintext-auth?
16776 Disable LOGIN command and all other plaintext authentications unless
16777 SSL/TLS is used (LOGINDISABLED capability). Note that if the remote IP
16778 matches the local IP (i.e.@: you're connecting from the same computer),
16779 the connection is considered secure and plaintext authentication is
16780 allowed. See also ssl=required setting.
16781 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16782 @end deftypevr
16783
16784 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-cache-size
16785 Authentication cache size (e.g.@: @samp{#e10e6}). 0 means it's disabled.
16786 Note that bsdauth, PAM and vpopmail require @samp{cache-key} to be set
16787 for caching to be used.
16788 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16789 @end deftypevr
16790
16791 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-ttl
16792 Time to live for cached data. After TTL expires the cached record
16793 is no longer used, *except* if the main database lookup returns internal
16794 failure. We also try to handle password changes automatically: If
16795 user's previous authentication was successful, but this one wasn't, the
16796 cache isn't used. For now this works only with plaintext
16797 authentication.
16798 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
16799 @end deftypevr
16800
16801 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-negative-ttl
16802 TTL for negative hits (user not found, password mismatch).
16803 0 disables caching them completely.
16804 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
16805 @end deftypevr
16806
16807 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-realms
16808 List of realms for SASL authentication mechanisms that need them.
16809 You can leave it empty if you don't want to support multiple realms.
16810 Many clients simply use the first one listed here, so keep the default
16811 realm first.
16812 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16813 @end deftypevr
16814
16815 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-default-realm
16816 Default realm/domain to use if none was specified. This is used for
16817 both SASL realms and appending @@domain to username in plaintext
16818 logins.
16819 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16820 @end deftypevr
16821
16822 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-chars
16823 List of allowed characters in username. If the user-given username
16824 contains a character not listed in here, the login automatically fails.
16825 This is just an extra check to make sure user can't exploit any
16826 potential quote escaping vulnerabilities with SQL/LDAP databases. If
16827 you want to allow all characters, set this value to empty.
16828 Defaults to @samp{"abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ01234567890.-_@@"}.
16829 @end deftypevr
16830
16831 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-translation
16832 Username character translations before it's looked up from
16833 databases. The value contains series of from -> to characters. For
16834 example @samp{#@@/@@} means that @samp{#} and @samp{/} characters are
16835 translated to @samp{@@}.
16836 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16837 @end deftypevr
16838
16839 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-format
16840 Username formatting before it's looked up from databases. You can
16841 use the standard variables here, e.g.@: %Lu would lowercase the username,
16842 %n would drop away the domain if it was given, or @samp{%n-AT-%d} would
16843 change the @samp{@@} into @samp{-AT-}. This translation is done after
16844 @samp{auth-username-translation} changes.
16845 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
16846 @end deftypevr
16847
16848 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-master-user-separator
16849 If you want to allow master users to log in by specifying the master
16850 username within the normal username string (i.e.@: not using SASL
16851 mechanism's support for it), you can specify the separator character
16852 here. The format is then <username><separator><master username>.
16853 UW-IMAP uses @samp{*} as the separator, so that could be a good
16854 choice.
16855 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16856 @end deftypevr
16857
16858 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-anonymous-username
16859 Username to use for users logging in with ANONYMOUS SASL
16860 mechanism.
16861 Defaults to @samp{"anonymous"}.
16862 @end deftypevr
16863
16864 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-worker-max-count
16865 Maximum number of dovecot-auth worker processes. They're used to
16866 execute blocking passdb and userdb queries (e.g.@: MySQL and PAM).
16867 They're automatically created and destroyed as needed.
16868 Defaults to @samp{30}.
16869 @end deftypevr
16870
16871 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-gssapi-hostname
16872 Host name to use in GSSAPI principal names. The default is to use
16873 the name returned by gethostname(). Use @samp{$ALL} (with quotes) to
16874 allow all keytab entries.
16875 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16876 @end deftypevr
16877
16878 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-krb5-keytab
16879 Kerberos keytab to use for the GSSAPI mechanism. Will use the
16880 system default (usually @file{/etc/krb5.keytab}) if not specified. You may
16881 need to change the auth service to run as root to be able to read this
16882 file.
16883 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16884 @end deftypevr
16885
16886 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-use-winbind?
16887 Do NTLM and GSS-SPNEGO authentication using Samba's winbind daemon
16888 and @samp{ntlm-auth} helper.
16889 <doc/wiki/Authentication/Mechanisms/Winbind.txt>.
16890 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16891 @end deftypevr
16892
16893 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-winbind-helper-path
16894 Path for Samba's @samp{ntlm-auth} helper binary.
16895 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/bin/ntlm_auth"}.
16896 @end deftypevr
16897
16898 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-failure-delay
16899 Time to delay before replying to failed authentications.
16900 Defaults to @samp{"2 secs"}.
16901 @end deftypevr
16902
16903 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-require-client-cert?
16904 Require a valid SSL client certificate or the authentication
16905 fails.
16906 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16907 @end deftypevr
16908
16909 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-username-from-cert?
16910 Take the username from client's SSL certificate, using
16911 @code{X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID()} which returns the subject's DN's
16912 CommonName.
16913 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16914 @end deftypevr
16915
16916 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-mechanisms
16917 List of wanted authentication mechanisms. Supported mechanisms are:
16918 @samp{plain}, @samp{login}, @samp{digest-md5}, @samp{cram-md5},
16919 @samp{ntlm}, @samp{rpa}, @samp{apop}, @samp{anonymous}, @samp{gssapi},
16920 @samp{otp}, @samp{skey}, and @samp{gss-spnego}. NOTE: See also
16921 @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} setting.
16922 @end deftypevr
16923
16924 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-servers
16925 List of IPs or hostnames to all director servers, including ourself.
16926 Ports can be specified as ip:port. The default port is the same as what
16927 director service's @samp{inet-listener} is using.
16928 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16929 @end deftypevr
16930
16931 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-mail-servers
16932 List of IPs or hostnames to all backend mail servers. Ranges are
16933 allowed too, like 10.0.0.10-10.0.0.30.
16934 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16935 @end deftypevr
16936
16937 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-user-expire
16938 How long to redirect users to a specific server after it no longer
16939 has any connections.
16940 Defaults to @samp{"15 min"}.
16941 @end deftypevr
16942
16943 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-username-hash
16944 How the username is translated before being hashed. Useful values
16945 include %Ln if user can log in with or without @@domain, %Ld if mailboxes
16946 are shared within domain.
16947 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
16948 @end deftypevr
16949
16950 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-path
16951 Log file to use for error messages. @samp{syslog} logs to syslog,
16952 @samp{/dev/stderr} logs to stderr.
16953 Defaults to @samp{"syslog"}.
16954 @end deftypevr
16955
16956 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string info-log-path
16957 Log file to use for informational messages. Defaults to
16958 @samp{log-path}.
16959 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16960 @end deftypevr
16961
16962 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string debug-log-path
16963 Log file to use for debug messages. Defaults to
16964 @samp{info-log-path}.
16965 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16966 @end deftypevr
16967
16968 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string syslog-facility
16969 Syslog facility to use if you're logging to syslog. Usually if you
16970 don't want to use @samp{mail}, you'll use local0..local7. Also other
16971 standard facilities are supported.
16972 Defaults to @samp{"mail"}.
16973 @end deftypevr
16974
16975 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose?
16976 Log unsuccessful authentication attempts and the reasons why they
16977 failed.
16978 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16979 @end deftypevr
16980
16981 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-verbose-passwords
16982 In case of password mismatches, log the attempted password. Valid
16983 values are no, plain and sha1. sha1 can be useful for detecting brute
16984 force password attempts vs. user simply trying the same password over
16985 and over again. You can also truncate the value to n chars by appending
16986 ":n" (e.g.@: sha1:6).
16987 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
16988 @end deftypevr
16989
16990 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug?
16991 Even more verbose logging for debugging purposes. Shows for example
16992 SQL queries.
16993 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16994 @end deftypevr
16995
16996 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug-passwords?
16997 In case of password mismatches, log the passwords and used scheme so
16998 the problem can be debugged. Enabling this also enables
16999 @samp{auth-debug}.
17000 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17001 @end deftypevr
17002
17003 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-debug?
17004 Enable mail process debugging. This can help you figure out why
17005 Dovecot isn't finding your mails.
17006 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17007 @end deftypevr
17008
17009 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-ssl?
17010 Show protocol level SSL errors.
17011 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17012 @end deftypevr
17013
17014 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-timestamp
17015 Prefix for each line written to log file. % codes are in
17016 strftime(3) format.
17017 Defaults to @samp{"\"%b %d %H:%M:%S \""}.
17018 @end deftypevr
17019
17020 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-log-format-elements
17021 List of elements we want to log. The elements which have a
17022 non-empty variable value are joined together to form a comma-separated
17023 string.
17024 @end deftypevr
17025
17026 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-log-format
17027 Login log format. %s contains @samp{login-log-format-elements}
17028 string, %$ contains the data we want to log.
17029 Defaults to @samp{"%$: %s"}.
17030 @end deftypevr
17031
17032 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-log-prefix
17033 Log prefix for mail processes. See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for list
17034 of possible variables you can use.
17035 Defaults to @samp{"\"%s(%u)<%@{pid@}><%@{session@}>: \""}.
17036 @end deftypevr
17037
17038 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string deliver-log-format
17039 Format to use for logging mail deliveries. You can use variables:
17040 @table @code
17041 @item %$
17042 Delivery status message (e.g.@: @samp{saved to INBOX})
17043 @item %m
17044 Message-ID
17045 @item %s
17046 Subject
17047 @item %f
17048 From address
17049 @item %p
17050 Physical size
17051 @item %w
17052 Virtual size.
17053 @end table
17054 Defaults to @samp{"msgid=%m: %$"}.
17055 @end deftypevr
17056
17057 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-location
17058 Location for users' mailboxes. The default is empty, which means
17059 that Dovecot tries to find the mailboxes automatically. This won't work
17060 if the user doesn't yet have any mail, so you should explicitly tell
17061 Dovecot the full location.
17062
17063 If you're using mbox, giving a path to the INBOX
17064 file (e.g.@: /var/mail/%u) isn't enough. You'll also need to tell Dovecot
17065 where the other mailboxes are kept. This is called the "root mail
17066 directory", and it must be the first path given in the
17067 @samp{mail-location} setting.
17068
17069 There are a few special variables you can use, eg.:
17070
17071 @table @samp
17072 @item %u
17073 username
17074 @item %n
17075 user part in user@@domain, same as %u if there's no domain
17076 @item %d
17077 domain part in user@@domain, empty if there's no domain
17078 @item %h
17079 home director
17080 @end table
17081
17082 See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for full list. Some examples:
17083 @table @samp
17084 @item maildir:~/Maildir
17085 @item mbox:~/mail:INBOX=/var/mail/%u
17086 @item mbox:/var/mail/%d/%1n/%n:INDEX=/var/indexes/%d/%1n/%
17087 @end table
17088 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17089 @end deftypevr
17090
17091 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-uid
17092 System user and group used to access mails. If you use multiple,
17093 userdb can override these by returning uid or gid fields. You can use
17094 either numbers or names. <doc/wiki/UserIds.txt>.
17095 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17096 @end deftypevr
17097
17098 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-gid
17099
17100 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17101 @end deftypevr
17102
17103 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-privileged-group
17104 Group to enable temporarily for privileged operations. Currently
17105 this is used only with INBOX when either its initial creation or
17106 dotlocking fails. Typically this is set to "mail" to give access to
17107 /var/mail.
17108 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17109 @end deftypevr
17110
17111 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-access-groups
17112 Grant access to these supplementary groups for mail processes.
17113 Typically these are used to set up access to shared mailboxes. Note
17114 that it may be dangerous to set these if users can create
17115 symlinks (e.g.@: if "mail" group is set here, ln -s /var/mail ~/mail/var
17116 could allow a user to delete others' mailboxes, or ln -s
17117 /secret/shared/box ~/mail/mybox would allow reading it).
17118 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17119 @end deftypevr
17120
17121 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-full-filesystem-access?
17122 Allow full file system access to clients. There's no access checks
17123 other than what the operating system does for the active UID/GID. It
17124 works with both maildir and mboxes, allowing you to prefix mailboxes
17125 names with e.g.@: /path/ or ~user/.
17126 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17127 @end deftypevr
17128
17129 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mmap-disable?
17130 Don't use mmap() at all. This is required if you store indexes to
17131 shared file systems (NFS or clustered file system).
17132 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17133 @end deftypevr
17134
17135 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean dotlock-use-excl?
17136 Rely on @samp{O_EXCL} to work when creating dotlock files. NFS
17137 supports @samp{O_EXCL} since version 3, so this should be safe to use
17138 nowadays by default.
17139 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17140 @end deftypevr
17141
17142 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-fsync
17143 When to use fsync() or fdatasync() calls:
17144 @table @code
17145 @item optimized
17146 Whenever necessary to avoid losing important data
17147 @item always
17148 Useful with e.g.@: NFS when write()s are delayed
17149 @item never
17150 Never use it (best performance, but crashes can lose data).
17151 @end table
17152 Defaults to @samp{"optimized"}.
17153 @end deftypevr
17154
17155 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-storage?
17156 Mail storage exists in NFS. Set this to yes to make Dovecot flush
17157 NFS caches whenever needed. If you're using only a single mail server
17158 this isn't needed.
17159 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17160 @end deftypevr
17161
17162 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-index?
17163 Mail index files also exist in NFS. Setting this to yes requires
17164 @samp{mmap-disable? #t} and @samp{fsync-disable? #f}.
17165 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17166 @end deftypevr
17167
17168 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lock-method
17169 Locking method for index files. Alternatives are fcntl, flock and
17170 dotlock. Dotlocking uses some tricks which may create more disk I/O
17171 than other locking methods. NFS users: flock doesn't work, remember to
17172 change @samp{mmap-disable}.
17173 Defaults to @samp{"fcntl"}.
17174 @end deftypevr
17175
17176 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-temp-dir
17177 Directory in which LDA/LMTP temporarily stores incoming mails >128
17178 kB.
17179 Defaults to @samp{"/tmp"}.
17180 @end deftypevr
17181
17182 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-uid
17183 Valid UID range for users. This is mostly to make sure that users can't
17184 log in as daemons or other system users. Note that denying root logins is
17185 hardcoded to dovecot binary and can't be done even if @samp{first-valid-uid}
17186 is set to 0.
17187 Defaults to @samp{500}.
17188 @end deftypevr
17189
17190 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-uid
17191
17192 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17193 @end deftypevr
17194
17195 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-gid
17196 Valid GID range for users. Users having non-valid GID as primary group ID
17197 aren't allowed to log in. If user belongs to supplementary groups with
17198 non-valid GIDs, those groups are not set.
17199 Defaults to @samp{1}.
17200 @end deftypevr
17201
17202 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-gid
17203
17204 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17205 @end deftypevr
17206
17207 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-keyword-length
17208 Maximum allowed length for mail keyword name. It's only forced when
17209 trying to create new keywords.
17210 Defaults to @samp{50}.
17211 @end deftypevr
17212
17213 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} colon-separated-file-name-list valid-chroot-dirs
17214 List of directories under which chrooting is allowed for mail
17215 processes (i.e.@: /var/mail will allow chrooting to /var/mail/foo/bar
17216 too). This setting doesn't affect @samp{login-chroot}
17217 @samp{mail-chroot} or auth chroot settings. If this setting is empty,
17218 "/./" in home dirs are ignored. WARNING: Never add directories here
17219 which local users can modify, that may lead to root exploit. Usually
17220 this should be done only if you don't allow shell access for users.
17221 <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
17222 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17223 @end deftypevr
17224
17225 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-chroot
17226 Default chroot directory for mail processes. This can be overridden
17227 for specific users in user database by giving /./ in user's home
17228 directory (e.g.@: /home/./user chroots into /home). Note that usually
17229 there is no real need to do chrooting, Dovecot doesn't allow users to
17230 access files outside their mail directory anyway. If your home
17231 directories are prefixed with the chroot directory, append "/."@: to
17232 @samp{mail-chroot}. <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
17233 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17234 @end deftypevr
17235
17236 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-socket-path
17237 UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
17238 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
17239 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
17240 @end deftypevr
17241
17242 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-plugin-dir
17243 Directory where to look up mail plugins.
17244 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/lib/dovecot"}.
17245 @end deftypevr
17246
17247 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
17248 List of plugins to load for all services. Plugins specific to IMAP,
17249 LDA, etc.@: are added to this list in their own .conf files.
17250 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17251 @end deftypevr
17252
17253 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-cache-min-mail-count
17254 The minimum number of mails in a mailbox before updates are done to
17255 cache file. This allows optimizing Dovecot's behavior to do less disk
17256 writes at the cost of more disk reads.
17257 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17258 @end deftypevr
17259
17260 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mailbox-idle-check-interval
17261 When IDLE command is running, mailbox is checked once in a while to
17262 see if there are any new mails or other changes. This setting defines
17263 the minimum time to wait between those checks. Dovecot can also use
17264 dnotify, inotify and kqueue to find out immediately when changes
17265 occur.
17266 Defaults to @samp{"30 secs"}.
17267 @end deftypevr
17268
17269 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-save-crlf?
17270 Save mails with CR+LF instead of plain LF. This makes sending those
17271 mails take less CPU, especially with sendfile() syscall with Linux and
17272 FreeBSD. But it also creates a bit more disk I/O which may just make it
17273 slower. Also note that if other software reads the mboxes/maildirs,
17274 they may handle the extra CRs wrong and cause problems.
17275 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17276 @end deftypevr
17277
17278 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-stat-dirs?
17279 By default LIST command returns all entries in maildir beginning
17280 with a dot. Enabling this option makes Dovecot return only entries
17281 which are directories. This is done by stat()ing each entry, so it
17282 causes more disk I/O.
17283 (For systems setting struct @samp{dirent->d_type} this check is free
17284 and it's done always regardless of this setting).
17285 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17286 @end deftypevr
17287
17288 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-copy-with-hardlinks?
17289 When copying a message, do it with hard links whenever possible.
17290 This makes the performance much better, and it's unlikely to have any
17291 side effects.
17292 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17293 @end deftypevr
17294
17295 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-very-dirty-syncs?
17296 Assume Dovecot is the only MUA accessing Maildir: Scan cur/
17297 directory only when its mtime changes unexpectedly or when we can't find
17298 the mail otherwise.
17299 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17300 @end deftypevr
17301
17302 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-read-locks
17303 Which locking methods to use for locking mbox. There are four
17304 available:
17305
17306 @table @code
17307 @item dotlock
17308 Create <mailbox>.lock file. This is the oldest and most NFS-safe
17309 solution. If you want to use /var/mail/ like directory, the users will
17310 need write access to that directory.
17311 @item dotlock-try
17312 Same as dotlock, but if it fails because of permissions or because there
17313 isn't enough disk space, just skip it.
17314 @item fcntl
17315 Use this if possible. Works with NFS too if lockd is used.
17316 @item flock
17317 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
17318 @item lockf
17319 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
17320 @end table
17321
17322 You can use multiple locking methods; if you do the order they're declared
17323 in is important to avoid deadlocks if other MTAs/MUAs are using multiple
17324 locking methods as well. Some operating systems don't allow using some of
17325 them simultaneously.
17326 @end deftypevr
17327
17328 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-write-locks
17329
17330 @end deftypevr
17331
17332 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-lock-timeout
17333 Maximum time to wait for lock (all of them) before aborting.
17334 Defaults to @samp{"5 mins"}.
17335 @end deftypevr
17336
17337 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-dotlock-change-timeout
17338 If dotlock exists but the mailbox isn't modified in any way,
17339 override the lock file after this much time.
17340 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
17341 @end deftypevr
17342
17343 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-dirty-syncs?
17344 When mbox changes unexpectedly we have to fully read it to find out
17345 what changed. If the mbox is large this can take a long time. Since
17346 the change is usually just a newly appended mail, it'd be faster to
17347 simply read the new mails. If this setting is enabled, Dovecot does
17348 this but still safely fallbacks to re-reading the whole mbox file
17349 whenever something in mbox isn't how it's expected to be. The only real
17350 downside to this setting is that if some other MUA changes message
17351 flags, Dovecot doesn't notice it immediately. Note that a full sync is
17352 done with SELECT, EXAMINE, EXPUNGE and CHECK commands.
17353 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17354 @end deftypevr
17355
17356 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-very-dirty-syncs?
17357 Like @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs}, but don't do full syncs even with SELECT,
17358 EXAMINE, EXPUNGE or CHECK commands. If this is set,
17359 @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs} is ignored.
17360 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17361 @end deftypevr
17362
17363 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-lazy-writes?
17364 Delay writing mbox headers until doing a full write sync (EXPUNGE
17365 and CHECK commands and when closing the mailbox). This is especially
17366 useful for POP3 where clients often delete all mails. The downside is
17367 that our changes aren't immediately visible to other MUAs.
17368 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17369 @end deftypevr
17370
17371 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mbox-min-index-size
17372 If mbox size is smaller than this (e.g.@: 100k), don't write index
17373 files. If an index file already exists it's still read, just not
17374 updated.
17375 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17376 @end deftypevr
17377
17378 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mdbox-rotate-size
17379 Maximum dbox file size until it's rotated.
17380 Defaults to @samp{10000000}.
17381 @end deftypevr
17382
17383 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mdbox-rotate-interval
17384 Maximum dbox file age until it's rotated. Typically in days. Day
17385 begins from midnight, so 1d = today, 2d = yesterday, etc. 0 = check
17386 disabled.
17387 Defaults to @samp{"1d"}.
17388 @end deftypevr
17389
17390 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mdbox-preallocate-space?
17391 When creating new mdbox files, immediately preallocate their size to
17392 @samp{mdbox-rotate-size}. This setting currently works only in Linux
17393 with some file systems (ext4, xfs).
17394 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17395 @end deftypevr
17396
17397 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-dir
17398 sdbox and mdbox support saving mail attachments to external files,
17399 which also allows single instance storage for them. Other backends
17400 don't support this for now.
17401
17402 WARNING: This feature hasn't been tested much yet. Use at your own risk.
17403
17404 Directory root where to store mail attachments. Disabled, if empty.
17405 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17406 @end deftypevr
17407
17408 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-attachment-min-size
17409 Attachments smaller than this aren't saved externally. It's also
17410 possible to write a plugin to disable saving specific attachments
17411 externally.
17412 Defaults to @samp{128000}.
17413 @end deftypevr
17414
17415 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-fs
17416 File system backend to use for saving attachments:
17417 @table @code
17418 @item posix
17419 No SiS done by Dovecot (but this might help FS's own deduplication)
17420 @item sis posix
17421 SiS with immediate byte-by-byte comparison during saving
17422 @item sis-queue posix
17423 SiS with delayed comparison and deduplication.
17424 @end table
17425 Defaults to @samp{"sis posix"}.
17426 @end deftypevr
17427
17428 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-hash
17429 Hash format to use in attachment filenames. You can add any text and
17430 variables: @code{%@{md4@}}, @code{%@{md5@}}, @code{%@{sha1@}},
17431 @code{%@{sha256@}}, @code{%@{sha512@}}, @code{%@{size@}}. Variables can be
17432 truncated, e.g.@: @code{%@{sha256:80@}} returns only first 80 bits.
17433 Defaults to @samp{"%@{sha1@}"}.
17434 @end deftypevr
17435
17436 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-process-limit
17437
17438 Defaults to @samp{100}.
17439 @end deftypevr
17440
17441 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-client-limit
17442
17443 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
17444 @end deftypevr
17445
17446 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-vsz-limit
17447 Default VSZ (virtual memory size) limit for service processes.
17448 This is mainly intended to catch and kill processes that leak memory
17449 before they eat up everything.
17450 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
17451 @end deftypevr
17452
17453 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-login-user
17454 Login user is internally used by login processes. This is the most
17455 untrusted user in Dovecot system. It shouldn't have access to anything
17456 at all.
17457 Defaults to @samp{"dovenull"}.
17458 @end deftypevr
17459
17460 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-internal-user
17461 Internal user is used by unprivileged processes. It should be
17462 separate from login user, so that login processes can't disturb other
17463 processes.
17464 Defaults to @samp{"dovecot"}.
17465 @end deftypevr
17466
17467 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl?
17468 SSL/TLS support: yes, no, required. <doc/wiki/SSL.txt>.
17469 Defaults to @samp{"required"}.
17470 @end deftypevr
17471
17472 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert
17473 PEM encoded X.509 SSL/TLS certificate (public key).
17474 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/default.pem"}.
17475 @end deftypevr
17476
17477 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key
17478 PEM encoded SSL/TLS private key. The key is opened before
17479 dropping root privileges, so keep the key file unreadable by anyone but
17480 root.
17481 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/private/default.pem"}.
17482 @end deftypevr
17483
17484 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key-password
17485 If key file is password protected, give the password here.
17486 Alternatively give it when starting dovecot with -p parameter. Since
17487 this file is often world-readable, you may want to place this setting
17488 instead to a different.
17489 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17490 @end deftypevr
17491
17492 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca
17493 PEM encoded trusted certificate authority. Set this only if you
17494 intend to use @samp{ssl-verify-client-cert? #t}. The file should
17495 contain the CA certificate(s) followed by the matching
17496 CRL(s). (e.g.@: @samp{ssl-ca </etc/ssl/certs/ca.pem}).
17497 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17498 @end deftypevr
17499
17500 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-require-crl?
17501 Require that CRL check succeeds for client certificates.
17502 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17503 @end deftypevr
17504
17505 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-verify-client-cert?
17506 Request client to send a certificate. If you also want to require
17507 it, set @samp{auth-ssl-require-client-cert? #t} in auth section.
17508 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17509 @end deftypevr
17510
17511 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-username-field
17512 Which field from certificate to use for username. commonName and
17513 x500UniqueIdentifier are the usual choices. You'll also need to set
17514 @samp{auth-ssl-username-from-cert? #t}.
17515 Defaults to @samp{"commonName"}.
17516 @end deftypevr
17517
17518 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-min-protocol
17519 Minimum SSL protocol version to accept.
17520 Defaults to @samp{"TLSv1"}.
17521 @end deftypevr
17522
17523 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cipher-list
17524 SSL ciphers to use.
17525 Defaults to @samp{"ALL:!kRSA:!SRP:!kDHd:!DSS:!aNULL:!eNULL:!EXPORT:!DES:!3DES:!MD5:!PSK:!RC4:!ADH:!LOW@@STRENGTH"}.
17526 @end deftypevr
17527
17528 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-crypto-device
17529 SSL crypto device to use, for valid values run "openssl engine".
17530 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17531 @end deftypevr
17532
17533 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string postmaster-address
17534 Address to use when sending rejection mails.
17535 %d expands to recipient domain.
17536 Defaults to @samp{"postmaster@@%d"}.
17537 @end deftypevr
17538
17539 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string hostname
17540 Hostname to use in various parts of sent mails (e.g.@: in Message-Id)
17541 and in LMTP replies. Default is the system's real hostname@@domain.
17542 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17543 @end deftypevr
17544
17545 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean quota-full-tempfail?
17546 If user is over quota, return with temporary failure instead of
17547 bouncing the mail.
17548 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17549 @end deftypevr
17550
17551 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name sendmail-path
17552 Binary to use for sending mails.
17553 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/sbin/sendmail"}.
17554 @end deftypevr
17555
17556 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string submission-host
17557 If non-empty, send mails via this SMTP host[:port] instead of
17558 sendmail.
17559 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17560 @end deftypevr
17561
17562 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-subject
17563 Subject: header to use for rejection mails. You can use the same
17564 variables as for @samp{rejection-reason} below.
17565 Defaults to @samp{"Rejected: %s"}.
17566 @end deftypevr
17567
17568 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-reason
17569 Human readable error message for rejection mails. You can use
17570 variables:
17571
17572 @table @code
17573 @item %n
17574 CRLF
17575 @item %r
17576 reason
17577 @item %s
17578 original subject
17579 @item %t
17580 recipient
17581 @end table
17582 Defaults to @samp{"Your message to <%t> was automatically rejected:%n%r"}.
17583 @end deftypevr
17584
17585 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string recipient-delimiter
17586 Delimiter character between local-part and detail in email
17587 address.
17588 Defaults to @samp{"+"}.
17589 @end deftypevr
17590
17591 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lda-original-recipient-header
17592 Header where the original recipient address (SMTP's RCPT TO:
17593 address) is taken from if not available elsewhere. With dovecot-lda -a
17594 parameter overrides this. A commonly used header for this is
17595 X-Original-To.
17596 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17597 @end deftypevr
17598
17599 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autocreate?
17600 Should saving a mail to a nonexistent mailbox automatically create
17601 it?.
17602 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17603 @end deftypevr
17604
17605 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autosubscribe?
17606 Should automatically created mailboxes be also automatically
17607 subscribed?.
17608 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17609 @end deftypevr
17610
17611 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer imap-max-line-length
17612 Maximum IMAP command line length. Some clients generate very long
17613 command lines with huge mailboxes, so you may need to raise this if you
17614 get "Too long argument" or "IMAP command line too large" errors
17615 often.
17616 Defaults to @samp{64000}.
17617 @end deftypevr
17618
17619 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-logout-format
17620 IMAP logout format string:
17621 @table @code
17622 @item %i
17623 total number of bytes read from client
17624 @item %o
17625 total number of bytes sent to client.
17626 @end table
17627 See @file{doc/wiki/Variables.txt} for a list of all the variables you can use.
17628 Defaults to @samp{"in=%i out=%o deleted=%@{deleted@} expunged=%@{expunged@} trashed=%@{trashed@} hdr_count=%@{fetch_hdr_count@} hdr_bytes=%@{fetch_hdr_bytes@} body_count=%@{fetch_body_count@} body_bytes=%@{fetch_body_bytes@}"}.
17629 @end deftypevr
17630
17631 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-capability
17632 Override the IMAP CAPABILITY response. If the value begins with '+',
17633 add the given capabilities on top of the defaults (e.g.@: +XFOO XBAR).
17634 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17635 @end deftypevr
17636
17637 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-idle-notify-interval
17638 How long to wait between "OK Still here" notifications when client
17639 is IDLEing.
17640 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
17641 @end deftypevr
17642
17643 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-send
17644 ID field names and values to send to clients. Using * as the value
17645 makes Dovecot use the default value. The following fields have default
17646 values currently: name, version, os, os-version, support-url,
17647 support-email.
17648 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17649 @end deftypevr
17650
17651 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-log
17652 ID fields sent by client to log. * means everything.
17653 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17654 @end deftypevr
17655
17656 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list imap-client-workarounds
17657 Workarounds for various client bugs:
17658
17659 @table @code
17660 @item delay-newmail
17661 Send EXISTS/RECENT new mail notifications only when replying to NOOP and
17662 CHECK commands. Some clients ignore them otherwise, for example OSX
17663 Mail (<v2.1). Outlook Express breaks more badly though, without this it
17664 may show user "Message no longer in server" errors. Note that OE6
17665 still breaks even with this workaround if synchronization is set to
17666 "Headers Only".
17667
17668 @item tb-extra-mailbox-sep
17669 Thunderbird gets somehow confused with LAYOUT=fs (mbox and dbox) and
17670 adds extra @samp{/} suffixes to mailbox names. This option causes Dovecot to
17671 ignore the extra @samp{/} instead of treating it as invalid mailbox name.
17672
17673 @item tb-lsub-flags
17674 Show \Noselect flags for LSUB replies with LAYOUT=fs (e.g.@: mbox).
17675 This makes Thunderbird realize they aren't selectable and show them
17676 greyed out, instead of only later giving "not selectable" popup error.
17677 @end table
17678 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17679 @end deftypevr
17680
17681 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-urlauth-host
17682 Host allowed in URLAUTH URLs sent by client. "*" allows all.
17683 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17684 @end deftypevr
17685
17686
17687 Whew! Lots of configuration options. The nice thing about it though is
17688 that Guix has a complete interface to Dovecot's configuration
17689 language. This allows not only a nice way to declare configurations,
17690 but also offers reflective capabilities as well: users can write code to
17691 inspect and transform configurations from within Scheme.
17692
17693 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{dovecot.conf} up
17694 and running. In that case, you can pass an
17695 @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} as the @code{#:config} parameter to
17696 @code{dovecot-service}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
17697 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
17698
17699 Available @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} fields are:
17700
17701 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
17702 The dovecot package.
17703 @end deftypevr
17704
17705 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} string string
17706 The contents of the @code{dovecot.conf}, as a string.
17707 @end deftypevr
17708
17709 For example, if your @code{dovecot.conf} is just the empty string, you
17710 could instantiate a dovecot service like this:
17711
17712 @lisp
17713 (dovecot-service #:config
17714 (opaque-dovecot-configuration
17715 (string "")))
17716 @end lisp
17717
17718 @subsubheading OpenSMTPD Service
17719
17720 @deffn {Scheme Variable} opensmtpd-service-type
17721 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.opensmtpd.org, OpenSMTPD}
17722 service, whose value should be an @code{opensmtpd-configuration} object
17723 as in this example:
17724
17725 @lisp
17726 (service opensmtpd-service-type
17727 (opensmtpd-configuration
17728 (config-file (local-file "./my-smtpd.conf"))))
17729 @end lisp
17730 @end deffn
17731
17732 @deftp {Data Type} opensmtpd-configuration
17733 Data type representing the configuration of opensmtpd.
17734
17735 @table @asis
17736 @item @code{package} (default: @var{opensmtpd})
17737 Package object of the OpenSMTPD SMTP server.
17738
17739 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-opensmtpd-file})
17740 File-like object of the OpenSMTPD configuration file to use. By default
17741 it listens on the loopback network interface, and allows for mail from
17742 users and daemons on the local machine, as well as permitting email to
17743 remote servers. Run @command{man smtpd.conf} for more information.
17744
17745 @end table
17746 @end deftp
17747
17748 @subsubheading Exim Service
17749
17750 @cindex mail transfer agent (MTA)
17751 @cindex MTA (mail transfer agent)
17752 @cindex SMTP
17753
17754 @deffn {Scheme Variable} exim-service-type
17755 This is the type of the @uref{https://exim.org, Exim} mail transfer
17756 agent (MTA), whose value should be an @code{exim-configuration} object
17757 as in this example:
17758
17759 @lisp
17760 (service exim-service-type
17761 (exim-configuration
17762 (config-file (local-file "./my-exim.conf"))))
17763 @end lisp
17764 @end deffn
17765
17766 In order to use an @code{exim-service-type} service you must also have a
17767 @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service present in your
17768 @code{operating-system} (even if it has no aliases).
17769
17770 @deftp {Data Type} exim-configuration
17771 Data type representing the configuration of exim.
17772
17773 @table @asis
17774 @item @code{package} (default: @var{exim})
17775 Package object of the Exim server.
17776
17777 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
17778 File-like object of the Exim configuration file to use. If its value is
17779 @code{#f} then use the default configuration file from the package
17780 provided in @code{package}. The resulting configuration file is loaded
17781 after setting the @code{exim_user} and @code{exim_group} configuration
17782 variables.
17783
17784 @end table
17785 @end deftp
17786
17787 @subsubheading Getmail service
17788
17789 @cindex IMAP
17790 @cindex POP
17791
17792 @deffn {Scheme Variable} getmail-service-type
17793 This is the type of the @uref{http://pyropus.ca/software/getmail/, Getmail}
17794 mail retriever, whose value should be an @code{getmail-configuration}.
17795 @end deffn
17796
17797 Available @code{getmail-configuration} fields are:
17798
17799 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} symbol name
17800 A symbol to identify the getmail service.
17801
17802 Defaults to @samp{"unset"}.
17803
17804 @end deftypevr
17805
17806 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} package package
17807 The getmail package to use.
17808
17809 @end deftypevr
17810
17811 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string user
17812 The user to run getmail as.
17813
17814 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
17815
17816 @end deftypevr
17817
17818 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string group
17819 The group to run getmail as.
17820
17821 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
17822
17823 @end deftypevr
17824
17825 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string directory
17826 The getmail directory to use.
17827
17828 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/getmail/default"}.
17829
17830 @end deftypevr
17831
17832 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} getmail-configuration-file rcfile
17833 The getmail configuration file to use.
17834
17835 Available @code{getmail-configuration-file} fields are:
17836
17837 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-retriever-configuration retriever
17838 What mail account to retrieve mail from, and how to access that account.
17839
17840 Available @code{getmail-retriever-configuration} fields are:
17841
17842 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string type
17843 The type of mail retriever to use. Valid values include @samp{passwd}
17844 and @samp{static}.
17845
17846 Defaults to @samp{"SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever"}.
17847
17848 @end deftypevr
17849
17850 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string server
17851 Username to login to the mail server with.
17852
17853 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
17854
17855 @end deftypevr
17856
17857 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string username
17858 Username to login to the mail server with.
17859
17860 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
17861
17862 @end deftypevr
17863
17864 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
17865 Port number to connect to.
17866
17867 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17868
17869 @end deftypevr
17870
17871 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string password
17872 Override fields from passwd.
17873
17874 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17875
17876 @end deftypevr
17877
17878 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} list password-command
17879 Override fields from passwd.
17880
17881 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17882
17883 @end deftypevr
17884
17885 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string keyfile
17886 PEM-formatted key file to use for the TLS negotiation.
17887
17888 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17889
17890 @end deftypevr
17891
17892 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string certfile
17893 PEM-formatted certificate file to use for the TLS negotiation.
17894
17895 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17896
17897 @end deftypevr
17898
17899 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string ca-certs
17900 CA certificates to use.
17901
17902 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17903
17904 @end deftypevr
17905
17906 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
17907 Extra retriever parameters.
17908
17909 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17910
17911 @end deftypevr
17912
17913 @end deftypevr
17914
17915 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-destination-configuration destination
17916 What to do with retrieved messages.
17917
17918 Available @code{getmail-destination-configuration} fields are:
17919
17920 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string type
17921 The type of mail destination. Valid values include @samp{Maildir},
17922 @samp{Mboxrd} and @samp{MDA_external}.
17923
17924 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
17925
17926 @end deftypevr
17927
17928 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string-or-filelike path
17929 The path option for the mail destination. The behaviour depends on the
17930 chosen type.
17931
17932 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17933
17934 @end deftypevr
17935
17936 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
17937 Extra destination parameters
17938
17939 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17940
17941 @end deftypevr
17942
17943 @end deftypevr
17944
17945 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-options-configuration options
17946 Configure getmail.
17947
17948 Available @code{getmail-options-configuration} fields are:
17949
17950 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer verbose
17951 If set to @samp{0}, getmail will only print warnings and errors. A
17952 value of @samp{1} means that messages will be printed about retrieving
17953 and deleting messages. If set to @samp{2}, getmail will print messages
17954 about each of it's actions.
17955
17956 Defaults to @samp{1}.
17957
17958 @end deftypevr
17959
17960 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean read-all
17961 If true, getmail will retrieve all available messages. Otherwise it
17962 will only retrieve messages it hasn't seen previously.
17963
17964 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17965
17966 @end deftypevr
17967
17968 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delete
17969 If set to true, messages will be deleted from the server after
17970 retrieving and successfully delivering them. Otherwise, messages will
17971 be left on the server.
17972
17973 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17974
17975 @end deftypevr
17976
17977 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-after
17978 Getmail will delete messages this number of days after seeing them, if
17979 they have been delivered. This means messages will be left on the
17980 server this number of days after delivering them. A value of @samp{0}
17981 disabled this feature.
17982
17983 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17984
17985 @end deftypevr
17986
17987 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-bigger-than
17988 Delete messages larger than this of bytes after retrieving them, even if
17989 the delete and delete-after options are disabled. A value of @samp{0}
17990 disables this feature.
17991
17992 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17993
17994 @end deftypevr
17995
17996 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-bytes-per-session
17997 Retrieve messages totalling up to this number of bytes before closing
17998 the session with the server. A value of @samp{0} disables this feature.
17999
18000 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18001
18002 @end deftypevr
18003
18004 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-message-size
18005 Don't retrieve messages larger than this number of bytes. A value of
18006 @samp{0} disables this feature.
18007
18008 Defaults to @samp{0}.
18009
18010 @end deftypevr
18011
18012 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delivered-to
18013 If true, getmail will add a Delivered-To header to messages.
18014
18015 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18016
18017 @end deftypevr
18018
18019 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean received
18020 If set, getmail adds a Received header to the messages.
18021
18022 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
18023
18024 @end deftypevr
18025
18026 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} string message-log
18027 Getmail will record a log of its actions to the named file. A value of
18028 @samp{""} disables this feature.
18029
18030 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18031
18032 @end deftypevr
18033
18034 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-syslog
18035 If true, getmail will record a log of its actions using the system
18036 logger.
18037
18038 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18039
18040 @end deftypevr
18041
18042 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-verbose
18043 If true, getmail will log information about messages not retrieved and
18044 the reason for not retrieving them, as well as starting and ending
18045 information lines.
18046
18047 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18048
18049 @end deftypevr
18050
18051 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
18052 Extra options to include.
18053
18054 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18055
18056 @end deftypevr
18057
18058 @end deftypevr
18059
18060 @end deftypevr
18061
18062 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list idle
18063 A list of mailboxes that getmail should wait on the server for new mail
18064 notifications. This depends on the server supporting the IDLE
18065 extension.
18066
18067 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18068
18069 @end deftypevr
18070
18071 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list environment-variables
18072 Environment variables to set for getmail.
18073
18074 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18075
18076 @end deftypevr
18077
18078 @subsubheading Mail Aliases Service
18079
18080 @cindex email aliases
18081 @cindex aliases, for email addresses
18082
18083 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mail-aliases-service-type
18084 This is the type of the service which provides @code{/etc/aliases},
18085 specifying how to deliver mail to users on this system.
18086
18087 @lisp
18088 (service mail-aliases-service-type
18089 '(("postmaster" "bob")
18090 ("bob" "bob@@example.com" "bob@@example2.com")))
18091 @end lisp
18092 @end deffn
18093
18094 The configuration for a @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service is an
18095 association list denoting how to deliver mail that comes to this
18096 system. Each entry is of the form @code{(alias addresses ...)}, with
18097 @code{alias} specifying the local alias and @code{addresses} specifying
18098 where to deliver this user's mail.
18099
18100 The aliases aren't required to exist as users on the local system. In
18101 the above example, there doesn't need to be a @code{postmaster} entry in
18102 the @code{operating-system}'s @code{user-accounts} in order to deliver
18103 the @code{postmaster} mail to @code{bob} (which subsequently would
18104 deliver mail to @code{bob@@example.com} and @code{bob@@example2.com}).
18105
18106 @subsubheading GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
18107 @cindex GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
18108
18109 @deffn {Scheme Variable} imap4d-service-type
18110 This is the type of the GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon (@pxref{imap4d,,,
18111 mailutils, GNU Mailutils Manual}), whose value should be an
18112 @code{imap4d-configuration} object as in this example:
18113
18114 @lisp
18115 (service imap4d-service-type
18116 (imap4d-configuration
18117 (config-file (local-file "imap4d.conf"))))
18118 @end lisp
18119 @end deffn
18120
18121 @deftp {Data Type} imap4d-configuration
18122 Data type representing the configuration of @command{imap4d}.
18123
18124 @table @asis
18125 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mailutils})
18126 The package that provides @command{imap4d}.
18127
18128 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-imap4d-config-file})
18129 File-like object of the configuration file to use, by default it will listen
18130 on TCP port 143 of @code{localhost}. @xref{Conf-imap4d,,, mailutils, GNU
18131 Mailutils Manual}, for details.
18132
18133 @end table
18134 @end deftp
18135
18136 @node Messaging Services
18137 @subsection Messaging Services
18138
18139 @cindex messaging
18140 @cindex jabber
18141 @cindex XMPP
18142 The @code{(gnu services messaging)} module provides Guix service
18143 definitions for messaging services: currently only Prosody is supported.
18144
18145 @subsubheading Prosody Service
18146
18147 @deffn {Scheme Variable} prosody-service-type
18148 This is the type for the @uref{https://prosody.im, Prosody XMPP
18149 communication server}. Its value must be a @code{prosody-configuration}
18150 record as in this example:
18151
18152 @lisp
18153 (service prosody-service-type
18154 (prosody-configuration
18155 (modules-enabled (cons "groups" "mam" %default-modules-enabled))
18156 (int-components
18157 (list
18158 (int-component-configuration
18159 (hostname "conference.example.net")
18160 (plugin "muc")
18161 (mod-muc (mod-muc-configuration)))))
18162 (virtualhosts
18163 (list
18164 (virtualhost-configuration
18165 (domain "example.net"))))))
18166 @end lisp
18167
18168 See below for details about @code{prosody-configuration}.
18169
18170 @end deffn
18171
18172 By default, Prosody does not need much configuration. Only one
18173 @code{virtualhosts} field is needed: it specifies the domain you wish
18174 Prosody to serve.
18175
18176 You can perform various sanity checks on the generated configuration
18177 with the @code{prosodyctl check} command.
18178
18179 Prosodyctl will also help you to import certificates from the
18180 @code{letsencrypt} directory so that the @code{prosody} user can access
18181 them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/letsencrypt}.
18182
18183 @example
18184 prosodyctl --root cert import /etc/letsencrypt/live
18185 @end example
18186
18187 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
18188 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
18189 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
18190 strings. Types starting with @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't
18191 show up in @code{prosody.cfg.lua} when their value is @code{'disabled}.
18192
18193 There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string, if you
18194 have an old @code{prosody.cfg.lua} file that you want to port over from
18195 some other system; see the end for more details.
18196
18197 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
18198 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a file name.
18199
18200 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
18201 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services messaging). Manually maintained
18202 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
18203 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
18204 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
18205 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
18206 @c the churn as Prosody updates.
18207
18208 Available @code{prosody-configuration} fields are:
18209
18210 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
18211 The Prosody package.
18212 @end deftypevr
18213
18214 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name data-path
18215 Location of the Prosody data storage directory. See
18216 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure}.
18217 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody"}.
18218 @end deftypevr
18219
18220 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object-list plugin-paths
18221 Additional plugin directories. They are searched in all the specified
18222 paths in order. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/plugins_directory}.
18223 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18224 @end deftypevr
18225
18226 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name certificates
18227 Every virtual host and component needs a certificate so that clients and
18228 servers can securely verify its identity. Prosody will automatically load
18229 certificates/keys from the directory specified here.
18230 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/prosody/certs"}.
18231 @end deftypevr
18232
18233 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list admins
18234 This is a list of accounts that are admins for the server. Note that you
18235 must create the accounts separately. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/admins} and
18236 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
18237 Example: @code{(admins '("user1@@example.com" "user2@@example.net"))}
18238 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18239 @end deftypevr
18240
18241 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean use-libevent?
18242 Enable use of libevent for better performance under high load. See
18243 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/libevent}.
18244 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18245 @end deftypevr
18246
18247 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} module-list modules-enabled
18248 This is the list of modules Prosody will load on startup. It looks for
18249 @code{mod_modulename.lua} in the plugins folder, so make sure that exists too.
18250 Documentation on modules can be found at:
18251 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules}.
18252 Defaults to @samp{("roster" "saslauth" "tls" "dialback" "disco" "carbons" "private" "blocklist" "vcard" "version" "uptime" "time" "ping" "pep" "register" "admin_adhoc")}.
18253 @end deftypevr
18254
18255 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list modules-disabled
18256 @samp{"offline"}, @samp{"c2s"} and @samp{"s2s"} are auto-loaded, but
18257 should you want to disable them then add them to this list.
18258 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18259 @end deftypevr
18260
18261 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object groups-file
18262 Path to a text file where the shared groups are defined. If this path is
18263 empty then @samp{mod_groups} does nothing. See
18264 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_groups}.
18265 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody/sharedgroups.txt"}.
18266 @end deftypevr
18267
18268 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean allow-registration?
18269 Disable account creation by default, for security. See
18270 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
18271 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18272 @end deftypevr
18273
18274 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-configuration ssl
18275 These are the SSL/TLS-related settings. Most of them are disabled so to
18276 use Prosody's defaults. If you do not completely understand these options, do
18277 not add them to your config, it is easy to lower the security of your server
18278 using them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/advanced_ssl_config}.
18279
18280 Available @code{ssl-configuration} fields are:
18281
18282 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string protocol
18283 This determines what handshake to use.
18284 @end deftypevr
18285
18286 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name key
18287 Path to your private key file.
18288 @end deftypevr
18289
18290 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name certificate
18291 Path to your certificate file.
18292 @end deftypevr
18293
18294 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} file-object capath
18295 Path to directory containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to
18296 trust when verifying the certificates of remote servers.
18297 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
18298 @end deftypevr
18299
18300 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-object cafile
18301 Path to a file containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to trust.
18302 Similar to @code{capath} but with all certificates concatenated together.
18303 @end deftypevr
18304
18305 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verify
18306 A list of verification options (these mostly map to OpenSSL's
18307 @code{set_verify()} flags).
18308 @end deftypevr
18309
18310 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list options
18311 A list of general options relating to SSL/TLS. These map to OpenSSL's
18312 @code{set_options()}. For a full list of options available in LuaSec, see the
18313 LuaSec source.
18314 @end deftypevr
18315
18316 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer depth
18317 How long a chain of certificate authorities to check when looking for a
18318 trusted root certificate.
18319 @end deftypevr
18320
18321 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ciphers
18322 An OpenSSL cipher string. This selects what ciphers Prosody will offer to
18323 clients, and in what order.
18324 @end deftypevr
18325
18326 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name dhparam
18327 A path to a file containing parameters for Diffie-Hellman key exchange. You
18328 can create such a file with:
18329 @code{openssl dhparam -out /etc/prosody/certs/dh-2048.pem 2048}
18330 @end deftypevr
18331
18332 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string curve
18333 Curve for Elliptic curve Diffie-Hellman. Prosody's default is
18334 @samp{"secp384r1"}.
18335 @end deftypevr
18336
18337 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verifyext
18338 A list of "extra" verification options.
18339 @end deftypevr
18340
18341 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string password
18342 Password for encrypted private keys.
18343 @end deftypevr
18344
18345 @end deftypevr
18346
18347 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean c2s-require-encryption?
18348 Whether to force all client-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
18349 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
18350 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18351 @end deftypevr
18352
18353 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list disable-sasl-mechanisms
18354 Set of mechanisms that will never be offered. See
18355 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_saslauth}.
18356 Defaults to @samp{("DIGEST-MD5")}.
18357 @end deftypevr
18358
18359 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-require-encryption?
18360 Whether to force all server-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
18361 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
18362 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18363 @end deftypevr
18364
18365 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-secure-auth?
18366 Whether to require encryption and certificate authentication. This
18367 provides ideal security, but requires servers you communicate with to support
18368 encryption AND present valid, trusted certificates. See
18369 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
18370 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18371 @end deftypevr
18372
18373 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-insecure-domains
18374 Many servers don't support encryption or have invalid or self-signed
18375 certificates. You can list domains here that will not be required to
18376 authenticate using certificates. They will be authenticated using DNS. See
18377 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
18378 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18379 @end deftypevr
18380
18381 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-secure-domains
18382 Even if you leave @code{s2s-secure-auth?} disabled, you can still require
18383 valid certificates for some domains by specifying a list here. See
18384 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
18385 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18386 @end deftypevr
18387
18388 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string authentication
18389 Select the authentication backend to use. The default provider stores
18390 passwords in plaintext and uses Prosody's configured data storage to store the
18391 authentication data. If you do not trust your server please see
18392 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_auth_internal_hashed} for information
18393 about using the hashed backend. See also
18394 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/authentication}
18395 Defaults to @samp{"internal_plain"}.
18396 @end deftypevr
18397
18398 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string log
18399 Set logging options. Advanced logging configuration is not yet supported
18400 by the Prosody service. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/logging}.
18401 Defaults to @samp{"*syslog"}.
18402 @end deftypevr
18403
18404 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name pidfile
18405 File to write pid in. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_posix}.
18406 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/prosody/prosody.pid"}.
18407 @end deftypevr
18408
18409 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer http-max-content-size
18410 Maximum allowed size of the HTTP body (in bytes).
18411 @end deftypevr
18412
18413 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string http-external-url
18414 Some modules expose their own URL in various ways. This URL is built
18415 from the protocol, host and port used. If Prosody sits behind a proxy, the
18416 public URL will be @code{http-external-url} instead. See
18417 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/http#external_url}.
18418 @end deftypevr
18419
18420 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} virtualhost-configuration-list virtualhosts
18421 A host in Prosody is a domain on which user accounts can be created. For
18422 example if you want your users to have addresses like
18423 @samp{"john.smith@@example.com"} then you need to add a host
18424 @samp{"example.com"}. All options in this list will apply only to this host.
18425
18426 Note: the name "virtual" host is used in configuration to avoid confusion with
18427 the actual physical host that Prosody is installed on. A single Prosody
18428 instance can serve many domains, each one defined as a VirtualHost entry in
18429 Prosody's configuration. Conversely a server that hosts a single domain would
18430 have just one VirtualHost entry.
18431
18432 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure#virtual_host_settings}.
18433
18434 Available @code{virtualhost-configuration} fields are:
18435
18436 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
18437 @deftypevr {@code{virtualhost-configuration} parameter} string domain
18438 Domain you wish Prosody to serve.
18439 @end deftypevr
18440
18441 @end deftypevr
18442
18443 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} int-component-configuration-list int-components
18444 Components are extra services on a server which are available to clients,
18445 usually on a subdomain of the main server (such as
18446 @samp{"mycomponent.example.com"}). Example components might be chatroom
18447 servers, user directories, or gateways to other protocols.
18448
18449 Internal components are implemented with Prosody-specific plugins. To add an
18450 internal component, you simply fill the hostname field, and the plugin you wish
18451 to use for the component.
18452
18453 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
18454 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18455
18456 Available @code{int-component-configuration} fields are:
18457
18458 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
18459 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
18460 Hostname of the component.
18461 @end deftypevr
18462
18463 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string plugin
18464 Plugin you wish to use for the component.
18465 @end deftypevr
18466
18467 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} maybe-mod-muc-configuration mod-muc
18468 Multi-user chat (MUC) is Prosody's module for allowing you to create
18469 hosted chatrooms/conferences for XMPP users.
18470
18471 General information on setting up and using multi-user chatrooms can be found
18472 in the "Chatrooms" documentation (@url{https://prosody.im/doc/chatrooms}),
18473 which you should read if you are new to XMPP chatrooms.
18474
18475 See also @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_muc}.
18476
18477 Available @code{mod-muc-configuration} fields are:
18478
18479 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string name
18480 The name to return in service discovery responses.
18481 Defaults to @samp{"Prosody Chatrooms"}.
18482 @end deftypevr
18483
18484 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string-or-boolean restrict-room-creation
18485 If @samp{#t}, this will only allow admins to create new chatrooms.
18486 Otherwise anyone can create a room. The value @samp{"local"} restricts room
18487 creation to users on the service's parent domain. E.g.@: @samp{user@@example.com}
18488 can create rooms on @samp{rooms.example.com}. The value @samp{"admin"}
18489 restricts to service administrators only.
18490 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18491 @end deftypevr
18492
18493 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-history-messages
18494 Maximum number of history messages that will be sent to the member that has
18495 just joined the room.
18496 Defaults to @samp{20}.
18497 @end deftypevr
18498
18499 @end deftypevr
18500
18501 @end deftypevr
18502
18503 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} ext-component-configuration-list ext-components
18504 External components use XEP-0114, which most standalone components
18505 support. To add an external component, you simply fill the hostname field. See
18506 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
18507 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18508
18509 Available @code{ext-component-configuration} fields are:
18510
18511 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
18512 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string component-secret
18513 Password which the component will use to log in.
18514 @end deftypevr
18515
18516 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
18517 Hostname of the component.
18518 @end deftypevr
18519
18520 @end deftypevr
18521
18522 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer-list component-ports
18523 Port(s) Prosody listens on for component connections.
18524 Defaults to @samp{(5347)}.
18525 @end deftypevr
18526
18527 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string component-interface
18528 Interface Prosody listens on for component connections.
18529 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
18530 @end deftypevr
18531
18532 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-raw-content raw-content
18533 Raw content that will be added to the configuration file.
18534 @end deftypevr
18535
18536 It could be that you just want to get a @code{prosody.cfg.lua}
18537 up and running. In that case, you can pass an
18538 @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} record as the value of
18539 @code{prosody-service-type}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
18540 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
18541 Available @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} fields are:
18542
18543 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
18544 The prosody package.
18545 @end deftypevr
18546
18547 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} string prosody.cfg.lua
18548 The contents of the @code{prosody.cfg.lua} to use.
18549 @end deftypevr
18550
18551 For example, if your @code{prosody.cfg.lua} is just the empty
18552 string, you could instantiate a prosody service like this:
18553
18554 @lisp
18555 (service prosody-service-type
18556 (opaque-prosody-configuration
18557 (prosody.cfg.lua "")))
18558 @end lisp
18559
18560 @c end of Prosody auto-generated documentation
18561
18562 @subsubheading BitlBee Service
18563
18564 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
18565 @cindex IRC gateway
18566 @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} is a gateway that provides an IRC
18567 interface to a variety of messaging protocols such as XMPP.
18568
18569 @defvr {Scheme Variable} bitlbee-service-type
18570 This is the service type for the @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} IRC
18571 gateway daemon. Its value is a @code{bitlbee-configuration} (see
18572 below).
18573
18574 To have BitlBee listen on port 6667 on localhost, add this line to your
18575 services:
18576
18577 @lisp
18578 (service bitlbee-service-type)
18579 @end lisp
18580 @end defvr
18581
18582 @deftp {Data Type} bitlbee-configuration
18583 This is the configuration for BitlBee, with the following fields:
18584
18585 @table @asis
18586 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
18587 @itemx @code{port} (default: @code{6667})
18588 Listen on the network interface corresponding to the IP address
18589 specified in @var{interface}, on @var{port}.
18590
18591 When @var{interface} is @code{127.0.0.1}, only local clients can
18592 connect; when it is @code{0.0.0.0}, connections can come from any
18593 networking interface.
18594
18595 @item @code{bitlbee} (default: @code{bitlbee})
18596 The BitlBee package to use.
18597
18598 @item @code{plugins} (default: @code{'()})
18599 List of plugin packages to use---e.g., @code{bitlbee-discord}.
18600
18601 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
18602 Configuration snippet added as-is to the BitlBee configuration file.
18603 @end table
18604 @end deftp
18605
18606 @subsubheading Quassel Service
18607
18608 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
18609 @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel} is a distributed IRC client,
18610 meaning that one or more clients can attach to and detach from the
18611 central core.
18612
18613 @defvr {Scheme Variable} quassel-service-type
18614 This is the service type for the @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel}
18615 IRC backend daemon. Its value is a @code{quassel-configuration}
18616 (see below).
18617 @end defvr
18618
18619 @deftp {Data Type} quassel-configuration
18620 This is the configuration for Quassel, with the following fields:
18621
18622 @table @asis
18623 @item @code{quassel} (default: @code{quassel})
18624 The Quassel package to use.
18625
18626 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"::,0.0.0.0"})
18627 @item @code{port} (default: @code{4242})
18628 Listen on the network interface(s) corresponding to the IPv4 or IPv6
18629 interfaces specified in the comma delimited @var{interface}, on
18630 @var{port}.
18631
18632 @item @code{loglevel} (default: @code{"Info"})
18633 The level of logging desired. Accepted values are Debug, Info, Warning
18634 and Error.
18635 @end table
18636 @end deftp
18637
18638 @node Telephony Services
18639 @subsection Telephony Services
18640
18641 @cindex Murmur (VoIP server)
18642 @cindex VoIP server
18643 This section describes how to set up and run a Murmur server. Murmur is
18644 the server of the @uref{https://mumble.info, Mumble} voice-over-IP
18645 (VoIP) suite.
18646
18647 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-configuration
18648 The service type for the Murmur server. An example configuration can
18649 look like this:
18650
18651 @lisp
18652 (service murmur-service-type
18653 (murmur-configuration
18654 (welcome-text
18655 "Welcome to this Mumble server running on Guix!")
18656 (cert-required? #t) ;disallow text password logins
18657 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/fullchain.pem")
18658 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/privkey.pem")))
18659 @end lisp
18660
18661 After reconfiguring your system, you can manually set the murmur @code{SuperUser}
18662 password with the command that is printed during the activation phase.
18663
18664 It is recommended to register a normal Mumble user account
18665 and grant it admin or moderator rights.
18666 You can use the @code{mumble} client to
18667 login as new normal user, register yourself, and log out.
18668 For the next step login with the name @code{SuperUser} use
18669 the @code{SuperUser} password that you set previously,
18670 and grant your newly registered mumble user administrator or moderator
18671 rights and create some channels.
18672
18673 Available @code{murmur-configuration} fields are:
18674
18675 @table @asis
18676 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mumble})
18677 Package that contains @code{bin/murmurd}.
18678
18679 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"murmur"})
18680 User who will run the Murmur server.
18681
18682 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"murmur"})
18683 Group of the user who will run the murmur server.
18684
18685 @item @code{port} (default: @code{64738})
18686 Port on which the server will listen.
18687
18688 @item @code{welcome-text} (default: @code{""})
18689 Welcome text sent to clients when they connect.
18690
18691 @item @code{server-password} (default: @code{""})
18692 Password the clients have to enter in order to connect.
18693
18694 @item @code{max-users} (default: @code{100})
18695 Maximum of users that can be connected to the server at once.
18696
18697 @item @code{max-user-bandwidth} (default: @code{#f})
18698 Maximum voice traffic a user can send per second.
18699
18700 @item @code{database-file} (default: @code{"/var/lib/murmur/db.sqlite"})
18701 File name of the sqlite database.
18702 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
18703
18704 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/murmur/murmur.log"})
18705 File name of the log file.
18706 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
18707
18708 @item @code{autoban-attempts} (default: @code{10})
18709 Maximum number of logins a user can make in @code{autoban-timeframe}
18710 without getting auto banned for @code{autoban-time}.
18711
18712 @item @code{autoban-timeframe} (default: @code{120})
18713 Timeframe for autoban in seconds.
18714
18715 @item @code{autoban-time} (default: @code{300})
18716 Amount of time in seconds for which a client gets banned
18717 when violating the autoban limits.
18718
18719 @item @code{opus-threshold} (default: @code{100})
18720 Percentage of clients that need to support opus
18721 before switching over to opus audio codec.
18722
18723 @item @code{channel-nesting-limit} (default: @code{10})
18724 How deep channels can be nested at maximum.
18725
18726 @item @code{channelname-regex} (default: @code{#f})
18727 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that channel names must conform to.
18728
18729 @item @code{username-regex} (default: @code{#f})
18730 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that user names must conform to.
18731
18732 @item @code{text-message-length} (default: @code{5000})
18733 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one text chat message.
18734
18735 @item @code{image-message-length} (default: @code{(* 128 1024)})
18736 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one image message.
18737
18738 @item @code{cert-required?} (default: @code{#f})
18739 If it is set to @code{#t} clients that use weak password authentication
18740 will not be accepted. Users must have completed the certificate wizard to join.
18741
18742 @item @code{remember-channel?} (default: @code{#f})
18743 Should murmur remember the last channel each user was in when they disconnected
18744 and put them into the remembered channel when they rejoin.
18745
18746 @item @code{allow-html?} (default: @code{#f})
18747 Should html be allowed in text messages, user comments, and channel descriptions.
18748
18749 @item @code{allow-ping?} (default: @code{#f})
18750 Setting to true exposes the current user count, the maximum user count, and
18751 the server's maximum bandwidth per client to unauthenticated users. In the
18752 Mumble client, this information is shown in the Connect dialog.
18753
18754 Disabling this setting will prevent public listing of the server.
18755
18756 @item @code{bonjour?} (default: @code{#f})
18757 Should the server advertise itself in the local network through the bonjour protocol.
18758
18759 @item @code{send-version?} (default: @code{#f})
18760 Should the murmur server version be exposed in ping requests.
18761
18762 @item @code{log-days} (default: @code{31})
18763 Murmur also stores logs in the database, which are accessible via RPC.
18764 The default is 31 days of months, but you can set this setting to 0 to keep logs forever,
18765 or -1 to disable logging to the database.
18766
18767 @item @code{obfuscate-ips?} (default: @code{#t})
18768 Should logged ips be obfuscated to protect the privacy of users.
18769
18770 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @code{#f})
18771 File name of the SSL/TLS certificate used for encrypted connections.
18772
18773 @lisp
18774 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/fullchain.pem")
18775 @end lisp
18776 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @code{#f})
18777 Filepath to the ssl private key used for encrypted connections.
18778 @lisp
18779 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/privkey.pem")
18780 @end lisp
18781
18782 @item @code{ssl-dh-params} (default: @code{#f})
18783 File name of a PEM-encoded file with Diffie-Hellman parameters
18784 for the SSL/TLS encryption. Alternatively you set it to
18785 @code{"@@ffdhe2048"}, @code{"@@ffdhe3072"}, @code{"@@ffdhe4096"}, @code{"@@ffdhe6144"}
18786 or @code{"@@ffdhe8192"} to use bundled parameters from RFC 7919.
18787
18788 @item @code{ssl-ciphers} (default: @code{#f})
18789 The @code{ssl-ciphers} option chooses the cipher suites to make available for use
18790 in SSL/TLS.
18791
18792 This option is specified using
18793 @uref{https://www.openssl.org/docs/apps/ciphers.html#CIPHER-LIST-FORMAT,
18794 OpenSSL cipher list notation}.
18795
18796 It is recommended that you try your cipher string using 'openssl ciphers <string>'
18797 before setting it here, to get a feel for which cipher suites you will get.
18798 After setting this option, it is recommend that you inspect your Murmur log
18799 to ensure that Murmur is using the cipher suites that you expected it to.
18800
18801 Note: Changing this option may impact the backwards compatibility of your
18802 Murmur server, and can remove the ability for older Mumble clients to be able
18803 to connect to it.
18804
18805 @item @code{public-registration} (default: @code{#f})
18806 Must be a @code{<murmur-public-registration-configuration>} record or @code{#f}.
18807
18808 You can optionally register your server in the public server list that the
18809 @code{mumble} client shows on startup.
18810 You cannot register your server if you have set a @code{server-password},
18811 or set @code{allow-ping} to @code{#f}.
18812
18813 It might take a few hours until it shows up in the public list.
18814
18815 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
18816 Optional alternative override for this configuration.
18817 @end table
18818 @end deftp
18819
18820 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-public-registration-configuration
18821 Configuration for public registration of a murmur service.
18822
18823 @table @asis
18824 @item @code{name}
18825 This is a display name for your server. Not to be confused with the hostname.
18826
18827 @item @code{password}
18828 A password to identify your registration.
18829 Subsequent updates will need the same password. Don't lose your password.
18830
18831 @item @code{url}
18832 This should be a @code{http://} or @code{https://} link to your web
18833 site.
18834
18835 @item @code{hostname} (default: @code{#f})
18836 By default your server will be listed by its IP address.
18837 If it is set your server will be linked by this host name instead.
18838 @end table
18839 @end deftp
18840
18841
18842
18843 @node Monitoring Services
18844 @subsection Monitoring Services
18845
18846 @subsubheading Tailon Service
18847
18848 @uref{https://tailon.readthedocs.io/, Tailon} is a web application for
18849 viewing and searching log files.
18850
18851 The following example will configure the service with default values.
18852 By default, Tailon can be accessed on port 8080 (@code{http://localhost:8080}).
18853
18854 @lisp
18855 (service tailon-service-type)
18856 @end lisp
18857
18858 The following example customises more of the Tailon configuration,
18859 adding @command{sed} to the list of allowed commands.
18860
18861 @lisp
18862 (service tailon-service-type
18863 (tailon-configuration
18864 (config-file
18865 (tailon-configuration-file
18866 (allowed-commands '("tail" "grep" "awk" "sed"))))))
18867 @end lisp
18868
18869
18870 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration
18871 Data type representing the configuration of Tailon.
18872 This type has the following parameters:
18873
18874 @table @asis
18875 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(tailon-configuration-file)})
18876 The configuration file to use for Tailon. This can be set to a
18877 @dfn{tailon-configuration-file} record value, or any gexp
18878 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
18879
18880 For example, to instead use a local file, the @code{local-file} function
18881 can be used:
18882
18883 @lisp
18884 (service tailon-service-type
18885 (tailon-configuration
18886 (config-file (local-file "./my-tailon.conf"))))
18887 @end lisp
18888
18889 @item @code{package} (default: @code{tailon})
18890 The tailon package to use.
18891
18892 @end table
18893 @end deftp
18894
18895 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration-file
18896 Data type representing the configuration options for Tailon.
18897 This type has the following parameters:
18898
18899 @table @asis
18900 @item @code{files} (default: @code{(list "/var/log")})
18901 List of files to display. The list can include strings for a single file
18902 or directory, or a list, where the first item is the name of a
18903 subsection, and the remaining items are the files or directories in that
18904 subsection.
18905
18906 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
18907 Address and port to which Tailon should bind on.
18908
18909 @item @code{relative-root} (default: @code{#f})
18910 URL path to use for Tailon, set to @code{#f} to not use a path.
18911
18912 @item @code{allow-transfers?} (default: @code{#t})
18913 Allow downloading the log files in the web interface.
18914
18915 @item @code{follow-names?} (default: @code{#t})
18916 Allow tailing of not-yet existent files.
18917
18918 @item @code{tail-lines} (default: @code{200})
18919 Number of lines to read initially from each file.
18920
18921 @item @code{allowed-commands} (default: @code{(list "tail" "grep" "awk")})
18922 Commands to allow running. By default, @code{sed} is disabled.
18923
18924 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
18925 Set @code{debug?} to @code{#t} to show debug messages.
18926
18927 @item @code{wrap-lines} (default: @code{#t})
18928 Initial line wrapping state in the web interface. Set to @code{#t} to
18929 initially wrap lines (the default), or to @code{#f} to initially not
18930 wrap lines.
18931
18932 @item @code{http-auth} (default: @code{#f})
18933 HTTP authentication type to use. Set to @code{#f} to disable
18934 authentication (the default). Supported values are @code{"digest"} or
18935 @code{"basic"}.
18936
18937 @item @code{users} (default: @code{#f})
18938 If HTTP authentication is enabled (see @code{http-auth}), access will be
18939 restricted to the credentials provided here. To configure users, use a
18940 list of pairs, where the first element of the pair is the username, and
18941 the 2nd element of the pair is the password.
18942
18943 @lisp
18944 (tailon-configuration-file
18945 (http-auth "basic")
18946 (users '(("user1" . "password1")
18947 ("user2" . "password2"))))
18948 @end lisp
18949
18950 @end table
18951 @end deftp
18952
18953
18954 @subsubheading Darkstat Service
18955 @cindex darkstat
18956 Darkstat is a packet sniffer that captures network traffic, calculates
18957 statistics about usage, and serves reports over HTTP.
18958
18959 @defvar {Scheme Variable} darkstat-service-type
18960 This is the service type for the
18961 @uref{https://unix4lyfe.org/darkstat/, darkstat}
18962 service, its value must be a @code{darkstat-configuration} record as in
18963 this example:
18964
18965 @lisp
18966 (service darkstat-service-type
18967 (darkstat-configuration
18968 (interface "eno1")))
18969 @end lisp
18970 @end defvar
18971
18972 @deftp {Data Type} darkstat-configuration
18973 Data type representing the configuration of @command{darkstat}.
18974
18975 @table @asis
18976 @item @code{package} (default: @code{darkstat})
18977 The darkstat package to use.
18978
18979 @item @code{interface}
18980 Capture traffic on the specified network interface.
18981
18982 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"667"})
18983 Bind the web interface to the specified port.
18984
18985 @item @code{bind-address} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
18986 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
18987
18988 @item @code{base} (default: @code{"/"})
18989 Specify the path of the base URL. This can be useful if
18990 @command{darkstat} is accessed via a reverse proxy.
18991
18992 @end table
18993 @end deftp
18994
18995 @subsubheading Prometheus Node Exporter Service
18996
18997 @cindex prometheus-node-exporter
18998 The Prometheus ``node exporter'' makes hardware and operating system statistics
18999 provided by the Linux kernel available for the Prometheus monitoring system.
19000 This service should be deployed on all physical nodes and virtual machines,
19001 where monitoring these statistics is desirable.
19002
19003 @defvar {Scheme variable} prometheus-node-exporter-service-type
19004 This is the service type for the
19005 @uref{https://github.com/prometheus/node_exporter/, prometheus-node-exporter}
19006 service, its value must be a @code{prometheus-node-exporter-configuration}
19007 record as in this example:
19008
19009 @lisp
19010 (service prometheus-node-exporter-service-type
19011 (prometheus-node-exporter-configuration
19012 (web-listen-address ":9100")))
19013 @end lisp
19014 @end defvar
19015
19016 @deftp {Data Type} prometheus-node-exporter-configuration
19017 Data type representing the configuration of @command{node_exporter}.
19018
19019 @table @asis
19020 @item @code{package} (default: @code{go-github-com-prometheus-node-exporter})
19021 The prometheus-node-exporter package to use.
19022
19023 @item @code{web-listen-address} (default: @code{":9100"})
19024 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
19025
19026 @end table
19027 @end deftp
19028
19029 @subsubheading Zabbix server
19030 @cindex zabbix zabbix-server
19031 Zabbix provides monitoring metrics, among others network utilization, CPU load
19032 and disk space consumption:
19033
19034 @itemize
19035 @item High performance, high capacity (able to monitor hundreds of thousands of devices).
19036 @item Auto-discovery of servers and network devices and interfaces.
19037 @item Low-level discovery, allows to automatically start monitoring new items, file systems or network interfaces among others.
19038 @item Distributed monitoring with centralized web administration.
19039 @item Native high performance agents.
19040 @item SLA, and ITIL KPI metrics on reporting.
19041 @item High-level (business) view of monitored resources through user-defined visual console screens and dashboards.
19042 @item Remote command execution through Zabbix proxies.
19043 @end itemize
19044
19045 @c %start of fragment
19046
19047 Available @code{zabbix-server-configuration} fields are:
19048
19049 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-server
19050 The zabbix-server package.
19051
19052 @end deftypevr
19053
19054 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string user
19055 User who will run the Zabbix server.
19056
19057 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
19058
19059 @end deftypevr
19060
19061 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} group group
19062 Group who will run the Zabbix server.
19063
19064 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
19065
19066 @end deftypevr
19067
19068 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-host
19069 Database host name.
19070
19071 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
19072
19073 @end deftypevr
19074
19075 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-name
19076 Database name.
19077
19078 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
19079
19080 @end deftypevr
19081
19082 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-user
19083 Database user.
19084
19085 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
19086
19087 @end deftypevr
19088
19089 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-password
19090 Database password. Please, use @code{include-files} with
19091 @code{DBPassword=SECRET} inside a specified file instead.
19092
19093 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19094
19095 @end deftypevr
19096
19097 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} number db-port
19098 Database port.
19099
19100 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
19101
19102 @end deftypevr
19103
19104 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-type
19105 Specifies where log messages are written to:
19106
19107 @itemize @bullet
19108 @item
19109 @code{system} - syslog.
19110
19111 @item
19112 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
19113
19114 @item
19115 @code{console} - standard output.
19116
19117 @end itemize
19118
19119 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19120
19121 @end deftypevr
19122
19123 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-file
19124 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
19125
19126 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/server.log"}.
19127
19128 @end deftypevr
19129
19130 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
19131 Name of PID file.
19132
19133 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_server.pid"}.
19134
19135 @end deftypevr
19136
19137 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca-location
19138 The location of certificate authority (CA) files for SSL server
19139 certificate verification.
19140
19141 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"}.
19142
19143 @end deftypevr
19144
19145 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-location
19146 Location of SSL client certificates.
19147
19148 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
19149
19150 @end deftypevr
19151
19152 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
19153 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
19154
19155 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19156
19157 @end deftypevr
19158
19159 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
19160 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
19161 configuration file.
19162
19163 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19164
19165 @end deftypevr
19166
19167 @c %end of fragment
19168
19169 @subsubheading Zabbix agent
19170 @cindex zabbix zabbix-agent
19171
19172 Zabbix agent gathers information for Zabbix server.
19173
19174 @c %start of fragment
19175
19176 Available @code{zabbix-agent-configuration} fields are:
19177
19178 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-agent
19179 The zabbix-agent package.
19180
19181 @end deftypevr
19182
19183 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string user
19184 User who will run the Zabbix agent.
19185
19186 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
19187
19188 @end deftypevr
19189
19190 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} group group
19191 Group who will run the Zabbix agent.
19192
19193 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
19194
19195 @end deftypevr
19196
19197 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string hostname
19198 Unique, case sensitive hostname which is required for active checks and
19199 must match hostname as configured on the server.
19200
19201 Defaults to @samp{"Zabbix server"}.
19202
19203 @end deftypevr
19204
19205 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-type
19206 Specifies where log messages are written to:
19207
19208 @itemize @bullet
19209 @item
19210 @code{system} - syslog.
19211
19212 @item
19213 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
19214
19215 @item
19216 @code{console} - standard output.
19217
19218 @end itemize
19219
19220 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19221
19222 @end deftypevr
19223
19224 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-file
19225 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
19226
19227 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/agent.log"}.
19228
19229 @end deftypevr
19230
19231 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
19232 Name of PID file.
19233
19234 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_agent.pid"}.
19235
19236 @end deftypevr
19237
19238 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server
19239 List of IP addresses, optionally in CIDR notation, or hostnames of
19240 Zabbix servers and Zabbix proxies. Incoming connections will be
19241 accepted only from the hosts listed here.
19242
19243 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
19244
19245 @end deftypevr
19246
19247 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server-active
19248 List of IP:port (or hostname:port) pairs of Zabbix servers and Zabbix
19249 proxies for active checks. If port is not specified, default port is
19250 used. If this parameter is not specified, active checks are disabled.
19251
19252 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
19253
19254 @end deftypevr
19255
19256 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
19257 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
19258
19259 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19260
19261 @end deftypevr
19262
19263 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
19264 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
19265 configuration file.
19266
19267 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19268
19269 @end deftypevr
19270
19271 @c %end of fragment
19272
19273 @subsubheading Zabbix front-end
19274 @cindex zabbix zabbix-front-end
19275
19276 This service provides a WEB interface to Zabbix server.
19277
19278 @c %start of fragment
19279
19280 Available @code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} fields are:
19281
19282 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
19283 NGINX configuration.
19284
19285 @end deftypevr
19286
19287 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-host
19288 Database host name.
19289
19290 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
19291
19292 @end deftypevr
19293
19294 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number db-port
19295 Database port.
19296
19297 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
19298
19299 @end deftypevr
19300
19301 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-name
19302 Database name.
19303
19304 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
19305
19306 @end deftypevr
19307
19308 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-user
19309 Database user.
19310
19311 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
19312
19313 @end deftypevr
19314
19315 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-password
19316 Database password. Please, use @code{db-secret-file} instead.
19317
19318 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19319
19320 @end deftypevr
19321
19322 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-secret-file
19323 Secret file which will be appended to @file{zabbix.conf.php} file. This
19324 file contains credentials for use by Zabbix front-end. You are expected
19325 to create it manually.
19326
19327 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19328
19329 @end deftypevr
19330
19331 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string zabbix-host
19332 Zabbix server hostname.
19333
19334 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
19335
19336 @end deftypevr
19337
19338 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number zabbix-port
19339 Zabbix server port.
19340
19341 Defaults to @samp{10051}.
19342
19343 @end deftypevr
19344
19345
19346 @c %end of fragment
19347
19348 @node Kerberos Services
19349 @subsection Kerberos Services
19350 @cindex Kerberos
19351
19352 The @code{(gnu services kerberos)} module provides services relating to
19353 the authentication protocol @dfn{Kerberos}.
19354
19355 @subsubheading Krb5 Service
19356
19357 Programs using a Kerberos client library normally
19358 expect a configuration file in @file{/etc/krb5.conf}.
19359 This service generates such a file from a definition provided in the
19360 operating system declaration.
19361 It does not cause any daemon to be started.
19362
19363 No ``keytab'' files are provided by this service---you must explicitly create them.
19364 This service is known to work with the MIT client library, @code{mit-krb5}.
19365 Other implementations have not been tested.
19366
19367 @defvr {Scheme Variable} krb5-service-type
19368 A service type for Kerberos 5 clients.
19369 @end defvr
19370
19371 @noindent
19372 Here is an example of its use:
19373 @lisp
19374 (service krb5-service-type
19375 (krb5-configuration
19376 (default-realm "EXAMPLE.COM")
19377 (allow-weak-crypto? #t)
19378 (realms (list
19379 (krb5-realm
19380 (name "EXAMPLE.COM")
19381 (admin-server "groucho.example.com")
19382 (kdc "karl.example.com"))
19383 (krb5-realm
19384 (name "ARGRX.EDU")
19385 (admin-server "kerb-admin.argrx.edu")
19386 (kdc "keys.argrx.edu"))))))
19387 @end lisp
19388
19389 @noindent
19390 This example provides a Kerberos@tie{}5 client configuration which:
19391 @itemize
19392 @item Recognizes two realms, @i{viz:} ``EXAMPLE.COM'' and ``ARGRX.EDU'', both
19393 of which have distinct administration servers and key distribution centers;
19394 @item Will default to the realm ``EXAMPLE.COM'' if the realm is not explicitly
19395 specified by clients;
19396 @item Accepts services which only support encryption types known to be weak.
19397 @end itemize
19398
19399 The @code{krb5-realm} and @code{krb5-configuration} types have many fields.
19400 Only the most commonly used ones are described here.
19401 For a full list, and more detailed explanation of each, see the MIT
19402 @uref{https://web.mit.edu/kerberos/krb5-devel/doc/admin/conf_files/krb5_conf.html,,krb5.conf}
19403 documentation.
19404
19405
19406 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-realm
19407 @cindex realm, kerberos
19408 @table @asis
19409 @item @code{name}
19410 This field is a string identifying the name of the realm.
19411 A common convention is to use the fully qualified DNS name of your organization,
19412 converted to upper case.
19413
19414 @item @code{admin-server}
19415 This field is a string identifying the host where the administration server is
19416 running.
19417
19418 @item @code{kdc}
19419 This field is a string identifying the key distribution center
19420 for the realm.
19421 @end table
19422 @end deftp
19423
19424 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-configuration
19425
19426 @table @asis
19427 @item @code{allow-weak-crypto?} (default: @code{#f})
19428 If this flag is @code{#t} then services which only offer encryption algorithms
19429 known to be weak will be accepted.
19430
19431 @item @code{default-realm} (default: @code{#f})
19432 This field should be a string identifying the default Kerberos
19433 realm for the client.
19434 You should set this field to the name of your Kerberos realm.
19435 If this value is @code{#f}
19436 then a realm must be specified with every Kerberos principal when invoking programs
19437 such as @command{kinit}.
19438
19439 @item @code{realms}
19440 This should be a non-empty list of @code{krb5-realm} objects, which clients may
19441 access.
19442 Normally, one of them will have a @code{name} field matching the @code{default-realm}
19443 field.
19444 @end table
19445 @end deftp
19446
19447
19448 @subsubheading PAM krb5 Service
19449 @cindex pam-krb5
19450
19451 The @code{pam-krb5} service allows for login authentication and password
19452 management via Kerberos.
19453 You will need this service if you want PAM enabled applications to authenticate
19454 users using Kerberos.
19455
19456 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pam-krb5-service-type
19457 A service type for the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
19458 @end defvr
19459
19460 @deftp {Data Type} pam-krb5-configuration
19461 Data type representing the configuration of the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
19462 This type has the following parameters:
19463 @table @asis
19464 @item @code{pam-krb5} (default: @code{pam-krb5})
19465 The pam-krb5 package to use.
19466
19467 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: @code{1000})
19468 The smallest user ID for which Kerberos authentications should be attempted.
19469 Local accounts with lower values will silently fail to authenticate.
19470 @end table
19471 @end deftp
19472
19473
19474 @node LDAP Services
19475 @subsection LDAP Services
19476 @cindex LDAP
19477 @cindex nslcd, LDAP service
19478
19479 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides the
19480 @code{nslcd-service-type}, which can be used to authenticate against an LDAP
19481 server. In addition to configuring the service itself, you may want to add
19482 @code{ldap} as a name service to the Name Service Switch. @xref{Name Service
19483 Switch} for detailed information.
19484
19485 Here is a simple operating system declaration with a default configuration of
19486 the @code{nslcd-service-type} and a Name Service Switch configuration that
19487 consults the @code{ldap} name service last:
19488
19489 @lisp
19490 (use-service-modules authentication)
19491 (use-modules (gnu system nss))
19492 ...
19493 (operating-system
19494 ...
19495 (services
19496 (cons*
19497 (service nslcd-service-type)
19498 (service dhcp-client-service-type)
19499 %base-services))
19500 (name-service-switch
19501 (let ((services (list (name-service (name "db"))
19502 (name-service (name "files"))
19503 (name-service (name "ldap")))))
19504 (name-service-switch
19505 (inherit %mdns-host-lookup-nss)
19506 (password services)
19507 (shadow services)
19508 (group services)
19509 (netgroup services)
19510 (gshadow services)))))
19511 @end lisp
19512
19513 @c %start of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
19514
19515 Available @code{nslcd-configuration} fields are:
19516
19517 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} package nss-pam-ldapd
19518 The @code{nss-pam-ldapd} package to use.
19519
19520 @end deftypevr
19521
19522 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number threads
19523 The number of threads to start that can handle requests and perform LDAP
19524 queries. Each thread opens a separate connection to the LDAP server.
19525 The default is to start 5 threads.
19526
19527 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19528
19529 @end deftypevr
19530
19531 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string uid
19532 This specifies the user id with which the daemon should be run.
19533
19534 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
19535
19536 @end deftypevr
19537
19538 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string gid
19539 This specifies the group id with which the daemon should be run.
19540
19541 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
19542
19543 @end deftypevr
19544
19545 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} log-option log
19546 This option controls the way logging is done via a list containing
19547 SCHEME and LEVEL. The SCHEME argument may either be the symbols "none"
19548 or "syslog", or an absolute file name. The LEVEL argument is optional
19549 and specifies the log level. The log level may be one of the following
19550 symbols: "crit", "error", "warning", "notice", "info" or "debug". All
19551 messages with the specified log level or higher are logged.
19552
19553 Defaults to @samp{("/var/log/nslcd" info)}.
19554
19555 @end deftypevr
19556
19557 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list uri
19558 The list of LDAP server URIs. Normally, only the first server will be
19559 used with the following servers as fall-back.
19560
19561 Defaults to @samp{("ldap://localhost:389/")}.
19562
19563 @end deftypevr
19564
19565 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ldap-version
19566 The version of the LDAP protocol to use. The default is to use the
19567 maximum version supported by the LDAP library.
19568
19569 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19570
19571 @end deftypevr
19572
19573 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string binddn
19574 Specifies the distinguished name with which to bind to the directory
19575 server for lookups. The default is to bind anonymously.
19576
19577 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19578
19579 @end deftypevr
19580
19581 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string bindpw
19582 Specifies the credentials with which to bind. This option is only
19583 applicable when used with binddn.
19584
19585 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19586
19587 @end deftypevr
19588
19589 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmoddn
19590 Specifies the distinguished name to use when the root user tries to
19591 modify a user's password using the PAM module.
19592
19593 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19594
19595 @end deftypevr
19596
19597 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmodpw
19598 Specifies the credentials with which to bind if the root user tries to
19599 change a user's password. This option is only applicable when used with
19600 rootpwmoddn
19601
19602 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19603
19604 @end deftypevr
19605
19606 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-mech
19607 Specifies the SASL mechanism to be used when performing SASL
19608 authentication.
19609
19610 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19611
19612 @end deftypevr
19613
19614 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-realm
19615 Specifies the SASL realm to be used when performing SASL authentication.
19616
19617 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19618
19619 @end deftypevr
19620
19621 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authcid
19622 Specifies the authentication identity to be used when performing SASL
19623 authentication.
19624
19625 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19626
19627 @end deftypevr
19628
19629 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authzid
19630 Specifies the authorization identity to be used when performing SASL
19631 authentication.
19632
19633 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19634
19635 @end deftypevr
19636
19637 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean sasl-canonicalize?
19638 Determines whether the LDAP server host name should be canonicalised. If
19639 this is enabled the LDAP library will do a reverse host name lookup. By
19640 default, it is left up to the LDAP library whether this check is
19641 performed or not.
19642
19643 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19644
19645 @end deftypevr
19646
19647 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string krb5-ccname
19648 Set the name for the GSS-API Kerberos credentials cache.
19649
19650 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19651
19652 @end deftypevr
19653
19654 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string base
19655 The directory search base.
19656
19657 Defaults to @samp{"dc=example,dc=com"}.
19658
19659 @end deftypevr
19660
19661 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} scope-option scope
19662 Specifies the search scope (subtree, onelevel, base or children). The
19663 default scope is subtree; base scope is almost never useful for name
19664 service lookups; children scope is not supported on all servers.
19665
19666 Defaults to @samp{(subtree)}.
19667
19668 @end deftypevr
19669
19670 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-deref-option deref
19671 Specifies the policy for dereferencing aliases. The default policy is
19672 to never dereference aliases.
19673
19674 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19675
19676 @end deftypevr
19677
19678 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean referrals
19679 Specifies whether automatic referral chasing should be enabled. The
19680 default behaviour is to chase referrals.
19681
19682 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19683
19684 @end deftypevr
19685
19686 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-map-entries maps
19687 This option allows for custom attributes to be looked up instead of the
19688 default RFC 2307 attributes. It is a list of maps, each consisting of
19689 the name of a map, the RFC 2307 attribute to match and the query
19690 expression for the attribute as it is available in the directory.
19691
19692 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19693
19694 @end deftypevr
19695
19696 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-filter-entries filters
19697 A list of filters consisting of the name of a map to which the filter
19698 applies and an LDAP search filter expression.
19699
19700 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19701
19702 @end deftypevr
19703
19704 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number bind-timelimit
19705 Specifies the time limit in seconds to use when connecting to the
19706 directory server. The default value is 10 seconds.
19707
19708 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19709
19710 @end deftypevr
19711
19712 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number timelimit
19713 Specifies the time limit (in seconds) to wait for a response from the
19714 LDAP server. A value of zero, which is the default, is to wait
19715 indefinitely for searches to be completed.
19716
19717 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19718
19719 @end deftypevr
19720
19721 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number idle-timelimit
19722 Specifies the period if inactivity (in seconds) after which the con‐
19723 nection to the LDAP server will be closed. The default is not to time
19724 out connections.
19725
19726 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19727
19728 @end deftypevr
19729
19730 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-sleeptime
19731 Specifies the number of seconds to sleep when connecting to all LDAP
19732 servers fails. By default one second is waited between the first
19733 failure and the first retry.
19734
19735 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19736
19737 @end deftypevr
19738
19739 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-retrytime
19740 Specifies the time after which the LDAP server is considered to be
19741 permanently unavailable. Once this time is reached retries will be done
19742 only once per this time period. The default value is 10 seconds.
19743
19744 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19745
19746 @end deftypevr
19747
19748 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-option ssl
19749 Specifies whether to use SSL/TLS or not (the default is not to). If
19750 'start-tls is specified then StartTLS is used rather than raw LDAP over
19751 SSL.
19752
19753 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19754
19755 @end deftypevr
19756
19757 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-tls-reqcert-option tls-reqcert
19758 Specifies what checks to perform on a server-supplied certificate. The
19759 meaning of the values is described in the ldap.conf(5) manual page.
19760
19761 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19762
19763 @end deftypevr
19764
19765 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertdir
19766 Specifies the directory containing X.509 certificates for peer authen‐
19767 tication. This parameter is ignored when using GnuTLS.
19768
19769 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19770
19771 @end deftypevr
19772
19773 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertfile
19774 Specifies the path to the X.509 certificate for peer authentication.
19775
19776 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19777
19778 @end deftypevr
19779
19780 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-randfile
19781 Specifies the path to an entropy source. This parameter is ignored when
19782 using GnuTLS.
19783
19784 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19785
19786 @end deftypevr
19787
19788 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-ciphers
19789 Specifies the ciphers to use for TLS as a string.
19790
19791 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19792
19793 @end deftypevr
19794
19795 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cert
19796 Specifies the path to the file containing the local certificate for
19797 client TLS authentication.
19798
19799 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19800
19801 @end deftypevr
19802
19803 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-key
19804 Specifies the path to the file containing the private key for client TLS
19805 authentication.
19806
19807 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19808
19809 @end deftypevr
19810
19811 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number pagesize
19812 Set this to a number greater than 0 to request paged results from the
19813 LDAP server in accordance with RFC2696. The default (0) is to not
19814 request paged results.
19815
19816 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19817
19818 @end deftypevr
19819
19820 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ignore-users-option nss-initgroups-ignoreusers
19821 This option prevents group membership lookups through LDAP for the
19822 specified users. Alternatively, the value 'all-local may be used. With
19823 that value nslcd builds a full list of non-LDAP users on startup.
19824
19825 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19826
19827 @end deftypevr
19828
19829 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-min-uid
19830 This option ensures that LDAP users with a numeric user id lower than
19831 the specified value are ignored.
19832
19833 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19834
19835 @end deftypevr
19836
19837 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-uid-offset
19838 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric user
19839 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local users.
19840
19841 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19842
19843 @end deftypevr
19844
19845 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-gid-offset
19846 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric group
19847 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local groups.
19848
19849 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19850
19851 @end deftypevr
19852
19853 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-nested-groups
19854 If this option is set, the member attribute of a group may point to
19855 another group. Members of nested groups are also returned in the higher
19856 level group and parent groups are returned when finding groups for a
19857 specific user. The default is not to perform extra searches for nested
19858 groups.
19859
19860 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19861
19862 @end deftypevr
19863
19864 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-getgrent-skipmembers
19865 If this option is set, the group member list is not retrieved when
19866 looking up groups. Lookups for finding which groups a user belongs to
19867 will remain functional so the user will likely still get the correct
19868 groups assigned on login.
19869
19870 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19871
19872 @end deftypevr
19873
19874 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-disable-enumeration
19875 If this option is set, functions which cause all user/group entries to
19876 be loaded from the directory will not succeed in doing so. This can
19877 dramatically reduce LDAP server load in situations where there are a
19878 great number of users and/or groups. This option is not recommended for
19879 most configurations.
19880
19881 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19882
19883 @end deftypevr
19884
19885 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string validnames
19886 This option can be used to specify how user and group names are verified
19887 within the system. This pattern is used to check all user and group
19888 names that are requested and returned from LDAP.
19889
19890 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19891
19892 @end deftypevr
19893
19894 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean ignorecase
19895 This specifies whether or not to perform searches using case-insensitive
19896 matching. Enabling this could open up the system to authorization
19897 bypass vulnerabilities and introduce nscd cache poisoning
19898 vulnerabilities which allow denial of service.
19899
19900 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19901
19902 @end deftypevr
19903
19904 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean pam-authc-ppolicy
19905 This option specifies whether password policy controls are requested and
19906 handled from the LDAP server when performing user authentication.
19907
19908 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19909
19910 @end deftypevr
19911
19912 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authc-search
19913 By default nslcd performs an LDAP search with the user's credentials
19914 after BIND (authentication) to ensure that the BIND operation was
19915 successful. The default search is a simple check to see if the user's
19916 DN exists. A search filter can be specified that will be used instead.
19917 It should return at least one entry.
19918
19919 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19920
19921 @end deftypevr
19922
19923 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authz-search
19924 This option allows flexible fine tuning of the authorisation check that
19925 should be performed. The search filter specified is executed and if any
19926 entries match, access is granted, otherwise access is denied.
19927
19928 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19929
19930 @end deftypevr
19931
19932 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-password-prohibit-message
19933 If this option is set password modification using pam_ldap will be
19934 denied and the specified message will be presented to the user instead.
19935 The message can be used to direct the user to an alternative means of
19936 changing their password.
19937
19938 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19939
19940 @end deftypevr
19941
19942 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list pam-services
19943 List of pam service names for which LDAP authentication should suffice.
19944
19945 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19946
19947 @end deftypevr
19948
19949 @c %end of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
19950
19951
19952 @node Web Services
19953 @subsection Web Services
19954
19955 @cindex web
19956 @cindex www
19957 @cindex HTTP
19958 The @code{(gnu services web)} module provides the Apache HTTP Server,
19959 the nginx web server, and also a fastcgi wrapper daemon.
19960
19961 @subsubheading Apache HTTP Server
19962
19963 @deffn {Scheme Variable} httpd-service-type
19964 Service type for the @uref{https://httpd.apache.org/,Apache HTTP} server
19965 (@dfn{httpd}). The value for this service type is a
19966 @code{httpd-configuration} record.
19967
19968 A simple example configuration is given below.
19969
19970 @lisp
19971 (service httpd-service-type
19972 (httpd-configuration
19973 (config
19974 (httpd-config-file
19975 (server-name "www.example.com")
19976 (document-root "/srv/http/www.example.com")))))
19977 @end lisp
19978
19979 Other services can also extend the @code{httpd-service-type} to add to
19980 the configuration.
19981
19982 @lisp
19983 (simple-service 'www.example.com-server httpd-service-type
19984 (list
19985 (httpd-virtualhost
19986 "*:80"
19987 (list (string-join '("ServerName www.example.com"
19988 "DocumentRoot /srv/http/www.example.com")
19989 "\n")))))
19990 @end lisp
19991 @end deffn
19992
19993 The details for the @code{httpd-configuration}, @code{httpd-module},
19994 @code{httpd-config-file} and @code{httpd-virtualhost} record types are
19995 given below.
19996
19997 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-configuration
19998 This data type represents the configuration for the httpd service.
19999
20000 @table @asis
20001 @item @code{package} (default: @code{httpd})
20002 The httpd package to use.
20003
20004 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
20005 The pid file used by the shepherd-service.
20006
20007 @item @code{config} (default: @code{(httpd-config-file)})
20008 The configuration file to use with the httpd service. The default value
20009 is a @code{httpd-config-file} record, but this can also be a different
20010 G-expression that generates a file, for example a @code{plain-file}. A
20011 file outside of the store can also be specified through a string.
20012
20013 @end table
20014 @end deffn
20015
20016 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-module
20017 This data type represents a module for the httpd service.
20018
20019 @table @asis
20020 @item @code{name}
20021 The name of the module.
20022
20023 @item @code{file}
20024 The file for the module. This can be relative to the httpd package being
20025 used, the absolute location of a file, or a G-expression for a file
20026 within the store, for example @code{(file-append mod-wsgi
20027 "/modules/mod_wsgi.so")}.
20028
20029 @end table
20030 @end deffn
20031
20032 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-httpd-modules
20033 A default list of @code{httpd-module} objects.
20034 @end defvr
20035
20036 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-config-file
20037 This data type represents a configuration file for the httpd service.
20038
20039 @table @asis
20040 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-httpd-modules})
20041 The modules to load. Additional modules can be added here, or loaded by
20042 additional configuration.
20043
20044 For example, in order to handle requests for PHP files, you can use Apache’s
20045 @code{mod_proxy_fcgi} module along with @code{php-fpm-service-type}:
20046
20047 @lisp
20048 (service httpd-service-type
20049 (httpd-configuration
20050 (config
20051 (httpd-config-file
20052 (modules (cons*
20053 (httpd-module
20054 (name "proxy_module")
20055 (file "modules/mod_proxy.so"))
20056 (httpd-module
20057 (name "proxy_fcgi_module")
20058 (file "modules/mod_proxy_fcgi.so"))
20059 %default-httpd-modules))
20060 (extra-config (list "\
20061 <FilesMatch \\.php$>
20062 SetHandler \"proxy:unix:/var/run/php-fpm.sock|fcgi://localhost/\"
20063 </FilesMatch>"))))))
20064 (service php-fpm-service-type
20065 (php-fpm-configuration
20066 (socket "/var/run/php-fpm.sock")
20067 (socket-group "httpd")))
20068 @end lisp
20069
20070 @item @code{server-root} (default: @code{httpd})
20071 The @code{ServerRoot} in the configuration file, defaults to the httpd
20072 package. Directives including @code{Include} and @code{LoadModule} are
20073 taken as relative to the server root.
20074
20075 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{#f})
20076 The @code{ServerName} in the configuration file, used to specify the
20077 request scheme, hostname and port that the server uses to identify
20078 itself.
20079
20080 This doesn't need to be set in the server config, and can be specified
20081 in virtual hosts. The default is @code{#f} to not specify a
20082 @code{ServerName}.
20083
20084 @item @code{document-root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
20085 The @code{DocumentRoot} from which files will be served.
20086
20087 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80")})
20088 The list of values for the @code{Listen} directives in the config
20089 file. The value should be a list of strings, when each string can
20090 specify the port number to listen on, and optionally the IP address and
20091 protocol to use.
20092
20093 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
20094 The @code{PidFile} to use. This should match the @code{pid-file} set in
20095 the @code{httpd-configuration} so that the Shepherd service is
20096 configured correctly.
20097
20098 @item @code{error-log} (default: @code{"/var/log/httpd/error_log"})
20099 The @code{ErrorLog} to which the server will log errors.
20100
20101 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
20102 The @code{User} which the server will answer requests as.
20103
20104 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"httpd"})
20105 The @code{Group} which the server will answer requests as.
20106
20107 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{(list "TypesConfig etc/httpd/mime.types")})
20108 A flat list of strings and G-expressions which will be added to the end
20109 of the configuration file.
20110
20111 Any values which the service is extended with will be appended to this
20112 list.
20113
20114 @end table
20115 @end deffn
20116
20117 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-virtualhost
20118 This data type represents a virtualhost configuration block for the httpd service.
20119
20120 These should be added to the extra-config for the httpd-service.
20121
20122 @lisp
20123 (simple-service 'www.example.com-server httpd-service-type
20124 (list
20125 (httpd-virtualhost
20126 "*:80"
20127 (list (string-join '("ServerName www.example.com"
20128 "DocumentRoot /srv/http/www.example.com")
20129 "\n")))))
20130 @end lisp
20131
20132 @table @asis
20133 @item @code{addresses-and-ports}
20134 The addresses and ports for the @code{VirtualHost} directive.
20135
20136 @item @code{contents}
20137 The contents of the @code{VirtualHost} directive, this should be a list
20138 of strings and G-expressions.
20139
20140 @end table
20141 @end deffn
20142
20143 @subsubheading NGINX
20144
20145 @deffn {Scheme Variable} nginx-service-type
20146 Service type for the @uref{https://nginx.org/,NGinx} web server. The
20147 value for this service type is a @code{<nginx-configuration>} record.
20148
20149 A simple example configuration is given below.
20150
20151 @lisp
20152 (service nginx-service-type
20153 (nginx-configuration
20154 (server-blocks
20155 (list (nginx-server-configuration
20156 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
20157 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
20158 @end lisp
20159
20160 In addition to adding server blocks to the service configuration
20161 directly, this service can be extended by other services to add server
20162 blocks, as in this example:
20163
20164 @lisp
20165 (simple-service 'my-extra-server nginx-service-type
20166 (list (nginx-server-configuration
20167 (root "/srv/http/extra-website")
20168 (try-files (list "$uri" "$uri/index.html")))))
20169 @end lisp
20170 @end deffn
20171
20172 At startup, @command{nginx} has not yet read its configuration file, so
20173 it uses a default file to log error messages. If it fails to load its
20174 configuration file, that is where error messages are logged. After the
20175 configuration file is loaded, the default error log file changes as per
20176 configuration. In our case, startup error messages can be found in
20177 @file{/var/run/nginx/logs/error.log}, and after configuration in
20178 @file{/var/log/nginx/error.log}. The second location can be changed
20179 with the @var{log-directory} configuration option.
20180
20181 @deffn {Data Type} nginx-configuration
20182 This data type represents the configuration for NGinx. Some
20183 configuration can be done through this and the other provided record
20184 types, or alternatively, a config file can be provided.
20185
20186 @table @asis
20187 @item @code{nginx} (default: @code{nginx})
20188 The nginx package to use.
20189
20190 @item @code{log-directory} (default: @code{"/var/log/nginx"})
20191 The directory to which NGinx will write log files.
20192
20193 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/nginx"})
20194 The directory in which NGinx will create a pid file, and write temporary
20195 files.
20196
20197 @item @code{server-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
20198 A list of @dfn{server blocks} to create in the generated configuration
20199 file, the elements should be of type
20200 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>}.
20201
20202 The following example would setup NGinx to serve @code{www.example.com}
20203 from the @code{/srv/http/www.example.com} directory, without using
20204 HTTPS.
20205 @lisp
20206 (service nginx-service-type
20207 (nginx-configuration
20208 (server-blocks
20209 (list (nginx-server-configuration
20210 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
20211 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
20212 @end lisp
20213
20214 @item @code{upstream-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
20215 A list of @dfn{upstream blocks} to create in the generated configuration
20216 file, the elements should be of type
20217 @code{<nginx-upstream-configuration>}.
20218
20219 Configuring upstreams through the @code{upstream-blocks} can be useful
20220 when combined with @code{locations} in the
20221 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>} records. The following example
20222 creates a server configuration with one location configuration, that
20223 will proxy requests to a upstream configuration, which will handle
20224 requests with two servers.
20225
20226 @lisp
20227 (service
20228 nginx-service-type
20229 (nginx-configuration
20230 (server-blocks
20231 (list (nginx-server-configuration
20232 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
20233 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com")
20234 (locations
20235 (list
20236 (nginx-location-configuration
20237 (uri "/path1")
20238 (body '("proxy_pass http://server-proxy;"))))))))
20239 (upstream-blocks
20240 (list (nginx-upstream-configuration
20241 (name "server-proxy")
20242 (servers (list "server1.example.com"
20243 "server2.example.com")))))))
20244 @end lisp
20245
20246 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
20247 If a configuration @var{file} is provided, this will be used, rather than
20248 generating a configuration file from the provided @code{log-directory},
20249 @code{run-directory}, @code{server-blocks} and @code{upstream-blocks}. For
20250 proper operation, these arguments should match what is in @var{file} to ensure
20251 that the directories are created when the service is activated.
20252
20253 This can be useful if you have an existing configuration file, or it's
20254 not possible to do what is required through the other parts of the
20255 nginx-configuration record.
20256
20257 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-size} (default: @code{#f})
20258 Bucket size for the server names hash tables, defaults to @code{#f} to
20259 use the size of the processors cache line.
20260
20261 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-max-size} (default: @code{#f})
20262 Maximum bucket size for the server names hash tables.
20263
20264 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
20265 List of nginx dynamic modules to load. This should be a list of file
20266 names of loadable modules, as in this example:
20267
20268 @lisp
20269 (modules
20270 (list
20271 (file-append nginx-accept-language-module "\
20272 /etc/nginx/modules/ngx_http_accept_language_module.so")))
20273 @end lisp
20274
20275 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
20276 Extra content for the @code{http} block. Should be string or a string
20277 valued G-expression.
20278
20279 @end table
20280 @end deffn
20281
20282 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-server-configuration
20283 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx server block.
20284 This type has the following parameters:
20285
20286 @table @asis
20287 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80" "443 ssl")})
20288 Each @code{listen} directive sets the address and port for IP, or the
20289 path for a UNIX-domain socket on which the server will accept requests.
20290 Both address and port, or only address or only port can be specified.
20291 An address may also be a hostname, for example:
20292
20293 @lisp
20294 '("127.0.0.1:8000" "127.0.0.1" "8000" "*:8000" "localhost:8000")
20295 @end lisp
20296
20297 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{(list 'default)})
20298 A list of server names this server represents. @code{'default} represents the
20299 default server for connections matching no other server.
20300
20301 @item @code{root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
20302 Root of the website nginx will serve.
20303
20304 @item @code{locations} (default: @code{'()})
20305 A list of @dfn{nginx-location-configuration} or
20306 @dfn{nginx-named-location-configuration} records to use within this
20307 server block.
20308
20309 @item @code{index} (default: @code{(list "index.html")})
20310 Index files to look for when clients ask for a directory. If it cannot be found,
20311 Nginx will send the list of files in the directory.
20312
20313 @item @code{try-files} (default: @code{'()})
20314 A list of files whose existence is checked in the specified order.
20315 @code{nginx} will use the first file it finds to process the request.
20316
20317 @item @code{ssl-certificate} (default: @code{#f})
20318 Where to find the certificate for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
20319 you don't have a certificate or you don't want to use HTTPS.
20320
20321 @item @code{ssl-certificate-key} (default: @code{#f})
20322 Where to find the private key for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
20323 you don't have a key or you don't want to use HTTPS.
20324
20325 @item @code{server-tokens?} (default: @code{#f})
20326 Whether the server should add its configuration to response.
20327
20328 @item @code{raw-content} (default: @code{'()})
20329 A list of raw lines added to the server block.
20330
20331 @end table
20332 @end deftp
20333
20334 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-upstream-configuration
20335 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{upstream}
20336 block. This type has the following parameters:
20337
20338 @table @asis
20339 @item @code{name}
20340 Name for this group of servers.
20341
20342 @item @code{servers}
20343 Specify the addresses of the servers in the group. The address can be
20344 specified as a IP address (e.g.@: @samp{127.0.0.1}), domain name
20345 (e.g.@: @samp{backend1.example.com}) or a path to a UNIX socket using the
20346 prefix @samp{unix:}. For addresses using an IP address or domain name,
20347 the default port is 80, and a different port can be specified
20348 explicitly.
20349
20350 @end table
20351 @end deftp
20352
20353 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-location-configuration
20354 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{location}
20355 block. This type has the following parameters:
20356
20357 @table @asis
20358 @item @code{uri}
20359 URI which this location block matches.
20360
20361 @anchor{nginx-location-configuration body}
20362 @item @code{body}
20363 Body of the location block, specified as a list of strings. This can contain
20364 many
20365 configuration directives. For example, to pass requests to a upstream
20366 server group defined using an @code{nginx-upstream-configuration} block,
20367 the following directive would be specified in the body @samp{(list "proxy_pass
20368 http://upstream-name;")}.
20369
20370 @end table
20371 @end deftp
20372
20373 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-named-location-configuration
20374 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx named location
20375 block. Named location blocks are used for request redirection, and not
20376 used for regular request processing. This type has the following
20377 parameters:
20378
20379 @table @asis
20380 @item @code{name}
20381 Name to identify this location block.
20382
20383 @item @code{body}
20384 @xref{nginx-location-configuration body}, as the body for named location
20385 blocks can be used in a similar way to the
20386 @code{nginx-location-configuration body}. One restriction is that the
20387 body of a named location block cannot contain location blocks.
20388
20389 @end table
20390 @end deftp
20391
20392 @subsubheading Varnish Cache
20393 @cindex Varnish
20394 Varnish is a fast cache server that sits in between web applications
20395 and end users. It proxies requests from clients and caches the
20396 accessed URLs such that multiple requests for the same resource only
20397 creates one request to the back-end.
20398
20399 @defvr {Scheme Variable} varnish-service-type
20400 Service type for the Varnish daemon.
20401 @end defvr
20402
20403 @deftp {Data Type} varnish-configuration
20404 Data type representing the @code{varnish} service configuration.
20405 This type has the following parameters:
20406
20407 @table @asis
20408 @item @code{package} (default: @code{varnish})
20409 The Varnish package to use.
20410
20411 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"default"})
20412 A name for this Varnish instance. Varnish will create a directory in
20413 @file{/var/varnish/} with this name and keep temporary files there. If
20414 the name starts with a forward slash, it is interpreted as an absolute
20415 directory name.
20416
20417 Pass the @code{-n} argument to other Varnish programs to connect to the
20418 named instance, e.g.@: @command{varnishncsa -n default}.
20419
20420 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
20421 The backend to use. This option has no effect if @code{vcl} is set.
20422
20423 @item @code{vcl} (default: #f)
20424 The @dfn{VCL} (Varnish Configuration Language) program to run. If this
20425 is @code{#f}, Varnish will proxy @code{backend} using the default
20426 configuration. Otherwise this must be a file-like object with valid
20427 VCL syntax.
20428
20429 @c Varnish does not support HTTPS, so keep this URL to avoid confusion.
20430 For example, to mirror @url{https://www.gnu.org,www.gnu.org} with VCL you
20431 can do something along these lines:
20432
20433 @lisp
20434 (define %gnu-mirror
20435 (plain-file "gnu.vcl"
20436 "vcl 4.1;
20437 backend gnu @{ .host = \"www.gnu.org\"; @}"))
20438
20439 (operating-system
20440 ;; @dots{}
20441 (services (cons (service varnish-service-type
20442 (varnish-configuration
20443 (listen '(":80"))
20444 (vcl %gnu-mirror)))
20445 %base-services)))
20446 @end lisp
20447
20448 The configuration of an already running Varnish instance can be inspected
20449 and changed using the @command{varnishadm} program.
20450
20451 Consult the @url{https://varnish-cache.org/docs/,Varnish User Guide} and
20452 @url{https://book.varnish-software.com/4.0/,Varnish Book} for
20453 comprehensive documentation on Varnish and its configuration language.
20454
20455 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("localhost:80")})
20456 List of addresses Varnish will listen on.
20457
20458 @item @code{storage} (default: @code{'("malloc,128m")})
20459 List of storage backends that will be available in VCL.
20460
20461 @item @code{parameters} (default: @code{'()})
20462 List of run-time parameters in the form @code{'(("parameter" . "value"))}.
20463
20464 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
20465 Additional arguments to pass to the @command{varnishd} process.
20466
20467 @end table
20468 @end deftp
20469
20470 @subsubheading Patchwork
20471 @cindex Patchwork
20472 Patchwork is a patch tracking system. It can collect patches sent to a
20473 mailing list, and display them in a web interface.
20474
20475 @defvr {Scheme Variable} patchwork-service-type
20476 Service type for Patchwork.
20477 @end defvr
20478
20479 The following example is an example of a minimal service for Patchwork, for
20480 the @code{patchwork.example.com} domain.
20481
20482 @lisp
20483 (service patchwork-service-type
20484 (patchwork-configuration
20485 (domain "patchwork.example.com")
20486 (settings-module
20487 (patchwork-settings-module
20488 (allowed-hosts (list domain))
20489 (default-from-email "patchwork@@patchwork.example.com")))
20490 (getmail-retriever-config
20491 (getmail-retriever-configuration
20492 (type "SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever")
20493 (server "imap.example.com")
20494 (port 993)
20495 (username "patchwork")
20496 (password-command
20497 (list (file-append coreutils "/bin/cat")
20498 "/etc/getmail-patchwork-imap-password"))
20499 (extra-parameters
20500 '((mailboxes . ("Patches"))))))))
20501
20502 @end lisp
20503
20504 There are three records for configuring the Patchwork service. The
20505 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} relates to the configuration for Patchwork
20506 within the HTTPD service.
20507
20508 The @code{settings-module} field within the @code{<patchwork-configuration>}
20509 record can be populated with the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record,
20510 which describes a settings module that is generated within the Guix store.
20511
20512 For the @code{database-configuration} field within the
20513 @code{<patchwork-settings-module>}, the
20514 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} must be used.
20515
20516 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-configuration
20517 Data type representing the Patchwork service configuration. This type has the
20518 following parameters:
20519
20520 @table @asis
20521 @item @code{patchwork} (default: @code{patchwork})
20522 The Patchwork package to use.
20523
20524 @item @code{domain}
20525 The domain to use for Patchwork, this is used in the HTTPD service virtual
20526 host.
20527
20528 @item @code{settings-module}
20529 The settings module to use for Patchwork. As a Django application, Patchwork
20530 is configured with a Python module containing the settings. This can either be
20531 an instance of the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record, any other record
20532 that represents the settings in the store, or a directory outside of the
20533 store.
20534
20535 @item @code{static-path} (default: @code{"/static/"})
20536 The path under which the HTTPD service should serve the static files.
20537
20538 @item @code{getmail-retriever-config}
20539 The getmail-retriever-configuration record value to use with
20540 Patchwork. Getmail will be configured with this value, the messages will be
20541 delivered to Patchwork.
20542
20543 @end table
20544 @end deftp
20545
20546 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-settings-module
20547 Data type representing a settings module for Patchwork. Some of these
20548 settings relate directly to Patchwork, but others relate to Django, the web
20549 framework used by Patchwork, or the Django Rest Framework library. This type
20550 has the following parameters:
20551
20552 @table @asis
20553 @item @code{database-configuration} (default: @code{(patchwork-database-configuration)})
20554 The database connection settings used for Patchwork. See the
20555 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} record type for more information.
20556
20557 @item @code{secret-key-file} (default: @code{"/etc/patchwork/django-secret-key"})
20558 Patchwork, as a Django web application uses a secret key for cryptographically
20559 signing values. This file should contain a unique unpredictable value.
20560
20561 If this file does not exist, it will be created and populated with a random
20562 value by the patchwork-setup shepherd service.
20563
20564 This setting relates to Django.
20565
20566 @item @code{allowed-hosts}
20567 A list of valid hosts for this Patchwork service. This should at least include
20568 the domain specified in the @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record.
20569
20570 This is a Django setting.
20571
20572 @item @code{default-from-email}
20573 The email address from which Patchwork should send email by default.
20574
20575 This is a Patchwork setting.
20576
20577 @item @code{static-url} (default: @code{#f})
20578 The URL to use when serving static assets. It can be part of a URL, or a full
20579 URL, but must end in a @code{/}.
20580
20581 If the default value is used, the @code{static-path} value from the
20582 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record will be used.
20583
20584 This is a Django setting.
20585
20586 @item @code{admins} (default: @code{'()})
20587 Email addresses to send the details of errors that occur. Each value should
20588 be a list containing two elements, the name and then the email address.
20589
20590 This is a Django setting.
20591
20592 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
20593 Whether to run Patchwork in debug mode. If set to @code{#t}, detailed error
20594 messages will be shown.
20595
20596 This is a Django setting.
20597
20598 @item @code{enable-rest-api?} (default: @code{#t})
20599 Whether to enable the Patchwork REST API.
20600
20601 This is a Patchwork setting.
20602
20603 @item @code{enable-xmlrpc?} (default: @code{#t})
20604 Whether to enable the XML RPC API.
20605
20606 This is a Patchwork setting.
20607
20608 @item @code{force-https-links?} (default: @code{#t})
20609 Whether to use HTTPS links on Patchwork pages.
20610
20611 This is a Patchwork setting.
20612
20613 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
20614 Extra code to place at the end of the Patchwork settings module.
20615
20616 @end table
20617 @end deftp
20618
20619 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-database-configuration
20620 Data type representing the database configuration for Patchwork.
20621
20622 @table @asis
20623 @item @code{engine} (default: @code{"django.db.backends.postgresql_psycopg2"})
20624 The database engine to use.
20625
20626 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"patchwork"})
20627 The name of the database to use.
20628
20629 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
20630 The user to connect to the database as.
20631
20632 @item @code{password} (default: @code{""})
20633 The password to use when connecting to the database.
20634
20635 @item @code{host} (default: @code{""})
20636 The host to make the database connection to.
20637
20638 @item @code{port} (default: @code{""})
20639 The port on which to connect to the database.
20640
20641 @end table
20642 @end deftp
20643
20644 @subsubheading Mumi
20645
20646 @cindex Mumi, Debbugs Web interface
20647 @cindex Debbugs, Mumi Web interface
20648 @uref{https://git.elephly.net/gitweb.cgi?p=software/mumi.git, Mumi} is a
20649 Web interface to the Debbugs bug tracker, by default for
20650 @uref{https://bugs.gnu.org, the GNU instance}. Mumi is a Web server,
20651 but it also fetches and indexes mail retrieved from Debbugs.
20652
20653 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mumi-service-type
20654 This is the service type for Mumi.
20655 @end defvr
20656
20657 @subsubheading FastCGI
20658 @cindex fastcgi
20659 @cindex fcgiwrap
20660 FastCGI is an interface between the front-end and the back-end of a web
20661 service. It is a somewhat legacy facility; new web services should
20662 generally just talk HTTP between the front-end and the back-end.
20663 However there are a number of back-end services such as PHP or the
20664 optimized HTTP Git repository access that use FastCGI, so we have
20665 support for it in Guix.
20666
20667 To use FastCGI, you configure the front-end web server (e.g., nginx) to
20668 dispatch some subset of its requests to the fastcgi backend, which
20669 listens on a local TCP or UNIX socket. There is an intermediary
20670 @code{fcgiwrap} program that sits between the actual backend process and
20671 the web server. The front-end indicates which backend program to run,
20672 passing that information to the @code{fcgiwrap} process.
20673
20674 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fcgiwrap-service-type
20675 A service type for the @code{fcgiwrap} FastCGI proxy.
20676 @end defvr
20677
20678 @deftp {Data Type} fcgiwrap-configuration
20679 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{fcgiwrap} service.
20680 This type has the following parameters:
20681 @table @asis
20682 @item @code{package} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
20683 The fcgiwrap package to use.
20684
20685 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{tcp:127.0.0.1:9000})
20686 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} process should listen, as a
20687 string. Valid @var{socket} values include
20688 @code{unix:@var{/path/to/unix/socket}},
20689 @code{tcp:@var{dot.ted.qu.ad}:@var{port}} and
20690 @code{tcp6:[@var{ipv6_addr}]:port}.
20691
20692 @item @code{user} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
20693 @itemx @code{group} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
20694 The user and group names, as strings, under which to run the
20695 @code{fcgiwrap} process. The @code{fastcgi} service will ensure that if
20696 the user asks for the specific user or group names @code{fcgiwrap} that
20697 the corresponding user and/or group is present on the system.
20698
20699 It is possible to configure a FastCGI-backed web service to pass HTTP
20700 authentication information from the front-end to the back-end, and to
20701 allow @code{fcgiwrap} to run the back-end process as a corresponding
20702 local user. To enable this capability on the back-end, run
20703 @code{fcgiwrap} as the @code{root} user and group. Note that this
20704 capability also has to be configured on the front-end as well.
20705 @end table
20706 @end deftp
20707
20708 @cindex php-fpm
20709 PHP-FPM (FastCGI Process Manager) is an alternative PHP FastCGI implementation
20710 with some additional features useful for sites of any size.
20711
20712 These features include:
20713 @itemize @bullet
20714 @item Adaptive process spawning
20715 @item Basic statistics (similar to Apache's mod_status)
20716 @item Advanced process management with graceful stop/start
20717 @item Ability to start workers with different uid/gid/chroot/environment
20718 and different php.ini (replaces safe_mode)
20719 @item Stdout & stderr logging
20720 @item Emergency restart in case of accidental opcode cache destruction
20721 @item Accelerated upload support
20722 @item Support for a "slowlog"
20723 @item Enhancements to FastCGI, such as fastcgi_finish_request() -
20724 a special function to finish request & flush all data while continuing to do
20725 something time-consuming (video converting, stats processing, etc.)
20726 @end itemize
20727 ...@: and much more.
20728
20729 @defvr {Scheme Variable} php-fpm-service-type
20730 A Service type for @code{php-fpm}.
20731 @end defvr
20732
20733 @deftp {Data Type} php-fpm-configuration
20734 Data Type for php-fpm service configuration.
20735 @table @asis
20736 @item @code{php} (default: @code{php})
20737 The php package to use.
20738 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.sock")})
20739 The address on which to accept FastCGI requests. Valid syntaxes are:
20740 @table @asis
20741 @item @code{"ip.add.re.ss:port"}
20742 Listen on a TCP socket to a specific address on a specific port.
20743 @item @code{"port"}
20744 Listen on a TCP socket to all addresses on a specific port.
20745 @item @code{"/path/to/unix/socket"}
20746 Listen on a unix socket.
20747 @end table
20748
20749 @item @code{user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
20750 User who will own the php worker processes.
20751 @item @code{group} (default: @code{php-fpm})
20752 Group of the worker processes.
20753 @item @code{socket-user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
20754 User who can speak to the php-fpm socket.
20755 @item @code{socket-group} (default: @code{nginx})
20756 Group that can speak to the php-fpm socket.
20757 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.pid")})
20758 The process id of the php-fpm process is written to this file
20759 once the service has started.
20760 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.log")})
20761 Log for the php-fpm master process.
20762 @item @code{process-manager} (default: @code{(php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration)})
20763 Detailed settings for the php-fpm process manager.
20764 Must be one of:
20765 @table @asis
20766 @item @code{<php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration>}
20767 @item @code{<php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration>}
20768 @item @code{<php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration>}
20769 @end table
20770 @item @code{display-errors} (default @code{#f})
20771 Determines whether php errors and warning should be sent to clients
20772 and displayed in their browsers.
20773 This is useful for local php development, but a security risk for public sites,
20774 as error messages can reveal passwords and personal data.
20775 @item @code{timezone} (default @code{#f})
20776 Specifies @code{php_admin_value[date.timezone]} parameter.
20777 @item @code{workers-logfile} (default @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.www.log")})
20778 This file will log the @code{stderr} outputs of php worker processes.
20779 Can be set to @code{#f} to disable logging.
20780 @item @code{file} (default @code{#f})
20781 An optional override of the whole configuration.
20782 You can use the @code{mixed-text-file} function or an absolute filepath for it.
20783 @end table
20784 @end deftp
20785
20786 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration
20787 Data Type for the @code{dynamic} php-fpm process manager. With the
20788 @code{dynamic} process manager, spare worker processes are kept around
20789 based on it's configured limits.
20790 @table @asis
20791 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
20792 Maximum of worker processes.
20793 @item @code{start-servers} (default: @code{2})
20794 How many worker processes should be started on start-up.
20795 @item @code{min-spare-servers} (default: @code{1})
20796 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at minimum.
20797 @item @code{max-spare-servers} (default: @code{3})
20798 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at maximum.
20799 @end table
20800 @end deftp
20801
20802 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration
20803 Data Type for the @code{static} php-fpm process manager. With the
20804 @code{static} process manager, an unchanging number of worker processes
20805 are created.
20806 @table @asis
20807 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
20808 Maximum of worker processes.
20809 @end table
20810 @end deftp
20811
20812 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration
20813 Data Type for the @code{on-demand} php-fpm process manager. With the
20814 @code{on-demand} process manager, worker processes are only created as
20815 requests arrive.
20816 @table @asis
20817 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
20818 Maximum of worker processes.
20819 @item @code{process-idle-timeout} (default: @code{10})
20820 The time in seconds after which a process with no requests is killed.
20821 @end table
20822 @end deftp
20823
20824
20825 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nginx-php-fpm-location @
20826 [#:nginx-package nginx] @
20827 [socket (string-append "/var/run/php" @
20828 (version-major (package-version php)) @
20829 "-fpm.sock")]
20830 A helper function to quickly add php to an @code{nginx-server-configuration}.
20831 @end deffn
20832
20833 A simple services setup for nginx with php can look like this:
20834 @lisp
20835 (services (cons* (service dhcp-client-service-type)
20836 (service php-fpm-service-type)
20837 (service nginx-service-type
20838 (nginx-server-configuration
20839 (server-name '("example.com"))
20840 (root "/srv/http/")
20841 (locations
20842 (list (nginx-php-location)))
20843 (listen '("80"))
20844 (ssl-certificate #f)
20845 (ssl-certificate-key #f)))
20846 %base-services))
20847 @end lisp
20848
20849 @cindex cat-avatar-generator
20850 The cat avatar generator is a simple service to demonstrate the use of php-fpm
20851 in @code{Nginx}. It is used to generate cat avatar from a seed, for instance
20852 the hash of a user's email address.
20853
20854 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} cat-avatar-generator-service @
20855 [#:cache-dir "/var/cache/cat-avatar-generator"] @
20856 [#:package cat-avatar-generator] @
20857 [#:configuration (nginx-server-configuration)]
20858 Returns an nginx-server-configuration that inherits @code{configuration}. It
20859 extends the nginx configuration to add a server block that serves @code{package},
20860 a version of cat-avatar-generator. During execution, cat-avatar-generator will
20861 be able to use @code{cache-dir} as its cache directory.
20862 @end deffn
20863
20864 A simple setup for cat-avatar-generator can look like this:
20865 @lisp
20866 (services (cons* (cat-avatar-generator-service
20867 #:configuration
20868 (nginx-server-configuration
20869 (server-name '("example.com"))))
20870 ...
20871 %base-services))
20872 @end lisp
20873
20874 @subsubheading Hpcguix-web
20875
20876 @cindex hpcguix-web
20877 The @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/, hpcguix-web}
20878 program is a customizable web interface to browse Guix packages,
20879 initially designed for users of high-performance computing (HPC)
20880 clusters.
20881
20882 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hpcguix-web-service-type
20883 The service type for @code{hpcguix-web}.
20884 @end defvr
20885
20886 @deftp {Data Type} hpcguix-web-configuration
20887 Data type for the hpcguix-web service configuration.
20888
20889 @table @asis
20890 @item @code{specs}
20891 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) specifying the hpcguix-web service
20892 configuration. The main items available in this spec are:
20893
20894 @table @asis
20895 @item @code{title-prefix} (default: @code{"hpcguix | "})
20896 The page title prefix.
20897
20898 @item @code{guix-command} (default: @code{"guix"})
20899 The @command{guix} command.
20900
20901 @item @code{package-filter-proc} (default: @code{(const #t)})
20902 A procedure specifying how to filter packages that are displayed.
20903
20904 @item @code{package-page-extension-proc} (default: @code{(const '())})
20905 Extension package for @code{hpcguix-web}.
20906
20907 @item @code{menu} (default: @code{'()})
20908 Additional entry in page @code{menu}.
20909
20910 @item @code{channels} (default: @code{%default-channels})
20911 List of channels from which the package list is built (@pxref{Channels}).
20912
20913 @item @code{package-list-expiration} (default: @code{(* 12 3600)})
20914 The expiration time, in seconds, after which the package list is rebuilt from
20915 the latest instances of the given channels.
20916 @end table
20917
20918 See the hpcguix-web repository for a
20919 @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/blob/master/hpcweb-configuration.scm,
20920 complete example}.
20921
20922 @item @code{package} (default: @code{hpcguix-web})
20923 The hpcguix-web package to use.
20924 @end table
20925 @end deftp
20926
20927 A typical hpcguix-web service declaration looks like this:
20928
20929 @lisp
20930 (service hpcguix-web-service-type
20931 (hpcguix-web-configuration
20932 (specs
20933 #~(define site-config
20934 (hpcweb-configuration
20935 (title-prefix "Guix-HPC - ")
20936 (menu '(("/about" "ABOUT"))))))))
20937 @end lisp
20938
20939 @quotation Note
20940 The hpcguix-web service periodically updates the package list it publishes by
20941 pulling channels from Git. To that end, it needs to access X.509 certificates
20942 so that it can authenticate Git servers when communicating over HTTPS, and it
20943 assumes that @file{/etc/ssl/certs} contains those certificates.
20944
20945 Thus, make sure to add @code{nss-certs} or another certificate package to the
20946 @code{packages} field of your configuration. @ref{X.509 Certificates}, for
20947 more information on X.509 certificates.
20948 @end quotation
20949
20950 @node Certificate Services
20951 @subsection Certificate Services
20952
20953 @cindex Web
20954 @cindex HTTP, HTTPS
20955 @cindex Let's Encrypt
20956 @cindex TLS certificates
20957 The @code{(gnu services certbot)} module provides a service to
20958 automatically obtain a valid TLS certificate from the Let's Encrypt
20959 certificate authority. These certificates can then be used to serve
20960 content securely over HTTPS or other TLS-based protocols, with the
20961 knowledge that the client will be able to verify the server's
20962 authenticity.
20963
20964 @url{https://letsencrypt.org/, Let's Encrypt} provides the
20965 @code{certbot} tool to automate the certification process. This tool
20966 first securely generates a key on the server. It then makes a request
20967 to the Let's Encrypt certificate authority (CA) to sign the key. The CA
20968 checks that the request originates from the host in question by using a
20969 challenge-response protocol, requiring the server to provide its
20970 response over HTTP. If that protocol completes successfully, the CA
20971 signs the key, resulting in a certificate. That certificate is valid
20972 for a limited period of time, and therefore to continue to provide TLS
20973 services, the server needs to periodically ask the CA to renew its
20974 signature.
20975
20976 The certbot service automates this process: the initial key
20977 generation, the initial certification request to the Let's Encrypt
20978 service, the web server challenge/response integration, writing the
20979 certificate to disk, the automated periodic renewals, and the deployment
20980 tasks associated with the renewal (e.g.@: reloading services, copying keys
20981 with different permissions).
20982
20983 Certbot is run twice a day, at a random minute within the hour. It
20984 won't do anything until your certificates are due for renewal or
20985 revoked, but running it regularly would give your service a chance of
20986 staying online in case a Let's Encrypt-initiated revocation happened for
20987 some reason.
20988
20989 By using this service, you agree to the ACME Subscriber Agreement, which
20990 can be found there:
20991 @url{https://acme-v01.api.letsencrypt.org/directory}.
20992
20993 @defvr {Scheme Variable} certbot-service-type
20994 A service type for the @code{certbot} Let's Encrypt client. Its value
20995 must be a @code{certbot-configuration} record as in this example:
20996
20997 @lisp
20998 (define %nginx-deploy-hook
20999 (program-file
21000 "nginx-deploy-hook"
21001 #~(let ((pid (call-with-input-file "/var/run/nginx/pid" read)))
21002 (kill pid SIGHUP))))
21003
21004 (service certbot-service-type
21005 (certbot-configuration
21006 (email "foo@@example.net")
21007 (certificates
21008 (list
21009 (certificate-configuration
21010 (domains '("example.net" "www.example.net"))
21011 (deploy-hook %nginx-deploy-hook))
21012 (certificate-configuration
21013 (domains '("bar.example.net")))))))
21014 @end lisp
21015
21016 See below for details about @code{certbot-configuration}.
21017 @end defvr
21018
21019 @deftp {Data Type} certbot-configuration
21020 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{certbot} service.
21021 This type has the following parameters:
21022
21023 @table @asis
21024 @item @code{package} (default: @code{certbot})
21025 The certbot package to use.
21026
21027 @item @code{webroot} (default: @code{/var/www})
21028 The directory from which to serve the Let's Encrypt challenge/response
21029 files.
21030
21031 @item @code{certificates} (default: @code{()})
21032 A list of @code{certificates-configuration}s for which to generate
21033 certificates and request signatures. Each certificate has a @code{name}
21034 and several @code{domains}.
21035
21036 @item @code{email}
21037 Mandatory email used for registration, recovery contact, and important
21038 account notifications.
21039
21040 @item @code{server} (default: @code{#f})
21041 Optional URL of ACME server. Setting this overrides certbot's default,
21042 which is the Let's Encrypt server.
21043
21044 @item @code{rsa-key-size} (default: @code{2048})
21045 Size of the RSA key.
21046
21047 @item @code{default-location} (default: @i{see below})
21048 The default @code{nginx-location-configuration}. Because @code{certbot}
21049 needs to be able to serve challenges and responses, it needs to be able
21050 to run a web server. It does so by extending the @code{nginx} web
21051 service with an @code{nginx-server-configuration} listening on the
21052 @var{domains} on port 80, and which has a
21053 @code{nginx-location-configuration} for the @code{/.well-known/} URI
21054 path subspace used by Let's Encrypt. @xref{Web Services}, for more on
21055 these nginx configuration data types.
21056
21057 Requests to other URL paths will be matched by the
21058 @code{default-location}, which if present is added to all
21059 @code{nginx-server-configuration}s.
21060
21061 By default, the @code{default-location} will issue a redirect from
21062 @code{http://@var{domain}/...} to @code{https://@var{domain}/...}, leaving
21063 you to define what to serve on your site via @code{https}.
21064
21065 Pass @code{#f} to not issue a default location.
21066 @end table
21067 @end deftp
21068
21069 @deftp {Data Type} certificate-configuration
21070 Data type representing the configuration of a certificate.
21071 This type has the following parameters:
21072
21073 @table @asis
21074 @item @code{name} (default: @i{see below})
21075 This name is used by Certbot for housekeeping and in file paths; it
21076 doesn't affect the content of the certificate itself. To see
21077 certificate names, run @code{certbot certificates}.
21078
21079 Its default is the first provided domain.
21080
21081 @item @code{domains} (default: @code{()})
21082 The first domain provided will be the subject CN of the certificate, and
21083 all domains will be Subject Alternative Names on the certificate.
21084
21085 @item @code{challenge} (default: @code{#f})
21086 The challenge type that has to be run by certbot. If @code{#f} is specified,
21087 default to the HTTP challenge. If a value is specified, defaults to the
21088 manual plugin (see @code{authentication-hook}, @code{cleanup-hook} and
21089 the documentation at @url{https://certbot.eff.org/docs/using.html#hooks}),
21090 and gives Let's Encrypt permission to log the public IP address of the
21091 requesting machine.
21092
21093 @item @code{authentication-hook} (default: @code{#f})
21094 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge to be
21095 answered. For this command, the shell variable @code{$CERTBOT_DOMAIN}
21096 will contain the domain being authenticated, @code{$CERTBOT_VALIDATION}
21097 contains the validation string and @code{$CERTBOT_TOKEN} contains the
21098 file name of the resource requested when performing an HTTP-01 challenge.
21099
21100 @item @code{cleanup-hook} (default: @code{#f})
21101 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge that
21102 have been answered by the @code{auth-hook}. For this command, the shell
21103 variables available in the @code{auth-hook} script are still available, and
21104 additionally @code{$CERTBOT_AUTH_OUTPUT} will contain the standard output
21105 of the @code{auth-hook} script.
21106
21107 @item @code{deploy-hook} (default: @code{#f})
21108 Command to be run in a shell once for each successfully issued
21109 certificate. For this command, the shell variable
21110 @code{$RENEWED_LINEAGE} will point to the config live subdirectory (for
21111 example, @samp{"/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com"}) containing the new
21112 certificates and keys; the shell variable @code{$RENEWED_DOMAINS} will
21113 contain a space-delimited list of renewed certificate domains (for
21114 example, @samp{"example.com www.example.com"}.
21115
21116 @end table
21117 @end deftp
21118
21119 For each @code{certificate-configuration}, the certificate is saved to
21120 @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/fullchain.pem} and the key is
21121 saved to @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/privkey.pem}.
21122 @node DNS Services
21123 @subsection DNS Services
21124 @cindex DNS (domain name system)
21125 @cindex domain name system (DNS)
21126
21127 The @code{(gnu services dns)} module provides services related to the
21128 @dfn{domain name system} (DNS). It provides a server service for hosting
21129 an @emph{authoritative} DNS server for multiple zones, slave or master.
21130 This service uses @uref{https://www.knot-dns.cz/, Knot DNS}. And also a
21131 caching and forwarding DNS server for the LAN, which uses
21132 @uref{http://www.thekelleys.org.uk/dnsmasq/doc.html, dnsmasq}.
21133
21134 @subsubheading Knot Service
21135
21136 An example configuration of an authoritative server for two zones, one master
21137 and one slave, is:
21138
21139 @lisp
21140 (define-zone-entries example.org.zone
21141 ;; Name TTL Class Type Data
21142 ("@@" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1")
21143 ("@@" "" "IN" "NS" "ns")
21144 ("ns" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1"))
21145
21146 (define master-zone
21147 (knot-zone-configuration
21148 (domain "example.org")
21149 (zone (zone-file
21150 (origin "example.org")
21151 (entries example.org.zone)))))
21152
21153 (define slave-zone
21154 (knot-zone-configuration
21155 (domain "plop.org")
21156 (dnssec-policy "default")
21157 (master (list "plop-master"))))
21158
21159 (define plop-master
21160 (knot-remote-configuration
21161 (id "plop-master")
21162 (address (list "208.76.58.171"))))
21163
21164 (operating-system
21165 ;; ...
21166 (services (cons* (service knot-service-type
21167 (knot-configuration
21168 (remotes (list plop-master))
21169 (zones (list master-zone slave-zone))))
21170 ;; ...
21171 %base-services)))
21172 @end lisp
21173
21174 @deffn {Scheme Variable} knot-service-type
21175 This is the type for the Knot DNS server.
21176
21177 Knot DNS is an authoritative DNS server, meaning that it can serve multiple
21178 zones, that is to say domain names you would buy from a registrar. This server
21179 is not a resolver, meaning that it can only resolve names for which it is
21180 authoritative. This server can be configured to serve zones as a master server
21181 or a slave server as a per-zone basis. Slave zones will get their data from
21182 masters, and will serve it as an authoritative server. From the point of view
21183 of a resolver, there is no difference between master and slave.
21184
21185 The following data types are used to configure the Knot DNS server:
21186 @end deffn
21187
21188 @deftp {Data Type} knot-key-configuration
21189 Data type representing a key.
21190 This type has the following parameters:
21191
21192 @table @asis
21193 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
21194 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must
21195 be unique and must not be empty.
21196
21197 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{#f})
21198 The algorithm to use. Choose between @code{#f}, @code{'hmac-md5},
21199 @code{'hmac-sha1}, @code{'hmac-sha224}, @code{'hmac-sha256}, @code{'hmac-sha384}
21200 and @code{'hmac-sha512}.
21201
21202 @item @code{secret} (default: @code{""})
21203 The secret key itself.
21204
21205 @end table
21206 @end deftp
21207
21208 @deftp {Data Type} knot-acl-configuration
21209 Data type representing an Access Control List (ACL) configuration.
21210 This type has the following parameters:
21211
21212 @table @asis
21213 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
21214 An identifier for ether configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must be
21215 unique and must not be empty.
21216
21217 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
21218 An ordered list of IP addresses, network subnets, or network ranges represented
21219 with strings. The query must match one of them. Empty value means that
21220 address match is not required.
21221
21222 @item @code{key} (default: @code{'()})
21223 An ordered list of references to keys represented with strings. The string
21224 must match a key ID defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration}. No key means
21225 that a key is not require to match that ACL.
21226
21227 @item @code{action} (default: @code{'()})
21228 An ordered list of actions that are permitted or forbidden by this ACL. Possible
21229 values are lists of zero or more elements from @code{'transfer}, @code{'notify}
21230 and @code{'update}.
21231
21232 @item @code{deny?} (default: @code{#f})
21233 When true, the ACL defines restrictions. Listed actions are forbidden. When
21234 false, listed actions are allowed.
21235
21236 @end table
21237 @end deftp
21238
21239 @deftp {Data Type} zone-entry
21240 Data type representing a record entry in a zone file.
21241 This type has the following parameters:
21242
21243 @table @asis
21244 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"@@"})
21245 The name of the record. @code{"@@"} refers to the origin of the zone. Names
21246 are relative to the origin of the zone. For example, in the @code{example.org}
21247 zone, @code{"ns.example.org"} actually refers to @code{ns.example.org.example.org}.
21248 Names ending with a dot are absolute, which means that @code{"ns.example.org."}
21249 refers to @code{ns.example.org}.
21250
21251 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{""})
21252 The Time-To-Live (TTL) of this record. If not set, the default TTL is used.
21253
21254 @item @code{class} (default: @code{"IN"})
21255 The class of the record. Knot currently supports only @code{"IN"} and
21256 partially @code{"CH"}.
21257
21258 @item @code{type} (default: @code{"A"})
21259 The type of the record. Common types include A (IPv4 address), AAAA (IPv6
21260 address), NS (Name Server) and MX (Mail eXchange). Many other types are
21261 defined.
21262
21263 @item @code{data} (default: @code{""})
21264 The data contained in the record. For instance an IP address associated with
21265 an A record, or a domain name associated with an NS record. Remember that
21266 domain names are relative to the origin unless they end with a dot.
21267
21268 @end table
21269 @end deftp
21270
21271 @deftp {Data Type} zone-file
21272 Data type representing the content of a zone file.
21273 This type has the following parameters:
21274
21275 @table @asis
21276 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
21277 The list of entries. The SOA record is taken care of, so you don't need to
21278 put it in the list of entries. This list should probably contain an entry
21279 for your primary authoritative DNS server. Other than using a list of entries
21280 directly, you can use @code{define-zone-entries} to define a object containing
21281 the list of entries more easily, that you can later pass to the @code{entries}
21282 field of the @code{zone-file}.
21283
21284 @item @code{origin} (default: @code{""})
21285 The name of your zone. This parameter cannot be empty.
21286
21287 @item @code{ns} (default: @code{"ns"})
21288 The domain of your primary authoritative DNS server. The name is relative to
21289 the origin, unless it ends with a dot. It is mandatory that this primary
21290 DNS server corresponds to an NS record in the zone and that it is associated
21291 to an IP address in the list of entries.
21292
21293 @item @code{mail} (default: @code{"hostmaster"})
21294 An email address people can contact you at, as the owner of the zone. This
21295 is translated as @code{<mail>@@<origin>}.
21296
21297 @item @code{serial} (default: @code{1})
21298 The serial number of the zone. As this is used to keep track of changes by
21299 both slaves and resolvers, it is mandatory that it @emph{never} decreases.
21300 Always increment it when you make a change in your zone.
21301
21302 @item @code{refresh} (default: @code{(* 2 24 3600)})
21303 The frequency at which slaves will do a zone transfer. This value is a number
21304 of seconds. It can be computed by multiplications or with
21305 @code{(string->duration)}.
21306
21307 @item @code{retry} (default: @code{(* 15 60)})
21308 The period after which a slave will retry to contact its master when it fails
21309 to do so a first time.
21310
21311 @item @code{expiry} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
21312 Default TTL of records. Existing records are considered correct for at most
21313 this amount of time. After this period, resolvers will invalidate their cache
21314 and check again that it still exists.
21315
21316 @item @code{nx} (default: @code{3600})
21317 Default TTL of inexistant records. This delay is usually short because you want
21318 your new domains to reach everyone quickly.
21319
21320 @end table
21321 @end deftp
21322
21323 @deftp {Data Type} knot-remote-configuration
21324 Data type representing a remote configuration.
21325 This type has the following parameters:
21326
21327 @table @asis
21328 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
21329 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this remote. IDs must
21330 be unique and must not be empty.
21331
21332 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
21333 An ordered list of destination IP addresses. Addresses are tried in sequence.
21334 An optional port can be given with the @@ separator. For instance:
21335 @code{(list "1.2.3.4" "2.3.4.5@@53")}. Default port is 53.
21336
21337 @item @code{via} (default: @code{'()})
21338 An ordered list of source IP addresses. An empty list will have Knot choose
21339 an appropriate source IP. An optional port can be given with the @@ separator.
21340 The default is to choose at random.
21341
21342 @item @code{key} (default: @code{#f})
21343 A reference to a key, that is a string containing the identifier of a key
21344 defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration} field.
21345
21346 @end table
21347 @end deftp
21348
21349 @deftp {Data Type} knot-keystore-configuration
21350 Data type representing a keystore to hold dnssec keys.
21351 This type has the following parameters:
21352
21353 @table @asis
21354 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
21355 The id of the keystore. It must not be empty.
21356
21357 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{'pem})
21358 The backend to store the keys in. Can be @code{'pem} or @code{'pkcs11}.
21359
21360 @item @code{config} (default: @code{"/var/lib/knot/keys/keys"})
21361 The configuration string of the backend. An example for the PKCS#11 is:
21362 @code{"pkcs11:token=knot;pin-value=1234 /gnu/store/.../lib/pkcs11/libsofthsm2.so"}.
21363 For the pem backend, the string represents a path in the file system.
21364
21365 @end table
21366 @end deftp
21367
21368 @deftp {Data Type} knot-policy-configuration
21369 Data type representing a dnssec policy. Knot DNS is able to automatically
21370 sign your zones. It can either generate and manage your keys automatically or
21371 use keys that you generate.
21372
21373 Dnssec is usually implemented using two keys: a Key Signing Key (KSK) that is
21374 used to sign the second, and a Zone Signing Key (ZSK) that is used to sign the
21375 zone. In order to be trusted, the KSK needs to be present in the parent zone
21376 (usually a top-level domain). If your registrar supports dnssec, you will
21377 have to send them your KSK's hash so they can add a DS record in their zone.
21378 This is not automated and need to be done each time you change your KSK.
21379
21380 The policy also defines the lifetime of keys. Usually, ZSK can be changed
21381 easily and use weaker cryptographic functions (they use lower parameters) in
21382 order to sign records quickly, so they are changed often. The KSK however
21383 requires manual interaction with the registrar, so they are changed less often
21384 and use stronger parameters because they sign only one record.
21385
21386 This type has the following parameters:
21387
21388 @table @asis
21389 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
21390 The id of the policy. It must not be empty.
21391
21392 @item @code{keystore} (default: @code{"default"})
21393 A reference to a keystore, that is a string containing the identifier of a
21394 keystore defined in a @code{knot-keystore-configuration} field. The
21395 @code{"default"} identifier means the default keystore (a kasp database that
21396 was setup by this service).
21397
21398 @item @code{manual?} (default: @code{#f})
21399 Whether the key management is manual or automatic.
21400
21401 @item @code{single-type-signing?} (default: @code{#f})
21402 When @code{#t}, use the Single-Type Signing Scheme.
21403
21404 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{"ecdsap256sha256"})
21405 An algorithm of signing keys and issued signatures.
21406
21407 @item @code{ksk-size} (default: @code{256})
21408 The length of the KSK. Note that this value is correct for the default
21409 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
21410
21411 @item @code{zsk-size} (default: @code{256})
21412 The length of the ZSK. Note that this value is correct for the default
21413 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
21414
21415 @item @code{dnskey-ttl} (default: @code{'default})
21416 The TTL value for DNSKEY records added into zone apex. The special
21417 @code{'default} value means same as the zone SOA TTL.
21418
21419 @item @code{zsk-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
21420 The period between ZSK publication and the next rollover initiation.
21421
21422 @item @code{propagation-delay} (default: @code{(* 24 3600)})
21423 An extra delay added for each key rollover step. This value should be high
21424 enough to cover propagation of data from the master server to all slaves.
21425
21426 @item @code{rrsig-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
21427 A validity period of newly issued signatures.
21428
21429 @item @code{rrsig-refresh} (default: @code{(* 7 24 3600)})
21430 A period how long before a signature expiration the signature will be refreshed.
21431
21432 @item @code{nsec3?} (default: @code{#f})
21433 When @code{#t}, NSEC3 will be used instead of NSEC.
21434
21435 @item @code{nsec3-iterations} (default: @code{5})
21436 The number of additional times the hashing is performed.
21437
21438 @item @code{nsec3-salt-length} (default: @code{8})
21439 The length of a salt field in octets, which is appended to the original owner
21440 name before hashing.
21441
21442 @item @code{nsec3-salt-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
21443 The validity period of newly issued salt field.
21444
21445 @end table
21446 @end deftp
21447
21448 @deftp {Data Type} knot-zone-configuration
21449 Data type representing a zone served by Knot.
21450 This type has the following parameters:
21451
21452 @table @asis
21453 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{""})
21454 The domain served by this configuration. It must not be empty.
21455
21456 @item @code{file} (default: @code{""})
21457 The file where this zone is saved. This parameter is ignored by master zones.
21458 Empty means default location that depends on the domain name.
21459
21460 @item @code{zone} (default: @code{(zone-file)})
21461 The content of the zone file. This parameter is ignored by slave zones. It
21462 must contain a zone-file record.
21463
21464 @item @code{master} (default: @code{'()})
21465 A list of master remotes. When empty, this zone is a master. When set, this
21466 zone is a slave. This is a list of remotes identifiers.
21467
21468 @item @code{ddns-master} (default: @code{#f})
21469 The main master. When empty, it defaults to the first master in the list of
21470 masters.
21471
21472 @item @code{notify} (default: @code{'()})
21473 A list of slave remote identifiers.
21474
21475 @item @code{acl} (default: @code{'()})
21476 A list of acl identifiers.
21477
21478 @item @code{semantic-checks?} (default: @code{#f})
21479 When set, this adds more semantic checks to the zone.
21480
21481 @item @code{disable-any?} (default: @code{#f})
21482 When set, this forbids queries of the ANY type.
21483
21484 @item @code{zonefile-sync} (default: @code{0})
21485 The delay between a modification in memory and on disk. 0 means immediate
21486 synchronization.
21487
21488 @item @code{zonefile-load} (default: @code{#f})
21489 The way the zone file contents are applied during zone load. Possible values
21490 are:
21491
21492 @itemize
21493 @item @code{#f} for using the default value from Knot,
21494 @item @code{'none} for not using the zone file at all,
21495 @item @code{'difference} for computing the difference between already available
21496 contents and zone contents and applying it to the current zone contents,
21497 @item @code{'difference-no-serial} for the same as @code{'difference}, but
21498 ignoring the SOA serial in the zone file, while the server takes care of it
21499 automatically.
21500 @item @code{'whole} for loading zone contents from the zone file.
21501 @end itemize
21502
21503 @item @code{journal-content} (default: @code{#f})
21504 The way the journal is used to store zone and its changes. Possible values
21505 are @code{'none} to not use it at all, @code{'changes} to store changes and
21506 @code{'all} to store contents. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
21507 default value from Knot is used.
21508
21509 @item @code{max-journal-usage} (default: @code{#f})
21510 The maximum size for the journal on disk. @code{#f} does not set this option,
21511 so the default value from Knot is used.
21512
21513 @item @code{max-journal-depth} (default: @code{#f})
21514 The maximum size of the history. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
21515 default value from Knot is used.
21516
21517 @item @code{max-zone-size} (default: @code{#f})
21518 The maximum size of the zone file. This limit is enforced for incoming
21519 transfer and updates. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the default
21520 value from Knot is used.
21521
21522 @item @code{dnssec-policy} (default: @code{#f})
21523 A reference to a @code{knot-policy-configuration} record, or the special
21524 name @code{"default"}. If the value is @code{#f}, there is no dnssec signing
21525 on this zone.
21526
21527 @item @code{serial-policy} (default: @code{'increment})
21528 A policy between @code{'increment} and @code{'unixtime}.
21529
21530 @end table
21531 @end deftp
21532
21533 @deftp {Data Type} knot-configuration
21534 Data type representing the Knot configuration.
21535 This type has the following parameters:
21536
21537 @table @asis
21538 @item @code{knot} (default: @code{knot})
21539 The Knot package.
21540
21541 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/knot"})
21542 The run directory. This directory will be used for pid file and sockets.
21543
21544 @item @code{includes} (default: @code{'()})
21545 A list of strings or file-like objects denoting other files that must be
21546 included at the top of the configuration file.
21547
21548 @cindex secrets, Knot service
21549 This can be used to manage secrets out-of-band. For example, secret
21550 keys may be stored in an out-of-band file not managed by Guix, and
21551 thus not visible in @file{/gnu/store}---e.g., you could store secret
21552 key configuration in @file{/etc/knot/secrets.conf} and add this file
21553 to the @code{includes} list.
21554
21555 One can generate a secret tsig key (for nsupdate and zone transfers with the
21556 keymgr command from the knot package. Note that the package is not automatically
21557 installed by the service. The following example shows how to generate a new
21558 tsig key:
21559
21560 @example
21561 keymgr -t mysecret > /etc/knot/secrets.conf
21562 chmod 600 /etc/knot/secrets.conf
21563 @end example
21564
21565 Also note that the generated key will be named @var{mysecret}, so it is the
21566 name that needs to be used in the @var{key} field of the
21567 @code{knot-acl-configuration} record and in other places that need to refer
21568 to that key.
21569
21570 It can also be used to add configuration not supported by this interface.
21571
21572 @item @code{listen-v4} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
21573 An ip address on which to listen.
21574
21575 @item @code{listen-v6} (default: @code{"::"})
21576 An ip address on which to listen.
21577
21578 @item @code{listen-port} (default: @code{53})
21579 A port on which to listen.
21580
21581 @item @code{keys} (default: @code{'()})
21582 The list of knot-key-configuration used by this configuration.
21583
21584 @item @code{acls} (default: @code{'()})
21585 The list of knot-acl-configuration used by this configuration.
21586
21587 @item @code{remotes} (default: @code{'()})
21588 The list of knot-remote-configuration used by this configuration.
21589
21590 @item @code{zones} (default: @code{'()})
21591 The list of knot-zone-configuration used by this configuration.
21592
21593 @end table
21594 @end deftp
21595
21596 @subsubheading Knot Resolver Service
21597
21598 @deffn {Scheme Variable} knot-resolver-service-type
21599 This this the type of the knot resolver service, whose value should be
21600 an @code{knot-resolver-configuration} object as in this example:
21601
21602 @lisp
21603 (service knot-resolver-service-type
21604 (knot-resolver-configuration
21605 (kresd-config-file (plain-file "kresd.conf" "
21606 net.listen('192.168.0.1', 5353)
21607 user('knot-resolver', 'knot-resolver')
21608 modules = @{ 'hints > iterate', 'stats', 'predict' @}
21609 cache.size = 100 * MB
21610 "))))
21611 @end lisp
21612
21613 For more information, refer its @url{https://knot-resolver.readthedocs.org/en/stable/daemon.html#configuration, manual}.
21614 @end deffn
21615
21616 @deftp {Data Type} knot-resolver-configuration
21617 Data type representing the configuration of knot-resolver.
21618
21619 @table @asis
21620 @item @code{package} (default: @var{knot-resolver})
21621 Package object of the knot DNS resolver.
21622
21623 @item @code{kresd-config-file} (default: %kresd.conf)
21624 File-like object of the kresd configuration file to use, by default it
21625 will listen on @code{127.0.0.1} and @code{::1}.
21626
21627 @item @code{garbage-collection-interval} (default: 1000)
21628 Number of milliseconds for @code{kres-cache-gc} to periodically trim the cache.
21629
21630 @end table
21631 @end deftp
21632
21633
21634 @subsubheading Dnsmasq Service
21635
21636 @deffn {Scheme Variable} dnsmasq-service-type
21637 This is the type of the dnsmasq service, whose value should be an
21638 @code{dnsmasq-configuration} object as in this example:
21639
21640 @lisp
21641 (service dnsmasq-service-type
21642 (dnsmasq-configuration
21643 (no-resolv? #t)
21644 (servers '("192.168.1.1"))))
21645 @end lisp
21646 @end deffn
21647
21648 @deftp {Data Type} dnsmasq-configuration
21649 Data type representing the configuration of dnsmasq.
21650
21651 @table @asis
21652 @item @code{package} (default: @var{dnsmasq})
21653 Package object of the dnsmasq server.
21654
21655 @item @code{no-hosts?} (default: @code{#f})
21656 When true, don't read the hostnames in /etc/hosts.
21657
21658 @item @code{port} (default: @code{53})
21659 The port to listen on. Setting this to zero completely disables DNS
21660 responses, leaving only DHCP and/or TFTP functions.
21661
21662 @item @code{local-service?} (default: @code{#t})
21663 Accept DNS queries only from hosts whose address is on a local subnet,
21664 ie a subnet for which an interface exists on the server.
21665
21666 @item @code{listen-addresses} (default: @code{'()})
21667 Listen on the given IP addresses.
21668
21669 @item @code{resolv-file} (default: @code{"/etc/resolv.conf"})
21670 The file to read the IP address of the upstream nameservers from.
21671
21672 @item @code{no-resolv?} (default: @code{#f})
21673 When true, don't read @var{resolv-file}.
21674
21675 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{'()})
21676 Specify IP address of upstream servers directly.
21677
21678 @item @code{cache-size} (default: @code{150})
21679 Set the size of dnsmasq's cache. Setting the cache size to zero
21680 disables caching.
21681
21682 @item @code{negative-cache?} (default: @code{#t})
21683 When false, disable negative caching.
21684
21685 @end table
21686 @end deftp
21687
21688 @subsubheading ddclient Service
21689
21690 @cindex ddclient
21691 The ddclient service described below runs the ddclient daemon, which takes
21692 care of automatically updating DNS entries for service providers such as
21693 @uref{https://dyn.com/dns/, Dyn}.
21694
21695 The following example show instantiates the service with its default
21696 configuration:
21697
21698 @lisp
21699 (service ddclient-service-type)
21700 @end lisp
21701
21702 Note that ddclient needs to access credentials that are stored in a
21703 @dfn{secret file}, by default @file{/etc/ddclient/secrets} (see
21704 @code{secret-file} below.) You are expected to create this file manually, in
21705 an ``out-of-band'' fashion (you @emph{could} make this file part of the
21706 service configuration, for instance by using @code{plain-file}, but it will be
21707 world-readable @i{via} @file{/gnu/store}.) See the examples in the
21708 @file{share/ddclient} directory of the @code{ddclient} package.
21709
21710 @c %start of fragment
21711
21712 Available @code{ddclient-configuration} fields are:
21713
21714 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} package ddclient
21715 The ddclient package.
21716
21717 @end deftypevr
21718
21719 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} integer daemon
21720 The period after which ddclient will retry to check IP and domain name.
21721
21722 Defaults to @samp{300}.
21723
21724 @end deftypevr
21725
21726 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean syslog
21727 Use syslog for the output.
21728
21729 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21730
21731 @end deftypevr
21732
21733 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail
21734 Mail to user.
21735
21736 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
21737
21738 @end deftypevr
21739
21740 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail-failure
21741 Mail failed update to user.
21742
21743 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
21744
21745 @end deftypevr
21746
21747 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string pid
21748 The ddclient PID file.
21749
21750 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/ddclient/ddclient.pid"}.
21751
21752 @end deftypevr
21753
21754 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl
21755 Enable SSL support.
21756
21757 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21758
21759 @end deftypevr
21760
21761 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string user
21762 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running ddclient
21763 program.
21764
21765 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
21766
21767 @end deftypevr
21768
21769 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string group
21770 Group of the user who will run the ddclient program.
21771
21772 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
21773
21774 @end deftypevr
21775
21776 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string secret-file
21777 Secret file which will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file. This
21778 file contains credentials for use by ddclient. You are expected to
21779 create it manually.
21780
21781 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ddclient/secrets.conf"}.
21782
21783 @end deftypevr
21784
21785 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
21786 Extra options will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file.
21787
21788 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21789
21790 @end deftypevr
21791
21792
21793 @c %end of fragment
21794
21795
21796 @node VPN Services
21797 @subsection VPN Services
21798 @cindex VPN (virtual private network)
21799 @cindex virtual private network (VPN)
21800
21801 The @code{(gnu services vpn)} module provides services related to
21802 @dfn{virtual private networks} (VPNs). It provides a @emph{client} service for
21803 your machine to connect to a VPN, and a @emph{server} service for your machine
21804 to host a VPN. Both services use @uref{https://openvpn.net/, OpenVPN}.
21805
21806 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-client-service @
21807 [#:config (openvpn-client-configuration)]
21808
21809 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a client.
21810 @end deffn
21811
21812 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-server-service @
21813 [#:config (openvpn-server-configuration)]
21814
21815 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a server.
21816
21817 Both can be run simultaneously.
21818 @end deffn
21819
21820 @c %automatically generated documentation
21821
21822 Available @code{openvpn-client-configuration} fields are:
21823
21824 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
21825 The OpenVPN package.
21826
21827 @end deftypevr
21828
21829 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
21830 The OpenVPN pid file.
21831
21832 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
21833
21834 @end deftypevr
21835
21836 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} proto proto
21837 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
21838 servers.
21839
21840 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
21841
21842 @end deftypevr
21843
21844 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} dev dev
21845 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
21846
21847 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
21848
21849 @end deftypevr
21850
21851 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string ca
21852 The certificate authority to check connections against.
21853
21854 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
21855
21856 @end deftypevr
21857
21858 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string cert
21859 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
21860 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
21861
21862 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
21863
21864 @end deftypevr
21865
21866 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string key
21867 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
21868 certificate is @code{cert}.
21869
21870 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
21871
21872 @end deftypevr
21873
21874 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
21875 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
21876
21877 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21878
21879 @end deftypevr
21880
21881 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
21882 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
21883
21884 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21885
21886 @end deftypevr
21887
21888 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
21889 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
21890 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
21891
21892 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21893
21894 @end deftypevr
21895
21896 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean fast-io?
21897 (Experimental) Optimize TUN/TAP/UDP I/O writes by avoiding a call to
21898 poll/epoll/select prior to the write operation.
21899
21900 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21901 @end deftypevr
21902
21903 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
21904 Verbosity level.
21905
21906 Defaults to @samp{3}.
21907
21908 @end deftypevr
21909
21910 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-client tls-auth
21911 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
21912 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
21913
21914 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21915
21916 @end deftypevr
21917
21918 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} maybe-string auth-user-pass
21919 Authenticate with server using username/password. The option is a file
21920 containing username/password on 2 lines. Do not use a file-like object as it
21921 would be added to the store and readable by any user.
21922
21923 Defaults to @samp{'disabled}.
21924 @end deftypevr
21925
21926 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} key-usage verify-key-usage?
21927 Whether to check the server certificate has server usage extension.
21928
21929 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21930
21931 @end deftypevr
21932
21933 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} bind bind?
21934 Bind to a specific local port number.
21935
21936 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21937
21938 @end deftypevr
21939
21940 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} resolv-retry resolv-retry?
21941 Retry resolving server address.
21942
21943 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21944
21945 @end deftypevr
21946
21947 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} openvpn-remote-list remote
21948 A list of remote servers to connect to.
21949
21950 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21951
21952 Available @code{openvpn-remote-configuration} fields are:
21953
21954 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} string name
21955 Server name.
21956
21957 Defaults to @samp{"my-server"}.
21958
21959 @end deftypevr
21960
21961 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} number port
21962 Port number the server listens to.
21963
21964 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
21965
21966 @end deftypevr
21967
21968 @end deftypevr
21969 @c %end of automatic openvpn-client documentation
21970
21971 @c %automatically generated documentation
21972
21973 Available @code{openvpn-server-configuration} fields are:
21974
21975 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
21976 The OpenVPN package.
21977
21978 @end deftypevr
21979
21980 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
21981 The OpenVPN pid file.
21982
21983 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
21984
21985 @end deftypevr
21986
21987 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} proto proto
21988 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
21989 servers.
21990
21991 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
21992
21993 @end deftypevr
21994
21995 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} dev dev
21996 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
21997
21998 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
21999
22000 @end deftypevr
22001
22002 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string ca
22003 The certificate authority to check connections against.
22004
22005 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
22006
22007 @end deftypevr
22008
22009 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string cert
22010 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
22011 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
22012
22013 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
22014
22015 @end deftypevr
22016
22017 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string key
22018 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
22019 certificate is @code{cert}.
22020
22021 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
22022
22023 @end deftypevr
22024
22025 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
22026 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
22027
22028 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22029
22030 @end deftypevr
22031
22032 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
22033 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
22034
22035 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22036
22037 @end deftypevr
22038
22039 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
22040 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
22041 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
22042
22043 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22044
22045 @end deftypevr
22046
22047 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean fast-io?
22048 (Experimental) Optimize TUN/TAP/UDP I/O writes by avoiding a call to
22049 poll/epoll/select prior to the write operation.
22050
22051 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22052 @end deftypevr
22053
22054 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
22055 Verbosity level.
22056
22057 Defaults to @samp{3}.
22058
22059 @end deftypevr
22060
22061 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-server tls-auth
22062 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
22063 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
22064
22065 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22066
22067 @end deftypevr
22068
22069 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number port
22070 Specifies the port number on which the server listens.
22071
22072 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
22073
22074 @end deftypevr
22075
22076 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} ip-mask server
22077 An ip and mask specifying the subnet inside the virtual network.
22078
22079 Defaults to @samp{"10.8.0.0 255.255.255.0"}.
22080
22081 @end deftypevr
22082
22083 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} cidr6 server-ipv6
22084 A CIDR notation specifying the IPv6 subnet inside the virtual network.
22085
22086 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22087
22088 @end deftypevr
22089
22090 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string dh
22091 The Diffie-Hellman parameters file.
22092
22093 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/dh2048.pem"}.
22094
22095 @end deftypevr
22096
22097 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string ifconfig-pool-persist
22098 The file that records client IPs.
22099
22100 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ipp.txt"}.
22101
22102 @end deftypevr
22103
22104 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} gateway redirect-gateway?
22105 When true, the server will act as a gateway for its clients.
22106
22107 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22108
22109 @end deftypevr
22110
22111 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean client-to-client?
22112 When true, clients are allowed to talk to each other inside the VPN.
22113
22114 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22115
22116 @end deftypevr
22117
22118 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} keepalive keepalive
22119 Causes ping-like messages to be sent back and forth over the link so
22120 that each side knows when the other side has gone down. @code{keepalive}
22121 requires a pair. The first element is the period of the ping sending,
22122 and the second element is the timeout before considering the other side
22123 down.
22124
22125 @end deftypevr
22126
22127 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number max-clients
22128 The maximum number of clients.
22129
22130 Defaults to @samp{100}.
22131
22132 @end deftypevr
22133
22134 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string status
22135 The status file. This file shows a small report on current connection.
22136 It is truncated and rewritten every minute.
22137
22138 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/status"}.
22139
22140 @end deftypevr
22141
22142 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} openvpn-ccd-list client-config-dir
22143 The list of configuration for some clients.
22144
22145 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22146
22147 Available @code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} fields are:
22148
22149 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} string name
22150 Client name.
22151
22152 Defaults to @samp{"client"}.
22153
22154 @end deftypevr
22155
22156 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask iroute
22157 Client own network
22158
22159 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22160
22161 @end deftypevr
22162
22163 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask ifconfig-push
22164 Client VPN IP.
22165
22166 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22167
22168 @end deftypevr
22169
22170 @end deftypevr
22171
22172
22173 @c %end of automatic openvpn-server documentation
22174
22175
22176 @node Network File System
22177 @subsection Network File System
22178 @cindex NFS
22179
22180 The @code{(gnu services nfs)} module provides the following services,
22181 which are most commonly used in relation to mounting or exporting
22182 directory trees as @dfn{network file systems} (NFS).
22183
22184 While it is possible to use the individual components that together make
22185 up a Network File System service, we recommended to configure an NFS
22186 server with the @code{nfs-service-type}.
22187
22188 @subsubheading NFS Service
22189 @cindex NFS, server
22190
22191 The NFS service takes care of setting up all NFS component services,
22192 kernel configuration file systems, and installs configuration files in
22193 the locations that NFS expects.
22194
22195 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nfs-service-type
22196 A service type for a complete NFS server.
22197 @end defvr
22198
22199 @deftp {Data Type} nfs-configuration
22200 This data type represents the configuration of the NFS service and all
22201 of its subsystems.
22202
22203 It has the following parameters:
22204 @table @asis
22205 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
22206 The nfs-utils package to use.
22207
22208 @item @code{nfs-version} (default: @code{#f})
22209 If a string value is provided, the @command{rpc.nfsd} daemon will be
22210 limited to supporting the given version of the NFS protocol.
22211
22212 @item @code{exports} (default: @code{'()})
22213 This is a list of directories the NFS server should export. Each entry
22214 is a list consisting of two elements: a directory name and a string
22215 containing all options. This is an example in which the directory
22216 @file{/export} is served to all NFS clients as a read-only share:
22217
22218 @lisp
22219 (nfs-configuration
22220 (exports
22221 '(("/export"
22222 "*(ro,insecure,no_subtree_check,crossmnt,fsid=0)"))))
22223 @end lisp
22224
22225 @item @code{rpcmountd-port} (default: @code{#f})
22226 The network port that the @command{rpc.mountd} daemon should use.
22227
22228 @item @code{rpcstatd-port} (default: @code{#f})
22229 The network port that the @command{rpc.statd} daemon should use.
22230
22231 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
22232 The rpcbind package to use.
22233
22234 @item @code{idmap-domain} (default: @code{"localdomain"})
22235 The local NFSv4 domain name.
22236
22237 @item @code{nfsd-port} (default: @code{2049})
22238 The network port that the @command{nfsd} daemon should use.
22239
22240 @item @code{nfsd-threads} (default: @code{8})
22241 The number of threads used by the @command{nfsd} daemon.
22242
22243 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
22244 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
22245
22246 @item @code{debug} (default: @code{'()"})
22247 A list of subsystems for which debugging output should be enabled. This
22248 is a list of symbols. Any of these symbols are valid: @code{nfsd},
22249 @code{nfs}, @code{rpc}, @code{idmap}, @code{statd}, or @code{mountd}.
22250 @end table
22251 @end deftp
22252
22253 If you don't need a complete NFS service or prefer to build it yourself
22254 you can use the individual component services that are documented below.
22255
22256 @subsubheading RPC Bind Service
22257 @cindex rpcbind
22258
22259 The RPC Bind service provides a facility to map program numbers into
22260 universal addresses.
22261 Many NFS related services use this facility. Hence it is automatically
22262 started when a dependent service starts.
22263
22264 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rpcbind-service-type
22265 A service type for the RPC portmapper daemon.
22266 @end defvr
22267
22268
22269 @deftp {Data Type} rpcbind-configuration
22270 Data type representing the configuration of the RPC Bind Service.
22271 This type has the following parameters:
22272 @table @asis
22273 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
22274 The rpcbind package to use.
22275
22276 @item @code{warm-start?} (default: @code{#t})
22277 If this parameter is @code{#t}, then the daemon will read a
22278 state file on startup thus reloading state information saved by a previous
22279 instance.
22280 @end table
22281 @end deftp
22282
22283
22284 @subsubheading Pipefs Pseudo File System
22285 @cindex pipefs
22286 @cindex rpc_pipefs
22287
22288 The pipefs file system is used to transfer NFS related data
22289 between the kernel and user space programs.
22290
22291 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pipefs-service-type
22292 A service type for the pipefs pseudo file system.
22293 @end defvr
22294
22295 @deftp {Data Type} pipefs-configuration
22296 Data type representing the configuration of the pipefs pseudo file system service.
22297 This type has the following parameters:
22298 @table @asis
22299 @item @code{mount-point} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
22300 The directory to which the file system is to be attached.
22301 @end table
22302 @end deftp
22303
22304
22305 @subsubheading GSS Daemon Service
22306 @cindex GSSD
22307 @cindex GSS
22308 @cindex global security system
22309
22310 The @dfn{global security system} (GSS) daemon provides strong security for RPC
22311 based protocols.
22312 Before exchanging RPC requests an RPC client must establish a security
22313 context. Typically this is done using the Kerberos command @command{kinit}
22314 or automatically at login time using PAM services (@pxref{Kerberos Services}).
22315
22316 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gss-service-type
22317 A service type for the Global Security System (GSS) daemon.
22318 @end defvr
22319
22320 @deftp {Data Type} gss-configuration
22321 Data type representing the configuration of the GSS daemon service.
22322 This type has the following parameters:
22323 @table @asis
22324 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
22325 The package in which the @command{rpc.gssd} command is to be found.
22326
22327 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
22328 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
22329
22330 @end table
22331 @end deftp
22332
22333
22334 @subsubheading IDMAP Daemon Service
22335 @cindex idmapd
22336 @cindex name mapper
22337
22338 The idmap daemon service provides mapping between user IDs and user names.
22339 Typically it is required in order to access file systems mounted via NFSv4.
22340
22341 @defvr {Scheme Variable} idmap-service-type
22342 A service type for the Identity Mapper (IDMAP) daemon.
22343 @end defvr
22344
22345 @deftp {Data Type} idmap-configuration
22346 Data type representing the configuration of the IDMAP daemon service.
22347 This type has the following parameters:
22348 @table @asis
22349 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
22350 The package in which the @command{rpc.idmapd} command is to be found.
22351
22352 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
22353 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
22354
22355 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{#f})
22356 The local NFSv4 domain name.
22357 This must be a string or @code{#f}.
22358 If it is @code{#f} then the daemon will use the host's fully qualified domain name.
22359
22360 @item @code{verbosity} (default: @code{0})
22361 The verbosity level of the daemon.
22362
22363 @end table
22364 @end deftp
22365
22366 @node Continuous Integration
22367 @subsection Continuous Integration
22368
22369 @cindex continuous integration
22370 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix/guix-cuirass.git, Cuirass} is a
22371 continuous integration tool for Guix. It can be used both for development and
22372 for providing substitutes to others (@pxref{Substitutes}).
22373
22374 The @code{(gnu services cuirass)} module provides the following service.
22375
22376 @defvr {Scheme Procedure} cuirass-service-type
22377 The type of the Cuirass service. Its value must be a
22378 @code{cuirass-configuration} object, as described below.
22379 @end defvr
22380
22381 To add build jobs, you have to set the @code{specifications} field of the
22382 configuration. Here is an example of a service that polls the Guix repository
22383 and builds the packages from a manifest. Some of the packages are defined in
22384 the @code{"custom-packages"} input, which is the equivalent of
22385 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}.
22386
22387 @lisp
22388 (define %cuirass-specs
22389 #~(list
22390 '((#:name . "my-manifest")
22391 (#:load-path-inputs . ("guix"))
22392 (#:package-path-inputs . ("custom-packages"))
22393 (#:proc-input . "guix")
22394 (#:proc-file . "build-aux/cuirass/gnu-system.scm")
22395 (#:proc . cuirass-jobs)
22396 (#:proc-args . ((subset . "manifests")
22397 (systems . ("x86_64-linux"))
22398 (manifests . (("config" . "guix/manifest.scm")))))
22399 (#:inputs . (((#:name . "guix")
22400 (#:url . "git://git.savannah.gnu.org/guix.git")
22401 (#:load-path . ".")
22402 (#:branch . "master")
22403 (#:no-compile? . #t))
22404 ((#:name . "config")
22405 (#:url . "https://git.example.org/config.git")
22406 (#:load-path . ".")
22407 (#:branch . "master")
22408 (#:no-compile? . #t))
22409 ((#:name . "custom-packages")
22410 (#:url . "https://git.example.org/custom-packages.git")
22411 (#:load-path . ".")
22412 (#:branch . "master")
22413 (#:no-compile? . #t)))))))
22414
22415 (service cuirass-service-type
22416 (cuirass-configuration
22417 (specifications %cuirass-specs)))
22418 @end lisp
22419
22420 While information related to build jobs is located directly in the
22421 specifications, global settings for the @command{cuirass} process are
22422 accessible in other @code{cuirass-configuration} fields.
22423
22424 @deftp {Data Type} cuirass-configuration
22425 Data type representing the configuration of Cuirass.
22426
22427 @table @asis
22428 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass.log"})
22429 Location of the log file.
22430
22431 @item @code{web-log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass-web.log"})
22432 Location of the log file used by the web interface.
22433
22434 @item @code{cache-directory} (default: @code{"/var/cache/cuirass"})
22435 Location of the repository cache.
22436
22437 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
22438 Owner of the @code{cuirass} process.
22439
22440 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
22441 Owner's group of the @code{cuirass} process.
22442
22443 @item @code{interval} (default: @code{60})
22444 Number of seconds between the poll of the repositories followed by the
22445 Cuirass jobs.
22446
22447 @item @code{database} (default: @code{"/var/lib/cuirass/cuirass.db"})
22448 Location of sqlite database which contains the build results and previously
22449 added specifications.
22450
22451 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
22452 Specifies the time-to-live (TTL) in seconds of garbage collector roots that
22453 are registered for build results. This means that build results are protected
22454 from garbage collection for at least @var{ttl} seconds.
22455
22456 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8081})
22457 Port number used by the HTTP server.
22458
22459 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
22460 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
22461 accept connections from localhost.
22462
22463 @item @code{specifications} (default: @code{#~'()})
22464 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) that evaluates to a list of specifications,
22465 where a specification is an association list
22466 (@pxref{Associations Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) whose
22467 keys are keywords (@code{#:keyword-example}) as shown in the example
22468 above.
22469
22470 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#f})
22471 This allows using substitutes to avoid building every dependencies of a job
22472 from source.
22473
22474 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
22475 Only evaluate specifications and build derivations once.
22476
22477 @item @code{fallback?} (default: @code{#f})
22478 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
22479 packages locally.
22480
22481 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
22482 Extra options to pass when running the Cuirass processes.
22483
22484 @item @code{cuirass} (default: @code{cuirass})
22485 The Cuirass package to use.
22486 @end table
22487 @end deftp
22488
22489 @node Power Management Services
22490 @subsection Power Management Services
22491
22492 @cindex tlp
22493 @cindex power management with TLP
22494 @subsubheading TLP daemon
22495
22496 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides a Guix service definition
22497 for the Linux power management tool TLP.
22498
22499 TLP enables various powersaving modes in userspace and kernel.
22500 Contrary to @code{upower-service}, it is not a passive,
22501 monitoring tool, as it will apply custom settings each time a new power
22502 source is detected. More information can be found at
22503 @uref{https://linrunner.de/en/tlp/tlp.html, TLP home page}.
22504
22505 @deffn {Scheme Variable} tlp-service-type
22506 The service type for the TLP tool. Its value should be a valid
22507 TLP configuration (see below). To use the default settings, simply
22508 write:
22509 @lisp
22510 (service tlp-service-type)
22511 @end lisp
22512 @end deffn
22513
22514 By default TLP does not need much configuration but most TLP parameters
22515 can be tweaked using @code{tlp-configuration}.
22516
22517 Each parameter definition is preceded by its type; for example,
22518 @samp{boolean foo} indicates that the @code{foo} parameter
22519 should be specified as a boolean. Types starting with
22520 @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't show up in TLP config file
22521 when their value is @code{'disabled}.
22522
22523 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
22524 @c (generate-tlp-documentation) in (gnu services pm). Manually maintained
22525 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
22526 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
22527 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
22528 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
22529 @c the churn as TLP updates.
22530
22531 Available @code{tlp-configuration} fields are:
22532
22533 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} package tlp
22534 The TLP package.
22535
22536 @end deftypevr
22537
22538 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean tlp-enable?
22539 Set to true if you wish to enable TLP.
22540
22541 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22542
22543 @end deftypevr
22544
22545 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string tlp-default-mode
22546 Default mode when no power supply can be detected. Alternatives are AC
22547 and BAT.
22548
22549 Defaults to @samp{"AC"}.
22550
22551 @end deftypevr
22552
22553 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-ac
22554 Number of seconds Linux kernel has to wait after the disk goes idle,
22555 before syncing on AC.
22556
22557 Defaults to @samp{0}.
22558
22559 @end deftypevr
22560
22561 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-bat
22562 Same as @code{disk-idle-ac} but on BAT mode.
22563
22564 Defaults to @samp{2}.
22565
22566 @end deftypevr
22567
22568 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-ac
22569 Dirty pages flushing periodicity, expressed in seconds.
22570
22571 Defaults to @samp{15}.
22572
22573 @end deftypevr
22574
22575 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-bat
22576 Same as @code{max-lost-work-secs-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
22577
22578 Defaults to @samp{60}.
22579
22580 @end deftypevr
22581
22582 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac
22583 CPU frequency scaling governor on AC mode. With intel_pstate driver,
22584 alternatives are powersave and performance. With acpi-cpufreq driver,
22585 alternatives are ondemand, powersave, performance and conservative.
22586
22587 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22588
22589 @end deftypevr
22590
22591 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-bat
22592 Same as @code{cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
22593
22594 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22595
22596 @end deftypevr
22597
22598 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-ac
22599 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
22600
22601 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22602
22603 @end deftypevr
22604
22605 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-ac
22606 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
22607
22608 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22609
22610 @end deftypevr
22611
22612 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-bat
22613 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
22614
22615 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22616
22617 @end deftypevr
22618
22619 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-bat
22620 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
22621
22622 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22623
22624 @end deftypevr
22625
22626 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-ac
22627 Limit the min P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
22628 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
22629
22630 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22631
22632 @end deftypevr
22633
22634 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-ac
22635 Limit the max P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
22636 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
22637
22638 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22639
22640 @end deftypevr
22641
22642 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-bat
22643 Same as @code{cpu-min-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
22644
22645 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22646
22647 @end deftypevr
22648
22649 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-bat
22650 Same as @code{cpu-max-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
22651
22652 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22653
22654 @end deftypevr
22655
22656 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-ac?
22657 Enable CPU turbo boost feature on AC mode.
22658
22659 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22660
22661 @end deftypevr
22662
22663 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-bat?
22664 Same as @code{cpu-boost-on-ac?} on BAT mode.
22665
22666 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22667
22668 @end deftypevr
22669
22670 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-ac?
22671 Allow Linux kernel to minimize the number of CPU cores/hyper-threads
22672 used under light load conditions.
22673
22674 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22675
22676 @end deftypevr
22677
22678 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-bat?
22679 Same as @code{sched-powersave-on-ac?} but on BAT mode.
22680
22681 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22682
22683 @end deftypevr
22684
22685 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean nmi-watchdog?
22686 Enable Linux kernel NMI watchdog.
22687
22688 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22689
22690 @end deftypevr
22691
22692 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string phc-controls
22693 For Linux kernels with PHC patch applied, change CPU voltages. An
22694 example value would be @samp{"F:V F:V F:V F:V"}.
22695
22696 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22697
22698 @end deftypevr
22699
22700 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-ac
22701 Set CPU performance versus energy saving policy on AC. Alternatives are
22702 performance, normal, powersave.
22703
22704 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
22705
22706 @end deftypevr
22707
22708 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-bat
22709 Same as @code{energy-perf-policy-ac} but on BAT mode.
22710
22711 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
22712
22713 @end deftypevr
22714
22715 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disks-devices
22716 Hard disk devices.
22717
22718 @end deftypevr
22719
22720 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-ac
22721 Hard disk advanced power management level.
22722
22723 @end deftypevr
22724
22725 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-bat
22726 Same as @code{disk-apm-bat} but on BAT mode.
22727
22728 @end deftypevr
22729
22730 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac
22731 Hard disk spin down timeout. One value has to be specified for each
22732 declared hard disk.
22733
22734 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22735
22736 @end deftypevr
22737
22738 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-bat
22739 Same as @code{disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
22740
22741 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22742
22743 @end deftypevr
22744
22745 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-iosched
22746 Select IO scheduler for disk devices. One value has to be specified for
22747 each declared hard disk. Example alternatives are cfq, deadline and
22748 noop.
22749
22750 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22751
22752 @end deftypevr
22753
22754 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-ac
22755 SATA aggressive link power management (ALPM) level. Alternatives are
22756 min_power, medium_power, max_performance.
22757
22758 Defaults to @samp{"max_performance"}.
22759
22760 @end deftypevr
22761
22762 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-bat
22763 Same as @code{sata-linkpwr-ac} but on BAT mode.
22764
22765 Defaults to @samp{"min_power"}.
22766
22767 @end deftypevr
22768
22769 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sata-linkpwr-blacklist
22770 Exclude specified SATA host devices for link power management.
22771
22772 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22773
22774 @end deftypevr
22775
22776 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac?
22777 Enable Runtime Power Management for AHCI controller and disks on AC
22778 mode.
22779
22780 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22781
22782 @end deftypevr
22783
22784 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-bat?
22785 Same as @code{ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac} on BAT mode.
22786
22787 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22788
22789 @end deftypevr
22790
22791 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer ahci-runtime-pm-timeout
22792 Seconds of inactivity before disk is suspended.
22793
22794 Defaults to @samp{15}.
22795
22796 @end deftypevr
22797
22798 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-ac
22799 PCI Express Active State Power Management level. Alternatives are
22800 default, performance, powersave.
22801
22802 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
22803
22804 @end deftypevr
22805
22806 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-bat
22807 Same as @code{pcie-aspm-ac} but on BAT mode.
22808
22809 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
22810
22811 @end deftypevr
22812
22813 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-ac
22814 Radeon graphics clock speed level. Alternatives are low, mid, high,
22815 auto, default.
22816
22817 Defaults to @samp{"high"}.
22818
22819 @end deftypevr
22820
22821 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-bat
22822 Same as @code{radeon-power-ac} but on BAT mode.
22823
22824 Defaults to @samp{"low"}.
22825
22826 @end deftypevr
22827
22828 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-ac
22829 Radeon dynamic power management method (DPM). Alternatives are battery,
22830 performance.
22831
22832 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
22833
22834 @end deftypevr
22835
22836 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-bat
22837 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-state-ac} but on BAT mode.
22838
22839 Defaults to @samp{"battery"}.
22840
22841 @end deftypevr
22842
22843 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-ac
22844 Radeon DPM performance level. Alternatives are auto, low, high.
22845
22846 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
22847
22848 @end deftypevr
22849
22850 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-bat
22851 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-perf-ac} but on BAT mode.
22852
22853 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
22854
22855 @end deftypevr
22856
22857 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-ac?
22858 Wifi power saving mode.
22859
22860 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22861
22862 @end deftypevr
22863
22864 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-bat?
22865 Same as @code{wifi-power-ac?} but on BAT mode.
22866
22867 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22868
22869 @end deftypevr
22870
22871 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean wol-disable?
22872 Disable wake on LAN.
22873
22874 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22875
22876 @end deftypevr
22877
22878 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-ac
22879 Timeout duration in seconds before activating audio power saving on
22880 Intel HDA and AC97 devices. A value of 0 disables power saving.
22881
22882 Defaults to @samp{0}.
22883
22884 @end deftypevr
22885
22886 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-bat
22887 Same as @code{sound-powersave-ac} but on BAT mode.
22888
22889 Defaults to @samp{1}.
22890
22891 @end deftypevr
22892
22893 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean sound-power-save-controller?
22894 Disable controller in powersaving mode on Intel HDA devices.
22895
22896 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22897
22898 @end deftypevr
22899
22900 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean bay-poweroff-on-bat?
22901 Enable optical drive in UltraBay/MediaBay on BAT mode. Drive can be
22902 powered on again by releasing (and reinserting) the eject lever or by
22903 pressing the disc eject button on newer models.
22904
22905 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22906
22907 @end deftypevr
22908
22909 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string bay-device
22910 Name of the optical drive device to power off.
22911
22912 Defaults to @samp{"sr0"}.
22913
22914 @end deftypevr
22915
22916 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-ac
22917 Runtime Power Management for PCI(e) bus devices. Alternatives are on
22918 and auto.
22919
22920 Defaults to @samp{"on"}.
22921
22922 @end deftypevr
22923
22924 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-bat
22925 Same as @code{runtime-pm-ac} but on BAT mode.
22926
22927 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
22928
22929 @end deftypevr
22930
22931 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean runtime-pm-all?
22932 Runtime Power Management for all PCI(e) bus devices, except blacklisted
22933 ones.
22934
22935 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22936
22937 @end deftypevr
22938
22939 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-blacklist
22940 Exclude specified PCI(e) device addresses from Runtime Power Management.
22941
22942 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22943
22944 @end deftypevr
22945
22946 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-driver-blacklist
22947 Exclude PCI(e) devices assigned to the specified drivers from Runtime
22948 Power Management.
22949
22950 @end deftypevr
22951
22952 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-autosuspend?
22953 Enable USB autosuspend feature.
22954
22955 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22956
22957 @end deftypevr
22958
22959 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-blacklist
22960 Exclude specified devices from USB autosuspend.
22961
22962 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22963
22964 @end deftypevr
22965
22966 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-blacklist-wwan?
22967 Exclude WWAN devices from USB autosuspend.
22968
22969 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22970
22971 @end deftypevr
22972
22973 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-whitelist
22974 Include specified devices into USB autosuspend, even if they are already
22975 excluded by the driver or via @code{usb-blacklist-wwan?}.
22976
22977 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22978
22979 @end deftypevr
22980
22981 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean usb-autosuspend-disable-on-shutdown?
22982 Enable USB autosuspend before shutdown.
22983
22984 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22985
22986 @end deftypevr
22987
22988 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean restore-device-state-on-startup?
22989 Restore radio device state (bluetooth, wifi, wwan) from previous
22990 shutdown on system startup.
22991
22992 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22993
22994 @end deftypevr
22995
22996 @cindex thermald
22997 @cindex CPU frequency scaling with thermald
22998 @subsubheading Thermald daemon
22999
23000 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides an interface to
23001 thermald, a CPU frequency scaling service which helps prevent overheating.
23002
23003 @defvr {Scheme Variable} thermald-service-type
23004 This is the service type for
23005 @uref{https://01.org/linux-thermal-daemon/, thermald}, the Linux
23006 Thermal Daemon, which is responsible for controlling the thermal state
23007 of processors and preventing overheating.
23008 @end defvr
23009
23010 @deftp {Data Type} thermald-configuration
23011 Data type representing the configuration of @code{thermald-service-type}.
23012
23013 @table @asis
23014 @item @code{ignore-cpuid-check?} (default: @code{#f})
23015 Ignore cpuid check for supported CPU models.
23016
23017 @item @code{thermald} (default: @var{thermald})
23018 Package object of thermald.
23019
23020 @end table
23021 @end deftp
23022
23023 @node Audio Services
23024 @subsection Audio Services
23025
23026 The @code{(gnu services audio)} module provides a service to start MPD
23027 (the Music Player Daemon).
23028
23029 @cindex mpd
23030 @subsubheading Music Player Daemon
23031
23032 The Music Player Daemon (MPD) is a service that can play music while
23033 being controlled from the local machine or over the network by a variety
23034 of clients.
23035
23036 The following example shows how one might run @code{mpd} as user
23037 @code{"bob"} on port @code{6666}. It uses pulseaudio for output.
23038
23039 @lisp
23040 (service mpd-service-type
23041 (mpd-configuration
23042 (user "bob")
23043 (port "6666")))
23044 @end lisp
23045
23046 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mpd-service-type
23047 The service type for @command{mpd}
23048 @end defvr
23049
23050 @deftp {Data Type} mpd-configuration
23051 Data type representing the configuration of @command{mpd}.
23052
23053 @table @asis
23054 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"mpd"})
23055 The user to run mpd as.
23056
23057 @item @code{music-dir} (default: @code{"~/Music"})
23058 The directory to scan for music files.
23059
23060 @item @code{playlist-dir} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/playlists"})
23061 The directory to store playlists.
23062
23063 @item @code{db-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/tag_cache"})
23064 The location of the music database.
23065
23066 @item @code{state-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/state"})
23067 The location of the file that stores current MPD's state.
23068
23069 @item @code{sticker-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/sticker.sql"})
23070 The location of the sticker database.
23071
23072 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"6600"})
23073 The port to run mpd on.
23074
23075 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"any"})
23076 The address that mpd will bind to. To use a Unix domain socket,
23077 an absolute path can be specified here.
23078
23079 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{"(list (mpd-output))"})
23080 The audio outputs that MPD can use. By default this is a single output using pulseaudio.
23081
23082 @end table
23083 @end deftp
23084
23085 @deftp {Data Type} mpd-output
23086 Data type representing an @command{mpd} audio output.
23087
23088 @table @asis
23089 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"MPD"})
23090 The name of the audio output.
23091
23092 @item @code{type} (default: @code{"pulse"})
23093 The type of audio output.
23094
23095 @item @code{enabled?} (default: @code{#t})
23096 Specifies whether this audio output is enabled when MPD is started. By
23097 default, all audio outputs are enabled. This is just the default
23098 setting when there is no state file; with a state file, the previous
23099 state is restored.
23100
23101 @item @code{tags?} (default: @code{#t})
23102 If set to @code{#f}, then MPD will not send tags to this output. This
23103 is only useful for output plugins that can receive tags, for example the
23104 @code{httpd} output plugin.
23105
23106 @item @code{always-on?} (default: @code{#f})
23107 If set to @code{#t}, then MPD attempts to keep this audio output always
23108 open. This may be useful for streaming servers, when you don’t want to
23109 disconnect all listeners even when playback is accidentally stopped.
23110
23111 @item @code{mixer-type}
23112 This field accepts a symbol that specifies which mixer should be used
23113 for this audio output: the @code{hardware} mixer, the @code{software}
23114 mixer, the @code{null} mixer (allows setting the volume, but with no
23115 effect; this can be used as a trick to implement an external mixer
23116 External Mixer) or no mixer (@code{none}).
23117
23118 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()"})
23119 An association list of option symbols to string values to be appended to
23120 the audio output configuration.
23121
23122 @end table
23123 @end deftp
23124
23125 The following example shows a configuration of @code{mpd} that provides
23126 an HTTP audio streaming output.
23127
23128 @lisp
23129 (service mpd-service-type
23130 (mpd-configuration
23131 (outputs
23132 (list (mpd-output
23133 (name "streaming")
23134 (type "httpd")
23135 (mixer-type 'null)
23136 (extra-options
23137 `((encoder . "vorbis")
23138 (port . "8080"))))))))
23139 @end lisp
23140
23141
23142 @node Virtualization Services
23143 @subsection Virtualization services
23144
23145 The @code{(gnu services virtualization)} module provides services for
23146 the libvirt and virtlog daemons, as well as other virtualization-related
23147 services.
23148
23149 @subsubheading Libvirt daemon
23150 @code{libvirtd} is the server side daemon component of the libvirt
23151 virtualization management system. This daemon runs on host servers
23152 and performs required management tasks for virtualized guests.
23153
23154 @deffn {Scheme Variable} libvirt-service-type
23155 This is the type of the @uref{https://libvirt.org, libvirt daemon}.
23156 Its value must be a @code{libvirt-configuration}.
23157
23158 @lisp
23159 (service libvirt-service-type
23160 (libvirt-configuration
23161 (unix-sock-group "libvirt")
23162 (tls-port "16555")))
23163 @end lisp
23164 @end deffn
23165
23166 @c Auto-generated with (generate-libvirt-documentation)
23167 Available @code{libvirt-configuration} fields are:
23168
23169 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} package libvirt
23170 Libvirt package.
23171
23172 @end deftypevr
23173
23174 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tls?
23175 Flag listening for secure TLS connections on the public TCP/IP port.
23176 must set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
23177
23178 It is necessary to setup a CA and issue server certificates before using
23179 this capability.
23180
23181 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23182
23183 @end deftypevr
23184
23185 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tcp?
23186 Listen for unencrypted TCP connections on the public TCP/IP port. must
23187 set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
23188
23189 Using the TCP socket requires SASL authentication by default. Only SASL
23190 mechanisms which support data encryption are allowed. This is
23191 DIGEST_MD5 and GSSAPI (Kerberos5)
23192
23193 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23194
23195 @end deftypevr
23196
23197 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-port
23198 Port for accepting secure TLS connections This can be a port number, or
23199 service name
23200
23201 Defaults to @samp{"16514"}.
23202
23203 @end deftypevr
23204
23205 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tcp-port
23206 Port for accepting insecure TCP connections This can be a port number,
23207 or service name
23208
23209 Defaults to @samp{"16509"}.
23210
23211 @end deftypevr
23212
23213 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string listen-addr
23214 IP address or hostname used for client connections.
23215
23216 Defaults to @samp{"0.0.0.0"}.
23217
23218 @end deftypevr
23219
23220 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean mdns-adv?
23221 Flag toggling mDNS advertisement of the libvirt service.
23222
23223 Alternatively can disable for all services on a host by stopping the
23224 Avahi daemon.
23225
23226 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23227
23228 @end deftypevr
23229
23230 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string mdns-name
23231 Default mDNS advertisement name. This must be unique on the immediate
23232 broadcast network.
23233
23234 Defaults to @samp{"Virtualization Host <hostname>"}.
23235
23236 @end deftypevr
23237
23238 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-group
23239 UNIX domain socket group ownership. This can be used to allow a
23240 'trusted' set of users access to management capabilities without
23241 becoming root.
23242
23243 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
23244
23245 @end deftypevr
23246
23247 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-ro-perms
23248 UNIX socket permissions for the R/O socket. This is used for monitoring
23249 VM status only.
23250
23251 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
23252
23253 @end deftypevr
23254
23255 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-rw-perms
23256 UNIX socket permissions for the R/W socket. Default allows only root.
23257 If PolicyKit is enabled on the socket, the default will change to allow
23258 everyone (eg, 0777)
23259
23260 Defaults to @samp{"0770"}.
23261
23262 @end deftypevr
23263
23264 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-admin-perms
23265 UNIX socket permissions for the admin socket. Default allows only owner
23266 (root), do not change it unless you are sure to whom you are exposing
23267 the access to.
23268
23269 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
23270
23271 @end deftypevr
23272
23273 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-dir
23274 The directory in which sockets will be found/created.
23275
23276 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/libvirt"}.
23277
23278 @end deftypevr
23279
23280 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-ro
23281 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-only sockets. By default socket
23282 permissions allow anyone to connect
23283
23284 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
23285
23286 @end deftypevr
23287
23288 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-rw
23289 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-write sockets. By default socket
23290 permissions only allow root. If PolicyKit support was compiled into
23291 libvirt, the default will be to use 'polkit' auth.
23292
23293 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
23294
23295 @end deftypevr
23296
23297 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tcp
23298 Authentication scheme for TCP sockets. If you don't enable SASL, then
23299 all TCP traffic is cleartext. Don't do this outside of a dev/test
23300 scenario.
23301
23302 Defaults to @samp{"sasl"}.
23303
23304 @end deftypevr
23305
23306 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tls
23307 Authentication scheme for TLS sockets. TLS sockets already have
23308 encryption provided by the TLS layer, and limited authentication is done
23309 by certificates.
23310
23311 It is possible to make use of any SASL authentication mechanism as well,
23312 by using 'sasl' for this option
23313
23314 Defaults to @samp{"none"}.
23315
23316 @end deftypevr
23317
23318 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list access-drivers
23319 API access control scheme.
23320
23321 By default an authenticated user is allowed access to all APIs. Access
23322 drivers can place restrictions on this.
23323
23324 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23325
23326 @end deftypevr
23327
23328 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string key-file
23329 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no private key is
23330 loaded.
23331
23332 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23333
23334 @end deftypevr
23335
23336 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string cert-file
23337 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no certificate is
23338 loaded.
23339
23340 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23341
23342 @end deftypevr
23343
23344 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string ca-file
23345 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no CA certificate
23346 is loaded.
23347
23348 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23349
23350 @end deftypevr
23351
23352 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string crl-file
23353 Certificate revocation list path. If set to an empty string, then no
23354 CRL is loaded.
23355
23356 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23357
23358 @end deftypevr
23359
23360 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-sanity-cert
23361 Disable verification of our own server certificates.
23362
23363 When libvirtd starts it performs some sanity checks against its own
23364 certificates.
23365
23366 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23367
23368 @end deftypevr
23369
23370 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-verify-cert
23371 Disable verification of client certificates.
23372
23373 Client certificate verification is the primary authentication mechanism.
23374 Any client which does not present a certificate signed by the CA will be
23375 rejected.
23376
23377 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23378
23379 @end deftypevr
23380
23381 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list tls-allowed-dn-list
23382 Whitelist of allowed x509 Distinguished Name.
23383
23384 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23385
23386 @end deftypevr
23387
23388 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list sasl-allowed-usernames
23389 Whitelist of allowed SASL usernames. The format for username depends on
23390 the SASL authentication mechanism.
23391
23392 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23393
23394 @end deftypevr
23395
23396 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-priority
23397 Override the compile time default TLS priority string. The default is
23398 usually "NORMAL" unless overridden at build time. Only set this is it
23399 is desired for libvirt to deviate from the global default settings.
23400
23401 Defaults to @samp{"NORMAL"}.
23402
23403 @end deftypevr
23404
23405 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
23406 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
23407 sockets combined.
23408
23409 Defaults to @samp{5000}.
23410
23411 @end deftypevr
23412
23413 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-queued-clients
23414 Maximum length of queue of connections waiting to be accepted by the
23415 daemon. Note, that some protocols supporting retransmission may obey
23416 this so that a later reattempt at connection succeeds.
23417
23418 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
23419
23420 @end deftypevr
23421
23422 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-anonymous-clients
23423 Maximum length of queue of accepted but not yet authenticated clients.
23424 Set this to zero to turn this feature off
23425
23426 Defaults to @samp{20}.
23427
23428 @end deftypevr
23429
23430 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer min-workers
23431 Number of workers to start up initially.
23432
23433 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23434
23435 @end deftypevr
23436
23437 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-workers
23438 Maximum number of worker threads.
23439
23440 If the number of active clients exceeds @code{min-workers}, then more
23441 threads are spawned, up to max_workers limit. Typically you'd want
23442 max_workers to equal maximum number of clients allowed.
23443
23444 Defaults to @samp{20}.
23445
23446 @end deftypevr
23447
23448 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer prio-workers
23449 Number of priority workers. If all workers from above pool are stuck,
23450 some calls marked as high priority (notably domainDestroy) can be
23451 executed in this pool.
23452
23453 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23454
23455 @end deftypevr
23456
23457 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-requests
23458 Total global limit on concurrent RPC calls.
23459
23460 Defaults to @samp{20}.
23461
23462 @end deftypevr
23463
23464 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-client-requests
23465 Limit on concurrent requests from a single client connection. To avoid
23466 one client monopolizing the server this should be a small fraction of
23467 the global max_requests and max_workers parameter.
23468
23469 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23470
23471 @end deftypevr
23472
23473 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-min-workers
23474 Same as @code{min-workers} but for the admin interface.
23475
23476 Defaults to @samp{1}.
23477
23478 @end deftypevr
23479
23480 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-workers
23481 Same as @code{max-workers} but for the admin interface.
23482
23483 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23484
23485 @end deftypevr
23486
23487 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-clients
23488 Same as @code{max-clients} but for the admin interface.
23489
23490 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23491
23492 @end deftypevr
23493
23494 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-queued-clients
23495 Same as @code{max-queued-clients} but for the admin interface.
23496
23497 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23498
23499 @end deftypevr
23500
23501 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-client-requests
23502 Same as @code{max-client-requests} but for the admin interface.
23503
23504 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23505
23506 @end deftypevr
23507
23508 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
23509 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
23510
23511 Defaults to @samp{3}.
23512
23513 @end deftypevr
23514
23515 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
23516 Logging filters.
23517
23518 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
23519 of logs The format for a filter is one of:
23520
23521 @itemize @bullet
23522 @item
23523 x:name
23524
23525 @item
23526 x:+name
23527
23528 @end itemize
23529
23530 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
23531 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
23532 file, e.g., "remote", "qemu", or "util.json" (the name in the filter can
23533 be a substring of the full category name, in order to match multiple
23534 similar categories), the optional "+" prefix tells libvirt to log stack
23535 trace for each message matching name, and @code{x} is the minimal level
23536 where matching messages should be logged:
23537
23538 @itemize @bullet
23539 @item
23540 1: DEBUG
23541
23542 @item
23543 2: INFO
23544
23545 @item
23546 3: WARNING
23547
23548 @item
23549 4: ERROR
23550
23551 @end itemize
23552
23553 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
23554 need to be separated by spaces.
23555
23556 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
23557
23558 @end deftypevr
23559
23560 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
23561 Logging outputs.
23562
23563 An output is one of the places to save logging information. The format
23564 for an output can be:
23565
23566 @table @code
23567 @item x:stderr
23568 output goes to stderr
23569
23570 @item x:syslog:name
23571 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
23572
23573 @item x:file:file_path
23574 output to a file, with the given filepath
23575
23576 @item x:journald
23577 output to journald logging system
23578
23579 @end table
23580
23581 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
23582
23583 @itemize @bullet
23584 @item
23585 1: DEBUG
23586
23587 @item
23588 2: INFO
23589
23590 @item
23591 3: WARNING
23592
23593 @item
23594 4: ERROR
23595
23596 @end itemize
23597
23598 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
23599 spaces.
23600
23601 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
23602
23603 @end deftypevr
23604
23605 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer audit-level
23606 Allows usage of the auditing subsystem to be altered
23607
23608 @itemize @bullet
23609 @item
23610 0: disable all auditing
23611
23612 @item
23613 1: enable auditing, only if enabled on host
23614
23615 @item
23616 2: enable auditing, and exit if disabled on host.
23617
23618 @end itemize
23619
23620 Defaults to @samp{1}.
23621
23622 @end deftypevr
23623
23624 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean audit-logging
23625 Send audit messages via libvirt logging infrastructure.
23626
23627 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23628
23629 @end deftypevr
23630
23631 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-string host-uuid
23632 Host UUID. UUID must not have all digits be the same.
23633
23634 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23635
23636 @end deftypevr
23637
23638 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string host-uuid-source
23639 Source to read host UUID.
23640
23641 @itemize @bullet
23642 @item
23643 @code{smbios}: fetch the UUID from @code{dmidecode -s system-uuid}
23644
23645 @item
23646 @code{machine-id}: fetch the UUID from @code{/etc/machine-id}
23647
23648 @end itemize
23649
23650 If @code{dmidecode} does not provide a valid UUID a temporary UUID will
23651 be generated.
23652
23653 Defaults to @samp{"smbios"}.
23654
23655 @end deftypevr
23656
23657 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-interval
23658 A keepalive message is sent to a client after @code{keepalive_interval}
23659 seconds of inactivity to check if the client is still responding. If
23660 set to -1, libvirtd will never send keepalive requests; however clients
23661 can still send them and the daemon will send responses.
23662
23663 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23664
23665 @end deftypevr
23666
23667 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-count
23668 Maximum number of keepalive messages that are allowed to be sent to the
23669 client without getting any response before the connection is considered
23670 broken.
23671
23672 In other words, the connection is automatically closed approximately
23673 after @code{keepalive_interval * (keepalive_count + 1)} seconds since
23674 the last message received from the client. When @code{keepalive-count}
23675 is set to 0, connections will be automatically closed after
23676 @code{keepalive-interval} seconds of inactivity without sending any
23677 keepalive messages.
23678
23679 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23680
23681 @end deftypevr
23682
23683 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-interval
23684 Same as above but for admin interface.
23685
23686 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23687
23688 @end deftypevr
23689
23690 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-count
23691 Same as above but for admin interface.
23692
23693 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23694
23695 @end deftypevr
23696
23697 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer ovs-timeout
23698 Timeout for Open vSwitch calls.
23699
23700 The @code{ovs-vsctl} utility is used for the configuration and its
23701 timeout option is set by default to 5 seconds to avoid potential
23702 infinite waits blocking libvirt.
23703
23704 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23705
23706 @end deftypevr
23707
23708 @c %end of autogenerated docs
23709
23710 @subsubheading Virtlog daemon
23711 The virtlogd service is a server side daemon component of libvirt that is
23712 used to manage logs from virtual machine consoles.
23713
23714 This daemon is not used directly by libvirt client applications, rather it
23715 is called on their behalf by @code{libvirtd}. By maintaining the logs in a
23716 standalone daemon, the main @code{libvirtd} daemon can be restarted without
23717 risk of losing logs. The @code{virtlogd} daemon has the ability to re-exec()
23718 itself upon receiving @code{SIGUSR1}, to allow live upgrades without downtime.
23719
23720 @deffn {Scheme Variable} virtlog-service-type
23721 This is the type of the virtlog daemon.
23722 Its value must be a @code{virtlog-configuration}.
23723
23724 @lisp
23725 (service virtlog-service-type
23726 (virtlog-configuration
23727 (max-clients 1000)))
23728 @end lisp
23729 @end deffn
23730
23731 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
23732 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
23733
23734 Defaults to @samp{3}.
23735
23736 @end deftypevr
23737
23738 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
23739 Logging filters.
23740
23741 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
23742 of logs The format for a filter is one of:
23743
23744 @itemize @bullet
23745 @item
23746 x:name
23747
23748 @item
23749 x:+name
23750
23751 @end itemize
23752
23753 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
23754 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
23755 file, e.g., "remote", "qemu", or "util.json" (the name in the filter can
23756 be a substring of the full category name, in order to match multiple
23757 similar categories), the optional "+" prefix tells libvirt to log stack
23758 trace for each message matching name, and @code{x} is the minimal level
23759 where matching messages should be logged:
23760
23761 @itemize @bullet
23762 @item
23763 1: DEBUG
23764
23765 @item
23766 2: INFO
23767
23768 @item
23769 3: WARNING
23770
23771 @item
23772 4: ERROR
23773
23774 @end itemize
23775
23776 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
23777 need to be separated by spaces.
23778
23779 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
23780
23781 @end deftypevr
23782
23783 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
23784 Logging outputs.
23785
23786 An output is one of the places to save logging information The format
23787 for an output can be:
23788
23789 @table @code
23790 @item x:stderr
23791 output goes to stderr
23792
23793 @item x:syslog:name
23794 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
23795
23796 @item x:file:file_path
23797 output to a file, with the given filepath
23798
23799 @item x:journald
23800 output to journald logging system
23801
23802 @end table
23803
23804 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
23805
23806 @itemize @bullet
23807 @item
23808 1: DEBUG
23809
23810 @item
23811 2: INFO
23812
23813 @item
23814 3: WARNING
23815
23816 @item
23817 4: ERROR
23818
23819 @end itemize
23820
23821 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
23822 spaces.
23823
23824 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
23825
23826 @end deftypevr
23827
23828 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
23829 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
23830 sockets combined.
23831
23832 Defaults to @samp{1024}.
23833
23834 @end deftypevr
23835
23836 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-size
23837 Maximum file size before rolling over.
23838
23839 Defaults to @samp{2MB}
23840
23841 @end deftypevr
23842
23843 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-backups
23844 Maximum number of backup files to keep.
23845
23846 Defaults to @samp{3}
23847
23848 @end deftypevr
23849
23850 @subsubheading Transparent Emulation with QEMU
23851
23852 @cindex emulation
23853 @cindex @code{binfmt_misc}
23854 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type} provides support for transparent
23855 emulation of program binaries built for different architectures---e.g.,
23856 it allows you to transparently execute an ARMv7 program on an x86_64
23857 machine. It achieves this by combining the @uref{https://www.qemu.org,
23858 QEMU} emulator and the @code{binfmt_misc} feature of the kernel Linux.
23859
23860 @defvr {Scheme Variable} qemu-binfmt-service-type
23861 This is the type of the QEMU/binfmt service for transparent emulation.
23862 Its value must be a @code{qemu-binfmt-configuration} object, which
23863 specifies the QEMU package to use as well as the architecture we want to
23864 emulated:
23865
23866 @lisp
23867 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
23868 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
23869 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm" "aarch64" "mips64el"))))
23870 @end lisp
23871
23872 In this example, we enable transparent emulation for the ARM and aarch64
23873 platforms. Running @code{herd stop qemu-binfmt} turns it off, and
23874 running @code{herd start qemu-binfmt} turns it back on (@pxref{Invoking
23875 herd, the @command{herd} command,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
23876 @end defvr
23877
23878 @deftp {Data Type} qemu-binfmt-configuration
23879 This is the configuration for the @code{qemu-binfmt} service.
23880
23881 @table @asis
23882 @item @code{platforms} (default: @code{'()})
23883 The list of emulated QEMU platforms. Each item must be a @dfn{platform
23884 object} as returned by @code{lookup-qemu-platforms} (see below).
23885
23886 @item @code{guix-support?} (default: @code{#f})
23887 When it is true, QEMU and all its dependencies are added to the build
23888 environment of @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
23889 @code{--chroot-directory} option}). This allows the @code{binfmt_misc}
23890 handlers to be used within the build environment, which in turn means
23891 that you can transparently build programs for another architecture.
23892
23893 For example, let's suppose you're on an x86_64 machine and you have this
23894 service:
23895
23896 @lisp
23897 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
23898 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
23899 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm"))
23900 (guix-support? #t)))
23901 @end lisp
23902
23903 You can run:
23904
23905 @example
23906 guix build -s armhf-linux inkscape
23907 @end example
23908
23909 @noindent
23910 and it will build Inkscape for ARMv7 @emph{as if it were a native
23911 build}, transparently using QEMU to emulate the ARMv7 CPU. Pretty handy
23912 if you'd like to test a package build for an architecture you don't have
23913 access to!
23914
23915 @item @code{qemu} (default: @code{qemu})
23916 The QEMU package to use.
23917 @end table
23918 @end deftp
23919
23920 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-qemu-platforms @var{platforms}@dots{}
23921 Return the list of QEMU platform objects corresponding to
23922 @var{platforms}@dots{}. @var{platforms} must be a list of strings
23923 corresponding to platform names, such as @code{"arm"}, @code{"sparc"},
23924 @code{"mips64el"}, and so on.
23925 @end deffn
23926
23927 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform? @var{obj}
23928 Return true if @var{obj} is a platform object.
23929 @end deffn
23930
23931 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform-name @var{platform}
23932 Return the name of @var{platform}---a string such as @code{"arm"}.
23933 @end deffn
23934
23935 @node Version Control Services
23936 @subsection Version Control Services
23937
23938 The @code{(gnu services version-control)} module provides a service to
23939 allow remote access to local Git repositories. There are three options:
23940 the @code{git-daemon-service}, which provides access to repositories via
23941 the @code{git://} unsecured TCP-based protocol, extending the
23942 @code{nginx} web server to proxy some requests to
23943 @code{git-http-backend}, or providing a web interface with
23944 @code{cgit-service-type}.
23945
23946 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-daemon-service [#:config (git-daemon-configuration)]
23947
23948 Return a service that runs @command{git daemon}, a simple TCP server to
23949 expose repositories over the Git protocol for anonymous access.
23950
23951 The optional @var{config} argument should be a
23952 @code{<git-daemon-configuration>} object, by default it allows read-only
23953 access to exported@footnote{By creating the magic file
23954 "git-daemon-export-ok" in the repository directory.} repositories under
23955 @file{/srv/git}.
23956
23957 @end deffn
23958
23959 @deftp {Data Type} git-daemon-configuration
23960 Data type representing the configuration for @code{git-daemon-service}.
23961
23962 @table @asis
23963 @item @code{package} (default: @var{git})
23964 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
23965
23966 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @var{#f})
23967 Whether to allow access for all Git repositories, even if they do not
23968 have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
23969
23970 @item @code{base-path} (default: @file{/srv/git})
23971 Whether to remap all the path requests as relative to the given path.
23972 If you run git daemon with @var{(base-path "/srv/git")} on example.com,
23973 then if you later try to pull @code{git://example.com/hello.git}, git
23974 daemon will interpret the path as @code{/srv/git/hello.git}.
23975
23976 @item @code{user-path} (default: @var{#f})
23977 Whether to allow @code{~user} notation to be used in requests. When
23978 specified with empty string, requests to @code{git://host/~alice/foo} is
23979 taken as a request to access @code{foo} repository in the home directory
23980 of user @code{alice}. If @var{(user-path "path")} is specified, the
23981 same request is taken as a request to access @code{path/foo} repository
23982 in the home directory of user @code{alice}.
23983
23984 @item @code{listen} (default: @var{'()})
23985 Whether to listen on specific IP addresses or hostnames, defaults to
23986 all.
23987
23988 @item @code{port} (default: @var{#f})
23989 Whether to listen on an alternative port, which defaults to 9418.
23990
23991 @item @code{whitelist} (default: @var{'()})
23992 If not empty, only allow access to this list of directories.
23993
23994 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{'()})
23995 Extra options will be passed to @code{git daemon}, please run
23996 @command{man git-daemon} for more information.
23997
23998 @end table
23999 @end deftp
24000
24001 The @code{git://} protocol lacks authentication. When you pull from a
24002 repository fetched via @code{git://}, you don't know whether the data you
24003 receive was modified or is even coming from the specified host, and your
24004 connection is subject to eavesdropping. It's better to use an authenticated
24005 and encrypted transport, such as @code{https}. Although Git allows you
24006 to serve repositories using unsophisticated file-based web servers,
24007 there is a faster protocol implemented by the @code{git-http-backend}
24008 program. This program is the back-end of a proper Git web service. It
24009 is designed to sit behind a FastCGI proxy. @xref{Web Services}, for more
24010 on running the necessary @code{fcgiwrap} daemon.
24011
24012 Guix has a separate configuration data type for serving Git repositories
24013 over HTTP.
24014
24015 @deftp {Data Type} git-http-configuration
24016 Data type representing the configuration for @code{git-http-service}.
24017
24018 @table @asis
24019 @item @code{package} (default: @var{git})
24020 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
24021
24022 @item @code{git-root} (default: @file{/srv/git})
24023 Directory containing the Git repositories to expose to the world.
24024
24025 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @var{#f})
24026 Whether to expose access for all Git repositories in @var{git-root},
24027 even if they do not have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
24028
24029 @item @code{uri-path} (default: @file{/git/})
24030 Path prefix for Git access. With the default @code{/git/} prefix, this
24031 will map @code{http://@var{server}/git/@var{repo}.git} to
24032 @code{/srv/git/@var{repo}.git}. Requests whose URI paths do not begin
24033 with this prefix are not passed on to this Git instance.
24034
24035 @item @code{fcgiwrap-socket} (default: @code{127.0.0.1:9000})
24036 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} daemon is listening. @xref{Web
24037 Services}.
24038 @end table
24039 @end deftp
24040
24041 There is no @code{git-http-service-type}, currently; instead you can
24042 create an @code{nginx-location-configuration} from a
24043 @code{git-http-configuration} and then add that location to a web
24044 server.
24045
24046 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-http-nginx-location-configuration @
24047 [config=(git-http-configuration)]
24048 Compute an @code{nginx-location-configuration} that corresponds to the
24049 given Git http configuration. An example nginx service definition to
24050 serve the default @file{/srv/git} over HTTPS might be:
24051
24052 @lisp
24053 (service nginx-service-type
24054 (nginx-configuration
24055 (server-blocks
24056 (list
24057 (nginx-server-configuration
24058 (listen '("443 ssl"))
24059 (server-name "git.my-host.org")
24060 (ssl-certificate
24061 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/fullchain.pem")
24062 (ssl-certificate-key
24063 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/privkey.pem")
24064 (locations
24065 (list
24066 (git-http-nginx-location-configuration
24067 (git-http-configuration (uri-path "/"))))))))))
24068 @end lisp
24069
24070 This example assumes that you are using Let's Encrypt to get your TLS
24071 certificate. @xref{Certificate Services}. The default @code{certbot}
24072 service will redirect all HTTP traffic on @code{git.my-host.org} to
24073 HTTPS. You will also need to add an @code{fcgiwrap} proxy to your
24074 system services. @xref{Web Services}.
24075 @end deffn
24076
24077 @subsubheading Cgit Service
24078
24079 @cindex Cgit service
24080 @cindex Git, web interface
24081 @uref{https://git.zx2c4.com/cgit/, Cgit} is a web frontend for Git
24082 repositories written in C.
24083
24084 The following example will configure the service with default values.
24085 By default, Cgit can be accessed on port 80 (@code{http://localhost:80}).
24086
24087 @lisp
24088 (service cgit-service-type)
24089 @end lisp
24090
24091 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
24092 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a string.
24093
24094 @c %start of fragment
24095
24096 Available @code{cgit-configuration} fields are:
24097
24098 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} package package
24099 The CGIT package.
24100
24101 @end deftypevr
24102
24103 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
24104 NGINX configuration.
24105
24106 @end deftypevr
24107
24108 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object about-filter
24109 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format the content of about
24110 pages (both top-level and for each repository).
24111
24112 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24113
24114 @end deftypevr
24115
24116 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string agefile
24117 Specifies a path, relative to each repository path, which can be used to
24118 specify the date and time of the youngest commit in the repository.
24119
24120 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24121
24122 @end deftypevr
24123
24124 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object auth-filter
24125 Specifies a command that will be invoked for authenticating repository
24126 access.
24127
24128 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24129
24130 @end deftypevr
24131
24132 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string branch-sort
24133 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
24134 ref list, and when set @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
24135
24136 Defaults to @samp{"name"}.
24137
24138 @end deftypevr
24139
24140 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string cache-root
24141 Path used to store the cgit cache entries.
24142
24143 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cgit"}.
24144
24145 @end deftypevr
24146
24147 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-static-ttl
24148 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
24149 version of repository pages accessed with a fixed SHA1.
24150
24151 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
24152
24153 @end deftypevr
24154
24155 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-dynamic-ttl
24156 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
24157 version of repository pages accessed without a fixed SHA1.
24158
24159 Defaults to @samp{5}.
24160
24161 @end deftypevr
24162
24163 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-repo-ttl
24164 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
24165 version of the repository summary page.
24166
24167 Defaults to @samp{5}.
24168
24169 @end deftypevr
24170
24171 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-root-ttl
24172 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
24173 version of the repository index page.
24174
24175 Defaults to @samp{5}.
24176
24177 @end deftypevr
24178
24179 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-scanrc-ttl
24180 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the result of
24181 scanning a path for Git repositories.
24182
24183 Defaults to @samp{15}.
24184
24185 @end deftypevr
24186
24187 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-about-ttl
24188 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
24189 version of the repository about page.
24190
24191 Defaults to @samp{15}.
24192
24193 @end deftypevr
24194
24195 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-snapshot-ttl
24196 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
24197 version of snapshots.
24198
24199 Defaults to @samp{5}.
24200
24201 @end deftypevr
24202
24203 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-size
24204 The maximum number of entries in the cgit cache. When set to @samp{0},
24205 caching is disabled.
24206
24207 Defaults to @samp{0}.
24208
24209 @end deftypevr
24210
24211 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean case-sensitive-sort?
24212 Sort items in the repo list case sensitively.
24213
24214 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
24215
24216 @end deftypevr
24217
24218 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-prefix
24219 List of common prefixes which, when combined with a repository URL,
24220 generates valid clone URLs for the repository.
24221
24222 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24223
24224 @end deftypevr
24225
24226 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-url
24227 List of @code{clone-url} templates.
24228
24229 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24230
24231 @end deftypevr
24232
24233 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object commit-filter
24234 Command which will be invoked to format commit messages.
24235
24236 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24237
24238 @end deftypevr
24239
24240 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string commit-sort
24241 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
24242 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
24243 ordering.
24244
24245 Defaults to @samp{"git log"}.
24246
24247 @end deftypevr
24248
24249 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object css
24250 URL which specifies the css document to include in all cgit pages.
24251
24252 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.css"}.
24253
24254 @end deftypevr
24255
24256 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object email-filter
24257 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format names and email
24258 address of committers, authors, and taggers, as represented in various
24259 places throughout the cgit interface.
24260
24261 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24262
24263 @end deftypevr
24264
24265 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean embedded?
24266 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate a HTML
24267 fragment suitable for embedding in other HTML pages.
24268
24269 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24270
24271 @end deftypevr
24272
24273 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-commit-graph?
24274 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print an ASCII-art
24275 commit history graph to the left of the commit messages in the
24276 repository log page.
24277
24278 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24279
24280 @end deftypevr
24281
24282 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-filter-overrides?
24283 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows all filter settings to be
24284 overridden in repository-specific cgitrc files.
24285
24286 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24287
24288 @end deftypevr
24289
24290 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-follow-links?
24291 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows users to follow a file in the
24292 log view.
24293
24294 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24295
24296 @end deftypevr
24297
24298 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-http-clone?
24299 If set to @samp{#t}, cgit will act as an dumb HTTP endpoint for Git
24300 clones.
24301
24302 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
24303
24304 @end deftypevr
24305
24306 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-links?
24307 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate extra links
24308 "summary", "commit", "tree" for each repo in the repository index.
24309
24310 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24311
24312 @end deftypevr
24313
24314 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-owner?
24315 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit display the owner of
24316 each repo in the repository index.
24317
24318 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
24319
24320 @end deftypevr
24321
24322 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-filecount?
24323 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
24324 modified files for each commit on the repository log page.
24325
24326 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24327
24328 @end deftypevr
24329
24330 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-linecount?
24331 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
24332 added and removed lines for each commit on the repository log page.
24333
24334 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24335
24336 @end deftypevr
24337
24338 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-remote-branches?
24339 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
24340 branches in the summary and refs views.
24341
24342 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24343
24344 @end deftypevr
24345
24346 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-subject-links?
24347 Flag which, when set to @code{1}, will make cgit use the subject of the
24348 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
24349 commit view.
24350
24351 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24352
24353 @end deftypevr
24354
24355 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-html-serving?
24356 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit use the subject of the
24357 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
24358 commit view.
24359
24360 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24361
24362 @end deftypevr
24363
24364 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-tree-linenumbers?
24365 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate linenumber
24366 links for plaintext blobs printed in the tree view.
24367
24368 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
24369
24370 @end deftypevr
24371
24372 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-git-config?
24373 Flag which, when set to @samp{#f}, will allow cgit to use Git config to
24374 set any repo specific settings.
24375
24376 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24377
24378 @end deftypevr
24379
24380 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object favicon
24381 URL used as link to a shortcut icon for cgit.
24382
24383 Defaults to @samp{"/favicon.ico"}.
24384
24385 @end deftypevr
24386
24387 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string footer
24388 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
24389 verbatim at the bottom of all pages (i.e.@: it replaces the standard
24390 "generated by..."@: message).
24391
24392 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24393
24394 @end deftypevr
24395
24396 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string head-include
24397 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
24398 verbatim in the HTML HEAD section on all pages.
24399
24400 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24401
24402 @end deftypevr
24403
24404 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string header
24405 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
24406 verbatim at the top of all pages.
24407
24408 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24409
24410 @end deftypevr
24411
24412 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object include
24413 Name of a configfile to include before the rest of the current config-
24414 file is parsed.
24415
24416 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24417
24418 @end deftypevr
24419
24420 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-header
24421 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
24422 verbatim above the repository index.
24423
24424 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24425
24426 @end deftypevr
24427
24428 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-info
24429 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
24430 verbatim below the heading on the repository index page.
24431
24432 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24433
24434 @end deftypevr
24435
24436 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean local-time?
24437 Flag which, if set to @samp{#t}, makes cgit print commit and tag times
24438 in the servers timezone.
24439
24440 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24441
24442 @end deftypevr
24443
24444 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object logo
24445 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
24446 on all cgit pages.
24447
24448 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.png"}.
24449
24450 @end deftypevr
24451
24452 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string logo-link
24453 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
24454
24455 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24456
24457 @end deftypevr
24458
24459 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object owner-filter
24460 Command which will be invoked to format the Owner column of the main
24461 page.
24462
24463 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24464
24465 @end deftypevr
24466
24467 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-atom-items
24468 Number of items to display in atom feeds view.
24469
24470 Defaults to @samp{10}.
24471
24472 @end deftypevr
24473
24474 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-commit-count
24475 Number of entries to list per page in "log" view.
24476
24477 Defaults to @samp{50}.
24478
24479 @end deftypevr
24480
24481 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-message-length
24482 Number of commit message characters to display in "log" view.
24483
24484 Defaults to @samp{80}.
24485
24486 @end deftypevr
24487
24488 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repo-count
24489 Specifies the number of entries to list per page on the repository index
24490 page.
24491
24492 Defaults to @samp{50}.
24493
24494 @end deftypevr
24495
24496 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repodesc-length
24497 Specifies the maximum number of repo description characters to display
24498 on the repository index page.
24499
24500 Defaults to @samp{80}.
24501
24502 @end deftypevr
24503
24504 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-blob-size
24505 Specifies the maximum size of a blob to display HTML for in KBytes.
24506
24507 Defaults to @samp{0}.
24508
24509 @end deftypevr
24510
24511 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string max-stats
24512 Maximum statistics period. Valid values are @samp{week},@samp{month},
24513 @samp{quarter} and @samp{year}.
24514
24515 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24516
24517 @end deftypevr
24518
24519 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} mimetype-alist mimetype
24520 Mimetype for the specified filename extension.
24521
24522 Defaults to @samp{((gif "image/gif") (html "text/html") (jpg
24523 "image/jpeg") (jpeg "image/jpeg") (pdf "application/pdf") (png
24524 "image/png") (svg "image/svg+xml"))}.
24525
24526 @end deftypevr
24527
24528 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object mimetype-file
24529 Specifies the file to use for automatic mimetype lookup.
24530
24531 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24532
24533 @end deftypevr
24534
24535 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string module-link
24536 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
24537 submodule is printed in a directory listing.
24538
24539 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24540
24541 @end deftypevr
24542
24543 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean nocache?
24544 If set to the value @samp{#t} caching will be disabled.
24545
24546 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24547
24548 @end deftypevr
24549
24550 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noplainemail?
24551 If set to @samp{#t} showing full author email addresses will be
24552 disabled.
24553
24554 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24555
24556 @end deftypevr
24557
24558 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noheader?
24559 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit omit the standard
24560 header on all pages.
24561
24562 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24563
24564 @end deftypevr
24565
24566 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} project-list project-list
24567 A list of subdirectories inside of @code{repository-directory}, relative
24568 to it, that should loaded as Git repositories. An empty list means that
24569 all subdirectories will be loaded.
24570
24571 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24572
24573 @end deftypevr
24574
24575 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object readme
24576 Text which will be used as default value for @code{cgit-repo-readme}.
24577
24578 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24579
24580 @end deftypevr
24581
24582 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean remove-suffix?
24583 If set to @code{#t} and @code{repository-directory} is enabled, if any
24584 repositories are found with a suffix of @code{.git}, this suffix will be
24585 removed for the URL and name.
24586
24587 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24588
24589 @end deftypevr
24590
24591 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer renamelimit
24592 Maximum number of files to consider when detecting renames.
24593
24594 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
24595
24596 @end deftypevr
24597
24598 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string repository-sort
24599 The way in which repositories in each section are sorted.
24600
24601 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24602
24603 @end deftypevr
24604
24605 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} robots-list robots
24606 Text used as content for the @code{robots} meta-tag.
24607
24608 Defaults to @samp{("noindex" "nofollow")}.
24609
24610 @end deftypevr
24611
24612 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-desc
24613 Text printed below the heading on the repository index page.
24614
24615 Defaults to @samp{"a fast webinterface for the git dscm"}.
24616
24617 @end deftypevr
24618
24619 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-readme
24620 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
24621 verbatim below the "about" link on the repository index page.
24622
24623 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24624
24625 @end deftypevr
24626
24627 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-title
24628 Text printed as heading on the repository index page.
24629
24630 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24631
24632 @end deftypevr
24633
24634 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean scan-hidden-path
24635 If set to @samp{#t} and repository-directory is enabled,
24636 repository-directory will recurse into directories whose name starts
24637 with a period. Otherwise, repository-directory will stay away from such
24638 directories, considered as "hidden". Note that this does not apply to
24639 the ".git" directory in non-bare repos.
24640
24641 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24642
24643 @end deftypevr
24644
24645 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list snapshots
24646 Text which specifies the default set of snapshot formats that cgit
24647 generates links for.
24648
24649 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24650
24651 @end deftypevr
24652
24653 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-directory repository-directory
24654 Name of the directory to scan for repositories (represents
24655 @code{scan-path}).
24656
24657 Defaults to @samp{"/srv/git"}.
24658
24659 @end deftypevr
24660
24661 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section
24662 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
24663 after this option will inherit the current section name.
24664
24665 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24666
24667 @end deftypevr
24668
24669 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section-sort
24670 Flag which, when set to @samp{1}, will sort the sections on the
24671 repository listing by name.
24672
24673 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24674
24675 @end deftypevr
24676
24677 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer section-from-path
24678 A number which, if defined prior to repository-directory, specifies how
24679 many path elements from each repo path to use as a default section name.
24680
24681 Defaults to @samp{0}.
24682
24683 @end deftypevr
24684
24685 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean side-by-side-diffs?
24686 If set to @samp{#t} shows side-by-side diffs instead of unidiffs per
24687 default.
24688
24689 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24690
24691 @end deftypevr
24692
24693 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object source-filter
24694 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format plaintext blobs in
24695 the tree view.
24696
24697 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24698
24699 @end deftypevr
24700
24701 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-branches
24702 Specifies the number of branches to display in the repository "summary"
24703 view.
24704
24705 Defaults to @samp{10}.
24706
24707 @end deftypevr
24708
24709 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-log
24710 Specifies the number of log entries to display in the repository
24711 "summary" view.
24712
24713 Defaults to @samp{10}.
24714
24715 @end deftypevr
24716
24717 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-tags
24718 Specifies the number of tags to display in the repository "summary"
24719 view.
24720
24721 Defaults to @samp{10}.
24722
24723 @end deftypevr
24724
24725 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string strict-export
24726 Filename which, if specified, needs to be present within the repository
24727 for cgit to allow access to that repository.
24728
24729 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24730
24731 @end deftypevr
24732
24733 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string virtual-root
24734 URL which, if specified, will be used as root for all cgit links.
24735
24736 Defaults to @samp{"/"}.
24737
24738 @end deftypevr
24739
24740 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-cgit-configuration-list repositories
24741 A list of @dfn{cgit-repo} records to use with config.
24742
24743 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24744
24745 Available @code{repository-cgit-configuration} fields are:
24746
24747 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list snapshots
24748 A mask of snapshot formats for this repo that cgit generates links for,
24749 restricted by the global @code{snapshots} setting.
24750
24751 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24752
24753 @end deftypevr
24754
24755 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object source-filter
24756 Override the default @code{source-filter}.
24757
24758 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24759
24760 @end deftypevr
24761
24762 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string url
24763 The relative URL used to access the repository.
24764
24765 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24766
24767 @end deftypevr
24768
24769 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object about-filter
24770 Override the default @code{about-filter}.
24771
24772 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24773
24774 @end deftypevr
24775
24776 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string branch-sort
24777 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
24778 ref list, and when set to @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
24779
24780 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24781
24782 @end deftypevr
24783
24784 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list clone-url
24785 A list of URLs which can be used to clone repo.
24786
24787 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24788
24789 @end deftypevr
24790
24791 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object commit-filter
24792 Override the default @code{commit-filter}.
24793
24794 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24795
24796 @end deftypevr
24797
24798 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string commit-sort
24799 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
24800 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
24801 ordering.
24802
24803 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24804
24805 @end deftypevr
24806
24807 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string defbranch
24808 The name of the default branch for this repository. If no such branch
24809 exists in the repository, the first branch name (when sorted) is used as
24810 default instead. By default branch pointed to by HEAD, or "master" if
24811 there is no suitable HEAD.
24812
24813 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24814
24815 @end deftypevr
24816
24817 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string desc
24818 The value to show as repository description.
24819
24820 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24821
24822 @end deftypevr
24823
24824 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string homepage
24825 The value to show as repository homepage.
24826
24827 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24828
24829 @end deftypevr
24830
24831 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object email-filter
24832 Override the default @code{email-filter}.
24833
24834 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24835
24836 @end deftypevr
24837
24838 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-commit-graph?
24839 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
24840 @code{enable-commit-graph?}.
24841
24842 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24843
24844 @end deftypevr
24845
24846 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-filecount?
24847 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
24848 @code{enable-log-filecount?}.
24849
24850 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24851
24852 @end deftypevr
24853
24854 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-linecount?
24855 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
24856 @code{enable-log-linecount?}.
24857
24858 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24859
24860 @end deftypevr
24861
24862 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-remote-branches?
24863 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
24864 branches in the summary and refs views.
24865
24866 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24867
24868 @end deftypevr
24869
24870 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-subject-links?
24871 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
24872 @code{enable-subject-links?}.
24873
24874 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24875
24876 @end deftypevr
24877
24878 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-html-serving?
24879 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
24880 @code{enable-html-serving?}.
24881
24882 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24883
24884 @end deftypevr
24885
24886 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean hide?
24887 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, hides the repository from the
24888 repository index.
24889
24890 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24891
24892 @end deftypevr
24893
24894 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean ignore?
24895 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, ignores the repository.
24896
24897 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24898
24899 @end deftypevr
24900
24901 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object logo
24902 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
24903 on this repo’s pages.
24904
24905 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24906
24907 @end deftypevr
24908
24909 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string logo-link
24910 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
24911
24912 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24913
24914 @end deftypevr
24915
24916 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object owner-filter
24917 Override the default @code{owner-filter}.
24918
24919 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24920
24921 @end deftypevr
24922
24923 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string module-link
24924 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
24925 submodule is printed in a directory listing. The arguments for the
24926 formatstring are the path and SHA1 of the submodule commit.
24927
24928 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24929
24930 @end deftypevr
24931
24932 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} module-link-path module-link-path
24933 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
24934 submodule with the specified subdirectory path is printed in a directory
24935 listing.
24936
24937 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24938
24939 @end deftypevr
24940
24941 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string max-stats
24942 Override the default maximum statistics period.
24943
24944 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24945
24946 @end deftypevr
24947
24948 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string name
24949 The value to show as repository name.
24950
24951 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24952
24953 @end deftypevr
24954
24955 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string owner
24956 A value used to identify the owner of the repository.
24957
24958 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24959
24960 @end deftypevr
24961
24962 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string path
24963 An absolute path to the repository directory.
24964
24965 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24966
24967 @end deftypevr
24968
24969 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string readme
24970 A path (relative to repo) which specifies a file to include verbatim as
24971 the "About" page for this repo.
24972
24973 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24974
24975 @end deftypevr
24976
24977 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string section
24978 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
24979 after this option will inherit the current section name.
24980
24981 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24982
24983 @end deftypevr
24984
24985 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list extra-options
24986 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
24987
24988 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24989
24990 @end deftypevr
24991
24992 @end deftypevr
24993
24994 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
24995 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
24996
24997 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24998
24999 @end deftypevr
25000
25001
25002 @c %end of fragment
25003
25004 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{cgitrc} up and
25005 running. In that case, you can pass an @code{opaque-cgit-configuration}
25006 as a record to @code{cgit-service-type}. As its name indicates, an
25007 opaque configuration does not have easy reflective capabilities.
25008
25009 Available @code{opaque-cgit-configuration} fields are:
25010
25011 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} package cgit
25012 The cgit package.
25013 @end deftypevr
25014
25015 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} string string
25016 The contents of the @code{cgitrc}, as a string.
25017 @end deftypevr
25018
25019 For example, if your @code{cgitrc} is just the empty string, you
25020 could instantiate a cgit service like this:
25021
25022 @lisp
25023 (service cgit-service-type
25024 (opaque-cgit-configuration
25025 (cgitrc "")))
25026 @end lisp
25027
25028 @subsubheading Gitolite Service
25029
25030 @cindex Gitolite service
25031 @cindex Git, hosting
25032 @uref{https://gitolite.com/gitolite/, Gitolite} is a tool for hosting Git
25033 repositories on a central server.
25034
25035 Gitolite can handle multiple repositories and users, and supports flexible
25036 configuration of the permissions for the users on the repositories.
25037
25038 The following example will configure Gitolite using the default @code{git}
25039 user, and the provided SSH public key.
25040
25041 @lisp
25042 (service gitolite-service-type
25043 (gitolite-configuration
25044 (admin-pubkey (plain-file
25045 "yourname.pub"
25046 "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com"))))
25047 @end lisp
25048
25049 Gitolite is configured through a special admin repository which you can clone,
25050 for example, if you setup Gitolite on @code{example.com}, you would run the
25051 following command to clone the admin repository.
25052
25053 @example
25054 git clone git@@example.com:gitolite-admin
25055 @end example
25056
25057 When the Gitolite service is activated, the provided @code{admin-pubkey} will
25058 be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory in the gitolite-admin
25059 repository. If this results in a change in the repository, it will be
25060 committed using the message ``gitolite setup by GNU Guix''.
25061
25062 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-configuration
25063 Data type representing the configuration for @code{gitolite-service-type}.
25064
25065 @table @asis
25066 @item @code{package} (default: @var{gitolite})
25067 Gitolite package to use.
25068
25069 @item @code{user} (default: @var{git})
25070 User to use for Gitolite. This will be user that you use when accessing
25071 Gitolite over SSH.
25072
25073 @item @code{group} (default: @var{git})
25074 Group to use for Gitolite.
25075
25076 @item @code{home-directory} (default: @var{"/var/lib/gitolite"})
25077 Directory in which to store the Gitolite configuration and repositories.
25078
25079 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @var{(gitolite-rc-file)})
25080 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}),
25081 representing the configuration for Gitolite.
25082
25083 @item @code{admin-pubkey} (default: @var{#f})
25084 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) used to
25085 setup Gitolite. This will be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory
25086 within the gitolite-admin repository.
25087
25088 To specify the SSH key as a string, use the @code{plain-file} function.
25089
25090 @lisp
25091 (plain-file "yourname.pub" "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com")
25092 @end lisp
25093
25094 @end table
25095 @end deftp
25096
25097 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-rc-file
25098 Data type representing the Gitolite RC file.
25099
25100 @table @asis
25101 @item @code{umask} (default: @code{#o0077})
25102 This controls the permissions Gitolite sets on the repositories and their
25103 contents.
25104
25105 A value like @code{#o0027} will give read access to the group used by Gitolite
25106 (by default: @code{git}). This is necessary when using Gitolite with software
25107 like cgit or gitweb.
25108
25109 @item @code{git-config-keys} (default: @code{""})
25110 Gitolite allows you to set git config values using the "config" keyword. This
25111 setting allows control over the config keys to accept.
25112
25113 @item @code{roles} (default: @code{'(("READERS" . 1) ("WRITERS" . ))})
25114 Set the role names allowed to be used by users running the perms command.
25115
25116 @item @code{enable} (default: @code{'("help" "desc" "info" "perms" "writable" "ssh-authkeys" "git-config" "daemon" "gitweb")})
25117 This setting controls the commands and features to enable within Gitolite.
25118
25119 @end table
25120 @end deftp
25121
25122
25123 @node Game Services
25124 @subsection Game Services
25125
25126 @subsubheading The Battle for Wesnoth Service
25127 @cindex wesnothd
25128 @uref{https://wesnoth.org, The Battle for Wesnoth} is a fantasy, turn
25129 based tactical strategy game, with several single player campaigns, and
25130 multiplayer games (both networked and local).
25131
25132 @defvar {Scheme Variable} wesnothd-service-type
25133 Service type for the wesnothd service. Its value must be a
25134 @code{wesnothd-configuration} object. To run wesnothd in the default
25135 configuration, instantiate it as:
25136
25137 @lisp
25138 (service wesnothd-service-type)
25139 @end lisp
25140 @end defvar
25141
25142 @deftp {Data Type} wesnothd-configuration
25143 Data type representing the configuration of @command{wesnothd}.
25144
25145 @table @asis
25146 @item @code{package} (default: @code{wesnoth-server})
25147 The wesnoth server package to use.
25148
25149 @item @code{port} (default: @code{15000})
25150 The port to bind the server to.
25151 @end table
25152 @end deftp
25153
25154
25155 @node PAM Mount Service
25156 @subsection PAM Mount Service
25157 @cindex pam-mount
25158
25159 The @code{(gnu services pam-mount)} module provides a service allowing
25160 users to mount volumes when they log in. It should be able to mount any
25161 volume format supported by the system.
25162
25163 @defvar {Scheme Variable} pam-mount-service-type
25164 Service type for PAM Mount support.
25165 @end defvar
25166
25167 @deftp {Data Type} pam-mount-configuration
25168 Data type representing the configuration of PAM Mount.
25169
25170 It takes the following parameters:
25171
25172 @table @asis
25173 @item @code{rules}
25174 The configuration rules that will be used to generate
25175 @file{/etc/security/pam_mount.conf.xml}.
25176
25177 The configuration rules are SXML elements (@pxref{SXML,,, guile, GNU
25178 Guile Reference Manual}), and the the default ones don't mount anything
25179 for anyone at login:
25180
25181 @lisp
25182 `((debug (@@ (enable "0")))
25183 (mntoptions (@@ (allow ,(string-join
25184 '("nosuid" "nodev" "loop"
25185 "encryption" "fsck" "nonempty"
25186 "allow_root" "allow_other")
25187 ","))))
25188 (mntoptions (@@ (require "nosuid,nodev")))
25189 (logout (@@ (wait "0")
25190 (hup "0")
25191 (term "no")
25192 (kill "no")))
25193 (mkmountpoint (@@ (enable "1")
25194 (remove "true"))))
25195 @end lisp
25196
25197 Some @code{volume} elements must be added to automatically mount volumes
25198 at login. Here's an example allowing the user @code{alice} to mount her
25199 encrypted @code{HOME} directory and allowing the user @code{bob} to mount
25200 the partition where he stores his data:
25201
25202 @lisp
25203 (define pam-mount-rules
25204 `((debug (@@ (enable "0")))
25205 (volume (@@ (user "alice")
25206 (fstype "crypt")
25207 (path "/dev/sda2")
25208 (mountpoint "/home/alice")))
25209 (volume (@@ (user "bob")
25210 (fstype "auto")
25211 (path "/dev/sdb3")
25212 (mountpoint "/home/bob/data")
25213 (options "defaults,autodefrag,compress")))
25214 (mntoptions (@@ (allow ,(string-join
25215 '("nosuid" "nodev" "loop"
25216 "encryption" "fsck" "nonempty"
25217 "allow_root" "allow_other")
25218 ","))))
25219 (mntoptions (@@ (require "nosuid,nodev")))
25220 (logout (@@ (wait "0")
25221 (hup "0")
25222 (term "no")
25223 (kill "no")))
25224 (mkmountpoint (@@ (enable "1")
25225 (remove "true")))))
25226
25227 (service pam-mount-service-type
25228 (pam-mount-configuration
25229 (rules pam-mount-rules)))
25230 @end lisp
25231
25232 The complete list of possible options can be found in the man page for
25233 @uref{http://pam-mount.sourceforge.net/pam_mount.conf.5.html, pam_mount.conf}.
25234 @end table
25235 @end deftp
25236
25237
25238 @node Guix Services
25239 @subsection Guix Services
25240
25241 @subsubheading Guix Data Service
25242 The @uref{http://data.guix.gnu.org,Guix Data Service} processes, stores
25243 and provides data about GNU Guix. This includes information about
25244 packages, derivations and lint warnings.
25245
25246 The data is stored in a PostgreSQL database, and available through a web
25247 interface.
25248
25249 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-data-service-type
25250 Service type for the Guix Data Service. Its value must be a
25251 @code{guix-data-service-configuration} object. The service optionally
25252 extends the getmail service, as the guix-commits mailing list is used to
25253 find out about changes in the Guix git repository.
25254 @end defvar
25255
25256 @deftp {Data Type} guix-data-service-configuration
25257 Data type representing the configuration of the Guix Data Service.
25258
25259 @table @asis
25260 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-data-service})
25261 The Guix Data Service package to use.
25262
25263 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-data-service"})
25264 The system user to run the service as.
25265
25266 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"guix-data-service"})
25267 The system group to run the service as.
25268
25269 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8765})
25270 The port to bind the web service to.
25271
25272 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
25273 The host to bind the web service to.
25274
25275 @item @code{getmail-idle-mailboxes} (default: @code{#f})
25276 If set, this is the list of mailboxes that the getmail service will be
25277 configured to listen to.
25278
25279 @item @code{commits-getmail-retriever-configuration} (default: @code{#f})
25280 If set, this is the @code{getmail-retriever-configuration} object with
25281 which to configure getmail to fetch mail from the guix-commits mailing
25282 list.
25283
25284 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{'()})
25285 Extra command line options for @code{guix-data-service}.
25286
25287 @item @code{extra-process-jobs-options} (default: @var{'()})
25288 Extra command line options for @code{guix-data-service-process-jobs}.
25289
25290 @end table
25291 @end deftp
25292
25293 @node Linux Services
25294 @subsubheading Linux Services
25295
25296 @cindex oom
25297 @cindex out of memory killer
25298 @cindex earlyoom
25299 @cindex early out of memory daemon
25300 @subsection Early OOM Service
25301
25302 @uref{https://github.com/rfjakob/earlyoom,Early OOM}, also known as
25303 Earlyoom, is a minimalist out of memory (OOM) daemon that runs in user
25304 space and provides a more responsive and configurable alternative to the
25305 in-kernel OOM killer. It is useful to prevent the system from becoming
25306 unresponsive when it runs out of memory.
25307
25308 @deffn {Scheme Variable} earlyoom-service-type
25309 The service type for running @command{earlyoom}, the Early OOM daemon.
25310 Its value must be a @code{earlyoom-configuration} object, described
25311 below. The service can be instantiated in its default configuration
25312 with:
25313
25314 @lisp
25315 (service earlyoom-service-type)
25316 @end lisp
25317 @end deffn
25318
25319 @deftp {Data Type} earlyoom-configuration
25320 This is the configuration record for the @code{earlyoom-service-type}.
25321
25322 @table @asis
25323 @item @code{earlyoom} (default: @var{earlyoom})
25324 The Earlyoom package to use.
25325
25326 @item @code{minimum-available-memory} (default: @code{10})
25327 The threshold for the minimum @emph{available} memory, in percentages.
25328
25329 @item @code{minimum-free-swap} (default: @code{10})
25330 The threshold for the minimum free swap memory, in percentages.
25331
25332 @item @code{prefer-regexp} (default: @code{#f})
25333 A regular expression (as a string) to match the names of the processes
25334 that should be preferably killed.
25335
25336 @item @code{avoid-regexp} (default: @code{#f})
25337 A regular expression (as a string) to match the names of the processes
25338 that should @emph{not} be killed.
25339
25340 @item @code{memory-report-interval} (default: @code{0})
25341 The interval in seconds at which a memory report is printed. It is
25342 disabled by default.
25343
25344 @item @code{ignore-positive-oom-score-adj?} (default: @code{#f})
25345 A boolean indicating whether the positive adjustments set in
25346 @file{/proc/*/oom_score_adj}.
25347
25348 @item @code{show-debug-messages?} (default: @code{#f})
25349 A boolean indicating whether debug messages should be printed. The logs
25350 are saved at @file{/var/log/earlyoom.log}.
25351
25352 @item @code{send-notification-command} (default: @code{#f})
25353 This can be used to provide a custom command used for sending
25354 notifications.
25355 @end table
25356 @end deftp
25357
25358
25359 @node Miscellaneous Services
25360 @subsection Miscellaneous Services
25361
25362 @cindex fingerprint
25363 @subsubheading Fingerprint Service
25364
25365 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides a DBus service to
25366 read and identify fingerprints via a fingerprint sensor.
25367
25368 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fprintd-service-type
25369 The service type for @command{fprintd}, which provides the fingerprint
25370 reading capability.
25371
25372 @lisp
25373 (service fprintd-service-type)
25374 @end lisp
25375 @end defvr
25376
25377 @cindex sysctl
25378 @subsubheading System Control Service
25379
25380 The @code{(gnu services sysctl)} provides a service to configure kernel
25381 parameters at boot.
25382
25383 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sysctl-service-type
25384 The service type for @command{sysctl}, which modifies kernel parameters
25385 under @file{/proc/sys/}. To enable IPv4 forwarding, it can be
25386 instantiated as:
25387
25388 @lisp
25389 (service sysctl-service-type
25390 (sysctl-configuration
25391 (settings '(("net.ipv4.ip_forward" . "1")))))
25392 @end lisp
25393 @end defvr
25394
25395 @deftp {Data Type} sysctl-configuration
25396 The data type representing the configuration of @command{sysctl}.
25397
25398 @table @asis
25399 @item @code{sysctl} (default: @code{(file-append procps "/sbin/sysctl"})
25400 The @command{sysctl} executable to use.
25401
25402 @item @code{settings} (default: @code{'()})
25403 An association list specifies kernel parameters and their values.
25404 @end table
25405 @end deftp
25406
25407 @cindex pcscd
25408 @subsubheading PC/SC Smart Card Daemon Service
25409
25410 The @code{(gnu services security-token)} module provides the following service
25411 to run @command{pcscd}, the PC/SC Smart Card Daemon. @command{pcscd} is the
25412 daemon program for pcsc-lite and the MuscleCard framework. It is a resource
25413 manager that coordinates communications with smart card readers, smart cards
25414 and cryptographic tokens that are connected to the system.
25415
25416 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pcscd-service-type
25417 Service type for the @command{pcscd} service. Its value must be a
25418 @code{pcscd-configuration} object. To run pcscd in the default
25419 configuration, instantiate it as:
25420
25421 @lisp
25422 (service pcscd-service-type)
25423 @end lisp
25424 @end defvr
25425
25426 @deftp {Data Type} pcscd-configuration
25427 The data type representing the configuration of @command{pcscd}.
25428
25429 @table @asis
25430 @item @code{pcsc-lite} (default: @code{pcsc-lite})
25431 The pcsc-lite package that provides pcscd.
25432 @item @code{usb-drivers} (default: @code{(list ccid)})
25433 List of packages that provide USB drivers to pcscd. Drivers are expected to be
25434 under @file{pcsc/drivers} in the store directory of the package.
25435 @end table
25436 @end deftp
25437
25438 @cindex lirc
25439 @subsubheading Lirc Service
25440
25441 The @code{(gnu services lirc)} module provides the following service.
25442
25443 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lirc-service [#:lirc lirc] @
25444 [#:device #f] [#:driver #f] [#:config-file #f] @
25445 [#:extra-options '()]
25446 Return a service that runs @url{http://www.lirc.org,LIRC}, a daemon that
25447 decodes infrared signals from remote controls.
25448
25449 Optionally, @var{device}, @var{driver} and @var{config-file}
25450 (configuration file name) may be specified. See @command{lircd} manual
25451 for details.
25452
25453 Finally, @var{extra-options} is a list of additional command-line options
25454 passed to @command{lircd}.
25455 @end deffn
25456
25457 @cindex spice
25458 @subsubheading Spice Service
25459
25460 The @code{(gnu services spice)} module provides the following service.
25461
25462 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} spice-vdagent-service [#:spice-vdagent]
25463 Returns a service that runs @url{https://www.spice-space.org,VDAGENT}, a daemon
25464 that enables sharing the clipboard with a vm and setting the guest display
25465 resolution when the graphical console window resizes.
25466 @end deffn
25467
25468 @cindex inputattach
25469 @subsubheading inputattach Service
25470
25471 @cindex tablet input, for Xorg
25472 @cindex touchscreen input, for Xorg
25473 The @uref{https://linuxwacom.github.io/, inputattach} service allows you to
25474 use input devices such as Wacom tablets, touchscreens, or joysticks with the
25475 Xorg display server.
25476
25477 @deffn {Scheme Variable} inputattach-service-type
25478 Type of a service that runs @command{inputattach} on a device and
25479 dispatches events from it.
25480 @end deffn
25481
25482 @deftp {Data Type} inputattach-configuration
25483 @table @asis
25484 @item @code{device-type} (default: @code{"wacom"})
25485 The type of device to connect to. Run @command{inputattach --help}, from the
25486 @code{inputattach} package, to see the list of supported device types.
25487
25488 @item @code{device} (default: @code{"/dev/ttyS0"})
25489 The device file to connect to the device.
25490
25491 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{#f})
25492 Baud rate to use for the serial connection.
25493 Should be a number or @code{#f}.
25494
25495 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{#f})
25496 If true, this must be the name of a file to log messages to.
25497 @end table
25498 @end deftp
25499
25500 @subsection Dictionary Services
25501 @cindex dictionary
25502 The @code{(gnu services dict)} module provides the following service:
25503
25504 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dicod-service [#:config (dicod-configuration)]
25505 Return a service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an implementation
25506 of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
25507
25508 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
25509 @command{dicod}, which should be a @code{<dicod-configuration>} object, by
25510 default it serves the GNU Collaborative International Dictionary of English.
25511
25512 You can add @command{open localhost} to your @file{~/.dico} file to make
25513 @code{localhost} the default server for @command{dico} client
25514 (@pxref{Initialization File,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
25515 @end deffn
25516
25517 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-configuration
25518 Data type representing the configuration of dicod.
25519
25520 @table @asis
25521 @item @code{dico} (default: @var{dico})
25522 Package object of the GNU Dico dictionary server.
25523
25524 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @var{'("localhost")})
25525 This is the list of IP addresses and ports and possibly socket file
25526 names to listen to (@pxref{Server Settings, @code{listen} directive,,
25527 dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
25528
25529 @item @code{handlers} (default: @var{'()})
25530 List of @code{<dicod-handler>} objects denoting handlers (module instances).
25531
25532 @item @code{databases} (default: @var{(list %dicod-database:gcide)})
25533 List of @code{<dicod-database>} objects denoting dictionaries to be served.
25534 @end table
25535 @end deftp
25536
25537 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-handler
25538 Data type representing a dictionary handler (module instance).
25539
25540 @table @asis
25541 @item @code{name}
25542 Name of the handler (module instance).
25543
25544 @item @code{module} (default: @var{#f})
25545 Name of the dicod module of the handler (instance). If it is @code{#f},
25546 the module has the same name as the handler.
25547 (@pxref{Modules,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
25548
25549 @item @code{options}
25550 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the module handler
25551 @end table
25552 @end deftp
25553
25554 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-database
25555 Data type representing a dictionary database.
25556
25557 @table @asis
25558 @item @code{name}
25559 Name of the database, will be used in DICT commands.
25560
25561 @item @code{handler}
25562 Name of the dicod handler (module instance) used by this database
25563 (@pxref{Handlers,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
25564
25565 @item @code{complex?} (default: @var{#f})
25566 Whether the database configuration complex. The complex configuration
25567 will need a corresponding @code{<dicod-handler>} object, otherwise not.
25568
25569 @item @code{options}
25570 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the database
25571 (@pxref{Databases,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
25572 @end table
25573 @end deftp
25574
25575 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %dicod-database:gcide
25576 A @code{<dicod-database>} object serving the GNU Collaborative International
25577 Dictionary of English using the @code{gcide} package.
25578 @end defvr
25579
25580 The following is an example @code{dicod-service} configuration.
25581
25582 @lisp
25583 (dicod-service #:config
25584 (dicod-configuration
25585 (handlers (list (dicod-handler
25586 (name "wordnet")
25587 (module "dictorg")
25588 (options
25589 (list #~(string-append "dbdir=" #$wordnet))))))
25590 (databases (list (dicod-database
25591 (name "wordnet")
25592 (complex? #t)
25593 (handler "wordnet")
25594 (options '("database=wn")))
25595 %dicod-database:gcide))))
25596 @end lisp
25597
25598 @cindex Docker
25599 @subsubheading Docker Service
25600
25601 The @code{(gnu services docker)} module provides the following services.
25602
25603 @defvr {Scheme Variable} docker-service-type
25604
25605 This is the type of the service that runs @url{https://www.docker.com,Docker},
25606 a daemon that can execute application bundles (sometimes referred to as
25607 ``containers'') in isolated environments.
25608
25609 @end defvr
25610
25611 @deftp {Data Type} docker-configuration
25612 This is the data type representing the configuration of Docker and Containerd.
25613
25614 @table @asis
25615
25616 @item @code{package} (default: @code{docker})
25617 The Docker package to use.
25618
25619 @item @code{containerd} (default: @var{containerd})
25620 The Containerd package to use.
25621
25622 @end table
25623 @end deftp
25624
25625 @cindex Audit
25626 @subsubheading Auditd Service
25627
25628 The @code{(gnu services auditd)} module provides the following service.
25629
25630 @defvr {Scheme Variable} auditd-service-type
25631
25632 This is the type of the service that runs
25633 @url{https://people.redhat.com/sgrubb/audit/,auditd},
25634 a daemon that tracks security-relevant information on your system.
25635
25636 Examples of things that can be tracked:
25637
25638 @enumerate
25639 @item
25640 File accesses
25641 @item
25642 System calls
25643 @item
25644 Invoked commands
25645 @item
25646 Failed login attempts
25647 @item
25648 Firewall filtering
25649 @item
25650 Network access
25651 @end enumerate
25652
25653 @command{auditctl} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
25654 to add or remove events to be tracked (until the next reboot).
25655 In order to permanently track events, put the command line arguments
25656 of auditctl into @file{/etc/audit/audit.rules}.
25657 @command{aureport} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
25658 to view a report of all recorded events.
25659 The audit daemon usually logs into the directory @file{/var/log/audit}.
25660
25661 @end defvr
25662
25663 @deftp {Data Type} auditd-configuration
25664 This is the data type representing the configuration of auditd.
25665
25666 @table @asis
25667
25668 @item @code{audit} (default: @code{audit})
25669 The audit package to use.
25670
25671 @end table
25672 @end deftp
25673
25674 @defvr {Scheme Variable} singularity-service-type
25675 This is the type of the service that allows you to run
25676 @url{https://www.sylabs.io/singularity/, Singularity}, a Docker-style tool to
25677 create and run application bundles (aka. ``containers''). The value for this
25678 service is the Singularity package to use.
25679
25680 The service does not install a daemon; instead, it installs helper programs as
25681 setuid-root (@pxref{Setuid Programs}) such that unprivileged users can invoke
25682 @command{singularity run} and similar commands.
25683 @end defvr
25684
25685 @cindex Nix
25686 @subsubheading Nix service
25687
25688 The @code{(gnu services nix)} module provides the following service.
25689
25690 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nix-service-type
25691
25692 This is the type of the service that runs build daemon of the
25693 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix} package manager. Here is an example showing
25694 how to use it:
25695
25696 @lisp
25697 (use-modules (gnu))
25698 (use-service-modules nix)
25699 (use-package-modules package-management)
25700
25701 (operating-system
25702 ;; @dots{}
25703 (packages (append (list nix)
25704 %base-packages))
25705
25706 (services (append (list (service nix-service-type))
25707 %base-services)))
25708 @end lisp
25709
25710 After @command{guix system reconfigure} configure Nix for your user:
25711
25712 @itemize
25713 @item Add a Nix channel and update it. See
25714 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/manual/, Nix Package Manager Guide}.
25715
25716 @item Create a symlink to your profile and activate Nix profile:
25717 @end itemize
25718
25719 @example
25720 $ ln -s "/nix/var/nix/profiles/per-user/$USER/profile" ~/.nix-profile
25721 $ source /run/current-system/profile/etc/profile.d/nix.sh
25722 @end example
25723
25724 @end defvr
25725
25726 @node Setuid Programs
25727 @section Setuid Programs
25728
25729 @cindex setuid programs
25730 Some programs need to run with ``root'' privileges, even when they are
25731 launched by unprivileged users. A notorious example is the
25732 @command{passwd} program, which users can run to change their
25733 password, and which needs to access the @file{/etc/passwd} and
25734 @file{/etc/shadow} files---something normally restricted to root, for
25735 obvious security reasons. To address that, these executables are
25736 @dfn{setuid-root}, meaning that they always run with root privileges
25737 (@pxref{How Change Persona,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual},
25738 for more info about the setuid mechanism.)
25739
25740 The store itself @emph{cannot} contain setuid programs: that would be a
25741 security issue since any user on the system can write derivations that
25742 populate the store (@pxref{The Store}). Thus, a different mechanism is
25743 used: instead of changing the setuid bit directly on files that are in
25744 the store, we let the system administrator @emph{declare} which programs
25745 should be setuid root.
25746
25747 The @code{setuid-programs} field of an @code{operating-system}
25748 declaration contains a list of G-expressions denoting the names of
25749 programs to be setuid-root (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
25750 For instance, the @command{passwd} program, which is part of the Shadow
25751 package, can be designated by this G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
25752
25753 @example
25754 #~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/passwd")
25755 @end example
25756
25757 A default set of setuid programs is defined by the
25758 @code{%setuid-programs} variable of the @code{(gnu system)} module.
25759
25760 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %setuid-programs
25761 A list of G-expressions denoting common programs that are setuid-root.
25762
25763 The list includes commands such as @command{passwd}, @command{ping},
25764 @command{su}, and @command{sudo}.
25765 @end defvr
25766
25767 Under the hood, the actual setuid programs are created in the
25768 @file{/run/setuid-programs} directory at system activation time. The
25769 files in this directory refer to the ``real'' binaries, which are in the
25770 store.
25771
25772 @node X.509 Certificates
25773 @section X.509 Certificates
25774
25775 @cindex HTTPS, certificates
25776 @cindex X.509 certificates
25777 @cindex TLS
25778 Web servers available over HTTPS (that is, HTTP over the transport-layer
25779 security mechanism, TLS) send client programs an @dfn{X.509 certificate}
25780 that the client can then use to @emph{authenticate} the server. To do
25781 that, clients verify that the server's certificate is signed by a
25782 so-called @dfn{certificate authority} (CA). But to verify the CA's
25783 signature, clients must have first acquired the CA's certificate.
25784
25785 Web browsers such as GNU@tie{}IceCat include their own set of CA
25786 certificates, such that they are able to verify CA signatures
25787 out-of-the-box.
25788
25789 However, most other programs that can talk HTTPS---@command{wget},
25790 @command{git}, @command{w3m}, etc.---need to be told where CA
25791 certificates can be found.
25792
25793 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
25794 In Guix, this is done by adding a package that provides certificates
25795 to the @code{packages} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
25796 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). Guix includes one such package,
25797 @code{nss-certs}, which is a set of CA certificates provided as part of
25798 Mozilla's Network Security Services.
25799
25800 Note that it is @emph{not} part of @code{%base-packages}, so you need to
25801 explicitly add it. The @file{/etc/ssl/certs} directory, which is where
25802 most applications and libraries look for certificates by default, points
25803 to the certificates installed globally.
25804
25805 Unprivileged users, including users of Guix on a foreign distro,
25806 can also install their own certificate package in
25807 their profile. A number of environment variables need to be defined so
25808 that applications and libraries know where to find them. Namely, the
25809 OpenSSL library honors the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} and @code{SSL_CERT_FILE}
25810 variables. Some applications add their own environment variables; for
25811 instance, the Git version control system honors the certificate bundle
25812 pointed to by the @code{GIT_SSL_CAINFO} environment variable. Thus, you
25813 would typically run something like:
25814
25815 @example
25816 $ guix install nss-certs
25817 $ export SSL_CERT_DIR="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs"
25818 $ export SSL_CERT_FILE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
25819 $ export GIT_SSL_CAINFO="$SSL_CERT_FILE"
25820 @end example
25821
25822 As another example, R requires the @code{CURL_CA_BUNDLE} environment
25823 variable to point to a certificate bundle, so you would have to run
25824 something like this:
25825
25826 @example
25827 $ guix install nss-certs
25828 $ export CURL_CA_BUNDLE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
25829 @end example
25830
25831 For other applications you may want to look up the required environment
25832 variable in the relevant documentation.
25833
25834
25835 @node Name Service Switch
25836 @section Name Service Switch
25837
25838 @cindex name service switch
25839 @cindex NSS
25840 The @code{(gnu system nss)} module provides bindings to the
25841 configuration file of the libc @dfn{name service switch} or @dfn{NSS}
25842 (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
25843 Manual}). In a nutshell, the NSS is a mechanism that allows libc to be
25844 extended with new ``name'' lookup methods for system databases, which
25845 includes host names, service names, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name
25846 Service Switch, System Databases and Name Service Switch,, libc, The GNU
25847 C Library Reference Manual}).
25848
25849 The NSS configuration specifies, for each system database, which lookup
25850 method is to be used, and how the various methods are chained
25851 together---for instance, under which circumstances NSS should try the
25852 next method in the list. The NSS configuration is given in the
25853 @code{name-service-switch} field of @code{operating-system} declarations
25854 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{name-service-switch}}).
25855
25856 @cindex nss-mdns
25857 @cindex .local, host name lookup
25858 As an example, the declaration below configures the NSS to use the
25859 @uref{https://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, @code{nss-mdns}
25860 back-end}, which supports host name lookups over multicast DNS (mDNS)
25861 for host names ending in @code{.local}:
25862
25863 @lisp
25864 (name-service-switch
25865 (hosts (list %files ;first, check /etc/hosts
25866
25867 ;; If the above did not succeed, try
25868 ;; with 'mdns_minimal'.
25869 (name-service
25870 (name "mdns_minimal")
25871
25872 ;; 'mdns_minimal' is authoritative for
25873 ;; '.local'. When it returns "not found",
25874 ;; no need to try the next methods.
25875 (reaction (lookup-specification
25876 (not-found => return))))
25877
25878 ;; Then fall back to DNS.
25879 (name-service
25880 (name "dns"))
25881
25882 ;; Finally, try with the "full" 'mdns'.
25883 (name-service
25884 (name "mdns")))))
25885 @end lisp
25886
25887 Do not worry: the @code{%mdns-host-lookup-nss} variable (see below)
25888 contains this configuration, so you will not have to type it if all you
25889 want is to have @code{.local} host lookup working.
25890
25891 Note that, in this case, in addition to setting the
25892 @code{name-service-switch} of the @code{operating-system} declaration,
25893 you also need to use @code{avahi-service-type} (@pxref{Networking Services,
25894 @code{avahi-service-type}}), or @code{%desktop-services}, which includes it
25895 (@pxref{Desktop Services}). Doing this makes @code{nss-mdns} accessible
25896 to the name service cache daemon (@pxref{Base Services,
25897 @code{nscd-service}}).
25898
25899 For convenience, the following variables provide typical NSS
25900 configurations.
25901
25902 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-nss
25903 This is the default name service switch configuration, a
25904 @code{name-service-switch} object.
25905 @end defvr
25906
25907 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %mdns-host-lookup-nss
25908 This is the name service switch configuration with support for host name
25909 lookup over multicast DNS (mDNS) for host names ending in @code{.local}.
25910 @end defvr
25911
25912 The reference for name service switch configuration is given below. It
25913 is a direct mapping of the configuration file format of the C library , so
25914 please refer to the C library manual for more information (@pxref{NSS
25915 Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
25916 Compared to the configuration file format of libc NSS, it has the advantage
25917 not only of adding this warm parenthetic feel that we like, but also
25918 static checks: you will know about syntax errors and typos as soon as you
25919 run @command{guix system}.
25920
25921 @deftp {Data Type} name-service-switch
25922
25923 This is the data type representation the configuration of libc's name
25924 service switch (NSS). Each field below represents one of the supported
25925 system databases.
25926
25927 @table @code
25928 @item aliases
25929 @itemx ethers
25930 @itemx group
25931 @itemx gshadow
25932 @itemx hosts
25933 @itemx initgroups
25934 @itemx netgroup
25935 @itemx networks
25936 @itemx password
25937 @itemx public-key
25938 @itemx rpc
25939 @itemx services
25940 @itemx shadow
25941 The system databases handled by the NSS. Each of these fields must be a
25942 list of @code{<name-service>} objects (see below).
25943 @end table
25944 @end deftp
25945
25946 @deftp {Data Type} name-service
25947
25948 This is the data type representing an actual name service and the
25949 associated lookup action.
25950
25951 @table @code
25952 @item name
25953 A string denoting the name service (@pxref{Services in the NSS
25954 configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
25955
25956 Note that name services listed here must be visible to nscd. This is
25957 achieved by passing the @code{#:name-services} argument to
25958 @code{nscd-service} the list of packages providing the needed name
25959 services (@pxref{Base Services, @code{nscd-service}}).
25960
25961 @item reaction
25962 An action specified using the @code{lookup-specification} macro
25963 (@pxref{Actions in the NSS configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library
25964 Reference Manual}). For example:
25965
25966 @lisp
25967 (lookup-specification (unavailable => continue)
25968 (success => return))
25969 @end lisp
25970 @end table
25971 @end deftp
25972
25973 @node Initial RAM Disk
25974 @section Initial RAM Disk
25975
25976 @cindex initrd
25977 @cindex initial RAM disk
25978 For bootstrapping purposes, the Linux-Libre kernel is passed an
25979 @dfn{initial RAM disk}, or @dfn{initrd}. An initrd contains a temporary
25980 root file system as well as an initialization script. The latter is
25981 responsible for mounting the real root file system, and for loading any
25982 kernel modules that may be needed to achieve that.
25983
25984 The @code{initrd-modules} field of an @code{operating-system}
25985 declaration allows you to specify Linux-libre kernel modules that must
25986 be available in the initrd. In particular, this is where you would list
25987 modules needed to actually drive the hard disk where your root partition
25988 is---although the default value of @code{initrd-modules} should cover
25989 most use cases. For example, assuming you need the @code{megaraid_sas}
25990 module in addition to the default modules to be able to access your root
25991 file system, you would write:
25992
25993 @lisp
25994 (operating-system
25995 ;; @dots{}
25996 (initrd-modules (cons "megaraid_sas" %base-initrd-modules)))
25997 @end lisp
25998
25999 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-initrd-modules
26000 This is the list of kernel modules included in the initrd by default.
26001 @end defvr
26002
26003 Furthermore, if you need lower-level customization, the @code{initrd}
26004 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration allows
26005 you to specify which initrd you would like to use. The @code{(gnu
26006 system linux-initrd)} module provides three ways to build an initrd: the
26007 high-level @code{base-initrd} procedure and the low-level
26008 @code{raw-initrd} and @code{expression->initrd} procedures.
26009
26010 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is intended to cover most common uses.
26011 For example, if you want to add a bunch of kernel modules to be loaded
26012 at boot time, you can define the @code{initrd} field of the operating
26013 system declaration like this:
26014
26015 @lisp
26016 (initrd (lambda (file-systems . rest)
26017 ;; Create a standard initrd but set up networking
26018 ;; with the parameters QEMU expects by default.
26019 (apply base-initrd file-systems
26020 #:qemu-networking? #t
26021 rest)))
26022 @end lisp
26023
26024 The @code{base-initrd} procedure also handles common use cases that
26025 involves using the system as a QEMU guest, or as a ``live'' system with
26026 volatile root file system.
26027
26028 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is built from @code{raw-initrd} procedure.
26029 Unlike @code{base-initrd}, @code{raw-initrd} doesn't do anything high-level,
26030 such as trying to guess which kernel modules and packages should be included
26031 to the initrd. An example use of @code{raw-initrd} is when a user has
26032 a custom Linux kernel configuration and default kernel modules included by
26033 @code{base-initrd} are not available.
26034
26035 The initial RAM disk produced by @code{base-initrd} or @code{raw-initrd}
26036 honors several options passed on the Linux kernel command line
26037 (that is, arguments passed @i{via} the @code{linux} command of GRUB, or the
26038 @code{-append} option of QEMU), notably:
26039
26040 @table @code
26041 @item --load=@var{boot}
26042 Tell the initial RAM disk to load @var{boot}, a file containing a Scheme
26043 program, once it has mounted the root file system.
26044
26045 Guix uses this option to yield control to a boot program that runs the
26046 service activation programs and then spawns the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, the
26047 initialization system.
26048
26049 @item --root=@var{root}
26050 Mount @var{root} as the root file system. @var{root} can be a
26051 device name like @code{/dev/sda1}, a file system label, or a file system
26052 UUID.
26053
26054 @item --system=@var{system}
26055 Have @file{/run/booted-system} and @file{/run/current-system} point to
26056 @var{system}.
26057
26058 @item modprobe.blacklist=@var{modules}@dots{}
26059 @cindex module, black-listing
26060 @cindex black list, of kernel modules
26061 Instruct the initial RAM disk as well as the @command{modprobe} command
26062 (from the kmod package) to refuse to load @var{modules}. @var{modules}
26063 must be a comma-separated list of module names---e.g.,
26064 @code{usbkbd,9pnet}.
26065
26066 @item --repl
26067 Start a read-eval-print loop (REPL) from the initial RAM disk before it
26068 tries to load kernel modules and to mount the root file system. Our
26069 marketing team calls it @dfn{boot-to-Guile}. The Schemer in you will
26070 love it. @xref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
26071 Manual}, for more information on Guile's REPL.
26072
26073 @end table
26074
26075 Now that you know all the features that initial RAM disks produced by
26076 @code{base-initrd} and @code{raw-initrd} provide,
26077 here is how to use it and customize it further.
26078
26079 @cindex initrd
26080 @cindex initial RAM disk
26081 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} raw-initrd @var{file-systems} @
26082 [#:linux-modules '()] [#:mapped-devices '()] @
26083 [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
26084 [#:helper-packages '()] [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f]
26085 Return a derivation that builds a raw initrd. @var{file-systems} is
26086 a list of file systems to be mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to
26087 the root file system specified on the kernel command line via @code{--root}.
26088 @var{linux-modules} is a list of kernel modules to be loaded at boot time.
26089 @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device mappings to realize before
26090 @var{file-systems} are mounted (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
26091 @var{helper-packages} is a list of packages to be copied in the initrd. It may
26092 include @code{e2fsck/static} or other packages needed by the initrd to check
26093 the root file system.
26094
26095 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
26096 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
26097 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
26098 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
26099 intended keyboard layout.
26100
26101 When @var{qemu-networking?} is true, set up networking with the standard QEMU
26102 parameters. When @var{virtio?} is true, load additional modules so that the
26103 initrd can be used as a QEMU guest with para-virtualized I/O drivers.
26104
26105 When @var{volatile-root?} is true, the root file system is writable but any changes
26106 to it are lost.
26107 @end deffn
26108
26109 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} base-initrd @var{file-systems} @
26110 [#:mapped-devices '()] [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
26111 [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f] @
26112 [#:linux-modules '()]
26113 Return as a file-like object a generic initrd, with kernel
26114 modules taken from @var{linux}. @var{file-systems} is a list of file-systems to be
26115 mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to the root file system specified
26116 on the kernel command line via @code{--root}. @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device
26117 mappings to realize before @var{file-systems} are mounted.
26118
26119 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
26120 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
26121 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
26122 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
26123 intended keyboard layout.
26124
26125 @var{qemu-networking?} and @var{volatile-root?} behaves as in @code{raw-initrd}.
26126
26127 The initrd is automatically populated with all the kernel modules necessary
26128 for @var{file-systems} and for the given options. Additional kernel
26129 modules can be listed in @var{linux-modules}. They will be added to the initrd, and
26130 loaded at boot time in the order in which they appear.
26131 @end deffn
26132
26133 Needless to say, the initrds we produce and use embed a
26134 statically-linked Guile, and the initialization program is a Guile
26135 program. That gives a lot of flexibility. The
26136 @code{expression->initrd} procedure builds such an initrd, given the
26137 program to run in that initrd.
26138
26139 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} expression->initrd @var{exp} @
26140 [#:guile %guile-static-stripped] [#:name "guile-initrd"]
26141 Return as a file-like object a Linux initrd (a gzipped cpio archive)
26142 containing @var{guile} and that evaluates @var{exp}, a G-expression,
26143 upon booting. All the derivations referenced by @var{exp} are
26144 automatically copied to the initrd.
26145 @end deffn
26146
26147 @node Bootloader Configuration
26148 @section Bootloader Configuration
26149
26150 @cindex bootloader
26151 @cindex boot loader
26152
26153 The operating system supports multiple bootloaders. The bootloader is
26154 configured using @code{bootloader-configuration} declaration. All the
26155 fields of this structure are bootloader agnostic except for one field,
26156 @code{bootloader} that indicates the bootloader to be configured and
26157 installed.
26158
26159 Some of the bootloaders do not honor every field of
26160 @code{bootloader-configuration}. For instance, the extlinux
26161 bootloader does not support themes and thus ignores the @code{theme}
26162 field.
26163
26164 @deftp {Data Type} bootloader-configuration
26165 The type of a bootloader configuration declaration.
26166
26167 @table @asis
26168
26169 @item @code{bootloader}
26170 @cindex EFI, bootloader
26171 @cindex UEFI, bootloader
26172 @cindex BIOS, bootloader
26173 The bootloader to use, as a @code{bootloader} object. For now
26174 @code{grub-bootloader}, @code{grub-efi-bootloader},
26175 @code{extlinux-bootloader} and @code{u-boot-bootloader} are supported.
26176
26177 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
26178 @code{grub-efi-bootloader} allows to boot on modern systems using the
26179 @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI). This is what you should
26180 use if the installation image contains a @file{/sys/firmware/efi} directory
26181 when you boot it on your system.
26182
26183 @vindex grub-bootloader
26184 @code{grub-bootloader} allows you to boot in particular Intel-based machines
26185 in ``legacy'' BIOS mode.
26186
26187 @cindex ARM, bootloaders
26188 @cindex AArch64, bootloaders
26189 Available bootloaders are described in @code{(gnu bootloader @dots{})}
26190 modules. In particular, @code{(gnu bootloader u-boot)} contains definitions
26191 of bootloaders for a wide range of ARM and AArch64 systems, using the
26192 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot bootloader}.
26193
26194 @item @code{target}
26195 This is a string denoting the target onto which to install the
26196 bootloader.
26197
26198 The interpretation depends on the bootloader in question. For
26199 @code{grub-bootloader}, for example, it should be a device name understood by
26200 the bootloader @command{installer} command, such as @code{/dev/sda} or
26201 @code{(hd0)} (@pxref{Invoking grub-install,,, grub, GNU GRUB Manual}). For
26202 @code{grub-efi-bootloader}, it should be the mount point of the EFI file
26203 system, usually @file{/boot/efi}.
26204
26205 @item @code{menu-entries} (default: @code{()})
26206 A possibly empty list of @code{menu-entry} objects (see below), denoting
26207 entries to appear in the bootloader menu, in addition to the current
26208 system entry and the entry pointing to previous system generations.
26209
26210 @item @code{default-entry} (default: @code{0})
26211 The index of the default boot menu entry. Index 0 is for the entry of the
26212 current system.
26213
26214 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{5})
26215 The number of seconds to wait for keyboard input before booting. Set to
26216 0 to boot immediately, and to -1 to wait indefinitely.
26217
26218 @cindex keyboard layout, for the bootloader
26219 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
26220 If this is @code{#f}, the bootloader's menu (if any) uses the default keyboard
26221 layout, usually US@tie{}English (``qwerty'').
26222
26223 Otherwise, this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object (@pxref{Keyboard
26224 Layout}).
26225
26226 @quotation Note
26227 This option is currently ignored by bootloaders other than @code{grub} and
26228 @code{grub-efi}.
26229 @end quotation
26230
26231 @item @code{theme} (default: @var{#f})
26232 The bootloader theme object describing the theme to use. If no theme
26233 is provided, some bootloaders might use a default theme, that's true
26234 for GRUB.
26235
26236 @item @code{terminal-outputs} (default: @code{'(gfxterm)})
26237 The output terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
26238 symbols. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console}, @code{serial},
26239 @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{gfxterm}, @code{vga_text},
26240 @code{mda_text}, @code{morse}, and @code{pkmodem}. This field
26241 corresponds to the GRUB variable @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_OUTPUT} (@pxref{Simple
26242 configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
26243
26244 @item @code{terminal-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
26245 The input terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
26246 symbols. For GRUB, the default is the native platform terminal as
26247 determined at run-time. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console},
26248 @code{serial}, @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{at_keyboard}, and
26249 @code{usb_keyboard}. This field corresponds to the GRUB variable
26250 @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_INPUT} (@pxref{Simple configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB
26251 manual}).
26252
26253 @item @code{serial-unit} (default: @code{#f})
26254 The serial unit used by the bootloader, as an integer from 0 to 3.
26255 For GRUB, it is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses 0, which
26256 corresponds to COM1 (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
26257
26258 @item @code{serial-speed} (default: @code{#f})
26259 The speed of the serial interface, as an integer. For GRUB, the
26260 default value is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses
26261 9600@tie{}bps (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
26262 @end table
26263
26264 @end deftp
26265
26266 @cindex dual boot
26267 @cindex boot menu
26268 Should you want to list additional boot menu entries @i{via} the
26269 @code{menu-entries} field above, you will need to create them with the
26270 @code{menu-entry} form. For example, imagine you want to be able to
26271 boot another distro (hard to imagine!), you can define a menu entry
26272 along these lines:
26273
26274 @lisp
26275 (menu-entry
26276 (label "The Other Distro")
26277 (linux "/boot/old/vmlinux-2.6.32")
26278 (linux-arguments '("root=/dev/sda2"))
26279 (initrd "/boot/old/initrd"))
26280 @end lisp
26281
26282 Details below.
26283
26284 @deftp {Data Type} menu-entry
26285 The type of an entry in the bootloader menu.
26286
26287 @table @asis
26288
26289 @item @code{label}
26290 The label to show in the menu---e.g., @code{"GNU"}.
26291
26292 @item @code{linux}
26293 The Linux kernel image to boot, for example:
26294
26295 @lisp
26296 (file-append linux-libre "/bzImage")
26297 @end lisp
26298
26299 For GRUB, it is also possible to specify a device explicitly in the
26300 file path using GRUB's device naming convention (@pxref{Naming
26301 convention,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}), for example:
26302
26303 @example
26304 "(hd0,msdos1)/boot/vmlinuz"
26305 @end example
26306
26307 If the device is specified explicitly as above, then the @code{device}
26308 field is ignored entirely.
26309
26310 @item @code{linux-arguments} (default: @code{()})
26311 The list of extra Linux kernel command-line arguments---e.g.,
26312 @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
26313
26314 @item @code{initrd}
26315 A G-Expression or string denoting the file name of the initial RAM disk
26316 to use (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
26317 @item @code{device} (default: @code{#f})
26318 The device where the kernel and initrd are to be found---i.e., for GRUB,
26319 @dfn{root} for this menu entry (@pxref{root,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}).
26320
26321 This may be a file system label (a string), a file system UUID (a
26322 bytevector, @pxref{File Systems}), or @code{#f}, in which case
26323 the bootloader will search the device containing the file specified by
26324 the @code{linux} field (@pxref{search,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}). It
26325 must @emph{not} be an OS device name such as @file{/dev/sda1}.
26326
26327 @end table
26328 @end deftp
26329
26330 @cindex HDPI
26331 @cindex HiDPI
26332 @cindex resolution
26333 @c FIXME: Write documentation once it's stable.
26334 For now only GRUB has theme support. GRUB themes are created using
26335 the @code{grub-theme} form, which is not fully documented yet.
26336
26337 @deftp {Data Type} grub-theme
26338 Data type representing the configuration of the GRUB theme.
26339
26340 @table @asis
26341 @item @code{gfxmode} (default: @code{'("auto")})
26342 The GRUB @code{gfxmode} to set (a list of screen resolution strings, see
26343 @pxref{gfxmode,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}).
26344 @end table
26345 @end deftp
26346
26347 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
26348 This is the default GRUB theme used by the operating system if no
26349 @code{theme} field is specified in @code{bootloader-configuration}
26350 record.
26351
26352 It comes with a fancy background image displaying the GNU and Guix
26353 logos.
26354 @end defvr
26355
26356 For example, to override the default resolution, you may use something
26357 like
26358
26359 @lisp
26360 (bootloader
26361 (grub-configuration
26362 ;; @dots{}
26363 (theme (grub-theme
26364 (inherit %default-theme)
26365 (gfxmode '("1024x786x32" "auto"))))))
26366 @end lisp
26367
26368 @node Invoking guix system
26369 @section Invoking @code{guix system}
26370
26371 Once you have written an operating system declaration as seen in the
26372 previous section, it can be @dfn{instantiated} using the @command{guix
26373 system} command. The synopsis is:
26374
26375 @example
26376 guix system @var{options}@dots{} @var{action} @var{file}
26377 @end example
26378
26379 @var{file} must be the name of a file containing an
26380 @code{operating-system} declaration. @var{action} specifies how the
26381 operating system is instantiated. Currently the following values are
26382 supported:
26383
26384 @table @code
26385 @item search
26386 Display available service type definitions that match the given regular
26387 expressions, sorted by relevance:
26388
26389 @cindex HDPI
26390 @cindex HiDPI
26391 @cindex resolution
26392 @example
26393 $ guix system search console
26394 name: console-fonts
26395 location: gnu/services/base.scm:806:2
26396 extends: shepherd-root
26397 description: Install the given fonts on the specified ttys (fonts are per
26398 + virtual console on GNU/Linux). The value of this service is a list of
26399 + tty/font pairs. The font can be the name of a font provided by the `kbd'
26400 + package or any valid argument to `setfont', as in this example:
26401 +
26402 + '(("tty1" . "LatGrkCyr-8x16")
26403 + ("tty2" . (file-append
26404 + font-tamzen
26405 + "/share/kbd/consolefonts/TamzenForPowerline10x20.psf"))
26406 + ("tty3" . (file-append
26407 + font-terminus
26408 + "/share/consolefonts/ter-132n"))) ; for HDPI
26409 relevance: 9
26410
26411 name: mingetty
26412 location: gnu/services/base.scm:1190:2
26413 extends: shepherd-root
26414 description: Provide console login using the `mingetty' program.
26415 relevance: 2
26416
26417 name: login
26418 location: gnu/services/base.scm:860:2
26419 extends: pam
26420 description: Provide a console log-in service as specified by its
26421 + configuration value, a `login-configuration' object.
26422 relevance: 2
26423
26424 @dots{}
26425 @end example
26426
26427 As for @command{guix package --search}, the result is written in
26428 @code{recutils} format, which makes it easy to filter the output
26429 (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}).
26430
26431 @item reconfigure
26432 Build the operating system described in @var{file}, activate it, and
26433 switch to it@footnote{This action (and the related actions
26434 @code{switch-generation} and @code{roll-back}) are usable only on
26435 systems already running Guix System.}.
26436
26437 @quotation Note
26438 @c The paragraph below refers to the problem discussed at
26439 @c <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2014-08/msg00057.html>.
26440 It is highly recommended to run @command{guix pull} once before you run
26441 @command{guix system reconfigure} for the first time (@pxref{Invoking
26442 guix pull}). Failing to do that you would see an older version of Guix
26443 once @command{reconfigure} has completed.
26444 @end quotation
26445
26446 This effects all the configuration specified in @var{file}: user
26447 accounts, system services, global package list, setuid programs, etc.
26448 The command starts system services specified in @var{file} that are not
26449 currently running; if a service is currently running this command will
26450 arrange for it to be upgraded the next time it is stopped (e.g.@: by
26451 @code{herd stop X} or @code{herd restart X}).
26452
26453 This command creates a new generation whose number is one greater than
26454 the current generation (as reported by @command{guix system
26455 list-generations}). If that generation already exists, it will be
26456 overwritten. This behavior mirrors that of @command{guix package}
26457 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
26458
26459 It also adds a bootloader menu entry for the new OS configuration,
26460 ---unless @option{--no-bootloader} is passed. For GRUB, it moves
26461 entries for older configurations to a submenu, allowing you to choose
26462 an older system generation at boot time should you need it.
26463
26464 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
26465 Upon completion, the new system is deployed under
26466 @file{/run/current-system}. This directory contains @dfn{provenance
26467 meta-data}: the list of channels in use (@pxref{Channels}) and
26468 @var{file} itself, when available. This information is useful should
26469 you later want to inspect how this particular generation was built.
26470
26471 In fact, assuming @var{file} is self-contained, you can later rebuild
26472 generation @var{n} of your operating system with:
26473
26474 @example
26475 guix time-machine \
26476 -C /var/guix/profiles/system-@var{n}-link/channels.scm -- \
26477 system reconfigure \
26478 /var/guix/profiles/system-@var{n}-link/configuration.scm
26479 @end example
26480
26481 You can think of it as some sort of built-in version control! Your
26482 system is not just a binary artifact: @emph{it carries its own source}.
26483 @xref{Service Reference, @code{provenance-service-type}}, for more
26484 information on provenance tracking.
26485
26486 @item switch-generation
26487 @cindex generations
26488 Switch to an existing system generation. This action atomically
26489 switches the system profile to the specified system generation. It
26490 also rearranges the system's existing bootloader menu entries. It
26491 makes the menu entry for the specified system generation the default,
26492 and it moves the entries for the other generations to a submenu, if
26493 supported by the bootloader being used. The next time the system
26494 boots, it will use the specified system generation.
26495
26496 The bootloader itself is not being reinstalled when using this
26497 command. Thus, the installed bootloader is used with an updated
26498 configuration file.
26499
26500 The target generation can be specified explicitly by its generation
26501 number. For example, the following invocation would switch to system
26502 generation 7:
26503
26504 @example
26505 guix system switch-generation 7
26506 @end example
26507
26508 The target generation can also be specified relative to the current
26509 generation with the form @code{+N} or @code{-N}, where @code{+3} means
26510 ``3 generations ahead of the current generation,'' and @code{-1} means
26511 ``1 generation prior to the current generation.'' When specifying a
26512 negative value such as @code{-1}, you must precede it with @code{--} to
26513 prevent it from being parsed as an option. For example:
26514
26515 @example
26516 guix system switch-generation -- -1
26517 @end example
26518
26519 Currently, the effect of invoking this action is @emph{only} to switch
26520 the system profile to an existing generation and rearrange the
26521 bootloader menu entries. To actually start using the target system
26522 generation, you must reboot after running this action. In the future,
26523 it will be updated to do the same things as @command{reconfigure},
26524 like activating and deactivating services.
26525
26526 This action will fail if the specified generation does not exist.
26527
26528 @item roll-back
26529 @cindex rolling back
26530 Switch to the preceding system generation. The next time the system
26531 boots, it will use the preceding system generation. This is the inverse
26532 of @command{reconfigure}, and it is exactly the same as invoking
26533 @command{switch-generation} with an argument of @code{-1}.
26534
26535 Currently, as with @command{switch-generation}, you must reboot after
26536 running this action to actually start using the preceding system
26537 generation.
26538
26539 @item delete-generations
26540 @cindex deleting system generations
26541 @cindex saving space
26542 Delete system generations, making them candidates for garbage collection
26543 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}, for information on how to run the ``garbage
26544 collector'').
26545
26546 This works in the same way as @command{guix package --delete-generations}
26547 (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{--delete-generations}}). With no
26548 arguments, all system generations but the current one are deleted:
26549
26550 @example
26551 guix system delete-generations
26552 @end example
26553
26554 You can also select the generations you want to delete. The example below
26555 deletes all the system generations that are more than two month old:
26556
26557 @example
26558 guix system delete-generations 2m
26559 @end example
26560
26561 Running this command automatically reinstalls the bootloader with an updated
26562 list of menu entries---e.g., the ``old generations'' sub-menu in GRUB no
26563 longer lists the generations that have been deleted.
26564
26565 @item build
26566 Build the derivation of the operating system, which includes all the
26567 configuration files and programs needed to boot and run the system.
26568 This action does not actually install anything.
26569
26570 @item init
26571 Populate the given directory with all the files necessary to run the
26572 operating system specified in @var{file}. This is useful for first-time
26573 installations of Guix System. For instance:
26574
26575 @example
26576 guix system init my-os-config.scm /mnt
26577 @end example
26578
26579 copies to @file{/mnt} all the store items required by the configuration
26580 specified in @file{my-os-config.scm}. This includes configuration
26581 files, packages, and so on. It also creates other essential files
26582 needed for the system to operate correctly---e.g., the @file{/etc},
26583 @file{/var}, and @file{/run} directories, and the @file{/bin/sh} file.
26584
26585 This command also installs bootloader on the target specified in
26586 @file{my-os-config}, unless the @option{--no-bootloader} option was
26587 passed.
26588
26589 @item vm
26590 @cindex virtual machine
26591 @cindex VM
26592 @anchor{guix system vm}
26593 Build a virtual machine that contains the operating system declared in
26594 @var{file}, and return a script to run that virtual machine (VM).
26595
26596 @quotation Note
26597 The @code{vm} action and others below
26598 can use KVM support in the Linux-libre kernel. Specifically, if the
26599 machine has hardware virtualization support, the corresponding
26600 KVM kernel module should be loaded, and the @file{/dev/kvm} device node
26601 must exist and be readable and writable by the user and by the
26602 build users of the daemon (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
26603 @end quotation
26604
26605 Arguments given to the script are passed to QEMU as in the example
26606 below, which enables networking and requests 1@tie{}GiB of RAM for the
26607 emulated machine:
26608
26609 @example
26610 $ /gnu/store/@dots{}-run-vm.sh -m 1024 -smp 2 -net user,model=virtio-net-pci
26611 @end example
26612
26613 The VM shares its store with the host system.
26614
26615 Additional file systems can be shared between the host and the VM using
26616 the @code{--share} and @code{--expose} command-line options: the former
26617 specifies a directory to be shared with write access, while the latter
26618 provides read-only access to the shared directory.
26619
26620 The example below creates a VM in which the user's home directory is
26621 accessible read-only, and where the @file{/exchange} directory is a
26622 read-write mapping of @file{$HOME/tmp} on the host:
26623
26624 @example
26625 guix system vm my-config.scm \
26626 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
26627 @end example
26628
26629 On GNU/Linux, the default is to boot directly to the kernel; this has
26630 the advantage of requiring only a very tiny root disk image since the
26631 store of the host can then be mounted.
26632
26633 The @code{--full-boot} option forces a complete boot sequence, starting
26634 with the bootloader. This requires more disk space since a root image
26635 containing at least the kernel, initrd, and bootloader data files must
26636 be created. The @code{--image-size} option can be used to specify the
26637 size of the image.
26638
26639 @cindex System images, creation in various formats
26640 @cindex Creating system images in various formats
26641 @item vm-image
26642 @itemx disk-image
26643 @itemx docker-image
26644 Return a virtual machine, disk image, or Docker image of the operating
26645 system declared in @var{file} that stands alone. By default,
26646 @command{guix system} estimates the size of the image needed to store
26647 the system, but you can use the @option{--image-size} option to specify
26648 a value. Docker images are built to contain exactly what they need, so
26649 the @option{--image-size} option is ignored in the case of
26650 @code{docker-image}.
26651
26652 You can specify the root file system type by using the
26653 @option{--file-system-type} option. It defaults to @code{ext4}.
26654
26655 When using @code{vm-image}, the returned image is in qcow2 format, which
26656 the QEMU emulator can efficiently use. @xref{Running Guix in a VM},
26657 for more information on how to run the image in a virtual machine.
26658
26659 When using @code{disk-image}, a raw disk image is produced; it can be
26660 copied as is to a USB stick, for instance. Assuming @code{/dev/sdc} is
26661 the device corresponding to a USB stick, one can copy the image to it
26662 using the following command:
26663
26664 @example
26665 # dd if=$(guix system disk-image my-os.scm) of=/dev/sdc
26666 @end example
26667
26668 When using @code{docker-image}, a Docker image is produced. Guix builds
26669 the image from scratch, not from a pre-existing Docker base image. As a
26670 result, it contains @emph{exactly} what you define in the operating
26671 system configuration file. You can then load the image and launch a
26672 Docker container using commands like the following:
26673
26674 @example
26675 image_id="`docker load < guix-system-docker-image.tar.gz`"
26676 container_id="`docker create $image_id`"
26677 docker start $container_id
26678 @end example
26679
26680 This command starts a new Docker container from the specified image. It
26681 will boot the Guix system in the usual manner, which means it will
26682 start any services you have defined in the operating system
26683 configuration. You can get an interactive shell running in the container
26684 using @command{docker exec}:
26685
26686 @example
26687 docker exec -ti $container_id /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
26688 @end example
26689
26690 Depending on what you run in the Docker container, it
26691 may be necessary to give the container additional permissions. For
26692 example, if you intend to build software using Guix inside of the Docker
26693 container, you may need to pass the @option{--privileged} option to
26694 @code{docker create}.
26695
26696 @item container
26697 Return a script to run the operating system declared in @var{file}
26698 within a container. Containers are a set of lightweight isolation
26699 mechanisms provided by the kernel Linux-libre. Containers are
26700 substantially less resource-demanding than full virtual machines since
26701 the kernel, shared objects, and other resources can be shared with the
26702 host system; this also means they provide thinner isolation.
26703
26704 Currently, the script must be run as root in order to support more than
26705 a single user and group. The container shares its store with the host
26706 system.
26707
26708 As with the @code{vm} action (@pxref{guix system vm}), additional file
26709 systems to be shared between the host and container can be specified
26710 using the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} options:
26711
26712 @example
26713 guix system container my-config.scm \
26714 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
26715 @end example
26716
26717 @quotation Note
26718 This option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
26719 @end quotation
26720
26721 @end table
26722
26723 @var{options} can contain any of the common build options (@pxref{Common
26724 Build Options}). In addition, @var{options} can contain one of the
26725 following:
26726
26727 @table @option
26728 @item --expression=@var{expr}
26729 @itemx -e @var{expr}
26730 Consider the operating-system @var{expr} evaluates to.
26731 This is an alternative to specifying a file which evaluates to an
26732 operating system.
26733 This is used to generate the Guix system installer @pxref{Building the
26734 Installation Image}).
26735
26736 @item --system=@var{system}
26737 @itemx -s @var{system}
26738 Attempt to build for @var{system} instead of the host system type.
26739 This works as per @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
26740
26741 @item --derivation
26742 @itemx -d
26743 Return the derivation file name of the given operating system without
26744 building anything.
26745
26746 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
26747 @item --save-provenance
26748 As discussed above, @command{guix system init} and @command{guix system
26749 reconfigure} always save provenance information @i{via} a dedicated
26750 service (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{provenance-service-type}}).
26751 However, other commands don't do that by default. If you wish to, say,
26752 create a virtual machine image that contains provenance information, you
26753 can run:
26754
26755 @example
26756 guix system vm-image --save-provenance config.scm
26757 @end example
26758
26759 That way, the resulting image will effectively ``embed its own source''
26760 in the form of meta-data in @file{/run/current-system}. With that
26761 information, one can rebuild the image to make sure it really contains
26762 what it pretends to contain; or they could use that to derive a variant
26763 of the image.
26764
26765 @item --file-system-type=@var{type}
26766 @itemx -t @var{type}
26767 For the @code{disk-image} action, create a file system of the given
26768 @var{type} on the image.
26769
26770 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} uses @code{ext4}.
26771
26772 @cindex ISO-9660 format
26773 @cindex CD image format
26774 @cindex DVD image format
26775 @code{--file-system-type=iso9660} produces an ISO-9660 image, suitable
26776 for burning on CDs and DVDs.
26777
26778 @item --image-size=@var{size}
26779 For the @code{vm-image} and @code{disk-image} actions, create an image
26780 of the given @var{size}. @var{size} may be a number of bytes, or it may
26781 include a unit as a suffix (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,,
26782 coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
26783
26784 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} computes an estimate
26785 of the image size as a function of the size of the system declared in
26786 @var{file}.
26787
26788 @item --network
26789 @itemx -N
26790 For the @code{container} action, allow containers to access the host network,
26791 that is, do not create a network namespace.
26792
26793 @item --root=@var{file}
26794 @itemx -r @var{file}
26795 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
26796 collector root.
26797
26798 @item --skip-checks
26799 Skip pre-installation safety checks.
26800
26801 By default, @command{guix system init} and @command{guix system
26802 reconfigure} perform safety checks: they make sure the file systems that
26803 appear in the @code{operating-system} declaration actually exist
26804 (@pxref{File Systems}), and that any Linux kernel modules that may be
26805 needed at boot time are listed in @code{initrd-modules} (@pxref{Initial
26806 RAM Disk}). Passing this option skips these tests altogether.
26807
26808 @cindex on-error
26809 @cindex on-error strategy
26810 @cindex error strategy
26811 @item --on-error=@var{strategy}
26812 Apply @var{strategy} when an error occurs when reading @var{file}.
26813 @var{strategy} may be one of the following:
26814
26815 @table @code
26816 @item nothing-special
26817 Report the error concisely and exit. This is the default strategy.
26818
26819 @item backtrace
26820 Likewise, but also display a backtrace.
26821
26822 @item debug
26823 Report the error and enter Guile's debugger. From there, you can run
26824 commands such as @code{,bt} to get a backtrace, @code{,locals} to
26825 display local variable values, and more generally inspect the state of the
26826 program. @xref{Debug Commands,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
26827 a list of available debugging commands.
26828 @end table
26829 @end table
26830
26831 Once you have built, configured, re-configured, and re-re-configured
26832 your Guix installation, you may find it useful to list the operating
26833 system generations available on disk---and that you can choose from the
26834 bootloader boot menu:
26835
26836 @table @code
26837
26838 @item describe
26839 Describe the current system generation: its file name, the kernel and
26840 bootloader used, etc., as well as provenance information when available.
26841
26842 @item list-generations
26843 List a summary of each generation of the operating system available on
26844 disk, in a human-readable way. This is similar to the
26845 @option{--list-generations} option of @command{guix package}
26846 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
26847
26848 Optionally, one can specify a pattern, with the same syntax that is used
26849 in @command{guix package --list-generations}, to restrict the list of
26850 generations displayed. For instance, the following command displays
26851 generations that are up to 10 days old:
26852
26853 @example
26854 $ guix system list-generations 10d
26855 @end example
26856
26857 @end table
26858
26859 The @command{guix system} command has even more to offer! The following
26860 sub-commands allow you to visualize how your system services relate to
26861 each other:
26862
26863 @anchor{system-extension-graph}
26864 @table @code
26865
26866 @item extension-graph
26867 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{service
26868 extension graph} of the operating system defined in @var{file}
26869 (@pxref{Service Composition}, for more information on service
26870 extensions.)
26871
26872 The command:
26873
26874 @example
26875 $ guix system extension-graph @var{file} | dot -Tpdf > services.pdf
26876 @end example
26877
26878 produces a PDF file showing the extension relations among services.
26879
26880 @anchor{system-shepherd-graph}
26881 @item shepherd-graph
26882 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{dependency
26883 graph} of shepherd services of the operating system defined in
26884 @var{file}. @xref{Shepherd Services}, for more information and for an
26885 example graph.
26886
26887 @end table
26888
26889 @node Invoking guix deploy
26890 @section Invoking @code{guix deploy}
26891
26892 We've already seen @code{operating-system} declarations used to manage a
26893 machine's configuration locally. Suppose you need to configure multiple
26894 machines, though---perhaps you're managing a service on the web that's
26895 comprised of several servers. @command{guix deploy} enables you to use those
26896 same @code{operating-system} declarations to manage multiple remote hosts at
26897 once as a logical ``deployment''.
26898
26899 @quotation Note
26900 The functionality described in this section is still under development
26901 and is subject to change. Get in touch with us on
26902 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}!
26903 @end quotation
26904
26905 @example
26906 guix deploy @var{file}
26907 @end example
26908
26909 Such an invocation will deploy the machines that the code within @var{file}
26910 evaluates to. As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this:
26911
26912 @lisp
26913 ;; This is a Guix deployment of a "bare bones" setup, with
26914 ;; no X11 display server, to a machine with an SSH daemon
26915 ;; listening on localhost:2222. A configuration such as this
26916 ;; may be appropriate for virtual machine with ports
26917 ;; forwarded to the host's loopback interface.
26918
26919 (use-service-modules networking ssh)
26920 (use-package-modules bootloaders)
26921
26922 (define %system
26923 (operating-system
26924 (host-name "gnu-deployed")
26925 (timezone "Etc/UTC")
26926 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
26927 (bootloader grub-bootloader)
26928 (target "/dev/vda")
26929 (terminal-outputs '(console))))
26930 (file-systems (cons (file-system
26931 (mount-point "/")
26932 (device "/dev/vda1")
26933 (type "ext4"))
26934 %base-file-systems))
26935 (services
26936 (append (list (service dhcp-client-service-type)
26937 (service openssh-service-type
26938 (openssh-configuration
26939 (permit-root-login #t)
26940 (allow-empty-passwords? #t))))
26941 %base-services))))
26942
26943 (list (machine
26944 (operating-system %system)
26945 (environment managed-host-environment-type)
26946 (configuration (machine-ssh-configuration
26947 (host-name "localhost")
26948 (system "x86_64-linux")
26949 (user "alice")
26950 (identity "./id_rsa")
26951 (port 2222)))))
26952 @end lisp
26953
26954 The file should evaluate to a list of @var{machine} objects. This example,
26955 upon being deployed, will create a new generation on the remote system
26956 realizing the @code{operating-system} declaration @var{%system}.
26957 @var{environment} and @var{configuration} specify how the machine should be
26958 provisioned---that is, how the computing resources should be created and
26959 managed. The above example does not create any resources, as a
26960 @code{'managed-host} is a machine that is already running the Guix system and
26961 available over the network. This is a particularly simple case; a more
26962 complex deployment may involve, for example, starting virtual machines through
26963 a Virtual Private Server (VPS) provider. In such a case, a different
26964 @var{environment} type would be used.
26965
26966 Do note that you first need to generate a key pair on the coordinator machine
26967 to allow the daemon to export signed archives of files from the store
26968 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
26969
26970 @example
26971 # guix archive --generate-key
26972 @end example
26973
26974 @noindent
26975 Each target machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that it
26976 accepts store items it receives from the coordinator:
26977
26978 @example
26979 # guix archive --authorize < coordinator-public-key.txt
26980 @end example
26981
26982 @code{user}, in this example, specifies the name of the user account to log in
26983 as to perform the deployment. Its default value is @code{root}, but root
26984 login over SSH may be forbidden in some cases. To work around this,
26985 @command{guix deploy} can log in as an unprivileged user and employ
26986 @code{sudo} to escalate privileges. This will only work if @code{sudo} is
26987 currently installed on the remote and can be invoked non-interactively as
26988 @code{user}. That is: the line in @code{sudoers} granting @code{user} the
26989 ability to use @code{sudo} must contain the @code{NOPASSWD} tag.
26990
26991 @deftp {Data Type} machine
26992 This is the data type representing a single machine in a heterogeneous Guix
26993 deployment.
26994
26995 @table @asis
26996 @item @code{operating-system}
26997 The object of the operating system configuration to deploy.
26998
26999 @item @code{environment}
27000 An @code{environment-type} describing how the machine should be provisioned.
27001
27002 @item @code{configuration} (default: @code{#f})
27003 An object describing the configuration for the machine's @code{environment}.
27004 If the @code{environment} has a default configuration, @code{#f} may be used.
27005 If @code{#f} is used for an environment with no default configuration,
27006 however, an error will be thrown.
27007 @end table
27008 @end deftp
27009
27010 @deftp {Data Type} machine-ssh-configuration
27011 This is the data type representing the SSH client parameters for a machine
27012 with an @code{environment} of @code{managed-host-environment-type}.
27013
27014 @table @asis
27015 @item @code{host-name}
27016 @item @code{build-locally?} (default: @code{#t})
27017 If false, system derivations will be built on the machine being deployed to.
27018 @item @code{system}
27019 The system type describing the architecture of the machine being deployed
27020 to---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
27021 @item @code{authorize?} (default: @code{#t})
27022 If true, the coordinator's signing key will be added to the remote's ACL
27023 keyring.
27024 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
27025 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"root"})
27026 @item @code{identity} (default: @code{#f})
27027 If specified, the path to the SSH private key to use to authenticate with the
27028 remote host.
27029
27030 @item @code{host-key} (default: @code{#f})
27031 This should be the SSH host key of the machine, which looks like this:
27032
27033 @example
27034 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nz@dots{} root@@example.org
27035 @end example
27036
27037 When @code{host-key} is @code{#f}, the server is authenticated against
27038 the @file{~/.ssh/known_hosts} file, just like the OpenSSH @command{ssh}
27039 client does.
27040
27041 @end table
27042 @end deftp
27043
27044 @deftp {Data Type} digital-ocean-configuration
27045 This is the data type describing the Droplet that should be created for a
27046 machine with an @code{environment} of @code{digital-ocean-environment-type}.
27047
27048 @table @asis
27049 @item @code{ssh-key}
27050 The path to the SSH private key to use to authenticate with the remote
27051 host. In the future, this field may not exist.
27052 @item @code{tags}
27053 A list of string ``tags'' that uniquely identify the machine. Must be given
27054 such that no two machines in the deployment have the same set of tags.
27055 @item @code{region}
27056 A Digital Ocean region slug, such as @code{"nyc3"}.
27057 @item @code{size}
27058 A Digital Ocean size slug, such as @code{"s-1vcpu-1gb"}
27059 @item @code{enable-ipv6?}
27060 Whether or not the droplet should be created with IPv6 networking.
27061 @end table
27062 @end deftp
27063
27064 @node Running Guix in a VM
27065 @section Running Guix in a Virtual Machine
27066
27067 @cindex virtual machine
27068 To run Guix in a virtual machine (VM), one can use the pre-built Guix VM image
27069 distributed at
27070 @url{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-vm-image-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.xz}.
27071 This image is a compressed image in QCOW format. You will first need to
27072 decompress with @command{xz -d}, and then you can pass it to an emulator such
27073 as QEMU (see below for details).
27074
27075 This image boots the Xfce graphical environment and it contains some
27076 commonly-used tools. You can install more software in the image by running
27077 @command{guix package} in a terminal (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). You can
27078 also reconfigure the system based on its initial configuration file available
27079 as @file{/etc/config.scm} (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
27080
27081 Instead of using this pre-built image, one can also build their own virtual
27082 machine image using @command{guix system vm-image} (@pxref{Invoking guix
27083 system}). The returned image is in qcow2 format, which the
27084 @uref{https://qemu.org/, QEMU emulator} can efficiently use.
27085
27086 @cindex QEMU
27087 If you built your own image, you must copy it out of the store
27088 (@pxref{The Store}) and give yourself permission to write to the copy
27089 before you can use it. When invoking QEMU, you must choose a system
27090 emulator that is suitable for your hardware platform. Here is a minimal
27091 QEMU invocation that will boot the result of @command{guix system
27092 vm-image} on x86_64 hardware:
27093
27094 @example
27095 $ qemu-system-x86_64 \
27096 -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci \
27097 -enable-kvm -m 1024 \
27098 -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd \
27099 -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
27100 @end example
27101
27102 Here is what each of these options means:
27103
27104 @table @code
27105 @item qemu-system-x86_64
27106 This specifies the hardware platform to emulate. This should match the
27107 host.
27108
27109 @item -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci
27110 Enable the unprivileged user-mode network stack. The guest OS can
27111 access the host but not vice versa. This is the simplest way to get the
27112 guest OS online. @code{model} specifies which network device to emulate:
27113 @code{virtio-net-pci} is a special device made for virtualized operating
27114 systems and recommended for most uses. Assuming your hardware platform is
27115 x86_64, you can get a list of available NIC models by running
27116 @command{qemu-system-x86_64 -nic model=help}.
27117
27118 @item -enable-kvm
27119 If your system has hardware virtualization extensions, enabling the
27120 virtual machine support (KVM) of the Linux kernel will make things run
27121 faster.
27122
27123 @c To run Xfce + 'guix pull', we need at least 1G of RAM.
27124 @item -m 1024
27125 RAM available to the guest OS, in mebibytes. Defaults to 128@tie{}MiB,
27126 which may be insufficient for some operations.
27127
27128 @item -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd
27129 Create a @code{virtio-blk} drive called ``myhd''. @code{virtio-blk} is a
27130 ``paravirtualization'' mechanism for block devices that allows QEMU to achieve
27131 better performance than if it were emulating a complete disk drive. See the
27132 QEMU and KVM documentation for more info.
27133
27134 @item -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
27135 Use our QCOW image, the @file{/tmp/qemu-image} file, as the backing store the
27136 the ``myhd'' drive.
27137 @end table
27138
27139 The default @command{run-vm.sh} script that is returned by an invocation of
27140 @command{guix system vm} does not add a @command{-nic user} flag by default.
27141 To get network access from within the vm add the @code{(dhcp-client-service)}
27142 to your system definition and start the VM using
27143 @command{`guix system vm config.scm` -nic user}. An important caveat of using
27144 @command{-nic user} for networking is that @command{ping} will not work, because
27145 it uses the ICMP protocol. You'll have to use a different command to check for
27146 network connectivity, for example @command{guix download}.
27147
27148 @subsection Connecting Through SSH
27149
27150 @cindex SSH
27151 @cindex SSH server
27152 To enable SSH inside a VM you need to add an SSH server like
27153 @code{openssh-service-type} to your VM (@pxref{Networking Services,
27154 @code{openssh-service-type}}). In addition you need to forward the SSH port,
27155 22 by default, to the host. You can do this with
27156
27157 @example
27158 `guix system vm config.scm` -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci,hostfwd=tcp::10022-:22
27159 @end example
27160
27161 To connect to the VM you can run
27162
27163 @example
27164 ssh -o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null -o StrictHostKeyChecking=no -p 10022
27165 @end example
27166
27167 The @command{-p} tells @command{ssh} the port you want to connect to.
27168 @command{-o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null} prevents @command{ssh} from complaining
27169 every time you modify your @command{config.scm} file and the
27170 @command{-o StrictHostKeyChecking=no} prevents you from having to allow a
27171 connection to an unknown host every time you connect.
27172
27173 @subsection Using @command{virt-viewer} with Spice
27174
27175 As an alternative to the default @command{qemu} graphical client you can
27176 use the @command{remote-viewer} from the @command{virt-viewer} package. To
27177 connect pass the @command{-spice port=5930,disable-ticketing} flag to
27178 @command{qemu}. See previous section for further information on how to do this.
27179
27180 Spice also allows you to do some nice stuff like share your clipboard with your
27181 VM. To enable that you'll also have to pass the following flags to @command{qemu}:
27182
27183 @example
27184 -device virtio-serial-pci,id=virtio-serial0,max_ports=16,bus=pci.0,addr=0x5
27185 -chardev spicevmc,name=vdagent,id=vdagent
27186 -device virtserialport,nr=1,bus=virtio-serial0.0,chardev=vdagent,
27187 name=com.redhat.spice.0
27188 @end example
27189
27190 You'll also need to add the @pxref{Miscellaneous Services, Spice service}.
27191
27192 @node Defining Services
27193 @section Defining Services
27194
27195 The previous sections show the available services and how one can combine
27196 them in an @code{operating-system} declaration. But how do we define
27197 them in the first place? And what is a service anyway?
27198
27199 @menu
27200 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
27201 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
27202 * Service Reference:: API reference.
27203 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
27204 @end menu
27205
27206 @node Service Composition
27207 @subsection Service Composition
27208
27209 @cindex services
27210 @cindex daemons
27211 Here we define a @dfn{service} as, broadly, something that extends the
27212 functionality of the operating system. Often a service is a process---a
27213 @dfn{daemon}---started when the system boots: a secure shell server, a
27214 Web server, the Guix build daemon, etc. Sometimes a service is a daemon
27215 whose execution can be triggered by another daemon---e.g., an FTP server
27216 started by @command{inetd} or a D-Bus service activated by
27217 @command{dbus-daemon}. Occasionally, a service does not map to a
27218 daemon. For instance, the ``account'' service collects user accounts
27219 and makes sure they exist when the system runs; the ``udev'' service
27220 collects device management rules and makes them available to the eudev
27221 daemon; the @file{/etc} service populates the @file{/etc} directory
27222 of the system.
27223
27224 @cindex service extensions
27225 Guix system services are connected by @dfn{extensions}. For instance, the
27226 secure shell service @emph{extends} the Shepherd---the
27227 initialization system, running as PID@tie{}1---by giving it the command
27228 lines to start and stop the secure shell daemon (@pxref{Networking
27229 Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}); the UPower service extends the D-Bus
27230 service by passing it its @file{.service} specification, and extends the
27231 udev service by passing it device management rules (@pxref{Desktop
27232 Services, @code{upower-service}}); the Guix daemon service extends the
27233 Shepherd by passing it the command lines to start and stop the daemon,
27234 and extends the account service by passing it a list of required build
27235 user accounts (@pxref{Base Services}).
27236
27237 All in all, services and their ``extends'' relations form a directed
27238 acyclic graph (DAG). If we represent services as boxes and extensions
27239 as arrows, a typical system might provide something like this:
27240
27241 @image{images/service-graph,,5in,Typical service extension graph.}
27242
27243 @cindex system service
27244 At the bottom, we see the @dfn{system service}, which produces the
27245 directory containing everything to run and boot the system, as returned
27246 by the @command{guix system build} command. @xref{Service Reference},
27247 to learn about the other service types shown here.
27248 @xref{system-extension-graph, the @command{guix system extension-graph}
27249 command}, for information on how to generate this representation for a
27250 particular operating system definition.
27251
27252 @cindex service types
27253 Technically, developers can define @dfn{service types} to express these
27254 relations. There can be any number of services of a given type on the
27255 system---for instance, a system running two instances of the GNU secure
27256 shell server (lsh) has two instances of @code{lsh-service-type}, with
27257 different parameters.
27258
27259 The following section describes the programming interface for service
27260 types and services.
27261
27262 @node Service Types and Services
27263 @subsection Service Types and Services
27264
27265 A @dfn{service type} is a node in the DAG described above. Let us start
27266 with a simple example, the service type for the Guix build daemon
27267 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}):
27268
27269 @lisp
27270 (define guix-service-type
27271 (service-type
27272 (name 'guix)
27273 (extensions
27274 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type guix-shepherd-service)
27275 (service-extension account-service-type guix-accounts)
27276 (service-extension activation-service-type guix-activation)))
27277 (default-value (guix-configuration))))
27278 @end lisp
27279
27280 @noindent
27281 It defines three things:
27282
27283 @enumerate
27284 @item
27285 A name, whose sole purpose is to make inspection and debugging easier.
27286
27287 @item
27288 A list of @dfn{service extensions}, where each extension designates the
27289 target service type and a procedure that, given the parameters of the
27290 service, returns a list of objects to extend the service of that type.
27291
27292 Every service type has at least one service extension. The only
27293 exception is the @dfn{boot service type}, which is the ultimate service.
27294
27295 @item
27296 Optionally, a default value for instances of this type.
27297 @end enumerate
27298
27299 In this example, @code{guix-service-type} extends three services:
27300
27301 @table @code
27302 @item shepherd-root-service-type
27303 The @code{guix-shepherd-service} procedure defines how the Shepherd
27304 service is extended. Namely, it returns a @code{<shepherd-service>}
27305 object that defines how @command{guix-daemon} is started and stopped
27306 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
27307
27308 @item account-service-type
27309 This extension for this service is computed by @code{guix-accounts},
27310 which returns a list of @code{user-group} and @code{user-account}
27311 objects representing the build user accounts (@pxref{Invoking
27312 guix-daemon}).
27313
27314 @item activation-service-type
27315 Here @code{guix-activation} is a procedure that returns a gexp, which is
27316 a code snippet to run at ``activation time''---e.g., when the service is
27317 booted.
27318 @end table
27319
27320 A service of this type is instantiated like this:
27321
27322 @lisp
27323 (service guix-service-type
27324 (guix-configuration
27325 (build-accounts 5)
27326 (use-substitutes? #f)))
27327 @end lisp
27328
27329 The second argument to the @code{service} form is a value representing
27330 the parameters of this specific service instance.
27331 @xref{guix-configuration-type, @code{guix-configuration}}, for
27332 information about the @code{guix-configuration} data type. When the
27333 value is omitted, the default value specified by
27334 @code{guix-service-type} is used:
27335
27336 @lisp
27337 (service guix-service-type)
27338 @end lisp
27339
27340 @code{guix-service-type} is quite simple because it extends other
27341 services but is not extensible itself.
27342
27343 @c @subsubsubsection Extensible Service Types
27344
27345 The service type for an @emph{extensible} service looks like this:
27346
27347 @lisp
27348 (define udev-service-type
27349 (service-type (name 'udev)
27350 (extensions
27351 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type
27352 udev-shepherd-service)))
27353
27354 (compose concatenate) ;concatenate the list of rules
27355 (extend (lambda (config rules)
27356 (match config
27357 (($ <udev-configuration> udev initial-rules)
27358 (udev-configuration
27359 (udev udev) ;the udev package to use
27360 (rules (append initial-rules rules)))))))))
27361 @end lisp
27362
27363 This is the service type for the
27364 @uref{https://wiki.gentoo.org/wiki/Project:Eudev, eudev device
27365 management daemon}. Compared to the previous example, in addition to an
27366 extension of @code{shepherd-root-service-type}, we see two new fields:
27367
27368 @table @code
27369 @item compose
27370 This is the procedure to @dfn{compose} the list of extensions to
27371 services of this type.
27372
27373 Services can extend the udev service by passing it lists of rules; we
27374 compose those extensions simply by concatenating them.
27375
27376 @item extend
27377 This procedure defines how the value of the service is @dfn{extended} with
27378 the composition of the extensions.
27379
27380 Udev extensions are composed into a list of rules, but the udev service
27381 value is itself a @code{<udev-configuration>} record. So here, we
27382 extend that record by appending the list of rules it contains to the
27383 list of contributed rules.
27384
27385 @item description
27386 This is a string giving an overview of the service type. The string can
27387 contain Texinfo markup (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). The
27388 @command{guix system search} command searches these strings and displays
27389 them (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
27390 @end table
27391
27392 There can be only one instance of an extensible service type such as
27393 @code{udev-service-type}. If there were more, the
27394 @code{service-extension} specifications would be ambiguous.
27395
27396 Still here? The next section provides a reference of the programming
27397 interface for services.
27398
27399 @node Service Reference
27400 @subsection Service Reference
27401
27402 We have seen an overview of service types (@pxref{Service Types and
27403 Services}). This section provides a reference on how to manipulate
27404 services and service types. This interface is provided by the
27405 @code{(gnu services)} module.
27406
27407 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service @var{type} [@var{value}]
27408 Return a new service of @var{type}, a @code{<service-type>} object (see
27409 below.) @var{value} can be any object; it represents the parameters of
27410 this particular service instance.
27411
27412 When @var{value} is omitted, the default value specified by @var{type}
27413 is used; if @var{type} does not specify a default value, an error is
27414 raised.
27415
27416 For instance, this:
27417
27418 @lisp
27419 (service openssh-service-type)
27420 @end lisp
27421
27422 @noindent
27423 is equivalent to this:
27424
27425 @lisp
27426 (service openssh-service-type
27427 (openssh-configuration))
27428 @end lisp
27429
27430 In both cases the result is an instance of @code{openssh-service-type}
27431 with the default configuration.
27432 @end deffn
27433
27434 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service? @var{obj}
27435 Return true if @var{obj} is a service.
27436 @end deffn
27437
27438 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-kind @var{service}
27439 Return the type of @var{service}---i.e., a @code{<service-type>} object.
27440 @end deffn
27441
27442 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-value @var{service}
27443 Return the value associated with @var{service}. It represents its
27444 parameters.
27445 @end deffn
27446
27447 Here is an example of how a service is created and manipulated:
27448
27449 @lisp
27450 (define s
27451 (service nginx-service-type
27452 (nginx-configuration
27453 (nginx nginx)
27454 (log-directory log-directory)
27455 (run-directory run-directory)
27456 (file config-file))))
27457
27458 (service? s)
27459 @result{} #t
27460
27461 (eq? (service-kind s) nginx-service-type)
27462 @result{} #t
27463 @end lisp
27464
27465 The @code{modify-services} form provides a handy way to change the
27466 parameters of some of the services of a list such as
27467 @code{%base-services} (@pxref{Base Services, @code{%base-services}}). It
27468 evaluates to a list of services. Of course, you could always use
27469 standard list combinators such as @code{map} and @code{fold} to do that
27470 (@pxref{SRFI-1, List Library,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual});
27471 @code{modify-services} simply provides a more concise form for this
27472 common pattern.
27473
27474 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-services @var{services} @
27475 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body}) @dots{}
27476
27477 Modify the services listed in @var{services} according to the given
27478 clauses. Each clause has the form:
27479
27480 @example
27481 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body})
27482 @end example
27483
27484 where @var{type} is a service type---e.g.,
27485 @code{guix-service-type}---and @var{variable} is an identifier that is
27486 bound within the @var{body} to the service parameters---e.g., a
27487 @code{guix-configuration} instance---of the original service of that
27488 @var{type}.
27489
27490 The @var{body} should evaluate to the new service parameters, which will
27491 be used to configure the new service. This new service will replace the
27492 original in the resulting list. Because a service's service parameters
27493 are created using @code{define-record-type*}, you can write a succinct
27494 @var{body} that evaluates to the new service parameters by using the
27495 @code{inherit} feature that @code{define-record-type*} provides.
27496
27497 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for example usage.
27498
27499 @end deffn
27500
27501 Next comes the programming interface for service types. This is
27502 something you want to know when writing new service definitions, but not
27503 necessarily when simply looking for ways to customize your
27504 @code{operating-system} declaration.
27505
27506 @deftp {Data Type} service-type
27507 @cindex service type
27508 This is the representation of a @dfn{service type} (@pxref{Service Types
27509 and Services}).
27510
27511 @table @asis
27512 @item @code{name}
27513 This is a symbol, used only to simplify inspection and debugging.
27514
27515 @item @code{extensions}
27516 A non-empty list of @code{<service-extension>} objects (see below).
27517
27518 @item @code{compose} (default: @code{#f})
27519 If this is @code{#f}, then the service type denotes services that cannot
27520 be extended---i.e., services that do not receive ``values'' from other
27521 services.
27522
27523 Otherwise, it must be a one-argument procedure. The procedure is called
27524 by @code{fold-services} and is passed a list of values collected from
27525 extensions. It may return any single value.
27526
27527 @item @code{extend} (default: @code{#f})
27528 If this is @code{#f}, services of this type cannot be extended.
27529
27530 Otherwise, it must be a two-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
27531 calls it, passing it the initial value of the service as the first
27532 argument and the result of applying @code{compose} to the extension
27533 values as the second argument. It must return a value that is a valid
27534 parameter value for the service instance.
27535 @end table
27536
27537 @xref{Service Types and Services}, for examples.
27538 @end deftp
27539
27540 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension @var{target-type} @
27541 @var{compute}
27542 Return a new extension for services of type @var{target-type}.
27543 @var{compute} must be a one-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
27544 calls it, passing it the value associated with the service that provides
27545 the extension; it must return a valid value for the target service.
27546 @end deffn
27547
27548 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension? @var{obj}
27549 Return true if @var{obj} is a service extension.
27550 @end deffn
27551
27552 Occasionally, you might want to simply extend an existing service. This
27553 involves creating a new service type and specifying the extension of
27554 interest, which can be verbose; the @code{simple-service} procedure
27555 provides a shorthand for this.
27556
27557 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} simple-service @var{name} @var{target} @var{value}
27558 Return a service that extends @var{target} with @var{value}. This works
27559 by creating a singleton service type @var{name}, of which the returned
27560 service is an instance.
27561
27562 For example, this extends mcron (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}) with
27563 an additional job:
27564
27565 @lisp
27566 (simple-service 'my-mcron-job mcron-service-type
27567 #~(job '(next-hour (3)) "guix gc -F 2G"))
27568 @end lisp
27569 @end deffn
27570
27571 At the core of the service abstraction lies the @code{fold-services}
27572 procedure, which is responsible for ``compiling'' a list of services
27573 down to a single directory that contains everything needed to boot and
27574 run the system---the directory shown by the @command{guix system build}
27575 command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). In essence, it propagates
27576 service extensions down the service graph, updating each node parameters
27577 on the way, until it reaches the root node.
27578
27579 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} fold-services @var{services} @
27580 [#:target-type @var{system-service-type}]
27581 Fold @var{services} by propagating their extensions down to the root of
27582 type @var{target-type}; return the root service adjusted accordingly.
27583 @end deffn
27584
27585 Lastly, the @code{(gnu services)} module also defines several essential
27586 service types, some of which are listed below.
27587
27588 @defvr {Scheme Variable} system-service-type
27589 This is the root of the service graph. It produces the system directory
27590 as returned by the @command{guix system build} command.
27591 @end defvr
27592
27593 @defvr {Scheme Variable} boot-service-type
27594 The type of the ``boot service'', which produces the @dfn{boot script}.
27595 The boot script is what the initial RAM disk runs when booting.
27596 @end defvr
27597
27598 @defvr {Scheme Variable} etc-service-type
27599 The type of the @file{/etc} service. This service is used to create
27600 files under @file{/etc} and can be extended by
27601 passing it name/file tuples such as:
27602
27603 @lisp
27604 (list `("issue" ,(plain-file "issue" "Welcome!\n")))
27605 @end lisp
27606
27607 In this example, the effect would be to add an @file{/etc/issue} file
27608 pointing to the given file.
27609 @end defvr
27610
27611 @defvr {Scheme Variable} setuid-program-service-type
27612 Type for the ``setuid-program service''. This service collects lists of
27613 executable file names, passed as gexps, and adds them to the set of
27614 setuid-root programs on the system (@pxref{Setuid Programs}).
27615 @end defvr
27616
27617 @defvr {Scheme Variable} profile-service-type
27618 Type of the service that populates the @dfn{system profile}---i.e., the
27619 programs under @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Other services can
27620 extend it by passing it lists of packages to add to the system profile.
27621 @end defvr
27622
27623 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
27624 @defvr {Scheme Variable} provenance-service-type
27625 This is the type of the service that records @dfn{provenance meta-data}
27626 in the system itself. It creates several files under
27627 @file{/run/current-system}:
27628
27629 @table @file
27630 @item channels.scm
27631 This is a ``channel file'' that can be passed to @command{guix pull -C}
27632 or @command{guix time-machine -C}, and which describes the channels used
27633 to build the system, if that information was available
27634 (@pxref{Channels}).
27635
27636 @item configuration.scm
27637 This is the file that was passed as the value for this
27638 @code{provenance-service-type} service. By default, @command{guix
27639 system reconfigure} automatically passes the OS configuration file it
27640 received on the command line.
27641
27642 @item provenance
27643 This contains the same information as the two other files but in a
27644 format that is more readily processable.
27645 @end table
27646
27647 In general, these two pieces of information (channels and configuration
27648 file) are enough to reproduce the operating system ``from source''.
27649
27650 @quotation Caveats
27651 This information is necessary to rebuild your operating system, but it
27652 is not always sufficient. In particular, @file{configuration.scm}
27653 itself is insufficient if it is not self-contained---if it refers to
27654 external Guile modules or to extra files. If you want
27655 @file{configuration.scm} to be self-contained, we recommend that modules
27656 or files it refers to be part of a channel.
27657
27658 Besides, provenance meta-data is ``silent'' in the sense that it does
27659 not change the bits contained in your system, @emph{except for the
27660 meta-data bits themselves}. Two different OS configurations or sets of
27661 channels can lead to the same system, bit-for-bit; when
27662 @code{provenance-service-type} is used, these two systems will have
27663 different meta-data and thus different store file names, which makes
27664 comparison less trivial.
27665 @end quotation
27666
27667 This service is automatically added to your operating system
27668 configuration when you use @command{guix system reconfigure},
27669 @command{guix system init}, or @command{guix deploy}.
27670 @end defvr
27671
27672 @node Shepherd Services
27673 @subsection Shepherd Services
27674
27675 @cindex shepherd services
27676 @cindex PID 1
27677 @cindex init system
27678 The @code{(gnu services shepherd)} module provides a way to define
27679 services managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, which is the
27680 initialization system---the first process that is started when the
27681 system boots, also known as PID@tie{}1
27682 (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
27683
27684 Services in the Shepherd can depend on each other. For instance, the
27685 SSH daemon may need to be started after the syslog daemon has been
27686 started, which in turn can only happen once all the file systems have
27687 been mounted. The simple operating system defined earlier (@pxref{Using
27688 the Configuration System}) results in a service graph like this:
27689
27690 @image{images/shepherd-graph,,5in,Typical shepherd service graph.}
27691
27692 You can actually generate such a graph for any operating system
27693 definition using the @command{guix system shepherd-graph} command
27694 (@pxref{system-shepherd-graph, @command{guix system shepherd-graph}}).
27695
27696 The @code{%shepherd-root-service} is a service object representing
27697 PID@tie{}1, of type @code{shepherd-root-service-type}; it can be extended
27698 by passing it lists of @code{<shepherd-service>} objects.
27699
27700 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-service
27701 The data type representing a service managed by the Shepherd.
27702
27703 @table @asis
27704 @item @code{provision}
27705 This is a list of symbols denoting what the service provides.
27706
27707 These are the names that may be passed to @command{herd start},
27708 @command{herd status}, and similar commands (@pxref{Invoking herd,,,
27709 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). @xref{Slots of services, the
27710 @code{provides} slot,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for details.
27711
27712 @item @code{requirement} (default: @code{'()})
27713 List of symbols denoting the Shepherd services this one depends on.
27714
27715 @cindex one-shot services, for the Shepherd
27716 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
27717 Whether this service is @dfn{one-shot}. One-shot services stop immediately
27718 after their @code{start} action has completed. @xref{Slots of services,,,
27719 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more info.
27720
27721 @item @code{respawn?} (default: @code{#t})
27722 Whether to restart the service when it stops, for instance when the
27723 underlying process dies.
27724
27725 @item @code{start}
27726 @itemx @code{stop} (default: @code{#~(const #f)})
27727 The @code{start} and @code{stop} fields refer to the Shepherd's
27728 facilities to start and stop processes (@pxref{Service De- and
27729 Constructors,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). They are given as
27730 G-expressions that get expanded in the Shepherd configuration file
27731 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
27732
27733 @item @code{actions} (default: @code{'()})
27734 @cindex actions, of Shepherd services
27735 This is a list of @code{shepherd-action} objects (see below) defining
27736 @dfn{actions} supported by the service, in addition to the standard
27737 @code{start} and @code{stop} actions. Actions listed here become available as
27738 @command{herd} sub-commands:
27739
27740 @example
27741 herd @var{action} @var{service} [@var{arguments}@dots{}]
27742 @end example
27743
27744 @item @code{auto-start?} (default: @code{#t})
27745 Whether this service should be started automatically by the Shepherd. If it
27746 is @code{#f} the service has to be started manually with @code{herd start}.
27747
27748 @item @code{documentation}
27749 A documentation string, as shown when running:
27750
27751 @example
27752 herd doc @var{service-name}
27753 @end example
27754
27755 where @var{service-name} is one of the symbols in @code{provision}
27756 (@pxref{Invoking herd,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
27757
27758 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-modules})
27759 This is the list of modules that must be in scope when @code{start} and
27760 @code{stop} are evaluated.
27761
27762 @end table
27763 @end deftp
27764
27765 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-action
27766 This is the data type that defines additional actions implemented by a
27767 Shepherd service (see above).
27768
27769 @table @code
27770 @item name
27771 Symbol naming the action.
27772
27773 @item documentation
27774 This is a documentation string for the action. It can be viewed by running:
27775
27776 @example
27777 herd doc @var{service} action @var{action}
27778 @end example
27779
27780 @item procedure
27781 This should be a gexp that evaluates to a procedure of at least one argument,
27782 which is the ``running value'' of the service (@pxref{Slots of services,,,
27783 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
27784 @end table
27785
27786 The following example defines an action called @code{say-hello} that kindly
27787 greets the user:
27788
27789 @lisp
27790 (shepherd-action
27791 (name 'say-hello)
27792 (documentation "Say hi!")
27793 (procedure #~(lambda (running . args)
27794 (format #t "Hello, friend! arguments: ~s\n"
27795 args)
27796 #t)))
27797 @end lisp
27798
27799 Assuming this action is added to the @code{example} service, then you can do:
27800
27801 @example
27802 # herd say-hello example
27803 Hello, friend! arguments: ()
27804 # herd say-hello example a b c
27805 Hello, friend! arguments: ("a" "b" "c")
27806 @end example
27807
27808 This, as you can see, is a fairly sophisticated way to say hello.
27809 @xref{Service Convenience,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more
27810 info on actions.
27811 @end deftp
27812
27813 @defvr {Scheme Variable} shepherd-root-service-type
27814 The service type for the Shepherd ``root service''---i.e., PID@tie{}1.
27815
27816 This is the service type that extensions target when they want to create
27817 shepherd services (@pxref{Service Types and Services}, for an example).
27818 Each extension must pass a list of @code{<shepherd-service>}.
27819 @end defvr
27820
27821 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shepherd-root-service
27822 This service represents PID@tie{}1.
27823 @end defvr
27824
27825
27826 @node Documentation
27827 @chapter Documentation
27828
27829 @cindex documentation, searching for
27830 @cindex searching for documentation
27831 @cindex Info, documentation format
27832 @cindex man pages
27833 @cindex manual pages
27834 In most cases packages installed with Guix come with documentation.
27835 There are two main documentation formats: ``Info'', a browseable
27836 hypertext format used for GNU software, and ``manual pages'' (or ``man
27837 pages''), the linear documentation format traditionally found on Unix.
27838 Info manuals are accessed with the @command{info} command or with Emacs,
27839 and man pages are accessed using @command{man}.
27840
27841 You can look for documentation of software installed on your system by
27842 keyword. For example, the following command searches for information
27843 about ``TLS'' in Info manuals:
27844
27845 @example
27846 $ info -k TLS
27847 "(emacs)Network Security" -- STARTTLS
27848 "(emacs)Network Security" -- TLS
27849 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_flags
27850 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_function
27851 @dots{}
27852 @end example
27853
27854 @noindent
27855 The command below searches for the same keyword in man pages:
27856
27857 @example
27858 $ man -k TLS
27859 SSL (7) - OpenSSL SSL/TLS library
27860 certtool (1) - GnuTLS certificate tool
27861 @dots {}
27862 @end example
27863
27864 These searches are purely local to your computer so you have the
27865 guarantee that documentation you find corresponds to what you have
27866 actually installed, you can access it off-line, and your privacy is
27867 respected.
27868
27869 Once you have these results, you can view the relevant documentation by
27870 running, say:
27871
27872 @example
27873 $ info "(gnutls)Core TLS API"
27874 @end example
27875
27876 @noindent
27877 or:
27878
27879 @example
27880 $ man certtool
27881 @end example
27882
27883 Info manuals contain sections and indices as well as hyperlinks like
27884 those found in Web pages. The @command{info} reader (@pxref{Top, Info
27885 reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU Info}) and its Emacs counterpart
27886 (@pxref{Misc Help,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}) provide intuitive key
27887 bindings to navigate manuals. @xref{Getting Started,,, info, Info: An
27888 Introduction}, for an introduction to Info navigation.
27889
27890 @node Installing Debugging Files
27891 @chapter Installing Debugging Files
27892
27893 @cindex debugging files
27894 Program binaries, as produced by the GCC compilers for instance, are
27895 typically written in the ELF format, with a section containing
27896 @dfn{debugging information}. Debugging information is what allows the
27897 debugger, GDB, to map binary code to source code; it is required to
27898 debug a compiled program in good conditions.
27899
27900 The problem with debugging information is that is takes up a fair amount
27901 of disk space. For example, debugging information for the GNU C Library
27902 weighs in at more than 60 MiB. Thus, as a user, keeping all the
27903 debugging info of all the installed programs is usually not an option.
27904 Yet, space savings should not come at the cost of an impediment to
27905 debugging---especially in the GNU system, which should make it easier
27906 for users to exert their computing freedom (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
27907
27908 Thankfully, the GNU Binary Utilities (Binutils) and GDB provide a
27909 mechanism that allows users to get the best of both worlds: debugging
27910 information can be stripped from the binaries and stored in separate
27911 files. GDB is then able to load debugging information from those files,
27912 when they are available (@pxref{Separate Debug Files,,, gdb, Debugging
27913 with GDB}).
27914
27915 The GNU distribution takes advantage of this by storing debugging
27916 information in the @code{lib/debug} sub-directory of a separate package
27917 output unimaginatively called @code{debug} (@pxref{Packages with
27918 Multiple Outputs}). Users can choose to install the @code{debug} output
27919 of a package when they need it. For instance, the following command
27920 installs the debugging information for the GNU C Library and for GNU
27921 Guile:
27922
27923 @example
27924 guix install glibc:debug guile:debug
27925 @end example
27926
27927 GDB must then be told to look for debug files in the user's profile, by
27928 setting the @code{debug-file-directory} variable (consider setting it
27929 from the @file{~/.gdbinit} file, @pxref{Startup,,, gdb, Debugging with
27930 GDB}):
27931
27932 @example
27933 (gdb) set debug-file-directory ~/.guix-profile/lib/debug
27934 @end example
27935
27936 From there on, GDB will pick up debugging information from the
27937 @code{.debug} files under @file{~/.guix-profile/lib/debug}.
27938
27939 In addition, you will most likely want GDB to be able to show the source
27940 code being debugged. To do that, you will have to unpack the source
27941 code of the package of interest (obtained with @code{guix build
27942 --source}, @pxref{Invoking guix build}), and to point GDB to that source
27943 directory using the @code{directory} command (@pxref{Source Path,
27944 @code{directory},, gdb, Debugging with GDB}).
27945
27946 @c XXX: keep me up-to-date
27947 The @code{debug} output mechanism in Guix is implemented by the
27948 @code{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems}). Currently, it is
27949 opt-in---debugging information is available only for the packages
27950 with definitions explicitly declaring a @code{debug} output. This may be
27951 changed to opt-out in the future if our build farm servers can handle
27952 the load. To check whether a package has a @code{debug} output, use
27953 @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
27954
27955
27956 @node Security Updates
27957 @chapter Security Updates
27958
27959 @cindex security updates
27960 @cindex security vulnerabilities
27961 Occasionally, important security vulnerabilities are discovered in software
27962 packages and must be patched. Guix developers try hard to keep track of
27963 known vulnerabilities and to apply fixes as soon as possible in the
27964 @code{master} branch of Guix (we do not yet provide a ``stable'' branch
27965 containing only security updates.) The @command{guix lint} tool helps
27966 developers find out about vulnerable versions of software packages in the
27967 distribution:
27968
27969 @smallexample
27970 $ guix lint -c cve
27971 gnu/packages/base.scm:652:2: glibc@@2.21: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-1781, CVE-2015-7547
27972 gnu/packages/gcc.scm:334:2: gcc@@4.9.3: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-5276
27973 gnu/packages/image.scm:312:2: openjpeg@@2.1.0: probably vulnerable to CVE-2016-1923, CVE-2016-1924
27974 @dots{}
27975 @end smallexample
27976
27977 @xref{Invoking guix lint}, for more information.
27978
27979 Guix follows a functional
27980 package management discipline (@pxref{Introduction}), which implies
27981 that, when a package is changed, @emph{every package that depends on it}
27982 must be rebuilt. This can significantly slow down the deployment of
27983 fixes in core packages such as libc or Bash, since basically the whole
27984 distribution would need to be rebuilt. Using pre-built binaries helps
27985 (@pxref{Substitutes}), but deployment may still take more time than
27986 desired.
27987
27988 @cindex grafts
27989 To address this, Guix implements @dfn{grafts}, a mechanism that allows
27990 for fast deployment of critical updates without the costs associated
27991 with a whole-distribution rebuild. The idea is to rebuild only the
27992 package that needs to be patched, and then to ``graft'' it onto packages
27993 explicitly installed by the user and that were previously referring to
27994 the original package. The cost of grafting is typically very low, and
27995 order of magnitudes lower than a full rebuild of the dependency chain.
27996
27997 @cindex replacements of packages, for grafts
27998 For instance, suppose a security update needs to be applied to Bash.
27999 Guix developers will provide a package definition for the ``fixed''
28000 Bash, say @code{bash-fixed}, in the usual way (@pxref{Defining
28001 Packages}). Then, the original package definition is augmented with a
28002 @code{replacement} field pointing to the package containing the bug fix:
28003
28004 @lisp
28005 (define bash
28006 (package
28007 (name "bash")
28008 ;; @dots{}
28009 (replacement bash-fixed)))
28010 @end lisp
28011
28012 From there on, any package depending directly or indirectly on Bash---as
28013 reported by @command{guix gc --requisites} (@pxref{Invoking guix
28014 gc})---that is installed is automatically ``rewritten'' to refer to
28015 @code{bash-fixed} instead of @code{bash}. This grafting process takes
28016 time proportional to the size of the package, usually less than a
28017 minute for an ``average'' package on a recent machine. Grafting is
28018 recursive: when an indirect dependency requires grafting, then grafting
28019 ``propagates'' up to the package that the user is installing.
28020
28021 Currently, the length of the name and version of the graft and that of
28022 the package it replaces (@code{bash-fixed} and @code{bash} in the example
28023 above) must be equal. This restriction mostly comes from the fact that
28024 grafting works by patching files, including binary files, directly.
28025 Other restrictions may apply: for instance, when adding a graft to a
28026 package providing a shared library, the original shared library and its
28027 replacement must have the same @code{SONAME} and be binary-compatible.
28028
28029 The @option{--no-grafts} command-line option allows you to forcefully
28030 avoid grafting (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--no-grafts}}).
28031 Thus, the command:
28032
28033 @example
28034 guix build bash --no-grafts
28035 @end example
28036
28037 @noindent
28038 returns the store file name of the original Bash, whereas:
28039
28040 @example
28041 guix build bash
28042 @end example
28043
28044 @noindent
28045 returns the store file name of the ``fixed'', replacement Bash. This
28046 allows you to distinguish between the two variants of Bash.
28047
28048 To verify which Bash your whole profile refers to, you can run
28049 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}):
28050
28051 @example
28052 guix gc -R `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile` | grep bash
28053 @end example
28054
28055 @noindent
28056 @dots{} and compare the store file names that you get with those above.
28057 Likewise for a complete Guix system generation:
28058
28059 @example
28060 guix gc -R `guix system build my-config.scm` | grep bash
28061 @end example
28062
28063 Lastly, to check which Bash running processes are using, you can use the
28064 @command{lsof} command:
28065
28066 @example
28067 lsof | grep /gnu/store/.*bash
28068 @end example
28069
28070
28071 @node Bootstrapping
28072 @chapter Bootstrapping
28073
28074 @c Adapted from the ELS 2013 paper.
28075
28076 @cindex bootstrapping
28077
28078 Bootstrapping in our context refers to how the distribution gets built
28079 ``from nothing''. Remember that the build environment of a derivation
28080 contains nothing but its declared inputs (@pxref{Introduction}). So
28081 there's an obvious chicken-and-egg problem: how does the first package
28082 get built? How does the first compiler get compiled? Note that this is
28083 a question of interest only to the curious hacker, not to the regular
28084 user, so you can shamelessly skip this section if you consider yourself
28085 a ``regular user''.
28086
28087 @cindex bootstrap binaries
28088 The GNU system is primarily made of C code, with libc at its core. The
28089 GNU build system itself assumes the availability of a Bourne shell and
28090 command-line tools provided by GNU Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and
28091 `grep'. Furthermore, build programs---programs that run
28092 @code{./configure}, @code{make}, etc.---are written in Guile Scheme
28093 (@pxref{Derivations}). Consequently, to be able to build anything at
28094 all, from scratch, Guix relies on pre-built binaries of Guile, GCC,
28095 Binutils, libc, and the other packages mentioned above---the
28096 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}.
28097
28098 These bootstrap binaries are ``taken for granted'', though we can also
28099 re-create them if needed (more on that later).
28100
28101 For @code{i686-linux} and @code{x86_64-linux} the Guix bootstrap process is
28102 more elaborate, @pxref{Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap}.
28103
28104 @menu
28105 * Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap:: A Bootstrap worthy of GNU.
28106 * Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries:: Building that what matters most.
28107 @end menu
28108
28109 @node Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap
28110 @section The Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap
28111
28112 Guix---like other GNU/Linux distributions---is traditionally bootstrapped from
28113 a set of bootstrap binaries: Bourne shell, command-line tools provided by GNU
28114 Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and `grep' and Guile, GCC, Binutils, and the
28115 GNU C Library (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). Usually, these bootstrap binaries are
28116 ``taken for granted.''
28117
28118 Taking these binaries for granted means that we consider them to be a correct
28119 and trustworthy `seed' for building the complete system. Therein lies a
28120 problem: the current combined size of these bootstrap binaries is about 250MB
28121 (@pxref{Bootstrappable Builds,,, mes, GNU Mes}). Auditing or even inspecting
28122 these is next to impossible.
28123
28124 For @code{i686-linux} and @code{x86_64-linux}, Guix now features a ``Reduced
28125 Binary Seed'' bootstrap @footnote{We would like to say: ``Full Source
28126 Bootstrap'' and while we are working towards that goal it would be hyperbole
28127 to use that term for what we do now.}.
28128
28129 The Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap removes the most critical tools---from a
28130 trust perspective---from the bootstrap binaries: GCC, Binutils and the GNU C
28131 Library are replaced by: @code{bootstrap-mescc-tools} (a tiny assembler and
28132 linker) and @code{bootstrap-mes} (a small Scheme Interpreter and a C compiler
28133 written in Scheme and the Mes C Library, built for TinyCC and for GCC). Using
28134 these new binary seeds and a new set of
28135 @c
28136 packages@footnote{@c
28137 nyacc-boot,
28138 mes-boot,
28139 tcc-boot0,
28140 tcc-boot,
28141 make-mesboot0,
28142 diffutils-mesboot,
28143 binutils-mesboot0,
28144 gcc-core-mesboot,
28145 mesboot-headers,
28146 glibc-mesboot0,
28147 gcc-mesboot0,
28148 binutils-mesboot,
28149 make-mesboot,
28150 gcc-mesboot1,
28151 gcc-mesboot1-wrapper,
28152 glibc-headers-mesboot,
28153 glibc-mesboot,
28154 gcc-mesboot,
28155 and
28156 gcc-mesboot-wrapper.
28157 }
28158 @c
28159 the ``missing'' Binutils, GCC, and the GNU C Library are built from source.
28160 From here on the more traditional bootstrap process resumes. This approach
28161 has reduced the bootstrap binaries in size to about 130MB. Work is ongoing to
28162 reduce this further. If you are interested, join us on @code{#bootstrappable}
28163 on the Freenode IRC network.
28164
28165 @c ./pre-inst-env guix graph --type=bag -e '(begin (use-modules (guix packages)) (%current-system "i686-linux") (@@ (gnu packages commencement) gcc-mesboot))' > doc/images/gcc-mesboot-bag-graph.dot
28166 @c dot -T png doc/images/gcc-mesboot-bag-graph.dot > doc/images/gcc-mesboot-bag-graph.png
28167
28168 Below is the generated dependency graph for @code{gcc-mesboot}, the bootstrap
28169 compiler used to build the rest of GuixSD.
28170
28171 @image{images/gcc-mesboot-bag-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the gcc-mesboot}
28172
28173 @node Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
28174 @section Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
28175
28176 @c As of Emacs 24.3, Info-mode displays the image, but since it's a
28177 @c large image, it's hard to scroll. Oh well.
28178 @image{images/bootstrap-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the early bootstrap derivations}
28179
28180 The figure above shows the very beginning of the dependency graph of the
28181 distribution, corresponding to the package definitions of the @code{(gnu
28182 packages bootstrap)} module. A similar figure can be generated with
28183 @command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}), along the lines of:
28184
28185 @example
28186 guix graph -t derivation \
28187 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-gcc)' \
28188 | dot -Tps > gcc.ps
28189 @end example
28190
28191 or, for the Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap
28192
28193 @example
28194 guix graph -t derivation \
28195 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-mes)' \
28196 | dot -Tps > mes.ps
28197 @end example
28198
28199 At this level of detail, things are
28200 slightly complex. First, Guile itself consists of an ELF executable,
28201 along with many source and compiled Scheme files that are dynamically
28202 loaded when it runs. This gets stored in the @file{guile-2.0.7.tar.xz}
28203 tarball shown in this graph. This tarball is part of Guix's ``source''
28204 distribution, and gets inserted into the store with @code{add-to-store}
28205 (@pxref{The Store}).
28206
28207 But how do we write a derivation that unpacks this tarball and adds it
28208 to the store? To solve this problem, the @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv}
28209 derivation---the first one that gets built---uses @code{bash} as its
28210 builder, which runs @code{build-bootstrap-guile.sh}, which in turn calls
28211 @code{tar} to unpack the tarball. Thus, @file{bash}, @file{tar},
28212 @file{xz}, and @file{mkdir} are statically-linked binaries, also part of
28213 the Guix source distribution, whose sole purpose is to allow the Guile
28214 tarball to be unpacked.
28215
28216 Once @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv} is built, we have a functioning
28217 Guile that can be used to run subsequent build programs. Its first task
28218 is to download tarballs containing the other pre-built binaries---this
28219 is what the @code{.tar.xz.drv} derivations do. Guix modules such as
28220 @code{ftp-client.scm} are used for this purpose. The
28221 @code{module-import.drv} derivations import those modules in a directory
28222 in the store, using the original layout. The
28223 @code{module-import-compiled.drv} derivations compile those modules, and
28224 write them in an output directory with the right layout. This
28225 corresponds to the @code{#:modules} argument of
28226 @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
28227
28228 Finally, the various tarballs are unpacked by the derivations
28229 @code{gcc-bootstrap-0.drv}, @code{glibc-bootstrap-0.drv}, or
28230 @code{bootstrap-mes-0.drv} and @code{bootstrap-mescc-tools-0.drv}, at which
28231 point we have a working C tool chain.
28232
28233 @unnumberedsec Building the Build Tools
28234
28235 Bootstrapping is complete when we have a full tool chain that does not
28236 depend on the pre-built bootstrap tools discussed above. This
28237 no-dependency requirement is verified by checking whether the files of
28238 the final tool chain contain references to the @file{/gnu/store}
28239 directories of the bootstrap inputs. The process that leads to this
28240 ``final'' tool chain is described by the package definitions found in
28241 the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module.
28242
28243 The @command{guix graph} command allows us to ``zoom out'' compared to
28244 the graph above, by looking at the level of package objects instead of
28245 individual derivations---remember that a package may translate to
28246 several derivations, typically one derivation to download its source,
28247 one to build the Guile modules it needs, and one to actually build the
28248 package from source. The command:
28249
28250 @example
28251 guix graph -t bag \
28252 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement)
28253 glibc-final-with-bootstrap-bash)' | dot -Tps > t.ps
28254 @end example
28255
28256 @noindent
28257 produces the dependency graph leading to the ``final'' C
28258 library@footnote{You may notice the @code{glibc-intermediate} label,
28259 suggesting that it is not @emph{quite} final, but as a good
28260 approximation, we will consider it final.}, depicted below.
28261
28262 @image{images/bootstrap-packages,6in,,Dependency graph of the early packages}
28263
28264 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/gnu-system-discuss/2012-10/msg00000.html>.
28265 The first tool that gets built with the bootstrap binaries is
28266 GNU@tie{}Make---noted @code{make-boot0} above---which is a prerequisite
28267 for all the following packages. From there Findutils and Diffutils get
28268 built.
28269
28270 Then come the first-stage Binutils and GCC, built as pseudo cross
28271 tools---i.e., with @code{--target} equal to @code{--host}. They are
28272 used to build libc. Thanks to this cross-build trick, this libc is
28273 guaranteed not to hold any reference to the initial tool chain.
28274
28275 From there the final Binutils and GCC (not shown above) are built.
28276 GCC uses @code{ld}
28277 from the final Binutils, and links programs against the just-built libc.
28278 This tool chain is used to build the other packages used by Guix and by
28279 the GNU Build System: Guile, Bash, Coreutils, etc.
28280
28281 And voilà! At this point we have the complete set of build tools that
28282 the GNU Build System expects. These are in the @code{%final-inputs}
28283 variable of the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module, and are
28284 implicitly used by any package that uses @code{gnu-build-system}
28285 (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
28286
28287
28288 @unnumberedsec Building the Bootstrap Binaries
28289
28290 @cindex bootstrap binaries
28291 Because the final tool chain does not depend on the bootstrap binaries,
28292 those rarely need to be updated. Nevertheless, it is useful to have an
28293 automated way to produce them, should an update occur, and this is what
28294 the @code{(gnu packages make-bootstrap)} module provides.
28295
28296 The following command builds the tarballs containing the bootstrap binaries
28297 (Binutils, GCC, glibc, for the traditional bootstrap and linux-libre-headers,
28298 bootstrap-mescc-tools, bootstrap-mes for the Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap,
28299 and Guile, and a tarball containing a mixture of Coreutils and other basic
28300 command-line tools):
28301
28302 @example
28303 guix build bootstrap-tarballs
28304 @end example
28305
28306 The generated tarballs are those that should be referred to in the
28307 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module mentioned at the beginning of
28308 this section.
28309
28310 Still here? Then perhaps by now you've started to wonder: when do we
28311 reach a fixed point? That is an interesting question! The answer is
28312 unknown, but if you would like to investigate further (and have
28313 significant computational and storage resources to do so), then let us
28314 know.
28315
28316 @unnumberedsec Reducing the Set of Bootstrap Binaries
28317
28318 Our traditional bootstrap includes GCC, GNU Libc, Guile, etc. That's a lot of
28319 binary code! Why is that a problem? It's a problem because these big chunks
28320 of binary code are practically non-auditable, which makes it hard to establish
28321 what source code produced them. Every unauditable binary also leaves us
28322 vulnerable to compiler backdoors as described by Ken Thompson in the 1984
28323 paper @emph{Reflections on Trusting Trust}.
28324
28325 This is mitigated by the fact that our bootstrap binaries were generated
28326 from an earlier Guix revision. Nevertheless it lacks the level of
28327 transparency that we get in the rest of the package dependency graph,
28328 where Guix always gives us a source-to-binary mapping. Thus, our goal
28329 is to reduce the set of bootstrap binaries to the bare minimum.
28330
28331 The @uref{https://bootstrappable.org, Bootstrappable.org web site} lists
28332 on-going projects to do that. One of these is about replacing the
28333 bootstrap GCC with a sequence of assemblers, interpreters, and compilers
28334 of increasing complexity, which could be built from source starting from
28335 a simple and auditable assembler.
28336
28337 Our first major achievement is the replacement of of GCC, the GNU C Library
28338 and Binutils by MesCC-Tools (a simple hex linker and macro assembler) and Mes
28339 (@pxref{Top, GNU Mes Reference Manual,, mes, GNU Mes}, a Scheme interpreter
28340 and C compiler in Scheme). Neither MesCC-Tools nor Mes can be fully
28341 bootstrapped yet and thus we inject them as binary seeds. We call this the
28342 Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap, as it has halved the size of our bootstrap
28343 binaries! Also, it has eliminated the C compiler binary; i686-linux and
28344 x86_64-linux Guix packages are now bootstrapped without any binary C compiler.
28345
28346 Work is ongoing to make MesCC-Tools and Mes fully bootstrappable and we are
28347 also looking at any other bootstrap binaries. Your help is welcome!
28348
28349 @node Porting
28350 @chapter Porting to a New Platform
28351
28352 As discussed above, the GNU distribution is self-contained, and
28353 self-containment is achieved by relying on pre-built ``bootstrap
28354 binaries'' (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). These binaries are specific to an
28355 operating system kernel, CPU architecture, and application binary
28356 interface (ABI). Thus, to port the distribution to a platform that is
28357 not yet supported, one must build those bootstrap binaries, and update
28358 the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module to use them on that platform.
28359
28360 Fortunately, Guix can @emph{cross compile} those bootstrap binaries.
28361 When everything goes well, and assuming the GNU tool chain supports the
28362 target platform, this can be as simple as running a command like this
28363 one:
28364
28365 @example
28366 guix build --target=armv5tel-linux-gnueabi bootstrap-tarballs
28367 @end example
28368
28369 For this to work, the @code{glibc-dynamic-linker} procedure in
28370 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} must be augmented to return the right
28371 file name for libc's dynamic linker on that platform; likewise,
28372 @code{system->linux-architecture} in @code{(gnu packages linux)} must be
28373 taught about the new platform.
28374
28375 Once these are built, the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module needs
28376 to be updated to refer to these binaries on the target platform. That
28377 is, the hashes and URLs of the bootstrap tarballs for the new platform
28378 must be added alongside those of the currently supported platforms. The
28379 bootstrap Guile tarball is treated specially: it is expected to be
28380 available locally, and @file{gnu/local.mk} has rules to download it for
28381 the supported architectures; a rule for the new platform must be added
28382 as well.
28383
28384 In practice, there may be some complications. First, it may be that the
28385 extended GNU triplet that specifies an ABI (like the @code{eabi} suffix
28386 above) is not recognized by all the GNU tools. Typically, glibc
28387 recognizes some of these, whereas GCC uses an extra @code{--with-abi}
28388 configure flag (see @code{gcc.scm} for examples of how to handle this).
28389 Second, some of the required packages could fail to build for that
28390 platform. Lastly, the generated binaries could be broken for some
28391 reason.
28392
28393 @c *********************************************************************
28394 @include contributing.texi
28395
28396 @c *********************************************************************
28397 @node Acknowledgments
28398 @chapter Acknowledgments
28399
28400 Guix is based on the @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix package manager},
28401 which was designed and
28402 implemented by Eelco Dolstra, with contributions from other people (see
28403 the @file{nix/AUTHORS} file in Guix.) Nix pioneered functional package
28404 management, and promoted unprecedented features, such as transactional
28405 package upgrades and rollbacks, per-user profiles, and referentially
28406 transparent build processes. Without this work, Guix would not exist.
28407
28408 The Nix-based software distributions, Nixpkgs and NixOS, have also been
28409 an inspiration for Guix.
28410
28411 GNU@tie{}Guix itself is a collective work with contributions from a
28412 number of people. See the @file{AUTHORS} file in Guix for more
28413 information on these fine people. The @file{THANKS} file lists people
28414 who have helped by reporting bugs, taking care of the infrastructure,
28415 providing artwork and themes, making suggestions, and more---thank you!
28416
28417
28418 @c *********************************************************************
28419 @node GNU Free Documentation License
28420 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
28421 @cindex license, GNU Free Documentation License
28422 @include fdl-1.3.texi
28423
28424 @c *********************************************************************
28425 @node Concept Index
28426 @unnumbered Concept Index
28427 @printindex cp
28428
28429 @node Programming Index
28430 @unnumbered Programming Index
28431 @syncodeindex tp fn
28432 @syncodeindex vr fn
28433 @printindex fn
28434
28435 @bye
28436
28437 @c Local Variables:
28438 @c ispell-local-dictionary: "american";
28439 @c End: